Reduce some cal-tex code duplication
[emacs.git] / src / xdisp.c
blobe41783d03c1154b36dbbc099f491a72df1779aac
1 /* Display generation from window structure and buffer text.
3 Copyright (C) 1985-1988, 1993-1995, 1997-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New redisplay written by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>.
22 Redisplay.
24 Emacs separates the task of updating the display from code
25 modifying global state, e.g. buffer text. This way functions
26 operating on buffers don't also have to be concerned with updating
27 the display.
29 Updating the display is triggered by the Lisp interpreter when it
30 decides it's time to do it. This is done either automatically for
31 you as part of the interpreter's command loop or as the result of
32 calling Lisp functions like `sit-for'. The C function `redisplay'
33 in xdisp.c is the only entry into the inner redisplay code.
35 The following diagram shows how redisplay code is invoked. As you
36 can see, Lisp calls redisplay and vice versa. Under window systems
37 like X, some portions of the redisplay code are also called
38 asynchronously during mouse movement or expose events. It is very
39 important that these code parts do NOT use the C library (malloc,
40 free) because many C libraries under Unix are not reentrant. They
41 may also NOT call functions of the Lisp interpreter which could
42 change the interpreter's state. If you don't follow these rules,
43 you will encounter bugs which are very hard to explain.
45 +--------------+ redisplay +----------------+
46 | Lisp machine |---------------->| Redisplay code |<--+
47 +--------------+ (xdisp.c) +----------------+ |
48 ^ | |
49 +----------------------------------+ |
50 Don't use this path when called |
51 asynchronously! |
53 expose_window (asynchronous) |
55 X expose events -----+
57 What does redisplay do? Obviously, it has to figure out somehow what
58 has been changed since the last time the display has been updated,
59 and to make these changes visible. Preferably it would do that in
60 a moderately intelligent way, i.e. fast.
62 Changes in buffer text can be deduced from window and buffer
63 structures, and from some global variables like `beg_unchanged' and
64 `end_unchanged'. The contents of the display are additionally
65 recorded in a `glyph matrix', a two-dimensional matrix of glyph
66 structures. Each row in such a matrix corresponds to a line on the
67 display, and each glyph in a row corresponds to a column displaying
68 a character, an image, or what else. This matrix is called the
69 `current glyph matrix' or `current matrix' in redisplay
70 terminology.
72 For buffer parts that have been changed since the last update, a
73 second glyph matrix is constructed, the so called `desired glyph
74 matrix' or short `desired matrix'. Current and desired matrix are
75 then compared to find a cheap way to update the display, e.g. by
76 reusing part of the display by scrolling lines.
78 You will find a lot of redisplay optimizations when you start
79 looking at the innards of redisplay. The overall goal of all these
80 optimizations is to make redisplay fast because it is done
81 frequently. Some of these optimizations are implemented by the
82 following functions:
84 . try_cursor_movement
86 This function tries to update the display if the text in the
87 window did not change and did not scroll, only point moved, and
88 it did not move off the displayed portion of the text.
90 . try_window_reusing_current_matrix
92 This function reuses the current matrix of a window when text
93 has not changed, but the window start changed (e.g., due to
94 scrolling).
96 . try_window_id
98 This function attempts to redisplay a window by reusing parts of
99 its existing display. It finds and reuses the part that was not
100 changed, and redraws the rest.
102 . try_window
104 This function performs the full redisplay of a single window
105 assuming that its fonts were not changed and that the cursor
106 will not end up in the scroll margins. (Loading fonts requires
107 re-adjustment of dimensions of glyph matrices, which makes this
108 method impossible to use.)
110 These optimizations are tried in sequence (some can be skipped if
111 it is known that they are not applicable). If none of the
112 optimizations were successful, redisplay calls redisplay_windows,
113 which performs a full redisplay of all windows.
115 Desired matrices.
117 Desired matrices are always built per Emacs window. The function
118 `display_line' is the central function to look at if you are
119 interested. It constructs one row in a desired matrix given an
120 iterator structure containing both a buffer position and a
121 description of the environment in which the text is to be
122 displayed. But this is too early, read on.
124 Characters and pixmaps displayed for a range of buffer text depend
125 on various settings of buffers and windows, on overlays and text
126 properties, on display tables, on selective display. The good news
127 is that all this hairy stuff is hidden behind a small set of
128 interface functions taking an iterator structure (struct it)
129 argument.
131 Iteration over things to be displayed is then simple. It is
132 started by initializing an iterator with a call to init_iterator,
133 passing it the buffer position where to start iteration. For
134 iteration over strings, pass -1 as the position to init_iterator,
135 and call reseat_to_string when the string is ready, to initialize
136 the iterator for that string. Thereafter, calls to
137 get_next_display_element fill the iterator structure with relevant
138 information about the next thing to display. Calls to
139 set_iterator_to_next move the iterator to the next thing.
141 Besides this, an iterator also contains information about the
142 display environment in which glyphs for display elements are to be
143 produced. It has fields for the width and height of the display,
144 the information whether long lines are truncated or continued, a
145 current X and Y position, and lots of other stuff you can better
146 see in dispextern.h.
148 Glyphs in a desired matrix are normally constructed in a loop
149 calling get_next_display_element and then PRODUCE_GLYPHS. The call
150 to PRODUCE_GLYPHS will fill the iterator structure with pixel
151 information about the element being displayed and at the same time
152 produce glyphs for it. If the display element fits on the line
153 being displayed, set_iterator_to_next is called next, otherwise the
154 glyphs produced are discarded. The function display_line is the
155 workhorse of filling glyph rows in the desired matrix with glyphs.
156 In addition to producing glyphs, it also handles line truncation
157 and continuation, word wrap, and cursor positioning (for the
158 latter, see also set_cursor_from_row).
160 Frame matrices.
162 That just couldn't be all, could it? What about terminal types not
163 supporting operations on sub-windows of the screen? To update the
164 display on such a terminal, window-based glyph matrices are not
165 well suited. To be able to reuse part of the display (scrolling
166 lines up and down), we must instead have a view of the whole
167 screen. This is what `frame matrices' are for. They are a trick.
169 Frames on terminals like above have a glyph pool. Windows on such
170 a frame sub-allocate their glyph memory from their frame's glyph
171 pool. The frame itself is given its own glyph matrices. By
172 coincidence---or maybe something else---rows in window glyph
173 matrices are slices of corresponding rows in frame matrices. Thus
174 writing to window matrices implicitly updates a frame matrix which
175 provides us with the view of the whole screen that we originally
176 wanted to have without having to move many bytes around. To be
177 honest, there is a little bit more done, but not much more. If you
178 plan to extend that code, take a look at dispnew.c. The function
179 build_frame_matrix is a good starting point.
181 Bidirectional display.
183 Bidirectional display adds quite some hair to this already complex
184 design. The good news are that a large portion of that hairy stuff
185 is hidden in bidi.c behind only 3 interfaces. bidi.c implements a
186 reordering engine which is called by set_iterator_to_next and
187 returns the next character to display in the visual order. See
188 commentary on bidi.c for more details. As far as redisplay is
189 concerned, the effect of calling bidi_move_to_visually_next, the
190 main interface of the reordering engine, is that the iterator gets
191 magically placed on the buffer or string position that is to be
192 displayed next. In other words, a linear iteration through the
193 buffer/string is replaced with a non-linear one. All the rest of
194 the redisplay is oblivious to the bidi reordering.
196 Well, almost oblivious---there are still complications, most of
197 them due to the fact that buffer and string positions no longer
198 change monotonously with glyph indices in a glyph row. Moreover,
199 for continued lines, the buffer positions may not even be
200 monotonously changing with vertical positions. Also, accounting
201 for face changes, overlays, etc. becomes more complex because
202 non-linear iteration could potentially skip many positions with
203 changes, and then cross them again on the way back...
205 One other prominent effect of bidirectional display is that some
206 paragraphs of text need to be displayed starting at the right
207 margin of the window---the so-called right-to-left, or R2L
208 paragraphs. R2L paragraphs are displayed with R2L glyph rows,
209 which have their reversed_p flag set. The bidi reordering engine
210 produces characters in such rows starting from the character which
211 should be the rightmost on display. PRODUCE_GLYPHS then reverses
212 the order, when it fills up the glyph row whose reversed_p flag is
213 set, by prepending each new glyph to what is already there, instead
214 of appending it. When the glyph row is complete, the function
215 extend_face_to_end_of_line fills the empty space to the left of the
216 leftmost character with special glyphs, which will display as,
217 well, empty. On text terminals, these special glyphs are simply
218 blank characters. On graphics terminals, there's a single stretch
219 glyph of a suitably computed width. Both the blanks and the
220 stretch glyph are given the face of the background of the line.
221 This way, the terminal-specific back-end can still draw the glyphs
222 left to right, even for R2L lines.
224 Bidirectional display and character compositions
226 Some scripts cannot be displayed by drawing each character
227 individually, because adjacent characters change each other's shape
228 on display. For example, Arabic and Indic scripts belong to this
229 category.
231 Emacs display supports this by providing "character compositions",
232 most of which is implemented in composite.c. During the buffer
233 scan that delivers characters to PRODUCE_GLYPHS, if the next
234 character to be delivered is a composed character, the iteration
235 calls composition_reseat_it and next_element_from_composition. If
236 they succeed to compose the character with one or more of the
237 following characters, the whole sequence of characters that where
238 composed is recorded in the `struct composition_it' object that is
239 part of the buffer iterator. The composed sequence could produce
240 one or more font glyphs (called "grapheme clusters") on the screen.
241 Each of these grapheme clusters is then delivered to PRODUCE_GLYPHS
242 in the direction corresponding to the current bidi scan direction
243 (recorded in the scan_dir member of the `struct bidi_it' object
244 that is part of the buffer iterator). In particular, if the bidi
245 iterator currently scans the buffer backwards, the grapheme
246 clusters are delivered back to front. This reorders the grapheme
247 clusters as appropriate for the current bidi context. Note that
248 this means that the grapheme clusters are always stored in the
249 LGSTRING object (see composite.c) in the logical order.
251 Moving an iterator in bidirectional text
252 without producing glyphs
254 Note one important detail mentioned above: that the bidi reordering
255 engine, driven by the iterator, produces characters in R2L rows
256 starting at the character that will be the rightmost on display.
257 As far as the iterator is concerned, the geometry of such rows is
258 still left to right, i.e. the iterator "thinks" the first character
259 is at the leftmost pixel position. The iterator does not know that
260 PRODUCE_GLYPHS reverses the order of the glyphs that the iterator
261 delivers. This is important when functions from the move_it_*
262 family are used to get to certain screen position or to match
263 screen coordinates with buffer coordinates: these functions use the
264 iterator geometry, which is left to right even in R2L paragraphs.
265 This works well with most callers of move_it_*, because they need
266 to get to a specific column, and columns are still numbered in the
267 reading order, i.e. the rightmost character in a R2L paragraph is
268 still column zero. But some callers do not get well with this; a
269 notable example is mouse clicks that need to find the character
270 that corresponds to certain pixel coordinates. See
271 buffer_posn_from_coords in dispnew.c for how this is handled. */
273 #include <config.h>
274 #include <stdio.h>
275 #include <limits.h>
276 #include <setjmp.h>
278 #include "lisp.h"
279 #include "keyboard.h"
280 #include "frame.h"
281 #include "window.h"
282 #include "termchar.h"
283 #include "dispextern.h"
284 #include "character.h"
285 #include "buffer.h"
286 #include "charset.h"
287 #include "indent.h"
288 #include "commands.h"
289 #include "keymap.h"
290 #include "macros.h"
291 #include "disptab.h"
292 #include "termhooks.h"
293 #include "termopts.h"
294 #include "intervals.h"
295 #include "coding.h"
296 #include "process.h"
297 #include "region-cache.h"
298 #include "font.h"
299 #include "fontset.h"
300 #include "blockinput.h"
302 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
303 #include "xterm.h"
304 #endif
305 #ifdef WINDOWSNT
306 #include "w32term.h"
307 #endif
308 #ifdef HAVE_NS
309 #include "nsterm.h"
310 #endif
311 #ifdef USE_GTK
312 #include "gtkutil.h"
313 #endif
315 #include "font.h"
317 #ifndef FRAME_X_OUTPUT
318 #define FRAME_X_OUTPUT(f) ((f)->output_data.x)
319 #endif
321 #define INFINITY 10000000
323 Lisp_Object Qoverriding_local_map, Qoverriding_terminal_local_map;
324 Lisp_Object Qwindow_scroll_functions;
325 static Lisp_Object Qwindow_text_change_functions;
326 static Lisp_Object Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions;
327 Lisp_Object Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks;
328 static Lisp_Object QCeval, QCpropertize;
329 Lisp_Object QCfile, QCdata;
330 static Lisp_Object Qfontified;
331 static Lisp_Object Qgrow_only;
332 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_eval_during_redisplay;
333 static Lisp_Object Qbuffer_position, Qposition, Qobject;
334 static Lisp_Object Qright_to_left, Qleft_to_right;
336 /* Cursor shapes */
337 Lisp_Object Qbar, Qhbar, Qbox, Qhollow;
339 /* Pointer shapes */
340 static Lisp_Object Qarrow, Qhand;
341 Lisp_Object Qtext;
343 /* Holds the list (error). */
344 static Lisp_Object list_of_error;
346 static Lisp_Object Qfontification_functions;
348 static Lisp_Object Qwrap_prefix;
349 static Lisp_Object Qline_prefix;
351 /* Non-nil means don't actually do any redisplay. */
353 Lisp_Object Qinhibit_redisplay;
355 /* Names of text properties relevant for redisplay. */
357 Lisp_Object Qdisplay;
359 Lisp_Object Qspace, QCalign_to;
360 static Lisp_Object QCrelative_width, QCrelative_height;
361 Lisp_Object Qleft_margin, Qright_margin;
362 static Lisp_Object Qspace_width, Qraise;
363 static Lisp_Object Qslice;
364 Lisp_Object Qcenter;
365 static Lisp_Object Qmargin, Qpointer;
366 static Lisp_Object Qline_height;
368 /* These setters are used only in this file, so they can be private. */
369 static inline void
370 wset_base_line_number (struct window *w, Lisp_Object val)
372 w->base_line_number = val;
374 static inline void
375 wset_base_line_pos (struct window *w, Lisp_Object val)
377 w->base_line_pos = val;
379 static inline void
380 wset_column_number_displayed (struct window *w, Lisp_Object val)
382 w->column_number_displayed = val;
384 static inline void
385 wset_region_showing (struct window *w, Lisp_Object val)
387 w->region_showing = val;
390 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
392 /* Test if overflow newline into fringe. Called with iterator IT
393 at or past right window margin, and with IT->current_x set. */
395 #define IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE(IT) \
396 (!NILP (Voverflow_newline_into_fringe) \
397 && FRAME_WINDOW_P ((IT)->f) \
398 && ((IT)->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L \
399 ? (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH ((IT)->w) > 0) \
400 : (WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH ((IT)->w) > 0)) \
401 && (IT)->current_x == (IT)->last_visible_x \
402 && (IT)->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP)
404 #else /* !HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
405 #define IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE(it) 0
406 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
408 /* Test if the display element loaded in IT, or the underlying buffer
409 or string character, is a space or a TAB character. This is used
410 to determine where word wrapping can occur. */
412 #define IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE(it) \
413 ((it->what == IT_CHARACTER && (it->c == ' ' || it->c == '\t')) \
414 || ((STRINGP (it->string) \
415 && (SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it)) == ' ' \
416 || SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it)) == '\t')) \
417 || (it->s \
418 && (it->s[IT_BYTEPOS (*it)] == ' ' \
419 || it->s[IT_BYTEPOS (*it)] == '\t')) \
420 || (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) < ZV_BYTE \
421 && (*BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it)) == ' ' \
422 || *BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it)) == '\t')))) \
424 /* Name of the face used to highlight trailing whitespace. */
426 static Lisp_Object Qtrailing_whitespace;
428 /* Name and number of the face used to highlight escape glyphs. */
430 static Lisp_Object Qescape_glyph;
432 /* Name and number of the face used to highlight non-breaking spaces. */
434 static Lisp_Object Qnobreak_space;
436 /* The symbol `image' which is the car of the lists used to represent
437 images in Lisp. Also a tool bar style. */
439 Lisp_Object Qimage;
441 /* The image map types. */
442 Lisp_Object QCmap;
443 static Lisp_Object QCpointer;
444 static Lisp_Object Qrect, Qcircle, Qpoly;
446 /* Tool bar styles */
447 Lisp_Object Qboth, Qboth_horiz, Qtext_image_horiz;
449 /* Non-zero means print newline to stdout before next mini-buffer
450 message. */
452 int noninteractive_need_newline;
454 /* Non-zero means print newline to message log before next message. */
456 static int message_log_need_newline;
458 /* Three markers that message_dolog uses.
459 It could allocate them itself, but that causes trouble
460 in handling memory-full errors. */
461 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker1;
462 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker2;
463 static Lisp_Object message_dolog_marker3;
465 /* The buffer position of the first character appearing entirely or
466 partially on the line of the selected window which contains the
467 cursor; <= 0 if not known. Set by set_cursor_from_row, used for
468 redisplay optimization in redisplay_internal. */
470 static struct text_pos this_line_start_pos;
472 /* Number of characters past the end of the line above, including the
473 terminating newline. */
475 static struct text_pos this_line_end_pos;
477 /* The vertical positions and the height of this line. */
479 static int this_line_vpos;
480 static int this_line_y;
481 static int this_line_pixel_height;
483 /* X position at which this display line starts. Usually zero;
484 negative if first character is partially visible. */
486 static int this_line_start_x;
488 /* The smallest character position seen by move_it_* functions as they
489 move across display lines. Used to set MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS of
490 hscrolled lines, see display_line. */
492 static struct text_pos this_line_min_pos;
494 /* Buffer that this_line_.* variables are referring to. */
496 static struct buffer *this_line_buffer;
499 /* Values of those variables at last redisplay are stored as
500 properties on `overlay-arrow-position' symbol. However, if
501 Voverlay_arrow_position is a marker, last-arrow-position is its
502 numerical position. */
504 static Lisp_Object Qlast_arrow_position, Qlast_arrow_string;
506 /* Alternative overlay-arrow-string and overlay-arrow-bitmap
507 properties on a symbol in overlay-arrow-variable-list. */
509 static Lisp_Object Qoverlay_arrow_string, Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap;
511 Lisp_Object Qmenu_bar_update_hook;
513 /* Nonzero if an overlay arrow has been displayed in this window. */
515 static int overlay_arrow_seen;
517 /* Number of windows showing the buffer of the selected window (or
518 another buffer with the same base buffer). keyboard.c refers to
519 this. */
521 int buffer_shared;
523 /* Vector containing glyphs for an ellipsis `...'. */
525 static Lisp_Object default_invis_vector[3];
527 /* This is the window where the echo area message was displayed. It
528 is always a mini-buffer window, but it may not be the same window
529 currently active as a mini-buffer. */
531 Lisp_Object echo_area_window;
533 /* List of pairs (MESSAGE . MULTIBYTE). The function save_message
534 pushes the current message and the value of
535 message_enable_multibyte on the stack, the function restore_message
536 pops the stack and displays MESSAGE again. */
538 static Lisp_Object Vmessage_stack;
540 /* Nonzero means multibyte characters were enabled when the echo area
541 message was specified. */
543 static int message_enable_multibyte;
545 /* Nonzero if we should redraw the mode lines on the next redisplay. */
547 int update_mode_lines;
549 /* Nonzero if window sizes or contents have changed since last
550 redisplay that finished. */
552 int windows_or_buffers_changed;
554 /* Nonzero means a frame's cursor type has been changed. */
556 int cursor_type_changed;
558 /* Nonzero after display_mode_line if %l was used and it displayed a
559 line number. */
561 static int line_number_displayed;
563 /* The name of the *Messages* buffer, a string. */
565 static Lisp_Object Vmessages_buffer_name;
567 /* Current, index 0, and last displayed echo area message. Either
568 buffers from echo_buffers, or nil to indicate no message. */
570 Lisp_Object echo_area_buffer[2];
572 /* The buffers referenced from echo_area_buffer. */
574 static Lisp_Object echo_buffer[2];
576 /* A vector saved used in with_area_buffer to reduce consing. */
578 static Lisp_Object Vwith_echo_area_save_vector;
580 /* Non-zero means display_echo_area should display the last echo area
581 message again. Set by redisplay_preserve_echo_area. */
583 static int display_last_displayed_message_p;
585 /* Nonzero if echo area is being used by print; zero if being used by
586 message. */
588 static int message_buf_print;
590 /* The symbol `inhibit-menubar-update' and its DEFVAR_BOOL variable. */
592 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_menubar_update;
593 static Lisp_Object Qmessage_truncate_lines;
595 /* Set to 1 in clear_message to make redisplay_internal aware
596 of an emptied echo area. */
598 static int message_cleared_p;
600 /* A scratch glyph row with contents used for generating truncation
601 glyphs. Also used in direct_output_for_insert. */
603 #define MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS 100
604 static struct glyph_row scratch_glyph_row;
605 static struct glyph scratch_glyphs[MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS];
607 /* Ascent and height of the last line processed by move_it_to. */
609 static int last_max_ascent, last_height;
611 /* Non-zero if there's a help-echo in the echo area. */
613 int help_echo_showing_p;
615 /* If >= 0, computed, exact values of mode-line and header-line height
616 to use in the macros CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT and
617 CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT. */
619 int current_mode_line_height, current_header_line_height;
621 /* The maximum distance to look ahead for text properties. Values
622 that are too small let us call compute_char_face and similar
623 functions too often which is expensive. Values that are too large
624 let us call compute_char_face and alike too often because we
625 might not be interested in text properties that far away. */
627 #define TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT 100
629 /* SAVE_IT and RESTORE_IT are called when we save a snapshot of the
630 iterator state and later restore it. This is needed because the
631 bidi iterator on bidi.c keeps a stacked cache of its states, which
632 is really a singleton. When we use scratch iterator objects to
633 move around the buffer, we can cause the bidi cache to be pushed or
634 popped, and therefore we need to restore the cache state when we
635 return to the original iterator. */
636 #define SAVE_IT(ITCOPY,ITORIG,CACHE) \
637 do { \
638 if (CACHE) \
639 bidi_unshelve_cache (CACHE, 1); \
640 ITCOPY = ITORIG; \
641 CACHE = bidi_shelve_cache (); \
642 } while (0)
644 #define RESTORE_IT(pITORIG,pITCOPY,CACHE) \
645 do { \
646 if (pITORIG != pITCOPY) \
647 *(pITORIG) = *(pITCOPY); \
648 bidi_unshelve_cache (CACHE, 0); \
649 CACHE = NULL; \
650 } while (0)
652 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
654 /* Non-zero means print traces of redisplay if compiled with
655 GLYPH_DEBUG defined. */
657 int trace_redisplay_p;
659 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
661 #ifdef DEBUG_TRACE_MOVE
662 /* Non-zero means trace with TRACE_MOVE to stderr. */
663 int trace_move;
665 #define TRACE_MOVE(x) if (trace_move) fprintf x; else (void) 0
666 #else
667 #define TRACE_MOVE(x) (void) 0
668 #endif
670 static Lisp_Object Qauto_hscroll_mode;
672 /* Buffer being redisplayed -- for redisplay_window_error. */
674 static struct buffer *displayed_buffer;
676 /* Value returned from text property handlers (see below). */
678 enum prop_handled
680 HANDLED_NORMALLY,
681 HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS,
682 HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED,
683 HANDLED_RETURN
686 /* A description of text properties that redisplay is interested
687 in. */
689 struct props
691 /* The name of the property. */
692 Lisp_Object *name;
694 /* A unique index for the property. */
695 enum prop_idx idx;
697 /* A handler function called to set up iterator IT from the property
698 at IT's current position. Value is used to steer handle_stop. */
699 enum prop_handled (*handler) (struct it *it);
702 static enum prop_handled handle_face_prop (struct it *);
703 static enum prop_handled handle_invisible_prop (struct it *);
704 static enum prop_handled handle_display_prop (struct it *);
705 static enum prop_handled handle_composition_prop (struct it *);
706 static enum prop_handled handle_overlay_change (struct it *);
707 static enum prop_handled handle_fontified_prop (struct it *);
709 /* Properties handled by iterators. */
711 static struct props it_props[] =
713 {&Qfontified, FONTIFIED_PROP_IDX, handle_fontified_prop},
714 /* Handle `face' before `display' because some sub-properties of
715 `display' need to know the face. */
716 {&Qface, FACE_PROP_IDX, handle_face_prop},
717 {&Qdisplay, DISPLAY_PROP_IDX, handle_display_prop},
718 {&Qinvisible, INVISIBLE_PROP_IDX, handle_invisible_prop},
719 {&Qcomposition, COMPOSITION_PROP_IDX, handle_composition_prop},
720 {NULL, 0, NULL}
723 /* Value is the position described by X. If X is a marker, value is
724 the marker_position of X. Otherwise, value is X. */
726 #define COERCE_MARKER(X) (MARKERP ((X)) ? Fmarker_position (X) : (X))
728 /* Enumeration returned by some move_it_.* functions internally. */
730 enum move_it_result
732 /* Not used. Undefined value. */
733 MOVE_UNDEFINED,
735 /* Move ended at the requested buffer position or ZV. */
736 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV,
738 /* Move ended at the requested X pixel position. */
739 MOVE_X_REACHED,
741 /* Move within a line ended at the end of a line that must be
742 continued. */
743 MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED,
745 /* Move within a line ended at the end of a line that would
746 be displayed truncated. */
747 MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED,
749 /* Move within a line ended at a line end. */
750 MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR
753 /* This counter is used to clear the face cache every once in a while
754 in redisplay_internal. It is incremented for each redisplay.
755 Every CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT full redisplays, the face cache is
756 cleared. */
758 #define CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT 500
759 static int clear_face_cache_count;
761 /* Similarly for the image cache. */
763 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
764 #define CLEAR_IMAGE_CACHE_COUNT 101
765 static int clear_image_cache_count;
767 /* Null glyph slice */
768 static struct glyph_slice null_glyph_slice = { 0, 0, 0, 0 };
769 #endif
771 /* Non-zero while redisplay_internal is in progress. */
773 int redisplaying_p;
775 static Lisp_Object Qinhibit_free_realized_faces;
776 static Lisp_Object Qmode_line_default_help_echo;
778 /* If a string, XTread_socket generates an event to display that string.
779 (The display is done in read_char.) */
781 Lisp_Object help_echo_string;
782 Lisp_Object help_echo_window;
783 Lisp_Object help_echo_object;
784 ptrdiff_t help_echo_pos;
786 /* Temporary variable for XTread_socket. */
788 Lisp_Object previous_help_echo_string;
790 /* Platform-independent portion of hourglass implementation. */
792 /* Non-zero means an hourglass cursor is currently shown. */
793 int hourglass_shown_p;
795 /* If non-null, an asynchronous timer that, when it expires, displays
796 an hourglass cursor on all frames. */
797 struct atimer *hourglass_atimer;
799 /* Name of the face used to display glyphless characters. */
800 Lisp_Object Qglyphless_char;
802 /* Symbol for the purpose of Vglyphless_char_display. */
803 static Lisp_Object Qglyphless_char_display;
805 /* Method symbols for Vglyphless_char_display. */
806 static Lisp_Object Qhex_code, Qempty_box, Qthin_space, Qzero_width;
808 /* Default pixel width of `thin-space' display method. */
809 #define THIN_SPACE_WIDTH 1
811 /* Default number of seconds to wait before displaying an hourglass
812 cursor. */
813 #define DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY 1
816 /* Function prototypes. */
818 static void setup_for_ellipsis (struct it *, int);
819 static void set_iterator_to_next (struct it *, int);
820 static void mark_window_display_accurate_1 (struct window *, int);
821 static int single_display_spec_string_p (Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object);
822 static int display_prop_string_p (Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object);
823 static int cursor_row_p (struct glyph_row *);
824 static int redisplay_mode_lines (Lisp_Object, int);
825 static char *decode_mode_spec_coding (Lisp_Object, char *, int);
827 static Lisp_Object get_it_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop);
829 static void handle_line_prefix (struct it *);
831 static void pint2str (char *, int, ptrdiff_t);
832 static void pint2hrstr (char *, int, ptrdiff_t);
833 static struct text_pos run_window_scroll_functions (Lisp_Object,
834 struct text_pos);
835 static void reconsider_clip_changes (struct window *, struct buffer *);
836 static int text_outside_line_unchanged_p (struct window *,
837 ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
838 static void store_mode_line_noprop_char (char);
839 static int store_mode_line_noprop (const char *, int, int);
840 static void handle_stop (struct it *);
841 static void handle_stop_backwards (struct it *, ptrdiff_t);
842 static void vmessage (const char *, va_list) ATTRIBUTE_FORMAT_PRINTF (1, 0);
843 static void ensure_echo_area_buffers (void);
844 static Lisp_Object unwind_with_echo_area_buffer (Lisp_Object);
845 static Lisp_Object with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (struct window *);
846 static int with_echo_area_buffer (struct window *, int,
847 int (*) (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t),
848 ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
849 static void clear_garbaged_frames (void);
850 static int current_message_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
851 static void pop_message (void);
852 static int truncate_message_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
853 static void set_message (const char *, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, int);
854 static int set_message_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
855 static int display_echo_area (struct window *);
856 static int display_echo_area_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
857 static int resize_mini_window_1 (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
858 static Lisp_Object unwind_redisplay (Lisp_Object);
859 static int string_char_and_length (const unsigned char *, int *);
860 static struct text_pos display_prop_end (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
861 struct text_pos);
862 static int compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (struct window *);
863 static void insert_left_trunc_glyphs (struct it *);
864 static struct glyph_row *get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (struct window *,
865 Lisp_Object);
866 static void extend_face_to_end_of_line (struct it *);
867 static int append_space_for_newline (struct it *, int);
868 static int cursor_row_fully_visible_p (struct window *, int, int);
869 static int try_scrolling (Lisp_Object, int, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, int, int);
870 static int try_cursor_movement (Lisp_Object, struct text_pos, int *);
871 static int trailing_whitespace_p (ptrdiff_t);
872 static intmax_t message_log_check_duplicate (ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t);
873 static void push_it (struct it *, struct text_pos *);
874 static void iterate_out_of_display_property (struct it *);
875 static void pop_it (struct it *);
876 static void sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (struct window *);
877 static void select_frame_for_redisplay (Lisp_Object);
878 static void redisplay_internal (void);
879 static int echo_area_display (int);
880 static void redisplay_windows (Lisp_Object);
881 static void redisplay_window (Lisp_Object, int);
882 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_error (Lisp_Object);
883 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_0 (Lisp_Object);
884 static Lisp_Object redisplay_window_1 (Lisp_Object);
885 static int set_cursor_from_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
886 struct glyph_matrix *, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t,
887 int, int);
888 static int update_menu_bar (struct frame *, int, int);
889 static int try_window_reusing_current_matrix (struct window *);
890 static int try_window_id (struct window *);
891 static int display_line (struct it *);
892 static int display_mode_lines (struct window *);
893 static int display_mode_line (struct window *, enum face_id, Lisp_Object);
894 static int display_mode_element (struct it *, int, int, int, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object, int);
895 static int store_mode_line_string (const char *, Lisp_Object, int, int, int, Lisp_Object);
896 static const char *decode_mode_spec (struct window *, int, int, Lisp_Object *);
897 static void display_menu_bar (struct window *);
898 static ptrdiff_t display_count_lines (ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t,
899 ptrdiff_t *);
900 static int display_string (const char *, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
901 ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, struct it *, int, int, int, int);
902 static void compute_line_metrics (struct it *);
903 static void run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (struct it *);
904 static int get_overlay_strings (struct it *, ptrdiff_t);
905 static int get_overlay_strings_1 (struct it *, ptrdiff_t, int);
906 static void next_overlay_string (struct it *);
907 static void reseat (struct it *, struct text_pos, int);
908 static void reseat_1 (struct it *, struct text_pos, int);
909 static void back_to_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *);
910 void reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *);
911 static void reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (struct it *, int);
912 static int next_element_from_ellipsis (struct it *);
913 static int next_element_from_display_vector (struct it *);
914 static int next_element_from_string (struct it *);
915 static int next_element_from_c_string (struct it *);
916 static int next_element_from_buffer (struct it *);
917 static int next_element_from_composition (struct it *);
918 static int next_element_from_image (struct it *);
919 static int next_element_from_stretch (struct it *);
920 static void load_overlay_strings (struct it *, ptrdiff_t);
921 static int init_from_display_pos (struct it *, struct window *,
922 struct display_pos *);
923 static void reseat_to_string (struct it *, const char *,
924 Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t, int, int);
925 static int get_next_display_element (struct it *);
926 static enum move_it_result
927 move_it_in_display_line_to (struct it *, ptrdiff_t, int,
928 enum move_operation_enum);
929 void move_it_vertically_backward (struct it *, int);
930 static void init_to_row_start (struct it *, struct window *,
931 struct glyph_row *);
932 static int init_to_row_end (struct it *, struct window *,
933 struct glyph_row *);
934 static void back_to_previous_line_start (struct it *);
935 static int forward_to_next_line_start (struct it *, int *, struct bidi_it *);
936 static struct text_pos string_pos_nchars_ahead (struct text_pos,
937 Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t);
938 static struct text_pos string_pos (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object);
939 static struct text_pos c_string_pos (ptrdiff_t, const char *, int);
940 static ptrdiff_t number_of_chars (const char *, int);
941 static void compute_stop_pos (struct it *);
942 static void compute_string_pos (struct text_pos *, struct text_pos,
943 Lisp_Object);
944 static int face_before_or_after_it_pos (struct it *, int);
945 static ptrdiff_t next_overlay_change (ptrdiff_t);
946 static int handle_display_spec (struct it *, Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
947 Lisp_Object, struct text_pos *, ptrdiff_t, int);
948 static int handle_single_display_spec (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
949 Lisp_Object, Lisp_Object,
950 struct text_pos *, ptrdiff_t, int, int);
951 static int underlying_face_id (struct it *);
952 static int in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (struct display_pos *,
953 struct window *);
955 #define face_before_it_pos(IT) face_before_or_after_it_pos ((IT), 1)
956 #define face_after_it_pos(IT) face_before_or_after_it_pos ((IT), 0)
958 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
960 static void x_consider_frame_title (Lisp_Object);
961 static int tool_bar_lines_needed (struct frame *, int *);
962 static void update_tool_bar (struct frame *, int);
963 static void build_desired_tool_bar_string (struct frame *f);
964 static int redisplay_tool_bar (struct frame *);
965 static void display_tool_bar_line (struct it *, int);
966 static void notice_overwritten_cursor (struct window *,
967 enum glyph_row_area,
968 int, int, int, int);
969 static void append_stretch_glyph (struct it *, Lisp_Object,
970 int, int, int);
973 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
975 static void produce_special_glyphs (struct it *, enum display_element_type);
976 static void show_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *, enum draw_glyphs_face);
977 static int coords_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *, int, int);
981 /***********************************************************************
982 Window display dimensions
983 ***********************************************************************/
985 /* Return the bottom boundary y-position for text lines in window W.
986 This is the first y position at which a line cannot start.
987 It is relative to the top of the window.
989 This is the height of W minus the height of a mode line, if any. */
992 window_text_bottom_y (struct window *w)
994 int height = WINDOW_TOTAL_HEIGHT (w);
996 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
997 height -= CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
998 return height;
1001 /* Return the pixel width of display area AREA of window W. AREA < 0
1002 means return the total width of W, not including fringes to
1003 the left and right of the window. */
1006 window_box_width (struct window *w, int area)
1008 int cols = XFASTINT (w->total_cols);
1009 int pixels = 0;
1011 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
1013 cols -= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w);
1015 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
1017 if (INTEGERP (w->left_margin_cols))
1018 cols -= XFASTINT (w->left_margin_cols);
1019 if (INTEGERP (w->right_margin_cols))
1020 cols -= XFASTINT (w->right_margin_cols);
1021 pixels = -WINDOW_TOTAL_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
1023 else if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
1025 cols = (INTEGERP (w->left_margin_cols)
1026 ? XFASTINT (w->left_margin_cols) : 0);
1027 pixels = 0;
1029 else if (area == RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
1031 cols = (INTEGERP (w->right_margin_cols)
1032 ? XFASTINT (w->right_margin_cols) : 0);
1033 pixels = 0;
1037 return cols * WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w) + pixels;
1041 /* Return the pixel height of the display area of window W, not
1042 including mode lines of W, if any. */
1045 window_box_height (struct window *w)
1047 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1048 int height = WINDOW_TOTAL_HEIGHT (w);
1050 eassert (height >= 0);
1052 /* Note: the code below that determines the mode-line/header-line
1053 height is essentially the same as that contained in the macro
1054 CURRENT_{MODE,HEADER}_LINE_HEIGHT, except that it checks whether
1055 the appropriate glyph row has its `mode_line_p' flag set,
1056 and if it doesn't, uses estimate_mode_line_height instead. */
1058 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
1060 struct glyph_row *ml_row
1061 = (w->current_matrix && w->current_matrix->rows
1062 ? MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
1063 : 0);
1064 if (ml_row && ml_row->mode_line_p)
1065 height -= ml_row->height;
1066 else
1067 height -= estimate_mode_line_height (f, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID (w));
1070 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1072 struct glyph_row *hl_row
1073 = (w->current_matrix && w->current_matrix->rows
1074 ? MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
1075 : 0);
1076 if (hl_row && hl_row->mode_line_p)
1077 height -= hl_row->height;
1078 else
1079 height -= estimate_mode_line_height (f, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID);
1082 /* With a very small font and a mode-line that's taller than
1083 default, we might end up with a negative height. */
1084 return max (0, height);
1087 /* Return the window-relative coordinate of the left edge of display
1088 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the left edge of the
1089 whole window, to the right of the left fringe of W. */
1092 window_box_left_offset (struct window *w, int area)
1094 int x;
1096 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1097 return 0;
1099 x = WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
1101 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
1102 x += (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
1103 + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
1104 else if (area == RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
1105 x += (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
1106 + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
1107 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA)
1108 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
1110 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)));
1111 else if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA
1112 && WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w))
1113 x += WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
1115 return x;
1119 /* Return the window-relative coordinate of the right edge of display
1120 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the right edge of the
1121 whole window, to the left of the right fringe of W. */
1124 window_box_right_offset (struct window *w, int area)
1126 return window_box_left_offset (w, area) + window_box_width (w, area);
1129 /* Return the frame-relative coordinate of the left edge of display
1130 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the left edge of the
1131 whole window, to the right of the left fringe of W. */
1134 window_box_left (struct window *w, int area)
1136 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1137 int x;
1139 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1140 return FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
1142 x = (WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w)
1143 + window_box_left_offset (w, area));
1145 return x;
1149 /* Return the frame-relative coordinate of the right edge of display
1150 area AREA of window W. AREA < 0 means return the right edge of the
1151 whole window, to the left of the right fringe of W. */
1154 window_box_right (struct window *w, int area)
1156 return window_box_left (w, area) + window_box_width (w, area);
1159 /* Get the bounding box of the display area AREA of window W, without
1160 mode lines, in frame-relative coordinates. AREA < 0 means the
1161 whole window, not including the left and right fringes of
1162 the window. Return in *BOX_X and *BOX_Y the frame-relative pixel
1163 coordinates of the upper-left corner of the box. Return in
1164 *BOX_WIDTH, and *BOX_HEIGHT the pixel width and height of the box. */
1166 void
1167 window_box (struct window *w, int area, int *box_x, int *box_y,
1168 int *box_width, int *box_height)
1170 if (box_width)
1171 *box_width = window_box_width (w, area);
1172 if (box_height)
1173 *box_height = window_box_height (w);
1174 if (box_x)
1175 *box_x = window_box_left (w, area);
1176 if (box_y)
1178 *box_y = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
1179 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1180 *box_y += CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
1185 /* Get the bounding box of the display area AREA of window W, without
1186 mode lines. AREA < 0 means the whole window, not including the
1187 left and right fringe of the window. Return in *TOP_LEFT_X
1188 and TOP_LEFT_Y the frame-relative pixel coordinates of the
1189 upper-left corner of the box. Return in *BOTTOM_RIGHT_X, and
1190 *BOTTOM_RIGHT_Y the coordinates of the bottom-right corner of the
1191 box. */
1193 static inline void
1194 window_box_edges (struct window *w, int area, int *top_left_x, int *top_left_y,
1195 int *bottom_right_x, int *bottom_right_y)
1197 window_box (w, area, top_left_x, top_left_y, bottom_right_x,
1198 bottom_right_y);
1199 *bottom_right_x += *top_left_x;
1200 *bottom_right_y += *top_left_y;
1205 /***********************************************************************
1206 Utilities
1207 ***********************************************************************/
1209 /* Return the bottom y-position of the line the iterator IT is in.
1210 This can modify IT's settings. */
1213 line_bottom_y (struct it *it)
1215 int line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
1216 int line_top_y = it->current_y;
1218 if (line_height == 0)
1220 if (last_height)
1221 line_height = last_height;
1222 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV)
1224 move_it_by_lines (it, 1);
1225 line_height = (it->max_ascent || it->max_descent
1226 ? it->max_ascent + it->max_descent
1227 : last_height);
1229 else
1231 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
1233 /* Use the default character height. */
1234 it->glyph_row = NULL;
1235 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
1236 it->c = ' ';
1237 it->len = 1;
1238 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
1239 line_height = it->ascent + it->descent;
1240 it->glyph_row = row;
1244 return line_top_y + line_height;
1247 /* Subroutine of pos_visible_p below. Extracts a display string, if
1248 any, from the display spec given as its argument. */
1249 static Lisp_Object
1250 string_from_display_spec (Lisp_Object spec)
1252 if (CONSP (spec))
1254 while (CONSP (spec))
1256 if (STRINGP (XCAR (spec)))
1257 return XCAR (spec);
1258 spec = XCDR (spec);
1261 else if (VECTORP (spec))
1263 ptrdiff_t i;
1265 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (spec); i++)
1267 if (STRINGP (AREF (spec, i)))
1268 return AREF (spec, i);
1270 return Qnil;
1273 return spec;
1277 /* Limit insanely large values of W->hscroll on frame F to the largest
1278 value that will still prevent first_visible_x and last_visible_x of
1279 'struct it' from overflowing an int. */
1280 static inline int
1281 window_hscroll_limited (struct window *w, struct frame *f)
1283 ptrdiff_t window_hscroll = w->hscroll;
1284 int window_text_width = window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
1285 int colwidth = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
1287 if (window_hscroll > (INT_MAX - window_text_width) / colwidth - 1)
1288 window_hscroll = (INT_MAX - window_text_width) / colwidth - 1;
1290 return window_hscroll;
1293 /* Return 1 if position CHARPOS is visible in window W.
1294 CHARPOS < 0 means return info about WINDOW_END position.
1295 If visible, set *X and *Y to pixel coordinates of top left corner.
1296 Set *RTOP and *RBOT to pixel height of an invisible area of glyph at POS.
1297 Set *ROWH and *VPOS to row's visible height and VPOS (row number). */
1300 pos_visible_p (struct window *w, ptrdiff_t charpos, int *x, int *y,
1301 int *rtop, int *rbot, int *rowh, int *vpos)
1303 struct it it;
1304 void *itdata = bidi_shelve_cache ();
1305 struct text_pos top;
1306 int visible_p = 0;
1307 struct buffer *old_buffer = NULL;
1309 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w))))
1310 return visible_p;
1312 if (XBUFFER (w->buffer) != current_buffer)
1314 old_buffer = current_buffer;
1315 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
1318 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (top, w->start);
1319 /* Scrolling a minibuffer window via scroll bar when the echo area
1320 shows long text sometimes resets the minibuffer contents behind
1321 our backs. */
1322 if (CHARPOS (top) > ZV)
1323 SET_TEXT_POS (top, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
1325 /* Compute exact mode line heights. */
1326 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
1327 current_mode_line_height
1328 = display_mode_line (w, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID (w),
1329 BVAR (current_buffer, mode_line_format));
1331 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
1332 current_header_line_height
1333 = display_mode_line (w, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID,
1334 BVAR (current_buffer, header_line_format));
1336 start_display (&it, w, top);
1337 move_it_to (&it, charpos, -1, it.last_visible_y-1, -1,
1338 (charpos >= 0 ? MOVE_TO_POS : 0) | MOVE_TO_Y);
1340 if (charpos >= 0
1341 && (((!it.bidi_p || it.bidi_it.scan_dir == 1)
1342 && IT_CHARPOS (it) >= charpos)
1343 /* When scanning backwards under bidi iteration, move_it_to
1344 stops at or _before_ CHARPOS, because it stops at or to
1345 the _right_ of the character at CHARPOS. */
1346 || (it.bidi_p && it.bidi_it.scan_dir == -1
1347 && IT_CHARPOS (it) <= charpos)))
1349 /* We have reached CHARPOS, or passed it. How the call to
1350 move_it_to can overshoot: (i) If CHARPOS is on invisible text
1351 or covered by a display property, move_it_to stops at the end
1352 of the invisible text, to the right of CHARPOS. (ii) If
1353 CHARPOS is in a display vector, move_it_to stops on its last
1354 glyph. */
1355 int top_x = it.current_x;
1356 int top_y = it.current_y;
1357 /* Calling line_bottom_y may change it.method, it.position, etc. */
1358 enum it_method it_method = it.method;
1359 int bottom_y = (last_height = 0, line_bottom_y (&it));
1360 int window_top_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
1362 if (top_y < window_top_y)
1363 visible_p = bottom_y > window_top_y;
1364 else if (top_y < it.last_visible_y)
1365 visible_p = 1;
1366 if (bottom_y >= it.last_visible_y
1367 && it.bidi_p && it.bidi_it.scan_dir == -1
1368 && IT_CHARPOS (it) < charpos)
1370 /* When the last line of the window is scanned backwards
1371 under bidi iteration, we could be duped into thinking
1372 that we have passed CHARPOS, when in fact move_it_to
1373 simply stopped short of CHARPOS because it reached
1374 last_visible_y. To see if that's what happened, we call
1375 move_it_to again with a slightly larger vertical limit,
1376 and see if it actually moved vertically; if it did, we
1377 didn't really reach CHARPOS, which is beyond window end. */
1378 struct it save_it = it;
1379 /* Why 10? because we don't know how many canonical lines
1380 will the height of the next line(s) be. So we guess. */
1381 int ten_more_lines =
1382 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w)));
1384 move_it_to (&it, charpos, -1, bottom_y + ten_more_lines, -1,
1385 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
1386 if (it.current_y > top_y)
1387 visible_p = 0;
1389 it = save_it;
1391 if (visible_p)
1393 if (it_method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR)
1395 /* We stopped on the last glyph of a display vector.
1396 Try and recompute. Hack alert! */
1397 if (charpos < 2 || top.charpos >= charpos)
1398 top_x = it.glyph_row->x;
1399 else
1401 struct it it2;
1402 start_display (&it2, w, top);
1403 move_it_to (&it2, charpos - 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1404 get_next_display_element (&it2);
1405 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it2);
1406 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it2)
1407 || it2.current_x > it2.last_visible_x)
1408 top_x = it.glyph_row->x;
1409 else
1411 top_x = it2.current_x;
1412 top_y = it2.current_y;
1416 else if (IT_CHARPOS (it) != charpos)
1418 Lisp_Object cpos = make_number (charpos);
1419 Lisp_Object spec = Fget_char_property (cpos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
1420 Lisp_Object string = string_from_display_spec (spec);
1421 int newline_in_string = 0;
1423 if (STRINGP (string))
1425 const char *s = SSDATA (string);
1426 const char *e = s + SBYTES (string);
1427 while (s < e)
1429 if (*s++ == '\n')
1431 newline_in_string = 1;
1432 break;
1436 /* The tricky code below is needed because there's a
1437 discrepancy between move_it_to and how we set cursor
1438 when the display line ends in a newline from a
1439 display string. move_it_to will stop _after_ such
1440 display strings, whereas set_cursor_from_row
1441 conspires with cursor_row_p to place the cursor on
1442 the first glyph produced from the display string. */
1444 /* We have overshoot PT because it is covered by a
1445 display property whose value is a string. If the
1446 string includes embedded newlines, we are also in the
1447 wrong display line. Backtrack to the correct line,
1448 where the display string begins. */
1449 if (newline_in_string)
1451 Lisp_Object startpos, endpos;
1452 EMACS_INT start, end;
1453 struct it it3;
1454 int it3_moved;
1456 /* Find the first and the last buffer positions
1457 covered by the display string. */
1458 endpos =
1459 Fnext_single_char_property_change (cpos, Qdisplay,
1460 Qnil, Qnil);
1461 startpos =
1462 Fprevious_single_char_property_change (endpos, Qdisplay,
1463 Qnil, Qnil);
1464 start = XFASTINT (startpos);
1465 end = XFASTINT (endpos);
1466 /* Move to the last buffer position before the
1467 display property. */
1468 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1469 move_it_to (&it3, start - 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1470 /* Move forward one more line if the position before
1471 the display string is a newline or if it is the
1472 rightmost character on a line that is
1473 continued or word-wrapped. */
1474 if (it3.method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
1475 && it3.c == '\n')
1476 move_it_by_lines (&it3, 1);
1477 else if (move_it_in_display_line_to (&it3, -1,
1478 it3.current_x
1479 + it3.pixel_width,
1480 MOVE_TO_X)
1481 == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED)
1483 move_it_by_lines (&it3, 1);
1484 /* When we are under word-wrap, the #$@%!
1485 move_it_by_lines moves 2 lines, so we need to
1486 fix that up. */
1487 if (it3.line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
1488 move_it_by_lines (&it3, -1);
1491 /* Record the vertical coordinate of the display
1492 line where we wound up. */
1493 top_y = it3.current_y;
1494 if (it3.bidi_p)
1496 /* When characters are reordered for display,
1497 the character displayed to the left of the
1498 display string could be _after_ the display
1499 property in the logical order. Use the
1500 smallest vertical position of these two. */
1501 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1502 move_it_to (&it3, end + 1, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1503 if (it3.current_y < top_y)
1504 top_y = it3.current_y;
1506 /* Move from the top of the window to the beginning
1507 of the display line where the display string
1508 begins. */
1509 start_display (&it3, w, top);
1510 move_it_to (&it3, -1, 0, top_y, -1, MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
1511 /* If it3_moved stays zero after the 'while' loop
1512 below, that means we already were at a newline
1513 before the loop (e.g., the display string begins
1514 with a newline), so we don't need to (and cannot)
1515 inspect the glyphs of it3.glyph_row, because
1516 PRODUCE_GLYPHS will not produce anything for a
1517 newline, and thus it3.glyph_row stays at its
1518 stale content it got at top of the window. */
1519 it3_moved = 0;
1520 /* Finally, advance the iterator until we hit the
1521 first display element whose character position is
1522 CHARPOS, or until the first newline from the
1523 display string, which signals the end of the
1524 display line. */
1525 while (get_next_display_element (&it3))
1527 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it3);
1528 if (IT_CHARPOS (it3) == charpos
1529 || ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it3))
1530 break;
1531 it3_moved = 1;
1532 set_iterator_to_next (&it3, 0);
1534 top_x = it3.current_x - it3.pixel_width;
1535 /* Normally, we would exit the above loop because we
1536 found the display element whose character
1537 position is CHARPOS. For the contingency that we
1538 didn't, and stopped at the first newline from the
1539 display string, move back over the glyphs
1540 produced from the string, until we find the
1541 rightmost glyph not from the string. */
1542 if (it3_moved
1543 && IT_CHARPOS (it3) != charpos && EQ (it3.object, string))
1545 struct glyph *g = it3.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
1546 + it3.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
1548 while (EQ ((g - 1)->object, string))
1550 --g;
1551 top_x -= g->pixel_width;
1553 eassert (g < it3.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
1554 + it3.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]);
1559 *x = top_x;
1560 *y = max (top_y + max (0, it.max_ascent - it.ascent), window_top_y);
1561 *rtop = max (0, window_top_y - top_y);
1562 *rbot = max (0, bottom_y - it.last_visible_y);
1563 *rowh = max (0, (min (bottom_y, it.last_visible_y)
1564 - max (top_y, window_top_y)));
1565 *vpos = it.vpos;
1568 else
1570 /* We were asked to provide info about WINDOW_END. */
1571 struct it it2;
1572 void *it2data = NULL;
1574 SAVE_IT (it2, it, it2data);
1575 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) < ZV && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (it)) != '\n')
1576 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
1577 if (charpos < IT_CHARPOS (it)
1578 || (it.what == IT_EOB && charpos == IT_CHARPOS (it)))
1580 visible_p = 1;
1581 RESTORE_IT (&it2, &it2, it2data);
1582 move_it_to (&it2, charpos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
1583 *x = it2.current_x;
1584 *y = it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent - it2.ascent;
1585 *rtop = max (0, -it2.current_y);
1586 *rbot = max (0, ((it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent + it2.max_descent)
1587 - it.last_visible_y));
1588 *rowh = max (0, (min (it2.current_y + it2.max_ascent + it2.max_descent,
1589 it.last_visible_y)
1590 - max (it2.current_y,
1591 WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w))));
1592 *vpos = it2.vpos;
1594 else
1595 bidi_unshelve_cache (it2data, 1);
1597 bidi_unshelve_cache (itdata, 0);
1599 if (old_buffer)
1600 set_buffer_internal_1 (old_buffer);
1602 current_header_line_height = current_mode_line_height = -1;
1604 if (visible_p && w->hscroll > 0)
1605 *x -=
1606 window_hscroll_limited (w, WINDOW_XFRAME (w))
1607 * WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
1609 #if 0
1610 /* Debugging code. */
1611 if (visible_p)
1612 fprintf (stderr, "+pv pt=%d vs=%d --> x=%d y=%d rt=%d rb=%d rh=%d vp=%d\n",
1613 charpos, w->vscroll, *x, *y, *rtop, *rbot, *rowh, *vpos);
1614 else
1615 fprintf (stderr, "-pv pt=%d vs=%d\n", charpos, w->vscroll);
1616 #endif
1618 return visible_p;
1622 /* Return the next character from STR. Return in *LEN the length of
1623 the character. This is like STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH but never
1624 returns an invalid character. If we find one, we return a `?', but
1625 with the length of the invalid character. */
1627 static inline int
1628 string_char_and_length (const unsigned char *str, int *len)
1630 int c;
1632 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (str, *len);
1633 if (!CHAR_VALID_P (c))
1634 /* We may not change the length here because other places in Emacs
1635 don't use this function, i.e. they silently accept invalid
1636 characters. */
1637 c = '?';
1639 return c;
1644 /* Given a position POS containing a valid character and byte position
1645 in STRING, return the position NCHARS ahead (NCHARS >= 0). */
1647 static struct text_pos
1648 string_pos_nchars_ahead (struct text_pos pos, Lisp_Object string, ptrdiff_t nchars)
1650 eassert (STRINGP (string) && nchars >= 0);
1652 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (string))
1654 const unsigned char *p = SDATA (string) + BYTEPOS (pos);
1655 int len;
1657 while (nchars--)
1659 string_char_and_length (p, &len);
1660 p += len;
1661 CHARPOS (pos) += 1;
1662 BYTEPOS (pos) += len;
1665 else
1666 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, CHARPOS (pos) + nchars, BYTEPOS (pos) + nchars);
1668 return pos;
1672 /* Value is the text position, i.e. character and byte position,
1673 for character position CHARPOS in STRING. */
1675 static inline struct text_pos
1676 string_pos (ptrdiff_t charpos, Lisp_Object string)
1678 struct text_pos pos;
1679 eassert (STRINGP (string));
1680 eassert (charpos >= 0);
1681 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, string_char_to_byte (string, charpos));
1682 return pos;
1686 /* Value is a text position, i.e. character and byte position, for
1687 character position CHARPOS in C string S. MULTIBYTE_P non-zero
1688 means recognize multibyte characters. */
1690 static struct text_pos
1691 c_string_pos (ptrdiff_t charpos, const char *s, int multibyte_p)
1693 struct text_pos pos;
1695 eassert (s != NULL);
1696 eassert (charpos >= 0);
1698 if (multibyte_p)
1700 int len;
1702 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, 0, 0);
1703 while (charpos--)
1705 string_char_and_length ((const unsigned char *) s, &len);
1706 s += len;
1707 CHARPOS (pos) += 1;
1708 BYTEPOS (pos) += len;
1711 else
1712 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, charpos);
1714 return pos;
1718 /* Value is the number of characters in C string S. MULTIBYTE_P
1719 non-zero means recognize multibyte characters. */
1721 static ptrdiff_t
1722 number_of_chars (const char *s, int multibyte_p)
1724 ptrdiff_t nchars;
1726 if (multibyte_p)
1728 ptrdiff_t rest = strlen (s);
1729 int len;
1730 const unsigned char *p = (const unsigned char *) s;
1732 for (nchars = 0; rest > 0; ++nchars)
1734 string_char_and_length (p, &len);
1735 rest -= len, p += len;
1738 else
1739 nchars = strlen (s);
1741 return nchars;
1745 /* Compute byte position NEWPOS->bytepos corresponding to
1746 NEWPOS->charpos. POS is a known position in string STRING.
1747 NEWPOS->charpos must be >= POS.charpos. */
1749 static void
1750 compute_string_pos (struct text_pos *newpos, struct text_pos pos, Lisp_Object string)
1752 eassert (STRINGP (string));
1753 eassert (CHARPOS (*newpos) >= CHARPOS (pos));
1755 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (string))
1756 *newpos = string_pos_nchars_ahead (pos, string,
1757 CHARPOS (*newpos) - CHARPOS (pos));
1758 else
1759 BYTEPOS (*newpos) = CHARPOS (*newpos);
1762 /* EXPORT:
1763 Return an estimation of the pixel height of mode or header lines on
1764 frame F. FACE_ID specifies what line's height to estimate. */
1767 estimate_mode_line_height (struct frame *f, enum face_id face_id)
1769 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1770 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
1772 int height = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
1774 /* This function is called so early when Emacs starts that the face
1775 cache and mode line face are not yet initialized. */
1776 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
1778 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
1779 if (face)
1781 if (face->font)
1782 height = FONT_HEIGHT (face->font);
1783 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
1784 height += 2 * face->box_line_width;
1788 return height;
1790 #endif
1792 return 1;
1795 /* Given a pixel position (PIX_X, PIX_Y) on frame F, return glyph
1796 co-ordinates in (*X, *Y). Set *BOUNDS to the rectangle that the
1797 glyph at X, Y occupies, if BOUNDS != 0. If NOCLIP is non-zero, do
1798 not force the value into range. */
1800 void
1801 pixel_to_glyph_coords (FRAME_PTR f, register int pix_x, register int pix_y,
1802 int *x, int *y, NativeRectangle *bounds, int noclip)
1805 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1806 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
1808 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to round down
1809 even for negative values. */
1810 if (pix_x < 0)
1811 pix_x -= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) - 1;
1812 if (pix_y < 0)
1813 pix_y -= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1;
1815 pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL (f, pix_x);
1816 pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_Y_TO_LINE (f, pix_y);
1818 if (bounds)
1819 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*bounds,
1820 FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, pix_x),
1821 FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, pix_y),
1822 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) - 1,
1823 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1);
1825 if (!noclip)
1827 if (pix_x < 0)
1828 pix_x = 0;
1829 else if (pix_x > FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f))
1830 pix_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f);
1832 if (pix_y < 0)
1833 pix_y = 0;
1834 else if (pix_y > FRAME_LINES (f))
1835 pix_y = FRAME_LINES (f);
1838 #endif
1840 *x = pix_x;
1841 *y = pix_y;
1845 /* Find the glyph under window-relative coordinates X/Y in window W.
1846 Consider only glyphs from buffer text, i.e. no glyphs from overlay
1847 strings. Return in *HPOS and *VPOS the row and column number of
1848 the glyph found. Return in *AREA the glyph area containing X.
1849 Value is a pointer to the glyph found or null if X/Y is not on
1850 text, or we can't tell because W's current matrix is not up to
1851 date. */
1853 static
1854 struct glyph *
1855 x_y_to_hpos_vpos (struct window *w, int x, int y, int *hpos, int *vpos,
1856 int *dx, int *dy, int *area)
1858 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
1859 struct glyph_row *row = NULL;
1860 int x0, i;
1862 /* Find row containing Y. Give up if some row is not enabled. */
1863 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows; ++i)
1865 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i);
1866 if (!row->enabled_p)
1867 return NULL;
1868 if (y >= row->y && y < MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row))
1869 break;
1872 *vpos = i;
1873 *hpos = 0;
1875 /* Give up if Y is not in the window. */
1876 if (i == w->current_matrix->nrows)
1877 return NULL;
1879 /* Get the glyph area containing X. */
1880 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1882 *area = TEXT_AREA;
1883 x0 = 0;
1885 else
1887 if (x < window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA))
1889 *area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
1890 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
1892 else if (x < window_box_right_offset (w, TEXT_AREA))
1894 *area = TEXT_AREA;
1895 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA) + min (row->x, 0);
1897 else
1899 *area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
1900 x0 = window_box_left_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA);
1904 /* Find glyph containing X. */
1905 glyph = row->glyphs[*area];
1906 end = glyph + row->used[*area];
1907 x -= x0;
1908 while (glyph < end && x >= glyph->pixel_width)
1910 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
1911 ++glyph;
1914 if (glyph == end)
1915 return NULL;
1917 if (dx)
1919 *dx = x;
1920 *dy = y - (row->y + row->ascent - glyph->ascent);
1923 *hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[*area];
1924 return glyph;
1927 /* Convert frame-relative x/y to coordinates relative to window W.
1928 Takes pseudo-windows into account. */
1930 static void
1931 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (struct window *w, int *x, int *y)
1933 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
1935 /* A pseudo-window is always full-width, and starts at the
1936 left edge of the frame, plus a frame border. */
1937 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1938 *x -= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
1939 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
1941 else
1943 *x -= WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
1944 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
1948 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
1950 /* EXPORT:
1951 Return in RECTS[] at most N clipping rectangles for glyph string S.
1952 Return the number of stored rectangles. */
1955 get_glyph_string_clip_rects (struct glyph_string *s, NativeRectangle *rects, int n)
1957 XRectangle r;
1959 if (n <= 0)
1960 return 0;
1962 if (s->row->full_width_p)
1964 /* Draw full-width. X coordinates are relative to S->w->left_col. */
1965 r.x = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (s->w);
1966 r.width = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (s->w);
1968 /* Unless displaying a mode or menu bar line, which are always
1969 fully visible, clip to the visible part of the row. */
1970 if (s->w->pseudo_window_p)
1971 r.height = s->row->visible_height;
1972 else
1973 r.height = s->height;
1975 else
1977 /* This is a text line that may be partially visible. */
1978 r.x = window_box_left (s->w, s->area);
1979 r.width = window_box_width (s->w, s->area);
1980 r.height = s->row->visible_height;
1983 if (s->clip_head)
1984 if (r.x < s->clip_head->x)
1986 if (r.width >= s->clip_head->x - r.x)
1987 r.width -= s->clip_head->x - r.x;
1988 else
1989 r.width = 0;
1990 r.x = s->clip_head->x;
1992 if (s->clip_tail)
1993 if (r.x + r.width > s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width)
1995 if (s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width >= r.x)
1996 r.width = s->clip_tail->x + s->clip_tail->background_width - r.x;
1997 else
1998 r.width = 0;
2001 /* If S draws overlapping rows, it's sufficient to use the top and
2002 bottom of the window for clipping because this glyph string
2003 intentionally draws over other lines. */
2004 if (s->for_overlaps)
2006 r.y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
2007 r.height = window_text_bottom_y (s->w) - r.y;
2009 /* Alas, the above simple strategy does not work for the
2010 environments with anti-aliased text: if the same text is
2011 drawn onto the same place multiple times, it gets thicker.
2012 If the overlap we are processing is for the erased cursor, we
2013 take the intersection with the rectangle of the cursor. */
2014 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR)
2016 XRectangle rc, r_save = r;
2018 rc.x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (s->w, s->w->phys_cursor.x);
2019 rc.y = s->w->phys_cursor.y;
2020 rc.width = s->w->phys_cursor_width;
2021 rc.height = s->w->phys_cursor_height;
2023 x_intersect_rectangles (&r_save, &rc, &r);
2026 else
2028 /* Don't use S->y for clipping because it doesn't take partially
2029 visible lines into account. For example, it can be negative for
2030 partially visible lines at the top of a window. */
2031 if (!s->row->full_width_p
2032 && MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_AT_TOP_P (s->w, s->row))
2033 r.y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
2034 else
2035 r.y = max (0, s->row->y);
2038 r.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, r.y);
2040 /* If drawing the cursor, don't let glyph draw outside its
2041 advertised boundaries. Cleartype does this under some circumstances. */
2042 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2044 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
2045 int height, max_y;
2047 if (s->x > r.x)
2049 r.width -= s->x - r.x;
2050 r.x = s->x;
2052 r.width = min (r.width, glyph->pixel_width);
2054 /* If r.y is below window bottom, ensure that we still see a cursor. */
2055 height = min (glyph->ascent + glyph->descent,
2056 min (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (s->f), s->row->visible_height));
2057 max_y = window_text_bottom_y (s->w) - height;
2058 max_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, max_y);
2059 if (s->ybase - glyph->ascent > max_y)
2061 r.y = max_y;
2062 r.height = height;
2064 else
2066 /* Don't draw cursor glyph taller than our actual glyph. */
2067 height = max (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (s->f), glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
2068 if (height < r.height)
2070 max_y = r.y + r.height;
2071 r.y = min (max_y, max (r.y, s->ybase + glyph->descent - height));
2072 r.height = min (max_y - r.y, height);
2077 if (s->row->clip)
2079 XRectangle r_save = r;
2081 if (! x_intersect_rectangles (&r_save, s->row->clip, &r))
2082 r.width = 0;
2085 if ((s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_BOTH) == 0
2086 || ((s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_BOTH) == OVERLAPS_BOTH && n == 1))
2088 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
2089 CONVERT_FROM_XRECT (r, *rects);
2090 #else
2091 *rects = r;
2092 #endif
2093 return 1;
2095 else
2097 /* If we are processing overlapping and allowed to return
2098 multiple clipping rectangles, we exclude the row of the glyph
2099 string from the clipping rectangle. This is to avoid drawing
2100 the same text on the environment with anti-aliasing. */
2101 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
2102 XRectangle rs[2];
2103 #else
2104 XRectangle *rs = rects;
2105 #endif
2106 int i = 0, row_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, s->row->y);
2108 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_PRED)
2110 rs[i] = r;
2111 if (r.y + r.height > row_y)
2113 if (r.y < row_y)
2114 rs[i].height = row_y - r.y;
2115 else
2116 rs[i].height = 0;
2118 i++;
2120 if (s->for_overlaps & OVERLAPS_SUCC)
2122 rs[i] = r;
2123 if (r.y < row_y + s->row->visible_height)
2125 if (r.y + r.height > row_y + s->row->visible_height)
2127 rs[i].y = row_y + s->row->visible_height;
2128 rs[i].height = r.y + r.height - rs[i].y;
2130 else
2131 rs[i].height = 0;
2133 i++;
2136 n = i;
2137 #ifdef CONVERT_FROM_XRECT
2138 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
2139 CONVERT_FROM_XRECT (rs[i], rects[i]);
2140 #endif
2141 return n;
2145 /* EXPORT:
2146 Return in *NR the clipping rectangle for glyph string S. */
2148 void
2149 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (struct glyph_string *s, NativeRectangle *nr)
2151 get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, nr, 1);
2155 /* EXPORT:
2156 Return the position and height of the phys cursor in window W.
2157 Set w->phys_cursor_width to width of phys cursor.
2160 void
2161 get_phys_cursor_geometry (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
2162 struct glyph *glyph, int *xp, int *yp, int *heightp)
2164 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
2165 int x, y, wd, h, h0, y0;
2167 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
2168 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
2169 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
2170 width instead. */
2171 wd = glyph->pixel_width - 1;
2172 #if defined (HAVE_NTGUI) || defined (HAVE_NS)
2173 wd++; /* Why? */
2174 #endif
2176 x = w->phys_cursor.x;
2177 if (x < 0)
2179 wd += x;
2180 x = 0;
2183 if (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
2184 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2185 wd = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f), wd);
2186 w->phys_cursor_width = wd;
2188 y = w->phys_cursor.y + row->ascent - glyph->ascent;
2190 /* If y is below window bottom, ensure that we still see a cursor. */
2191 h0 = min (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f), row->visible_height);
2193 h = max (h0, glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
2194 h0 = min (h0, glyph->ascent + glyph->descent);
2196 y0 = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
2197 if (y < y0)
2199 h = max (h - (y0 - y) + 1, h0);
2200 y = y0 - 1;
2202 else
2204 y0 = window_text_bottom_y (w) - h0;
2205 if (y > y0)
2207 h += y - y0;
2208 y = y0;
2212 *xp = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, x);
2213 *yp = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, y);
2214 *heightp = h;
2218 * Remember which glyph the mouse is over.
2221 void
2222 remember_mouse_glyph (struct frame *f, int gx, int gy, NativeRectangle *rect)
2224 Lisp_Object window;
2225 struct window *w;
2226 struct glyph_row *r, *gr, *end_row;
2227 enum window_part part;
2228 enum glyph_row_area area;
2229 int x, y, width, height;
2231 /* Try to determine frame pixel position and size of the glyph under
2232 frame pixel coordinates X/Y on frame F. */
2234 if (!f->glyphs_initialized_p
2235 || (window = window_from_coordinates (f, gx, gy, &part, 0),
2236 NILP (window)))
2238 width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f);
2239 height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f);
2240 goto virtual_glyph;
2243 w = XWINDOW (window);
2244 width = WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
2245 height = WINDOW_FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
2247 x = window_relative_x_coord (w, part, gx);
2248 y = gy - WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
2250 r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
2251 end_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
2253 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
2255 area = TEXT_AREA;
2256 part = ON_MODE_LINE; /* Don't adjust margin. */
2257 goto text_glyph;
2260 switch (part)
2262 case ON_LEFT_MARGIN:
2263 area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
2264 goto text_glyph;
2266 case ON_RIGHT_MARGIN:
2267 area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
2268 goto text_glyph;
2270 case ON_HEADER_LINE:
2271 case ON_MODE_LINE:
2272 gr = (part == ON_HEADER_LINE
2273 ? MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
2274 : MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix));
2275 gy = gr->y;
2276 area = TEXT_AREA;
2277 goto text_glyph_row_found;
2279 case ON_TEXT:
2280 area = TEXT_AREA;
2282 text_glyph:
2283 gr = 0; gy = 0;
2284 for (; r <= end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
2285 if (r->y + r->height > y)
2287 gr = r; gy = r->y;
2288 break;
2291 text_glyph_row_found:
2292 if (gr && gy <= y)
2294 struct glyph *g = gr->glyphs[area];
2295 struct glyph *end = g + gr->used[area];
2297 height = gr->height;
2298 for (gx = gr->x; g < end; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
2299 if (gx + g->pixel_width > x)
2300 break;
2302 if (g < end)
2304 if (g->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
2306 /* Don't remember when mouse is over image, as
2307 image may have hot-spots. */
2308 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*rect, 0, 0, 0, 0);
2309 return;
2311 width = g->pixel_width;
2313 else
2315 /* Use nominal char spacing at end of line. */
2316 x -= gx;
2317 gx += (x / width) * width;
2320 if (part != ON_MODE_LINE && part != ON_HEADER_LINE)
2321 gx += window_box_left_offset (w, area);
2323 else
2325 /* Use nominal line height at end of window. */
2326 gx = (x / width) * width;
2327 y -= gy;
2328 gy += (y / height) * height;
2330 break;
2332 case ON_LEFT_FRINGE:
2333 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2334 ? WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w)
2335 : window_box_right_offset (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
2336 width = WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
2337 goto row_glyph;
2339 case ON_RIGHT_FRINGE:
2340 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2341 ? window_box_right_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
2342 : window_box_right_offset (w, TEXT_AREA));
2343 width = WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
2344 goto row_glyph;
2346 case ON_SCROLL_BAR:
2347 gx = (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w)
2349 : (window_box_right_offset (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
2350 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
2351 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
2352 : 0)));
2353 width = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
2355 row_glyph:
2356 gr = 0, gy = 0;
2357 for (; r <= end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
2358 if (r->y + r->height > y)
2360 gr = r; gy = r->y;
2361 break;
2364 if (gr && gy <= y)
2365 height = gr->height;
2366 else
2368 /* Use nominal line height at end of window. */
2369 y -= gy;
2370 gy += (y / height) * height;
2372 break;
2374 default:
2376 virtual_glyph:
2377 /* If there is no glyph under the mouse, then we divide the screen
2378 into a grid of the smallest glyph in the frame, and use that
2379 as our "glyph". */
2381 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to
2382 round down even for negative values. */
2383 if (gx < 0)
2384 gx -= width - 1;
2385 if (gy < 0)
2386 gy -= height - 1;
2388 gx = (gx / width) * width;
2389 gy = (gy / height) * height;
2391 goto store_rect;
2394 gx += WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
2395 gy += WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
2397 store_rect:
2398 STORE_NATIVE_RECT (*rect, gx, gy, width, height);
2400 /* Visible feedback for debugging. */
2401 #if 0
2402 #if HAVE_X_WINDOWS
2403 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2404 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2405 gx, gy, width, height);
2406 #endif
2407 #endif
2411 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
2414 /***********************************************************************
2415 Lisp form evaluation
2416 ***********************************************************************/
2418 /* Error handler for safe_eval and safe_call. */
2420 static Lisp_Object
2421 safe_eval_handler (Lisp_Object arg, ptrdiff_t nargs, Lisp_Object *args)
2423 add_to_log ("Error during redisplay: %S signalled %S",
2424 Flist (nargs, args), arg);
2425 return Qnil;
2428 /* Call function FUNC with the rest of NARGS - 1 arguments
2429 following. Return the result, or nil if something went
2430 wrong. Prevent redisplay during the evaluation. */
2432 Lisp_Object
2433 safe_call (ptrdiff_t nargs, Lisp_Object func, ...)
2435 Lisp_Object val;
2437 if (inhibit_eval_during_redisplay)
2438 val = Qnil;
2439 else
2441 va_list ap;
2442 ptrdiff_t i;
2443 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
2444 struct gcpro gcpro1;
2445 Lisp_Object *args = alloca (nargs * word_size);
2447 args[0] = func;
2448 va_start (ap, func);
2449 for (i = 1; i < nargs; i++)
2450 args[i] = va_arg (ap, Lisp_Object);
2451 va_end (ap);
2453 GCPRO1 (args[0]);
2454 gcpro1.nvars = nargs;
2455 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
2456 /* Use Qt to ensure debugger does not run,
2457 so there is no possibility of wanting to redisplay. */
2458 val = internal_condition_case_n (Ffuncall, nargs, args, Qt,
2459 safe_eval_handler);
2460 UNGCPRO;
2461 val = unbind_to (count, val);
2464 return val;
2468 /* Call function FN with one argument ARG.
2469 Return the result, or nil if something went wrong. */
2471 Lisp_Object
2472 safe_call1 (Lisp_Object fn, Lisp_Object arg)
2474 return safe_call (2, fn, arg);
2477 static Lisp_Object Qeval;
2479 Lisp_Object
2480 safe_eval (Lisp_Object sexpr)
2482 return safe_call1 (Qeval, sexpr);
2485 /* Call function FN with two arguments ARG1 and ARG2.
2486 Return the result, or nil if something went wrong. */
2488 Lisp_Object
2489 safe_call2 (Lisp_Object fn, Lisp_Object arg1, Lisp_Object arg2)
2491 return safe_call (3, fn, arg1, arg2);
2496 /***********************************************************************
2497 Debugging
2498 ***********************************************************************/
2500 #if 0
2502 /* Define CHECK_IT to perform sanity checks on iterators.
2503 This is for debugging. It is too slow to do unconditionally. */
2505 static void
2506 check_it (struct it *it)
2508 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
2510 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
2511 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0);
2513 else
2515 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < 0);
2516 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
2518 /* Check that character and byte positions agree. */
2519 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == BYTE_TO_CHAR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it)));
2523 if (it->dpvec)
2524 eassert (it->current.dpvec_index >= 0);
2525 else
2526 eassert (it->current.dpvec_index < 0);
2529 #define CHECK_IT(IT) check_it ((IT))
2531 #else /* not 0 */
2533 #define CHECK_IT(IT) (void) 0
2535 #endif /* not 0 */
2538 #if defined GLYPH_DEBUG && defined ENABLE_CHECKING
2540 /* Check that the window end of window W is what we expect it
2541 to be---the last row in the current matrix displaying text. */
2543 static void
2544 check_window_end (struct window *w)
2546 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
2547 && !NILP (w->window_end_valid))
2549 struct glyph_row *row;
2550 eassert ((row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix,
2551 XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos)),
2552 !row->enabled_p
2553 || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
2554 || MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, w->current_matrix) == 0));
2558 #define CHECK_WINDOW_END(W) check_window_end ((W))
2560 #else
2562 #define CHECK_WINDOW_END(W) (void) 0
2564 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG and ENABLE_CHECKING */
2568 /***********************************************************************
2569 Iterator initialization
2570 ***********************************************************************/
2572 /* Initialize IT for displaying current_buffer in window W, starting
2573 at character position CHARPOS. CHARPOS < 0 means that no buffer
2574 position is specified which is useful when the iterator is assigned
2575 a position later. BYTEPOS is the byte position corresponding to
2576 CHARPOS. BYTEPOS < 0 means compute it from CHARPOS.
2578 If ROW is not null, calls to produce_glyphs with IT as parameter
2579 will produce glyphs in that row.
2581 BASE_FACE_ID is the id of a base face to use. It must be one of
2582 DEFAULT_FACE_ID for normal text, MODE_LINE_FACE_ID,
2583 MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID, or HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID for displaying
2584 mode lines, or TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID for displaying the tool-bar.
2586 If ROW is null and BASE_FACE_ID is equal to MODE_LINE_FACE_ID,
2587 MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID, or HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID, the iterator
2588 will be initialized to use the corresponding mode line glyph row of
2589 the desired matrix of W. */
2591 void
2592 init_iterator (struct it *it, struct window *w,
2593 ptrdiff_t charpos, ptrdiff_t bytepos,
2594 struct glyph_row *row, enum face_id base_face_id)
2596 int highlight_region_p;
2597 enum face_id remapped_base_face_id = base_face_id;
2599 /* Some precondition checks. */
2600 eassert (w != NULL && it != NULL);
2601 eassert (charpos < 0 || (charpos >= BUF_BEG (current_buffer)
2602 && charpos <= ZV));
2604 /* If face attributes have been changed since the last redisplay,
2605 free realized faces now because they depend on face definitions
2606 that might have changed. Don't free faces while there might be
2607 desired matrices pending which reference these faces. */
2608 if (face_change_count && !inhibit_free_realized_faces)
2610 face_change_count = 0;
2611 free_all_realized_faces (Qnil);
2614 /* Perhaps remap BASE_FACE_ID to a user-specified alternative. */
2615 if (! NILP (Vface_remapping_alist))
2616 remapped_base_face_id
2617 = lookup_basic_face (XFRAME (w->frame), base_face_id);
2619 /* Use one of the mode line rows of W's desired matrix if
2620 appropriate. */
2621 if (row == NULL)
2623 if (base_face_id == MODE_LINE_FACE_ID
2624 || base_face_id == MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID)
2625 row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
2626 else if (base_face_id == HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID)
2627 row = MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
2630 /* Clear IT. */
2631 memset (it, 0, sizeof *it);
2632 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
2633 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
2634 it->base_face_id = remapped_base_face_id;
2635 it->string = Qnil;
2636 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
2637 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
2638 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
2639 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
2640 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
2642 /* The window in which we iterate over current_buffer: */
2643 XSETWINDOW (it->window, w);
2644 it->w = w;
2645 it->f = XFRAME (w->frame);
2647 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
2649 /* Extra space between lines (on window systems only). */
2650 if (base_face_id == DEFAULT_FACE_ID
2651 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
2653 if (NATNUMP (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing)))
2654 it->extra_line_spacing = XFASTINT (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing));
2655 else if (FLOATP (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing)))
2656 it->extra_line_spacing = (XFLOAT_DATA (BVAR (current_buffer, extra_line_spacing))
2657 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
2658 else if (it->f->extra_line_spacing > 0)
2659 it->extra_line_spacing = it->f->extra_line_spacing;
2660 it->max_extra_line_spacing = 0;
2663 /* If realized faces have been removed, e.g. because of face
2664 attribute changes of named faces, recompute them. When running
2665 in batch mode, the face cache of the initial frame is null. If
2666 we happen to get called, make a dummy face cache. */
2667 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (it->f) == NULL)
2668 init_frame_faces (it->f);
2669 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (it->f)->used == 0)
2670 recompute_basic_faces (it->f);
2672 /* Current value of the `slice', `space-width', and 'height' properties. */
2673 it->slice.x = it->slice.y = it->slice.width = it->slice.height = Qnil;
2674 it->space_width = Qnil;
2675 it->font_height = Qnil;
2676 it->override_ascent = -1;
2678 /* Are control characters displayed as `^C'? */
2679 it->ctl_arrow_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, ctl_arrow));
2681 /* -1 means everything between a CR and the following line end
2682 is invisible. >0 means lines indented more than this value are
2683 invisible. */
2684 it->selective = (INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
2685 ? (clip_to_bounds
2686 (-1, XINT (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display)),
2687 PTRDIFF_MAX))
2688 : (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
2689 ? -1 : 0));
2690 it->selective_display_ellipsis_p
2691 = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display_ellipses));
2693 /* Display table to use. */
2694 it->dp = window_display_table (w);
2696 /* Are multibyte characters enabled in current_buffer? */
2697 it->multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
2699 /* Non-zero if we should highlight the region. */
2700 highlight_region_p
2701 = (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
2702 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active))
2703 && XMARKER (BVAR (current_buffer, mark))->buffer != 0);
2705 /* Set IT->region_beg_charpos and IT->region_end_charpos to the
2706 start and end of a visible region in window IT->w. Set both to
2707 -1 to indicate no region. */
2708 if (highlight_region_p
2709 /* Maybe highlight only in selected window. */
2710 && (/* Either show region everywhere. */
2711 highlight_nonselected_windows
2712 /* Or show region in the selected window. */
2713 || w == XWINDOW (selected_window)
2714 /* Or show the region if we are in the mini-buffer and W is
2715 the window the mini-buffer refers to. */
2716 || (MINI_WINDOW_P (XWINDOW (selected_window))
2717 && WINDOWP (minibuf_selected_window)
2718 && w == XWINDOW (minibuf_selected_window))))
2720 ptrdiff_t markpos = marker_position (BVAR (current_buffer, mark));
2721 it->region_beg_charpos = min (PT, markpos);
2722 it->region_end_charpos = max (PT, markpos);
2724 else
2725 it->region_beg_charpos = it->region_end_charpos = -1;
2727 /* Get the position at which the redisplay_end_trigger hook should
2728 be run, if it is to be run at all. */
2729 if (MARKERP (w->redisplay_end_trigger)
2730 && XMARKER (w->redisplay_end_trigger)->buffer != 0)
2731 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos
2732 = marker_position (w->redisplay_end_trigger);
2733 else if (INTEGERP (w->redisplay_end_trigger))
2734 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos =
2735 clip_to_bounds (PTRDIFF_MIN, XINT (w->redisplay_end_trigger), PTRDIFF_MAX);
2737 it->tab_width = SANE_TAB_WIDTH (current_buffer);
2739 /* Are lines in the display truncated? */
2740 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID
2741 || it->w->hscroll
2742 || (! WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (it->w)
2743 && ((!NILP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows)
2744 && !INTEGERP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows))
2745 || (INTEGERP (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows)
2746 && (WINDOW_TOTAL_COLS (it->w)
2747 < XINT (Vtruncate_partial_width_windows))))))
2748 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
2749 else if (NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, truncate_lines)))
2750 it->line_wrap = NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, word_wrap))
2751 ? WINDOW_WRAP : WORD_WRAP;
2752 else
2753 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
2755 /* Get dimensions of truncation and continuation glyphs. These are
2756 displayed as fringe bitmaps under X, but we need them for such
2757 frames when the fringes are turned off. But leave the dimensions
2758 zero for tooltip frames, as these glyphs look ugly there and also
2759 sabotage calculations of tooltip dimensions in x-show-tip. */
2760 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
2761 if (!(FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
2762 && FRAMEP (tip_frame)
2763 && it->f == XFRAME (tip_frame)))
2764 #endif
2766 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
2768 /* We will need the truncation glyph. */
2769 eassert (it->glyph_row == NULL);
2770 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
2771 it->truncation_pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
2773 else
2775 /* We will need the continuation glyph. */
2776 eassert (it->glyph_row == NULL);
2777 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
2778 it->continuation_pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
2782 /* Reset these values to zero because the produce_special_glyphs
2783 above has changed them. */
2784 it->pixel_width = it->ascent = it->descent = 0;
2785 it->phys_ascent = it->phys_descent = 0;
2787 /* Set this after getting the dimensions of truncation and
2788 continuation glyphs, so that we don't produce glyphs when calling
2789 produce_special_glyphs, above. */
2790 it->glyph_row = row;
2791 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
2793 /* Forget any previous info about this row being reversed. */
2794 if (it->glyph_row)
2795 it->glyph_row->reversed_p = 0;
2797 /* Get the dimensions of the display area. The display area
2798 consists of the visible window area plus a horizontally scrolled
2799 part to the left of the window. All x-values are relative to the
2800 start of this total display area. */
2801 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
2803 /* Mode lines, menu bar in terminal frames. */
2804 it->first_visible_x = 0;
2805 it->last_visible_x = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
2807 else
2809 it->first_visible_x =
2810 window_hscroll_limited (it->w, it->f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f);
2811 it->last_visible_x = (it->first_visible_x
2812 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA));
2814 /* If we truncate lines, leave room for the truncation glyph(s) at
2815 the right margin. Otherwise, leave room for the continuation
2816 glyph(s). Done only if the window has no fringes. Since we
2817 don't know at this point whether there will be any R2L lines in
2818 the window, we reserve space for truncation/continuation glyphs
2819 even if only one of the fringes is absent. */
2820 if (WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0
2821 || (it->bidi_p && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0))
2823 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
2824 it->last_visible_x -= it->truncation_pixel_width;
2825 else
2826 it->last_visible_x -= it->continuation_pixel_width;
2829 it->header_line_p = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w);
2830 it->current_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w) + w->vscroll;
2833 /* Leave room for a border glyph. */
2834 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
2835 && !WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (it->w))
2836 it->last_visible_x -= 1;
2838 it->last_visible_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
2840 /* For mode lines and alike, arrange for the first glyph having a
2841 left box line if the face specifies a box. */
2842 if (base_face_id != DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
2844 struct face *face;
2846 it->face_id = remapped_base_face_id;
2848 /* If we have a boxed mode line, make the first character appear
2849 with a left box line. */
2850 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, remapped_base_face_id);
2851 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2852 it->start_of_box_run_p = 1;
2855 /* If a buffer position was specified, set the iterator there,
2856 getting overlays and face properties from that position. */
2857 if (charpos >= BUF_BEG (current_buffer))
2859 it->end_charpos = ZV;
2860 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = charpos;
2862 /* We will rely on `reseat' to set this up properly, via
2863 handle_face_prop. */
2864 it->face_id = it->base_face_id;
2866 /* Compute byte position if not specified. */
2867 if (bytepos < charpos)
2868 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos);
2869 else
2870 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = bytepos;
2872 it->start = it->current;
2873 /* Do we need to reorder bidirectional text? Not if this is a
2874 unibyte buffer: by definition, none of the single-byte
2875 characters are strong R2L, so no reordering is needed. And
2876 bidi.c doesn't support unibyte buffers anyway. Also, don't
2877 reorder while we are loading loadup.el, since the tables of
2878 character properties needed for reordering are not yet
2879 available. */
2880 it->bidi_p =
2881 NILP (Vpurify_flag)
2882 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_display_reordering))
2883 && it->multibyte_p;
2885 /* If we are to reorder bidirectional text, init the bidi
2886 iterator. */
2887 if (it->bidi_p)
2889 /* Note the paragraph direction that this buffer wants to
2890 use. */
2891 if (EQ (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_paragraph_direction),
2892 Qleft_to_right))
2893 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
2894 else if (EQ (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_paragraph_direction),
2895 Qright_to_left))
2896 it->paragraph_embedding = R2L;
2897 else
2898 it->paragraph_embedding = NEUTRAL_DIR;
2899 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
2900 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
2901 &it->bidi_it);
2904 /* Compute faces etc. */
2905 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
2908 CHECK_IT (it);
2912 /* Initialize IT for the display of window W with window start POS. */
2914 void
2915 start_display (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct text_pos pos)
2917 struct glyph_row *row;
2918 int first_vpos = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0;
2920 row = w->desired_matrix->rows + first_vpos;
2921 init_iterator (it, w, CHARPOS (pos), BYTEPOS (pos), row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
2922 it->first_vpos = first_vpos;
2924 /* Don't reseat to previous visible line start if current start
2925 position is in a string or image. */
2926 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE)
2928 int start_at_line_beg_p;
2929 int first_y = it->current_y;
2931 /* If window start is not at a line start, skip forward to POS to
2932 get the correct continuation lines width. */
2933 start_at_line_beg_p = (CHARPOS (pos) == BEGV
2934 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (pos) - 1) == '\n');
2935 if (!start_at_line_beg_p)
2937 int new_x;
2939 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (it);
2940 move_it_to (it, CHARPOS (pos), -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
2942 new_x = it->current_x + it->pixel_width;
2944 /* If lines are continued, this line may end in the middle
2945 of a multi-glyph character (e.g. a control character
2946 displayed as \003, or in the middle of an overlay
2947 string). In this case move_it_to above will not have
2948 taken us to the start of the continuation line but to the
2949 end of the continued line. */
2950 if (it->current_x > 0
2951 && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE /* Lines are continued. */
2952 && (/* And glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
2953 new_x > it->last_visible_x
2954 /* Or it fits exactly and we're on a window
2955 system frame. */
2956 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
2957 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
2958 && ((it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
2959 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
2960 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)))))
2962 if ((it->current.dpvec_index >= 0
2963 || it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
2964 /* If we are on a newline from a display vector or
2965 overlay string, then we are already at the end of
2966 a screen line; no need to go to the next line in
2967 that case, as this line is not really continued.
2968 (If we do go to the next line, C-e will not DTRT.) */
2969 && it->c != '\n')
2971 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
2972 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, -1, -1, 0);
2975 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
2977 /* If the character at POS is displayed via a display
2978 vector, move_it_to above stops at the final glyph of
2979 IT->dpvec. To make the caller redisplay that character
2980 again (a.k.a. start at POS), we need to reset the
2981 dpvec_index to the beginning of IT->dpvec. */
2982 else if (it->current.dpvec_index >= 0)
2983 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
2985 /* We're starting a new display line, not affected by the
2986 height of the continued line, so clear the appropriate
2987 fields in the iterator structure. */
2988 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
2989 it->max_phys_ascent = it->max_phys_descent = 0;
2991 it->current_y = first_y;
2992 it->vpos = 0;
2993 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
2999 /* Return 1 if POS is a position in ellipses displayed for invisible
3000 text. W is the window we display, for text property lookup. */
3002 static int
3003 in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (struct display_pos *pos, struct window *w)
3005 Lisp_Object prop, window;
3006 int ellipses_p = 0;
3007 ptrdiff_t charpos = CHARPOS (pos->pos);
3009 /* If POS specifies a position in a display vector, this might
3010 be for an ellipsis displayed for invisible text. We won't
3011 get the iterator set up for delivering that ellipsis unless
3012 we make sure that it gets aware of the invisible text. */
3013 if (pos->dpvec_index >= 0
3014 && pos->overlay_string_index < 0
3015 && CHARPOS (pos->string_pos) < 0
3016 && charpos > BEGV
3017 && (XSETWINDOW (window, w),
3018 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos),
3019 Qinvisible, window),
3020 !TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop)))
3022 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos - 1), Qinvisible,
3023 window);
3024 ellipses_p = 2 == TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
3027 return ellipses_p;
3031 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W,
3032 starting at position POS that includes overlay string and display
3033 vector/ control character translation position information. Value
3034 is zero if there are overlay strings with newlines at POS. */
3036 static int
3037 init_from_display_pos (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct display_pos *pos)
3039 ptrdiff_t charpos = CHARPOS (pos->pos), bytepos = BYTEPOS (pos->pos);
3040 int i, overlay_strings_with_newlines = 0;
3042 /* If POS specifies a position in a display vector, this might
3043 be for an ellipsis displayed for invisible text. We won't
3044 get the iterator set up for delivering that ellipsis unless
3045 we make sure that it gets aware of the invisible text. */
3046 if (in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (pos, w))
3048 --charpos;
3049 bytepos = 0;
3052 /* Keep in mind: the call to reseat in init_iterator skips invisible
3053 text, so we might end up at a position different from POS. This
3054 is only a problem when POS is a row start after a newline and an
3055 overlay starts there with an after-string, and the overlay has an
3056 invisible property. Since we don't skip invisible text in
3057 display_line and elsewhere immediately after consuming the
3058 newline before the row start, such a POS will not be in a string,
3059 but the call to init_iterator below will move us to the
3060 after-string. */
3061 init_iterator (it, w, charpos, bytepos, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
3063 /* This only scans the current chunk -- it should scan all chunks.
3064 However, OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE has been increased from 3 in 21.1
3065 to 16 in 22.1 to make this a lesser problem. */
3066 for (i = 0; i < it->n_overlay_strings && i < OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE; ++i)
3068 const char *s = SSDATA (it->overlay_strings[i]);
3069 const char *e = s + SBYTES (it->overlay_strings[i]);
3071 while (s < e && *s != '\n')
3072 ++s;
3074 if (s < e)
3076 overlay_strings_with_newlines = 1;
3077 break;
3081 /* If position is within an overlay string, set up IT to the right
3082 overlay string. */
3083 if (pos->overlay_string_index >= 0)
3085 int relative_index;
3087 /* If the first overlay string happens to have a `display'
3088 property for an image, the iterator will be set up for that
3089 image, and we have to undo that setup first before we can
3090 correct the overlay string index. */
3091 if (it->method == GET_FROM_IMAGE)
3092 pop_it (it);
3094 /* We already have the first chunk of overlay strings in
3095 IT->overlay_strings. Load more until the one for
3096 pos->overlay_string_index is in IT->overlay_strings. */
3097 if (pos->overlay_string_index >= OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE)
3099 ptrdiff_t n = pos->overlay_string_index / OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
3100 it->current.overlay_string_index = 0;
3101 while (n--)
3103 load_overlay_strings (it, 0);
3104 it->current.overlay_string_index += OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
3108 it->current.overlay_string_index = pos->overlay_string_index;
3109 relative_index = (it->current.overlay_string_index
3110 % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE);
3111 it->string = it->overlay_strings[relative_index];
3112 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
3113 it->current.string_pos = pos->string_pos;
3114 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
3117 if (CHARPOS (pos->string_pos) >= 0)
3119 /* Recorded position is not in an overlay string, but in another
3120 string. This can only be a string from a `display' property.
3121 IT should already be filled with that string. */
3122 it->current.string_pos = pos->string_pos;
3123 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
3126 /* Restore position in display vector translations, control
3127 character translations or ellipses. */
3128 if (pos->dpvec_index >= 0)
3130 if (it->dpvec == NULL)
3131 get_next_display_element (it);
3132 eassert (it->dpvec && it->current.dpvec_index == 0);
3133 it->current.dpvec_index = pos->dpvec_index;
3136 CHECK_IT (it);
3137 return !overlay_strings_with_newlines;
3141 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W
3142 starting at ROW->start. */
3144 static void
3145 init_to_row_start (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
3147 init_from_display_pos (it, w, &row->start);
3148 it->start = row->start;
3149 it->continuation_lines_width = row->continuation_lines_width;
3150 CHECK_IT (it);
3154 /* Initialize IT for stepping through current_buffer in window W
3155 starting in the line following ROW, i.e. starting at ROW->end.
3156 Value is zero if there are overlay strings with newlines at ROW's
3157 end position. */
3159 static int
3160 init_to_row_end (struct it *it, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
3162 int success = 0;
3164 if (init_from_display_pos (it, w, &row->end))
3166 if (row->continued_p)
3167 it->continuation_lines_width
3168 = row->continuation_lines_width + row->pixel_width;
3169 CHECK_IT (it);
3170 success = 1;
3173 return success;
3179 /***********************************************************************
3180 Text properties
3181 ***********************************************************************/
3183 /* Called when IT reaches IT->stop_charpos. Handle text property and
3184 overlay changes. Set IT->stop_charpos to the next position where
3185 to stop. */
3187 static void
3188 handle_stop (struct it *it)
3190 enum prop_handled handled;
3191 int handle_overlay_change_p;
3192 struct props *p;
3194 it->dpvec = NULL;
3195 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
3196 handle_overlay_change_p = !it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p;
3197 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 0;
3198 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
3200 /* Use face of preceding text for ellipsis (if invisible) */
3201 if (it->selective_display_ellipsis_p)
3202 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
3206 handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3208 /* Call text property handlers. */
3209 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3211 handled = p->handler (it);
3213 if (handled == HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS)
3214 break;
3215 else if (handled == HANDLED_RETURN)
3217 /* We still want to show before and after strings from
3218 overlays even if the actual buffer text is replaced. */
3219 if (!handle_overlay_change_p
3220 || it->sp > 1
3221 /* Don't call get_overlay_strings_1 if we already
3222 have overlay strings loaded, because doing so
3223 will load them again and push the iterator state
3224 onto the stack one more time, which is not
3225 expected by the rest of the code that processes
3226 overlay strings. */
3227 || (it->current.overlay_string_index < 0
3228 ? !get_overlay_strings_1 (it, 0, 0)
3229 : 0))
3231 if (it->ellipsis_p)
3232 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
3233 /* When handling a display spec, we might load an
3234 empty string. In that case, discard it here. We
3235 used to discard it in handle_single_display_spec,
3236 but that causes get_overlay_strings_1, above, to
3237 ignore overlay strings that we must check. */
3238 if (STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string))
3239 pop_it (it);
3240 return;
3242 else if (STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string))
3243 pop_it (it);
3244 else
3246 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 1;
3247 it->string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
3248 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
3249 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3251 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
3252 break;
3254 else if (handled == HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED)
3255 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3258 if (handled != HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS)
3260 /* Don't check for overlay strings below when set to deliver
3261 characters from a display vector. */
3262 if (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR)
3263 handle_overlay_change_p = 0;
3265 /* Handle overlay changes.
3266 This sets HANDLED to HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS
3267 if it finds overlays. */
3268 if (handle_overlay_change_p)
3269 handled = handle_overlay_change (it);
3272 if (it->ellipsis_p)
3274 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
3275 break;
3278 while (handled == HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS);
3280 /* Determine where to stop next. */
3281 if (handled == HANDLED_NORMALLY)
3282 compute_stop_pos (it);
3286 /* Compute IT->stop_charpos from text property and overlay change
3287 information for IT's current position. */
3289 static void
3290 compute_stop_pos (struct it *it)
3292 register INTERVAL iv, next_iv;
3293 Lisp_Object object, limit, position;
3294 ptrdiff_t charpos, bytepos;
3296 if (STRINGP (it->string))
3298 /* Strings are usually short, so don't limit the search for
3299 properties. */
3300 it->stop_charpos = it->end_charpos;
3301 object = it->string;
3302 limit = Qnil;
3303 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
3304 bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
3306 else
3308 ptrdiff_t pos;
3310 /* If end_charpos is out of range for some reason, such as a
3311 misbehaving display function, rationalize it (Bug#5984). */
3312 if (it->end_charpos > ZV)
3313 it->end_charpos = ZV;
3314 it->stop_charpos = it->end_charpos;
3316 /* If next overlay change is in front of the current stop pos
3317 (which is IT->end_charpos), stop there. Note: value of
3318 next_overlay_change is point-max if no overlay change
3319 follows. */
3320 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
3321 bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
3322 pos = next_overlay_change (charpos);
3323 if (pos < it->stop_charpos)
3324 it->stop_charpos = pos;
3326 /* If showing the region, we have to stop at the region
3327 start or end because the face might change there. */
3328 if (it->region_beg_charpos > 0)
3330 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->region_beg_charpos)
3331 it->stop_charpos = min (it->stop_charpos, it->region_beg_charpos);
3332 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->region_end_charpos)
3333 it->stop_charpos = min (it->stop_charpos, it->region_end_charpos);
3336 /* Set up variables for computing the stop position from text
3337 property changes. */
3338 XSETBUFFER (object, current_buffer);
3339 limit = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT);
3342 /* Get the interval containing IT's position. Value is a null
3343 interval if there isn't such an interval. */
3344 position = make_number (charpos);
3345 iv = validate_interval_range (object, &position, &position, 0);
3346 if (iv)
3348 Lisp_Object values_here[LAST_PROP_IDX];
3349 struct props *p;
3351 /* Get properties here. */
3352 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3353 values_here[p->idx] = textget (iv->plist, *p->name);
3355 /* Look for an interval following iv that has different
3356 properties. */
3357 for (next_iv = next_interval (iv);
3358 (next_iv
3359 && (NILP (limit)
3360 || XFASTINT (limit) > next_iv->position));
3361 next_iv = next_interval (next_iv))
3363 for (p = it_props; p->handler; ++p)
3365 Lisp_Object new_value;
3367 new_value = textget (next_iv->plist, *p->name);
3368 if (!EQ (values_here[p->idx], new_value))
3369 break;
3372 if (p->handler)
3373 break;
3376 if (next_iv)
3378 if (INTEGERP (limit)
3379 && next_iv->position >= XFASTINT (limit))
3380 /* No text property change up to limit. */
3381 it->stop_charpos = min (XFASTINT (limit), it->stop_charpos);
3382 else
3383 /* Text properties change in next_iv. */
3384 it->stop_charpos = min (it->stop_charpos, next_iv->position);
3388 if (it->cmp_it.id < 0)
3390 ptrdiff_t stoppos = it->end_charpos;
3392 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
3393 stoppos = -1;
3394 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, bytepos,
3395 stoppos, it->string);
3398 eassert (STRINGP (it->string)
3399 || (it->stop_charpos >= BEGV
3400 && it->stop_charpos >= IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
3404 /* Return the position of the next overlay change after POS in
3405 current_buffer. Value is point-max if no overlay change
3406 follows. This is like `next-overlay-change' but doesn't use
3407 xmalloc. */
3409 static ptrdiff_t
3410 next_overlay_change (ptrdiff_t pos)
3412 ptrdiff_t i, noverlays;
3413 ptrdiff_t endpos;
3414 Lisp_Object *overlays;
3416 /* Get all overlays at the given position. */
3417 GET_OVERLAYS_AT (pos, overlays, noverlays, &endpos, 1);
3419 /* If any of these overlays ends before endpos,
3420 use its ending point instead. */
3421 for (i = 0; i < noverlays; ++i)
3423 Lisp_Object oend;
3424 ptrdiff_t oendpos;
3426 oend = OVERLAY_END (overlays[i]);
3427 oendpos = OVERLAY_POSITION (oend);
3428 endpos = min (endpos, oendpos);
3431 return endpos;
3434 /* How many characters forward to search for a display property or
3435 display string. Searching too far forward makes the bidi display
3436 sluggish, especially in small windows. */
3437 #define MAX_DISP_SCAN 250
3439 /* Return the character position of a display string at or after
3440 position specified by POSITION. If no display string exists at or
3441 after POSITION, return ZV. A display string is either an overlay
3442 with `display' property whose value is a string, or a `display'
3443 text property whose value is a string. STRING is data about the
3444 string to iterate; if STRING->lstring is nil, we are iterating a
3445 buffer. FRAME_WINDOW_P is non-zero when we are displaying a window
3446 on a GUI frame. DISP_PROP is set to zero if we searched
3447 MAX_DISP_SCAN characters forward without finding any display
3448 strings, non-zero otherwise. It is set to 2 if the display string
3449 uses any kind of `(space ...)' spec that will produce a stretch of
3450 white space in the text area. */
3451 ptrdiff_t
3452 compute_display_string_pos (struct text_pos *position,
3453 struct bidi_string_data *string,
3454 int frame_window_p, int *disp_prop)
3456 /* OBJECT = nil means current buffer. */
3457 Lisp_Object object =
3458 (string && STRINGP (string->lstring)) ? string->lstring : Qnil;
3459 Lisp_Object pos, spec, limpos;
3460 int string_p = (string && (STRINGP (string->lstring) || string->s));
3461 ptrdiff_t eob = string_p ? string->schars : ZV;
3462 ptrdiff_t begb = string_p ? 0 : BEGV;
3463 ptrdiff_t bufpos, charpos = CHARPOS (*position);
3464 ptrdiff_t lim =
3465 (charpos < eob - MAX_DISP_SCAN) ? charpos + MAX_DISP_SCAN : eob;
3466 struct text_pos tpos;
3467 int rv = 0;
3469 *disp_prop = 1;
3471 if (charpos >= eob
3472 /* We don't support display properties whose values are strings
3473 that have display string properties. */
3474 || string->from_disp_str
3475 /* C strings cannot have display properties. */
3476 || (string->s && !STRINGP (object)))
3478 *disp_prop = 0;
3479 return eob;
3482 /* If the character at CHARPOS is where the display string begins,
3483 return CHARPOS. */
3484 pos = make_number (charpos);
3485 if (STRINGP (object))
3486 bufpos = string->bufpos;
3487 else
3488 bufpos = charpos;
3489 tpos = *position;
3490 if (!NILP (spec = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object))
3491 && (charpos <= begb
3492 || !EQ (Fget_char_property (make_number (charpos - 1), Qdisplay,
3493 object),
3494 spec))
3495 && (rv = handle_display_spec (NULL, spec, object, Qnil, &tpos, bufpos,
3496 frame_window_p)))
3498 if (rv == 2)
3499 *disp_prop = 2;
3500 return charpos;
3503 /* Look forward for the first character with a `display' property
3504 that will replace the underlying text when displayed. */
3505 limpos = make_number (lim);
3506 do {
3507 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, object, limpos);
3508 CHARPOS (tpos) = XFASTINT (pos);
3509 if (CHARPOS (tpos) >= lim)
3511 *disp_prop = 0;
3512 break;
3514 if (STRINGP (object))
3515 BYTEPOS (tpos) = string_char_to_byte (object, CHARPOS (tpos));
3516 else
3517 BYTEPOS (tpos) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (CHARPOS (tpos));
3518 spec = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object);
3519 if (!STRINGP (object))
3520 bufpos = CHARPOS (tpos);
3521 } while (NILP (spec)
3522 || !(rv = handle_display_spec (NULL, spec, object, Qnil, &tpos,
3523 bufpos, frame_window_p)));
3524 if (rv == 2)
3525 *disp_prop = 2;
3527 return CHARPOS (tpos);
3530 /* Return the character position of the end of the display string that
3531 started at CHARPOS. If there's no display string at CHARPOS,
3532 return -1. A display string is either an overlay with `display'
3533 property whose value is a string or a `display' text property whose
3534 value is a string. */
3535 ptrdiff_t
3536 compute_display_string_end (ptrdiff_t charpos, struct bidi_string_data *string)
3538 /* OBJECT = nil means current buffer. */
3539 Lisp_Object object =
3540 (string && STRINGP (string->lstring)) ? string->lstring : Qnil;
3541 Lisp_Object pos = make_number (charpos);
3542 ptrdiff_t eob =
3543 (STRINGP (object) || (string && string->s)) ? string->schars : ZV;
3545 if (charpos >= eob || (string->s && !STRINGP (object)))
3546 return eob;
3548 /* It could happen that the display property or overlay was removed
3549 since we found it in compute_display_string_pos above. One way
3550 this can happen is if JIT font-lock was called (through
3551 handle_fontified_prop), and jit-lock-functions remove text
3552 properties or overlays from the portion of buffer that includes
3553 CHARPOS. Muse mode is known to do that, for example. In this
3554 case, we return -1 to the caller, to signal that no display
3555 string is actually present at CHARPOS. See bidi_fetch_char for
3556 how this is handled.
3558 An alternative would be to never look for display properties past
3559 it->stop_charpos. But neither compute_display_string_pos nor
3560 bidi_fetch_char that calls it know or care where the next
3561 stop_charpos is. */
3562 if (NILP (Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, object)))
3563 return -1;
3565 /* Look forward for the first character where the `display' property
3566 changes. */
3567 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, object, Qnil);
3569 return XFASTINT (pos);
3574 /***********************************************************************
3575 Fontification
3576 ***********************************************************************/
3578 /* Handle changes in the `fontified' property of the current buffer by
3579 calling hook functions from Qfontification_functions to fontify
3580 regions of text. */
3582 static enum prop_handled
3583 handle_fontified_prop (struct it *it)
3585 Lisp_Object prop, pos;
3586 enum prop_handled handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3588 if (!NILP (Vmemory_full))
3589 return handled;
3591 /* Get the value of the `fontified' property at IT's current buffer
3592 position. (The `fontified' property doesn't have a special
3593 meaning in strings.) If the value is nil, call functions from
3594 Qfontification_functions. */
3595 if (!STRINGP (it->string)
3596 && it->s == NULL
3597 && !NILP (Vfontification_functions)
3598 && !NILP (Vrun_hooks)
3599 && (pos = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it)),
3600 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qfontified, Qnil),
3601 /* Ignore the special cased nil value always present at EOB since
3602 no amount of fontifying will be able to change it. */
3603 NILP (prop) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < Z))
3605 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
3606 Lisp_Object val;
3607 struct buffer *obuf = current_buffer;
3608 int begv = BEGV, zv = ZV;
3609 int old_clip_changed = current_buffer->clip_changed;
3611 val = Vfontification_functions;
3612 specbind (Qfontification_functions, Qnil);
3614 eassert (it->end_charpos == ZV);
3616 if (!CONSP (val) || EQ (XCAR (val), Qlambda))
3617 safe_call1 (val, pos);
3618 else
3620 Lisp_Object fns, fn;
3621 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
3623 fns = Qnil;
3624 GCPRO2 (val, fns);
3626 for (; CONSP (val); val = XCDR (val))
3628 fn = XCAR (val);
3630 if (EQ (fn, Qt))
3632 /* A value of t indicates this hook has a local
3633 binding; it means to run the global binding too.
3634 In a global value, t should not occur. If it
3635 does, we must ignore it to avoid an endless
3636 loop. */
3637 for (fns = Fdefault_value (Qfontification_functions);
3638 CONSP (fns);
3639 fns = XCDR (fns))
3641 fn = XCAR (fns);
3642 if (!EQ (fn, Qt))
3643 safe_call1 (fn, pos);
3646 else
3647 safe_call1 (fn, pos);
3650 UNGCPRO;
3653 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
3655 /* Fontification functions routinely call `save-restriction'.
3656 Normally, this tags clip_changed, which can confuse redisplay
3657 (see discussion in Bug#6671). Since we don't perform any
3658 special handling of fontification changes in the case where
3659 `save-restriction' isn't called, there's no point doing so in
3660 this case either. So, if the buffer's restrictions are
3661 actually left unchanged, reset clip_changed. */
3662 if (obuf == current_buffer)
3664 if (begv == BEGV && zv == ZV)
3665 current_buffer->clip_changed = old_clip_changed;
3667 /* There isn't much we can reasonably do to protect against
3668 misbehaving fontification, but here's a fig leaf. */
3669 else if (!NILP (BVAR (obuf, name)))
3670 set_buffer_internal_1 (obuf);
3672 /* The fontification code may have added/removed text.
3673 It could do even a lot worse, but let's at least protect against
3674 the most obvious case where only the text past `pos' gets changed',
3675 as is/was done in grep.el where some escapes sequences are turned
3676 into face properties (bug#7876). */
3677 it->end_charpos = ZV;
3679 /* Return HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS only if function fontified
3680 something. This avoids an endless loop if they failed to
3681 fontify the text for which reason ever. */
3682 if (!NILP (Fget_char_property (pos, Qfontified, Qnil)))
3683 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
3686 return handled;
3691 /***********************************************************************
3692 Faces
3693 ***********************************************************************/
3695 /* Set up iterator IT from face properties at its current position.
3696 Called from handle_stop. */
3698 static enum prop_handled
3699 handle_face_prop (struct it *it)
3701 int new_face_id;
3702 ptrdiff_t next_stop;
3704 if (!STRINGP (it->string))
3706 new_face_id
3707 = face_at_buffer_position (it->w,
3708 IT_CHARPOS (*it),
3709 it->region_beg_charpos,
3710 it->region_end_charpos,
3711 &next_stop,
3712 (IT_CHARPOS (*it)
3713 + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT),
3714 0, it->base_face_id);
3716 /* Is this a start of a run of characters with box face?
3717 Caveat: this can be called for a freshly initialized
3718 iterator; face_id is -1 in this case. We know that the new
3719 face will not change until limit, i.e. if the new face has a
3720 box, all characters up to limit will have one. But, as
3721 usual, we don't know whether limit is really the end. */
3722 if (new_face_id != it->face_id)
3724 struct face *new_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, new_face_id);
3726 /* If new face has a box but old face has not, this is
3727 the start of a run of characters with box, i.e. it has
3728 a shadow on the left side. The value of face_id of the
3729 iterator will be -1 if this is the initial call that gets
3730 the face. In this case, we have to look in front of IT's
3731 position and see whether there is a face != new_face_id. */
3732 it->start_of_box_run_p
3733 = (new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3734 && (it->face_id >= 0
3735 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) == BEG
3736 || new_face_id != face_before_it_pos (it)));
3737 it->face_box_p = new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
3740 else
3742 int base_face_id;
3743 ptrdiff_t bufpos;
3744 int i;
3745 Lisp_Object from_overlay
3746 = (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0
3747 ? it->string_overlays[it->current.overlay_string_index
3748 % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE]
3749 : Qnil);
3751 /* See if we got to this string directly or indirectly from
3752 an overlay property. That includes the before-string or
3753 after-string of an overlay, strings in display properties
3754 provided by an overlay, their text properties, etc.
3756 FROM_OVERLAY is the overlay that brought us here, or nil if none. */
3757 if (! NILP (from_overlay))
3758 for (i = it->sp - 1; i >= 0; i--)
3760 if (it->stack[i].current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
3761 from_overlay
3762 = it->string_overlays[it->stack[i].current.overlay_string_index
3763 % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE];
3764 else if (! NILP (it->stack[i].from_overlay))
3765 from_overlay = it->stack[i].from_overlay;
3767 if (!NILP (from_overlay))
3768 break;
3771 if (! NILP (from_overlay))
3773 bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
3774 /* For a string from an overlay, the base face depends
3775 only on text properties and ignores overlays. */
3776 base_face_id
3777 = face_for_overlay_string (it->w,
3778 IT_CHARPOS (*it),
3779 it->region_beg_charpos,
3780 it->region_end_charpos,
3781 &next_stop,
3782 (IT_CHARPOS (*it)
3783 + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT),
3785 from_overlay);
3787 else
3789 bufpos = 0;
3791 /* For strings from a `display' property, use the face at
3792 IT's current buffer position as the base face to merge
3793 with, so that overlay strings appear in the same face as
3794 surrounding text, unless they specify their own
3795 faces. */
3796 base_face_id = it->string_from_prefix_prop_p
3797 ? DEFAULT_FACE_ID
3798 : underlying_face_id (it);
3801 new_face_id = face_at_string_position (it->w,
3802 it->string,
3803 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
3804 bufpos,
3805 it->region_beg_charpos,
3806 it->region_end_charpos,
3807 &next_stop,
3808 base_face_id, 0);
3810 /* Is this a start of a run of characters with box? Caveat:
3811 this can be called for a freshly allocated iterator; face_id
3812 is -1 is this case. We know that the new face will not
3813 change until the next check pos, i.e. if the new face has a
3814 box, all characters up to that position will have a
3815 box. But, as usual, we don't know whether that position
3816 is really the end. */
3817 if (new_face_id != it->face_id)
3819 struct face *new_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, new_face_id);
3820 struct face *old_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
3822 /* If new face has a box but old face hasn't, this is the
3823 start of a run of characters with box, i.e. it has a
3824 shadow on the left side. */
3825 it->start_of_box_run_p
3826 = new_face->box && (old_face == NULL || !old_face->box);
3827 it->face_box_p = new_face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
3831 it->face_id = new_face_id;
3832 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
3836 /* Return the ID of the face ``underlying'' IT's current position,
3837 which is in a string. If the iterator is associated with a
3838 buffer, return the face at IT's current buffer position.
3839 Otherwise, use the iterator's base_face_id. */
3841 static int
3842 underlying_face_id (struct it *it)
3844 int face_id = it->base_face_id, i;
3846 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
3848 for (i = it->sp - 1; i >= 0; --i)
3849 if (NILP (it->stack[i].string))
3850 face_id = it->stack[i].face_id;
3852 return face_id;
3856 /* Compute the face one character before or after the current position
3857 of IT, in the visual order. BEFORE_P non-zero means get the face
3858 in front (to the left in L2R paragraphs, to the right in R2L
3859 paragraphs) of IT's screen position. Value is the ID of the face. */
3861 static int
3862 face_before_or_after_it_pos (struct it *it, int before_p)
3864 int face_id, limit;
3865 ptrdiff_t next_check_charpos;
3866 struct it it_copy;
3867 void *it_copy_data = NULL;
3869 eassert (it->s == NULL);
3871 if (STRINGP (it->string))
3873 ptrdiff_t bufpos, charpos;
3874 int base_face_id;
3876 /* No face change past the end of the string (for the case
3877 we are padding with spaces). No face change before the
3878 string start. */
3879 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string)
3880 || (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == 0 && before_p))
3881 return it->face_id;
3883 if (!it->bidi_p)
3885 /* Set charpos to the position before or after IT's current
3886 position, in the logical order, which in the non-bidi
3887 case is the same as the visual order. */
3888 if (before_p)
3889 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) - 1;
3890 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
3891 /* For composition, we must check the character after the
3892 composition. */
3893 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) + it->cmp_it.nchars;
3894 else
3895 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) + 1;
3897 else
3899 if (before_p)
3901 /* With bidi iteration, the character before the current
3902 in the visual order cannot be found by simple
3903 iteration, because "reverse" reordering is not
3904 supported. Instead, we need to use the move_it_*
3905 family of functions. */
3906 /* Ignore face changes before the first visible
3907 character on this display line. */
3908 if (it->current_x <= it->first_visible_x)
3909 return it->face_id;
3910 SAVE_IT (it_copy, *it, it_copy_data);
3911 /* Implementation note: Since move_it_in_display_line
3912 works in the iterator geometry, and thinks the first
3913 character is always the leftmost, even in R2L lines,
3914 we don't need to distinguish between the R2L and L2R
3915 cases here. */
3916 move_it_in_display_line (&it_copy, SCHARS (it_copy.string),
3917 it_copy.current_x - 1, MOVE_TO_X);
3918 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (it_copy);
3919 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it_copy_data);
3921 else
3923 /* Set charpos to the string position of the character
3924 that comes after IT's current position in the visual
3925 order. */
3926 int n = (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION ? it->cmp_it.nchars : 1);
3928 it_copy = *it;
3929 while (n--)
3930 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it_copy.bidi_it);
3932 charpos = it_copy.bidi_it.charpos;
3935 eassert (0 <= charpos && charpos <= SCHARS (it->string));
3937 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
3938 bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
3939 else
3940 bufpos = 0;
3942 base_face_id = underlying_face_id (it);
3944 /* Get the face for ASCII, or unibyte. */
3945 face_id = face_at_string_position (it->w,
3946 it->string,
3947 charpos,
3948 bufpos,
3949 it->region_beg_charpos,
3950 it->region_end_charpos,
3951 &next_check_charpos,
3952 base_face_id, 0);
3954 /* Correct the face for charsets different from ASCII. Do it
3955 for the multibyte case only. The face returned above is
3956 suitable for unibyte text if IT->string is unibyte. */
3957 if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
3959 struct text_pos pos1 = string_pos (charpos, it->string);
3960 const unsigned char *p = SDATA (it->string) + BYTEPOS (pos1);
3961 int c, len;
3962 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
3964 c = string_char_and_length (p, &len);
3965 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, charpos, it->string);
3968 else
3970 struct text_pos pos;
3972 if ((IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= ZV && !before_p)
3973 || (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV && before_p))
3974 return it->face_id;
3976 limit = IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT;
3977 pos = it->current.pos;
3979 if (!it->bidi_p)
3981 if (before_p)
3982 DEC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
3983 else
3985 if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
3987 /* For composition, we must check the position after
3988 the composition. */
3989 pos.charpos += it->cmp_it.nchars;
3990 pos.bytepos += it->len;
3992 else
3993 INC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
3996 else
3998 if (before_p)
4000 /* With bidi iteration, the character before the current
4001 in the visual order cannot be found by simple
4002 iteration, because "reverse" reordering is not
4003 supported. Instead, we need to use the move_it_*
4004 family of functions. */
4005 /* Ignore face changes before the first visible
4006 character on this display line. */
4007 if (it->current_x <= it->first_visible_x)
4008 return it->face_id;
4009 SAVE_IT (it_copy, *it, it_copy_data);
4010 /* Implementation note: Since move_it_in_display_line
4011 works in the iterator geometry, and thinks the first
4012 character is always the leftmost, even in R2L lines,
4013 we don't need to distinguish between the R2L and L2R
4014 cases here. */
4015 move_it_in_display_line (&it_copy, ZV,
4016 it_copy.current_x - 1, MOVE_TO_X);
4017 pos = it_copy.current.pos;
4018 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it_copy_data);
4020 else
4022 /* Set charpos to the buffer position of the character
4023 that comes after IT's current position in the visual
4024 order. */
4025 int n = (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION ? it->cmp_it.nchars : 1);
4027 it_copy = *it;
4028 while (n--)
4029 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it_copy.bidi_it);
4031 SET_TEXT_POS (pos,
4032 it_copy.bidi_it.charpos, it_copy.bidi_it.bytepos);
4035 eassert (BEGV <= CHARPOS (pos) && CHARPOS (pos) <= ZV);
4037 /* Determine face for CHARSET_ASCII, or unibyte. */
4038 face_id = face_at_buffer_position (it->w,
4039 CHARPOS (pos),
4040 it->region_beg_charpos,
4041 it->region_end_charpos,
4042 &next_check_charpos,
4043 limit, 0, -1);
4045 /* Correct the face for charsets different from ASCII. Do it
4046 for the multibyte case only. The face returned above is
4047 suitable for unibyte text if current_buffer is unibyte. */
4048 if (it->multibyte_p)
4050 int c = FETCH_MULTIBYTE_CHAR (BYTEPOS (pos));
4051 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
4052 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, CHARPOS (pos), Qnil);
4056 return face_id;
4061 /***********************************************************************
4062 Invisible text
4063 ***********************************************************************/
4065 /* Set up iterator IT from invisible properties at its current
4066 position. Called from handle_stop. */
4068 static enum prop_handled
4069 handle_invisible_prop (struct it *it)
4071 enum prop_handled handled = HANDLED_NORMALLY;
4072 int invis_p;
4073 Lisp_Object prop;
4075 if (STRINGP (it->string))
4077 Lisp_Object end_charpos, limit, charpos;
4079 /* Get the value of the invisible text property at the
4080 current position. Value will be nil if there is no such
4081 property. */
4082 charpos = make_number (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
4083 prop = Fget_text_property (charpos, Qinvisible, it->string);
4084 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4086 if (invis_p && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos)
4088 /* Record whether we have to display an ellipsis for the
4089 invisible text. */
4090 int display_ellipsis_p = (invis_p == 2);
4091 ptrdiff_t len, endpos;
4093 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
4095 /* Get the position at which the next visible text can be
4096 found in IT->string, if any. */
4097 endpos = len = SCHARS (it->string);
4098 XSETINT (limit, len);
4101 end_charpos = Fnext_single_property_change (charpos, Qinvisible,
4102 it->string, limit);
4103 if (INTEGERP (end_charpos))
4105 endpos = XFASTINT (end_charpos);
4106 prop = Fget_text_property (end_charpos, Qinvisible, it->string);
4107 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4108 if (invis_p == 2)
4109 display_ellipsis_p = 1;
4112 while (invis_p && endpos < len);
4114 if (display_ellipsis_p)
4115 it->ellipsis_p = 1;
4117 if (endpos < len)
4119 /* Text at END_CHARPOS is visible. Move IT there. */
4120 struct text_pos old;
4121 ptrdiff_t oldpos;
4123 old = it->current.string_pos;
4124 oldpos = CHARPOS (old);
4125 if (it->bidi_p)
4127 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt
4128 && it->bidi_it.charpos < SCHARS (it->string))
4129 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding,
4130 &it->bidi_it, 1);
4131 /* Bidi-iterate out of the invisible text. */
4134 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
4136 while (oldpos <= it->bidi_it.charpos
4137 && it->bidi_it.charpos < endpos);
4139 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
4140 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
4141 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= endpos)
4142 it->prev_stop = endpos;
4144 else
4146 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = XFASTINT (end_charpos);
4147 compute_string_pos (&it->current.string_pos, old, it->string);
4150 else
4152 /* The rest of the string is invisible. If this is an
4153 overlay string, proceed with the next overlay string
4154 or whatever comes and return a character from there. */
4155 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0
4156 && !display_ellipsis_p)
4158 next_overlay_string (it);
4159 /* Don't check for overlay strings when we just
4160 finished processing them. */
4161 handled = HANDLED_OVERLAY_STRING_CONSUMED;
4163 else
4165 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = SCHARS (it->string);
4166 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = SBYTES (it->string);
4171 else
4173 ptrdiff_t newpos, next_stop, start_charpos, tem;
4174 Lisp_Object pos, overlay;
4176 /* First of all, is there invisible text at this position? */
4177 tem = start_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
4178 pos = make_number (tem);
4179 prop = get_char_property_and_overlay (pos, Qinvisible, it->window,
4180 &overlay);
4181 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4183 /* If we are on invisible text, skip over it. */
4184 if (invis_p && start_charpos < it->end_charpos)
4186 /* Record whether we have to display an ellipsis for the
4187 invisible text. */
4188 int display_ellipsis_p = invis_p == 2;
4190 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
4192 /* Loop skipping over invisible text. The loop is left at
4193 ZV or with IT on the first char being visible again. */
4196 /* Try to skip some invisible text. Return value is the
4197 position reached which can be equal to where we start
4198 if there is nothing invisible there. This skips both
4199 over invisible text properties and overlays with
4200 invisible property. */
4201 newpos = skip_invisible (tem, &next_stop, ZV, it->window);
4203 /* If we skipped nothing at all we weren't at invisible
4204 text in the first place. If everything to the end of
4205 the buffer was skipped, end the loop. */
4206 if (newpos == tem || newpos >= ZV)
4207 invis_p = 0;
4208 else
4210 /* We skipped some characters but not necessarily
4211 all there are. Check if we ended up on visible
4212 text. Fget_char_property returns the property of
4213 the char before the given position, i.e. if we
4214 get invis_p = 0, this means that the char at
4215 newpos is visible. */
4216 pos = make_number (newpos);
4217 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qinvisible, it->window);
4218 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
4221 /* If we ended up on invisible text, proceed to
4222 skip starting with next_stop. */
4223 if (invis_p)
4224 tem = next_stop;
4226 /* If there are adjacent invisible texts, don't lose the
4227 second one's ellipsis. */
4228 if (invis_p == 2)
4229 display_ellipsis_p = 1;
4231 while (invis_p);
4233 /* The position newpos is now either ZV or on visible text. */
4234 if (it->bidi_p)
4236 ptrdiff_t bpos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (newpos);
4237 int on_newline =
4238 bpos == ZV_BYTE || FETCH_BYTE (bpos) == '\n';
4239 int after_newline =
4240 newpos <= BEGV || FETCH_BYTE (bpos - 1) == '\n';
4242 /* If the invisible text ends on a newline or on a
4243 character after a newline, we can avoid the costly,
4244 character by character, bidi iteration to NEWPOS, and
4245 instead simply reseat the iterator there. That's
4246 because all bidi reordering information is tossed at
4247 the newline. This is a big win for modes that hide
4248 complete lines, like Outline, Org, etc. */
4249 if (on_newline || after_newline)
4251 struct text_pos tpos;
4252 bidi_dir_t pdir = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
4254 SET_TEXT_POS (tpos, newpos, bpos);
4255 reseat_1 (it, tpos, 0);
4256 /* If we reseat on a newline/ZV, we need to prep the
4257 bidi iterator for advancing to the next character
4258 after the newline/EOB, keeping the current paragraph
4259 direction (so that PRODUCE_GLYPHS does TRT wrt
4260 prepending/appending glyphs to a glyph row). */
4261 if (on_newline)
4263 it->bidi_it.first_elt = 0;
4264 it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir = pdir;
4265 it->bidi_it.ch = (bpos == ZV_BYTE) ? -1 : '\n';
4266 it->bidi_it.nchars = 1;
4267 it->bidi_it.ch_len = 1;
4270 else /* Must use the slow method. */
4272 /* With bidi iteration, the region of invisible text
4273 could start and/or end in the middle of a
4274 non-base embedding level. Therefore, we need to
4275 skip invisible text using the bidi iterator,
4276 starting at IT's current position, until we find
4277 ourselves outside of the invisible text.
4278 Skipping invisible text _after_ bidi iteration
4279 avoids affecting the visual order of the
4280 displayed text when invisible properties are
4281 added or removed. */
4282 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt && it->bidi_it.charpos < ZV)
4284 /* If we were `reseat'ed to a new paragraph,
4285 determine the paragraph base direction. We
4286 need to do it now because
4287 next_element_from_buffer may not have a
4288 chance to do it, if we are going to skip any
4289 text at the beginning, which resets the
4290 FIRST_ELT flag. */
4291 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding,
4292 &it->bidi_it, 1);
4296 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
4298 while (it->stop_charpos <= it->bidi_it.charpos
4299 && it->bidi_it.charpos < newpos);
4300 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
4301 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
4302 /* If we overstepped NEWPOS, record its position in
4303 the iterator, so that we skip invisible text if
4304 later the bidi iteration lands us in the
4305 invisible region again. */
4306 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= newpos)
4307 it->prev_stop = newpos;
4310 else
4312 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = newpos;
4313 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (newpos);
4316 /* If there are before-strings at the start of invisible
4317 text, and the text is invisible because of a text
4318 property, arrange to show before-strings because 20.x did
4319 it that way. (If the text is invisible because of an
4320 overlay property instead of a text property, this is
4321 already handled in the overlay code.) */
4322 if (NILP (overlay)
4323 && get_overlay_strings (it, it->stop_charpos))
4325 handled = HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
4326 it->stack[it->sp - 1].display_ellipsis_p = display_ellipsis_p;
4328 else if (display_ellipsis_p)
4330 /* Make sure that the glyphs of the ellipsis will get
4331 correct `charpos' values. If we would not update
4332 it->position here, the glyphs would belong to the
4333 last visible character _before_ the invisible
4334 text, which confuses `set_cursor_from_row'.
4336 We use the last invisible position instead of the
4337 first because this way the cursor is always drawn on
4338 the first "." of the ellipsis, whenever PT is inside
4339 the invisible text. Otherwise the cursor would be
4340 placed _after_ the ellipsis when the point is after the
4341 first invisible character. */
4342 if (!STRINGP (it->object))
4344 it->position.charpos = newpos - 1;
4345 it->position.bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (it->position.charpos);
4347 it->ellipsis_p = 1;
4348 /* Let the ellipsis display before
4349 considering any properties of the following char.
4350 Fixes jasonr@gnu.org 01 Oct 07 bug. */
4351 handled = HANDLED_RETURN;
4356 return handled;
4360 /* Make iterator IT return `...' next.
4361 Replaces LEN characters from buffer. */
4363 static void
4364 setup_for_ellipsis (struct it *it, int len)
4366 /* Use the display table definition for `...'. Invalid glyphs
4367 will be handled by the method returning elements from dpvec. */
4368 if (it->dp && VECTORP (DISP_INVIS_VECTOR (it->dp)))
4370 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (DISP_INVIS_VECTOR (it->dp));
4371 it->dpvec = v->contents;
4372 it->dpend = v->contents + v->header.size;
4374 else
4376 /* Default `...'. */
4377 it->dpvec = default_invis_vector;
4378 it->dpend = default_invis_vector + 3;
4381 it->dpvec_char_len = len;
4382 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
4383 it->dpvec_face_id = -1;
4385 /* Remember the current face id in case glyphs specify faces.
4386 IT's face is restored in set_iterator_to_next.
4387 saved_face_id was set to preceding char's face in handle_stop. */
4388 if (it->saved_face_id < 0 || it->saved_face_id != it->face_id)
4389 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
4391 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
4392 it->ellipsis_p = 1;
4397 /***********************************************************************
4398 'display' property
4399 ***********************************************************************/
4401 /* Set up iterator IT from `display' property at its current position.
4402 Called from handle_stop.
4403 We return HANDLED_RETURN if some part of the display property
4404 overrides the display of the buffer text itself.
4405 Otherwise we return HANDLED_NORMALLY. */
4407 static enum prop_handled
4408 handle_display_prop (struct it *it)
4410 Lisp_Object propval, object, overlay;
4411 struct text_pos *position;
4412 ptrdiff_t bufpos;
4413 /* Nonzero if some property replaces the display of the text itself. */
4414 int display_replaced_p = 0;
4416 if (STRINGP (it->string))
4418 object = it->string;
4419 position = &it->current.string_pos;
4420 bufpos = CHARPOS (it->current.pos);
4422 else
4424 XSETWINDOW (object, it->w);
4425 position = &it->current.pos;
4426 bufpos = CHARPOS (*position);
4429 /* Reset those iterator values set from display property values. */
4430 it->slice.x = it->slice.y = it->slice.width = it->slice.height = Qnil;
4431 it->space_width = Qnil;
4432 it->font_height = Qnil;
4433 it->voffset = 0;
4435 /* We don't support recursive `display' properties, i.e. string
4436 values that have a string `display' property, that have a string
4437 `display' property etc. */
4438 if (!it->string_from_display_prop_p)
4439 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
4441 propval = get_char_property_and_overlay (make_number (position->charpos),
4442 Qdisplay, object, &overlay);
4443 if (NILP (propval))
4444 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
4445 /* Now OVERLAY is the overlay that gave us this property, or nil
4446 if it was a text property. */
4448 if (!STRINGP (it->string))
4449 object = it->w->buffer;
4451 display_replaced_p = handle_display_spec (it, propval, object, overlay,
4452 position, bufpos,
4453 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f));
4455 return display_replaced_p ? HANDLED_RETURN : HANDLED_NORMALLY;
4458 /* Subroutine of handle_display_prop. Returns non-zero if the display
4459 specification in SPEC is a replacing specification, i.e. it would
4460 replace the text covered by `display' property with something else,
4461 such as an image or a display string. If SPEC includes any kind or
4462 `(space ...) specification, the value is 2; this is used by
4463 compute_display_string_pos, which see.
4465 See handle_single_display_spec for documentation of arguments.
4466 frame_window_p is non-zero if the window being redisplayed is on a
4467 GUI frame; this argument is used only if IT is NULL, see below.
4469 IT can be NULL, if this is called by the bidi reordering code
4470 through compute_display_string_pos, which see. In that case, this
4471 function only examines SPEC, but does not otherwise "handle" it, in
4472 the sense that it doesn't set up members of IT from the display
4473 spec. */
4474 static int
4475 handle_display_spec (struct it *it, Lisp_Object spec, Lisp_Object object,
4476 Lisp_Object overlay, struct text_pos *position,
4477 ptrdiff_t bufpos, int frame_window_p)
4479 int replacing_p = 0;
4480 int rv;
4482 if (CONSP (spec)
4483 /* Simple specifications. */
4484 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qimage)
4485 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace)
4486 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qwhen)
4487 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qslice)
4488 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace_width)
4489 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qheight)
4490 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qraise)
4491 /* Marginal area specifications. */
4492 && !(CONSP (XCAR (spec)) && EQ (XCAR (XCAR (spec)), Qmargin))
4493 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe)
4494 && !EQ (XCAR (spec), Qright_fringe)
4495 && !NILP (XCAR (spec)))
4497 for (; CONSP (spec); spec = XCDR (spec))
4499 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, XCAR (spec), object,
4500 overlay, position, bufpos,
4501 replacing_p, frame_window_p)))
4503 replacing_p = rv;
4504 /* If some text in a string is replaced, `position' no
4505 longer points to the position of `object'. */
4506 if (!it || STRINGP (object))
4507 break;
4511 else if (VECTORP (spec))
4513 ptrdiff_t i;
4514 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (spec); ++i)
4515 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, AREF (spec, i), object,
4516 overlay, position, bufpos,
4517 replacing_p, frame_window_p)))
4519 replacing_p = rv;
4520 /* If some text in a string is replaced, `position' no
4521 longer points to the position of `object'. */
4522 if (!it || STRINGP (object))
4523 break;
4526 else
4528 if ((rv = handle_single_display_spec (it, spec, object, overlay,
4529 position, bufpos, 0,
4530 frame_window_p)))
4531 replacing_p = rv;
4534 return replacing_p;
4537 /* Value is the position of the end of the `display' property starting
4538 at START_POS in OBJECT. */
4540 static struct text_pos
4541 display_prop_end (struct it *it, Lisp_Object object, struct text_pos start_pos)
4543 Lisp_Object end;
4544 struct text_pos end_pos;
4546 end = Fnext_single_char_property_change (make_number (CHARPOS (start_pos)),
4547 Qdisplay, object, Qnil);
4548 CHARPOS (end_pos) = XFASTINT (end);
4549 if (STRINGP (object))
4550 compute_string_pos (&end_pos, start_pos, it->string);
4551 else
4552 BYTEPOS (end_pos) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (XFASTINT (end));
4554 return end_pos;
4558 /* Set up IT from a single `display' property specification SPEC. OBJECT
4559 is the object in which the `display' property was found. *POSITION
4560 is the position in OBJECT at which the `display' property was found.
4561 BUFPOS is the buffer position of OBJECT (different from POSITION if
4562 OBJECT is not a buffer). DISPLAY_REPLACED_P non-zero means that we
4563 previously saw a display specification which already replaced text
4564 display with something else, for example an image; we ignore such
4565 properties after the first one has been processed.
4567 OVERLAY is the overlay this `display' property came from,
4568 or nil if it was a text property.
4570 If SPEC is a `space' or `image' specification, and in some other
4571 cases too, set *POSITION to the position where the `display'
4572 property ends.
4574 If IT is NULL, only examine the property specification in SPEC, but
4575 don't set up IT. In that case, FRAME_WINDOW_P non-zero means SPEC
4576 is intended to be displayed in a window on a GUI frame.
4578 Value is non-zero if something was found which replaces the display
4579 of buffer or string text. */
4581 static int
4582 handle_single_display_spec (struct it *it, Lisp_Object spec, Lisp_Object object,
4583 Lisp_Object overlay, struct text_pos *position,
4584 ptrdiff_t bufpos, int display_replaced_p,
4585 int frame_window_p)
4587 Lisp_Object form;
4588 Lisp_Object location, value;
4589 struct text_pos start_pos = *position;
4590 int valid_p;
4592 /* If SPEC is a list of the form `(when FORM . VALUE)', evaluate FORM.
4593 If the result is non-nil, use VALUE instead of SPEC. */
4594 form = Qt;
4595 if (CONSP (spec) && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qwhen))
4597 spec = XCDR (spec);
4598 if (!CONSP (spec))
4599 return 0;
4600 form = XCAR (spec);
4601 spec = XCDR (spec);
4604 if (!NILP (form) && !EQ (form, Qt))
4606 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
4607 struct gcpro gcpro1;
4609 /* Bind `object' to the object having the `display' property, a
4610 buffer or string. Bind `position' to the position in the
4611 object where the property was found, and `buffer-position'
4612 to the current position in the buffer. */
4614 if (NILP (object))
4615 XSETBUFFER (object, current_buffer);
4616 specbind (Qobject, object);
4617 specbind (Qposition, make_number (CHARPOS (*position)));
4618 specbind (Qbuffer_position, make_number (bufpos));
4619 GCPRO1 (form);
4620 form = safe_eval (form);
4621 UNGCPRO;
4622 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
4625 if (NILP (form))
4626 return 0;
4628 /* Handle `(height HEIGHT)' specifications. */
4629 if (CONSP (spec)
4630 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qheight)
4631 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4633 if (it)
4635 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4636 return 0;
4638 it->font_height = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4639 if (!NILP (it->font_height))
4641 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
4642 int new_height = -1;
4644 if (CONSP (it->font_height)
4645 && (EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qplus)
4646 || EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qminus))
4647 && CONSP (XCDR (it->font_height))
4648 && RANGED_INTEGERP (0, XCAR (XCDR (it->font_height)), INT_MAX))
4650 /* `(+ N)' or `(- N)' where N is an integer. */
4651 int steps = XINT (XCAR (XCDR (it->font_height)));
4652 if (EQ (XCAR (it->font_height), Qplus))
4653 steps = - steps;
4654 it->face_id = smaller_face (it->f, it->face_id, steps);
4656 else if (FUNCTIONP (it->font_height))
4658 /* Call function with current height as argument.
4659 Value is the new height. */
4660 Lisp_Object height;
4661 height = safe_call1 (it->font_height,
4662 face->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]);
4663 if (NUMBERP (height))
4664 new_height = XFLOATINT (height);
4666 else if (NUMBERP (it->font_height))
4668 /* Value is a multiple of the canonical char height. */
4669 struct face *f;
4671 f = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f,
4672 lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID));
4673 new_height = (XFLOATINT (it->font_height)
4674 * XINT (f->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]));
4676 else
4678 /* Evaluate IT->font_height with `height' bound to the
4679 current specified height to get the new height. */
4680 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
4682 specbind (Qheight, face->lface[LFACE_HEIGHT_INDEX]);
4683 value = safe_eval (it->font_height);
4684 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
4686 if (NUMBERP (value))
4687 new_height = XFLOATINT (value);
4690 if (new_height > 0)
4691 it->face_id = face_with_height (it->f, it->face_id, new_height);
4695 return 0;
4698 /* Handle `(space-width WIDTH)'. */
4699 if (CONSP (spec)
4700 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qspace_width)
4701 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4703 if (it)
4705 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4706 return 0;
4708 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4709 if (NUMBERP (value) && XFLOATINT (value) > 0)
4710 it->space_width = value;
4713 return 0;
4716 /* Handle `(slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT)'. */
4717 if (CONSP (spec)
4718 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qslice))
4720 Lisp_Object tem;
4722 if (it)
4724 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4725 return 0;
4727 if (tem = XCDR (spec), CONSP (tem))
4729 it->slice.x = XCAR (tem);
4730 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4732 it->slice.y = XCAR (tem);
4733 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4735 it->slice.width = XCAR (tem);
4736 if (tem = XCDR (tem), CONSP (tem))
4737 it->slice.height = XCAR (tem);
4743 return 0;
4746 /* Handle `(raise FACTOR)'. */
4747 if (CONSP (spec)
4748 && EQ (XCAR (spec), Qraise)
4749 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4751 if (it)
4753 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4754 return 0;
4756 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4757 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4758 if (NUMBERP (value))
4760 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
4761 it->voffset = - (XFLOATINT (value)
4762 * (FONT_HEIGHT (face->font)));
4764 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4767 return 0;
4770 /* Don't handle the other kinds of display specifications
4771 inside a string that we got from a `display' property. */
4772 if (it && it->string_from_display_prop_p)
4773 return 0;
4775 /* Characters having this form of property are not displayed, so
4776 we have to find the end of the property. */
4777 if (it)
4779 start_pos = *position;
4780 *position = display_prop_end (it, object, start_pos);
4782 value = Qnil;
4784 /* Stop the scan at that end position--we assume that all
4785 text properties change there. */
4786 if (it)
4787 it->stop_charpos = position->charpos;
4789 /* Handle `(left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])'
4790 and `(right-fringe BITMAP [FACE])'. */
4791 if (CONSP (spec)
4792 && (EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe)
4793 || EQ (XCAR (spec), Qright_fringe))
4794 && CONSP (XCDR (spec)))
4796 int fringe_bitmap;
4798 if (it)
4800 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
4801 /* If we return here, POSITION has been advanced
4802 across the text with this property. */
4804 /* Synchronize the bidi iterator with POSITION. This is
4805 needed because we are not going to push the iterator
4806 on behalf of this display property, so there will be
4807 no pop_it call to do this synchronization for us. */
4808 if (it->bidi_p)
4810 it->position = *position;
4811 iterate_out_of_display_property (it);
4812 *position = it->position;
4814 return 1;
4817 else if (!frame_window_p)
4818 return 1;
4820 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4821 value = XCAR (XCDR (spec));
4822 if (!SYMBOLP (value)
4823 || !(fringe_bitmap = lookup_fringe_bitmap (value)))
4824 /* If we return here, POSITION has been advanced
4825 across the text with this property. */
4827 if (it && it->bidi_p)
4829 it->position = *position;
4830 iterate_out_of_display_property (it);
4831 *position = it->position;
4833 return 1;
4836 if (it)
4838 int face_id = lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);;
4840 if (CONSP (XCDR (XCDR (spec))))
4842 Lisp_Object face_name = XCAR (XCDR (XCDR (spec)));
4843 int face_id2 = lookup_derived_face (it->f, face_name,
4844 FRINGE_FACE_ID, 0);
4845 if (face_id2 >= 0)
4846 face_id = face_id2;
4849 /* Save current settings of IT so that we can restore them
4850 when we are finished with the glyph property value. */
4851 push_it (it, position);
4853 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
4854 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
4855 it->image_id = -1; /* no image */
4856 it->position = start_pos;
4857 it->object = NILP (object) ? it->w->buffer : object;
4858 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
4859 it->from_overlay = Qnil;
4860 it->face_id = face_id;
4861 it->from_disp_prop_p = 1;
4863 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
4864 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
4865 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
4866 *position = start_pos;
4868 if (EQ (XCAR (spec), Qleft_fringe))
4870 it->left_user_fringe_bitmap = fringe_bitmap;
4871 it->left_user_fringe_face_id = face_id;
4873 else
4875 it->right_user_fringe_bitmap = fringe_bitmap;
4876 it->right_user_fringe_face_id = face_id;
4879 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4880 return 1;
4883 /* Prepare to handle `((margin left-margin) ...)',
4884 `((margin right-margin) ...)' and `((margin nil) ...)'
4885 prefixes for display specifications. */
4886 location = Qunbound;
4887 if (CONSP (spec) && CONSP (XCAR (spec)))
4889 Lisp_Object tem;
4891 value = XCDR (spec);
4892 if (CONSP (value))
4893 value = XCAR (value);
4895 tem = XCAR (spec);
4896 if (EQ (XCAR (tem), Qmargin)
4897 && (tem = XCDR (tem),
4898 tem = CONSP (tem) ? XCAR (tem) : Qnil,
4899 (NILP (tem)
4900 || EQ (tem, Qleft_margin)
4901 || EQ (tem, Qright_margin))))
4902 location = tem;
4905 if (EQ (location, Qunbound))
4907 location = Qnil;
4908 value = spec;
4911 /* After this point, VALUE is the property after any
4912 margin prefix has been stripped. It must be a string,
4913 an image specification, or `(space ...)'.
4915 LOCATION specifies where to display: `left-margin',
4916 `right-margin' or nil. */
4918 valid_p = (STRINGP (value)
4919 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4920 || ((it ? FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f) : frame_window_p)
4921 && valid_image_p (value))
4922 #endif /* not HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
4923 || (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace)));
4925 if (valid_p && !display_replaced_p)
4927 int retval = 1;
4929 if (!it)
4931 /* Callers need to know whether the display spec is any kind
4932 of `(space ...)' spec that is about to affect text-area
4933 display. */
4934 if (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace) && NILP (location))
4935 retval = 2;
4936 return retval;
4939 /* Save current settings of IT so that we can restore them
4940 when we are finished with the glyph property value. */
4941 push_it (it, position);
4942 it->from_overlay = overlay;
4943 it->from_disp_prop_p = 1;
4945 if (NILP (location))
4946 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
4947 else if (EQ (location, Qleft_margin))
4948 it->area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
4949 else
4950 it->area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
4952 if (STRINGP (value))
4954 it->string = value;
4955 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
4956 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
4957 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
4958 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (it->string);
4959 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
4960 it->stop_charpos = 0;
4961 it->prev_stop = 0;
4962 it->base_level_stop = 0;
4963 it->string_from_display_prop_p = 1;
4964 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
4965 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
4966 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
4967 if (BUFFERP (object))
4968 *position = start_pos;
4970 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
4971 object. If the parent object's paragraph direction is
4972 not yet determined, default to L2R. */
4973 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
4974 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
4975 else
4976 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
4978 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this display string. */
4979 if (it->bidi_p)
4981 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
4982 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
4983 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
4984 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = bufpos;
4985 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 1;
4986 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
4987 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
4990 else if (CONSP (value) && EQ (XCAR (value), Qspace))
4992 it->method = GET_FROM_STRETCH;
4993 it->object = value;
4994 *position = it->position = start_pos;
4995 retval = 1 + (it->area == TEXT_AREA);
4997 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
4998 else
5000 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
5001 it->image_id = lookup_image (it->f, value);
5002 it->position = start_pos;
5003 it->object = NILP (object) ? it->w->buffer : object;
5004 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
5006 /* Say that we haven't consumed the characters with
5007 `display' property yet. The call to pop_it in
5008 set_iterator_to_next will clean this up. */
5009 *position = start_pos;
5011 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
5013 return retval;
5016 /* Invalid property or property not supported. Restore
5017 POSITION to what it was before. */
5018 *position = start_pos;
5019 return 0;
5022 /* Check if PROP is a display property value whose text should be
5023 treated as intangible. OVERLAY is the overlay from which PROP
5024 came, or nil if it came from a text property. CHARPOS and BYTEPOS
5025 specify the buffer position covered by PROP. */
5028 display_prop_intangible_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object overlay,
5029 ptrdiff_t charpos, ptrdiff_t bytepos)
5031 int frame_window_p = FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (selected_frame));
5032 struct text_pos position;
5034 SET_TEXT_POS (position, charpos, bytepos);
5035 return handle_display_spec (NULL, prop, Qnil, overlay,
5036 &position, charpos, frame_window_p);
5040 /* Return 1 if PROP is a display sub-property value containing STRING.
5042 Implementation note: this and the following function are really
5043 special cases of handle_display_spec and
5044 handle_single_display_spec, and should ideally use the same code.
5045 Until they do, these two pairs must be consistent and must be
5046 modified in sync. */
5048 static int
5049 single_display_spec_string_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object string)
5051 if (EQ (string, prop))
5052 return 1;
5054 /* Skip over `when FORM'. */
5055 if (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), Qwhen))
5057 prop = XCDR (prop);
5058 if (!CONSP (prop))
5059 return 0;
5060 /* Actually, the condition following `when' should be eval'ed,
5061 like handle_single_display_spec does, and we should return
5062 zero if it evaluates to nil. However, this function is
5063 called only when the buffer was already displayed and some
5064 glyph in the glyph matrix was found to come from a display
5065 string. Therefore, the condition was already evaluated, and
5066 the result was non-nil, otherwise the display string wouldn't
5067 have been displayed and we would have never been called for
5068 this property. Thus, we can skip the evaluation and assume
5069 its result is non-nil. */
5070 prop = XCDR (prop);
5073 if (CONSP (prop))
5074 /* Skip over `margin LOCATION'. */
5075 if (EQ (XCAR (prop), Qmargin))
5077 prop = XCDR (prop);
5078 if (!CONSP (prop))
5079 return 0;
5081 prop = XCDR (prop);
5082 if (!CONSP (prop))
5083 return 0;
5086 return EQ (prop, string) || (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), string));
5090 /* Return 1 if STRING appears in the `display' property PROP. */
5092 static int
5093 display_prop_string_p (Lisp_Object prop, Lisp_Object string)
5095 if (CONSP (prop)
5096 && !EQ (XCAR (prop), Qwhen)
5097 && !(CONSP (XCAR (prop)) && EQ (Qmargin, XCAR (XCAR (prop)))))
5099 /* A list of sub-properties. */
5100 while (CONSP (prop))
5102 if (single_display_spec_string_p (XCAR (prop), string))
5103 return 1;
5104 prop = XCDR (prop);
5107 else if (VECTORP (prop))
5109 /* A vector of sub-properties. */
5110 ptrdiff_t i;
5111 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (prop); ++i)
5112 if (single_display_spec_string_p (AREF (prop, i), string))
5113 return 1;
5115 else
5116 return single_display_spec_string_p (prop, string);
5118 return 0;
5121 /* Look for STRING in overlays and text properties in the current
5122 buffer, between character positions FROM and TO (excluding TO).
5123 BACK_P non-zero means look back (in this case, TO is supposed to be
5124 less than FROM).
5125 Value is the first character position where STRING was found, or
5126 zero if it wasn't found before hitting TO.
5128 This function may only use code that doesn't eval because it is
5129 called asynchronously from note_mouse_highlight. */
5131 static ptrdiff_t
5132 string_buffer_position_lim (Lisp_Object string,
5133 ptrdiff_t from, ptrdiff_t to, int back_p)
5135 Lisp_Object limit, prop, pos;
5136 int found = 0;
5138 pos = make_number (max (from, BEGV));
5140 if (!back_p) /* looking forward */
5142 limit = make_number (min (to, ZV));
5143 while (!found && !EQ (pos, limit))
5145 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
5146 if (!NILP (prop) && display_prop_string_p (prop, string))
5147 found = 1;
5148 else
5149 pos = Fnext_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil,
5150 limit);
5153 else /* looking back */
5155 limit = make_number (max (to, BEGV));
5156 while (!found && !EQ (pos, limit))
5158 prop = Fget_char_property (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil);
5159 if (!NILP (prop) && display_prop_string_p (prop, string))
5160 found = 1;
5161 else
5162 pos = Fprevious_single_char_property_change (pos, Qdisplay, Qnil,
5163 limit);
5167 return found ? XINT (pos) : 0;
5170 /* Determine which buffer position in current buffer STRING comes from.
5171 AROUND_CHARPOS is an approximate position where it could come from.
5172 Value is the buffer position or 0 if it couldn't be determined.
5174 This function is necessary because we don't record buffer positions
5175 in glyphs generated from strings (to keep struct glyph small).
5176 This function may only use code that doesn't eval because it is
5177 called asynchronously from note_mouse_highlight. */
5179 static ptrdiff_t
5180 string_buffer_position (Lisp_Object string, ptrdiff_t around_charpos)
5182 const int MAX_DISTANCE = 1000;
5183 ptrdiff_t found = string_buffer_position_lim (string, around_charpos,
5184 around_charpos + MAX_DISTANCE,
5187 if (!found)
5188 found = string_buffer_position_lim (string, around_charpos,
5189 around_charpos - MAX_DISTANCE, 1);
5190 return found;
5195 /***********************************************************************
5196 `composition' property
5197 ***********************************************************************/
5199 /* Set up iterator IT from `composition' property at its current
5200 position. Called from handle_stop. */
5202 static enum prop_handled
5203 handle_composition_prop (struct it *it)
5205 Lisp_Object prop, string;
5206 ptrdiff_t pos, pos_byte, start, end;
5208 if (STRINGP (it->string))
5210 unsigned char *s;
5212 pos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
5213 pos_byte = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
5214 string = it->string;
5215 s = SDATA (string) + pos_byte;
5216 it->c = STRING_CHAR (s);
5218 else
5220 pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
5221 pos_byte = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
5222 string = Qnil;
5223 it->c = FETCH_CHAR (pos_byte);
5226 /* If there's a valid composition and point is not inside of the
5227 composition (in the case that the composition is from the current
5228 buffer), draw a glyph composed from the composition components. */
5229 if (find_composition (pos, -1, &start, &end, &prop, string)
5230 && COMPOSITION_VALID_P (start, end, prop)
5231 && (STRINGP (it->string) || (PT <= start || PT >= end)))
5233 if (start < pos)
5234 /* As we can't handle this situation (perhaps font-lock added
5235 a new composition), we just return here hoping that next
5236 redisplay will detect this composition much earlier. */
5237 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5238 if (start != pos)
5240 if (STRINGP (it->string))
5241 pos_byte = string_char_to_byte (it->string, start);
5242 else
5243 pos_byte = CHAR_TO_BYTE (start);
5245 it->cmp_it.id = get_composition_id (start, pos_byte, end - start,
5246 prop, string);
5248 if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
5250 it->cmp_it.ch = -1;
5251 it->cmp_it.nchars = COMPOSITION_LENGTH (prop);
5252 it->cmp_it.nglyphs = -1;
5256 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5261 /***********************************************************************
5262 Overlay strings
5263 ***********************************************************************/
5265 /* The following structure is used to record overlay strings for
5266 later sorting in load_overlay_strings. */
5268 struct overlay_entry
5270 Lisp_Object overlay;
5271 Lisp_Object string;
5272 EMACS_INT priority;
5273 int after_string_p;
5277 /* Set up iterator IT from overlay strings at its current position.
5278 Called from handle_stop. */
5280 static enum prop_handled
5281 handle_overlay_change (struct it *it)
5283 if (!STRINGP (it->string) && get_overlay_strings (it, 0))
5284 return HANDLED_RECOMPUTE_PROPS;
5285 else
5286 return HANDLED_NORMALLY;
5290 /* Set up the next overlay string for delivery by IT, if there is an
5291 overlay string to deliver. Called by set_iterator_to_next when the
5292 end of the current overlay string is reached. If there are more
5293 overlay strings to display, IT->string and
5294 IT->current.overlay_string_index are set appropriately here.
5295 Otherwise IT->string is set to nil. */
5297 static void
5298 next_overlay_string (struct it *it)
5300 ++it->current.overlay_string_index;
5301 if (it->current.overlay_string_index == it->n_overlay_strings)
5303 /* No more overlay strings. Restore IT's settings to what
5304 they were before overlay strings were processed, and
5305 continue to deliver from current_buffer. */
5307 it->ellipsis_p = (it->stack[it->sp - 1].display_ellipsis_p != 0);
5308 pop_it (it);
5309 eassert (it->sp > 0
5310 || (NILP (it->string)
5311 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
5312 && it->stop_charpos >= BEGV
5313 && it->stop_charpos <= it->end_charpos));
5314 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
5315 it->n_overlay_strings = 0;
5316 it->overlay_strings_charpos = -1;
5317 /* If there's an empty display string on the stack, pop the
5318 stack, to resync the bidi iterator with IT's position. Such
5319 empty strings are pushed onto the stack in
5320 get_overlay_strings_1. */
5321 if (it->sp > 0 && STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string))
5322 pop_it (it);
5324 /* If we're at the end of the buffer, record that we have
5325 processed the overlay strings there already, so that
5326 next_element_from_buffer doesn't try it again. */
5327 if (NILP (it->string) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
5328 it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p = 1;
5330 else
5332 /* There are more overlay strings to process. If
5333 IT->current.overlay_string_index has advanced to a position
5334 where we must load IT->overlay_strings with more strings, do
5335 it. We must load at the IT->overlay_strings_charpos where
5336 IT->n_overlay_strings was originally computed; when invisible
5337 text is present, this might not be IT_CHARPOS (Bug#7016). */
5338 int i = it->current.overlay_string_index % OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE;
5340 if (it->current.overlay_string_index && i == 0)
5341 load_overlay_strings (it, it->overlay_strings_charpos);
5343 /* Initialize IT to deliver display elements from the overlay
5344 string. */
5345 it->string = it->overlay_strings[i];
5346 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
5347 SET_TEXT_POS (it->current.string_pos, 0, 0);
5348 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5349 it->stop_charpos = 0;
5350 if (it->cmp_it.stop_pos >= 0)
5351 it->cmp_it.stop_pos = 0;
5352 it->prev_stop = 0;
5353 it->base_level_stop = 0;
5355 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this overlay string. */
5356 if (it->bidi_p)
5358 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
5359 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
5360 it->bidi_it.string.schars = SCHARS (it->string);
5361 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = it->overlay_strings_charpos;
5362 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5363 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
5364 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
5368 CHECK_IT (it);
5372 /* Compare two overlay_entry structures E1 and E2. Used as a
5373 comparison function for qsort in load_overlay_strings. Overlay
5374 strings for the same position are sorted so that
5376 1. All after-strings come in front of before-strings, except
5377 when they come from the same overlay.
5379 2. Within after-strings, strings are sorted so that overlay strings
5380 from overlays with higher priorities come first.
5382 2. Within before-strings, strings are sorted so that overlay
5383 strings from overlays with higher priorities come last.
5385 Value is analogous to strcmp. */
5388 static int
5389 compare_overlay_entries (const void *e1, const void *e2)
5391 struct overlay_entry *entry1 = (struct overlay_entry *) e1;
5392 struct overlay_entry *entry2 = (struct overlay_entry *) e2;
5393 int result;
5395 if (entry1->after_string_p != entry2->after_string_p)
5397 /* Let after-strings appear in front of before-strings if
5398 they come from different overlays. */
5399 if (EQ (entry1->overlay, entry2->overlay))
5400 result = entry1->after_string_p ? 1 : -1;
5401 else
5402 result = entry1->after_string_p ? -1 : 1;
5404 else if (entry1->priority != entry2->priority)
5406 if (entry1->after_string_p)
5407 /* After-strings sorted in order of decreasing priority. */
5408 result = entry2->priority < entry1->priority ? -1 : 1;
5409 else
5410 /* Before-strings sorted in order of increasing priority. */
5411 result = entry1->priority < entry2->priority ? -1 : 1;
5413 else
5414 result = 0;
5416 return result;
5420 /* Load the vector IT->overlay_strings with overlay strings from IT's
5421 current buffer position, or from CHARPOS if that is > 0. Set
5422 IT->n_overlays to the total number of overlay strings found.
5424 Overlay strings are processed OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE strings at
5425 a time. On entry into load_overlay_strings,
5426 IT->current.overlay_string_index gives the number of overlay
5427 strings that have already been loaded by previous calls to this
5428 function.
5430 IT->add_overlay_start contains an additional overlay start
5431 position to consider for taking overlay strings from, if non-zero.
5432 This position comes into play when the overlay has an `invisible'
5433 property, and both before and after-strings. When we've skipped to
5434 the end of the overlay, because of its `invisible' property, we
5435 nevertheless want its before-string to appear.
5436 IT->add_overlay_start will contain the overlay start position
5437 in this case.
5439 Overlay strings are sorted so that after-string strings come in
5440 front of before-string strings. Within before and after-strings,
5441 strings are sorted by overlay priority. See also function
5442 compare_overlay_entries. */
5444 static void
5445 load_overlay_strings (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos)
5447 Lisp_Object overlay, window, str, invisible;
5448 struct Lisp_Overlay *ov;
5449 ptrdiff_t start, end;
5450 ptrdiff_t size = 20;
5451 ptrdiff_t n = 0, i, j;
5452 int invis_p;
5453 struct overlay_entry *entries = alloca (size * sizeof *entries);
5454 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5456 if (charpos <= 0)
5457 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
5459 /* Append the overlay string STRING of overlay OVERLAY to vector
5460 `entries' which has size `size' and currently contains `n'
5461 elements. AFTER_P non-zero means STRING is an after-string of
5462 OVERLAY. */
5463 #define RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING(OVERLAY, STRING, AFTER_P) \
5464 do \
5466 Lisp_Object priority; \
5468 if (n == size) \
5470 struct overlay_entry *old = entries; \
5471 SAFE_NALLOCA (entries, 2, size); \
5472 memcpy (entries, old, size * sizeof *entries); \
5473 size *= 2; \
5476 entries[n].string = (STRING); \
5477 entries[n].overlay = (OVERLAY); \
5478 priority = Foverlay_get ((OVERLAY), Qpriority); \
5479 entries[n].priority = INTEGERP (priority) ? XINT (priority) : 0; \
5480 entries[n].after_string_p = (AFTER_P); \
5481 ++n; \
5483 while (0)
5485 /* Process overlay before the overlay center. */
5486 for (ov = current_buffer->overlays_before; ov; ov = ov->next)
5488 XSETMISC (overlay, ov);
5489 eassert (OVERLAYP (overlay));
5490 start = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay));
5491 end = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_END (overlay));
5493 if (end < charpos)
5494 break;
5496 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't start or end at IT's current
5497 position. */
5498 if (end != charpos && start != charpos)
5499 continue;
5501 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't apply to IT->w. */
5502 window = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qwindow);
5503 if (WINDOWP (window) && XWINDOW (window) != it->w)
5504 continue;
5506 /* If the text ``under'' the overlay is invisible, both before-
5507 and after-strings from this overlay are visible; start and
5508 end position are indistinguishable. */
5509 invisible = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qinvisible);
5510 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (invisible);
5512 /* If overlay has a non-empty before-string, record it. */
5513 if ((start == charpos || (end == charpos && invis_p))
5514 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string), STRINGP (str))
5515 && SCHARS (str))
5516 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 0);
5518 /* If overlay has a non-empty after-string, record it. */
5519 if ((end == charpos || (start == charpos && invis_p))
5520 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string), STRINGP (str))
5521 && SCHARS (str))
5522 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 1);
5525 /* Process overlays after the overlay center. */
5526 for (ov = current_buffer->overlays_after; ov; ov = ov->next)
5528 XSETMISC (overlay, ov);
5529 eassert (OVERLAYP (overlay));
5530 start = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay));
5531 end = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_END (overlay));
5533 if (start > charpos)
5534 break;
5536 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't start or end at IT's current
5537 position. */
5538 if (end != charpos && start != charpos)
5539 continue;
5541 /* Skip this overlay if it doesn't apply to IT->w. */
5542 window = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qwindow);
5543 if (WINDOWP (window) && XWINDOW (window) != it->w)
5544 continue;
5546 /* If the text ``under'' the overlay is invisible, it has a zero
5547 dimension, and both before- and after-strings apply. */
5548 invisible = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qinvisible);
5549 invis_p = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (invisible);
5551 /* If overlay has a non-empty before-string, record it. */
5552 if ((start == charpos || (end == charpos && invis_p))
5553 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string), STRINGP (str))
5554 && SCHARS (str))
5555 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 0);
5557 /* If overlay has a non-empty after-string, record it. */
5558 if ((end == charpos || (start == charpos && invis_p))
5559 && (str = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string), STRINGP (str))
5560 && SCHARS (str))
5561 RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING (overlay, str, 1);
5564 #undef RECORD_OVERLAY_STRING
5566 /* Sort entries. */
5567 if (n > 1)
5568 qsort (entries, n, sizeof *entries, compare_overlay_entries);
5570 /* Record number of overlay strings, and where we computed it. */
5571 it->n_overlay_strings = n;
5572 it->overlay_strings_charpos = charpos;
5574 /* IT->current.overlay_string_index is the number of overlay strings
5575 that have already been consumed by IT. Copy some of the
5576 remaining overlay strings to IT->overlay_strings. */
5577 i = 0;
5578 j = it->current.overlay_string_index;
5579 while (i < OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE && j < n)
5581 it->overlay_strings[i] = entries[j].string;
5582 it->string_overlays[i++] = entries[j++].overlay;
5585 CHECK_IT (it);
5586 SAFE_FREE ();
5590 /* Get the first chunk of overlay strings at IT's current buffer
5591 position, or at CHARPOS if that is > 0. Value is non-zero if at
5592 least one overlay string was found. */
5594 static int
5595 get_overlay_strings_1 (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos, int compute_stop_p)
5597 /* Get the first OVERLAY_STRING_CHUNK_SIZE overlay strings to
5598 process. This fills IT->overlay_strings with strings, and sets
5599 IT->n_overlay_strings to the total number of strings to process.
5600 IT->pos.overlay_string_index has to be set temporarily to zero
5601 because load_overlay_strings needs this; it must be set to -1
5602 when no overlay strings are found because a zero value would
5603 indicate a position in the first overlay string. */
5604 it->current.overlay_string_index = 0;
5605 load_overlay_strings (it, charpos);
5607 /* If we found overlay strings, set up IT to deliver display
5608 elements from the first one. Otherwise set up IT to deliver
5609 from current_buffer. */
5610 if (it->n_overlay_strings)
5612 /* Make sure we know settings in current_buffer, so that we can
5613 restore meaningful values when we're done with the overlay
5614 strings. */
5615 if (compute_stop_p)
5616 compute_stop_pos (it);
5617 eassert (it->face_id >= 0);
5619 /* Save IT's settings. They are restored after all overlay
5620 strings have been processed. */
5621 eassert (!compute_stop_p || it->sp == 0);
5623 /* When called from handle_stop, there might be an empty display
5624 string loaded. In that case, don't bother saving it. But
5625 don't use this optimization with the bidi iterator, since we
5626 need the corresponding pop_it call to resync the bidi
5627 iterator's position with IT's position, after we are done
5628 with the overlay strings. (The corresponding call to pop_it
5629 in case of an empty display string is in
5630 next_overlay_string.) */
5631 if (!(!it->bidi_p
5632 && STRINGP (it->string) && !SCHARS (it->string)))
5633 push_it (it, NULL);
5635 /* Set up IT to deliver display elements from the first overlay
5636 string. */
5637 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
5638 it->string = it->overlay_strings[0];
5639 it->from_overlay = Qnil;
5640 it->stop_charpos = 0;
5641 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
5642 it->end_charpos = SCHARS (it->string);
5643 it->prev_stop = 0;
5644 it->base_level_stop = 0;
5645 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
5646 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5647 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
5649 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
5650 buffer. */
5651 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
5652 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
5653 else
5654 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
5656 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this overlay string. */
5657 if (it->bidi_p)
5659 ptrdiff_t pos = (charpos > 0 ? charpos : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
5661 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
5662 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
5663 it->bidi_it.string.schars = SCHARS (it->string);
5664 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = pos;
5665 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5666 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
5667 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
5669 return 1;
5672 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
5673 return 0;
5676 static int
5677 get_overlay_strings (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos)
5679 it->string = Qnil;
5680 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
5682 (void) get_overlay_strings_1 (it, charpos, 1);
5684 CHECK_IT (it);
5686 /* Value is non-zero if we found at least one overlay string. */
5687 return STRINGP (it->string);
5692 /***********************************************************************
5693 Saving and restoring state
5694 ***********************************************************************/
5696 /* Save current settings of IT on IT->stack. Called, for example,
5697 before setting up IT for an overlay string, to be able to restore
5698 IT's settings to what they were after the overlay string has been
5699 processed. If POSITION is non-NULL, it is the position to save on
5700 the stack instead of IT->position. */
5702 static void
5703 push_it (struct it *it, struct text_pos *position)
5705 struct iterator_stack_entry *p;
5707 eassert (it->sp < IT_STACK_SIZE);
5708 p = it->stack + it->sp;
5710 p->stop_charpos = it->stop_charpos;
5711 p->prev_stop = it->prev_stop;
5712 p->base_level_stop = it->base_level_stop;
5713 p->cmp_it = it->cmp_it;
5714 eassert (it->face_id >= 0);
5715 p->face_id = it->face_id;
5716 p->string = it->string;
5717 p->method = it->method;
5718 p->from_overlay = it->from_overlay;
5719 switch (p->method)
5721 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
5722 p->u.image.object = it->object;
5723 p->u.image.image_id = it->image_id;
5724 p->u.image.slice = it->slice;
5725 break;
5726 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
5727 p->u.stretch.object = it->object;
5728 break;
5730 p->position = position ? *position : it->position;
5731 p->current = it->current;
5732 p->end_charpos = it->end_charpos;
5733 p->string_nchars = it->string_nchars;
5734 p->area = it->area;
5735 p->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
5736 p->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
5737 p->space_width = it->space_width;
5738 p->font_height = it->font_height;
5739 p->voffset = it->voffset;
5740 p->string_from_display_prop_p = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
5741 p->string_from_prefix_prop_p = it->string_from_prefix_prop_p;
5742 p->display_ellipsis_p = 0;
5743 p->line_wrap = it->line_wrap;
5744 p->bidi_p = it->bidi_p;
5745 p->paragraph_embedding = it->paragraph_embedding;
5746 p->from_disp_prop_p = it->from_disp_prop_p;
5747 ++it->sp;
5749 /* Save the state of the bidi iterator as well. */
5750 if (it->bidi_p)
5751 bidi_push_it (&it->bidi_it);
5754 static void
5755 iterate_out_of_display_property (struct it *it)
5757 int buffer_p = !STRINGP (it->string);
5758 ptrdiff_t eob = (buffer_p ? ZV : it->end_charpos);
5759 ptrdiff_t bob = (buffer_p ? BEGV : 0);
5761 eassert (eob >= CHARPOS (it->position) && CHARPOS (it->position) >= bob);
5763 /* Maybe initialize paragraph direction. If we are at the beginning
5764 of a new paragraph, next_element_from_buffer may not have a
5765 chance to do that. */
5766 if (it->bidi_it.first_elt && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob)
5767 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
5768 /* prev_stop can be zero, so check against BEGV as well. */
5769 while (it->bidi_it.charpos >= bob
5770 && it->prev_stop <= it->bidi_it.charpos
5771 && it->bidi_it.charpos < CHARPOS (it->position)
5772 && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob)
5773 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
5774 /* Record the stop_pos we just crossed, for when we cross it
5775 back, maybe. */
5776 if (it->bidi_it.charpos > CHARPOS (it->position))
5777 it->prev_stop = CHARPOS (it->position);
5778 /* If we ended up not where pop_it put us, resync IT's
5779 positional members with the bidi iterator. */
5780 if (it->bidi_it.charpos != CHARPOS (it->position))
5781 SET_TEXT_POS (it->position, it->bidi_it.charpos, it->bidi_it.bytepos);
5782 if (buffer_p)
5783 it->current.pos = it->position;
5784 else
5785 it->current.string_pos = it->position;
5788 /* Restore IT's settings from IT->stack. Called, for example, when no
5789 more overlay strings must be processed, and we return to delivering
5790 display elements from a buffer, or when the end of a string from a
5791 `display' property is reached and we return to delivering display
5792 elements from an overlay string, or from a buffer. */
5794 static void
5795 pop_it (struct it *it)
5797 struct iterator_stack_entry *p;
5798 int from_display_prop = it->from_disp_prop_p;
5800 eassert (it->sp > 0);
5801 --it->sp;
5802 p = it->stack + it->sp;
5803 it->stop_charpos = p->stop_charpos;
5804 it->prev_stop = p->prev_stop;
5805 it->base_level_stop = p->base_level_stop;
5806 it->cmp_it = p->cmp_it;
5807 it->face_id = p->face_id;
5808 it->current = p->current;
5809 it->position = p->position;
5810 it->string = p->string;
5811 it->from_overlay = p->from_overlay;
5812 if (NILP (it->string))
5813 SET_TEXT_POS (it->current.string_pos, -1, -1);
5814 it->method = p->method;
5815 switch (it->method)
5817 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
5818 it->image_id = p->u.image.image_id;
5819 it->object = p->u.image.object;
5820 it->slice = p->u.image.slice;
5821 break;
5822 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
5823 it->object = p->u.stretch.object;
5824 break;
5825 case GET_FROM_BUFFER:
5826 it->object = it->w->buffer;
5827 break;
5828 case GET_FROM_STRING:
5829 it->object = it->string;
5830 break;
5831 case GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR:
5832 if (it->s)
5833 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
5834 else if (STRINGP (it->string))
5835 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
5836 else
5838 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
5839 it->object = it->w->buffer;
5842 it->end_charpos = p->end_charpos;
5843 it->string_nchars = p->string_nchars;
5844 it->area = p->area;
5845 it->multibyte_p = p->multibyte_p;
5846 it->avoid_cursor_p = p->avoid_cursor_p;
5847 it->space_width = p->space_width;
5848 it->font_height = p->font_height;
5849 it->voffset = p->voffset;
5850 it->string_from_display_prop_p = p->string_from_display_prop_p;
5851 it->string_from_prefix_prop_p = p->string_from_prefix_prop_p;
5852 it->line_wrap = p->line_wrap;
5853 it->bidi_p = p->bidi_p;
5854 it->paragraph_embedding = p->paragraph_embedding;
5855 it->from_disp_prop_p = p->from_disp_prop_p;
5856 if (it->bidi_p)
5858 bidi_pop_it (&it->bidi_it);
5859 /* Bidi-iterate until we get out of the portion of text, if any,
5860 covered by a `display' text property or by an overlay with
5861 `display' property. (We cannot just jump there, because the
5862 internal coherency of the bidi iterator state can not be
5863 preserved across such jumps.) We also must determine the
5864 paragraph base direction if the overlay we just processed is
5865 at the beginning of a new paragraph. */
5866 if (from_display_prop
5867 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER || it->method == GET_FROM_STRING))
5868 iterate_out_of_display_property (it);
5870 eassert ((BUFFERP (it->object)
5871 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.charpos
5872 && IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.bytepos)
5873 || (STRINGP (it->object)
5874 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.charpos
5875 && IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) == it->bidi_it.bytepos)
5876 || (CONSP (it->object) && it->method == GET_FROM_STRETCH));
5882 /***********************************************************************
5883 Moving over lines
5884 ***********************************************************************/
5886 /* Set IT's current position to the previous line start. */
5888 static void
5889 back_to_previous_line_start (struct it *it)
5891 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = find_next_newline_no_quit (IT_CHARPOS (*it) - 1, -1);
5892 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (IT_CHARPOS (*it));
5896 /* Move IT to the next line start.
5898 Value is non-zero if a newline was found. Set *SKIPPED_P to 1 if
5899 we skipped over part of the text (as opposed to moving the iterator
5900 continuously over the text). Otherwise, don't change the value
5901 of *SKIPPED_P.
5903 If BIDI_IT_PREV is non-NULL, store into it the state of the bidi
5904 iterator on the newline, if it was found.
5906 Newlines may come from buffer text, overlay strings, or strings
5907 displayed via the `display' property. That's the reason we can't
5908 simply use find_next_newline_no_quit.
5910 Note that this function may not skip over invisible text that is so
5911 because of text properties and immediately follows a newline. If
5912 it would, function reseat_at_next_visible_line_start, when called
5913 from set_iterator_to_next, would effectively make invisible
5914 characters following a newline part of the wrong glyph row, which
5915 leads to wrong cursor motion. */
5917 static int
5918 forward_to_next_line_start (struct it *it, int *skipped_p,
5919 struct bidi_it *bidi_it_prev)
5921 ptrdiff_t old_selective;
5922 int newline_found_p, n;
5923 const int MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE = 500;
5925 /* If already on a newline, just consume it to avoid unintended
5926 skipping over invisible text below. */
5927 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER
5928 && it->c == '\n'
5929 && CHARPOS (it->position) == IT_CHARPOS (*it))
5931 if (it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
5932 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
5933 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
5934 it->c = 0;
5935 return 1;
5938 /* Don't handle selective display in the following. It's (a)
5939 unnecessary because it's done by the caller, and (b) leads to an
5940 infinite recursion because next_element_from_ellipsis indirectly
5941 calls this function. */
5942 old_selective = it->selective;
5943 it->selective = 0;
5945 /* Scan for a newline within MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE display elements
5946 from buffer text. */
5947 for (n = newline_found_p = 0;
5948 !newline_found_p && n < MAX_NEWLINE_DISTANCE;
5949 n += STRINGP (it->string) ? 0 : 1)
5951 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
5952 return 0;
5953 newline_found_p = it->what == IT_CHARACTER && it->c == '\n';
5954 if (newline_found_p && it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
5955 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
5956 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
5959 /* If we didn't find a newline near enough, see if we can use a
5960 short-cut. */
5961 if (!newline_found_p)
5963 ptrdiff_t start = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
5964 ptrdiff_t limit = find_next_newline_no_quit (start, 1);
5965 Lisp_Object pos;
5967 eassert (!STRINGP (it->string));
5969 /* If there isn't any `display' property in sight, and no
5970 overlays, we can just use the position of the newline in
5971 buffer text. */
5972 if (it->stop_charpos >= limit
5973 || ((pos = Fnext_single_property_change (make_number (start),
5974 Qdisplay, Qnil,
5975 make_number (limit)),
5976 NILP (pos))
5977 && next_overlay_change (start) == ZV))
5979 if (!it->bidi_p)
5981 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = limit;
5982 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (limit);
5984 else
5986 struct bidi_it bprev;
5988 /* Help bidi.c avoid expensive searches for display
5989 properties and overlays, by telling it that there are
5990 none up to `limit'. */
5991 if (it->bidi_it.disp_pos < limit)
5993 it->bidi_it.disp_pos = limit;
5994 it->bidi_it.disp_prop = 0;
5996 do {
5997 bprev = it->bidi_it;
5998 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
5999 } while (it->bidi_it.charpos != limit);
6000 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = limit;
6001 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6002 if (bidi_it_prev)
6003 *bidi_it_prev = bprev;
6005 *skipped_p = newline_found_p = 1;
6007 else
6009 while (get_next_display_element (it)
6010 && !newline_found_p)
6012 newline_found_p = ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it);
6013 if (newline_found_p && it->bidi_p && bidi_it_prev)
6014 *bidi_it_prev = it->bidi_it;
6015 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6020 it->selective = old_selective;
6021 return newline_found_p;
6025 /* Set IT's current position to the previous visible line start. Skip
6026 invisible text that is so either due to text properties or due to
6027 selective display. Caution: this does not change IT->current_x and
6028 IT->hpos. */
6030 static void
6031 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *it)
6033 while (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
6035 back_to_previous_line_start (it);
6037 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV)
6038 break;
6040 /* If selective > 0, then lines indented more than its value are
6041 invisible. */
6042 if (it->selective > 0
6043 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
6044 it->selective))
6045 continue;
6047 /* Check the newline before point for invisibility. */
6049 Lisp_Object prop;
6050 prop = Fget_char_property (make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it) - 1),
6051 Qinvisible, it->window);
6052 if (TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop))
6053 continue;
6056 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) <= BEGV)
6057 break;
6060 struct it it2;
6061 void *it2data = NULL;
6062 ptrdiff_t pos;
6063 ptrdiff_t beg, end;
6064 Lisp_Object val, overlay;
6066 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
6068 /* If newline is part of a composition, continue from start of composition */
6069 if (find_composition (IT_CHARPOS (*it), -1, &beg, &end, &val, Qnil)
6070 && beg < IT_CHARPOS (*it))
6071 goto replaced;
6073 /* If newline is replaced by a display property, find start of overlay
6074 or interval and continue search from that point. */
6075 pos = --IT_CHARPOS (it2);
6076 --IT_BYTEPOS (it2);
6077 it2.sp = 0;
6078 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
6079 it2.string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
6080 it2.from_disp_prop_p = 0;
6081 if (handle_display_prop (&it2) == HANDLED_RETURN
6082 && !NILP (val = get_char_property_and_overlay
6083 (make_number (pos), Qdisplay, Qnil, &overlay))
6084 && (OVERLAYP (overlay)
6085 ? (beg = OVERLAY_POSITION (OVERLAY_START (overlay)))
6086 : get_property_and_range (pos, Qdisplay, &val, &beg, &end, Qnil)))
6088 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
6089 goto replaced;
6092 /* Newline is not replaced by anything -- so we are done. */
6093 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
6094 break;
6096 replaced:
6097 if (beg < BEGV)
6098 beg = BEGV;
6099 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = beg;
6100 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = buf_charpos_to_bytepos (current_buffer, beg);
6104 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
6106 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
6107 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == BEGV
6108 || FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) == '\n');
6109 CHECK_IT (it);
6113 /* Reseat iterator IT at the previous visible line start. Skip
6114 invisible text that is so either due to text properties or due to
6115 selective display. At the end, update IT's overlay information,
6116 face information etc. */
6118 void
6119 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (struct it *it)
6121 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
6122 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
6123 CHECK_IT (it);
6127 /* Reseat iterator IT on the next visible line start in the current
6128 buffer. ON_NEWLINE_P non-zero means position IT on the newline
6129 preceding the line start. Skip over invisible text that is so
6130 because of selective display. Compute faces, overlays etc at the
6131 new position. Note that this function does not skip over text that
6132 is invisible because of text properties. */
6134 static void
6135 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (struct it *it, int on_newline_p)
6137 int newline_found_p, skipped_p = 0;
6138 struct bidi_it bidi_it_prev;
6140 newline_found_p = forward_to_next_line_start (it, &skipped_p, &bidi_it_prev);
6142 /* Skip over lines that are invisible because they are indented
6143 more than the value of IT->selective. */
6144 if (it->selective > 0)
6145 while (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV
6146 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
6147 it->selective))
6149 eassert (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == BEGV
6150 || FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) == '\n');
6151 newline_found_p =
6152 forward_to_next_line_start (it, &skipped_p, &bidi_it_prev);
6155 /* Position on the newline if that's what's requested. */
6156 if (on_newline_p && newline_found_p)
6158 if (STRINGP (it->string))
6160 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) > 0)
6162 if (!it->bidi_p)
6164 --IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
6165 --IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
6167 else
6169 /* We need to restore the bidi iterator to the state
6170 it had on the newline, and resync the IT's
6171 position with that. */
6172 it->bidi_it = bidi_it_prev;
6173 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
6174 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6178 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
6180 if (!it->bidi_p)
6182 --IT_CHARPOS (*it);
6183 --IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
6185 else
6187 /* We need to restore the bidi iterator to the state it
6188 had on the newline and resync IT with that. */
6189 it->bidi_it = bidi_it_prev;
6190 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
6191 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
6193 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 0);
6196 else if (skipped_p)
6197 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 0);
6199 CHECK_IT (it);
6204 /***********************************************************************
6205 Changing an iterator's position
6206 ***********************************************************************/
6208 /* Change IT's current position to POS in current_buffer. If FORCE_P
6209 is non-zero, always check for text properties at the new position.
6210 Otherwise, text properties are only looked up if POS >=
6211 IT->check_charpos of a property. */
6213 static void
6214 reseat (struct it *it, struct text_pos pos, int force_p)
6216 ptrdiff_t original_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
6218 reseat_1 (it, pos, 0);
6220 /* Determine where to check text properties. Avoid doing it
6221 where possible because text property lookup is very expensive. */
6222 if (force_p
6223 || CHARPOS (pos) > it->stop_charpos
6224 || CHARPOS (pos) < original_pos)
6226 if (it->bidi_p)
6228 /* For bidi iteration, we need to prime prev_stop and
6229 base_level_stop with our best estimations. */
6230 /* Implementation note: Of course, POS is not necessarily a
6231 stop position, so assigning prev_pos to it is a lie; we
6232 should have called compute_stop_backwards. However, if
6233 the current buffer does not include any R2L characters,
6234 that call would be a waste of cycles, because the
6235 iterator will never move back, and thus never cross this
6236 "fake" stop position. So we delay that backward search
6237 until the time we really need it, in next_element_from_buffer. */
6238 if (CHARPOS (pos) != it->prev_stop)
6239 it->prev_stop = CHARPOS (pos);
6240 if (CHARPOS (pos) < it->base_level_stop)
6241 it->base_level_stop = 0; /* meaning it's unknown */
6242 handle_stop (it);
6244 else
6246 handle_stop (it);
6247 it->prev_stop = it->base_level_stop = 0;
6252 CHECK_IT (it);
6256 /* Change IT's buffer position to POS. SET_STOP_P non-zero means set
6257 IT->stop_pos to POS, also. */
6259 static void
6260 reseat_1 (struct it *it, struct text_pos pos, int set_stop_p)
6262 /* Don't call this function when scanning a C string. */
6263 eassert (it->s == NULL);
6265 /* POS must be a reasonable value. */
6266 eassert (CHARPOS (pos) >= BEGV && CHARPOS (pos) <= ZV);
6268 it->current.pos = it->position = pos;
6269 it->end_charpos = ZV;
6270 it->dpvec = NULL;
6271 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
6272 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
6273 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = -1;
6274 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
6275 it->string = Qnil;
6276 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
6277 it->object = it->w->buffer;
6278 it->area = TEXT_AREA;
6279 it->multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
6280 it->sp = 0;
6281 it->string_from_display_prop_p = 0;
6282 it->string_from_prefix_prop_p = 0;
6284 it->from_disp_prop_p = 0;
6285 it->face_before_selective_p = 0;
6286 if (it->bidi_p)
6288 bidi_init_it (IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
6289 &it->bidi_it);
6290 bidi_unshelve_cache (NULL, 0);
6291 it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir = NEUTRAL_DIR;
6292 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
6293 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
6294 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6295 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = 0;
6298 if (set_stop_p)
6300 it->stop_charpos = CHARPOS (pos);
6301 it->base_level_stop = CHARPOS (pos);
6306 /* Set up IT for displaying a string, starting at CHARPOS in window W.
6307 If S is non-null, it is a C string to iterate over. Otherwise,
6308 STRING gives a Lisp string to iterate over.
6310 If PRECISION > 0, don't return more then PRECISION number of
6311 characters from the string.
6313 If FIELD_WIDTH > 0, return padding spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
6314 characters have been returned. FIELD_WIDTH < 0 means an infinite
6315 field width.
6317 MULTIBYTE = 0 means disable processing of multibyte characters,
6318 MULTIBYTE > 0 means enable it,
6319 MULTIBYTE < 0 means use IT->multibyte_p.
6321 IT must be initialized via a prior call to init_iterator before
6322 calling this function. */
6324 static void
6325 reseat_to_string (struct it *it, const char *s, Lisp_Object string,
6326 ptrdiff_t charpos, ptrdiff_t precision, int field_width,
6327 int multibyte)
6329 /* No region in strings. */
6330 it->region_beg_charpos = it->region_end_charpos = -1;
6332 /* No text property checks performed by default, but see below. */
6333 it->stop_charpos = -1;
6335 /* Set iterator position and end position. */
6336 memset (&it->current, 0, sizeof it->current);
6337 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
6338 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
6339 eassert (charpos >= 0);
6341 /* If STRING is specified, use its multibyteness, otherwise use the
6342 setting of MULTIBYTE, if specified. */
6343 if (multibyte >= 0)
6344 it->multibyte_p = multibyte > 0;
6346 /* Bidirectional reordering of strings is controlled by the default
6347 value of bidi-display-reordering. Don't try to reorder while
6348 loading loadup.el, as the necessary character property tables are
6349 not yet available. */
6350 it->bidi_p =
6351 NILP (Vpurify_flag)
6352 && !NILP (BVAR (&buffer_defaults, bidi_display_reordering));
6354 if (s == NULL)
6356 eassert (STRINGP (string));
6357 it->string = string;
6358 it->s = NULL;
6359 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (string);
6360 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
6361 it->current.string_pos = string_pos (charpos, string);
6363 if (it->bidi_p)
6365 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = string;
6366 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
6367 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6368 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6369 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 0;
6370 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
6371 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
6372 FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
6375 else
6377 it->s = (const unsigned char *) s;
6378 it->string = Qnil;
6380 /* Note that we use IT->current.pos, not it->current.string_pos,
6381 for displaying C strings. */
6382 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = -1;
6383 if (it->multibyte_p)
6385 it->current.pos = c_string_pos (charpos, s, 1);
6386 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = number_of_chars (s, 1);
6388 else
6390 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = charpos;
6391 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = strlen (s);
6394 if (it->bidi_p)
6396 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = Qnil;
6397 it->bidi_it.string.s = (const unsigned char *) s;
6398 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6399 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = 0;
6400 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = 0;
6401 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
6402 bidi_init_it (charpos, IT_BYTEPOS (*it), FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f),
6403 &it->bidi_it);
6405 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
6408 /* PRECISION > 0 means don't return more than PRECISION characters
6409 from the string. */
6410 if (precision > 0 && it->end_charpos - charpos > precision)
6412 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = charpos + precision;
6413 if (it->bidi_p)
6414 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
6417 /* FIELD_WIDTH > 0 means pad with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
6418 characters have been returned. FIELD_WIDTH == 0 means don't pad,
6419 FIELD_WIDTH < 0 means infinite field width. This is useful for
6420 padding with `-' at the end of a mode line. */
6421 if (field_width < 0)
6422 field_width = INFINITY;
6423 /* Implementation note: We deliberately don't enlarge
6424 it->bidi_it.string.schars here to fit it->end_charpos, because
6425 the bidi iterator cannot produce characters out of thin air. */
6426 if (field_width > it->end_charpos - charpos)
6427 it->end_charpos = charpos + field_width;
6429 /* Use the standard display table for displaying strings. */
6430 if (DISP_TABLE_P (Vstandard_display_table))
6431 it->dp = XCHAR_TABLE (Vstandard_display_table);
6433 it->stop_charpos = charpos;
6434 it->prev_stop = charpos;
6435 it->base_level_stop = 0;
6436 if (it->bidi_p)
6438 it->bidi_it.first_elt = 1;
6439 it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir = NEUTRAL_DIR;
6440 it->bidi_it.disp_pos = -1;
6442 if (s == NULL && it->multibyte_p)
6444 ptrdiff_t endpos = SCHARS (it->string);
6445 if (endpos > it->end_charpos)
6446 endpos = it->end_charpos;
6447 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, -1, endpos,
6448 it->string);
6450 CHECK_IT (it);
6455 /***********************************************************************
6456 Iteration
6457 ***********************************************************************/
6459 /* Map enum it_method value to corresponding next_element_from_* function. */
6461 static int (* get_next_element[NUM_IT_METHODS]) (struct it *it) =
6463 next_element_from_buffer,
6464 next_element_from_display_vector,
6465 next_element_from_string,
6466 next_element_from_c_string,
6467 next_element_from_image,
6468 next_element_from_stretch
6471 #define GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT(it) (*get_next_element[(it)->method]) (it)
6474 /* Return 1 iff a character at CHARPOS (and BYTEPOS) is composed
6475 (possibly with the following characters). */
6477 #define CHAR_COMPOSED_P(IT,CHARPOS,BYTEPOS,END_CHARPOS) \
6478 ((IT)->cmp_it.id >= 0 \
6479 || ((IT)->cmp_it.stop_pos == (CHARPOS) \
6480 && composition_reseat_it (&(IT)->cmp_it, CHARPOS, BYTEPOS, \
6481 END_CHARPOS, (IT)->w, \
6482 FACE_FROM_ID ((IT)->f, (IT)->face_id), \
6483 (IT)->string)))
6486 /* Lookup the char-table Vglyphless_char_display for character C (-1
6487 if we want information for no-font case), and return the display
6488 method symbol. By side-effect, update it->what and
6489 it->glyphless_method. This function is called from
6490 get_next_display_element for each character element, and from
6491 x_produce_glyphs when no suitable font was found. */
6493 Lisp_Object
6494 lookup_glyphless_char_display (int c, struct it *it)
6496 Lisp_Object glyphless_method = Qnil;
6498 if (CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
6499 && CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)) >= 1)
6501 if (c >= 0)
6503 glyphless_method = CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display, c);
6504 if (CONSP (glyphless_method))
6505 glyphless_method = FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
6506 ? XCAR (glyphless_method)
6507 : XCDR (glyphless_method);
6509 else
6510 glyphless_method = XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0];
6513 retry:
6514 if (NILP (glyphless_method))
6516 if (c >= 0)
6517 /* The default is to display the character by a proper font. */
6518 return Qnil;
6519 /* The default for the no-font case is to display an empty box. */
6520 glyphless_method = Qempty_box;
6522 if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qzero_width))
6524 if (c >= 0)
6525 return glyphless_method;
6526 /* This method can't be used for the no-font case. */
6527 glyphless_method = Qempty_box;
6529 if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qthin_space))
6530 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE;
6531 else if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qempty_box))
6532 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_EMPTY_BOX;
6533 else if (EQ (glyphless_method, Qhex_code))
6534 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE;
6535 else if (STRINGP (glyphless_method))
6536 it->glyphless_method = GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM;
6537 else
6539 /* Invalid value. We use the default method. */
6540 glyphless_method = Qnil;
6541 goto retry;
6543 it->what = IT_GLYPHLESS;
6544 return glyphless_method;
6547 /* Load IT's display element fields with information about the next
6548 display element from the current position of IT. Value is zero if
6549 end of buffer (or C string) is reached. */
6551 static struct frame *last_escape_glyph_frame = NULL;
6552 static int last_escape_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
6553 static int last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id = 0;
6555 struct frame *last_glyphless_glyph_frame = NULL;
6556 int last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
6557 int last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id = 0;
6559 static int
6560 get_next_display_element (struct it *it)
6562 /* Non-zero means that we found a display element. Zero means that
6563 we hit the end of what we iterate over. Performance note: the
6564 function pointer `method' used here turns out to be faster than
6565 using a sequence of if-statements. */
6566 int success_p;
6568 get_next:
6569 success_p = GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
6571 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
6573 /* UAX#9, L4: "A character is depicted by a mirrored glyph if
6574 and only if (a) the resolved directionality of that character
6575 is R..." */
6576 /* FIXME: Do we need an exception for characters from display
6577 tables? */
6578 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.type == STRONG_R)
6579 it->c = bidi_mirror_char (it->c);
6580 /* Map via display table or translate control characters.
6581 IT->c, IT->len etc. have been set to the next character by
6582 the function call above. If we have a display table, and it
6583 contains an entry for IT->c, translate it. Don't do this if
6584 IT->c itself comes from a display table, otherwise we could
6585 end up in an infinite recursion. (An alternative could be to
6586 count the recursion depth of this function and signal an
6587 error when a certain maximum depth is reached.) Is it worth
6588 it? */
6589 if (success_p && it->dpvec == NULL)
6591 Lisp_Object dv;
6592 struct charset *unibyte = CHARSET_FROM_ID (charset_unibyte);
6593 int nonascii_space_p = 0;
6594 int nonascii_hyphen_p = 0;
6595 int c = it->c; /* This is the character to display. */
6597 if (! it->multibyte_p && ! ASCII_CHAR_P (c))
6599 eassert (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c));
6600 if (unibyte_display_via_language_environment)
6602 c = DECODE_CHAR (unibyte, c);
6603 if (c < 0)
6604 c = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it->c);
6606 else
6607 c = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it->c);
6610 if (it->dp
6611 && (dv = DISP_CHAR_VECTOR (it->dp, c),
6612 VECTORP (dv)))
6614 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (dv);
6616 /* Return the first character from the display table
6617 entry, if not empty. If empty, don't display the
6618 current character. */
6619 if (v->header.size)
6621 it->dpvec_char_len = it->len;
6622 it->dpvec = v->contents;
6623 it->dpend = v->contents + v->header.size;
6624 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
6625 it->dpvec_face_id = -1;
6626 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
6627 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
6628 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
6630 else
6632 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6634 goto get_next;
6637 if (! NILP (lookup_glyphless_char_display (c, it)))
6639 if (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS)
6640 goto done;
6641 /* Don't display this character. */
6642 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6643 goto get_next;
6646 /* If `nobreak-char-display' is non-nil, we display
6647 non-ASCII spaces and hyphens specially. */
6648 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (c) && ! NILP (Vnobreak_char_display))
6650 if (c == 0xA0)
6651 nonascii_space_p = 1;
6652 else if (c == 0xAD || c == 0x2010 || c == 0x2011)
6653 nonascii_hyphen_p = 1;
6656 /* Translate control characters into `\003' or `^C' form.
6657 Control characters coming from a display table entry are
6658 currently not translated because we use IT->dpvec to hold
6659 the translation. This could easily be changed but I
6660 don't believe that it is worth doing.
6662 The characters handled by `nobreak-char-display' must be
6663 translated too.
6665 Non-printable characters and raw-byte characters are also
6666 translated to octal form. */
6667 if (((c < ' ' || c == 127) /* ASCII control chars */
6668 ? (it->area != TEXT_AREA
6669 /* In mode line, treat \n, \t like other crl chars. */
6670 || (c != '\t'
6671 && it->glyph_row
6672 && (it->glyph_row->mode_line_p || it->avoid_cursor_p))
6673 || (c != '\n' && c != '\t'))
6674 : (nonascii_space_p
6675 || nonascii_hyphen_p
6676 || CHAR_BYTE8_P (c)
6677 || ! CHAR_PRINTABLE_P (c))))
6679 /* C is a control character, non-ASCII space/hyphen,
6680 raw-byte, or a non-printable character which must be
6681 displayed either as '\003' or as `^C' where the '\\'
6682 and '^' can be defined in the display table. Fill
6683 IT->ctl_chars with glyphs for what we have to
6684 display. Then, set IT->dpvec to these glyphs. */
6685 Lisp_Object gc;
6686 int ctl_len;
6687 int face_id;
6688 int lface_id = 0;
6689 int escape_glyph;
6691 /* Handle control characters with ^. */
6693 if (ASCII_CHAR_P (c) && it->ctl_arrow_p)
6695 int g;
6697 g = '^'; /* default glyph for Control */
6698 /* Set IT->ctl_chars[0] to the glyph for `^'. */
6699 if (it->dp
6700 && (gc = DISP_CTRL_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
6702 g = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
6703 lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
6705 if (lface_id)
6707 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id, it->face_id);
6709 else if (it->f == last_escape_glyph_frame
6710 && it->face_id == last_escape_glyph_face_id)
6712 face_id = last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id;
6714 else
6716 /* Merge the escape-glyph face into the current face. */
6717 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qescape_glyph, 0,
6718 it->face_id);
6719 last_escape_glyph_frame = it->f;
6720 last_escape_glyph_face_id = it->face_id;
6721 last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id = face_id;
6724 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], g);
6725 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[1], c ^ 0100);
6726 ctl_len = 2;
6727 goto display_control;
6730 /* Handle non-ascii space in the mode where it only gets
6731 highlighting. */
6733 if (nonascii_space_p && EQ (Vnobreak_char_display, Qt))
6735 /* Merge `nobreak-space' into the current face. */
6736 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qnobreak_space, 0,
6737 it->face_id);
6738 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], ' ');
6739 ctl_len = 1;
6740 goto display_control;
6743 /* Handle sequences that start with the "escape glyph". */
6745 /* the default escape glyph is \. */
6746 escape_glyph = '\\';
6748 if (it->dp
6749 && (gc = DISP_ESCAPE_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
6751 escape_glyph = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
6752 lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
6754 if (lface_id)
6756 /* The display table specified a face.
6757 Merge it into face_id and also into escape_glyph. */
6758 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id,
6759 it->face_id);
6761 else if (it->f == last_escape_glyph_frame
6762 && it->face_id == last_escape_glyph_face_id)
6764 face_id = last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id;
6766 else
6768 /* Merge the escape-glyph face into the current face. */
6769 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qescape_glyph, 0,
6770 it->face_id);
6771 last_escape_glyph_frame = it->f;
6772 last_escape_glyph_face_id = it->face_id;
6773 last_escape_glyph_merged_face_id = face_id;
6776 /* Draw non-ASCII hyphen with just highlighting: */
6778 if (nonascii_hyphen_p && EQ (Vnobreak_char_display, Qt))
6780 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], '-');
6781 ctl_len = 1;
6782 goto display_control;
6785 /* Draw non-ASCII space/hyphen with escape glyph: */
6787 if (nonascii_space_p || nonascii_hyphen_p)
6789 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], escape_glyph);
6790 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[1], nonascii_space_p ? ' ' : '-');
6791 ctl_len = 2;
6792 goto display_control;
6796 char str[10];
6797 int len, i;
6799 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (c))
6800 /* Display \200 instead of \17777600. */
6801 c = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (c);
6802 len = sprintf (str, "%03o", c);
6804 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[0], escape_glyph);
6805 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
6806 XSETINT (it->ctl_chars[i + 1], str[i]);
6807 ctl_len = len + 1;
6810 display_control:
6811 /* Set up IT->dpvec and return first character from it. */
6812 it->dpvec_char_len = it->len;
6813 it->dpvec = it->ctl_chars;
6814 it->dpend = it->dpvec + ctl_len;
6815 it->current.dpvec_index = 0;
6816 it->dpvec_face_id = face_id;
6817 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
6818 it->method = GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR;
6819 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
6820 goto get_next;
6822 it->char_to_display = c;
6824 else if (success_p)
6826 it->char_to_display = it->c;
6830 /* Adjust face id for a multibyte character. There are no multibyte
6831 character in unibyte text. */
6832 if ((it->what == IT_CHARACTER || it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
6833 && it->multibyte_p
6834 && success_p
6835 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
6837 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
6839 if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION && it->cmp_it.ch >= 0)
6841 /* Automatic composition with glyph-string. */
6842 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (it->cmp_it.id);
6844 it->face_id = face_for_font (it->f, LGSTRING_FONT (gstring), face);
6846 else
6848 ptrdiff_t pos = (it->s ? -1
6849 : STRINGP (it->string) ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it)
6850 : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
6851 int c;
6853 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
6854 c = it->char_to_display;
6855 else
6857 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[it->cmp_it.id];
6858 int i;
6860 c = ' ';
6861 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
6862 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with
6863 padding space on the left or right. */
6864 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i)) != '\t')
6865 break;
6867 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, c, pos, it->string);
6871 done:
6872 /* Is this character the last one of a run of characters with
6873 box? If yes, set IT->end_of_box_run_p to 1. */
6874 if (it->face_box_p
6875 && it->s == NULL)
6877 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING && it->sp)
6879 int face_id = underlying_face_id (it);
6880 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
6882 if (face)
6884 if (face->box == FACE_NO_BOX)
6886 /* If the box comes from face properties in a
6887 display string, check faces in that string. */
6888 int string_face_id = face_after_it_pos (it);
6889 it->end_of_box_run_p
6890 = (FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, string_face_id)->box
6891 == FACE_NO_BOX);
6893 /* Otherwise, the box comes from the underlying face.
6894 If this is the last string character displayed, check
6895 the next buffer location. */
6896 else if ((IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string) - 1)
6897 && (it->current.overlay_string_index
6898 == it->n_overlay_strings - 1))
6900 ptrdiff_t ignore;
6901 int next_face_id;
6902 struct text_pos pos = it->current.pos;
6903 INC_TEXT_POS (pos, it->multibyte_p);
6905 next_face_id = face_at_buffer_position
6906 (it->w, CHARPOS (pos), it->region_beg_charpos,
6907 it->region_end_charpos, &ignore,
6908 (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + TEXT_PROP_DISTANCE_LIMIT), 0,
6909 -1);
6910 it->end_of_box_run_p
6911 = (FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, next_face_id)->box
6912 == FACE_NO_BOX);
6916 else
6918 int face_id = face_after_it_pos (it);
6919 it->end_of_box_run_p
6920 = (face_id != it->face_id
6921 && FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id)->box == FACE_NO_BOX);
6924 /* If we reached the end of the object we've been iterating (e.g., a
6925 display string or an overlay string), and there's something on
6926 IT->stack, proceed with what's on the stack. It doesn't make
6927 sense to return zero if there's unprocessed stuff on the stack,
6928 because otherwise that stuff will never be displayed. */
6929 if (!success_p && it->sp > 0)
6931 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
6932 success_p = get_next_display_element (it);
6935 /* Value is 0 if end of buffer or string reached. */
6936 return success_p;
6940 /* Move IT to the next display element.
6942 RESEAT_P non-zero means if called on a newline in buffer text,
6943 skip to the next visible line start.
6945 Functions get_next_display_element and set_iterator_to_next are
6946 separate because I find this arrangement easier to handle than a
6947 get_next_display_element function that also increments IT's
6948 position. The way it is we can first look at an iterator's current
6949 display element, decide whether it fits on a line, and if it does,
6950 increment the iterator position. The other way around we probably
6951 would either need a flag indicating whether the iterator has to be
6952 incremented the next time, or we would have to implement a
6953 decrement position function which would not be easy to write. */
6955 void
6956 set_iterator_to_next (struct it *it, int reseat_p)
6958 /* Reset flags indicating start and end of a sequence of characters
6959 with box. Reset them at the start of this function because
6960 moving the iterator to a new position might set them. */
6961 it->start_of_box_run_p = it->end_of_box_run_p = 0;
6963 switch (it->method)
6965 case GET_FROM_BUFFER:
6966 /* The current display element of IT is a character from
6967 current_buffer. Advance in the buffer, and maybe skip over
6968 invisible lines that are so because of selective display. */
6969 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it) && reseat_p)
6970 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
6971 else if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
6973 /* We are currently getting glyphs from a composition. */
6974 int i;
6976 if (! it->bidi_p)
6978 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
6979 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
6980 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
6982 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
6984 else
6986 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
6987 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
6988 IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
6989 it->end_charpos, Qnil);
6992 else if (! it->cmp_it.reversed_p)
6994 /* Composition created while scanning forward. */
6995 /* Update IT's char/byte positions to point to the first
6996 character of the next grapheme cluster, or to the
6997 character visually after the current composition. */
6998 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
6999 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7000 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7001 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7003 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7005 /* Proceed to the next grapheme cluster. */
7006 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7008 else
7010 /* No more grapheme clusters in this composition.
7011 Find the next stop position. */
7012 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7013 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7014 /* Now we are scanning backward and don't know
7015 where to stop. */
7016 stop = -1;
7017 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7018 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
7021 else
7023 /* Composition created while scanning backward. */
7024 /* Update IT's char/byte positions to point to the last
7025 character of the previous grapheme cluster, or the
7026 character visually after the current composition. */
7027 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7028 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7029 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7030 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7031 if (it->cmp_it.from > 0)
7033 /* Proceed to the previous grapheme cluster. */
7034 it->cmp_it.to = it->cmp_it.from;
7036 else
7038 /* No more grapheme clusters in this composition.
7039 Find the next stop position. */
7040 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7041 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7042 /* Now we are scanning backward and don't know
7043 where to stop. */
7044 stop = -1;
7045 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7046 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
7050 else
7052 eassert (it->len != 0);
7054 if (!it->bidi_p)
7056 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
7057 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
7059 else
7061 int prev_scan_dir = it->bidi_it.scan_dir;
7062 /* If this is a new paragraph, determine its base
7063 direction (a.k.a. its base embedding level). */
7064 if (it->bidi_it.new_paragraph)
7065 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 0);
7066 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7067 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7068 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7069 if (prev_scan_dir != it->bidi_it.scan_dir)
7071 /* As the scan direction was changed, we must
7072 re-compute the stop position for composition. */
7073 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7074 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7075 stop = -1;
7076 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7077 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), stop, Qnil);
7080 eassert (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) == CHAR_TO_BYTE (IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
7082 break;
7084 case GET_FROM_C_STRING:
7085 /* Current display element of IT is from a C string. */
7086 if (!it->bidi_p
7087 /* If the string position is beyond string's end, it means
7088 next_element_from_c_string is padding the string with
7089 blanks, in which case we bypass the bidi iterator,
7090 because it cannot deal with such virtual characters. */
7091 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->bidi_it.string.schars)
7093 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
7094 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
7096 else
7098 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7099 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7100 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7102 break;
7104 case GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR:
7105 /* Current display element of IT is from a display table entry.
7106 Advance in the display table definition. Reset it to null if
7107 end reached, and continue with characters from buffers/
7108 strings. */
7109 ++it->current.dpvec_index;
7111 /* Restore face of the iterator to what they were before the
7112 display vector entry (these entries may contain faces). */
7113 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
7115 if (it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index >= it->dpend)
7117 int recheck_faces = it->ellipsis_p;
7119 if (it->s)
7120 it->method = GET_FROM_C_STRING;
7121 else if (STRINGP (it->string))
7122 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
7123 else
7125 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
7126 it->object = it->w->buffer;
7129 it->dpvec = NULL;
7130 it->current.dpvec_index = -1;
7132 /* Skip over characters which were displayed via IT->dpvec. */
7133 if (it->dpvec_char_len < 0)
7134 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 1);
7135 else if (it->dpvec_char_len > 0)
7137 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING
7138 && it->n_overlay_strings > 0)
7139 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 1;
7140 it->len = it->dpvec_char_len;
7141 set_iterator_to_next (it, reseat_p);
7144 /* Maybe recheck faces after display vector */
7145 if (recheck_faces)
7146 it->stop_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7148 break;
7150 case GET_FROM_STRING:
7151 /* Current display element is a character from a Lisp string. */
7152 eassert (it->s == NULL && STRINGP (it->string));
7153 /* Don't advance past string end. These conditions are true
7154 when set_iterator_to_next is called at the end of
7155 get_next_display_element, in which case the Lisp string is
7156 already exhausted, and all we want is pop the iterator
7157 stack. */
7158 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
7160 /* This is an overlay string, so there's no padding with
7161 spaces, and the number of characters in the string is
7162 where the string ends. */
7163 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string))
7164 goto consider_string_end;
7166 else
7168 /* Not an overlay string. There could be padding, so test
7169 against it->end_charpos . */
7170 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7171 goto consider_string_end;
7173 if (it->cmp_it.id >= 0)
7175 int i;
7177 if (! it->bidi_p)
7179 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
7180 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
7181 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7182 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7183 else
7185 it->cmp_it.id = -1;
7186 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7187 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7188 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
7189 it->end_charpos, it->string);
7192 else if (! it->cmp_it.reversed_p)
7194 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7195 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7196 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7197 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7199 if (it->cmp_it.to < it->cmp_it.nglyphs)
7200 it->cmp_it.from = it->cmp_it.to;
7201 else
7203 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7204 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7205 stop = -1;
7206 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7207 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7208 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
7209 it->string);
7212 else
7214 for (i = 0; i < it->cmp_it.nchars; i++)
7215 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7216 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7217 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7218 if (it->cmp_it.from > 0)
7219 it->cmp_it.to = it->cmp_it.from;
7220 else
7222 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7223 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7224 stop = -1;
7225 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7226 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7227 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
7228 it->string);
7232 else
7234 if (!it->bidi_p
7235 /* If the string position is beyond string's end, it
7236 means next_element_from_string is padding the string
7237 with blanks, in which case we bypass the bidi
7238 iterator, because it cannot deal with such virtual
7239 characters. */
7240 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->bidi_it.string.schars)
7242 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->len;
7243 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += 1;
7245 else
7247 int prev_scan_dir = it->bidi_it.scan_dir;
7249 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7250 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7251 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7252 if (prev_scan_dir != it->bidi_it.scan_dir)
7254 ptrdiff_t stop = it->end_charpos;
7256 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7257 stop = -1;
7258 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it,
7259 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7260 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), stop,
7261 it->string);
7266 consider_string_end:
7268 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
7270 /* IT->string is an overlay string. Advance to the
7271 next, if there is one. */
7272 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string))
7274 it->ellipsis_p = 0;
7275 next_overlay_string (it);
7276 if (it->ellipsis_p)
7277 setup_for_ellipsis (it, 0);
7280 else
7282 /* IT->string is not an overlay string. If we reached
7283 its end, and there is something on IT->stack, proceed
7284 with what is on the stack. This can be either another
7285 string, this time an overlay string, or a buffer. */
7286 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == SCHARS (it->string)
7287 && it->sp > 0)
7289 pop_it (it);
7290 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
7291 goto consider_string_end;
7294 break;
7296 case GET_FROM_IMAGE:
7297 case GET_FROM_STRETCH:
7298 /* The position etc with which we have to proceed are on
7299 the stack. The position may be at the end of a string,
7300 if the `display' property takes up the whole string. */
7301 eassert (it->sp > 0);
7302 pop_it (it);
7303 if (it->method == GET_FROM_STRING)
7304 goto consider_string_end;
7305 break;
7307 default:
7308 /* There are no other methods defined, so this should be a bug. */
7309 abort ();
7312 eassert (it->method != GET_FROM_STRING
7313 || (STRINGP (it->string)
7314 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0));
7317 /* Load IT's display element fields with information about the next
7318 display element which comes from a display table entry or from the
7319 result of translating a control character to one of the forms `^C'
7320 or `\003'.
7322 IT->dpvec holds the glyphs to return as characters.
7323 IT->saved_face_id holds the face id before the display vector--it
7324 is restored into IT->face_id in set_iterator_to_next. */
7326 static int
7327 next_element_from_display_vector (struct it *it)
7329 Lisp_Object gc;
7331 /* Precondition. */
7332 eassert (it->dpvec && it->current.dpvec_index >= 0);
7334 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
7336 /* KFS: This code used to check ip->dpvec[0] instead of the current element.
7337 That seemed totally bogus - so I changed it... */
7338 gc = it->dpvec[it->current.dpvec_index];
7340 if (GLYPH_CODE_P (gc))
7342 it->c = GLYPH_CODE_CHAR (gc);
7343 it->len = CHAR_BYTES (it->c);
7345 /* The entry may contain a face id to use. Such a face id is
7346 the id of a Lisp face, not a realized face. A face id of
7347 zero means no face is specified. */
7348 if (it->dpvec_face_id >= 0)
7349 it->face_id = it->dpvec_face_id;
7350 else
7352 int lface_id = GLYPH_CODE_FACE (gc);
7353 if (lface_id > 0)
7354 it->face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qt, lface_id,
7355 it->saved_face_id);
7358 else
7359 /* Display table entry is invalid. Return a space. */
7360 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7362 /* Don't change position and object of the iterator here. They are
7363 still the values of the character that had this display table
7364 entry or was translated, and that's what we want. */
7365 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7366 return 1;
7369 /* Get the first element of string/buffer in the visual order, after
7370 being reseated to a new position in a string or a buffer. */
7371 static void
7372 get_visually_first_element (struct it *it)
7374 int string_p = STRINGP (it->string) || it->s;
7375 ptrdiff_t eob = (string_p ? it->bidi_it.string.schars : ZV);
7376 ptrdiff_t bob = (string_p ? 0 : BEGV);
7378 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7380 it->bidi_it.charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
7381 it->bidi_it.bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
7383 else
7385 it->bidi_it.charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7386 it->bidi_it.bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
7389 if (it->bidi_it.charpos == eob)
7391 /* Nothing to do, but reset the FIRST_ELT flag, like
7392 bidi_paragraph_init does, because we are not going to
7393 call it. */
7394 it->bidi_it.first_elt = 0;
7396 else if (it->bidi_it.charpos == bob
7397 || (!string_p
7398 && (FETCH_CHAR (it->bidi_it.bytepos - 1) == '\n'
7399 || FETCH_CHAR (it->bidi_it.bytepos) == '\n')))
7401 /* If we are at the beginning of a line/string, we can produce
7402 the next element right away. */
7403 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
7404 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7406 else
7408 ptrdiff_t orig_bytepos = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7410 /* We need to prime the bidi iterator starting at the line's or
7411 string's beginning, before we will be able to produce the
7412 next element. */
7413 if (string_p)
7414 it->bidi_it.charpos = it->bidi_it.bytepos = 0;
7415 else
7417 it->bidi_it.charpos = find_next_newline_no_quit (IT_CHARPOS (*it),
7418 -1);
7419 it->bidi_it.bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (it->bidi_it.charpos);
7421 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 1);
7424 /* Now return to buffer/string position where we were asked
7425 to get the next display element, and produce that. */
7426 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
7428 while (it->bidi_it.bytepos != orig_bytepos
7429 && it->bidi_it.charpos < eob);
7432 /* Adjust IT's position information to where we ended up. */
7433 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7435 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7436 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7438 else
7440 IT_CHARPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.charpos;
7441 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) = it->bidi_it.bytepos;
7444 if (STRINGP (it->string) || !it->s)
7446 ptrdiff_t stop, charpos, bytepos;
7448 if (STRINGP (it->string))
7450 eassert (!it->s);
7451 stop = SCHARS (it->string);
7452 if (stop > it->end_charpos)
7453 stop = it->end_charpos;
7454 charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
7455 bytepos = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it);
7457 else
7459 stop = it->end_charpos;
7460 charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7461 bytepos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it);
7463 if (it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0)
7464 stop = -1;
7465 composition_compute_stop_pos (&it->cmp_it, charpos, bytepos, stop,
7466 it->string);
7470 /* Load IT with the next display element from Lisp string IT->string.
7471 IT->current.string_pos is the current position within the string.
7472 If IT->current.overlay_string_index >= 0, the Lisp string is an
7473 overlay string. */
7475 static int
7476 next_element_from_string (struct it *it)
7478 struct text_pos position;
7480 eassert (STRINGP (it->string));
7481 eassert (!it->bidi_p || EQ (it->string, it->bidi_it.string.lstring));
7482 eassert (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= 0);
7483 position = it->current.string_pos;
7485 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
7486 character at IT_STRING_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means
7487 that we were reseat()ed to a new string, whose paragraph
7488 direction is not known. */
7489 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
7491 get_visually_first_element (it);
7492 SET_TEXT_POS (position, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it), IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7495 /* Time to check for invisible text? */
7496 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos)
7498 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->stop_charpos)
7500 if (!(!it->bidi_p
7501 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)
7502 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == it->stop_charpos))
7504 /* With bidi non-linear iteration, we could find
7505 ourselves far beyond the last computed stop_charpos,
7506 with several other stop positions in between that we
7507 missed. Scan them all now, in buffer's logical
7508 order, until we find and handle the last stop_charpos
7509 that precedes our current position. */
7510 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->stop_charpos);
7511 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7513 else
7515 if (it->bidi_p)
7517 /* Take note of the stop position we just moved
7518 across, for when we will move back across it. */
7519 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7520 /* If we are at base paragraph embedding level, take
7521 note of the last stop position seen at this
7522 level. */
7523 if (BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7524 it->base_level_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7526 handle_stop (it);
7528 /* Since a handler may have changed IT->method, we must
7529 recurse here. */
7530 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7533 else if (it->bidi_p
7534 /* If we are before prev_stop, we may have overstepped
7535 on our way backwards a stop_pos, and if so, we need
7536 to handle that stop_pos. */
7537 && IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->prev_stop
7538 /* We can sometimes back up for reasons that have nothing
7539 to do with bidi reordering. E.g., compositions. The
7540 code below is only needed when we are above the base
7541 embedding level, so test for that explicitly. */
7542 && !BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7544 /* If we lost track of base_level_stop, we have no better
7545 place for handle_stop_backwards to start from than string
7546 beginning. This happens, e.g., when we were reseated to
7547 the previous screenful of text by vertical-motion. */
7548 if (it->base_level_stop <= 0
7549 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->base_level_stop)
7550 it->base_level_stop = 0;
7551 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->base_level_stop);
7552 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7556 if (it->current.overlay_string_index >= 0)
7558 /* Get the next character from an overlay string. In overlay
7559 strings, there is no field width or padding with spaces to
7560 do. */
7561 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= SCHARS (it->string))
7563 it->what = IT_EOB;
7564 return 0;
7566 else if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7567 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
7568 it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0
7569 ? -1
7570 : SCHARS (it->string))
7571 && next_element_from_composition (it))
7573 return 1;
7575 else if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
7577 const unsigned char *s = (SDATA (it->string)
7578 + IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7579 it->c = string_char_and_length (s, &it->len);
7581 else
7583 it->c = SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7584 it->len = 1;
7587 else
7589 /* Get the next character from a Lisp string that is not an
7590 overlay string. Such strings come from the mode line, for
7591 example. We may have to pad with spaces, or truncate the
7592 string. See also next_element_from_c_string. */
7593 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7595 it->what = IT_EOB;
7596 return 0;
7598 else if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->string_nchars)
7600 /* Pad with spaces. */
7601 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7602 CHARPOS (position) = BYTEPOS (position) = -1;
7604 else if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
7605 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it),
7606 it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0
7607 ? -1
7608 : it->string_nchars)
7609 && next_element_from_composition (it))
7611 return 1;
7613 else if (STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string))
7615 const unsigned char *s = (SDATA (it->string)
7616 + IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7617 it->c = string_char_and_length (s, &it->len);
7619 else
7621 it->c = SREF (it->string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it));
7622 it->len = 1;
7626 /* Record what we have and where it came from. */
7627 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7628 it->object = it->string;
7629 it->position = position;
7630 return 1;
7634 /* Load IT with next display element from C string IT->s.
7635 IT->string_nchars is the maximum number of characters to return
7636 from the string. IT->end_charpos may be greater than
7637 IT->string_nchars when this function is called, in which case we
7638 may have to return padding spaces. Value is zero if end of string
7639 reached, including padding spaces. */
7641 static int
7642 next_element_from_c_string (struct it *it)
7644 int success_p = 1;
7646 eassert (it->s);
7647 eassert (!it->bidi_p || it->s == it->bidi_it.string.s);
7648 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7649 BYTEPOS (it->position) = CHARPOS (it->position) = 0;
7650 it->object = Qnil;
7652 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
7653 character at IT_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means that
7654 we were reseated to a new string, whose paragraph direction is
7655 not known. */
7656 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
7657 get_visually_first_element (it);
7659 /* IT's position can be greater than IT->string_nchars in case a
7660 field width or precision has been specified when the iterator was
7661 initialized. */
7662 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7664 /* End of the game. */
7665 it->what = IT_EOB;
7666 success_p = 0;
7668 else if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->string_nchars)
7670 /* Pad with spaces. */
7671 it->c = ' ', it->len = 1;
7672 BYTEPOS (it->position) = CHARPOS (it->position) = -1;
7674 else if (it->multibyte_p)
7675 it->c = string_char_and_length (it->s + IT_BYTEPOS (*it), &it->len);
7676 else
7677 it->c = it->s[IT_BYTEPOS (*it)], it->len = 1;
7679 return success_p;
7683 /* Set up IT to return characters from an ellipsis, if appropriate.
7684 The definition of the ellipsis glyphs may come from a display table
7685 entry. This function fills IT with the first glyph from the
7686 ellipsis if an ellipsis is to be displayed. */
7688 static int
7689 next_element_from_ellipsis (struct it *it)
7691 if (it->selective_display_ellipsis_p)
7692 setup_for_ellipsis (it, it->len);
7693 else
7695 /* The face at the current position may be different from the
7696 face we find after the invisible text. Remember what it
7697 was in IT->saved_face_id, and signal that it's there by
7698 setting face_before_selective_p. */
7699 it->saved_face_id = it->face_id;
7700 it->method = GET_FROM_BUFFER;
7701 it->object = it->w->buffer;
7702 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 1);
7703 it->face_before_selective_p = 1;
7706 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7710 /* Deliver an image display element. The iterator IT is already
7711 filled with image information (done in handle_display_prop). Value
7712 is always 1. */
7715 static int
7716 next_element_from_image (struct it *it)
7718 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
7719 it->ignore_overlay_strings_at_pos_p = 0;
7720 return 1;
7724 /* Fill iterator IT with next display element from a stretch glyph
7725 property. IT->object is the value of the text property. Value is
7726 always 1. */
7728 static int
7729 next_element_from_stretch (struct it *it)
7731 it->what = IT_STRETCH;
7732 return 1;
7735 /* Scan backwards from IT's current position until we find a stop
7736 position, or until BEGV. This is called when we find ourself
7737 before both the last known prev_stop and base_level_stop while
7738 reordering bidirectional text. */
7740 static void
7741 compute_stop_pos_backwards (struct it *it)
7743 const int SCAN_BACK_LIMIT = 1000;
7744 struct text_pos pos;
7745 struct display_pos save_current = it->current;
7746 struct text_pos save_position = it->position;
7747 ptrdiff_t charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
7748 ptrdiff_t where_we_are = charpos;
7749 ptrdiff_t save_stop_pos = it->stop_charpos;
7750 ptrdiff_t save_end_pos = it->end_charpos;
7752 eassert (NILP (it->string) && !it->s);
7753 eassert (it->bidi_p);
7754 it->bidi_p = 0;
7757 it->end_charpos = min (charpos + 1, ZV);
7758 charpos = max (charpos - SCAN_BACK_LIMIT, BEGV);
7759 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, charpos, BYTE_TO_CHAR (charpos));
7760 reseat_1 (it, pos, 0);
7761 compute_stop_pos (it);
7762 /* We must advance forward, right? */
7763 if (it->stop_charpos <= charpos)
7764 abort ();
7766 while (charpos > BEGV && it->stop_charpos >= it->end_charpos);
7768 if (it->stop_charpos <= where_we_are)
7769 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7770 else
7771 it->prev_stop = BEGV;
7772 it->bidi_p = 1;
7773 it->current = save_current;
7774 it->position = save_position;
7775 it->stop_charpos = save_stop_pos;
7776 it->end_charpos = save_end_pos;
7779 /* Scan forward from CHARPOS in the current buffer/string, until we
7780 find a stop position > current IT's position. Then handle the stop
7781 position before that. This is called when we bump into a stop
7782 position while reordering bidirectional text. CHARPOS should be
7783 the last previously processed stop_pos (or BEGV/0, if none were
7784 processed yet) whose position is less that IT's current
7785 position. */
7787 static void
7788 handle_stop_backwards (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t charpos)
7790 int bufp = !STRINGP (it->string);
7791 ptrdiff_t where_we_are = (bufp ? IT_CHARPOS (*it) : IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
7792 struct display_pos save_current = it->current;
7793 struct text_pos save_position = it->position;
7794 struct text_pos pos1;
7795 ptrdiff_t next_stop;
7797 /* Scan in strict logical order. */
7798 eassert (it->bidi_p);
7799 it->bidi_p = 0;
7802 it->prev_stop = charpos;
7803 if (bufp)
7805 SET_TEXT_POS (pos1, charpos, CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos));
7806 reseat_1 (it, pos1, 0);
7808 else
7809 it->current.string_pos = string_pos (charpos, it->string);
7810 compute_stop_pos (it);
7811 /* We must advance forward, right? */
7812 if (it->stop_charpos <= it->prev_stop)
7813 abort ();
7814 charpos = it->stop_charpos;
7816 while (charpos <= where_we_are);
7818 it->bidi_p = 1;
7819 it->current = save_current;
7820 it->position = save_position;
7821 next_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7822 it->stop_charpos = it->prev_stop;
7823 handle_stop (it);
7824 it->stop_charpos = next_stop;
7827 /* Load IT with the next display element from current_buffer. Value
7828 is zero if end of buffer reached. IT->stop_charpos is the next
7829 position at which to stop and check for text properties or buffer
7830 end. */
7832 static int
7833 next_element_from_buffer (struct it *it)
7835 int success_p = 1;
7837 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
7838 eassert (NILP (it->string) && !it->s);
7839 eassert (!it->bidi_p
7840 || (EQ (it->bidi_it.string.lstring, Qnil)
7841 && it->bidi_it.string.s == NULL));
7843 /* With bidi reordering, the character to display might not be the
7844 character at IT_CHARPOS. BIDI_IT.FIRST_ELT non-zero means that
7845 we were reseat()ed to a new buffer position, which is potentially
7846 a different paragraph. */
7847 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.first_elt)
7849 get_visually_first_element (it);
7850 SET_TEXT_POS (it->position, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
7853 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->stop_charpos)
7855 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->end_charpos)
7857 int overlay_strings_follow_p;
7859 /* End of the game, except when overlay strings follow that
7860 haven't been returned yet. */
7861 if (it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p)
7862 overlay_strings_follow_p = 0;
7863 else
7865 it->overlay_strings_at_end_processed_p = 1;
7866 overlay_strings_follow_p = get_overlay_strings (it, 0);
7869 if (overlay_strings_follow_p)
7870 success_p = GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7871 else
7873 it->what = IT_EOB;
7874 it->position = it->current.pos;
7875 success_p = 0;
7878 else if (!(!it->bidi_p
7879 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)
7880 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) == it->stop_charpos))
7882 /* With bidi non-linear iteration, we could find ourselves
7883 far beyond the last computed stop_charpos, with several
7884 other stop positions in between that we missed. Scan
7885 them all now, in buffer's logical order, until we find
7886 and handle the last stop_charpos that precedes our
7887 current position. */
7888 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->stop_charpos);
7889 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7891 else
7893 if (it->bidi_p)
7895 /* Take note of the stop position we just moved across,
7896 for when we will move back across it. */
7897 it->prev_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7898 /* If we are at base paragraph embedding level, take
7899 note of the last stop position seen at this
7900 level. */
7901 if (BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7902 it->base_level_stop = it->stop_charpos;
7904 handle_stop (it);
7905 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7908 else if (it->bidi_p
7909 /* If we are before prev_stop, we may have overstepped on
7910 our way backwards a stop_pos, and if so, we need to
7911 handle that stop_pos. */
7912 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->prev_stop
7913 /* We can sometimes back up for reasons that have nothing
7914 to do with bidi reordering. E.g., compositions. The
7915 code below is only needed when we are above the base
7916 embedding level, so test for that explicitly. */
7917 && !BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
7919 if (it->base_level_stop <= 0
7920 || IT_CHARPOS (*it) < it->base_level_stop)
7922 /* If we lost track of base_level_stop, we need to find
7923 prev_stop by looking backwards. This happens, e.g., when
7924 we were reseated to the previous screenful of text by
7925 vertical-motion. */
7926 it->base_level_stop = BEGV;
7927 compute_stop_pos_backwards (it);
7928 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->prev_stop);
7930 else
7931 handle_stop_backwards (it, it->base_level_stop);
7932 return GET_NEXT_DISPLAY_ELEMENT (it);
7934 else
7936 /* No face changes, overlays etc. in sight, so just return a
7937 character from current_buffer. */
7938 unsigned char *p;
7939 ptrdiff_t stop;
7941 /* Maybe run the redisplay end trigger hook. Performance note:
7942 This doesn't seem to cost measurable time. */
7943 if (it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos
7944 && it->glyph_row
7945 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos)
7946 run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (it);
7948 stop = it->bidi_it.scan_dir < 0 ? -1 : it->end_charpos;
7949 if (CHAR_COMPOSED_P (it, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it),
7950 stop)
7951 && next_element_from_composition (it))
7953 return 1;
7956 /* Get the next character, maybe multibyte. */
7957 p = BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
7958 if (it->multibyte_p && !ASCII_BYTE_P (*p))
7959 it->c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (p, it->len);
7960 else
7961 it->c = *p, it->len = 1;
7963 /* Record what we have and where it came from. */
7964 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
7965 it->object = it->w->buffer;
7966 it->position = it->current.pos;
7968 /* Normally we return the character found above, except when we
7969 really want to return an ellipsis for selective display. */
7970 if (it->selective)
7972 if (it->c == '\n')
7974 /* A value of selective > 0 means hide lines indented more
7975 than that number of columns. */
7976 if (it->selective > 0
7977 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) + 1 < ZV
7978 && indented_beyond_p (IT_CHARPOS (*it) + 1,
7979 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) + 1,
7980 it->selective))
7982 success_p = next_element_from_ellipsis (it);
7983 it->dpvec_char_len = -1;
7986 else if (it->c == '\r' && it->selective == -1)
7988 /* A value of selective == -1 means that everything from the
7989 CR to the end of the line is invisible, with maybe an
7990 ellipsis displayed for it. */
7991 success_p = next_element_from_ellipsis (it);
7992 it->dpvec_char_len = -1;
7997 /* Value is zero if end of buffer reached. */
7998 eassert (!success_p || it->what != IT_CHARACTER || it->len > 0);
7999 return success_p;
8003 /* Run the redisplay end trigger hook for IT. */
8005 static void
8006 run_redisplay_end_trigger_hook (struct it *it)
8008 Lisp_Object args[3];
8010 /* IT->glyph_row should be non-null, i.e. we should be actually
8011 displaying something, or otherwise we should not run the hook. */
8012 eassert (it->glyph_row);
8014 /* Set up hook arguments. */
8015 args[0] = Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions;
8016 args[1] = it->window;
8017 XSETINT (args[2], it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos);
8018 it->redisplay_end_trigger_charpos = 0;
8020 /* Since we are *trying* to run these functions, don't try to run
8021 them again, even if they get an error. */
8022 wset_redisplay_end_trigger (it->w, Qnil);
8023 Frun_hook_with_args (3, args);
8025 /* Notice if it changed the face of the character we are on. */
8026 handle_face_prop (it);
8030 /* Deliver a composition display element. Unlike the other
8031 next_element_from_XXX, this function is not registered in the array
8032 get_next_element[]. It is called from next_element_from_buffer and
8033 next_element_from_string when necessary. */
8035 static int
8036 next_element_from_composition (struct it *it)
8038 it->what = IT_COMPOSITION;
8039 it->len = it->cmp_it.nbytes;
8040 if (STRINGP (it->string))
8042 if (it->c < 0)
8044 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
8045 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
8046 return 0;
8048 it->position = it->current.string_pos;
8049 it->object = it->string;
8050 it->c = composition_update_it (&it->cmp_it, IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it),
8051 IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it), it->string);
8053 else
8055 if (it->c < 0)
8057 IT_CHARPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nchars;
8058 IT_BYTEPOS (*it) += it->cmp_it.nbytes;
8059 if (it->bidi_p)
8061 if (it->bidi_it.new_paragraph)
8062 bidi_paragraph_init (it->paragraph_embedding, &it->bidi_it, 0);
8063 /* Resync the bidi iterator with IT's new position.
8064 FIXME: this doesn't support bidirectional text. */
8065 while (it->bidi_it.charpos < IT_CHARPOS (*it))
8066 bidi_move_to_visually_next (&it->bidi_it);
8068 return 0;
8070 it->position = it->current.pos;
8071 it->object = it->w->buffer;
8072 it->c = composition_update_it (&it->cmp_it, IT_CHARPOS (*it),
8073 IT_BYTEPOS (*it), Qnil);
8075 return 1;
8080 /***********************************************************************
8081 Moving an iterator without producing glyphs
8082 ***********************************************************************/
8084 /* Check if iterator is at a position corresponding to a valid buffer
8085 position after some move_it_ call. */
8087 #define IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P(it) \
8088 ((it)->method == GET_FROM_STRING \
8089 ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) == 0 \
8090 : 1)
8093 /* Move iterator IT to a specified buffer or X position within one
8094 line on the display without producing glyphs.
8096 OP should be a bit mask including some or all of these bits:
8097 MOVE_TO_X: Stop upon reaching x-position TO_X.
8098 MOVE_TO_POS: Stop upon reaching buffer or string position TO_CHARPOS.
8099 Regardless of OP's value, stop upon reaching the end of the display line.
8101 TO_X is normally a value 0 <= TO_X <= IT->last_visible_x.
8102 This means, in particular, that TO_X includes window's horizontal
8103 scroll amount.
8105 The return value has several possible values that
8106 say what condition caused the scan to stop:
8108 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV
8109 - when TO_POS or ZV was reached.
8111 MOVE_X_REACHED
8112 -when TO_X was reached before TO_POS or ZV were reached.
8114 MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED
8115 - when we reached the end of the display area and the line must
8116 be continued.
8118 MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED
8119 - when we reached the end of the display area and the line is
8120 truncated.
8122 MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR
8123 - when we stopped at a line end, i.e. a newline or a CR and selective
8124 display is on. */
8126 static enum move_it_result
8127 move_it_in_display_line_to (struct it *it,
8128 ptrdiff_t to_charpos, int to_x,
8129 enum move_operation_enum op)
8131 enum move_it_result result = MOVE_UNDEFINED;
8132 struct glyph_row *saved_glyph_row;
8133 struct it wrap_it, atpos_it, atx_it, ppos_it;
8134 void *wrap_data = NULL, *atpos_data = NULL, *atx_data = NULL;
8135 void *ppos_data = NULL;
8136 int may_wrap = 0;
8137 enum it_method prev_method = it->method;
8138 ptrdiff_t prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8139 int saw_smaller_pos = prev_pos < to_charpos;
8141 /* Don't produce glyphs in produce_glyphs. */
8142 saved_glyph_row = it->glyph_row;
8143 it->glyph_row = NULL;
8145 /* Use wrap_it to save a copy of IT wherever a word wrap could
8146 occur. Use atpos_it to save a copy of IT at the desired buffer
8147 position, if found, so that we can scan ahead and check if the
8148 word later overshoots the window edge. Use atx_it similarly, for
8149 pixel positions. */
8150 wrap_it.sp = -1;
8151 atpos_it.sp = -1;
8152 atx_it.sp = -1;
8154 /* Use ppos_it under bidi reordering to save a copy of IT for the
8155 position > CHARPOS that is the closest to CHARPOS. We restore
8156 that position in IT when we have scanned the entire display line
8157 without finding a match for CHARPOS and all the character
8158 positions are greater than CHARPOS. */
8159 if (it->bidi_p)
8161 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8162 SET_TEXT_POS (ppos_it.current.pos, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
8163 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos)
8164 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8167 #define BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P() \
8168 ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0 \
8169 && BUFFERP (it->object) \
8170 && (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == to_charpos \
8171 || ((!it->bidi_p \
8172 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it)) \
8173 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos) \
8174 || (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION \
8175 && ((IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos \
8176 && to_charpos >= it->cmp_it.charpos) \
8177 || (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos \
8178 && to_charpos <= it->cmp_it.charpos)))) \
8179 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER \
8180 || (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR \
8181 && it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index + 1 >= it->dpend)))
8183 /* If there's a line-/wrap-prefix, handle it. */
8184 if (it->hpos == 0 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
8185 && it->current_y < it->last_visible_y)
8186 handle_line_prefix (it);
8188 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8189 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8191 while (1)
8193 int x, i, ascent = 0, descent = 0;
8195 /* Utility macro to reset an iterator with x, ascent, and descent. */
8196 #define IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT(IT) \
8197 ((IT)->current_x = x, (IT)->max_ascent = ascent, \
8198 (IT)->max_descent = descent)
8200 /* Stop if we move beyond TO_CHARPOS (after an image or a
8201 display string or stretch glyph). */
8202 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8203 && BUFFERP (it->object)
8204 && it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
8205 && (((!it->bidi_p
8206 /* When the iterator is at base embedding level, we
8207 are guaranteed that characters are delivered for
8208 display in strictly increasing order of their
8209 buffer positions. */
8210 || BIDI_AT_BASE_LEVEL (it->bidi_it))
8211 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8212 || (it->bidi_p
8213 && (prev_method == GET_FROM_IMAGE
8214 || prev_method == GET_FROM_STRETCH
8215 || prev_method == GET_FROM_STRING)
8216 /* Passed TO_CHARPOS from left to right. */
8217 && ((prev_pos < to_charpos
8218 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8219 /* Passed TO_CHARPOS from right to left. */
8220 || (prev_pos > to_charpos
8221 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos)))))
8223 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8225 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8226 break;
8228 else if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp < 0)
8229 /* If wrap_it is valid, the current position might be in a
8230 word that is wrapped. So, save the iterator in
8231 atpos_it and continue to see if wrapping happens. */
8232 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8235 /* Stop when ZV reached.
8236 We used to stop here when TO_CHARPOS reached as well, but that is
8237 too soon if this glyph does not fit on this line. So we handle it
8238 explicitly below. */
8239 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
8241 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8242 break;
8245 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
8247 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8249 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8250 break;
8253 else
8255 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
8257 if (IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it))
8258 may_wrap = 1;
8259 else if (may_wrap)
8261 /* We have reached a glyph that follows one or more
8262 whitespace characters. If the position is
8263 already found, we are done. */
8264 if (atpos_it.sp >= 0)
8266 RESTORE_IT (it, &atpos_it, atpos_data);
8267 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8268 goto done;
8270 if (atx_it.sp >= 0)
8272 RESTORE_IT (it, &atx_it, atx_data);
8273 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8274 goto done;
8276 /* Otherwise, we can wrap here. */
8277 SAVE_IT (wrap_it, *it, wrap_data);
8278 may_wrap = 0;
8283 /* Remember the line height for the current line, in case
8284 the next element doesn't fit on the line. */
8285 ascent = it->max_ascent;
8286 descent = it->max_descent;
8288 /* The call to produce_glyphs will get the metrics of the
8289 display element IT is loaded with. Record the x-position
8290 before this display element, in case it doesn't fit on the
8291 line. */
8292 x = it->current_x;
8294 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
8296 if (it->area != TEXT_AREA)
8298 prev_method = it->method;
8299 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8300 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8301 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8302 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8303 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos,
8304 IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8305 if (it->bidi_p
8306 && (op & MOVE_TO_POS)
8307 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos
8308 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it))
8309 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8310 continue;
8313 /* The number of glyphs we get back in IT->nglyphs will normally
8314 be 1 except when IT->c is (i) a TAB, or (ii) a multi-glyph
8315 character on a terminal frame, or (iii) a line end. For the
8316 second case, IT->nglyphs - 1 padding glyphs will be present.
8317 (On X frames, there is only one glyph produced for a
8318 composite character.)
8320 The behavior implemented below means, for continuation lines,
8321 that as many spaces of a TAB as fit on the current line are
8322 displayed there. For terminal frames, as many glyphs of a
8323 multi-glyph character are displayed in the current line, too.
8324 This is what the old redisplay code did, and we keep it that
8325 way. Under X, the whole shape of a complex character must
8326 fit on the line or it will be completely displayed in the
8327 next line.
8329 Note that both for tabs and padding glyphs, all glyphs have
8330 the same width. */
8331 if (it->nglyphs)
8333 /* More than one glyph or glyph doesn't fit on line. All
8334 glyphs have the same width. */
8335 int single_glyph_width = it->pixel_width / it->nglyphs;
8336 int new_x;
8337 int x_before_this_char = x;
8338 int hpos_before_this_char = it->hpos;
8340 for (i = 0; i < it->nglyphs; ++i, x = new_x)
8342 new_x = x + single_glyph_width;
8344 /* We want to leave anything reaching TO_X to the caller. */
8345 if ((op & MOVE_TO_X) && new_x > to_x)
8347 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8349 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8350 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8351 if (atpos_it.sp < 0)
8353 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8354 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atpos_it);
8357 else
8359 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8361 it->current_x = x;
8362 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8363 break;
8365 if (atx_it.sp < 0)
8367 SAVE_IT (atx_it, *it, atx_data);
8368 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atx_it);
8373 if (/* Lines are continued. */
8374 it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
8375 && (/* And glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
8376 new_x > it->last_visible_x
8377 /* Or it fits exactly and we're on a window
8378 system frame. */
8379 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
8380 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8381 && ((it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
8382 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
8383 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)))))
8385 if (/* IT->hpos == 0 means the very first glyph
8386 doesn't fit on the line, e.g. a wide image. */
8387 it->hpos == 0
8388 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
8389 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)))
8391 ++it->hpos;
8392 it->current_x = new_x;
8394 /* The character's last glyph just barely fits
8395 in this row. */
8396 if (i == it->nglyphs - 1)
8398 /* If this is the destination position,
8399 return a position *before* it in this row,
8400 now that we know it fits in this row. */
8401 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8403 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP
8404 || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8406 it->hpos = hpos_before_this_char;
8407 it->current_x = x_before_this_char;
8408 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8409 break;
8411 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP
8412 && atpos_it.sp < 0)
8414 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8415 atpos_it.current_x = x_before_this_char;
8416 atpos_it.hpos = hpos_before_this_char;
8420 prev_method = it->method;
8421 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8422 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8423 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8424 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8425 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos,
8426 IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8427 /* On graphical terminals, newlines may
8428 "overflow" into the fringe if
8429 overflow-newline-into-fringe is non-nil.
8430 On text terminals, and on graphical
8431 terminals with no right margin, newlines
8432 may overflow into the last glyph on the
8433 display line.*/
8434 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8435 || ((it->bidi_p
8436 && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
8437 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
8438 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0
8439 || IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
8441 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
8443 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8444 break;
8446 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8448 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8449 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8450 else
8451 result = MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED;
8452 break;
8454 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8456 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8457 break;
8462 else
8463 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (it);
8465 if (wrap_it.sp >= 0)
8467 RESTORE_IT (it, &wrap_it, wrap_data);
8468 atpos_it.sp = -1;
8469 atx_it.sp = -1;
8472 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_in: continued at %d\n",
8473 IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8474 result = MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED;
8475 break;
8478 if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8480 if (it->line_wrap != WORD_WRAP || wrap_it.sp < 0)
8481 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8482 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp < 0)
8484 SAVE_IT (atpos_it, *it, atpos_data);
8485 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (&atpos_it);
8489 if (new_x > it->first_visible_x)
8491 /* Glyph is visible. Increment number of glyphs that
8492 would be displayed. */
8493 ++it->hpos;
8497 if (result != MOVE_UNDEFINED)
8498 break;
8500 else if (BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ())
8502 buffer_pos_reached:
8503 IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT (it);
8504 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8505 break;
8507 else if ((op & MOVE_TO_X) && it->current_x >= to_x)
8509 /* Stop when TO_X specified and reached. This check is
8510 necessary here because of lines consisting of a line end,
8511 only. The line end will not produce any glyphs and we
8512 would never get MOVE_X_REACHED. */
8513 eassert (it->nglyphs == 0);
8514 result = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8515 break;
8518 /* Is this a line end? If yes, we're done. */
8519 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8521 /* If we are past TO_CHARPOS, but never saw any character
8522 positions smaller than TO_CHARPOS, return
8523 MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV, like the unidirectional display
8524 did. */
8525 if (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0)
8527 if (!saw_smaller_pos && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8529 if (IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8531 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8532 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8534 else
8535 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8537 else if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && atpos_it.sp >= 0
8538 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8539 goto buffer_pos_reached;
8540 else
8541 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8543 else
8544 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8545 break;
8548 prev_method = it->method;
8549 if (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER)
8550 prev_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8551 /* The current display element has been consumed. Advance
8552 to the next. */
8553 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8554 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos))
8555 SET_TEXT_POS (this_line_min_pos, IT_CHARPOS (*it), IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
8556 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) < to_charpos)
8557 saw_smaller_pos = 1;
8558 if (it->bidi_p
8559 && (op & MOVE_TO_POS)
8560 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos
8561 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it))
8562 SAVE_IT (ppos_it, *it, ppos_data);
8564 /* Stop if lines are truncated and IT's current x-position is
8565 past the right edge of the window now. */
8566 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
8567 && it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
8569 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8570 || ((it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
8571 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
8572 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0
8573 || IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
8575 int at_eob_p = 0;
8577 if ((at_eob_p = !get_next_display_element (it))
8578 || BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P ()
8579 /* If we are past TO_CHARPOS, but never saw any
8580 character positions smaller than TO_CHARPOS,
8581 return MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV, like the
8582 unidirectional display did. */
8583 || (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8584 && !saw_smaller_pos
8585 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos))
8587 if (it->bidi_p
8588 && !at_eob_p && IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8589 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8590 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8591 break;
8593 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
8595 result = MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR;
8596 break;
8599 else if (it->bidi_p && (op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8600 && !saw_smaller_pos
8601 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8603 if (IT_CHARPOS (ppos_it) < ZV)
8604 RESTORE_IT (it, &ppos_it, ppos_data);
8605 result = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8606 break;
8608 result = MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED;
8609 break;
8611 #undef IT_RESET_X_ASCENT_DESCENT
8614 #undef BUFFER_POS_REACHED_P
8616 /* If we scanned beyond to_pos and didn't find a point to wrap at,
8617 restore the saved iterator. */
8618 if (atpos_it.sp >= 0)
8619 RESTORE_IT (it, &atpos_it, atpos_data);
8620 else if (atx_it.sp >= 0)
8621 RESTORE_IT (it, &atx_it, atx_data);
8623 done:
8625 if (atpos_data)
8626 bidi_unshelve_cache (atpos_data, 1);
8627 if (atx_data)
8628 bidi_unshelve_cache (atx_data, 1);
8629 if (wrap_data)
8630 bidi_unshelve_cache (wrap_data, 1);
8631 if (ppos_data)
8632 bidi_unshelve_cache (ppos_data, 1);
8634 /* Restore the iterator settings altered at the beginning of this
8635 function. */
8636 it->glyph_row = saved_glyph_row;
8637 return result;
8640 /* For external use. */
8641 void
8642 move_it_in_display_line (struct it *it,
8643 ptrdiff_t to_charpos, int to_x,
8644 enum move_operation_enum op)
8646 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP
8647 && (op & MOVE_TO_X))
8649 struct it save_it;
8650 void *save_data = NULL;
8651 int skip;
8653 SAVE_IT (save_it, *it, save_data);
8654 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8655 /* When word-wrap is on, TO_X may lie past the end
8656 of a wrapped line. Then it->current is the
8657 character on the next line, so backtrack to the
8658 space before the wrap point. */
8659 if (skip == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED)
8661 int prev_x = max (it->current_x - 1, 0);
8662 RESTORE_IT (it, &save_it, save_data);
8663 move_it_in_display_line_to
8664 (it, -1, prev_x, MOVE_TO_X);
8666 else
8667 bidi_unshelve_cache (save_data, 1);
8669 else
8670 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8674 /* Move IT forward until it satisfies one or more of the criteria in
8675 TO_CHARPOS, TO_X, TO_Y, and TO_VPOS.
8677 OP is a bit-mask that specifies where to stop, and in particular,
8678 which of those four position arguments makes a difference. See the
8679 description of enum move_operation_enum.
8681 If TO_CHARPOS is in invisible text, e.g. a truncated part of a
8682 screen line, this function will set IT to the next position that is
8683 displayed to the right of TO_CHARPOS on the screen. */
8685 void
8686 move_it_to (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t to_charpos, int to_x, int to_y, int to_vpos, int op)
8688 enum move_it_result skip, skip2 = MOVE_X_REACHED;
8689 int line_height, line_start_x = 0, reached = 0;
8690 void *backup_data = NULL;
8692 for (;;)
8694 if (op & MOVE_TO_VPOS)
8696 /* If no TO_CHARPOS and no TO_X specified, stop at the
8697 start of the line TO_VPOS. */
8698 if ((op & (MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_POS)) == 0)
8700 if (it->vpos == to_vpos)
8702 reached = 1;
8703 break;
8705 else
8706 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, -1, -1, 0);
8708 else
8710 /* TO_VPOS >= 0 means stop at TO_X in the line at
8711 TO_VPOS, or at TO_POS, whichever comes first. */
8712 if (it->vpos == to_vpos)
8714 reached = 2;
8715 break;
8718 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, to_x, op);
8720 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV || it->vpos == to_vpos)
8722 reached = 3;
8723 break;
8725 else if (skip == MOVE_X_REACHED && it->vpos != to_vpos)
8727 /* We have reached TO_X but not in the line we want. */
8728 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos,
8729 -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
8730 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8732 reached = 4;
8733 break;
8738 else if (op & MOVE_TO_Y)
8740 struct it it_backup;
8742 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
8743 SAVE_IT (it_backup, *it, backup_data);
8745 /* TO_Y specified means stop at TO_X in the line containing
8746 TO_Y---or at TO_CHARPOS if this is reached first. The
8747 problem is that we can't really tell whether the line
8748 contains TO_Y before we have completely scanned it, and
8749 this may skip past TO_X. What we do is to first scan to
8750 TO_X.
8752 If TO_X is not specified, use a TO_X of zero. The reason
8753 is to make the outcome of this function more predictable.
8754 If we didn't use TO_X == 0, we would stop at the end of
8755 the line which is probably not what a caller would expect
8756 to happen. */
8757 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to
8758 (it, to_charpos, ((op & MOVE_TO_X) ? to_x : 0),
8759 (MOVE_TO_X | (op & MOVE_TO_POS)));
8761 /* If TO_CHARPOS is reached or ZV, we don't have to do more. */
8762 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8763 reached = 5;
8764 else if (skip == MOVE_X_REACHED)
8766 /* If TO_X was reached, we want to know whether TO_Y is
8767 in the line. We know this is the case if the already
8768 scanned glyphs make the line tall enough. Otherwise,
8769 we must check by scanning the rest of the line. */
8770 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8771 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8772 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8774 reached = 6;
8775 break;
8777 SAVE_IT (it_backup, *it, backup_data);
8778 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: from %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8779 skip2 = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, -1,
8780 op & MOVE_TO_POS);
8781 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: to %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
8782 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8783 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: line_height = %d\n", line_height));
8785 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8786 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8788 /* If TO_Y is in this line and TO_X was reached
8789 above, we scanned too far. We have to restore
8790 IT's settings to the ones before skipping. But
8791 keep the more accurate values of max_ascent and
8792 max_descent we've found while skipping the rest
8793 of the line, for the sake of callers, such as
8794 pos_visible_p, that need to know the line
8795 height. */
8796 int max_ascent = it->max_ascent;
8797 int max_descent = it->max_descent;
8799 RESTORE_IT (it, &it_backup, backup_data);
8800 it->max_ascent = max_ascent;
8801 it->max_descent = max_descent;
8802 reached = 6;
8804 else
8806 skip = skip2;
8807 if (skip == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV)
8808 reached = 7;
8811 else
8813 /* Check whether TO_Y is in this line. */
8814 line_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8815 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it: line_height = %d\n", line_height));
8817 if (to_y >= it->current_y
8818 && to_y < it->current_y + line_height)
8820 /* When word-wrap is on, TO_X may lie past the end
8821 of a wrapped line. Then it->current is the
8822 character on the next line, so backtrack to the
8823 space before the wrap point. */
8824 if (skip == MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED
8825 && it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP)
8827 int prev_x = max (it->current_x - 1, 0);
8828 RESTORE_IT (it, &it_backup, backup_data);
8829 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to
8830 (it, -1, prev_x, MOVE_TO_X);
8832 reached = 6;
8836 if (reached)
8837 break;
8839 else if (BUFFERP (it->object)
8840 && (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
8841 || it->method == GET_FROM_STRETCH)
8842 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= to_charpos
8843 /* Under bidi iteration, a call to set_iterator_to_next
8844 can scan far beyond to_charpos if the initial
8845 portion of the next line needs to be reordered. In
8846 that case, give move_it_in_display_line_to another
8847 chance below. */
8848 && !(it->bidi_p
8849 && it->bidi_it.scan_dir == -1))
8850 skip = MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV;
8851 else
8852 skip = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, to_charpos, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
8854 switch (skip)
8856 case MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV:
8857 reached = 8;
8858 goto out;
8860 case MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR:
8861 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
8862 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
8863 break;
8865 case MOVE_LINE_TRUNCATED:
8866 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
8867 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
8868 if ((op & MOVE_TO_POS) != 0
8869 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > to_charpos)
8871 reached = 9;
8872 goto out;
8874 break;
8876 case MOVE_LINE_CONTINUED:
8877 /* For continued lines ending in a tab, some of the glyphs
8878 associated with the tab are displayed on the current
8879 line. Since it->current_x does not include these glyphs,
8880 we use it->last_visible_x instead. */
8881 if (it->c == '\t')
8883 it->continuation_lines_width += it->last_visible_x;
8884 /* When moving by vpos, ensure that the iterator really
8885 advances to the next line (bug#847, bug#969). Fixme:
8886 do we need to do this in other circumstances? */
8887 if (it->current_x != it->last_visible_x
8888 && (op & MOVE_TO_VPOS)
8889 && !(op & (MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_POS)))
8891 line_start_x = it->current_x + it->pixel_width
8892 - it->last_visible_x;
8893 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
8896 else
8897 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
8898 break;
8900 default:
8901 abort ();
8904 /* Reset/increment for the next run. */
8905 recenter_overlay_lists (current_buffer, IT_CHARPOS (*it));
8906 it->current_x = line_start_x;
8907 line_start_x = 0;
8908 it->hpos = 0;
8909 it->current_y += it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8910 ++it->vpos;
8911 last_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8912 last_max_ascent = it->max_ascent;
8913 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
8916 out:
8918 /* On text terminals, we may stop at the end of a line in the middle
8919 of a multi-character glyph. If the glyph itself is continued,
8920 i.e. it is actually displayed on the next line, don't treat this
8921 stopping point as valid; move to the next line instead (unless
8922 that brings us offscreen). */
8923 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
8924 && op & MOVE_TO_POS
8925 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) == to_charpos
8926 && it->what == IT_CHARACTER
8927 && it->nglyphs > 1
8928 && it->line_wrap == WINDOW_WRAP
8929 && it->current_x == it->last_visible_x - 1
8930 && it->c != '\n'
8931 && it->c != '\t'
8932 && it->vpos < XFASTINT (it->w->window_end_vpos))
8934 it->continuation_lines_width += it->current_x;
8935 it->current_x = it->hpos = it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
8936 it->current_y += it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8937 ++it->vpos;
8938 last_height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
8939 last_max_ascent = it->max_ascent;
8942 if (backup_data)
8943 bidi_unshelve_cache (backup_data, 1);
8945 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_to: reached %d\n", reached));
8949 /* Move iterator IT backward by a specified y-distance DY, DY >= 0.
8951 If DY > 0, move IT backward at least that many pixels. DY = 0
8952 means move IT backward to the preceding line start or BEGV. This
8953 function may move over more than DY pixels if IT->current_y - DY
8954 ends up in the middle of a line; in this case IT->current_y will be
8955 set to the top of the line moved to. */
8957 void
8958 move_it_vertically_backward (struct it *it, int dy)
8960 int nlines, h;
8961 struct it it2, it3;
8962 void *it2data = NULL, *it3data = NULL;
8963 ptrdiff_t start_pos;
8965 move_further_back:
8966 eassert (dy >= 0);
8968 start_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
8970 /* Estimate how many newlines we must move back. */
8971 nlines = max (1, dy / FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
8973 /* Set the iterator's position that many lines back. */
8974 while (nlines-- && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
8975 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
8977 /* Reseat the iterator here. When moving backward, we don't want
8978 reseat to skip forward over invisible text, set up the iterator
8979 to deliver from overlay strings at the new position etc. So,
8980 use reseat_1 here. */
8981 reseat_1 (it, it->current.pos, 1);
8983 /* We are now surely at a line start. */
8984 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0; /* FIXME: this is incorrect when bidi
8985 reordering is in effect. */
8986 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
8988 /* Move forward and see what y-distance we moved. First move to the
8989 start of the next line so that we get its height. We need this
8990 height to be able to tell whether we reached the specified
8991 y-distance. */
8992 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
8993 it2.max_ascent = it2.max_descent = 0;
8996 move_it_to (&it2, start_pos, -1, -1, it2.vpos + 1,
8997 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_VPOS);
8999 while (!(IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (&it2)
9000 /* If we are in a display string which starts at START_POS,
9001 and that display string includes a newline, and we are
9002 right after that newline (i.e. at the beginning of a
9003 display line), exit the loop, because otherwise we will
9004 infloop, since move_it_to will see that it is already at
9005 START_POS and will not move. */
9006 || (it2.method == GET_FROM_STRING
9007 && IT_CHARPOS (it2) == start_pos
9008 && SREF (it2.string, IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (it2) - 1) == '\n')));
9009 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
9010 SAVE_IT (it3, it2, it3data);
9012 move_it_to (&it2, start_pos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9013 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= BEGV);
9014 /* H is the actual vertical distance from the position in *IT
9015 and the starting position. */
9016 h = it2.current_y - it->current_y;
9017 /* NLINES is the distance in number of lines. */
9018 nlines = it2.vpos - it->vpos;
9020 /* Correct IT's y and vpos position
9021 so that they are relative to the starting point. */
9022 it->vpos -= nlines;
9023 it->current_y -= h;
9025 if (dy == 0)
9027 /* DY == 0 means move to the start of the screen line. The
9028 value of nlines is > 0 if continuation lines were involved,
9029 or if the original IT position was at start of a line. */
9030 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
9031 if (nlines > 0)
9032 move_it_by_lines (it, nlines);
9033 /* The above code moves us to some position NLINES down,
9034 usually to its first glyph (leftmost in an L2R line), but
9035 that's not necessarily the start of the line, under bidi
9036 reordering. We want to get to the character position
9037 that is immediately after the newline of the previous
9038 line. */
9039 if (it->bidi_p
9040 && !it->continuation_lines_width
9041 && !STRINGP (it->string)
9042 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV
9043 && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n')
9045 ptrdiff_t nl_pos =
9046 find_next_newline_no_quit (IT_CHARPOS (*it) - 1, -1);
9048 move_it_to (it, nl_pos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9050 bidi_unshelve_cache (it3data, 1);
9052 else
9054 /* The y-position we try to reach, relative to *IT.
9055 Note that H has been subtracted in front of the if-statement. */
9056 int target_y = it->current_y + h - dy;
9057 int y0 = it3.current_y;
9058 int y1;
9059 int line_height;
9061 RESTORE_IT (&it3, &it3, it3data);
9062 y1 = line_bottom_y (&it3);
9063 line_height = y1 - y0;
9064 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
9065 /* If we did not reach target_y, try to move further backward if
9066 we can. If we moved too far backward, try to move forward. */
9067 if (target_y < it->current_y
9068 /* This is heuristic. In a window that's 3 lines high, with
9069 a line height of 13 pixels each, recentering with point
9070 on the bottom line will try to move -39/2 = 19 pixels
9071 backward. Try to avoid moving into the first line. */
9072 && (it->current_y - target_y
9073 > min (window_box_height (it->w), line_height * 2 / 3))
9074 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV)
9076 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, " not far enough -> move_vert %d\n",
9077 target_y - it->current_y));
9078 dy = it->current_y - target_y;
9079 goto move_further_back;
9081 else if (target_y >= it->current_y + line_height
9082 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV)
9084 /* Should move forward by at least one line, maybe more.
9086 Note: Calling move_it_by_lines can be expensive on
9087 terminal frames, where compute_motion is used (via
9088 vmotion) to do the job, when there are very long lines
9089 and truncate-lines is nil. That's the reason for
9090 treating terminal frames specially here. */
9092 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
9093 move_it_vertically (it, target_y - (it->current_y + line_height));
9094 else
9098 move_it_by_lines (it, 1);
9100 while (target_y >= line_bottom_y (it) && IT_CHARPOS (*it) < ZV);
9107 /* Move IT by a specified amount of pixel lines DY. DY negative means
9108 move backwards. DY = 0 means move to start of screen line. At the
9109 end, IT will be on the start of a screen line. */
9111 void
9112 move_it_vertically (struct it *it, int dy)
9114 if (dy <= 0)
9115 move_it_vertically_backward (it, -dy);
9116 else
9118 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_v: from %d, %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it), dy));
9119 move_it_to (it, ZV, -1, it->current_y + dy, -1,
9120 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
9121 TRACE_MOVE ((stderr, "move_it_v: to %d\n", IT_CHARPOS (*it)));
9123 /* If buffer ends in ZV without a newline, move to the start of
9124 the line to satisfy the post-condition. */
9125 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == ZV
9126 && ZV > BEGV
9127 && FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n')
9128 move_it_by_lines (it, 0);
9133 /* Move iterator IT past the end of the text line it is in. */
9135 void
9136 move_it_past_eol (struct it *it)
9138 enum move_it_result rc;
9140 rc = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, Z, 0, MOVE_TO_POS);
9141 if (rc == MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR)
9142 set_iterator_to_next (it, 0);
9146 /* Move IT by a specified number DVPOS of screen lines down. DVPOS
9147 negative means move up. DVPOS == 0 means move to the start of the
9148 screen line.
9150 Optimization idea: If we would know that IT->f doesn't use
9151 a face with proportional font, we could be faster for
9152 truncate-lines nil. */
9154 void
9155 move_it_by_lines (struct it *it, ptrdiff_t dvpos)
9158 /* The commented-out optimization uses vmotion on terminals. This
9159 gives bad results, because elements like it->what, on which
9160 callers such as pos_visible_p rely, aren't updated. */
9161 /* struct position pos;
9162 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
9164 struct text_pos textpos;
9166 pos = *vmotion (IT_CHARPOS (*it), dvpos, it->w);
9167 SET_TEXT_POS (textpos, pos.bufpos, pos.bytepos);
9168 reseat (it, textpos, 1);
9169 it->vpos += pos.vpos;
9170 it->current_y += pos.vpos;
9172 else */
9174 if (dvpos == 0)
9176 /* DVPOS == 0 means move to the start of the screen line. */
9177 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
9178 /* Let next call to line_bottom_y calculate real line height */
9179 last_height = 0;
9181 else if (dvpos > 0)
9183 move_it_to (it, -1, -1, -1, it->vpos + dvpos, MOVE_TO_VPOS);
9184 if (!IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
9186 /* Only move to the next buffer position if we ended up in a
9187 string from display property, not in an overlay string
9188 (before-string or after-string). That is because the
9189 latter don't conceal the underlying buffer position, so
9190 we can ask to move the iterator to the exact position we
9191 are interested in. Note that, even if we are already at
9192 IT_CHARPOS (*it), the call below is not a no-op, as it
9193 will detect that we are at the end of the string, pop the
9194 iterator, and compute it->current_x and it->hpos
9195 correctly. */
9196 move_it_to (it, IT_CHARPOS (*it) + it->string_from_display_prop_p,
9197 -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9200 else
9202 struct it it2;
9203 void *it2data = NULL;
9204 ptrdiff_t start_charpos, i;
9206 /* Start at the beginning of the screen line containing IT's
9207 position. This may actually move vertically backwards,
9208 in case of overlays, so adjust dvpos accordingly. */
9209 dvpos += it->vpos;
9210 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
9211 dvpos -= it->vpos;
9213 /* Go back -DVPOS visible lines and reseat the iterator there. */
9214 start_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
9215 for (i = -dvpos; i > 0 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) > BEGV; --i)
9216 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
9217 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
9219 /* Move further back if we end up in a string or an image. */
9220 while (!IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
9222 /* First try to move to start of display line. */
9223 dvpos += it->vpos;
9224 move_it_vertically_backward (it, 0);
9225 dvpos -= it->vpos;
9226 if (IT_POS_VALID_AFTER_MOVE_P (it))
9227 break;
9228 /* If start of line is still in string or image,
9229 move further back. */
9230 back_to_previous_visible_line_start (it);
9231 reseat (it, it->current.pos, 1);
9232 dvpos--;
9235 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
9237 /* Above call may have moved too far if continuation lines
9238 are involved. Scan forward and see if it did. */
9239 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
9240 it2.vpos = it2.current_y = 0;
9241 move_it_to (&it2, start_charpos, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
9242 it->vpos -= it2.vpos;
9243 it->current_y -= it2.current_y;
9244 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
9246 /* If we moved too far back, move IT some lines forward. */
9247 if (it2.vpos > -dvpos)
9249 int delta = it2.vpos + dvpos;
9251 RESTORE_IT (&it2, &it2, it2data);
9252 SAVE_IT (it2, *it, it2data);
9253 move_it_to (it, -1, -1, -1, it->vpos + delta, MOVE_TO_VPOS);
9254 /* Move back again if we got too far ahead. */
9255 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) >= start_charpos)
9256 RESTORE_IT (it, &it2, it2data);
9257 else
9258 bidi_unshelve_cache (it2data, 1);
9260 else
9261 RESTORE_IT (it, it, it2data);
9265 /* Return 1 if IT points into the middle of a display vector. */
9268 in_display_vector_p (struct it *it)
9270 return (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
9271 && it->current.dpvec_index > 0
9272 && it->dpvec + it->current.dpvec_index != it->dpend);
9276 /***********************************************************************
9277 Messages
9278 ***********************************************************************/
9281 /* Add a message with format string FORMAT and arguments ARG1 and ARG2
9282 to *Messages*. */
9284 void
9285 add_to_log (const char *format, Lisp_Object arg1, Lisp_Object arg2)
9287 Lisp_Object args[3];
9288 Lisp_Object msg, fmt;
9289 char *buffer;
9290 ptrdiff_t len;
9291 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2, gcpro3, gcpro4;
9292 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
9294 /* Do nothing if called asynchronously. Inserting text into
9295 a buffer may call after-change-functions and alike and
9296 that would means running Lisp asynchronously. */
9297 if (handling_signal)
9298 return;
9300 fmt = msg = Qnil;
9301 GCPRO4 (fmt, msg, arg1, arg2);
9303 args[0] = fmt = build_string (format);
9304 args[1] = arg1;
9305 args[2] = arg2;
9306 msg = Fformat (3, args);
9308 len = SBYTES (msg) + 1;
9309 buffer = SAFE_ALLOCA (len);
9310 memcpy (buffer, SDATA (msg), len);
9312 message_dolog (buffer, len - 1, 1, 0);
9313 SAFE_FREE ();
9315 UNGCPRO;
9319 /* Output a newline in the *Messages* buffer if "needs" one. */
9321 void
9322 message_log_maybe_newline (void)
9324 if (message_log_need_newline)
9325 message_dolog ("", 0, 1, 0);
9329 /* Add a string M of length NBYTES to the message log, optionally
9330 terminated with a newline when NLFLAG is non-zero. MULTIBYTE, if
9331 nonzero, means interpret the contents of M as multibyte. This
9332 function calls low-level routines in order to bypass text property
9333 hooks, etc. which might not be safe to run.
9335 This may GC (insert may run before/after change hooks),
9336 so the buffer M must NOT point to a Lisp string. */
9338 void
9339 message_dolog (const char *m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int nlflag, int multibyte)
9341 const unsigned char *msg = (const unsigned char *) m;
9343 if (!NILP (Vmemory_full))
9344 return;
9346 if (!NILP (Vmessage_log_max))
9348 struct buffer *oldbuf;
9349 Lisp_Object oldpoint, oldbegv, oldzv;
9350 int old_windows_or_buffers_changed = windows_or_buffers_changed;
9351 ptrdiff_t point_at_end = 0;
9352 ptrdiff_t zv_at_end = 0;
9353 Lisp_Object old_deactivate_mark, tem;
9354 struct gcpro gcpro1;
9356 old_deactivate_mark = Vdeactivate_mark;
9357 oldbuf = current_buffer;
9358 Fset_buffer (Fget_buffer_create (Vmessages_buffer_name));
9359 bset_undo_list (current_buffer, Qt);
9361 oldpoint = message_dolog_marker1;
9362 set_marker_restricted (oldpoint, make_number (PT), Qnil);
9363 oldbegv = message_dolog_marker2;
9364 set_marker_restricted (oldbegv, make_number (BEGV), Qnil);
9365 oldzv = message_dolog_marker3;
9366 set_marker_restricted (oldzv, make_number (ZV), Qnil);
9367 GCPRO1 (old_deactivate_mark);
9369 if (PT == Z)
9370 point_at_end = 1;
9371 if (ZV == Z)
9372 zv_at_end = 1;
9374 BEGV = BEG;
9375 BEGV_BYTE = BEG_BYTE;
9376 ZV = Z;
9377 ZV_BYTE = Z_BYTE;
9378 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
9380 /* Insert the string--maybe converting multibyte to single byte
9381 or vice versa, so that all the text fits the buffer. */
9382 if (multibyte
9383 && NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
9385 ptrdiff_t i;
9386 int c, char_bytes;
9387 char work[1];
9389 /* Convert a multibyte string to single-byte
9390 for the *Message* buffer. */
9391 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += char_bytes)
9393 c = string_char_and_length (msg + i, &char_bytes);
9394 work[0] = (ASCII_CHAR_P (c)
9396 : multibyte_char_to_unibyte (c));
9397 insert_1_both (work, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0);
9400 else if (! multibyte
9401 && ! NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
9403 ptrdiff_t i;
9404 int c, char_bytes;
9405 unsigned char str[MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH];
9406 /* Convert a single-byte string to multibyte
9407 for the *Message* buffer. */
9408 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
9410 c = msg[i];
9411 MAKE_CHAR_MULTIBYTE (c);
9412 char_bytes = CHAR_STRING (c, str);
9413 insert_1_both ((char *) str, 1, char_bytes, 1, 0, 0);
9416 else if (nbytes)
9417 insert_1 (m, nbytes, 1, 0, 0);
9419 if (nlflag)
9421 ptrdiff_t this_bol, this_bol_byte, prev_bol, prev_bol_byte;
9422 printmax_t dups;
9423 insert_1 ("\n", 1, 1, 0, 0);
9425 scan_newline (Z, Z_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE, -2, 0);
9426 this_bol = PT;
9427 this_bol_byte = PT_BYTE;
9429 /* See if this line duplicates the previous one.
9430 If so, combine duplicates. */
9431 if (this_bol > BEG)
9433 scan_newline (PT, PT_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE, -2, 0);
9434 prev_bol = PT;
9435 prev_bol_byte = PT_BYTE;
9437 dups = message_log_check_duplicate (prev_bol_byte,
9438 this_bol_byte);
9439 if (dups)
9441 del_range_both (prev_bol, prev_bol_byte,
9442 this_bol, this_bol_byte, 0);
9443 if (dups > 1)
9445 char dupstr[sizeof " [ times]"
9446 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (printmax_t)];
9448 /* If you change this format, don't forget to also
9449 change message_log_check_duplicate. */
9450 int duplen = sprintf (dupstr, " [%"pMd" times]", dups);
9451 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z - 1, Z_BYTE - 1);
9452 insert_1 (dupstr, duplen, 1, 0, 1);
9457 /* If we have more than the desired maximum number of lines
9458 in the *Messages* buffer now, delete the oldest ones.
9459 This is safe because we don't have undo in this buffer. */
9461 if (NATNUMP (Vmessage_log_max))
9463 scan_newline (Z, Z_BYTE, BEG, BEG_BYTE,
9464 -XFASTINT (Vmessage_log_max) - 1, 0);
9465 del_range_both (BEG, BEG_BYTE, PT, PT_BYTE, 0);
9468 BEGV = XMARKER (oldbegv)->charpos;
9469 BEGV_BYTE = marker_byte_position (oldbegv);
9471 if (zv_at_end)
9473 ZV = Z;
9474 ZV_BYTE = Z_BYTE;
9476 else
9478 ZV = XMARKER (oldzv)->charpos;
9479 ZV_BYTE = marker_byte_position (oldzv);
9482 if (point_at_end)
9483 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
9484 else
9485 /* We can't do Fgoto_char (oldpoint) because it will run some
9486 Lisp code. */
9487 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (XMARKER (oldpoint)->charpos,
9488 XMARKER (oldpoint)->bytepos);
9490 UNGCPRO;
9491 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldpoint));
9492 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldbegv));
9493 unchain_marker (XMARKER (oldzv));
9495 tem = Fget_buffer_window (Fcurrent_buffer (), Qt);
9496 set_buffer_internal (oldbuf);
9497 if (NILP (tem))
9498 windows_or_buffers_changed = old_windows_or_buffers_changed;
9499 message_log_need_newline = !nlflag;
9500 Vdeactivate_mark = old_deactivate_mark;
9505 /* We are at the end of the buffer after just having inserted a newline.
9506 (Note: We depend on the fact we won't be crossing the gap.)
9507 Check to see if the most recent message looks a lot like the previous one.
9508 Return 0 if different, 1 if the new one should just replace it, or a
9509 value N > 1 if we should also append " [N times]". */
9511 static intmax_t
9512 message_log_check_duplicate (ptrdiff_t prev_bol_byte, ptrdiff_t this_bol_byte)
9514 ptrdiff_t i;
9515 ptrdiff_t len = Z_BYTE - 1 - this_bol_byte;
9516 int seen_dots = 0;
9517 unsigned char *p1 = BUF_BYTE_ADDRESS (current_buffer, prev_bol_byte);
9518 unsigned char *p2 = BUF_BYTE_ADDRESS (current_buffer, this_bol_byte);
9520 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
9522 if (i >= 3 && p1[i-3] == '.' && p1[i-2] == '.' && p1[i-1] == '.')
9523 seen_dots = 1;
9524 if (p1[i] != p2[i])
9525 return seen_dots;
9527 p1 += len;
9528 if (*p1 == '\n')
9529 return 2;
9530 if (*p1++ == ' ' && *p1++ == '[')
9532 char *pend;
9533 intmax_t n = strtoimax ((char *) p1, &pend, 10);
9534 if (0 < n && n < INTMAX_MAX && strncmp (pend, " times]\n", 8) == 0)
9535 return n+1;
9537 return 0;
9541 /* Display an echo area message M with a specified length of NBYTES
9542 bytes. The string may include null characters. If M is 0, clear
9543 out any existing message, and let the mini-buffer text show
9544 through.
9546 This may GC, so the buffer M must NOT point to a Lisp string. */
9548 void
9549 message2 (const char *m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte)
9551 /* First flush out any partial line written with print. */
9552 message_log_maybe_newline ();
9553 if (m)
9554 message_dolog (m, nbytes, 1, multibyte);
9555 message2_nolog (m, nbytes, multibyte);
9559 /* The non-logging counterpart of message2. */
9561 void
9562 message2_nolog (const char *m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte)
9564 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9565 message_enable_multibyte = multibyte;
9567 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (sf))
9569 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9570 putc ('\n', stderr);
9571 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9572 if (m)
9573 fwrite (m, nbytes, 1, stderr);
9574 if (cursor_in_echo_area == 0)
9575 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9576 fflush (stderr);
9578 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9579 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9580 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
9581 else if (INTERACTIVE
9582 && sf->glyphs_initialized_p
9583 && FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (sf))
9585 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9586 struct frame *f;
9588 /* Get the frame containing the mini-buffer
9589 that the selected frame is using. */
9590 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9591 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9593 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9594 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf)
9595 && ! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9596 Fmake_frame_visible (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9598 if (m)
9600 set_message (m, Qnil, nbytes, multibyte);
9601 if (minibuffer_auto_raise)
9602 Fraise_frame (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9604 else
9605 clear_message (1, 1);
9607 do_pending_window_change (0);
9608 echo_area_display (1);
9609 do_pending_window_change (0);
9610 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook != 0 && ! gc_in_progress)
9611 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook) (f);
9616 /* Display an echo area message M with a specified length of NBYTES
9617 bytes. The string may include null characters. If M is not a
9618 string, clear out any existing message, and let the mini-buffer
9619 text show through.
9621 This function cancels echoing. */
9623 void
9624 message3 (Lisp_Object m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte)
9626 struct gcpro gcpro1;
9628 GCPRO1 (m);
9629 clear_message (1,1);
9630 cancel_echoing ();
9632 /* First flush out any partial line written with print. */
9633 message_log_maybe_newline ();
9634 if (STRINGP (m))
9636 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
9637 char *buffer = SAFE_ALLOCA (nbytes);
9638 memcpy (buffer, SDATA (m), nbytes);
9639 message_dolog (buffer, nbytes, 1, multibyte);
9640 SAFE_FREE ();
9642 message3_nolog (m, nbytes, multibyte);
9644 UNGCPRO;
9648 /* The non-logging version of message3.
9649 This does not cancel echoing, because it is used for echoing.
9650 Perhaps we need to make a separate function for echoing
9651 and make this cancel echoing. */
9653 void
9654 message3_nolog (Lisp_Object m, ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte)
9656 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9657 message_enable_multibyte = multibyte;
9659 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (sf))
9661 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9662 putc ('\n', stderr);
9663 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9664 if (STRINGP (m))
9665 fwrite (SDATA (m), nbytes, 1, stderr);
9666 if (cursor_in_echo_area == 0)
9667 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9668 fflush (stderr);
9670 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9671 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9672 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
9673 else if (INTERACTIVE
9674 && sf->glyphs_initialized_p
9675 && FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (sf))
9677 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9678 Lisp_Object frame;
9679 struct frame *f;
9681 /* Get the frame containing the mini-buffer
9682 that the selected frame is using. */
9683 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9684 frame = XWINDOW (mini_window)->frame;
9685 f = XFRAME (frame);
9687 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9688 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf)
9689 && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9690 Fmake_frame_visible (frame);
9692 if (STRINGP (m) && SCHARS (m) > 0)
9694 set_message (NULL, m, nbytes, multibyte);
9695 if (minibuffer_auto_raise)
9696 Fraise_frame (frame);
9697 /* Assume we are not echoing.
9698 (If we are, echo_now will override this.) */
9699 echo_message_buffer = Qnil;
9701 else
9702 clear_message (1, 1);
9704 do_pending_window_change (0);
9705 echo_area_display (1);
9706 do_pending_window_change (0);
9707 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook != 0 && ! gc_in_progress)
9708 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook) (f);
9713 /* Display a null-terminated echo area message M. If M is 0, clear
9714 out any existing message, and let the mini-buffer text show through.
9716 The buffer M must continue to exist until after the echo area gets
9717 cleared or some other message gets displayed there. Do not pass
9718 text that is stored in a Lisp string. Do not pass text in a buffer
9719 that was alloca'd. */
9721 void
9722 message1 (const char *m)
9724 message2 (m, (m ? strlen (m) : 0), 0);
9728 /* The non-logging counterpart of message1. */
9730 void
9731 message1_nolog (const char *m)
9733 message2_nolog (m, (m ? strlen (m) : 0), 0);
9736 /* Display a message M which contains a single %s
9737 which gets replaced with STRING. */
9739 void
9740 message_with_string (const char *m, Lisp_Object string, int log)
9742 CHECK_STRING (string);
9744 if (noninteractive)
9746 if (m)
9748 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9749 putc ('\n', stderr);
9750 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9751 fprintf (stderr, m, SDATA (string));
9752 if (!cursor_in_echo_area)
9753 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9754 fflush (stderr);
9757 else if (INTERACTIVE)
9759 /* The frame whose minibuffer we're going to display the message on.
9760 It may be larger than the selected frame, so we need
9761 to use its buffer, not the selected frame's buffer. */
9762 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9763 struct frame *f, *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9765 /* Get the frame containing the minibuffer
9766 that the selected frame is using. */
9767 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9768 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9770 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9771 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9772 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
9773 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f))
9775 Lisp_Object args[2], msg;
9776 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
9778 args[0] = build_string (m);
9779 args[1] = msg = string;
9780 GCPRO2 (args[0], msg);
9781 gcpro1.nvars = 2;
9783 msg = Fformat (2, args);
9785 if (log)
9786 message3 (msg, SBYTES (msg), STRING_MULTIBYTE (msg));
9787 else
9788 message3_nolog (msg, SBYTES (msg), STRING_MULTIBYTE (msg));
9790 UNGCPRO;
9792 /* Print should start at the beginning of the message
9793 buffer next time. */
9794 message_buf_print = 0;
9800 /* Dump an informative message to the minibuf. If M is 0, clear out
9801 any existing message, and let the mini-buffer text show through. */
9803 static void
9804 vmessage (const char *m, va_list ap)
9806 if (noninteractive)
9808 if (m)
9810 if (noninteractive_need_newline)
9811 putc ('\n', stderr);
9812 noninteractive_need_newline = 0;
9813 vfprintf (stderr, m, ap);
9814 if (cursor_in_echo_area == 0)
9815 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9816 fflush (stderr);
9819 else if (INTERACTIVE)
9821 /* The frame whose mini-buffer we're going to display the message
9822 on. It may be larger than the selected frame, so we need to
9823 use its buffer, not the selected frame's buffer. */
9824 Lisp_Object mini_window;
9825 struct frame *f, *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
9827 /* Get the frame containing the mini-buffer
9828 that the selected frame is using. */
9829 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
9830 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
9832 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
9833 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
9834 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss
9835 it. */
9836 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f))
9838 if (m)
9840 ptrdiff_t len;
9842 len = doprnt (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f),
9843 FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f), m, (char *)0, ap);
9845 message2 (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f), len, 1);
9847 else
9848 message1 (0);
9850 /* Print should start at the beginning of the message
9851 buffer next time. */
9852 message_buf_print = 0;
9857 void
9858 message (const char *m, ...)
9860 va_list ap;
9861 va_start (ap, m);
9862 vmessage (m, ap);
9863 va_end (ap);
9867 #if 0
9868 /* The non-logging version of message. */
9870 void
9871 message_nolog (const char *m, ...)
9873 Lisp_Object old_log_max;
9874 va_list ap;
9875 va_start (ap, m);
9876 old_log_max = Vmessage_log_max;
9877 Vmessage_log_max = Qnil;
9878 vmessage (m, ap);
9879 Vmessage_log_max = old_log_max;
9880 va_end (ap);
9882 #endif
9885 /* Display the current message in the current mini-buffer. This is
9886 only called from error handlers in process.c, and is not time
9887 critical. */
9889 void
9890 update_echo_area (void)
9892 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
9894 Lisp_Object string;
9895 string = Fcurrent_message ();
9896 message3 (string, SBYTES (string),
9897 !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)));
9902 /* Make sure echo area buffers in `echo_buffers' are live.
9903 If they aren't, make new ones. */
9905 static void
9906 ensure_echo_area_buffers (void)
9908 int i;
9910 for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
9911 if (!BUFFERP (echo_buffer[i])
9912 || NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i]), name)))
9914 char name[30];
9915 Lisp_Object old_buffer;
9916 int j;
9918 old_buffer = echo_buffer[i];
9919 echo_buffer[i] = Fget_buffer_create
9920 (make_formatted_string (name, " *Echo Area %d*", i));
9921 bset_truncate_lines (XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i]), Qnil);
9922 /* to force word wrap in echo area -
9923 it was decided to postpone this*/
9924 /* XBUFFER (echo_buffer[i])->word_wrap = Qt; */
9926 for (j = 0; j < 2; ++j)
9927 if (EQ (old_buffer, echo_area_buffer[j]))
9928 echo_area_buffer[j] = echo_buffer[i];
9933 /* Call FN with args A1..A4 with either the current or last displayed
9934 echo_area_buffer as current buffer.
9936 WHICH zero means use the current message buffer
9937 echo_area_buffer[0]. If that is nil, choose a suitable buffer
9938 from echo_buffer[] and clear it.
9940 WHICH > 0 means use echo_area_buffer[1]. If that is nil, choose a
9941 suitable buffer from echo_buffer[] and clear it.
9943 If WHICH < 0, set echo_area_buffer[1] to echo_area_buffer[0], so
9944 that the current message becomes the last displayed one, make
9945 choose a suitable buffer for echo_area_buffer[0], and clear it.
9947 Value is what FN returns. */
9949 static int
9950 with_echo_area_buffer (struct window *w, int which,
9951 int (*fn) (ptrdiff_t, Lisp_Object, ptrdiff_t, ptrdiff_t),
9952 ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
9954 Lisp_Object buffer;
9955 int this_one, the_other, clear_buffer_p, rc;
9956 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
9958 /* If buffers aren't live, make new ones. */
9959 ensure_echo_area_buffers ();
9961 clear_buffer_p = 0;
9963 if (which == 0)
9964 this_one = 0, the_other = 1;
9965 else if (which > 0)
9966 this_one = 1, the_other = 0;
9967 else
9969 this_one = 0, the_other = 1;
9970 clear_buffer_p = 1;
9972 /* We need a fresh one in case the current echo buffer equals
9973 the one containing the last displayed echo area message. */
9974 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[this_one])
9975 && EQ (echo_area_buffer[this_one], echo_area_buffer[the_other]))
9976 echo_area_buffer[this_one] = Qnil;
9979 /* Choose a suitable buffer from echo_buffer[] is we don't
9980 have one. */
9981 if (NILP (echo_area_buffer[this_one]))
9983 echo_area_buffer[this_one]
9984 = (EQ (echo_area_buffer[the_other], echo_buffer[this_one])
9985 ? echo_buffer[the_other]
9986 : echo_buffer[this_one]);
9987 clear_buffer_p = 1;
9990 buffer = echo_area_buffer[this_one];
9992 /* Don't get confused by reusing the buffer used for echoing
9993 for a different purpose. */
9994 if (echo_kboard == NULL && EQ (buffer, echo_message_buffer))
9995 cancel_echoing ();
9997 record_unwind_protect (unwind_with_echo_area_buffer,
9998 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (w));
10000 /* Make the echo area buffer current. Note that for display
10001 purposes, it is not necessary that the displayed window's buffer
10002 == current_buffer, except for text property lookup. So, let's
10003 only set that buffer temporarily here without doing a full
10004 Fset_window_buffer. We must also change w->pointm, though,
10005 because otherwise an assertions in unshow_buffer fails, and Emacs
10006 aborts. */
10007 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (buffer));
10008 if (w)
10010 wset_buffer (w, buffer);
10011 set_marker_both (w->pointm, buffer, BEG, BEG_BYTE);
10014 bset_undo_list (current_buffer, Qt);
10015 bset_read_only (current_buffer, Qnil);
10016 specbind (Qinhibit_read_only, Qt);
10017 specbind (Qinhibit_modification_hooks, Qt);
10019 if (clear_buffer_p && Z > BEG)
10020 del_range (BEG, Z);
10022 eassert (BEGV >= BEG);
10023 eassert (ZV <= Z && ZV >= BEGV);
10025 rc = fn (a1, a2, a3, a4);
10027 eassert (BEGV >= BEG);
10028 eassert (ZV <= Z && ZV >= BEGV);
10030 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10031 return rc;
10035 /* Save state that should be preserved around the call to the function
10036 FN called in with_echo_area_buffer. */
10038 static Lisp_Object
10039 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data (struct window *w)
10041 int i = 0;
10042 Lisp_Object vector, tmp;
10044 /* Reduce consing by keeping one vector in
10045 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector. */
10046 vector = Vwith_echo_area_save_vector;
10047 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = Qnil;
10049 if (NILP (vector))
10050 vector = Fmake_vector (make_number (7), Qnil);
10052 XSETBUFFER (tmp, current_buffer); ASET (vector, i, tmp); ++i;
10053 ASET (vector, i, Vdeactivate_mark); ++i;
10054 ASET (vector, i, make_number (windows_or_buffers_changed)); ++i;
10056 if (w)
10058 XSETWINDOW (tmp, w); ASET (vector, i, tmp); ++i;
10059 ASET (vector, i, w->buffer); ++i;
10060 ASET (vector, i, make_number (XMARKER (w->pointm)->charpos)); ++i;
10061 ASET (vector, i, make_number (XMARKER (w->pointm)->bytepos)); ++i;
10063 else
10065 int end = i + 4;
10066 for (; i < end; ++i)
10067 ASET (vector, i, Qnil);
10070 eassert (i == ASIZE (vector));
10071 return vector;
10075 /* Restore global state from VECTOR which was created by
10076 with_echo_area_buffer_unwind_data. */
10078 static Lisp_Object
10079 unwind_with_echo_area_buffer (Lisp_Object vector)
10081 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (AREF (vector, 0)));
10082 Vdeactivate_mark = AREF (vector, 1);
10083 windows_or_buffers_changed = XFASTINT (AREF (vector, 2));
10085 if (WINDOWP (AREF (vector, 3)))
10087 struct window *w;
10088 Lisp_Object buffer, charpos, bytepos;
10090 w = XWINDOW (AREF (vector, 3));
10091 buffer = AREF (vector, 4);
10092 charpos = AREF (vector, 5);
10093 bytepos = AREF (vector, 6);
10095 wset_buffer (w, buffer);
10096 set_marker_both (w->pointm, buffer,
10097 XFASTINT (charpos), XFASTINT (bytepos));
10100 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = vector;
10101 return Qnil;
10105 /* Set up the echo area for use by print functions. MULTIBYTE_P
10106 non-zero means we will print multibyte. */
10108 void
10109 setup_echo_area_for_printing (int multibyte_p)
10111 /* If we can't find an echo area any more, exit. */
10112 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (selected_frame)))
10113 Fkill_emacs (Qnil);
10115 ensure_echo_area_buffers ();
10117 if (!message_buf_print)
10119 /* A message has been output since the last time we printed.
10120 Choose a fresh echo area buffer. */
10121 if (EQ (echo_area_buffer[1], echo_buffer[0]))
10122 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1];
10123 else
10124 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[0];
10126 /* Switch to that buffer and clear it. */
10127 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]));
10128 bset_truncate_lines (current_buffer, Qnil);
10130 if (Z > BEG)
10132 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
10133 specbind (Qinhibit_read_only, Qt);
10134 /* Note that undo recording is always disabled. */
10135 del_range (BEG, Z);
10136 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10138 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEG, BEG_BYTE);
10140 /* Set up the buffer for the multibyteness we need. */
10141 if (multibyte_p
10142 != !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10143 Fset_buffer_multibyte (multibyte_p ? Qt : Qnil);
10145 /* Raise the frame containing the echo area. */
10146 if (minibuffer_auto_raise)
10148 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10149 Lisp_Object mini_window;
10150 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
10151 Fraise_frame (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
10154 message_log_maybe_newline ();
10155 message_buf_print = 1;
10157 else
10159 if (NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10161 if (EQ (echo_area_buffer[1], echo_buffer[0]))
10162 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1];
10163 else
10164 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[0];
10167 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10169 /* Someone switched buffers between print requests. */
10170 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (echo_area_buffer[0]));
10171 bset_truncate_lines (current_buffer, Qnil);
10177 /* Display an echo area message in window W. Value is non-zero if W's
10178 height is changed. If display_last_displayed_message_p is
10179 non-zero, display the message that was last displayed, otherwise
10180 display the current message. */
10182 static int
10183 display_echo_area (struct window *w)
10185 int i, no_message_p, window_height_changed_p;
10187 /* Temporarily disable garbage collections while displaying the echo
10188 area. This is done because a GC can print a message itself.
10189 That message would modify the echo area buffer's contents while a
10190 redisplay of the buffer is going on, and seriously confuse
10191 redisplay. */
10192 ptrdiff_t count = inhibit_garbage_collection ();
10194 /* If there is no message, we must call display_echo_area_1
10195 nevertheless because it resizes the window. But we will have to
10196 reset the echo_area_buffer in question to nil at the end because
10197 with_echo_area_buffer will sets it to an empty buffer. */
10198 i = display_last_displayed_message_p ? 1 : 0;
10199 no_message_p = NILP (echo_area_buffer[i]);
10201 window_height_changed_p
10202 = with_echo_area_buffer (w, display_last_displayed_message_p,
10203 display_echo_area_1,
10204 (intptr_t) w, Qnil, 0, 0);
10206 if (no_message_p)
10207 echo_area_buffer[i] = Qnil;
10209 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10210 return window_height_changed_p;
10214 /* Helper for display_echo_area. Display the current buffer which
10215 contains the current echo area message in window W, a mini-window,
10216 a pointer to which is passed in A1. A2..A4 are currently not used.
10217 Change the height of W so that all of the message is displayed.
10218 Value is non-zero if height of W was changed. */
10220 static int
10221 display_echo_area_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
10223 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10224 struct window *w = (struct window *) i1;
10225 Lisp_Object window;
10226 struct text_pos start;
10227 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
10229 /* Do this before displaying, so that we have a large enough glyph
10230 matrix for the display. If we can't get enough space for the
10231 whole text, display the last N lines. That works by setting w->start. */
10232 window_height_changed_p = resize_mini_window (w, 0);
10234 /* Use the starting position chosen by resize_mini_window. */
10235 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start, w->start);
10237 /* Display. */
10238 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
10239 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
10240 try_window (window, start, 0);
10242 return window_height_changed_p;
10246 /* Resize the echo area window to exactly the size needed for the
10247 currently displayed message, if there is one. If a mini-buffer
10248 is active, don't shrink it. */
10250 void
10251 resize_echo_area_exactly (void)
10253 if (BUFFERP (echo_area_buffer[0])
10254 && WINDOWP (echo_area_window))
10256 struct window *w = XWINDOW (echo_area_window);
10257 int resized_p;
10258 Lisp_Object resize_exactly;
10260 if (minibuf_level == 0)
10261 resize_exactly = Qt;
10262 else
10263 resize_exactly = Qnil;
10265 resized_p = with_echo_area_buffer (w, 0, resize_mini_window_1,
10266 (intptr_t) w, resize_exactly,
10267 0, 0);
10268 if (resized_p)
10270 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
10271 ++update_mode_lines;
10272 redisplay_internal ();
10278 /* Callback function for with_echo_area_buffer, when used from
10279 resize_echo_area_exactly. A1 contains a pointer to the window to
10280 resize, EXACTLY non-nil means resize the mini-window exactly to the
10281 size of the text displayed. A3 and A4 are not used. Value is what
10282 resize_mini_window returns. */
10284 static int
10285 resize_mini_window_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object exactly, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
10287 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10288 return resize_mini_window ((struct window *) i1, !NILP (exactly));
10292 /* Resize mini-window W to fit the size of its contents. EXACT_P
10293 means size the window exactly to the size needed. Otherwise, it's
10294 only enlarged until W's buffer is empty.
10296 Set W->start to the right place to begin display. If the whole
10297 contents fit, start at the beginning. Otherwise, start so as
10298 to make the end of the contents appear. This is particularly
10299 important for y-or-n-p, but seems desirable generally.
10301 Value is non-zero if the window height has been changed. */
10304 resize_mini_window (struct window *w, int exact_p)
10306 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
10307 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
10309 eassert (MINI_WINDOW_P (w));
10311 /* By default, start display at the beginning. */
10312 set_marker_both (w->start, w->buffer,
10313 BUF_BEGV (XBUFFER (w->buffer)),
10314 BUF_BEGV_BYTE (XBUFFER (w->buffer)));
10316 /* Don't resize windows while redisplaying a window; it would
10317 confuse redisplay functions when the size of the window they are
10318 displaying changes from under them. Such a resizing can happen,
10319 for instance, when which-func prints a long message while
10320 we are running fontification-functions. We're running these
10321 functions with safe_call which binds inhibit-redisplay to t. */
10322 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
10323 return 0;
10325 /* Nil means don't try to resize. */
10326 if (NILP (Vresize_mini_windows)
10327 || (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f) == NULL))
10328 return 0;
10330 if (!FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (f))
10332 struct it it;
10333 struct window *root = XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f));
10334 int total_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (root) + WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10335 int height;
10336 EMACS_INT max_height;
10337 int unit = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
10338 struct text_pos start;
10339 struct buffer *old_current_buffer = NULL;
10341 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer))
10343 old_current_buffer = current_buffer;
10344 set_buffer_internal (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
10347 init_iterator (&it, w, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
10349 /* Compute the max. number of lines specified by the user. */
10350 if (FLOATP (Vmax_mini_window_height))
10351 max_height = XFLOATINT (Vmax_mini_window_height) * FRAME_LINES (f);
10352 else if (INTEGERP (Vmax_mini_window_height))
10353 max_height = XINT (Vmax_mini_window_height);
10354 else
10355 max_height = total_height / 4;
10357 /* Correct that max. height if it's bogus. */
10358 max_height = max (1, max_height);
10359 max_height = min (total_height, max_height);
10361 /* Find out the height of the text in the window. */
10362 if (it.line_wrap == TRUNCATE)
10363 height = 1;
10364 else
10366 last_height = 0;
10367 move_it_to (&it, ZV, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
10368 if (it.max_ascent == 0 && it.max_descent == 0)
10369 height = it.current_y + last_height;
10370 else
10371 height = it.current_y + it.max_ascent + it.max_descent;
10372 height -= min (it.extra_line_spacing, it.max_extra_line_spacing);
10373 height = (height + unit - 1) / unit;
10376 /* Compute a suitable window start. */
10377 if (height > max_height)
10379 height = max_height;
10380 init_iterator (&it, w, ZV, ZV_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
10381 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, (height - 1) * unit);
10382 start = it.current.pos;
10384 else
10385 SET_TEXT_POS (start, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
10386 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, start);
10388 if (EQ (Vresize_mini_windows, Qgrow_only))
10390 /* Let it grow only, until we display an empty message, in which
10391 case the window shrinks again. */
10392 if (height > WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w))
10394 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10395 freeze_window_starts (f, 1);
10396 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w));
10397 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10399 else if (height < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w)
10400 && (exact_p || BEGV == ZV))
10402 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10403 freeze_window_starts (f, 0);
10404 shrink_mini_window (w);
10405 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10408 else
10410 /* Always resize to exact size needed. */
10411 if (height > WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w))
10413 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10414 freeze_window_starts (f, 1);
10415 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w));
10416 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10418 else if (height < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w))
10420 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
10421 freeze_window_starts (f, 0);
10422 shrink_mini_window (w);
10424 if (height)
10426 freeze_window_starts (f, 1);
10427 grow_mini_window (w, height - WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w));
10430 window_height_changed_p = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height;
10434 if (old_current_buffer)
10435 set_buffer_internal (old_current_buffer);
10438 return window_height_changed_p;
10442 /* Value is the current message, a string, or nil if there is no
10443 current message. */
10445 Lisp_Object
10446 current_message (void)
10448 Lisp_Object msg;
10450 if (!BUFFERP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10451 msg = Qnil;
10452 else
10454 with_echo_area_buffer (0, 0, current_message_1,
10455 (intptr_t) &msg, Qnil, 0, 0);
10456 if (NILP (msg))
10457 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10460 return msg;
10464 static int
10465 current_message_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
10467 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10468 Lisp_Object *msg = (Lisp_Object *) i1;
10470 if (Z > BEG)
10471 *msg = make_buffer_string (BEG, Z, 1);
10472 else
10473 *msg = Qnil;
10474 return 0;
10478 /* Push the current message on Vmessage_stack for later restoration
10479 by restore_message. Value is non-zero if the current message isn't
10480 empty. This is a relatively infrequent operation, so it's not
10481 worth optimizing. */
10484 push_message (void)
10486 Lisp_Object msg;
10487 msg = current_message ();
10488 Vmessage_stack = Fcons (msg, Vmessage_stack);
10489 return STRINGP (msg);
10493 /* Restore message display from the top of Vmessage_stack. */
10495 void
10496 restore_message (void)
10498 Lisp_Object msg;
10500 eassert (CONSP (Vmessage_stack));
10501 msg = XCAR (Vmessage_stack);
10502 if (STRINGP (msg))
10503 message3_nolog (msg, SBYTES (msg), STRING_MULTIBYTE (msg));
10504 else
10505 message3_nolog (msg, 0, 0);
10509 /* Handler for record_unwind_protect calling pop_message. */
10511 Lisp_Object
10512 pop_message_unwind (Lisp_Object dummy)
10514 pop_message ();
10515 return Qnil;
10518 /* Pop the top-most entry off Vmessage_stack. */
10520 static void
10521 pop_message (void)
10523 eassert (CONSP (Vmessage_stack));
10524 Vmessage_stack = XCDR (Vmessage_stack);
10528 /* Check that Vmessage_stack is nil. Called from emacs.c when Emacs
10529 exits. If the stack is not empty, we have a missing pop_message
10530 somewhere. */
10532 void
10533 check_message_stack (void)
10535 if (!NILP (Vmessage_stack))
10536 abort ();
10540 /* Truncate to NCHARS what will be displayed in the echo area the next
10541 time we display it---but don't redisplay it now. */
10543 void
10544 truncate_echo_area (ptrdiff_t nchars)
10546 if (nchars == 0)
10547 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10548 /* A null message buffer means that the frame hasn't really been
10549 initialized yet. Error messages get reported properly by
10550 cmd_error, so this must be just an informative message; toss it. */
10551 else if (!noninteractive
10552 && INTERACTIVE
10553 && !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
10555 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10556 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (sf))
10557 with_echo_area_buffer (0, 0, truncate_message_1, nchars, Qnil, 0, 0);
10562 /* Helper function for truncate_echo_area. Truncate the current
10563 message to at most NCHARS characters. */
10565 static int
10566 truncate_message_1 (ptrdiff_t nchars, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t a3, ptrdiff_t a4)
10568 if (BEG + nchars < Z)
10569 del_range (BEG + nchars, Z);
10570 if (Z == BEG)
10571 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10572 return 0;
10576 /* Set the current message to a substring of S or STRING.
10578 If STRING is a Lisp string, set the message to the first NBYTES
10579 bytes from STRING. NBYTES zero means use the whole string. If
10580 STRING is multibyte, the message will be displayed multibyte.
10582 If S is not null, set the message to the first LEN bytes of S. LEN
10583 zero means use the whole string. MULTIBYTE_P non-zero means S is
10584 multibyte. Display the message multibyte in that case.
10586 Doesn't GC, as with_echo_area_buffer binds Qinhibit_modification_hooks
10587 to t before calling set_message_1 (which calls insert).
10590 static void
10591 set_message (const char *s, Lisp_Object string,
10592 ptrdiff_t nbytes, int multibyte_p)
10594 message_enable_multibyte
10595 = ((s && multibyte_p)
10596 || (STRINGP (string) && STRING_MULTIBYTE (string)));
10598 with_echo_area_buffer (0, -1, set_message_1,
10599 (intptr_t) s, string, nbytes, multibyte_p);
10600 message_buf_print = 0;
10601 help_echo_showing_p = 0;
10605 /* Helper function for set_message. Arguments have the same meaning
10606 as there, with A1 corresponding to S and A2 corresponding to STRING
10607 This function is called with the echo area buffer being
10608 current. */
10610 static int
10611 set_message_1 (ptrdiff_t a1, Lisp_Object a2, ptrdiff_t nbytes, ptrdiff_t multibyte_p)
10613 intptr_t i1 = a1;
10614 const char *s = (const char *) i1;
10615 const unsigned char *msg = (const unsigned char *) s;
10616 Lisp_Object string = a2;
10618 /* Change multibyteness of the echo buffer appropriately. */
10619 if (message_enable_multibyte
10620 != !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10621 Fset_buffer_multibyte (message_enable_multibyte ? Qt : Qnil);
10623 bset_truncate_lines (current_buffer, message_truncate_lines ? Qt : Qnil);
10624 if (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, bidi_display_reordering)))
10625 bset_bidi_paragraph_direction (current_buffer, Qleft_to_right);
10627 /* Insert new message at BEG. */
10628 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEG, BEG_BYTE);
10630 if (STRINGP (string))
10632 ptrdiff_t nchars;
10634 if (nbytes == 0)
10635 nbytes = SBYTES (string);
10636 nchars = string_byte_to_char (string, nbytes);
10638 /* This function takes care of single/multibyte conversion. We
10639 just have to ensure that the echo area buffer has the right
10640 setting of enable_multibyte_characters. */
10641 insert_from_string (string, 0, 0, nchars, nbytes, 1);
10643 else if (s)
10645 if (nbytes == 0)
10646 nbytes = strlen (s);
10648 if (multibyte_p && NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10650 /* Convert from multi-byte to single-byte. */
10651 ptrdiff_t i;
10652 int c, n;
10653 char work[1];
10655 /* Convert a multibyte string to single-byte. */
10656 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += n)
10658 c = string_char_and_length (msg + i, &n);
10659 work[0] = (ASCII_CHAR_P (c)
10661 : multibyte_char_to_unibyte (c));
10662 insert_1_both (work, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0);
10665 else if (!multibyte_p
10666 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters)))
10668 /* Convert from single-byte to multi-byte. */
10669 ptrdiff_t i;
10670 int c, n;
10671 unsigned char str[MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH];
10673 /* Convert a single-byte string to multibyte. */
10674 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
10676 c = msg[i];
10677 MAKE_CHAR_MULTIBYTE (c);
10678 n = CHAR_STRING (c, str);
10679 insert_1_both ((char *) str, 1, n, 1, 0, 0);
10682 else
10683 insert_1 (s, nbytes, 1, 0, 0);
10686 return 0;
10690 /* Clear messages. CURRENT_P non-zero means clear the current
10691 message. LAST_DISPLAYED_P non-zero means clear the message
10692 last displayed. */
10694 void
10695 clear_message (int current_p, int last_displayed_p)
10697 if (current_p)
10699 echo_area_buffer[0] = Qnil;
10700 message_cleared_p = 1;
10703 if (last_displayed_p)
10704 echo_area_buffer[1] = Qnil;
10706 message_buf_print = 0;
10709 /* Clear garbaged frames.
10711 This function is used where the old redisplay called
10712 redraw_garbaged_frames which in turn called redraw_frame which in
10713 turn called clear_frame. The call to clear_frame was a source of
10714 flickering. I believe a clear_frame is not necessary. It should
10715 suffice in the new redisplay to invalidate all current matrices,
10716 and ensure a complete redisplay of all windows. */
10718 static void
10719 clear_garbaged_frames (void)
10721 if (frame_garbaged)
10723 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
10724 int changed_count = 0;
10726 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
10728 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
10730 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
10732 if (f->resized_p)
10734 Fredraw_frame (frame);
10735 f->force_flush_display_p = 1;
10737 clear_current_matrices (f);
10738 changed_count++;
10739 f->garbaged = 0;
10740 f->resized_p = 0;
10744 frame_garbaged = 0;
10745 if (changed_count)
10746 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
10751 /* Redisplay the echo area of the selected frame. If UPDATE_FRAME_P
10752 is non-zero update selected_frame. Value is non-zero if the
10753 mini-windows height has been changed. */
10755 static int
10756 echo_area_display (int update_frame_p)
10758 Lisp_Object mini_window;
10759 struct window *w;
10760 struct frame *f;
10761 int window_height_changed_p = 0;
10762 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
10764 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
10765 w = XWINDOW (mini_window);
10766 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
10768 /* Don't display if frame is invisible or not yet initialized. */
10769 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || !f->glyphs_initialized_p)
10770 return 0;
10772 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
10773 /* When Emacs starts, selected_frame may be the initial terminal
10774 frame. If we let this through, a message would be displayed on
10775 the terminal. */
10776 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (XFRAME (selected_frame)))
10777 return 0;
10778 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
10780 /* Redraw garbaged frames. */
10781 if (frame_garbaged)
10782 clear_garbaged_frames ();
10784 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]) || minibuf_level == 0)
10786 echo_area_window = mini_window;
10787 window_height_changed_p = display_echo_area (w);
10788 w->must_be_updated_p = 1;
10790 /* Update the display, unless called from redisplay_internal.
10791 Also don't update the screen during redisplay itself. The
10792 update will happen at the end of redisplay, and an update
10793 here could cause confusion. */
10794 if (update_frame_p && !redisplaying_p)
10796 int n = 0;
10798 /* If the display update has been interrupted by pending
10799 input, update mode lines in the frame. Due to the
10800 pending input, it might have been that redisplay hasn't
10801 been called, so that mode lines above the echo area are
10802 garbaged. This looks odd, so we prevent it here. */
10803 if (!display_completed)
10804 n = redisplay_mode_lines (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), 0);
10806 if (window_height_changed_p
10807 /* Don't do this if Emacs is shutting down. Redisplay
10808 needs to run hooks. */
10809 && !NILP (Vrun_hooks))
10811 /* Must update other windows. Likewise as in other
10812 cases, don't let this update be interrupted by
10813 pending input. */
10814 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
10815 specbind (Qredisplay_dont_pause, Qt);
10816 windows_or_buffers_changed = 1;
10817 redisplay_internal ();
10818 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
10820 else if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && n == 0)
10822 /* Window configuration is the same as before.
10823 Can do with a display update of the echo area,
10824 unless we displayed some mode lines. */
10825 update_single_window (w, 1);
10826 FRAME_RIF (f)->flush_display (f);
10828 else
10829 update_frame (f, 1, 1);
10831 /* If cursor is in the echo area, make sure that the next
10832 redisplay displays the minibuffer, so that the cursor will
10833 be replaced with what the minibuffer wants. */
10834 if (cursor_in_echo_area)
10835 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
10838 else if (!EQ (mini_window, selected_window))
10839 windows_or_buffers_changed++;
10841 /* Last displayed message is now the current message. */
10842 echo_area_buffer[1] = echo_area_buffer[0];
10843 /* Inform read_char that we're not echoing. */
10844 echo_message_buffer = Qnil;
10846 /* Prevent redisplay optimization in redisplay_internal by resetting
10847 this_line_start_pos. This is done because the mini-buffer now
10848 displays the message instead of its buffer text. */
10849 if (EQ (mini_window, selected_window))
10850 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
10852 return window_height_changed_p;
10857 /***********************************************************************
10858 Mode Lines and Frame Titles
10859 ***********************************************************************/
10861 /* A buffer for constructing non-propertized mode-line strings and
10862 frame titles in it; allocated from the heap in init_xdisp and
10863 resized as needed in store_mode_line_noprop_char. */
10865 static char *mode_line_noprop_buf;
10867 /* The buffer's end, and a current output position in it. */
10869 static char *mode_line_noprop_buf_end;
10870 static char *mode_line_noprop_ptr;
10872 #define MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN(start) \
10873 ((mode_line_noprop_ptr - mode_line_noprop_buf) - start)
10875 static enum {
10876 MODE_LINE_DISPLAY = 0,
10877 MODE_LINE_TITLE,
10878 MODE_LINE_NOPROP,
10879 MODE_LINE_STRING
10880 } mode_line_target;
10882 /* Alist that caches the results of :propertize.
10883 Each element is (PROPERTIZED-STRING . PROPERTY-LIST). */
10884 static Lisp_Object mode_line_proptrans_alist;
10886 /* List of strings making up the mode-line. */
10887 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_list;
10889 /* Base face property when building propertized mode line string. */
10890 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_face;
10891 static Lisp_Object mode_line_string_face_prop;
10894 /* Unwind data for mode line strings */
10896 static Lisp_Object Vmode_line_unwind_vector;
10898 static Lisp_Object
10899 format_mode_line_unwind_data (struct frame *target_frame,
10900 struct buffer *obuf,
10901 Lisp_Object owin,
10902 int save_proptrans)
10904 Lisp_Object vector, tmp;
10906 /* Reduce consing by keeping one vector in
10907 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector. */
10908 vector = Vmode_line_unwind_vector;
10909 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = Qnil;
10911 if (NILP (vector))
10912 vector = Fmake_vector (make_number (10), Qnil);
10914 ASET (vector, 0, make_number (mode_line_target));
10915 ASET (vector, 1, make_number (MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0)));
10916 ASET (vector, 2, mode_line_string_list);
10917 ASET (vector, 3, save_proptrans ? mode_line_proptrans_alist : Qt);
10918 ASET (vector, 4, mode_line_string_face);
10919 ASET (vector, 5, mode_line_string_face_prop);
10921 if (obuf)
10922 XSETBUFFER (tmp, obuf);
10923 else
10924 tmp = Qnil;
10925 ASET (vector, 6, tmp);
10926 ASET (vector, 7, owin);
10927 if (target_frame)
10929 /* Similarly to `with-selected-window', if the operation selects
10930 a window on another frame, we must restore that frame's
10931 selected window, and (for a tty) the top-frame. */
10932 ASET (vector, 8, target_frame->selected_window);
10933 if (FRAME_TERMCAP_P (target_frame))
10934 ASET (vector, 9, FRAME_TTY (target_frame)->top_frame);
10937 return vector;
10940 static Lisp_Object
10941 unwind_format_mode_line (Lisp_Object vector)
10943 Lisp_Object old_window = AREF (vector, 7);
10944 Lisp_Object target_frame_window = AREF (vector, 8);
10945 Lisp_Object old_top_frame = AREF (vector, 9);
10947 mode_line_target = XINT (AREF (vector, 0));
10948 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf + XINT (AREF (vector, 1));
10949 mode_line_string_list = AREF (vector, 2);
10950 if (! EQ (AREF (vector, 3), Qt))
10951 mode_line_proptrans_alist = AREF (vector, 3);
10952 mode_line_string_face = AREF (vector, 4);
10953 mode_line_string_face_prop = AREF (vector, 5);
10955 /* Select window before buffer, since it may change the buffer. */
10956 if (!NILP (old_window))
10958 /* If the operation that we are unwinding had selected a window
10959 on a different frame, reset its frame-selected-window. For a
10960 text terminal, reset its top-frame if necessary. */
10961 if (!NILP (target_frame_window))
10963 Lisp_Object frame
10964 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (target_frame_window));
10966 if (!EQ (frame, WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (old_window))))
10967 Fselect_window (target_frame_window, Qt);
10969 if (!NILP (old_top_frame) && !EQ (old_top_frame, frame))
10970 Fselect_frame (old_top_frame, Qt);
10973 Fselect_window (old_window, Qt);
10976 if (!NILP (AREF (vector, 6)))
10978 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (AREF (vector, 6)));
10979 ASET (vector, 6, Qnil);
10982 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = vector;
10983 return Qnil;
10987 /* Store a single character C for the frame title in mode_line_noprop_buf.
10988 Re-allocate mode_line_noprop_buf if necessary. */
10990 static void
10991 store_mode_line_noprop_char (char c)
10993 /* If output position has reached the end of the allocated buffer,
10994 increase the buffer's size. */
10995 if (mode_line_noprop_ptr == mode_line_noprop_buf_end)
10997 ptrdiff_t len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
10998 ptrdiff_t size = len;
10999 mode_line_noprop_buf =
11000 xpalloc (mode_line_noprop_buf, &size, 1, STRING_BYTES_BOUND, 1);
11001 mode_line_noprop_buf_end = mode_line_noprop_buf + size;
11002 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf + len;
11005 *mode_line_noprop_ptr++ = c;
11009 /* Store part of a frame title in mode_line_noprop_buf, beginning at
11010 mode_line_noprop_ptr. STRING is the string to store. Do not copy
11011 characters that yield more columns than PRECISION; PRECISION <= 0
11012 means copy the whole string. Pad with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH
11013 number of characters have been copied; FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't
11014 pad. Called from display_mode_element when it is used to build a
11015 frame title. */
11017 static int
11018 store_mode_line_noprop (const char *string, int field_width, int precision)
11020 const unsigned char *str = (const unsigned char *) string;
11021 int n = 0;
11022 ptrdiff_t dummy, nbytes;
11024 /* Copy at most PRECISION chars from STR. */
11025 nbytes = strlen (string);
11026 n += c_string_width (str, nbytes, precision, &dummy, &nbytes);
11027 while (nbytes--)
11028 store_mode_line_noprop_char (*str++);
11030 /* Fill up with spaces until FIELD_WIDTH reached. */
11031 while (field_width > 0
11032 && n < field_width)
11034 store_mode_line_noprop_char (' ');
11035 ++n;
11038 return n;
11041 /***********************************************************************
11042 Frame Titles
11043 ***********************************************************************/
11045 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11047 /* Set the title of FRAME, if it has changed. The title format is
11048 Vicon_title_format if FRAME is iconified, otherwise it is
11049 frame_title_format. */
11051 static void
11052 x_consider_frame_title (Lisp_Object frame)
11054 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
11056 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
11057 || FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (f)
11058 || f->explicit_name)
11060 /* Do we have more than one visible frame on this X display? */
11061 Lisp_Object tail;
11062 Lisp_Object fmt;
11063 ptrdiff_t title_start;
11064 char *title;
11065 ptrdiff_t len;
11066 struct it it;
11067 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11069 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
11071 Lisp_Object other_frame = XCAR (tail);
11072 struct frame *tf = XFRAME (other_frame);
11074 if (tf != f
11075 && FRAME_KBOARD (tf) == FRAME_KBOARD (f)
11076 && !FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (tf)
11077 && !EQ (other_frame, tip_frame)
11078 && (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (tf) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (tf)))
11079 break;
11082 /* Set global variable indicating that multiple frames exist. */
11083 multiple_frames = CONSP (tail);
11085 /* Switch to the buffer of selected window of the frame. Set up
11086 mode_line_target so that display_mode_element will output into
11087 mode_line_noprop_buf; then display the title. */
11088 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
11089 format_mode_line_unwind_data
11090 (f, current_buffer, selected_window, 0));
11092 Fselect_window (f->selected_window, Qt);
11093 set_buffer_internal_1
11094 (XBUFFER (XWINDOW (f->selected_window)->buffer));
11095 fmt = FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) ? Vicon_title_format : Vframe_title_format;
11097 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_TITLE;
11098 title_start = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
11099 init_iterator (&it, XWINDOW (f->selected_window), -1, -1,
11100 NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
11101 display_mode_element (&it, 0, -1, -1, fmt, Qnil, 0);
11102 len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (title_start);
11103 title = mode_line_noprop_buf + title_start;
11104 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11106 /* Set the title only if it's changed. This avoids consing in
11107 the common case where it hasn't. (If it turns out that we've
11108 already wasted too much time by walking through the list with
11109 display_mode_element, then we might need to optimize at a
11110 higher level than this.) */
11111 if (! STRINGP (f->name)
11112 || SBYTES (f->name) != len
11113 || memcmp (title, SDATA (f->name), len) != 0)
11114 x_implicitly_set_name (f, make_string (title, len), Qnil);
11118 #endif /* not HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
11121 /***********************************************************************
11122 Menu Bars
11123 ***********************************************************************/
11126 /* Prepare for redisplay by updating menu-bar item lists when
11127 appropriate. This can call eval. */
11129 void
11130 prepare_menu_bars (void)
11132 int all_windows;
11133 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
11134 struct frame *f;
11135 Lisp_Object tooltip_frame;
11137 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11138 tooltip_frame = tip_frame;
11139 #else
11140 tooltip_frame = Qnil;
11141 #endif
11143 /* Update all frame titles based on their buffer names, etc. We do
11144 this before the menu bars so that the buffer-menu will show the
11145 up-to-date frame titles. */
11146 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11147 if (windows_or_buffers_changed || update_mode_lines)
11149 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
11151 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
11153 f = XFRAME (frame);
11154 if (!EQ (frame, tooltip_frame)
11155 && (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)))
11156 x_consider_frame_title (frame);
11159 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
11161 /* Update the menu bar item lists, if appropriate. This has to be
11162 done before any actual redisplay or generation of display lines. */
11163 all_windows = (update_mode_lines
11164 || buffer_shared > 1
11165 || windows_or_buffers_changed);
11166 if (all_windows)
11168 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
11169 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11170 /* 1 means that update_menu_bar has run its hooks
11171 so any further calls to update_menu_bar shouldn't do so again. */
11172 int menu_bar_hooks_run = 0;
11174 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
11176 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
11178 f = XFRAME (frame);
11180 /* Ignore tooltip frame. */
11181 if (EQ (frame, tooltip_frame))
11182 continue;
11184 /* If a window on this frame changed size, report that to
11185 the user and clear the size-change flag. */
11186 if (FRAME_WINDOW_SIZES_CHANGED (f))
11188 Lisp_Object functions;
11190 /* Clear flag first in case we get an error below. */
11191 FRAME_WINDOW_SIZES_CHANGED (f) = 0;
11192 functions = Vwindow_size_change_functions;
11193 GCPRO2 (tail, functions);
11195 while (CONSP (functions))
11197 if (!EQ (XCAR (functions), Qt))
11198 call1 (XCAR (functions), frame);
11199 functions = XCDR (functions);
11201 UNGCPRO;
11204 GCPRO1 (tail);
11205 menu_bar_hooks_run = update_menu_bar (f, 0, menu_bar_hooks_run);
11206 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11207 update_tool_bar (f, 0);
11208 #endif
11209 #ifdef HAVE_NS
11210 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
11211 && FRAME_NS_P (f))
11212 ns_set_doc_edited
11213 (f, Fbuffer_modified_p (XWINDOW (f->selected_window)->buffer));
11214 #endif
11215 UNGCPRO;
11218 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11220 else
11222 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
11223 update_menu_bar (sf, 1, 0);
11224 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11225 update_tool_bar (sf, 1);
11226 #endif
11231 /* Update the menu bar item list for frame F. This has to be done
11232 before we start to fill in any display lines, because it can call
11233 eval.
11235 If SAVE_MATCH_DATA is non-zero, we must save and restore it here.
11237 If HOOKS_RUN is 1, that means a previous call to update_menu_bar
11238 already ran the menu bar hooks for this redisplay, so there
11239 is no need to run them again. The return value is the
11240 updated value of this flag, to pass to the next call. */
11242 static int
11243 update_menu_bar (struct frame *f, int save_match_data, int hooks_run)
11245 Lisp_Object window;
11246 register struct window *w;
11248 /* If called recursively during a menu update, do nothing. This can
11249 happen when, for instance, an activate-menubar-hook causes a
11250 redisplay. */
11251 if (inhibit_menubar_update)
11252 return hooks_run;
11254 window = FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f);
11255 w = XWINDOW (window);
11257 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
11259 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
11260 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
11261 FRAME_EXTERNAL_MENU_BAR (f)
11262 #else
11263 FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0
11264 #endif
11265 : FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0)
11267 /* If the user has switched buffers or windows, we need to
11268 recompute to reflect the new bindings. But we'll
11269 recompute when update_mode_lines is set too; that means
11270 that people can use force-mode-line-update to request
11271 that the menu bar be recomputed. The adverse effect on
11272 the rest of the redisplay algorithm is about the same as
11273 windows_or_buffers_changed anyway. */
11274 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
11275 /* This used to test w->update_mode_line, but we believe
11276 there is no need to recompute the menu in that case. */
11277 || update_mode_lines
11278 || ((BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (XBUFFER (w->buffer))
11279 < BUF_MODIFF (XBUFFER (w->buffer)))
11280 != w->last_had_star)
11281 || ((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
11282 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), mark_active)))
11283 != !NILP (w->region_showing)))
11285 struct buffer *prev = current_buffer;
11286 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11288 specbind (Qinhibit_menubar_update, Qt);
11290 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
11291 if (save_match_data)
11292 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
11293 if (NILP (Voverriding_local_map_menu_flag))
11295 specbind (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, Qnil);
11296 specbind (Qoverriding_local_map, Qnil);
11299 if (!hooks_run)
11301 /* Run the Lucid hook. */
11302 safe_run_hooks (Qactivate_menubar_hook);
11304 /* If it has changed current-menubar from previous value,
11305 really recompute the menu-bar from the value. */
11306 if (! NILP (Vlucid_menu_bar_dirty_flag))
11307 call0 (Qrecompute_lucid_menubar);
11309 safe_run_hooks (Qmenu_bar_update_hook);
11311 hooks_run = 1;
11314 XSETFRAME (Vmenu_updating_frame, f);
11315 fset_menu_bar_items (f, menu_bar_items (FRAME_MENU_BAR_ITEMS (f)));
11317 /* Redisplay the menu bar in case we changed it. */
11318 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
11319 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
11320 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
11322 #if defined (HAVE_NS)
11323 /* All frames on Mac OS share the same menubar. So only
11324 the selected frame should be allowed to set it. */
11325 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
11326 #endif
11327 set_frame_menubar (f, 0, 0);
11329 else
11330 /* On a terminal screen, the menu bar is an ordinary screen
11331 line, and this makes it get updated. */
11332 w->update_mode_line = 1;
11333 #else /* ! (USE_X_TOOLKIT || HAVE_NTGUI || HAVE_NS || USE_GTK) */
11334 /* In the non-toolkit version, the menu bar is an ordinary screen
11335 line, and this makes it get updated. */
11336 w->update_mode_line = 1;
11337 #endif /* ! (USE_X_TOOLKIT || HAVE_NTGUI || HAVE_NS || USE_GTK) */
11339 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11340 set_buffer_internal_1 (prev);
11344 return hooks_run;
11349 /***********************************************************************
11350 Output Cursor
11351 ***********************************************************************/
11353 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11355 /* EXPORT:
11356 Nominal cursor position -- where to draw output.
11357 HPOS and VPOS are window relative glyph matrix coordinates.
11358 X and Y are window relative pixel coordinates. */
11360 struct cursor_pos output_cursor;
11363 /* EXPORT:
11364 Set the global variable output_cursor to CURSOR. All cursor
11365 positions are relative to updated_window. */
11367 void
11368 set_output_cursor (struct cursor_pos *cursor)
11370 output_cursor.hpos = cursor->hpos;
11371 output_cursor.vpos = cursor->vpos;
11372 output_cursor.x = cursor->x;
11373 output_cursor.y = cursor->y;
11377 /* EXPORT for RIF:
11378 Set a nominal cursor position.
11380 HPOS and VPOS are column/row positions in a window glyph matrix. X
11381 and Y are window text area relative pixel positions.
11383 If this is done during an update, updated_window will contain the
11384 window that is being updated and the position is the future output
11385 cursor position for that window. If updated_window is null, use
11386 selected_window and display the cursor at the given position. */
11388 void
11389 x_cursor_to (int vpos, int hpos, int y, int x)
11391 struct window *w;
11393 /* If updated_window is not set, work on selected_window. */
11394 if (updated_window)
11395 w = updated_window;
11396 else
11397 w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
11399 /* Set the output cursor. */
11400 output_cursor.hpos = hpos;
11401 output_cursor.vpos = vpos;
11402 output_cursor.x = x;
11403 output_cursor.y = y;
11405 /* If not called as part of an update, really display the cursor.
11406 This will also set the cursor position of W. */
11407 if (updated_window == NULL)
11409 BLOCK_INPUT;
11410 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, hpos, vpos, x, y);
11411 if (FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional)
11412 FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional (SELECTED_FRAME ());
11413 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11417 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
11420 /***********************************************************************
11421 Tool-bars
11422 ***********************************************************************/
11424 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
11426 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
11428 FRAME_PTR last_mouse_frame;
11430 /* Tool-bar item index of the item on which a mouse button was pressed
11431 or -1. */
11433 int last_tool_bar_item;
11436 static Lisp_Object
11437 update_tool_bar_unwind (Lisp_Object frame)
11439 selected_frame = frame;
11440 return Qnil;
11443 /* Update the tool-bar item list for frame F. This has to be done
11444 before we start to fill in any display lines. Called from
11445 prepare_menu_bars. If SAVE_MATCH_DATA is non-zero, we must save
11446 and restore it here. */
11448 static void
11449 update_tool_bar (struct frame *f, int save_match_data)
11451 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
11452 int do_update = FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f);
11453 #else
11454 int do_update = WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11455 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)) > 0;
11456 #endif
11458 if (do_update)
11460 Lisp_Object window;
11461 struct window *w;
11463 window = FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f);
11464 w = XWINDOW (window);
11466 /* If the user has switched buffers or windows, we need to
11467 recompute to reflect the new bindings. But we'll
11468 recompute when update_mode_lines is set too; that means
11469 that people can use force-mode-line-update to request
11470 that the menu bar be recomputed. The adverse effect on
11471 the rest of the redisplay algorithm is about the same as
11472 windows_or_buffers_changed anyway. */
11473 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
11474 || w->update_mode_line
11475 || update_mode_lines
11476 || ((BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (XBUFFER (w->buffer))
11477 < BUF_MODIFF (XBUFFER (w->buffer)))
11478 != w->last_had_star)
11479 || ((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
11480 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), mark_active)))
11481 != !NILP (w->region_showing)))
11483 struct buffer *prev = current_buffer;
11484 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
11485 Lisp_Object frame, new_tool_bar;
11486 int new_n_tool_bar;
11487 struct gcpro gcpro1;
11489 /* Set current_buffer to the buffer of the selected
11490 window of the frame, so that we get the right local
11491 keymaps. */
11492 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
11494 /* Save match data, if we must. */
11495 if (save_match_data)
11496 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
11498 /* Make sure that we don't accidentally use bogus keymaps. */
11499 if (NILP (Voverriding_local_map_menu_flag))
11501 specbind (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, Qnil);
11502 specbind (Qoverriding_local_map, Qnil);
11505 GCPRO1 (new_tool_bar);
11507 /* We must temporarily set the selected frame to this frame
11508 before calling tool_bar_items, because the calculation of
11509 the tool-bar keymap uses the selected frame (see
11510 `tool-bar-make-keymap' in tool-bar.el). */
11511 record_unwind_protect (update_tool_bar_unwind, selected_frame);
11512 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
11513 selected_frame = frame;
11515 /* Build desired tool-bar items from keymaps. */
11516 new_tool_bar
11517 = tool_bar_items (Fcopy_sequence (f->tool_bar_items),
11518 &new_n_tool_bar);
11520 /* Redisplay the tool-bar if we changed it. */
11521 if (new_n_tool_bar != f->n_tool_bar_items
11522 || NILP (Fequal (new_tool_bar, f->tool_bar_items)))
11524 /* Redisplay that happens asynchronously due to an expose event
11525 may access f->tool_bar_items. Make sure we update both
11526 variables within BLOCK_INPUT so no such event interrupts. */
11527 BLOCK_INPUT;
11528 fset_tool_bar_items (f, new_tool_bar);
11529 f->n_tool_bar_items = new_n_tool_bar;
11530 w->update_mode_line = 1;
11531 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11534 UNGCPRO;
11536 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
11537 set_buffer_internal_1 (prev);
11543 /* Set F->desired_tool_bar_string to a Lisp string representing frame
11544 F's desired tool-bar contents. F->tool_bar_items must have
11545 been set up previously by calling prepare_menu_bars. */
11547 static void
11548 build_desired_tool_bar_string (struct frame *f)
11550 int i, size, size_needed;
11551 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2, gcpro3;
11552 Lisp_Object image, plist, props;
11554 image = plist = props = Qnil;
11555 GCPRO3 (image, plist, props);
11557 /* Prepare F->desired_tool_bar_string. If we can reuse it, do so.
11558 Otherwise, make a new string. */
11560 /* The size of the string we might be able to reuse. */
11561 size = (STRINGP (f->desired_tool_bar_string)
11562 ? SCHARS (f->desired_tool_bar_string)
11563 : 0);
11565 /* We need one space in the string for each image. */
11566 size_needed = f->n_tool_bar_items;
11568 /* Reuse f->desired_tool_bar_string, if possible. */
11569 if (size < size_needed || NILP (f->desired_tool_bar_string))
11570 fset_desired_tool_bar_string
11571 (f, Fmake_string (make_number (size_needed), make_number (' ')));
11572 else
11574 props = list4 (Qdisplay, Qnil, Qmenu_item, Qnil);
11575 Fremove_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (size),
11576 props, f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11579 /* Put a `display' property on the string for the images to display,
11580 put a `menu_item' property on tool-bar items with a value that
11581 is the index of the item in F's tool-bar item vector. */
11582 for (i = 0; i < f->n_tool_bar_items; ++i)
11584 #define PROP(IDX) \
11585 AREF (f->tool_bar_items, i * TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS + (IDX))
11587 int enabled_p = !NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P));
11588 int selected_p = !NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_SELECTED_P));
11589 int hmargin, vmargin, relief, idx, end;
11591 /* If image is a vector, choose the image according to the
11592 button state. */
11593 image = PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_IMAGES);
11594 if (VECTORP (image))
11596 if (enabled_p)
11597 idx = (selected_p
11598 ? TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_ENABLED_SELECTED
11599 : TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_ENABLED_DESELECTED);
11600 else
11601 idx = (selected_p
11602 ? TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DISABLED_SELECTED
11603 : TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DISABLED_DESELECTED);
11605 eassert (ASIZE (image) >= idx);
11606 image = AREF (image, idx);
11608 else
11609 idx = -1;
11611 /* Ignore invalid image specifications. */
11612 if (!valid_image_p (image))
11613 continue;
11615 /* Display the tool-bar button pressed, or depressed. */
11616 plist = Fcopy_sequence (XCDR (image));
11618 /* Compute margin and relief to draw. */
11619 relief = (tool_bar_button_relief >= 0
11620 ? tool_bar_button_relief
11621 : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF);
11622 hmargin = vmargin = relief;
11624 if (RANGED_INTEGERP (1, Vtool_bar_button_margin,
11625 INT_MAX - max (hmargin, vmargin)))
11627 hmargin += XFASTINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
11628 vmargin += XFASTINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
11630 else if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
11632 if (RANGED_INTEGERP (1, XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin),
11633 INT_MAX - hmargin))
11634 hmargin += XFASTINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
11636 if (RANGED_INTEGERP (1, XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin),
11637 INT_MAX - vmargin))
11638 vmargin += XFASTINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
11641 if (auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p)
11643 /* Add a `:relief' property to the image spec if the item is
11644 selected. */
11645 if (selected_p)
11647 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCrelief, make_number (-relief));
11648 hmargin -= relief;
11649 vmargin -= relief;
11652 else
11654 /* If image is selected, display it pressed, i.e. with a
11655 negative relief. If it's not selected, display it with a
11656 raised relief. */
11657 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCrelief,
11658 (selected_p
11659 ? make_number (-relief)
11660 : make_number (relief)));
11661 hmargin -= relief;
11662 vmargin -= relief;
11665 /* Put a margin around the image. */
11666 if (hmargin || vmargin)
11668 if (hmargin == vmargin)
11669 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCmargin, make_number (hmargin));
11670 else
11671 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCmargin,
11672 Fcons (make_number (hmargin),
11673 make_number (vmargin)));
11676 /* If button is not enabled, and we don't have special images
11677 for the disabled state, make the image appear disabled by
11678 applying an appropriate algorithm to it. */
11679 if (!enabled_p && idx < 0)
11680 plist = Fplist_put (plist, QCconversion, Qdisabled);
11682 /* Put a `display' text property on the string for the image to
11683 display. Put a `menu-item' property on the string that gives
11684 the start of this item's properties in the tool-bar items
11685 vector. */
11686 image = Fcons (Qimage, plist);
11687 props = list4 (Qdisplay, image,
11688 Qmenu_item, make_number (i * TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS));
11690 /* Let the last image hide all remaining spaces in the tool bar
11691 string. The string can be longer than needed when we reuse a
11692 previous string. */
11693 if (i + 1 == f->n_tool_bar_items)
11694 end = SCHARS (f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11695 else
11696 end = i + 1;
11697 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (i), make_number (end),
11698 props, f->desired_tool_bar_string);
11699 #undef PROP
11702 UNGCPRO;
11706 /* Display one line of the tool-bar of frame IT->f.
11708 HEIGHT specifies the desired height of the tool-bar line.
11709 If the actual height of the glyph row is less than HEIGHT, the
11710 row's height is increased to HEIGHT, and the icons are centered
11711 vertically in the new height.
11713 If HEIGHT is -1, we are counting needed tool-bar lines, so don't
11714 count a final empty row in case the tool-bar width exactly matches
11715 the window width.
11718 static void
11719 display_tool_bar_line (struct it *it, int height)
11721 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
11722 int max_x = it->last_visible_x;
11723 struct glyph *last;
11725 prepare_desired_row (row);
11726 row->y = it->current_y;
11728 /* Note that this isn't made use of if the face hasn't a box,
11729 so there's no need to check the face here. */
11730 it->start_of_box_run_p = 1;
11732 while (it->current_x < max_x)
11734 int x, n_glyphs_before, i, nglyphs;
11735 struct it it_before;
11737 /* Get the next display element. */
11738 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
11740 /* Don't count empty row if we are counting needed tool-bar lines. */
11741 if (height < 0 && !it->hpos)
11742 return;
11743 break;
11746 /* Produce glyphs. */
11747 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
11748 it_before = *it;
11750 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
11752 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
11753 i = 0;
11754 x = it_before.current_x;
11755 while (i < nglyphs)
11757 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
11759 if (x + glyph->pixel_width > max_x)
11761 /* Glyph doesn't fit on line. Backtrack. */
11762 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
11763 *it = it_before;
11764 /* If this is the only glyph on this line, it will never fit on the
11765 tool-bar, so skip it. But ensure there is at least one glyph,
11766 so we don't accidentally disable the tool-bar. */
11767 if (n_glyphs_before == 0
11768 && (it->vpos > 0 || IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) < it->end_charpos-1))
11769 break;
11770 goto out;
11773 ++it->hpos;
11774 x += glyph->pixel_width;
11775 ++i;
11778 /* Stop at line end. */
11779 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
11780 break;
11782 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
11785 out:;
11787 row->displays_text_p = row->used[TEXT_AREA] != 0;
11789 /* Use default face for the border below the tool bar.
11791 FIXME: When auto-resize-tool-bars is grow-only, there is
11792 no additional border below the possibly empty tool-bar lines.
11793 So to make the extra empty lines look "normal", we have to
11794 use the tool-bar face for the border too. */
11795 if (!row->displays_text_p && !EQ (Vauto_resize_tool_bars, Qgrow_only))
11796 it->face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
11798 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
11799 last = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
11800 last->right_box_line_p = 1;
11801 if (last == row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA])
11802 last->left_box_line_p = 1;
11804 /* Make line the desired height and center it vertically. */
11805 if ((height -= it->max_ascent + it->max_descent) > 0)
11807 /* Don't add more than one line height. */
11808 height %= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f);
11809 it->max_ascent += height / 2;
11810 it->max_descent += (height + 1) / 2;
11813 compute_line_metrics (it);
11815 /* If line is empty, make it occupy the rest of the tool-bar. */
11816 if (!row->displays_text_p)
11818 row->height = row->phys_height = it->last_visible_y - row->y;
11819 row->visible_height = row->height;
11820 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent = 0;
11821 row->extra_line_spacing = 0;
11824 row->full_width_p = 1;
11825 row->continued_p = 0;
11826 row->truncated_on_left_p = 0;
11827 row->truncated_on_right_p = 0;
11829 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
11830 it->current_y += row->height;
11831 ++it->vpos;
11832 ++it->glyph_row;
11836 /* Max tool-bar height. */
11838 #define MAX_FRAME_TOOL_BAR_HEIGHT(f) \
11839 ((FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * FRAME_LINES (f)))
11841 /* Value is the number of screen lines needed to make all tool-bar
11842 items of frame F visible. The number of actual rows needed is
11843 returned in *N_ROWS if non-NULL. */
11845 static int
11846 tool_bar_lines_needed (struct frame *f, int *n_rows)
11848 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
11849 struct it it;
11850 /* tool_bar_lines_needed is called from redisplay_tool_bar after building
11851 the desired matrix, so use (unused) mode-line row as temporary row to
11852 avoid destroying the first tool-bar row. */
11853 struct glyph_row *temp_row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
11855 /* Initialize an iterator for iteration over
11856 F->desired_tool_bar_string in the tool-bar window of frame F. */
11857 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, temp_row, TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID);
11858 it.first_visible_x = 0;
11859 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
11860 reseat_to_string (&it, NULL, f->desired_tool_bar_string, 0, 0, 0, -1);
11861 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
11863 while (!ITERATOR_AT_END_P (&it))
11865 clear_glyph_row (temp_row);
11866 it.glyph_row = temp_row;
11867 display_tool_bar_line (&it, -1);
11869 clear_glyph_row (temp_row);
11871 /* f->n_tool_bar_rows == 0 means "unknown"; -1 means no tool-bar. */
11872 if (n_rows)
11873 *n_rows = it.vpos > 0 ? it.vpos : -1;
11875 return (it.current_y + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) - 1) / FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
11879 DEFUN ("tool-bar-lines-needed", Ftool_bar_lines_needed, Stool_bar_lines_needed,
11880 0, 1, 0,
11881 doc: /* Return the number of lines occupied by the tool bar of FRAME. */)
11882 (Lisp_Object frame)
11884 struct frame *f;
11885 struct window *w;
11886 int nlines = 0;
11888 if (NILP (frame))
11889 frame = selected_frame;
11890 else
11891 CHECK_FRAME (frame);
11892 f = XFRAME (frame);
11894 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11895 && (w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window),
11896 WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) > 0))
11898 update_tool_bar (f, 1);
11899 if (f->n_tool_bar_items)
11901 build_desired_tool_bar_string (f);
11902 nlines = tool_bar_lines_needed (f, NULL);
11906 return make_number (nlines);
11910 /* Display the tool-bar of frame F. Value is non-zero if tool-bar's
11911 height should be changed. */
11913 static int
11914 redisplay_tool_bar (struct frame *f)
11916 struct window *w;
11917 struct it it;
11918 struct glyph_row *row;
11920 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
11921 if (FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f))
11922 update_frame_tool_bar (f);
11923 return 0;
11924 #endif
11926 /* If frame hasn't a tool-bar window or if it is zero-height, don't
11927 do anything. This means you must start with tool-bar-lines
11928 non-zero to get the auto-sizing effect. Or in other words, you
11929 can turn off tool-bars by specifying tool-bar-lines zero. */
11930 if (!WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
11931 || (w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window),
11932 WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) == 0))
11933 return 0;
11935 /* Set up an iterator for the tool-bar window. */
11936 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, w->desired_matrix->rows, TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID);
11937 it.first_visible_x = 0;
11938 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
11939 row = it.glyph_row;
11941 /* Build a string that represents the contents of the tool-bar. */
11942 build_desired_tool_bar_string (f);
11943 reseat_to_string (&it, NULL, f->desired_tool_bar_string, 0, 0, 0, -1);
11944 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. But it
11945 doesn't make sense to have an R2L tool bar if the menu bar cannot
11946 be drawn also R2L, and making the menu bar R2L is tricky due
11947 toolkit-specific code that implements it. If an R2L tool bar is
11948 ever supported, display_tool_bar_line should also be augmented to
11949 call unproduce_glyphs like display_line and display_string
11950 do. */
11951 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
11953 if (f->n_tool_bar_rows == 0)
11955 int nlines;
11957 if ((nlines = tool_bar_lines_needed (f, &f->n_tool_bar_rows),
11958 nlines != WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w)))
11960 Lisp_Object frame;
11961 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
11963 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
11964 Fmodify_frame_parameters (frame,
11965 Fcons (Fcons (Qtool_bar_lines,
11966 make_number (nlines)),
11967 Qnil));
11968 if (WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height)
11970 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
11971 fonts_changed_p = 1;
11972 return 1;
11977 /* Display as many lines as needed to display all tool-bar items. */
11979 if (f->n_tool_bar_rows > 0)
11981 int border, rows, height, extra;
11983 if (TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, Vtool_bar_border))
11984 border = XINT (Vtool_bar_border);
11985 else if (EQ (Vtool_bar_border, Qinternal_border_width))
11986 border = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
11987 else if (EQ (Vtool_bar_border, Qborder_width))
11988 border = f->border_width;
11989 else
11990 border = 0;
11991 if (border < 0)
11992 border = 0;
11994 rows = f->n_tool_bar_rows;
11995 height = max (1, (it.last_visible_y - border) / rows);
11996 extra = it.last_visible_y - border - height * rows;
11998 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
12000 int h = 0;
12001 if (extra > 0 && rows-- > 0)
12003 h = (extra + rows - 1) / rows;
12004 extra -= h;
12006 display_tool_bar_line (&it, height + h);
12009 else
12011 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
12012 display_tool_bar_line (&it, 0);
12015 /* It doesn't make much sense to try scrolling in the tool-bar
12016 window, so don't do it. */
12017 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
12018 w->must_be_updated_p = 1;
12020 if (!NILP (Vauto_resize_tool_bars))
12022 int max_tool_bar_height = MAX_FRAME_TOOL_BAR_HEIGHT (f);
12023 int change_height_p = 0;
12025 /* If we couldn't display everything, change the tool-bar's
12026 height if there is room for more. */
12027 if (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (it) < it.end_charpos
12028 && it.current_y < max_tool_bar_height)
12029 change_height_p = 1;
12031 row = it.glyph_row - 1;
12033 /* If there are blank lines at the end, except for a partially
12034 visible blank line at the end that is smaller than
12035 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT, change the tool-bar's height. */
12036 if (!row->displays_text_p
12037 && row->height >= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
12038 change_height_p = 1;
12040 /* If row displays tool-bar items, but is partially visible,
12041 change the tool-bar's height. */
12042 if (row->displays_text_p
12043 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > it.last_visible_y
12044 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < max_tool_bar_height)
12045 change_height_p = 1;
12047 /* Resize windows as needed by changing the `tool-bar-lines'
12048 frame parameter. */
12049 if (change_height_p)
12051 Lisp_Object frame;
12052 int old_height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
12053 int nrows;
12054 int nlines = tool_bar_lines_needed (f, &nrows);
12056 change_height_p = ((EQ (Vauto_resize_tool_bars, Qgrow_only)
12057 && !f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p)
12058 ? (nlines > old_height)
12059 : (nlines != old_height));
12060 f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p = 0;
12062 if (change_height_p)
12064 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
12065 Fmodify_frame_parameters (frame,
12066 Fcons (Fcons (Qtool_bar_lines,
12067 make_number (nlines)),
12068 Qnil));
12069 if (WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) != old_height)
12071 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
12072 f->n_tool_bar_rows = nrows;
12073 fonts_changed_p = 1;
12074 return 1;
12080 f->minimize_tool_bar_window_p = 0;
12081 return 0;
12085 /* Get information about the tool-bar item which is displayed in GLYPH
12086 on frame F. Return in *PROP_IDX the index where tool-bar item
12087 properties start in F->tool_bar_items. Value is zero if
12088 GLYPH doesn't display a tool-bar item. */
12090 static int
12091 tool_bar_item_info (struct frame *f, struct glyph *glyph, int *prop_idx)
12093 Lisp_Object prop;
12094 int success_p;
12095 int charpos;
12097 /* This function can be called asynchronously, which means we must
12098 exclude any possibility that Fget_text_property signals an
12099 error. */
12100 charpos = min (SCHARS (f->current_tool_bar_string), glyph->charpos);
12101 charpos = max (0, charpos);
12103 /* Get the text property `menu-item' at pos. The value of that
12104 property is the start index of this item's properties in
12105 F->tool_bar_items. */
12106 prop = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
12107 Qmenu_item, f->current_tool_bar_string);
12108 if (INTEGERP (prop))
12110 *prop_idx = XINT (prop);
12111 success_p = 1;
12113 else
12114 success_p = 0;
12116 return success_p;
12120 /* Get information about the tool-bar item at position X/Y on frame F.
12121 Return in *GLYPH a pointer to the glyph of the tool-bar item in
12122 the current matrix of the tool-bar window of F, or NULL if not
12123 on a tool-bar item. Return in *PROP_IDX the index of the tool-bar
12124 item in F->tool_bar_items. Value is
12126 -1 if X/Y is not on a tool-bar item
12127 0 if X/Y is on the same item that was highlighted before.
12128 1 otherwise. */
12130 static int
12131 get_tool_bar_item (struct frame *f, int x, int y, struct glyph **glyph,
12132 int *hpos, int *vpos, int *prop_idx)
12134 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
12135 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
12136 int area;
12138 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
12139 *glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, hpos, vpos, 0, 0, &area);
12140 if (*glyph == NULL)
12141 return -1;
12143 /* Get the start of this tool-bar item's properties in
12144 f->tool_bar_items. */
12145 if (!tool_bar_item_info (f, *glyph, prop_idx))
12146 return -1;
12148 /* Is mouse on the highlighted item? */
12149 if (EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
12150 && *vpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
12151 && *vpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
12152 && (*vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
12153 || *hpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
12154 && (*vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
12155 || *hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col
12156 || hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end))
12157 return 0;
12159 return 1;
12163 /* EXPORT:
12164 Handle mouse button event on the tool-bar of frame F, at
12165 frame-relative coordinates X/Y. DOWN_P is 1 for a button press,
12166 0 for button release. MODIFIERS is event modifiers for button
12167 release. */
12169 void
12170 handle_tool_bar_click (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int down_p,
12171 int modifiers)
12173 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
12174 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
12175 int hpos, vpos, prop_idx;
12176 struct glyph *glyph;
12177 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
12179 /* If not on the highlighted tool-bar item, return. */
12180 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
12181 if (get_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx) != 0)
12182 return;
12184 /* If item is disabled, do nothing. */
12185 enabled_p = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P);
12186 if (NILP (enabled_p))
12187 return;
12189 if (down_p)
12191 /* Show item in pressed state. */
12192 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN);
12193 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN;
12194 last_tool_bar_item = prop_idx;
12196 else
12198 Lisp_Object key, frame;
12199 struct input_event event;
12200 EVENT_INIT (event);
12202 /* Show item in released state. */
12203 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED);
12204 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
12206 key = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_KEY);
12208 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
12209 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
12210 event.frame_or_window = frame;
12211 event.arg = frame;
12212 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
12214 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
12215 event.frame_or_window = frame;
12216 event.arg = key;
12217 event.modifiers = modifiers;
12218 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
12219 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
12224 /* Possibly highlight a tool-bar item on frame F when mouse moves to
12225 tool-bar window-relative coordinates X/Y. Called from
12226 note_mouse_highlight. */
12228 static void
12229 note_tool_bar_highlight (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
12231 Lisp_Object window = f->tool_bar_window;
12232 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
12233 Display_Info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
12234 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
12235 int hpos, vpos;
12236 struct glyph *glyph;
12237 struct glyph_row *row;
12238 int i;
12239 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
12240 int prop_idx;
12241 enum draw_glyphs_face draw = DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
12242 int mouse_down_p, rc;
12244 /* Function note_mouse_highlight is called with negative X/Y
12245 values when mouse moves outside of the frame. */
12246 if (x <= 0 || y <= 0)
12248 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
12249 return;
12252 rc = get_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx);
12253 if (rc < 0)
12255 /* Not on tool-bar item. */
12256 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
12257 return;
12259 else if (rc == 0)
12260 /* On same tool-bar item as before. */
12261 goto set_help_echo;
12263 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
12265 /* Mouse is down, but on different tool-bar item? */
12266 mouse_down_p = (dpyinfo->grabbed
12267 && f == last_mouse_frame
12268 && FRAME_LIVE_P (f));
12269 if (mouse_down_p
12270 && last_tool_bar_item != prop_idx)
12271 return;
12273 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
12274 draw = mouse_down_p ? DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN : DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
12276 /* If tool-bar item is not enabled, don't highlight it. */
12277 enabled_p = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P);
12278 if (!NILP (enabled_p))
12280 /* Compute the x-position of the glyph. In front and past the
12281 image is a space. We include this in the highlighted area. */
12282 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
12283 for (i = x = 0; i < hpos; ++i)
12284 x += row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i].pixel_width;
12286 /* Record this as the current active region. */
12287 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos;
12288 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = vpos;
12289 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
12290 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = row->y;
12291 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
12293 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos + 1;
12294 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = vpos;
12295 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x + glyph->pixel_width;
12296 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = row->y;
12297 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
12298 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID;
12300 /* Display it as active. */
12301 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, draw);
12302 hlinfo->mouse_face_image_state = draw;
12305 set_help_echo:
12307 /* Set help_echo_string to a help string to display for this tool-bar item.
12308 XTread_socket does the rest. */
12309 help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
12310 help_echo_pos = -1;
12311 help_echo_string = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_HELP);
12312 if (NILP (help_echo_string))
12313 help_echo_string = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_CAPTION);
12316 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
12320 /************************************************************************
12321 Horizontal scrolling
12322 ************************************************************************/
12324 static int hscroll_window_tree (Lisp_Object);
12325 static int hscroll_windows (Lisp_Object);
12327 /* For all leaf windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW, set their
12328 hscroll value so that PT is (i) visible in the window, and (ii) so
12329 that it is not within a certain margin at the window's left and
12330 right border. Value is non-zero if any window's hscroll has been
12331 changed. */
12333 static int
12334 hscroll_window_tree (Lisp_Object window)
12336 int hscrolled_p = 0;
12337 int hscroll_relative_p = FLOATP (Vhscroll_step);
12338 int hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12339 double hscroll_step_rel = 0;
12341 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12343 hscroll_step_rel = XFLOAT_DATA (Vhscroll_step);
12344 if (hscroll_step_rel < 0)
12346 hscroll_relative_p = 0;
12347 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12350 else if (TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, Vhscroll_step))
12352 hscroll_step_abs = XINT (Vhscroll_step);
12353 if (hscroll_step_abs < 0)
12354 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12356 else
12357 hscroll_step_abs = 0;
12359 while (WINDOWP (window))
12361 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
12363 if (WINDOWP (w->hchild))
12364 hscrolled_p |= hscroll_window_tree (w->hchild);
12365 else if (WINDOWP (w->vchild))
12366 hscrolled_p |= hscroll_window_tree (w->vchild);
12367 else if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0)
12369 int h_margin;
12370 int text_area_width;
12371 struct glyph_row *current_cursor_row
12372 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
12373 struct glyph_row *desired_cursor_row
12374 = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
12375 struct glyph_row *cursor_row
12376 = (desired_cursor_row->enabled_p
12377 ? desired_cursor_row
12378 : current_cursor_row);
12379 int row_r2l_p = cursor_row->reversed_p;
12381 text_area_width = window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
12383 /* Scroll when cursor is inside this scroll margin. */
12384 h_margin = hscroll_margin * WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w);
12386 if (!NILP (Fbuffer_local_value (Qauto_hscroll_mode, w->buffer))
12387 /* For left-to-right rows, hscroll when cursor is either
12388 (i) inside the right hscroll margin, or (ii) if it is
12389 inside the left margin and the window is already
12390 hscrolled. */
12391 && ((!row_r2l_p
12392 && ((w->hscroll
12393 && w->cursor.x <= h_margin)
12394 || (cursor_row->enabled_p
12395 && cursor_row->truncated_on_right_p
12396 && (w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin))))
12397 /* For right-to-left rows, the logic is similar,
12398 except that rules for scrolling to left and right
12399 are reversed. E.g., if cursor.x <= h_margin, we
12400 need to hscroll "to the right" unconditionally,
12401 and that will scroll the screen to the left so as
12402 to reveal the next portion of the row. */
12403 || (row_r2l_p
12404 && ((cursor_row->enabled_p
12405 /* FIXME: It is confusing to set the
12406 truncated_on_right_p flag when R2L rows
12407 are actually truncated on the left. */
12408 && cursor_row->truncated_on_right_p
12409 && w->cursor.x <= h_margin)
12410 || (w->hscroll
12411 && (w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin))))))
12413 struct it it;
12414 ptrdiff_t hscroll;
12415 struct buffer *saved_current_buffer;
12416 ptrdiff_t pt;
12417 int wanted_x;
12419 /* Find point in a display of infinite width. */
12420 saved_current_buffer = current_buffer;
12421 current_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
12423 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
12424 pt = PT;
12425 else
12427 pt = marker_position (w->pointm);
12428 pt = max (BEGV, pt);
12429 pt = min (ZV, pt);
12432 /* Move iterator to pt starting at cursor_row->start in
12433 a line with infinite width. */
12434 init_to_row_start (&it, w, cursor_row);
12435 it.last_visible_x = INFINITY;
12436 move_it_in_display_line_to (&it, pt, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
12437 current_buffer = saved_current_buffer;
12439 /* Position cursor in window. */
12440 if (!hscroll_relative_p && hscroll_step_abs == 0)
12441 hscroll = max (0, (it.current_x
12442 - (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (&it)
12443 ? (text_area_width - 4 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f))
12444 : (text_area_width / 2))))
12445 / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12446 else if ((!row_r2l_p
12447 && w->cursor.x >= text_area_width - h_margin)
12448 || (row_r2l_p && w->cursor.x <= h_margin))
12450 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12451 wanted_x = text_area_width * (1 - hscroll_step_rel)
12452 - h_margin;
12453 else
12454 wanted_x = text_area_width
12455 - hscroll_step_abs * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f)
12456 - h_margin;
12457 hscroll
12458 = max (0, it.current_x - wanted_x) / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12460 else
12462 if (hscroll_relative_p)
12463 wanted_x = text_area_width * hscroll_step_rel
12464 + h_margin;
12465 else
12466 wanted_x = hscroll_step_abs * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f)
12467 + h_margin;
12468 hscroll
12469 = max (0, it.current_x - wanted_x) / FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it.f);
12471 hscroll = max (hscroll, w->min_hscroll);
12473 /* Don't prevent redisplay optimizations if hscroll
12474 hasn't changed, as it will unnecessarily slow down
12475 redisplay. */
12476 if (w->hscroll != hscroll)
12478 XBUFFER (w->buffer)->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p = 1;
12479 w->hscroll = hscroll;
12480 hscrolled_p = 1;
12485 window = w->next;
12488 /* Value is non-zero if hscroll of any leaf window has been changed. */
12489 return hscrolled_p;
12493 /* Set hscroll so that cursor is visible and not inside horizontal
12494 scroll margins for all windows in the tree rooted at WINDOW. See
12495 also hscroll_window_tree above. Value is non-zero if any window's
12496 hscroll has been changed. If it has, desired matrices on the frame
12497 of WINDOW are cleared. */
12499 static int
12500 hscroll_windows (Lisp_Object window)
12502 int hscrolled_p = hscroll_window_tree (window);
12503 if (hscrolled_p)
12504 clear_desired_matrices (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (window))));
12505 return hscrolled_p;
12510 /************************************************************************
12511 Redisplay
12512 ************************************************************************/
12514 /* Variables holding some state of redisplay if GLYPH_DEBUG is defined
12515 to a non-zero value. This is sometimes handy to have in a debugger
12516 session. */
12518 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
12520 /* First and last unchanged row for try_window_id. */
12522 static int debug_first_unchanged_at_end_vpos;
12523 static int debug_last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos;
12525 /* Delta vpos and y. */
12527 static int debug_dvpos, debug_dy;
12529 /* Delta in characters and bytes for try_window_id. */
12531 static ptrdiff_t debug_delta, debug_delta_bytes;
12533 /* Values of window_end_pos and window_end_vpos at the end of
12534 try_window_id. */
12536 static ptrdiff_t debug_end_vpos;
12538 /* Append a string to W->desired_matrix->method. FMT is a printf
12539 format string. If trace_redisplay_p is non-zero also printf the
12540 resulting string to stderr. */
12542 static void debug_method_add (struct window *, char const *, ...)
12543 ATTRIBUTE_FORMAT_PRINTF (2, 3);
12545 static void
12546 debug_method_add (struct window *w, char const *fmt, ...)
12548 char *method = w->desired_matrix->method;
12549 int len = strlen (method);
12550 int size = sizeof w->desired_matrix->method;
12551 int remaining = size - len - 1;
12552 va_list ap;
12554 if (len && remaining)
12556 method[len] = '|';
12557 --remaining, ++len;
12560 va_start (ap, fmt);
12561 vsnprintf (method + len, remaining + 1, fmt, ap);
12562 va_end (ap);
12564 if (trace_redisplay_p)
12565 fprintf (stderr, "%p (%s): %s\n",
12567 ((BUFFERP (w->buffer)
12568 && STRINGP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), name)))
12569 ? SSDATA (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), name))
12570 : "no buffer"),
12571 method + len);
12574 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
12577 /* Value is non-zero if all changes in window W, which displays
12578 current_buffer, are in the text between START and END. START is a
12579 buffer position, END is given as a distance from Z. Used in
12580 redisplay_internal for display optimization. */
12582 static inline int
12583 text_outside_line_unchanged_p (struct window *w,
12584 ptrdiff_t start, ptrdiff_t end)
12586 int unchanged_p = 1;
12588 /* If text or overlays have changed, see where. */
12589 if (w->last_modified < MODIFF
12590 || w->last_overlay_modified < OVERLAY_MODIFF)
12592 /* Gap in the line? */
12593 if (GPT < start || Z - GPT < end)
12594 unchanged_p = 0;
12596 /* Changes start in front of the line, or end after it? */
12597 if (unchanged_p
12598 && (BEG_UNCHANGED < start - 1
12599 || END_UNCHANGED < end))
12600 unchanged_p = 0;
12602 /* If selective display, can't optimize if changes start at the
12603 beginning of the line. */
12604 if (unchanged_p
12605 && INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
12606 && XINT (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display)) > 0
12607 && (BEG_UNCHANGED < start || GPT <= start))
12608 unchanged_p = 0;
12610 /* If there are overlays at the start or end of the line, these
12611 may have overlay strings with newlines in them. A change at
12612 START, for instance, may actually concern the display of such
12613 overlay strings as well, and they are displayed on different
12614 lines. So, quickly rule out this case. (For the future, it
12615 might be desirable to implement something more telling than
12616 just BEG/END_UNCHANGED.) */
12617 if (unchanged_p)
12619 if (BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED == start
12620 && overlay_touches_p (start))
12621 unchanged_p = 0;
12622 if (END_UNCHANGED == end
12623 && overlay_touches_p (Z - end))
12624 unchanged_p = 0;
12627 /* Under bidi reordering, adding or deleting a character in the
12628 beginning of a paragraph, before the first strong directional
12629 character, can change the base direction of the paragraph (unless
12630 the buffer specifies a fixed paragraph direction), which will
12631 require to redisplay the whole paragraph. It might be worthwhile
12632 to find the paragraph limits and widen the range of redisplayed
12633 lines to that, but for now just give up this optimization. */
12634 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
12635 && NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_paragraph_direction)))
12636 unchanged_p = 0;
12639 return unchanged_p;
12643 /* Do a frame update, taking possible shortcuts into account. This is
12644 the main external entry point for redisplay.
12646 If the last redisplay displayed an echo area message and that message
12647 is no longer requested, we clear the echo area or bring back the
12648 mini-buffer if that is in use. */
12650 void
12651 redisplay (void)
12653 redisplay_internal ();
12657 static Lisp_Object
12658 overlay_arrow_string_or_property (Lisp_Object var)
12660 Lisp_Object val;
12662 if (val = Fget (var, Qoverlay_arrow_string), STRINGP (val))
12663 return val;
12665 return Voverlay_arrow_string;
12668 /* Return 1 if there are any overlay-arrows in current_buffer. */
12669 static int
12670 overlay_arrow_in_current_buffer_p (void)
12672 Lisp_Object vlist;
12674 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12675 CONSP (vlist);
12676 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12678 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12679 Lisp_Object val;
12681 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12682 continue;
12683 val = find_symbol_value (var);
12684 if (MARKERP (val)
12685 && current_buffer == XMARKER (val)->buffer)
12686 return 1;
12688 return 0;
12692 /* Return 1 if any overlay_arrows have moved or overlay-arrow-string
12693 has changed. */
12695 static int
12696 overlay_arrows_changed_p (void)
12698 Lisp_Object vlist;
12700 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12701 CONSP (vlist);
12702 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12704 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12705 Lisp_Object val, pstr;
12707 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12708 continue;
12709 val = find_symbol_value (var);
12710 if (!MARKERP (val))
12711 continue;
12712 if (! EQ (COERCE_MARKER (val),
12713 Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_position))
12714 || ! (pstr = overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var),
12715 EQ (pstr, Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_string))))
12716 return 1;
12718 return 0;
12721 /* Mark overlay arrows to be updated on next redisplay. */
12723 static void
12724 update_overlay_arrows (int up_to_date)
12726 Lisp_Object vlist;
12728 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12729 CONSP (vlist);
12730 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12732 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12734 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12735 continue;
12737 if (up_to_date > 0)
12739 Lisp_Object val = find_symbol_value (var);
12740 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_position,
12741 COERCE_MARKER (val));
12742 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_string,
12743 overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var));
12745 else if (up_to_date < 0
12746 || !NILP (Fget (var, Qlast_arrow_position)))
12748 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_position, Qt);
12749 Fput (var, Qlast_arrow_string, Qt);
12755 /* Return overlay arrow string to display at row.
12756 Return integer (bitmap number) for arrow bitmap in left fringe.
12757 Return nil if no overlay arrow. */
12759 static Lisp_Object
12760 overlay_arrow_at_row (struct it *it, struct glyph_row *row)
12762 Lisp_Object vlist;
12764 for (vlist = Voverlay_arrow_variable_list;
12765 CONSP (vlist);
12766 vlist = XCDR (vlist))
12768 Lisp_Object var = XCAR (vlist);
12769 Lisp_Object val;
12771 if (!SYMBOLP (var))
12772 continue;
12774 val = find_symbol_value (var);
12776 if (MARKERP (val)
12777 && current_buffer == XMARKER (val)->buffer
12778 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == marker_position (val)))
12780 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
12781 /* FIXME: if ROW->reversed_p is set, this should test
12782 the right fringe, not the left one. */
12783 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) > 0)
12785 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
12786 if (val = Fget (var, Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap), SYMBOLP (val))
12788 int fringe_bitmap;
12789 if ((fringe_bitmap = lookup_fringe_bitmap (val)) != 0)
12790 return make_number (fringe_bitmap);
12792 #endif
12793 return make_number (-1); /* Use default arrow bitmap */
12795 return overlay_arrow_string_or_property (var);
12799 return Qnil;
12802 /* Return 1 if point moved out of or into a composition. Otherwise
12803 return 0. PREV_BUF and PREV_PT are the last point buffer and
12804 position. BUF and PT are the current point buffer and position. */
12806 static int
12807 check_point_in_composition (struct buffer *prev_buf, ptrdiff_t prev_pt,
12808 struct buffer *buf, ptrdiff_t pt)
12810 ptrdiff_t start, end;
12811 Lisp_Object prop;
12812 Lisp_Object buffer;
12814 XSETBUFFER (buffer, buf);
12815 /* Check a composition at the last point if point moved within the
12816 same buffer. */
12817 if (prev_buf == buf)
12819 if (prev_pt == pt)
12820 /* Point didn't move. */
12821 return 0;
12823 if (prev_pt > BUF_BEGV (buf) && prev_pt < BUF_ZV (buf)
12824 && find_composition (prev_pt, -1, &start, &end, &prop, buffer)
12825 && COMPOSITION_VALID_P (start, end, prop)
12826 && start < prev_pt && end > prev_pt)
12827 /* The last point was within the composition. Return 1 iff
12828 point moved out of the composition. */
12829 return (pt <= start || pt >= end);
12832 /* Check a composition at the current point. */
12833 return (pt > BUF_BEGV (buf) && pt < BUF_ZV (buf)
12834 && find_composition (pt, -1, &start, &end, &prop, buffer)
12835 && COMPOSITION_VALID_P (start, end, prop)
12836 && start < pt && end > pt);
12840 /* Reconsider the setting of B->clip_changed which is displayed
12841 in window W. */
12843 static inline void
12844 reconsider_clip_changes (struct window *w, struct buffer *b)
12846 if (b->clip_changed
12847 && !NILP (w->window_end_valid)
12848 && w->current_matrix->buffer == b
12849 && w->current_matrix->zv == BUF_ZV (b)
12850 && w->current_matrix->begv == BUF_BEGV (b))
12851 b->clip_changed = 0;
12853 /* If display wasn't paused, and W is not a tool bar window, see if
12854 point has been moved into or out of a composition. In that case,
12855 we set b->clip_changed to 1 to force updating the screen. If
12856 b->clip_changed has already been set to 1, we can skip this
12857 check. */
12858 if (!b->clip_changed
12859 && BUFFERP (w->buffer) && !NILP (w->window_end_valid))
12861 ptrdiff_t pt;
12863 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
12864 pt = PT;
12865 else
12866 pt = marker_position (w->pointm);
12868 if ((w->current_matrix->buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer)
12869 || pt != w->last_point)
12870 && check_point_in_composition (w->current_matrix->buffer,
12871 w->last_point,
12872 XBUFFER (w->buffer), pt))
12873 b->clip_changed = 1;
12878 /* Select FRAME to forward the values of frame-local variables into C
12879 variables so that the redisplay routines can access those values
12880 directly. */
12882 static void
12883 select_frame_for_redisplay (Lisp_Object frame)
12885 Lisp_Object tail, tem;
12886 Lisp_Object old = selected_frame;
12887 struct Lisp_Symbol *sym;
12889 eassert (FRAMEP (frame) && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (frame)));
12891 selected_frame = frame;
12893 do {
12894 for (tail = XFRAME (frame)->param_alist;
12895 CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
12896 if (CONSP (XCAR (tail))
12897 && (tem = XCAR (XCAR (tail)),
12898 SYMBOLP (tem))
12899 && (sym = indirect_variable (XSYMBOL (tem)),
12900 sym->redirect == SYMBOL_LOCALIZED)
12901 && sym->val.blv->frame_local)
12902 /* Use find_symbol_value rather than Fsymbol_value
12903 to avoid an error if it is void. */
12904 find_symbol_value (tem);
12905 } while (!EQ (frame, old) && (frame = old, 1));
12909 #define STOP_POLLING \
12910 do { if (! polling_stopped_here) stop_polling (); \
12911 polling_stopped_here = 1; } while (0)
12913 #define RESUME_POLLING \
12914 do { if (polling_stopped_here) start_polling (); \
12915 polling_stopped_here = 0; } while (0)
12918 /* Perhaps in the future avoid recentering windows if it
12919 is not necessary; currently that causes some problems. */
12921 static void
12922 redisplay_internal (void)
12924 struct window *w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
12925 struct window *sw;
12926 struct frame *fr;
12927 int pending;
12928 int must_finish = 0;
12929 struct text_pos tlbufpos, tlendpos;
12930 int number_of_visible_frames;
12931 ptrdiff_t count, count1;
12932 struct frame *sf;
12933 int polling_stopped_here = 0;
12934 Lisp_Object old_frame = selected_frame;
12936 /* Non-zero means redisplay has to consider all windows on all
12937 frames. Zero means, only selected_window is considered. */
12938 int consider_all_windows_p;
12940 /* Non-zero means redisplay has to redisplay the miniwindow */
12941 int update_miniwindow_p = 0;
12943 TRACE ((stderr, "redisplay_internal %d\n", redisplaying_p));
12945 /* No redisplay if running in batch mode or frame is not yet fully
12946 initialized, or redisplay is explicitly turned off by setting
12947 Vinhibit_redisplay. */
12948 if (FRAME_INITIAL_P (SELECTED_FRAME ())
12949 || !NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
12950 return;
12952 /* Don't examine these until after testing Vinhibit_redisplay.
12953 When Emacs is shutting down, perhaps because its connection to
12954 X has dropped, we should not look at them at all. */
12955 fr = XFRAME (w->frame);
12956 sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
12958 if (!fr->glyphs_initialized_p)
12959 return;
12961 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
12962 if (popup_activated ())
12963 return;
12964 #endif
12966 /* I don't think this happens but let's be paranoid. */
12967 if (redisplaying_p)
12968 return;
12970 /* Record a function that resets redisplaying_p to its old value
12971 when we leave this function. */
12972 count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
12973 record_unwind_protect (unwind_redisplay,
12974 Fcons (make_number (redisplaying_p), selected_frame));
12975 ++redisplaying_p;
12976 specbind (Qinhibit_free_realized_faces, Qnil);
12979 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
12981 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
12983 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
12984 f->already_hscrolled_p = 0;
12988 retry:
12989 /* Remember the currently selected window. */
12990 sw = w;
12992 if (!EQ (old_frame, selected_frame)
12993 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (old_frame)))
12994 /* When running redisplay, we play a bit fast-and-loose and allow e.g.
12995 selected_frame and selected_window to be temporarily out-of-sync so
12996 when we come back here via `goto retry', we need to resync because we
12997 may need to run Elisp code (via prepare_menu_bars). */
12998 select_frame_for_redisplay (old_frame);
13000 pending = 0;
13001 reconsider_clip_changes (w, current_buffer);
13002 last_escape_glyph_frame = NULL;
13003 last_escape_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
13004 last_glyphless_glyph_frame = NULL;
13005 last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = (1 << FACE_ID_BITS);
13007 /* If new fonts have been loaded that make a glyph matrix adjustment
13008 necessary, do it. */
13009 if (fonts_changed_p)
13011 adjust_glyphs (NULL);
13012 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
13013 fonts_changed_p = 0;
13016 /* If face_change_count is non-zero, init_iterator will free all
13017 realized faces, which includes the faces referenced from current
13018 matrices. So, we can't reuse current matrices in this case. */
13019 if (face_change_count)
13020 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
13022 if ((FRAME_TERMCAP_P (sf) || FRAME_MSDOS_P (sf))
13023 && FRAME_TTY (sf)->previous_frame != sf)
13025 /* Since frames on a single ASCII terminal share the same
13026 display area, displaying a different frame means redisplay
13027 the whole thing. */
13028 windows_or_buffers_changed++;
13029 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (sf);
13030 #ifndef DOS_NT
13031 set_tty_color_mode (FRAME_TTY (sf), sf);
13032 #endif
13033 FRAME_TTY (sf)->previous_frame = sf;
13036 /* Set the visible flags for all frames. Do this before checking
13037 for resized or garbaged frames; they want to know if their frames
13038 are visible. See the comment in frame.h for
13039 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY. */
13041 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
13043 number_of_visible_frames = 0;
13045 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13047 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13049 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
13050 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
13051 ++number_of_visible_frames;
13052 clear_desired_matrices (f);
13056 /* Notice any pending interrupt request to change frame size. */
13057 do_pending_window_change (1);
13059 /* do_pending_window_change could change the selected_window due to
13060 frame resizing which makes the selected window too small. */
13061 if (WINDOWP (selected_window) && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw)
13063 sw = w;
13064 reconsider_clip_changes (w, current_buffer);
13067 /* Clear frames marked as garbaged. */
13068 if (frame_garbaged)
13069 clear_garbaged_frames ();
13071 /* Build menubar and tool-bar items. */
13072 if (NILP (Vmemory_full))
13073 prepare_menu_bars ();
13075 if (windows_or_buffers_changed)
13076 update_mode_lines++;
13078 /* Detect case that we need to write or remove a star in the mode line. */
13079 if ((SAVE_MODIFF < MODIFF) != w->last_had_star)
13081 w->update_mode_line = 1;
13082 if (buffer_shared > 1)
13083 update_mode_lines++;
13086 /* Avoid invocation of point motion hooks by `current_column' below. */
13087 count1 = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
13088 specbind (Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks, Qt);
13090 /* If %c is in the mode line, update it if needed. */
13091 if (!NILP (w->column_number_displayed)
13092 /* This alternative quickly identifies a common case
13093 where no change is needed. */
13094 && !(PT == w->last_point
13095 && w->last_modified >= MODIFF
13096 && w->last_overlay_modified >= OVERLAY_MODIFF)
13097 && (XFASTINT (w->column_number_displayed) != current_column ()))
13098 w->update_mode_line = 1;
13100 unbind_to (count1, Qnil);
13102 FRAME_SCROLL_BOTTOM_VPOS (XFRAME (w->frame)) = -1;
13104 /* The variable buffer_shared is set in redisplay_window and
13105 indicates that we redisplay a buffer in different windows. See
13106 there. */
13107 consider_all_windows_p = (update_mode_lines || buffer_shared > 1
13108 || cursor_type_changed);
13110 /* If specs for an arrow have changed, do thorough redisplay
13111 to ensure we remove any arrow that should no longer exist. */
13112 if (overlay_arrows_changed_p ())
13113 consider_all_windows_p = windows_or_buffers_changed = 1;
13115 /* Normally the message* functions will have already displayed and
13116 updated the echo area, but the frame may have been trashed, or
13117 the update may have been preempted, so display the echo area
13118 again here. Checking message_cleared_p captures the case that
13119 the echo area should be cleared. */
13120 if ((!NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]) && !display_last_displayed_message_p)
13121 || (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[1]) && display_last_displayed_message_p)
13122 || (message_cleared_p
13123 && minibuf_level == 0
13124 /* If the mini-window is currently selected, this means the
13125 echo-area doesn't show through. */
13126 && !MINI_WINDOW_P (XWINDOW (selected_window))))
13128 int window_height_changed_p = echo_area_display (0);
13130 if (message_cleared_p)
13131 update_miniwindow_p = 1;
13133 must_finish = 1;
13135 /* If we don't display the current message, don't clear the
13136 message_cleared_p flag, because, if we did, we wouldn't clear
13137 the echo area in the next redisplay which doesn't preserve
13138 the echo area. */
13139 if (!display_last_displayed_message_p)
13140 message_cleared_p = 0;
13142 if (fonts_changed_p)
13143 goto retry;
13144 else if (window_height_changed_p)
13146 consider_all_windows_p = 1;
13147 ++update_mode_lines;
13148 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
13150 /* If window configuration was changed, frames may have been
13151 marked garbaged. Clear them or we will experience
13152 surprises wrt scrolling. */
13153 if (frame_garbaged)
13154 clear_garbaged_frames ();
13157 else if (EQ (selected_window, minibuf_window)
13158 && (current_buffer->clip_changed
13159 || w->last_modified < MODIFF
13160 || w->last_overlay_modified < OVERLAY_MODIFF)
13161 && resize_mini_window (w, 0))
13163 /* Resized active mini-window to fit the size of what it is
13164 showing if its contents might have changed. */
13165 must_finish = 1;
13166 /* FIXME: this causes all frames to be updated, which seems unnecessary
13167 since only the current frame needs to be considered. This function needs
13168 to be rewritten with two variables, consider_all_windows and
13169 consider_all_frames. */
13170 consider_all_windows_p = 1;
13171 ++windows_or_buffers_changed;
13172 ++update_mode_lines;
13174 /* If window configuration was changed, frames may have been
13175 marked garbaged. Clear them or we will experience
13176 surprises wrt scrolling. */
13177 if (frame_garbaged)
13178 clear_garbaged_frames ();
13182 /* If showing the region, and mark has changed, we must redisplay
13183 the whole window. The assignment to this_line_start_pos prevents
13184 the optimization directly below this if-statement. */
13185 if (((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
13186 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), mark_active)))
13187 != !NILP (w->region_showing))
13188 || (!NILP (w->region_showing)
13189 && !EQ (w->region_showing,
13190 Fmarker_position (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), mark)))))
13191 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
13193 /* Optimize the case that only the line containing the cursor in the
13194 selected window has changed. Variables starting with this_ are
13195 set in display_line and record information about the line
13196 containing the cursor. */
13197 tlbufpos = this_line_start_pos;
13198 tlendpos = this_line_end_pos;
13199 if (!consider_all_windows_p
13200 && CHARPOS (tlbufpos) > 0
13201 && !w->update_mode_line
13202 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
13203 && !current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p
13204 && FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
13205 && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
13206 /* Make sure recorded data applies to current buffer, etc. */
13207 && this_line_buffer == current_buffer
13208 && current_buffer == XBUFFER (w->buffer)
13209 && !w->force_start
13210 && !w->optional_new_start
13211 /* Point must be on the line that we have info recorded about. */
13212 && PT >= CHARPOS (tlbufpos)
13213 && PT <= Z - CHARPOS (tlendpos)
13214 /* All text outside that line, including its final newline,
13215 must be unchanged. */
13216 && text_outside_line_unchanged_p (w, CHARPOS (tlbufpos),
13217 CHARPOS (tlendpos)))
13219 if (CHARPOS (tlbufpos) > BEGV
13220 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (tlbufpos) - 1) != '\n'
13221 && (CHARPOS (tlbufpos) == ZV
13222 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (tlbufpos)) == '\n'))
13223 /* Former continuation line has disappeared by becoming empty. */
13224 goto cancel;
13225 else if (w->last_modified < MODIFF
13226 || w->last_overlay_modified < OVERLAY_MODIFF
13227 || MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
13229 /* We have to handle the case of continuation around a
13230 wide-column character (see the comment in indent.c around
13231 line 1340).
13233 For instance, in the following case:
13235 -------- Insert --------
13236 K_A_N_\\ `a' K_A_N_a\ `X_' are wide-column chars.
13237 J_I_ ==> J_I_ `^^' are cursors.
13238 ^^ ^^
13239 -------- --------
13241 As we have to redraw the line above, we cannot use this
13242 optimization. */
13244 struct it it;
13245 int line_height_before = this_line_pixel_height;
13247 /* Note that start_display will handle the case that the
13248 line starting at tlbufpos is a continuation line. */
13249 start_display (&it, w, tlbufpos);
13251 /* Implementation note: It this still necessary? */
13252 if (it.current_x != this_line_start_x)
13253 goto cancel;
13255 TRACE ((stderr, "trying display optimization 1\n"));
13256 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
13257 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
13258 it.vpos = this_line_vpos;
13259 it.current_y = this_line_y;
13260 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, this_line_vpos);
13261 display_line (&it);
13263 /* If line contains point, is not continued,
13264 and ends at same distance from eob as before, we win. */
13265 if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0
13266 /* Line is not continued, otherwise this_line_start_pos
13267 would have been set to 0 in display_line. */
13268 && CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos)
13269 /* Line ends as before. */
13270 && CHARPOS (this_line_end_pos) == CHARPOS (tlendpos)
13271 /* Line has same height as before. Otherwise other lines
13272 would have to be shifted up or down. */
13273 && this_line_pixel_height == line_height_before)
13275 /* If this is not the window's last line, we must adjust
13276 the charstarts of the lines below. */
13277 if (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
13279 struct glyph_row *row
13280 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, this_line_vpos + 1);
13281 ptrdiff_t delta, delta_bytes;
13283 /* We used to distinguish between two cases here,
13284 conditioned by Z - CHARPOS (tlendpos) == ZV, for
13285 when the line ends in a newline or the end of the
13286 buffer's accessible portion. But both cases did
13287 the same, so they were collapsed. */
13288 delta = (Z
13289 - CHARPOS (tlendpos)
13290 - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row));
13291 delta_bytes = (Z_BYTE
13292 - BYTEPOS (tlendpos)
13293 - MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row));
13295 increment_matrix_positions (w->current_matrix,
13296 this_line_vpos + 1,
13297 w->current_matrix->nrows,
13298 delta, delta_bytes);
13301 /* If this row displays text now but previously didn't,
13302 or vice versa, w->window_end_vpos may have to be
13303 adjusted. */
13304 if ((it.glyph_row - 1)->displays_text_p)
13306 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) < this_line_vpos)
13307 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (this_line_vpos));
13309 else if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) == this_line_vpos
13310 && this_line_vpos > 0)
13311 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (this_line_vpos - 1));
13312 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
13314 /* Update hint: No need to try to scroll in update_window. */
13315 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
13317 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
13318 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
13319 debug_method_add (w, "optimization 1");
13320 #endif
13321 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13322 update_window_fringes (w, 0);
13323 #endif
13324 goto update;
13326 else
13327 goto cancel;
13329 else if (/* Cursor position hasn't changed. */
13330 PT == w->last_point
13331 /* Make sure the cursor was last displayed
13332 in this window. Otherwise we have to reposition it. */
13333 && 0 <= w->cursor.vpos
13334 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) > w->cursor.vpos)
13336 if (!must_finish)
13338 do_pending_window_change (1);
13339 /* If selected_window changed, redisplay again. */
13340 if (WINDOWP (selected_window)
13341 && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw)
13342 goto retry;
13344 /* We used to always goto end_of_redisplay here, but this
13345 isn't enough if we have a blinking cursor. */
13346 if (w->cursor_off_p == w->last_cursor_off_p)
13347 goto end_of_redisplay;
13349 goto update;
13351 /* If highlighting the region, or if the cursor is in the echo area,
13352 then we can't just move the cursor. */
13353 else if (! (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
13354 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
13355 && (EQ (selected_window,
13356 BVAR (current_buffer, last_selected_window))
13357 || highlight_nonselected_windows)
13358 && NILP (w->region_showing)
13359 && NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace)
13360 && !cursor_in_echo_area)
13362 struct it it;
13363 struct glyph_row *row;
13365 /* Skip from tlbufpos to PT and see where it is. Note that
13366 PT may be in invisible text. If so, we will end at the
13367 next visible position. */
13368 init_iterator (&it, w, CHARPOS (tlbufpos), BYTEPOS (tlbufpos),
13369 NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
13370 it.current_x = this_line_start_x;
13371 it.current_y = this_line_y;
13372 it.vpos = this_line_vpos;
13374 /* The call to move_it_to stops in front of PT, but
13375 moves over before-strings. */
13376 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, -1, -1, MOVE_TO_POS);
13378 if (it.vpos == this_line_vpos
13379 && (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, this_line_vpos),
13380 row->enabled_p))
13382 eassert (this_line_vpos == it.vpos);
13383 eassert (this_line_y == it.current_y);
13384 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
13385 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
13386 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
13387 debug_method_add (w, "optimization 3");
13388 #endif
13389 goto update;
13391 else
13392 goto cancel;
13395 cancel:
13396 /* Text changed drastically or point moved off of line. */
13397 SET_MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, this_line_vpos, 0);
13400 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
13401 consider_all_windows_p |= buffer_shared > 1;
13402 ++clear_face_cache_count;
13403 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13404 ++clear_image_cache_count;
13405 #endif
13407 /* Build desired matrices, and update the display. If
13408 consider_all_windows_p is non-zero, do it for all windows on all
13409 frames. Otherwise do it for selected_window, only. */
13411 if (consider_all_windows_p)
13413 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
13415 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13416 XFRAME (frame)->updated_p = 0;
13418 /* Recompute # windows showing selected buffer. This will be
13419 incremented each time such a window is displayed. */
13420 buffer_shared = 0;
13422 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13424 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13426 /* We don't have to do anything for unselected terminal
13427 frames. */
13428 if ((FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f) || FRAME_MSDOS_P (f))
13429 && !EQ (FRAME_TTY (f)->top_frame, frame))
13430 continue;
13432 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) || FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f) || f == sf)
13434 if (! EQ (frame, selected_frame))
13435 /* Select the frame, for the sake of frame-local
13436 variables. */
13437 select_frame_for_redisplay (frame);
13439 /* Mark all the scroll bars to be removed; we'll redeem
13440 the ones we want when we redisplay their windows. */
13441 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->condemn_scroll_bars_hook)
13442 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->condemn_scroll_bars_hook (f);
13444 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (f))
13445 redisplay_windows (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f));
13447 /* The X error handler may have deleted that frame. */
13448 if (!FRAME_LIVE_P (f))
13449 continue;
13451 /* Any scroll bars which redisplay_windows should have
13452 nuked should now go away. */
13453 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->judge_scroll_bars_hook)
13454 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->judge_scroll_bars_hook (f);
13456 /* If fonts changed, display again. */
13457 /* ??? rms: I suspect it is a mistake to jump all the way
13458 back to retry here. It should just retry this frame. */
13459 if (fonts_changed_p)
13460 goto retry;
13462 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (f))
13464 /* See if we have to hscroll. */
13465 if (!f->already_hscrolled_p)
13467 f->already_hscrolled_p = 1;
13468 if (hscroll_windows (f->root_window))
13469 goto retry;
13472 /* Prevent various kinds of signals during display
13473 update. stdio is not robust about handling
13474 signals, which can cause an apparent I/O
13475 error. */
13476 if (interrupt_input)
13477 unrequest_sigio ();
13478 STOP_POLLING;
13480 /* Update the display. */
13481 set_window_update_flags (XWINDOW (f->root_window), 1);
13482 pending |= update_frame (f, 0, 0);
13483 f->updated_p = 1;
13488 if (!EQ (old_frame, selected_frame)
13489 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (old_frame)))
13490 /* We played a bit fast-and-loose above and allowed selected_frame
13491 and selected_window to be temporarily out-of-sync but let's make
13492 sure this stays contained. */
13493 select_frame_for_redisplay (old_frame);
13494 eassert (EQ (XFRAME (selected_frame)->selected_window,
13495 selected_window));
13497 if (!pending)
13499 /* Do the mark_window_display_accurate after all windows have
13500 been redisplayed because this call resets flags in buffers
13501 which are needed for proper redisplay. */
13502 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13504 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
13505 if (f->updated_p)
13507 mark_window_display_accurate (f->root_window, 1);
13508 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook)
13509 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->frame_up_to_date_hook (f);
13514 else if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (sf))
13516 Lisp_Object mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
13517 struct frame *mini_frame;
13519 displayed_buffer = XBUFFER (XWINDOW (selected_window)->buffer);
13520 /* Use list_of_error, not Qerror, so that
13521 we catch only errors and don't run the debugger. */
13522 internal_condition_case_1 (redisplay_window_1, selected_window,
13523 list_of_error,
13524 redisplay_window_error);
13525 if (update_miniwindow_p)
13526 internal_condition_case_1 (redisplay_window_1, mini_window,
13527 list_of_error,
13528 redisplay_window_error);
13530 /* Compare desired and current matrices, perform output. */
13532 update:
13533 /* If fonts changed, display again. */
13534 if (fonts_changed_p)
13535 goto retry;
13537 /* Prevent various kinds of signals during display update.
13538 stdio is not robust about handling signals,
13539 which can cause an apparent I/O error. */
13540 if (interrupt_input)
13541 unrequest_sigio ();
13542 STOP_POLLING;
13544 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (sf) && !FRAME_OBSCURED_P (sf))
13546 if (hscroll_windows (selected_window))
13547 goto retry;
13549 XWINDOW (selected_window)->must_be_updated_p = 1;
13550 pending = update_frame (sf, 0, 0);
13553 /* We may have called echo_area_display at the top of this
13554 function. If the echo area is on another frame, that may
13555 have put text on a frame other than the selected one, so the
13556 above call to update_frame would not have caught it. Catch
13557 it here. */
13558 mini_window = FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (sf);
13559 mini_frame = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (mini_window)));
13561 if (mini_frame != sf && FRAME_WINDOW_P (mini_frame))
13563 XWINDOW (mini_window)->must_be_updated_p = 1;
13564 pending |= update_frame (mini_frame, 0, 0);
13565 if (!pending && hscroll_windows (mini_window))
13566 goto retry;
13570 /* If display was paused because of pending input, make sure we do a
13571 thorough update the next time. */
13572 if (pending)
13574 /* Prevent the optimization at the beginning of
13575 redisplay_internal that tries a single-line update of the
13576 line containing the cursor in the selected window. */
13577 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
13579 /* Let the overlay arrow be updated the next time. */
13580 update_overlay_arrows (0);
13582 /* If we pause after scrolling, some rows in the current
13583 matrices of some windows are not valid. */
13584 if (!WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w)
13585 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (w->frame)))
13586 update_mode_lines = 1;
13588 else
13590 if (!consider_all_windows_p)
13592 /* This has already been done above if
13593 consider_all_windows_p is set. */
13594 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (w, 1);
13596 /* Say overlay arrows are up to date. */
13597 update_overlay_arrows (1);
13599 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (sf)->frame_up_to_date_hook != 0)
13600 FRAME_TERMINAL (sf)->frame_up_to_date_hook (sf);
13603 update_mode_lines = 0;
13604 windows_or_buffers_changed = 0;
13605 cursor_type_changed = 0;
13608 /* Start SIGIO interrupts coming again. Having them off during the
13609 code above makes it less likely one will discard output, but not
13610 impossible, since there might be stuff in the system buffer here.
13611 But it is much hairier to try to do anything about that. */
13612 if (interrupt_input)
13613 request_sigio ();
13614 RESUME_POLLING;
13616 /* If a frame has become visible which was not before, redisplay
13617 again, so that we display it. Expose events for such a frame
13618 (which it gets when becoming visible) don't call the parts of
13619 redisplay constructing glyphs, so simply exposing a frame won't
13620 display anything in this case. So, we have to display these
13621 frames here explicitly. */
13622 if (!pending)
13624 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
13625 int new_count = 0;
13627 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
13629 int this_is_visible = 0;
13631 if (XFRAME (frame)->visible)
13632 this_is_visible = 1;
13633 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (XFRAME (frame));
13634 if (XFRAME (frame)->visible)
13635 this_is_visible = 1;
13637 if (this_is_visible)
13638 new_count++;
13641 if (new_count != number_of_visible_frames)
13642 windows_or_buffers_changed++;
13645 /* Change frame size now if a change is pending. */
13646 do_pending_window_change (1);
13648 /* If we just did a pending size change, or have additional
13649 visible frames, or selected_window changed, redisplay again. */
13650 if ((windows_or_buffers_changed && !pending)
13651 || (WINDOWP (selected_window) && (w = XWINDOW (selected_window)) != sw))
13652 goto retry;
13654 /* Clear the face and image caches.
13656 We used to do this only if consider_all_windows_p. But the cache
13657 needs to be cleared if a timer creates images in the current
13658 buffer (e.g. the test case in Bug#6230). */
13660 if (clear_face_cache_count > CLEAR_FACE_CACHE_COUNT)
13662 clear_face_cache (0);
13663 clear_face_cache_count = 0;
13666 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
13667 if (clear_image_cache_count > CLEAR_IMAGE_CACHE_COUNT)
13669 clear_image_caches (Qnil);
13670 clear_image_cache_count = 0;
13672 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
13674 end_of_redisplay:
13675 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
13676 RESUME_POLLING;
13680 /* Redisplay, but leave alone any recent echo area message unless
13681 another message has been requested in its place.
13683 This is useful in situations where you need to redisplay but no
13684 user action has occurred, making it inappropriate for the message
13685 area to be cleared. See tracking_off and
13686 wait_reading_process_output for examples of these situations.
13688 FROM_WHERE is an integer saying from where this function was
13689 called. This is useful for debugging. */
13691 void
13692 redisplay_preserve_echo_area (int from_where)
13694 TRACE ((stderr, "redisplay_preserve_echo_area (%d)\n", from_where));
13696 if (!NILP (echo_area_buffer[1]))
13698 /* We have a previously displayed message, but no current
13699 message. Redisplay the previous message. */
13700 display_last_displayed_message_p = 1;
13701 redisplay_internal ();
13702 display_last_displayed_message_p = 0;
13704 else
13705 redisplay_internal ();
13707 if (FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ()) != NULL
13708 && FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional)
13709 FRAME_RIF (SELECTED_FRAME ())->flush_display_optional (NULL);
13713 /* Function registered with record_unwind_protect in
13714 redisplay_internal. Reset redisplaying_p to the value it had
13715 before redisplay_internal was called, and clear
13716 prevent_freeing_realized_faces_p. It also selects the previously
13717 selected frame, unless it has been deleted (by an X connection
13718 failure during redisplay, for example). */
13720 static Lisp_Object
13721 unwind_redisplay (Lisp_Object val)
13723 Lisp_Object old_redisplaying_p, old_frame;
13725 old_redisplaying_p = XCAR (val);
13726 redisplaying_p = XFASTINT (old_redisplaying_p);
13727 old_frame = XCDR (val);
13728 if (! EQ (old_frame, selected_frame)
13729 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (old_frame)))
13730 select_frame_for_redisplay (old_frame);
13731 return Qnil;
13735 /* Mark the display of window W as accurate or inaccurate. If
13736 ACCURATE_P is non-zero mark display of W as accurate. If
13737 ACCURATE_P is zero, arrange for W to be redisplayed the next time
13738 redisplay_internal is called. */
13740 static void
13741 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (struct window *w, int accurate_p)
13743 if (BUFFERP (w->buffer))
13745 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
13747 w->last_modified = accurate_p ? BUF_MODIFF(b) : 0;
13748 w->last_overlay_modified = accurate_p ? BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF(b) : 0;
13749 w->last_had_star
13750 = BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b);
13752 if (accurate_p)
13754 b->clip_changed = 0;
13755 b->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p = 0;
13757 BUF_UNCHANGED_MODIFIED (b) = BUF_MODIFF (b);
13758 BUF_OVERLAY_UNCHANGED_MODIFIED (b) = BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF (b);
13759 BUF_BEG_UNCHANGED (b) = BUF_GPT (b) - BUF_BEG (b);
13760 BUF_END_UNCHANGED (b) = BUF_Z (b) - BUF_GPT (b);
13762 w->current_matrix->buffer = b;
13763 w->current_matrix->begv = BUF_BEGV (b);
13764 w->current_matrix->zv = BUF_ZV (b);
13766 w->last_cursor = w->cursor;
13767 w->last_cursor_off_p = w->cursor_off_p;
13769 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
13770 w->last_point = BUF_PT (b);
13771 else
13772 w->last_point = XMARKER (w->pointm)->charpos;
13776 if (accurate_p)
13778 wset_window_end_valid (w, w->buffer);
13779 w->update_mode_line = 0;
13784 /* Mark the display of windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW as
13785 accurate or inaccurate. If ACCURATE_P is non-zero mark display of
13786 windows as accurate. If ACCURATE_P is zero, arrange for windows to
13787 be redisplayed the next time redisplay_internal is called. */
13789 void
13790 mark_window_display_accurate (Lisp_Object window, int accurate_p)
13792 struct window *w;
13794 for (; !NILP (window); window = w->next)
13796 w = XWINDOW (window);
13797 mark_window_display_accurate_1 (w, accurate_p);
13799 if (!NILP (w->vchild))
13800 mark_window_display_accurate (w->vchild, accurate_p);
13801 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
13802 mark_window_display_accurate (w->hchild, accurate_p);
13805 if (accurate_p)
13807 update_overlay_arrows (1);
13809 else
13811 /* Force a thorough redisplay the next time by setting
13812 last_arrow_position and last_arrow_string to t, which is
13813 unequal to any useful value of Voverlay_arrow_... */
13814 update_overlay_arrows (-1);
13819 /* Return value in display table DP (Lisp_Char_Table *) for character
13820 C. Since a display table doesn't have any parent, we don't have to
13821 follow parent. Do not call this function directly but use the
13822 macro DISP_CHAR_VECTOR. */
13824 Lisp_Object
13825 disp_char_vector (struct Lisp_Char_Table *dp, int c)
13827 Lisp_Object val;
13829 if (ASCII_CHAR_P (c))
13831 val = dp->ascii;
13832 if (SUB_CHAR_TABLE_P (val))
13833 val = XSUB_CHAR_TABLE (val)->contents[c];
13835 else
13837 Lisp_Object table;
13839 XSETCHAR_TABLE (table, dp);
13840 val = char_table_ref (table, c);
13842 if (NILP (val))
13843 val = dp->defalt;
13844 return val;
13849 /***********************************************************************
13850 Window Redisplay
13851 ***********************************************************************/
13853 /* Redisplay all leaf windows in the window tree rooted at WINDOW. */
13855 static void
13856 redisplay_windows (Lisp_Object window)
13858 while (!NILP (window))
13860 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
13862 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
13863 redisplay_windows (w->hchild);
13864 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
13865 redisplay_windows (w->vchild);
13866 else if (!NILP (w->buffer))
13868 displayed_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
13869 /* Use list_of_error, not Qerror, so that
13870 we catch only errors and don't run the debugger. */
13871 internal_condition_case_1 (redisplay_window_0, window,
13872 list_of_error,
13873 redisplay_window_error);
13876 window = w->next;
13880 static Lisp_Object
13881 redisplay_window_error (Lisp_Object ignore)
13883 displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff = BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer);
13884 return Qnil;
13887 static Lisp_Object
13888 redisplay_window_0 (Lisp_Object window)
13890 if (displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff < BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer))
13891 redisplay_window (window, 0);
13892 return Qnil;
13895 static Lisp_Object
13896 redisplay_window_1 (Lisp_Object window)
13898 if (displayed_buffer->display_error_modiff < BUF_MODIFF (displayed_buffer))
13899 redisplay_window (window, 1);
13900 return Qnil;
13904 /* Set cursor position of W. PT is assumed to be displayed in ROW.
13905 DELTA and DELTA_BYTES are the numbers of characters and bytes by
13906 which positions recorded in ROW differ from current buffer
13907 positions.
13909 Return 0 if cursor is not on this row, 1 otherwise. */
13911 static int
13912 set_cursor_from_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
13913 struct glyph_matrix *matrix,
13914 ptrdiff_t delta, ptrdiff_t delta_bytes,
13915 int dy, int dvpos)
13917 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
13918 struct glyph *end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
13919 struct glyph *cursor = NULL;
13920 /* The last known character position in row. */
13921 ptrdiff_t last_pos = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
13922 int x = row->x;
13923 ptrdiff_t pt_old = PT - delta;
13924 ptrdiff_t pos_before = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
13925 ptrdiff_t pos_after = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
13926 struct glyph *glyph_before = glyph - 1, *glyph_after = end;
13927 /* A glyph beyond the edge of TEXT_AREA which we should never
13928 touch. */
13929 struct glyph *glyphs_end = end;
13930 /* Non-zero means we've found a match for cursor position, but that
13931 glyph has the avoid_cursor_p flag set. */
13932 int match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
13933 /* Non-zero means we've seen at least one glyph that came from a
13934 display string. */
13935 int string_seen = 0;
13936 /* Largest and smallest buffer positions seen so far during scan of
13937 glyph row. */
13938 ptrdiff_t bpos_max = pos_before;
13939 ptrdiff_t bpos_min = pos_after;
13940 /* Last buffer position covered by an overlay string with an integer
13941 `cursor' property. */
13942 ptrdiff_t bpos_covered = 0;
13943 /* Non-zero means the display string on which to display the cursor
13944 comes from a text property, not from an overlay. */
13945 int string_from_text_prop = 0;
13947 /* Don't even try doing anything if called for a mode-line or
13948 header-line row, since the rest of the code isn't prepared to
13949 deal with such calamities. */
13950 eassert (!row->mode_line_p);
13951 if (row->mode_line_p)
13952 return 0;
13954 /* Skip over glyphs not having an object at the start and the end of
13955 the row. These are special glyphs like truncation marks on
13956 terminal frames. */
13957 if (row->displays_text_p)
13959 if (!row->reversed_p)
13961 while (glyph < end
13962 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
13963 && glyph->charpos < 0)
13965 x += glyph->pixel_width;
13966 ++glyph;
13968 while (end > glyph
13969 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object)
13970 /* CHARPOS is zero for blanks and stretch glyphs
13971 inserted by extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
13972 && (end - 1)->charpos <= 0)
13973 --end;
13974 glyph_before = glyph - 1;
13975 glyph_after = end;
13977 else
13979 struct glyph *g;
13981 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to process it from back
13982 to front, so swap the edge pointers. */
13983 glyphs_end = end = glyph - 1;
13984 glyph += row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
13986 while (glyph > end + 1
13987 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
13988 && glyph->charpos < 0)
13990 --glyph;
13991 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
13993 if (INTEGERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos < 0)
13994 --glyph;
13995 /* By default, in reversed rows we put the cursor on the
13996 rightmost (first in the reading order) glyph. */
13997 for (g = end + 1; g < glyph; g++)
13998 x += g->pixel_width;
13999 while (end < glyph
14000 && INTEGERP ((end + 1)->object)
14001 && (end + 1)->charpos <= 0)
14002 ++end;
14003 glyph_before = glyph + 1;
14004 glyph_after = end;
14007 else if (row->reversed_p)
14009 /* In R2L rows that don't display text, put the cursor on the
14010 rightmost glyph. Case in point: an empty last line that is
14011 part of an R2L paragraph. */
14012 cursor = end - 1;
14013 /* Avoid placing the cursor on the last glyph of the row, where
14014 on terminal frames we hold the vertical border between
14015 adjacent windows. */
14016 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (WINDOW_XFRAME (w))
14017 && !WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
14018 && cursor == row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] - 1)
14019 cursor--;
14020 x = -1; /* will be computed below, at label compute_x */
14023 /* Step 1: Try to find the glyph whose character position
14024 corresponds to point. If that's not possible, find 2 glyphs
14025 whose character positions are the closest to point, one before
14026 point, the other after it. */
14027 if (!row->reversed_p)
14028 while (/* not marched to end of glyph row */
14029 glyph < end
14030 /* glyph was not inserted by redisplay for internal purposes */
14031 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object))
14033 if (BUFFERP (glyph->object))
14035 ptrdiff_t dpos = glyph->charpos - pt_old;
14037 if (glyph->charpos > bpos_max)
14038 bpos_max = glyph->charpos;
14039 if (glyph->charpos < bpos_min)
14040 bpos_min = glyph->charpos;
14041 if (!glyph->avoid_cursor_p)
14043 /* If we hit point, we've found the glyph on which to
14044 display the cursor. */
14045 if (dpos == 0)
14047 match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
14048 break;
14050 /* See if we've found a better approximation to
14051 POS_BEFORE or to POS_AFTER. */
14052 if (0 > dpos && dpos > pos_before - pt_old)
14054 pos_before = glyph->charpos;
14055 glyph_before = glyph;
14057 else if (0 < dpos && dpos < pos_after - pt_old)
14059 pos_after = glyph->charpos;
14060 glyph_after = glyph;
14063 else if (dpos == 0)
14064 match_with_avoid_cursor = 1;
14066 else if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
14068 Lisp_Object chprop;
14069 ptrdiff_t glyph_pos = glyph->charpos;
14071 chprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (glyph_pos), Qcursor,
14072 glyph->object);
14073 if (!NILP (chprop))
14075 /* If the string came from a `display' text property,
14076 look up the buffer position of that property and
14077 use that position to update bpos_max, as if we
14078 actually saw such a position in one of the row's
14079 glyphs. This helps with supporting integer values
14080 of `cursor' property on the display string in
14081 situations where most or all of the row's buffer
14082 text is completely covered by display properties,
14083 so that no glyph with valid buffer positions is
14084 ever seen in the row. */
14085 ptrdiff_t prop_pos =
14086 string_buffer_position_lim (glyph->object, pos_before,
14087 pos_after, 0);
14089 if (prop_pos >= pos_before)
14090 bpos_max = prop_pos - 1;
14092 if (INTEGERP (chprop))
14094 bpos_covered = bpos_max + XINT (chprop);
14095 /* If the `cursor' property covers buffer positions up
14096 to and including point, we should display cursor on
14097 this glyph. Note that, if a `cursor' property on one
14098 of the string's characters has an integer value, we
14099 will break out of the loop below _before_ we get to
14100 the position match above. IOW, integer values of
14101 the `cursor' property override the "exact match for
14102 point" strategy of positioning the cursor. */
14103 /* Implementation note: bpos_max == pt_old when, e.g.,
14104 we are in an empty line, where bpos_max is set to
14105 MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS, see above. */
14106 if (bpos_max <= pt_old && bpos_covered >= pt_old)
14108 cursor = glyph;
14109 break;
14113 string_seen = 1;
14115 x += glyph->pixel_width;
14116 ++glyph;
14118 else if (glyph > end) /* row is reversed */
14119 while (!INTEGERP (glyph->object))
14121 if (BUFFERP (glyph->object))
14123 ptrdiff_t dpos = glyph->charpos - pt_old;
14125 if (glyph->charpos > bpos_max)
14126 bpos_max = glyph->charpos;
14127 if (glyph->charpos < bpos_min)
14128 bpos_min = glyph->charpos;
14129 if (!glyph->avoid_cursor_p)
14131 if (dpos == 0)
14133 match_with_avoid_cursor = 0;
14134 break;
14136 if (0 > dpos && dpos > pos_before - pt_old)
14138 pos_before = glyph->charpos;
14139 glyph_before = glyph;
14141 else if (0 < dpos && dpos < pos_after - pt_old)
14143 pos_after = glyph->charpos;
14144 glyph_after = glyph;
14147 else if (dpos == 0)
14148 match_with_avoid_cursor = 1;
14150 else if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
14152 Lisp_Object chprop;
14153 ptrdiff_t glyph_pos = glyph->charpos;
14155 chprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (glyph_pos), Qcursor,
14156 glyph->object);
14157 if (!NILP (chprop))
14159 ptrdiff_t prop_pos =
14160 string_buffer_position_lim (glyph->object, pos_before,
14161 pos_after, 0);
14163 if (prop_pos >= pos_before)
14164 bpos_max = prop_pos - 1;
14166 if (INTEGERP (chprop))
14168 bpos_covered = bpos_max + XINT (chprop);
14169 /* If the `cursor' property covers buffer positions up
14170 to and including point, we should display cursor on
14171 this glyph. */
14172 if (bpos_max <= pt_old && bpos_covered >= pt_old)
14174 cursor = glyph;
14175 break;
14178 string_seen = 1;
14180 --glyph;
14181 if (glyph == glyphs_end) /* don't dereference outside TEXT_AREA */
14183 x--; /* can't use any pixel_width */
14184 break;
14186 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14189 /* Step 2: If we didn't find an exact match for point, we need to
14190 look for a proper place to put the cursor among glyphs between
14191 GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER. */
14192 if (!((row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end)
14193 && BUFFERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos == pt_old)
14194 && bpos_covered < pt_old)
14196 /* An empty line has a single glyph whose OBJECT is zero and
14197 whose CHARPOS is the position of a newline on that line.
14198 Note that on a TTY, there are more glyphs after that, which
14199 were produced by extend_face_to_end_of_line, but their
14200 CHARPOS is zero or negative. */
14201 int empty_line_p =
14202 (row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end)
14203 && INTEGERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos > 0;
14205 if (row->ends_in_ellipsis_p && pos_after == last_pos)
14207 ptrdiff_t ellipsis_pos;
14209 /* Scan back over the ellipsis glyphs. */
14210 if (!row->reversed_p)
14212 ellipsis_pos = (glyph - 1)->charpos;
14213 while (glyph > row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
14214 && (glyph - 1)->charpos == ellipsis_pos)
14215 glyph--, x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14216 /* That loop always goes one position too far, including
14217 the glyph before the ellipsis. So scan forward over
14218 that one. */
14219 x += glyph->pixel_width;
14220 glyph++;
14222 else /* row is reversed */
14224 ellipsis_pos = (glyph + 1)->charpos;
14225 while (glyph < row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1
14226 && (glyph + 1)->charpos == ellipsis_pos)
14227 glyph++, x += glyph->pixel_width;
14228 x -= glyph->pixel_width;
14229 glyph--;
14232 else if (match_with_avoid_cursor)
14234 cursor = glyph_after;
14235 x = -1;
14237 else if (string_seen)
14239 int incr = row->reversed_p ? -1 : +1;
14241 /* Need to find the glyph that came out of a string which is
14242 present at point. That glyph is somewhere between
14243 GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER, and it came from a string
14244 positioned between POS_BEFORE and POS_AFTER in the
14245 buffer. */
14246 struct glyph *start, *stop;
14247 ptrdiff_t pos = pos_before;
14249 x = -1;
14251 /* If the row ends in a newline from a display string,
14252 reordering could have moved the glyphs belonging to the
14253 string out of the [GLYPH_BEFORE..GLYPH_AFTER] range. So
14254 in this case we extend the search to the last glyph in
14255 the row that was not inserted by redisplay. */
14256 if (row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
14258 glyph_after = end;
14259 pos_after = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
14262 /* GLYPH_BEFORE and GLYPH_AFTER are the glyphs that
14263 correspond to POS_BEFORE and POS_AFTER, respectively. We
14264 need START and STOP in the order that corresponds to the
14265 row's direction as given by its reversed_p flag. If the
14266 directionality of characters between POS_BEFORE and
14267 POS_AFTER is the opposite of the row's base direction,
14268 these characters will have been reordered for display,
14269 and we need to reverse START and STOP. */
14270 if (!row->reversed_p)
14272 start = min (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14273 stop = max (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14275 else
14277 start = max (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14278 stop = min (glyph_before, glyph_after);
14280 for (glyph = start + incr;
14281 row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop; )
14284 /* Any glyphs that come from the buffer are here because
14285 of bidi reordering. Skip them, and only pay
14286 attention to glyphs that came from some string. */
14287 if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
14289 Lisp_Object str;
14290 ptrdiff_t tem;
14291 /* If the display property covers the newline, we
14292 need to search for it one position farther. */
14293 ptrdiff_t lim = pos_after
14294 + (pos_after == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta);
14296 string_from_text_prop = 0;
14297 str = glyph->object;
14298 tem = string_buffer_position_lim (str, pos, lim, 0);
14299 if (tem == 0 /* from overlay */
14300 || pos <= tem)
14302 /* If the string from which this glyph came is
14303 found in the buffer at point, or at position
14304 that is closer to point than pos_after, then
14305 we've found the glyph we've been looking for.
14306 If it comes from an overlay (tem == 0), and
14307 it has the `cursor' property on one of its
14308 glyphs, record that glyph as a candidate for
14309 displaying the cursor. (As in the
14310 unidirectional version, we will display the
14311 cursor on the last candidate we find.) */
14312 if (tem == 0
14313 || tem == pt_old
14314 || (tem - pt_old > 0 && tem < pos_after))
14316 /* The glyphs from this string could have
14317 been reordered. Find the one with the
14318 smallest string position. Or there could
14319 be a character in the string with the
14320 `cursor' property, which means display
14321 cursor on that character's glyph. */
14322 ptrdiff_t strpos = glyph->charpos;
14324 if (tem)
14326 cursor = glyph;
14327 string_from_text_prop = 1;
14329 for ( ;
14330 (row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop)
14331 && EQ (glyph->object, str);
14332 glyph += incr)
14334 Lisp_Object cprop;
14335 ptrdiff_t gpos = glyph->charpos;
14337 cprop = Fget_char_property (make_number (gpos),
14338 Qcursor,
14339 glyph->object);
14340 if (!NILP (cprop))
14342 cursor = glyph;
14343 break;
14345 if (tem && glyph->charpos < strpos)
14347 strpos = glyph->charpos;
14348 cursor = glyph;
14352 if (tem == pt_old
14353 || (tem - pt_old > 0 && tem < pos_after))
14354 goto compute_x;
14356 if (tem)
14357 pos = tem + 1; /* don't find previous instances */
14359 /* This string is not what we want; skip all of the
14360 glyphs that came from it. */
14361 while ((row->reversed_p ? glyph > stop : glyph < stop)
14362 && EQ (glyph->object, str))
14363 glyph += incr;
14365 else
14366 glyph += incr;
14369 /* If we reached the end of the line, and END was from a string,
14370 the cursor is not on this line. */
14371 if (cursor == NULL
14372 && (row->reversed_p ? glyph <= end : glyph >= end)
14373 && (row->reversed_p ? end > glyphs_end : end < glyphs_end)
14374 && STRINGP (end->object)
14375 && row->continued_p)
14376 return 0;
14378 /* A truncated row may not include PT among its character positions.
14379 Setting the cursor inside the scroll margin will trigger
14380 recalculation of hscroll in hscroll_window_tree. But if a
14381 display string covers point, defer to the string-handling
14382 code below to figure this out. */
14383 else if (row->truncated_on_left_p && pt_old < bpos_min)
14385 cursor = glyph_before;
14386 x = -1;
14388 else if ((row->truncated_on_right_p && pt_old > bpos_max)
14389 /* Zero-width characters produce no glyphs. */
14390 || (!empty_line_p
14391 && (row->reversed_p
14392 ? glyph_after > glyphs_end
14393 : glyph_after < glyphs_end)))
14395 cursor = glyph_after;
14396 x = -1;
14400 compute_x:
14401 if (cursor != NULL)
14402 glyph = cursor;
14403 else if (glyph == glyphs_end
14404 && pos_before == pos_after
14405 && STRINGP ((row->reversed_p
14406 ? row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1
14407 : row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA])->object))
14409 /* If all the glyphs of this row came from strings, put the
14410 cursor on the first glyph of the row. This avoids having the
14411 cursor outside of the text area in this very rare and hard
14412 use case. */
14413 glyph =
14414 row->reversed_p
14415 ? row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1
14416 : row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
14418 if (x < 0)
14420 struct glyph *g;
14422 /* Need to compute x that corresponds to GLYPH. */
14423 for (g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], x = row->x; g < glyph; g++)
14425 if (g >= row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA])
14426 abort ();
14427 x += g->pixel_width;
14431 /* ROW could be part of a continued line, which, under bidi
14432 reordering, might have other rows whose start and end charpos
14433 occlude point. Only set w->cursor if we found a better
14434 approximation to the cursor position than we have from previously
14435 examined candidate rows belonging to the same continued line. */
14436 if (/* we already have a candidate row */
14437 w->cursor.vpos >= 0
14438 /* that candidate is not the row we are processing */
14439 && MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos) != row
14440 /* Make sure cursor.vpos specifies a row whose start and end
14441 charpos occlude point, and it is valid candidate for being a
14442 cursor-row. This is because some callers of this function
14443 leave cursor.vpos at the row where the cursor was displayed
14444 during the last redisplay cycle. */
14445 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)) <= pt_old
14446 && pt_old <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14447 && cursor_row_p (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)))
14449 struct glyph *g1 =
14450 MATRIX_ROW_GLYPH_START (matrix, w->cursor.vpos) + w->cursor.hpos;
14452 /* Don't consider glyphs that are outside TEXT_AREA. */
14453 if (!(row->reversed_p ? glyph > glyphs_end : glyph < glyphs_end))
14454 return 0;
14455 /* Keep the candidate whose buffer position is the closest to
14456 point or has the `cursor' property. */
14457 if (/* previous candidate is a glyph in TEXT_AREA of that row */
14458 w->cursor.hpos >= 0
14459 && w->cursor.hpos < MATRIX_ROW_USED (matrix, w->cursor.vpos)
14460 && ((BUFFERP (g1->object)
14461 && (g1->charpos == pt_old /* an exact match always wins */
14462 || (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
14463 && eabs (g1->charpos - pt_old)
14464 < eabs (glyph->charpos - pt_old))))
14465 /* previous candidate is a glyph from a string that has
14466 a non-nil `cursor' property */
14467 || (STRINGP (g1->object)
14468 && (!NILP (Fget_char_property (make_number (g1->charpos),
14469 Qcursor, g1->object))
14470 /* previous candidate is from the same display
14471 string as this one, and the display string
14472 came from a text property */
14473 || (EQ (g1->object, glyph->object)
14474 && string_from_text_prop)
14475 /* this candidate is from newline and its
14476 position is not an exact match */
14477 || (INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14478 && glyph->charpos != pt_old)))))
14479 return 0;
14480 /* If this candidate gives an exact match, use that. */
14481 if (!((BUFFERP (glyph->object) && glyph->charpos == pt_old)
14482 /* If this candidate is a glyph created for the
14483 terminating newline of a line, and point is on that
14484 newline, it wins because it's an exact match. */
14485 || (!row->continued_p
14486 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
14487 && glyph->charpos == 0
14488 && pt_old == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) - 1))
14489 /* Otherwise, keep the candidate that comes from a row
14490 spanning less buffer positions. This may win when one or
14491 both candidate positions are on glyphs that came from
14492 display strings, for which we cannot compare buffer
14493 positions. */
14494 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14495 - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos))
14496 < MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) - MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
14497 return 0;
14499 w->cursor.hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
14500 w->cursor.x = x;
14501 w->cursor.vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, matrix) + dvpos;
14502 w->cursor.y = row->y + dy;
14504 if (w == XWINDOW (selected_window))
14506 if (!row->continued_p
14507 && !MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
14508 && row->x == 0)
14510 this_line_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
14512 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos)
14513 = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + delta;
14514 BYTEPOS (this_line_start_pos)
14515 = MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row) + delta_bytes;
14517 CHARPOS (this_line_end_pos)
14518 = Z - (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + delta);
14519 BYTEPOS (this_line_end_pos)
14520 = Z_BYTE - (MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + delta_bytes);
14522 this_line_y = w->cursor.y;
14523 this_line_pixel_height = row->height;
14524 this_line_vpos = w->cursor.vpos;
14525 this_line_start_x = row->x;
14527 else
14528 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
14531 return 1;
14535 /* Run window scroll functions, if any, for WINDOW with new window
14536 start STARTP. Sets the window start of WINDOW to that position.
14538 We assume that the window's buffer is really current. */
14540 static inline struct text_pos
14541 run_window_scroll_functions (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos startp)
14543 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
14544 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, startp);
14546 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer))
14547 abort ();
14549 if (!NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions))
14551 run_hook_with_args_2 (Qwindow_scroll_functions, window,
14552 make_number (CHARPOS (startp)));
14553 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
14554 /* In case the hook functions switch buffers. */
14555 if (current_buffer != XBUFFER (w->buffer))
14556 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
14559 return startp;
14563 /* Make sure the line containing the cursor is fully visible.
14564 A value of 1 means there is nothing to be done.
14565 (Either the line is fully visible, or it cannot be made so,
14566 or we cannot tell.)
14568 If FORCE_P is non-zero, return 0 even if partial visible cursor row
14569 is higher than window.
14571 A value of 0 means the caller should do scrolling
14572 as if point had gone off the screen. */
14574 static int
14575 cursor_row_fully_visible_p (struct window *w, int force_p, int current_matrix_p)
14577 struct glyph_matrix *matrix;
14578 struct glyph_row *row;
14579 int window_height;
14581 if (!make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p)
14582 return 1;
14584 /* It's not always possible to find the cursor, e.g, when a window
14585 is full of overlay strings. Don't do anything in that case. */
14586 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
14587 return 1;
14589 matrix = current_matrix_p ? w->current_matrix : w->desired_matrix;
14590 row = MATRIX_ROW (matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
14592 /* If the cursor row is not partially visible, there's nothing to do. */
14593 if (!MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, row))
14594 return 1;
14596 /* If the row the cursor is in is taller than the window's height,
14597 it's not clear what to do, so do nothing. */
14598 window_height = window_box_height (w);
14599 if (row->height >= window_height)
14601 if (!force_p || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
14602 || w->vscroll || w->cursor.vpos == 0)
14603 return 1;
14605 return 0;
14609 /* Try scrolling PT into view in window WINDOW. JUST_THIS_ONE_P
14610 non-zero means only WINDOW is redisplayed in redisplay_internal.
14611 TEMP_SCROLL_STEP has the same meaning as emacs_scroll_step, and is used
14612 in redisplay_window to bring a partially visible line into view in
14613 the case that only the cursor has moved.
14615 LAST_LINE_MISFIT should be nonzero if we're scrolling because the
14616 last screen line's vertical height extends past the end of the screen.
14618 Value is
14620 1 if scrolling succeeded
14622 0 if scrolling didn't find point.
14624 -1 if new fonts have been loaded so that we must interrupt
14625 redisplay, adjust glyph matrices, and try again. */
14627 enum
14629 SCROLLING_SUCCESS,
14630 SCROLLING_FAILED,
14631 SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES
14634 /* If scroll-conservatively is more than this, never recenter.
14636 If you change this, don't forget to update the doc string of
14637 `scroll-conservatively' and the Emacs manual. */
14638 #define SCROLL_LIMIT 100
14640 static int
14641 try_scrolling (Lisp_Object window, int just_this_one_p,
14642 ptrdiff_t arg_scroll_conservatively, ptrdiff_t scroll_step,
14643 int temp_scroll_step, int last_line_misfit)
14645 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
14646 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
14647 struct text_pos pos, startp;
14648 struct it it;
14649 int this_scroll_margin, scroll_max, rc, height;
14650 int dy = 0, amount_to_scroll = 0, scroll_down_p = 0;
14651 int extra_scroll_margin_lines = last_line_misfit ? 1 : 0;
14652 Lisp_Object aggressive;
14653 /* We will never try scrolling more than this number of lines. */
14654 int scroll_limit = SCROLL_LIMIT;
14656 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
14657 debug_method_add (w, "try_scrolling");
14658 #endif
14660 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
14662 /* Compute scroll margin height in pixels. We scroll when point is
14663 within this distance from the top or bottom of the window. */
14664 if (scroll_margin > 0)
14665 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4)
14666 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14667 else
14668 this_scroll_margin = 0;
14670 /* Force arg_scroll_conservatively to have a reasonable value, to
14671 avoid scrolling too far away with slow move_it_* functions. Note
14672 that the user can supply scroll-conservatively equal to
14673 `most-positive-fixnum', which can be larger than INT_MAX. */
14674 if (arg_scroll_conservatively > scroll_limit)
14676 arg_scroll_conservatively = scroll_limit + 1;
14677 scroll_max = scroll_limit * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14679 else if (scroll_step || arg_scroll_conservatively || temp_scroll_step)
14680 /* Compute how much we should try to scroll maximally to bring
14681 point into view. */
14682 scroll_max = (max (scroll_step,
14683 max (arg_scroll_conservatively, temp_scroll_step))
14684 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
14685 else if (NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively))
14686 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively)))
14687 /* We're trying to scroll because of aggressive scrolling but no
14688 scroll_step is set. Choose an arbitrary one. */
14689 scroll_max = 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14690 else
14691 scroll_max = 0;
14693 too_near_end:
14695 /* Decide whether to scroll down. */
14696 if (PT > CHARPOS (startp))
14698 int scroll_margin_y;
14700 /* Compute the pixel ypos of the scroll margin, then move IT to
14701 either that ypos or PT, whichever comes first. */
14702 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14703 scroll_margin_y = it.last_visible_y - this_scroll_margin
14704 - FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * extra_scroll_margin_lines;
14705 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, scroll_margin_y - 1, -1,
14706 (MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y));
14708 if (PT > CHARPOS (it.current.pos))
14710 int y0 = line_bottom_y (&it);
14711 /* Compute how many pixels below window bottom to stop searching
14712 for PT. This avoids costly search for PT that is far away if
14713 the user limited scrolling by a small number of lines, but
14714 always finds PT if scroll_conservatively is set to a large
14715 number, such as most-positive-fixnum. */
14716 int slack = max (scroll_max, 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
14717 int y_to_move = it.last_visible_y + slack;
14719 /* Compute the distance from the scroll margin to PT or to
14720 the scroll limit, whichever comes first. This should
14721 include the height of the cursor line, to make that line
14722 fully visible. */
14723 move_it_to (&it, PT, -1, y_to_move,
14724 -1, MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_Y);
14725 dy = line_bottom_y (&it) - y0;
14727 if (dy > scroll_max)
14728 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14730 if (dy > 0)
14731 scroll_down_p = 1;
14735 if (scroll_down_p)
14737 /* Point is in or below the bottom scroll margin, so move the
14738 window start down. If scrolling conservatively, move it just
14739 enough down to make point visible. If scroll_step is set,
14740 move it down by scroll_step. */
14741 if (arg_scroll_conservatively)
14742 amount_to_scroll
14743 = min (max (dy, FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
14744 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * arg_scroll_conservatively);
14745 else if (scroll_step || temp_scroll_step)
14746 amount_to_scroll = scroll_max;
14747 else
14749 aggressive = BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively);
14750 height = WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
14751 if (NUMBERP (aggressive))
14753 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive) * height;
14754 amount_to_scroll = float_amount;
14755 if (amount_to_scroll == 0 && float_amount > 0)
14756 amount_to_scroll = 1;
14757 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near top of
14758 the window. */
14759 if (amount_to_scroll > height - 2*this_scroll_margin + dy)
14760 amount_to_scroll = height - 2*this_scroll_margin + dy;
14764 if (amount_to_scroll <= 0)
14765 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14767 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14768 if (arg_scroll_conservatively <= scroll_limit)
14769 move_it_vertically (&it, amount_to_scroll);
14770 else
14772 /* Extra precision for users who set scroll-conservatively
14773 to a large number: make sure the amount we scroll
14774 the window start is never less than amount_to_scroll,
14775 which was computed as distance from window bottom to
14776 point. This matters when lines at window top and lines
14777 below window bottom have different height. */
14778 struct it it1;
14779 void *it1data = NULL;
14780 /* We use a temporary it1 because line_bottom_y can modify
14781 its argument, if it moves one line down; see there. */
14782 int start_y;
14784 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
14785 start_y = line_bottom_y (&it1);
14786 do {
14787 RESTORE_IT (&it, &it, it1data);
14788 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
14789 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
14790 } while (line_bottom_y (&it1) - start_y < amount_to_scroll);
14793 /* If STARTP is unchanged, move it down another screen line. */
14794 if (CHARPOS (it.current.pos) == CHARPOS (startp))
14795 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
14796 startp = it.current.pos;
14798 else
14800 struct text_pos scroll_margin_pos = startp;
14802 /* See if point is inside the scroll margin at the top of the
14803 window. */
14804 if (this_scroll_margin)
14806 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14807 move_it_vertically (&it, this_scroll_margin);
14808 scroll_margin_pos = it.current.pos;
14811 if (PT < CHARPOS (scroll_margin_pos))
14813 /* Point is in the scroll margin at the top of the window or
14814 above what is displayed in the window. */
14815 int y0, y_to_move;
14817 /* Compute the vertical distance from PT to the scroll
14818 margin position. Move as far as scroll_max allows, or
14819 one screenful, or 10 screen lines, whichever is largest.
14820 Give up if distance is greater than scroll_max. */
14821 SET_TEXT_POS (pos, PT, PT_BYTE);
14822 start_display (&it, w, pos);
14823 y0 = it.current_y;
14824 y_to_move = max (it.last_visible_y,
14825 max (scroll_max, 10 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)));
14826 move_it_to (&it, CHARPOS (scroll_margin_pos), 0,
14827 y_to_move, -1,
14828 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
14829 dy = it.current_y - y0;
14830 if (dy > scroll_max)
14831 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14833 /* Compute new window start. */
14834 start_display (&it, w, startp);
14836 if (arg_scroll_conservatively)
14837 amount_to_scroll = max (dy, FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) *
14838 max (scroll_step, temp_scroll_step));
14839 else if (scroll_step || temp_scroll_step)
14840 amount_to_scroll = scroll_max;
14841 else
14843 aggressive = BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively);
14844 height = WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
14845 if (NUMBERP (aggressive))
14847 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive) * height;
14848 amount_to_scroll = float_amount;
14849 if (amount_to_scroll == 0 && float_amount > 0)
14850 amount_to_scroll = 1;
14851 amount_to_scroll -=
14852 this_scroll_margin - dy - FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
14853 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near
14854 bottom of the window. */
14855 if (amount_to_scroll > height - 2*this_scroll_margin + dy)
14856 amount_to_scroll = height - 2*this_scroll_margin + dy;
14860 if (amount_to_scroll <= 0)
14861 return SCROLLING_FAILED;
14863 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, amount_to_scroll);
14864 startp = it.current.pos;
14868 /* Run window scroll functions. */
14869 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, startp);
14871 /* Display the window. Give up if new fonts are loaded, or if point
14872 doesn't appear. */
14873 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
14874 rc = SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES;
14875 else if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
14877 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
14878 rc = SCROLLING_FAILED;
14880 else
14882 /* Maybe forget recorded base line for line number display. */
14883 if (!just_this_one_p
14884 || current_buffer->clip_changed
14885 || BEG_UNCHANGED < CHARPOS (startp))
14886 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
14888 /* If cursor ends up on a partially visible line,
14889 treat that as being off the bottom of the screen. */
14890 if (! cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, extra_scroll_margin_lines <= 1, 0)
14891 /* It's possible that the cursor is on the first line of the
14892 buffer, which is partially obscured due to a vscroll
14893 (Bug#7537). In that case, avoid looping forever . */
14894 && extra_scroll_margin_lines < w->desired_matrix->nrows - 1)
14896 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
14897 ++extra_scroll_margin_lines;
14898 goto too_near_end;
14900 rc = SCROLLING_SUCCESS;
14903 return rc;
14907 /* Compute a suitable window start for window W if display of W starts
14908 on a continuation line. Value is non-zero if a new window start
14909 was computed.
14911 The new window start will be computed, based on W's width, starting
14912 from the start of the continued line. It is the start of the
14913 screen line with the minimum distance from the old start W->start. */
14915 static int
14916 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (struct window *w)
14918 struct text_pos pos, start_pos;
14919 int window_start_changed_p = 0;
14921 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start_pos, w->start);
14923 /* If window start is on a continuation line... Window start may be
14924 < BEGV in case there's invisible text at the start of the
14925 buffer (M-x rmail, for example). */
14926 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) > BEGV
14927 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (start_pos) - 1) != '\n')
14929 struct it it;
14930 struct glyph_row *row;
14932 /* Handle the case that the window start is out of range. */
14933 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) < BEGV)
14934 SET_TEXT_POS (start_pos, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
14935 else if (CHARPOS (start_pos) > ZV)
14936 SET_TEXT_POS (start_pos, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
14938 /* Find the start of the continued line. This should be fast
14939 because scan_buffer is fast (newline cache). */
14940 row = w->desired_matrix->rows + (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0);
14941 init_iterator (&it, w, CHARPOS (start_pos), BYTEPOS (start_pos),
14942 row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
14943 reseat_at_previous_visible_line_start (&it);
14945 /* If the line start is "too far" away from the window start,
14946 say it takes too much time to compute a new window start. */
14947 if (CHARPOS (start_pos) - IT_CHARPOS (it)
14948 < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) * WINDOW_TOTAL_COLS (w))
14950 int min_distance, distance;
14952 /* Move forward by display lines to find the new window
14953 start. If window width was enlarged, the new start can
14954 be expected to be > the old start. If window width was
14955 decreased, the new window start will be < the old start.
14956 So, we're looking for the display line start with the
14957 minimum distance from the old window start. */
14958 pos = it.current.pos;
14959 min_distance = INFINITY;
14960 while ((distance = eabs (CHARPOS (start_pos) - IT_CHARPOS (it))),
14961 distance < min_distance)
14963 min_distance = distance;
14964 pos = it.current.pos;
14965 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
14968 /* Set the window start there. */
14969 SET_MARKER_FROM_TEXT_POS (w->start, pos);
14970 window_start_changed_p = 1;
14974 return window_start_changed_p;
14978 /* Try cursor movement in case text has not changed in window WINDOW,
14979 with window start STARTP. Value is
14981 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS if successful
14983 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED if this method cannot be used
14985 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL if we know we have to scroll the
14986 display. *SCROLL_STEP is set to 1, under certain circumstances, if
14987 we want to scroll as if scroll-step were set to 1. See the code.
14989 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES if we need larger matrices, in
14990 which case we have to abort this redisplay, and adjust matrices
14991 first. */
14993 enum
14995 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS,
14996 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED,
14997 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL,
14998 CURSOR_MOVEMENT_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES
15001 static int
15002 try_cursor_movement (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos startp, int *scroll_step)
15004 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
15005 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
15006 int rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED;
15008 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15009 if (inhibit_try_cursor_movement)
15010 return rc;
15011 #endif
15013 /* Previously, there was a check for Lisp integer in the
15014 if-statement below. Now, this field is converted to
15015 ptrdiff_t, thus zero means invalid position in a buffer. */
15016 eassert (w->last_point > 0);
15018 /* Handle case where text has not changed, only point, and it has
15019 not moved off the frame. */
15020 if (/* Point may be in this window. */
15021 PT >= CHARPOS (startp)
15022 /* Selective display hasn't changed. */
15023 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
15024 /* Function force-mode-line-update is used to force a thorough
15025 redisplay. It sets either windows_or_buffers_changed or
15026 update_mode_lines. So don't take a shortcut here for these
15027 cases. */
15028 && !update_mode_lines
15029 && !windows_or_buffers_changed
15030 && !cursor_type_changed
15031 /* Can't use this case if highlighting a region. When a
15032 region exists, cursor movement has to do more than just
15033 set the cursor. */
15034 && !(!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
15035 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
15036 && NILP (w->region_showing)
15037 && NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace)
15038 /* This code is not used for mini-buffer for the sake of the case
15039 of redisplaying to replace an echo area message; since in
15040 that case the mini-buffer contents per se are usually
15041 unchanged. This code is of no real use in the mini-buffer
15042 since the handling of this_line_start_pos, etc., in redisplay
15043 handles the same cases. */
15044 && !EQ (window, minibuf_window)
15045 /* When splitting windows or for new windows, it happens that
15046 redisplay is called with a nil window_end_vpos or one being
15047 larger than the window. This should really be fixed in
15048 window.c. I don't have this on my list, now, so we do
15049 approximately the same as the old redisplay code. --gerd. */
15050 && INTEGERP (w->window_end_vpos)
15051 && XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) < w->current_matrix->nrows
15052 && (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
15053 || !overlay_arrow_in_current_buffer_p ()))
15055 int this_scroll_margin, top_scroll_margin;
15056 struct glyph_row *row = NULL;
15058 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15059 debug_method_add (w, "cursor movement");
15060 #endif
15062 /* Scroll if point within this distance from the top or bottom
15063 of the window. This is a pixel value. */
15064 if (scroll_margin > 0)
15066 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4);
15067 this_scroll_margin *= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
15069 else
15070 this_scroll_margin = 0;
15072 top_scroll_margin = this_scroll_margin;
15073 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
15074 top_scroll_margin += CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
15076 /* Start with the row the cursor was displayed during the last
15077 not paused redisplay. Give up if that row is not valid. */
15078 if (w->last_cursor.vpos < 0
15079 || w->last_cursor.vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows)
15080 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15081 else
15083 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->last_cursor.vpos);
15084 if (row->mode_line_p)
15085 ++row;
15086 if (!row->enabled_p)
15087 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15090 if (rc == CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED)
15092 int scroll_p = 0, must_scroll = 0;
15093 int last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w) - this_scroll_margin;
15095 if (PT > w->last_point)
15097 /* Point has moved forward. */
15098 while (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) < PT
15099 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y)
15101 eassert (row->enabled_p);
15102 ++row;
15105 /* If the end position of a row equals the start
15106 position of the next row, and PT is at that position,
15107 we would rather display cursor in the next line. */
15108 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
15109 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15110 && row < w->current_matrix->rows
15111 + w->current_matrix->nrows - 1
15112 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row+1) == PT
15113 && !cursor_row_p (row))
15114 ++row;
15116 /* If within the scroll margin, scroll. Note that
15117 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y gives the pixel position at which
15118 the next line would be drawn, and that
15119 this_scroll_margin can be zero. */
15120 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y
15121 || PT > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15122 /* Line is completely visible last line in window
15123 and PT is to be set in the next line. */
15124 || (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) == last_y
15125 && PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15126 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
15127 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)))
15128 scroll_p = 1;
15130 else if (PT < w->last_point)
15132 /* Cursor has to be moved backward. Note that PT >=
15133 CHARPOS (startp) because of the outer if-statement. */
15134 while (!row->mode_line_p
15135 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) > PT
15136 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15137 && (MATRIX_ROW_STARTS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)
15138 || (/* STARTS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_STRING_P (row) */
15139 row > w->current_matrix->rows
15140 && (row-1)->ends_in_newline_from_string_p))))
15141 && (row->y > top_scroll_margin
15142 || CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV))
15144 eassert (row->enabled_p);
15145 --row;
15148 /* Consider the following case: Window starts at BEGV,
15149 there is invisible, intangible text at BEGV, so that
15150 display starts at some point START > BEGV. It can
15151 happen that we are called with PT somewhere between
15152 BEGV and START. Try to handle that case. */
15153 if (row < w->current_matrix->rows
15154 || row->mode_line_p)
15156 row = w->current_matrix->rows;
15157 if (row->mode_line_p)
15158 ++row;
15161 /* Due to newlines in overlay strings, we may have to
15162 skip forward over overlay strings. */
15163 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
15164 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15165 && !cursor_row_p (row))
15166 ++row;
15168 /* If within the scroll margin, scroll. */
15169 if (row->y < top_scroll_margin
15170 && CHARPOS (startp) != BEGV)
15171 scroll_p = 1;
15173 else
15175 /* Cursor did not move. So don't scroll even if cursor line
15176 is partially visible, as it was so before. */
15177 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15180 if (PT < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
15181 || PT > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
15183 /* if PT is not in the glyph row, give up. */
15184 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15185 must_scroll = 1;
15187 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15188 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering)))
15190 struct glyph_row *row1;
15192 /* If rows are bidi-reordered and point moved, back up
15193 until we find a row that does not belong to a
15194 continuation line. This is because we must consider
15195 all rows of a continued line as candidates for the
15196 new cursor positioning, since row start and end
15197 positions change non-linearly with vertical position
15198 in such rows. */
15199 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in
15200 continuation lines' rows is implemented for
15201 bidi-reordered rows. */
15202 for (row1 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
15203 MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row);
15204 --row)
15206 /* If we hit the beginning of the displayed portion
15207 without finding the first row of a continued
15208 line, give up. */
15209 if (row <= row1)
15211 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15212 break;
15214 eassert (row->enabled_p);
15217 if (must_scroll)
15219 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15220 && MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, row)
15221 /* Make sure this isn't a header line by any chance, since
15222 then MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P might yield non-zero. */
15223 && !row->mode_line_p
15224 && make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p)
15226 if (PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15227 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
15228 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))
15229 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15230 else if (row->height > window_box_height (w))
15232 /* If we end up in a partially visible line, let's
15233 make it fully visible, except when it's taller
15234 than the window, in which case we can't do much
15235 about it. */
15236 *scroll_step = 1;
15237 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15239 else
15241 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
15242 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 1))
15243 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15244 else
15245 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15248 else if (scroll_p)
15249 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15250 else if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15251 && !NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering)))
15253 /* With bidi-reordered rows, there could be more than
15254 one candidate row whose start and end positions
15255 occlude point. We need to let set_cursor_from_row
15256 find the best candidate. */
15257 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in
15258 continuation lines' rows is implemented for
15259 bidi-reordered rows. */
15260 int rv = 0;
15264 int at_zv_p = 0, exact_match_p = 0;
15266 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) <= PT
15267 && PT <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
15268 && cursor_row_p (row))
15269 rv |= set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix,
15270 0, 0, 0, 0);
15271 /* As soon as we've found the exact match for point,
15272 or the first suitable row whose ends_at_zv_p flag
15273 is set, we are done. */
15274 at_zv_p =
15275 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos)->ends_at_zv_p;
15276 if (rv && !at_zv_p
15277 && w->cursor.hpos >= 0
15278 && w->cursor.hpos < MATRIX_ROW_USED (w->current_matrix,
15279 w->cursor.vpos))
15281 struct glyph_row *candidate =
15282 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
15283 struct glyph *g =
15284 candidate->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + w->cursor.hpos;
15285 ptrdiff_t endpos = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (candidate);
15287 exact_match_p =
15288 (BUFFERP (g->object) && g->charpos == PT)
15289 || (INTEGERP (g->object)
15290 && (g->charpos == PT
15291 || (g->charpos == 0 && endpos - 1 == PT)));
15293 if (rv && (at_zv_p || exact_match_p))
15295 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15296 break;
15298 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) == last_y)
15299 break;
15300 ++row;
15302 while (((MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
15303 || row->continued_p)
15304 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y)
15305 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15306 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y));
15307 /* If we didn't find any candidate rows, or exited the
15308 loop before all the candidates were examined, signal
15309 to the caller that this method failed. */
15310 if (rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS
15311 && !(rv
15312 && !MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row)
15313 && !row->continued_p))
15314 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL;
15315 else if (rv)
15316 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15318 else
15322 if (set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0))
15324 rc = CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS;
15325 break;
15327 ++row;
15329 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < last_y
15330 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == PT
15331 && cursor_row_p (row));
15336 return rc;
15339 #if !defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS || defined USE_GTK
15340 static
15341 #endif
15342 void
15343 set_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w)
15345 ptrdiff_t start, end, whole;
15347 /* Calculate the start and end positions for the current window.
15348 At some point, it would be nice to choose between scrollbars
15349 which reflect the whole buffer size, with special markers
15350 indicating narrowing, and scrollbars which reflect only the
15351 visible region.
15353 Note that mini-buffers sometimes aren't displaying any text. */
15354 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
15355 || (w == XWINDOW (minibuf_window)
15356 && NILP (echo_area_buffer[0])))
15358 struct buffer *buf = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
15359 whole = BUF_ZV (buf) - BUF_BEGV (buf);
15360 start = marker_position (w->start) - BUF_BEGV (buf);
15361 /* I don't think this is guaranteed to be right. For the
15362 moment, we'll pretend it is. */
15363 end = BUF_Z (buf) - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) - BUF_BEGV (buf);
15365 if (end < start)
15366 end = start;
15367 if (whole < (end - start))
15368 whole = end - start;
15370 else
15371 start = end = whole = 0;
15373 /* Indicate what this scroll bar ought to be displaying now. */
15374 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (XFRAME (w->frame))->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook)
15375 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (XFRAME (w->frame))->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook)
15376 (w, end - start, whole, start);
15380 /* Redisplay leaf window WINDOW. JUST_THIS_ONE_P non-zero means only
15381 selected_window is redisplayed.
15383 We can return without actually redisplaying the window if
15384 fonts_changed_p is nonzero. In that case, redisplay_internal will
15385 retry. */
15387 static void
15388 redisplay_window (Lisp_Object window, int just_this_one_p)
15390 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
15391 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
15392 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
15393 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
15394 struct text_pos lpoint, opoint, startp;
15395 int update_mode_line;
15396 int tem;
15397 struct it it;
15398 /* Record it now because it's overwritten. */
15399 int current_matrix_up_to_date_p = 0;
15400 int used_current_matrix_p = 0;
15401 /* This is less strict than current_matrix_up_to_date_p.
15402 It indicates that the buffer contents and narrowing are unchanged. */
15403 int buffer_unchanged_p = 0;
15404 int temp_scroll_step = 0;
15405 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
15406 int rc;
15407 int centering_position = -1;
15408 int last_line_misfit = 0;
15409 ptrdiff_t beg_unchanged, end_unchanged;
15411 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15412 opoint = lpoint;
15414 /* W must be a leaf window here. */
15415 eassert (!NILP (w->buffer));
15416 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15417 *w->desired_matrix->method = 0;
15418 #endif
15420 restart:
15421 reconsider_clip_changes (w, buffer);
15423 /* Has the mode line to be updated? */
15424 update_mode_line = (w->update_mode_line
15425 || update_mode_lines
15426 || buffer->clip_changed
15427 || buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p);
15429 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
15431 if (w == XWINDOW (echo_area_window)
15432 && !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))
15434 if (update_mode_line)
15435 /* We may have to update a tty frame's menu bar or a
15436 tool-bar. Example `M-x C-h C-h C-g'. */
15437 goto finish_menu_bars;
15438 else
15439 /* We've already displayed the echo area glyphs in this window. */
15440 goto finish_scroll_bars;
15442 else if ((w != XWINDOW (minibuf_window)
15443 || minibuf_level == 0)
15444 /* When buffer is nonempty, redisplay window normally. */
15445 && BUF_Z (XBUFFER (w->buffer)) == BUF_BEG (XBUFFER (w->buffer))
15446 /* Quail displays non-mini buffers in minibuffer window.
15447 In that case, redisplay the window normally. */
15448 && !NILP (Fmemq (w->buffer, Vminibuffer_list)))
15450 /* W is a mini-buffer window, but it's not active, so clear
15451 it. */
15452 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
15453 struct glyph_row *row;
15454 int y;
15456 for (y = 0, row = w->desired_matrix->rows;
15457 y < yb;
15458 y += row->height, ++row)
15459 blank_row (w, row, y);
15460 goto finish_scroll_bars;
15463 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15466 /* Otherwise set up data on this window; select its buffer and point
15467 value. */
15468 /* Really select the buffer, for the sake of buffer-local
15469 variables. */
15470 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
15472 current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15473 = (!NILP (w->window_end_valid)
15474 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
15475 && !current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p
15476 && w->last_modified >= MODIFF
15477 && w->last_overlay_modified >= OVERLAY_MODIFF);
15479 /* Run the window-bottom-change-functions
15480 if it is possible that the text on the screen has changed
15481 (either due to modification of the text, or any other reason). */
15482 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15483 && !NILP (Vwindow_text_change_functions))
15485 safe_run_hooks (Qwindow_text_change_functions);
15486 goto restart;
15489 beg_unchanged = BEG_UNCHANGED;
15490 end_unchanged = END_UNCHANGED;
15492 SET_TEXT_POS (opoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15494 specbind (Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks, Qt);
15496 buffer_unchanged_p
15497 = (!NILP (w->window_end_valid)
15498 && !current_buffer->clip_changed
15499 && w->last_modified >= MODIFF
15500 && w->last_overlay_modified >= OVERLAY_MODIFF);
15502 /* When windows_or_buffers_changed is non-zero, we can't rely on
15503 the window end being valid, so set it to nil there. */
15504 if (windows_or_buffers_changed)
15506 /* If window starts on a continuation line, maybe adjust the
15507 window start in case the window's width changed. */
15508 if (XMARKER (w->start)->buffer == current_buffer)
15509 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (w);
15511 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
15514 /* Some sanity checks. */
15515 CHECK_WINDOW_END (w);
15516 if (Z == Z_BYTE && CHARPOS (opoint) != BYTEPOS (opoint))
15517 abort ();
15518 if (BYTEPOS (opoint) < CHARPOS (opoint))
15519 abort ();
15521 /* If %c is in mode line, update it if needed. */
15522 if (!NILP (w->column_number_displayed)
15523 /* This alternative quickly identifies a common case
15524 where no change is needed. */
15525 && !(PT == w->last_point
15526 && w->last_modified >= MODIFF
15527 && w->last_overlay_modified >= OVERLAY_MODIFF)
15528 && (XFASTINT (w->column_number_displayed) != current_column ()))
15529 update_mode_line = 1;
15531 /* Count number of windows showing the selected buffer. An indirect
15532 buffer counts as its base buffer. */
15533 if (!just_this_one_p)
15535 struct buffer *current_base, *window_base;
15536 current_base = current_buffer;
15537 window_base = XBUFFER (XWINDOW (selected_window)->buffer);
15538 if (current_base->base_buffer)
15539 current_base = current_base->base_buffer;
15540 if (window_base->base_buffer)
15541 window_base = window_base->base_buffer;
15542 if (current_base == window_base)
15543 buffer_shared++;
15546 /* Point refers normally to the selected window. For any other
15547 window, set up appropriate value. */
15548 if (!EQ (window, selected_window))
15550 ptrdiff_t new_pt = XMARKER (w->pointm)->charpos;
15551 ptrdiff_t new_pt_byte = marker_byte_position (w->pointm);
15552 if (new_pt < BEGV)
15554 new_pt = BEGV;
15555 new_pt_byte = BEGV_BYTE;
15556 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
15558 else if (new_pt > (ZV - 1))
15560 new_pt = ZV;
15561 new_pt_byte = ZV_BYTE;
15562 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
15565 /* We don't use SET_PT so that the point-motion hooks don't run. */
15566 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (new_pt, new_pt_byte);
15569 /* If any of the character widths specified in the display table
15570 have changed, invalidate the width run cache. It's true that
15571 this may be a bit late to catch such changes, but the rest of
15572 redisplay goes (non-fatally) haywire when the display table is
15573 changed, so why should we worry about doing any better? */
15574 if (current_buffer->width_run_cache)
15576 struct Lisp_Char_Table *disptab = buffer_display_table ();
15578 if (! disptab_matches_widthtab
15579 (disptab, XVECTOR (BVAR (current_buffer, width_table))))
15581 invalidate_region_cache (current_buffer,
15582 current_buffer->width_run_cache,
15583 BEG, Z);
15584 recompute_width_table (current_buffer, disptab);
15588 /* If window-start is screwed up, choose a new one. */
15589 if (XMARKER (w->start)->buffer != current_buffer)
15590 goto recenter;
15592 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
15594 /* If someone specified a new starting point but did not insist,
15595 check whether it can be used. */
15596 if (w->optional_new_start
15597 && CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
15598 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
15600 w->optional_new_start = 0;
15601 start_display (&it, w, startp);
15602 move_it_to (&it, PT, 0, it.last_visible_y, -1,
15603 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y);
15604 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) == PT)
15605 w->force_start = 1;
15606 /* IT may overshoot PT if text at PT is invisible. */
15607 else if (IT_CHARPOS (it) > PT && CHARPOS (startp) <= PT)
15608 w->force_start = 1;
15611 force_start:
15613 /* Handle case where place to start displaying has been specified,
15614 unless the specified location is outside the accessible range. */
15615 if (w->force_start || w->frozen_window_start_p)
15617 /* We set this later on if we have to adjust point. */
15618 int new_vpos = -1;
15620 w->force_start = 0;
15621 w->vscroll = 0;
15622 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
15624 /* Forget any recorded base line for line number display. */
15625 if (!buffer_unchanged_p)
15626 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
15628 /* Redisplay the mode line. Select the buffer properly for that.
15629 Also, run the hook window-scroll-functions
15630 because we have scrolled. */
15631 /* Note, we do this after clearing force_start because
15632 if there's an error, it is better to forget about force_start
15633 than to get into an infinite loop calling the hook functions
15634 and having them get more errors. */
15635 if (!update_mode_line
15636 || ! NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions))
15638 update_mode_line = 1;
15639 w->update_mode_line = 1;
15640 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, startp);
15643 w->last_modified = 0;
15644 w->last_overlay_modified = 0;
15645 if (CHARPOS (startp) < BEGV)
15646 SET_TEXT_POS (startp, BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
15647 else if (CHARPOS (startp) > ZV)
15648 SET_TEXT_POS (startp, ZV, ZV_BYTE);
15650 /* Redisplay, then check if cursor has been set during the
15651 redisplay. Give up if new fonts were loaded. */
15652 /* We used to issue a CHECK_MARGINS argument to try_window here,
15653 but this causes scrolling to fail when point begins inside
15654 the scroll margin (bug#148) -- cyd */
15655 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
15657 w->force_start = 1;
15658 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15659 goto need_larger_matrices;
15662 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0 && !w->frozen_window_start_p)
15664 /* If point does not appear, try to move point so it does
15665 appear. The desired matrix has been built above, so we
15666 can use it here. */
15667 new_vpos = window_box_height (w) / 2;
15670 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 0))
15672 /* Point does appear, but on a line partly visible at end of window.
15673 Move it back to a fully-visible line. */
15674 new_vpos = window_box_height (w);
15677 /* If we need to move point for either of the above reasons,
15678 now actually do it. */
15679 if (new_vpos >= 0)
15681 struct glyph_row *row;
15683 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->desired_matrix);
15684 while (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < new_vpos)
15685 ++row;
15687 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row),
15688 MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row));
15690 if (w != XWINDOW (selected_window))
15691 set_marker_both (w->pointm, Qnil, PT, PT_BYTE);
15692 else if (current_buffer == old)
15693 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
15695 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->desired_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
15697 /* If we are highlighting the region, then we just changed
15698 the region, so redisplay to show it. */
15699 if (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
15700 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
15702 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15703 if (!try_window (window, startp, 0))
15704 goto need_larger_matrices;
15708 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15709 debug_method_add (w, "forced window start");
15710 #endif
15711 goto done;
15714 /* Handle case where text has not changed, only point, and it has
15715 not moved off the frame, and we are not retrying after hscroll.
15716 (current_matrix_up_to_date_p is nonzero when retrying.) */
15717 if (current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15718 && (rc = try_cursor_movement (window, startp, &temp_scroll_step),
15719 rc != CURSOR_MOVEMENT_CANNOT_BE_USED))
15721 switch (rc)
15723 case CURSOR_MOVEMENT_SUCCESS:
15724 used_current_matrix_p = 1;
15725 goto done;
15727 case CURSOR_MOVEMENT_MUST_SCROLL:
15728 goto try_to_scroll;
15730 default:
15731 abort ();
15734 /* If current starting point was originally the beginning of a line
15735 but no longer is, find a new starting point. */
15736 else if (w->start_at_line_beg
15737 && !(CHARPOS (startp) <= BEGV
15738 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (startp) - 1) == '\n'))
15740 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15741 debug_method_add (w, "recenter 1");
15742 #endif
15743 goto recenter;
15746 /* Try scrolling with try_window_id. Value is > 0 if update has
15747 been done, it is -1 if we know that the same window start will
15748 not work. It is 0 if unsuccessful for some other reason. */
15749 else if ((tem = try_window_id (w)) != 0)
15751 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15752 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_id %d", tem);
15753 #endif
15755 if (fonts_changed_p)
15756 goto need_larger_matrices;
15757 if (tem > 0)
15758 goto done;
15760 /* Otherwise try_window_id has returned -1 which means that we
15761 don't want the alternative below this comment to execute. */
15763 else if (CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
15764 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV
15765 && PT >= CHARPOS (startp)
15766 && (CHARPOS (startp) < ZV
15767 /* Avoid starting at end of buffer. */
15768 || CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV
15769 || (w->last_modified >= MODIFF
15770 && w->last_overlay_modified >= OVERLAY_MODIFF)))
15772 int d1, d2, d3, d4, d5, d6;
15774 /* If first window line is a continuation line, and window start
15775 is inside the modified region, but the first change is before
15776 current window start, we must select a new window start.
15778 However, if this is the result of a down-mouse event (e.g. by
15779 extending the mouse-drag-overlay), we don't want to select a
15780 new window start, since that would change the position under
15781 the mouse, resulting in an unwanted mouse-movement rather
15782 than a simple mouse-click. */
15783 if (!w->start_at_line_beg
15784 && NILP (do_mouse_tracking)
15785 && CHARPOS (startp) > BEGV
15786 && CHARPOS (startp) > BEG + beg_unchanged
15787 && CHARPOS (startp) <= Z - end_unchanged
15788 /* Even if w->start_at_line_beg is nil, a new window may
15789 start at a line_beg, since that's how set_buffer_window
15790 sets it. So, we need to check the return value of
15791 compute_window_start_on_continuation_line. (See also
15792 bug#197). */
15793 && XMARKER (w->start)->buffer == current_buffer
15794 && compute_window_start_on_continuation_line (w)
15795 /* It doesn't make sense to force the window start like we
15796 do at label force_start if it is already known that point
15797 will not be visible in the resulting window, because
15798 doing so will move point from its correct position
15799 instead of scrolling the window to bring point into view.
15800 See bug#9324. */
15801 && pos_visible_p (w, PT, &d1, &d2, &d3, &d4, &d5, &d6))
15803 w->force_start = 1;
15804 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
15805 goto force_start;
15808 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15809 debug_method_add (w, "same window start");
15810 #endif
15812 /* Try to redisplay starting at same place as before.
15813 If point has not moved off frame, accept the results. */
15814 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
15815 /* Don't use try_window_reusing_current_matrix in this case
15816 because a window scroll function can have changed the
15817 buffer. */
15818 || !NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions)
15819 || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
15820 || !(used_current_matrix_p
15821 = try_window_reusing_current_matrix (w)))
15823 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "1"));
15824 if (try_window (window, startp, TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS) < 0)
15825 /* -1 means we need to scroll.
15826 0 means we need new matrices, but fonts_changed_p
15827 is set in that case, so we will detect it below. */
15828 goto try_to_scroll;
15831 if (fonts_changed_p)
15832 goto need_larger_matrices;
15834 if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0)
15836 if (!just_this_one_p
15837 || current_buffer->clip_changed
15838 || BEG_UNCHANGED < CHARPOS (startp))
15839 /* Forget any recorded base line for line number display. */
15840 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
15842 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 1, 0))
15844 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15845 last_line_misfit = 1;
15847 /* Drop through and scroll. */
15848 else
15849 goto done;
15851 else
15852 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
15855 try_to_scroll:
15857 w->last_modified = 0;
15858 w->last_overlay_modified = 0;
15860 /* Redisplay the mode line. Select the buffer properly for that. */
15861 if (!update_mode_line)
15863 update_mode_line = 1;
15864 w->update_mode_line = 1;
15867 /* Try to scroll by specified few lines. */
15868 if ((scroll_conservatively
15869 || emacs_scroll_step
15870 || temp_scroll_step
15871 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively))
15872 || NUMBERP (BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively)))
15873 && CHARPOS (startp) >= BEGV
15874 && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
15876 /* The function returns -1 if new fonts were loaded, 1 if
15877 successful, 0 if not successful. */
15878 int ss = try_scrolling (window, just_this_one_p,
15879 scroll_conservatively,
15880 emacs_scroll_step,
15881 temp_scroll_step, last_line_misfit);
15882 switch (ss)
15884 case SCROLLING_SUCCESS:
15885 goto done;
15887 case SCROLLING_NEED_LARGER_MATRICES:
15888 goto need_larger_matrices;
15890 case SCROLLING_FAILED:
15891 break;
15893 default:
15894 abort ();
15898 /* Finally, just choose a place to start which positions point
15899 according to user preferences. */
15901 recenter:
15903 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
15904 debug_method_add (w, "recenter");
15905 #endif
15907 /* w->vscroll = 0; */
15909 /* Forget any previously recorded base line for line number display. */
15910 if (!buffer_unchanged_p)
15911 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
15913 /* Determine the window start relative to point. */
15914 init_iterator (&it, w, PT, PT_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
15915 it.current_y = it.last_visible_y;
15916 if (centering_position < 0)
15918 int margin =
15919 scroll_margin > 0
15920 ? min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4)
15921 : 0;
15922 ptrdiff_t margin_pos = CHARPOS (startp);
15923 Lisp_Object aggressive;
15924 int scrolling_up;
15926 /* If there is a scroll margin at the top of the window, find
15927 its character position. */
15928 if (margin
15929 /* Cannot call start_display if startp is not in the
15930 accessible region of the buffer. This can happen when we
15931 have just switched to a different buffer and/or changed
15932 its restriction. In that case, startp is initialized to
15933 the character position 1 (BEGV) because we did not yet
15934 have chance to display the buffer even once. */
15935 && BEGV <= CHARPOS (startp) && CHARPOS (startp) <= ZV)
15937 struct it it1;
15938 void *it1data = NULL;
15940 SAVE_IT (it1, it, it1data);
15941 start_display (&it1, w, startp);
15942 move_it_vertically (&it1, margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
15943 margin_pos = IT_CHARPOS (it1);
15944 RESTORE_IT (&it, &it, it1data);
15946 scrolling_up = PT > margin_pos;
15947 aggressive =
15948 scrolling_up
15949 ? BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_up_aggressively)
15950 : BVAR (current_buffer, scroll_down_aggressively);
15952 if (!MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
15953 && (scroll_conservatively > SCROLL_LIMIT || NUMBERP (aggressive)))
15955 int pt_offset = 0;
15957 /* Setting scroll-conservatively overrides
15958 scroll-*-aggressively. */
15959 if (!scroll_conservatively && NUMBERP (aggressive))
15961 double float_amount = XFLOATINT (aggressive);
15963 pt_offset = float_amount * WINDOW_BOX_TEXT_HEIGHT (w);
15964 if (pt_offset == 0 && float_amount > 0)
15965 pt_offset = 1;
15966 if (pt_offset && margin > 0)
15967 margin -= 1;
15969 /* Compute how much to move the window start backward from
15970 point so that point will be displayed where the user
15971 wants it. */
15972 if (scrolling_up)
15974 centering_position = it.last_visible_y;
15975 if (pt_offset)
15976 centering_position -= pt_offset;
15977 centering_position -=
15978 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * (1 + margin + (last_line_misfit != 0))
15979 + WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
15980 /* Don't let point enter the scroll margin near top of
15981 the window. */
15982 if (centering_position < margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
15983 centering_position = margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
15985 else
15986 centering_position = margin * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) + pt_offset;
15988 else
15989 /* Set the window start half the height of the window backward
15990 from point. */
15991 centering_position = window_box_height (w) / 2;
15993 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, centering_position);
15995 eassert (IT_CHARPOS (it) >= BEGV);
15997 /* The function move_it_vertically_backward may move over more
15998 than the specified y-distance. If it->w is small, e.g. a
15999 mini-buffer window, we may end up in front of the window's
16000 display area. Start displaying at the start of the line
16001 containing PT in this case. */
16002 if (it.current_y <= 0)
16004 init_iterator (&it, w, PT, PT_BYTE, NULL, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
16005 move_it_vertically_backward (&it, 0);
16006 it.current_y = 0;
16009 it.current_x = it.hpos = 0;
16011 /* Set the window start position here explicitly, to avoid an
16012 infinite loop in case the functions in window-scroll-functions
16013 get errors. */
16014 set_marker_both (w->start, Qnil, IT_CHARPOS (it), IT_BYTEPOS (it));
16016 /* Run scroll hooks. */
16017 startp = run_window_scroll_functions (window, it.current.pos);
16019 /* Redisplay the window. */
16020 if (!current_matrix_up_to_date_p
16021 || windows_or_buffers_changed
16022 || cursor_type_changed
16023 /* Don't use try_window_reusing_current_matrix in this case
16024 because it can have changed the buffer. */
16025 || !NILP (Vwindow_scroll_functions)
16026 || !just_this_one_p
16027 || MINI_WINDOW_P (w)
16028 || !(used_current_matrix_p
16029 = try_window_reusing_current_matrix (w)))
16030 try_window (window, startp, 0);
16032 /* If new fonts have been loaded (due to fontsets), give up. We
16033 have to start a new redisplay since we need to re-adjust glyph
16034 matrices. */
16035 if (fonts_changed_p)
16036 goto need_larger_matrices;
16038 /* If cursor did not appear assume that the middle of the window is
16039 in the first line of the window. Do it again with the next line.
16040 (Imagine a window of height 100, displaying two lines of height
16041 60. Moving back 50 from it->last_visible_y will end in the first
16042 line.) */
16043 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16045 if (!NILP (w->window_end_valid)
16046 && PT >= Z - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos))
16048 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16049 move_it_by_lines (&it, 1);
16050 try_window (window, it.current.pos, 0);
16052 else if (PT < IT_CHARPOS (it))
16054 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16055 move_it_by_lines (&it, -1);
16056 try_window (window, it.current.pos, 0);
16058 else
16060 /* Not much we can do about it. */
16064 /* Consider the following case: Window starts at BEGV, there is
16065 invisible, intangible text at BEGV, so that display starts at
16066 some point START > BEGV. It can happen that we are called with
16067 PT somewhere between BEGV and START. Try to handle that case. */
16068 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16070 struct glyph_row *row = w->current_matrix->rows;
16071 if (row->mode_line_p)
16072 ++row;
16073 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
16076 if (!cursor_row_fully_visible_p (w, 0, 0))
16078 /* If vscroll is enabled, disable it and try again. */
16079 if (w->vscroll)
16081 w->vscroll = 0;
16082 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16083 goto recenter;
16086 /* Users who set scroll-conservatively to a large number want
16087 point just above/below the scroll margin. If we ended up
16088 with point's row partially visible, move the window start to
16089 make that row fully visible and out of the margin. */
16090 if (scroll_conservatively > SCROLL_LIMIT)
16092 int margin =
16093 scroll_margin > 0
16094 ? min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4)
16095 : 0;
16096 int move_down = w->cursor.vpos >= WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 2;
16098 move_it_by_lines (&it, move_down ? margin + 1 : -(margin + 1));
16099 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16100 if (1 == try_window (window, it.current.pos,
16101 TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS))
16102 goto done;
16105 /* If centering point failed to make the whole line visible,
16106 put point at the top instead. That has to make the whole line
16107 visible, if it can be done. */
16108 if (centering_position == 0)
16109 goto done;
16111 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16112 centering_position = 0;
16113 goto recenter;
16116 done:
16118 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start);
16119 w->start_at_line_beg = (CHARPOS (startp) == BEGV
16120 || FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (startp) - 1) == '\n');
16122 /* Display the mode line, if we must. */
16123 if ((update_mode_line
16124 /* If window not full width, must redo its mode line
16125 if (a) the window to its side is being redone and
16126 (b) we do a frame-based redisplay. This is a consequence
16127 of how inverted lines are drawn in frame-based redisplay. */
16128 || (!just_this_one_p
16129 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
16130 && !WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w))
16131 /* Line number to display. */
16132 || INTEGERP (w->base_line_pos)
16133 /* Column number is displayed and different from the one displayed. */
16134 || (!NILP (w->column_number_displayed)
16135 && (XFASTINT (w->column_number_displayed) != current_column ())))
16136 /* This means that the window has a mode line. */
16137 && (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
16138 || WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)))
16140 display_mode_lines (w);
16142 /* If mode line height has changed, arrange for a thorough
16143 immediate redisplay using the correct mode line height. */
16144 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
16145 && CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w) != DESIRED_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w))
16147 fonts_changed_p = 1;
16148 MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->height
16149 = DESIRED_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16152 /* If header line height has changed, arrange for a thorough
16153 immediate redisplay using the correct header line height. */
16154 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)
16155 && CURRENT_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w) != DESIRED_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w))
16157 fonts_changed_p = 1;
16158 MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->height
16159 = DESIRED_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16162 if (fonts_changed_p)
16163 goto need_larger_matrices;
16166 if (!line_number_displayed
16167 && !BUFFERP (w->base_line_pos))
16169 wset_base_line_pos (w, Qnil);
16170 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
16173 finish_menu_bars:
16175 /* When we reach a frame's selected window, redo the frame's menu bar. */
16176 if (update_mode_line
16177 && EQ (FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f), window))
16179 int redisplay_menu_p = 0;
16181 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
16183 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (HAVE_NTGUI) \
16184 || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (USE_GTK)
16185 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_EXTERNAL_MENU_BAR (f);
16186 #else
16187 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0;
16188 #endif
16190 else
16191 redisplay_menu_p = FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) > 0;
16193 if (redisplay_menu_p)
16194 display_menu_bar (w);
16196 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
16197 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
16199 #if defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS)
16200 if (FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f))
16201 redisplay_tool_bar (f);
16202 #else
16203 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
16204 && (FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) > 0
16205 || !NILP (Vauto_resize_tool_bars))
16206 && redisplay_tool_bar (f))
16207 ignore_mouse_drag_p = 1;
16208 #endif
16210 #endif
16213 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
16214 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
16215 && update_window_fringes (w, (just_this_one_p
16216 || (!used_current_matrix_p && !overlay_arrow_seen)
16217 || w->pseudo_window_p)))
16219 update_begin (f);
16220 BLOCK_INPUT;
16221 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
16222 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
16223 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
16224 update_end (f);
16226 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
16228 /* We go to this label, with fonts_changed_p nonzero,
16229 if it is necessary to try again using larger glyph matrices.
16230 We have to redeem the scroll bar even in this case,
16231 because the loop in redisplay_internal expects that. */
16232 need_larger_matrices:
16234 finish_scroll_bars:
16236 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR (w))
16238 /* Set the thumb's position and size. */
16239 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
16241 /* Note that we actually used the scroll bar attached to this
16242 window, so it shouldn't be deleted at the end of redisplay. */
16243 if (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->redeem_scroll_bar_hook)
16244 (*FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->redeem_scroll_bar_hook) (w);
16247 /* Restore current_buffer and value of point in it. The window
16248 update may have changed the buffer, so first make sure `opoint'
16249 is still valid (Bug#6177). */
16250 if (CHARPOS (opoint) < BEGV)
16251 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
16252 else if (CHARPOS (opoint) > ZV)
16253 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (Z, Z_BYTE);
16254 else
16255 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (opoint), BYTEPOS (opoint));
16257 set_buffer_internal_1 (old);
16258 /* Avoid an abort in TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH if the buffer has become
16259 shorter. This can be caused by log truncation in *Messages*. */
16260 if (CHARPOS (lpoint) <= ZV)
16261 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (lpoint), BYTEPOS (lpoint));
16263 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
16267 /* Build the complete desired matrix of WINDOW with a window start
16268 buffer position POS.
16270 Value is 1 if successful. It is zero if fonts were loaded during
16271 redisplay which makes re-adjusting glyph matrices necessary, and -1
16272 if point would appear in the scroll margins.
16273 (We check the former only if TRY_WINDOW_IGNORE_FONTS_CHANGE is
16274 unset in FLAGS, and the latter only if TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS is
16275 set in FLAGS.) */
16278 try_window (Lisp_Object window, struct text_pos pos, int flags)
16280 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
16281 struct it it;
16282 struct glyph_row *last_text_row = NULL;
16283 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
16285 /* Make POS the new window start. */
16286 set_marker_both (w->start, Qnil, CHARPOS (pos), BYTEPOS (pos));
16288 /* Mark cursor position as unknown. No overlay arrow seen. */
16289 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16290 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
16292 /* Initialize iterator and info to start at POS. */
16293 start_display (&it, w, pos);
16295 /* Display all lines of W. */
16296 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
16298 if (display_line (&it))
16299 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
16300 if (fonts_changed_p && !(flags & TRY_WINDOW_IGNORE_FONTS_CHANGE))
16301 return 0;
16304 /* Don't let the cursor end in the scroll margins. */
16305 if ((flags & TRY_WINDOW_CHECK_MARGINS)
16306 && !MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
16308 int this_scroll_margin;
16310 if (scroll_margin > 0)
16312 this_scroll_margin = min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4);
16313 this_scroll_margin *= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
16315 else
16316 this_scroll_margin = 0;
16318 if ((w->cursor.y >= 0 /* not vscrolled */
16319 && w->cursor.y < this_scroll_margin
16320 && CHARPOS (pos) > BEGV
16321 && IT_CHARPOS (it) < ZV)
16322 /* rms: considering make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p here
16323 seems to give wrong results. We don't want to recenter
16324 when the last line is partly visible, we want to allow
16325 that case to be handled in the usual way. */
16326 || w->cursor.y > it.last_visible_y - this_scroll_margin - 1)
16328 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16329 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16330 return -1;
16334 /* If bottom moved off end of frame, change mode line percentage. */
16335 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) <= 0
16336 && Z != IT_CHARPOS (it))
16337 w->update_mode_line = 1;
16339 /* Set window_end_pos to the offset of the last character displayed
16340 on the window from the end of current_buffer. Set
16341 window_end_vpos to its row number. */
16342 if (last_text_row)
16344 eassert (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (last_text_row));
16345 w->window_end_bytepos
16346 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
16347 wset_window_end_pos
16348 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row)));
16349 wset_window_end_vpos
16350 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row, w->desired_matrix)));
16351 eassert
16352 (MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix,
16353 XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos))->displays_text_p);
16355 else
16357 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - ZV_BYTE;
16358 wset_window_end_pos (w, make_number (Z - ZV));
16359 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (0));
16362 /* But that is not valid info until redisplay finishes. */
16363 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
16364 return 1;
16369 /************************************************************************
16370 Window redisplay reusing current matrix when buffer has not changed
16371 ************************************************************************/
16373 /* Try redisplay of window W showing an unchanged buffer with a
16374 different window start than the last time it was displayed by
16375 reusing its current matrix. Value is non-zero if successful.
16376 W->start is the new window start. */
16378 static int
16379 try_window_reusing_current_matrix (struct window *w)
16381 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
16382 struct glyph_row *bottom_row;
16383 struct it it;
16384 struct run run;
16385 struct text_pos start, new_start;
16386 int nrows_scrolled, i;
16387 struct glyph_row *last_text_row;
16388 struct glyph_row *last_reused_text_row;
16389 struct glyph_row *start_row;
16390 int start_vpos, min_y, max_y;
16392 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
16393 if (inhibit_try_window_reusing)
16394 return 0;
16395 #endif
16397 if (/* This function doesn't handle terminal frames. */
16398 !FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
16399 /* Don't try to reuse the display if windows have been split
16400 or such. */
16401 || windows_or_buffers_changed
16402 || cursor_type_changed)
16403 return 0;
16405 /* Can't do this if region may have changed. */
16406 if ((!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
16407 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
16408 || !NILP (w->region_showing)
16409 || !NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
16410 return 0;
16412 /* If top-line visibility has changed, give up. */
16413 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w)
16414 != MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->mode_line_p)
16415 return 0;
16417 /* Give up if old or new display is scrolled vertically. We could
16418 make this function handle this, but right now it doesn't. */
16419 start_row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16420 if (w->vscroll || MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, start_row))
16421 return 0;
16423 /* The variable new_start now holds the new window start. The old
16424 start `start' can be determined from the current matrix. */
16425 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (new_start, w->start);
16426 start = start_row->minpos;
16427 start_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (start_row, w->current_matrix);
16429 /* Clear the desired matrix for the display below. */
16430 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16432 if (CHARPOS (new_start) <= CHARPOS (start))
16434 /* Don't use this method if the display starts with an ellipsis
16435 displayed for invisible text. It's not easy to handle that case
16436 below, and it's certainly not worth the effort since this is
16437 not a frequent case. */
16438 if (in_ellipses_for_invisible_text_p (&start_row->start, w))
16439 return 0;
16441 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "twu1"));
16443 /* Display up to a row that can be reused. The variable
16444 last_text_row is set to the last row displayed that displays
16445 text. Note that it.vpos == 0 if or if not there is a
16446 header-line; it's not the same as the MATRIX_ROW_VPOS! */
16447 start_display (&it, w, new_start);
16448 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16449 last_text_row = last_reused_text_row = NULL;
16451 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y
16452 && !fonts_changed_p)
16454 /* If we have reached into the characters in the START row,
16455 that means the line boundaries have changed. So we
16456 can't start copying with the row START. Maybe it will
16457 work to start copying with the following row. */
16458 while (IT_CHARPOS (it) > CHARPOS (start))
16460 /* Advance to the next row as the "start". */
16461 start_row++;
16462 start = start_row->minpos;
16463 /* If there are no more rows to try, or just one, give up. */
16464 if (start_row == MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix) - 1
16465 || w->vscroll || MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_P (w, start_row)
16466 || CHARPOS (start) == ZV)
16468 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16469 return 0;
16472 start_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (start_row, w->current_matrix);
16474 /* If we have reached alignment, we can copy the rest of the
16475 rows. */
16476 if (IT_CHARPOS (it) == CHARPOS (start)
16477 /* Don't accept "alignment" inside a display vector,
16478 since start_row could have started in the middle of
16479 that same display vector (thus their character
16480 positions match), and we have no way of telling if
16481 that is the case. */
16482 && it.current.dpvec_index < 0)
16483 break;
16485 if (display_line (&it))
16486 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
16490 /* A value of current_y < last_visible_y means that we stopped
16491 at the previous window start, which in turn means that we
16492 have at least one reusable row. */
16493 if (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
16495 struct glyph_row *row;
16497 /* IT.vpos always starts from 0; it counts text lines. */
16498 nrows_scrolled = it.vpos - (start_row - MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix));
16500 /* Find PT if not already found in the lines displayed. */
16501 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16503 int dy = it.current_y - start_row->y;
16505 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16506 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, row, NULL, dy);
16507 if (row)
16508 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0,
16509 dy, nrows_scrolled);
16510 else
16512 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16513 return 0;
16517 /* Scroll the display. Do it before the current matrix is
16518 changed. The problem here is that update has not yet
16519 run, i.e. part of the current matrix is not up to date.
16520 scroll_run_hook will clear the cursor, and use the
16521 current matrix to get the height of the row the cursor is
16522 in. */
16523 run.current_y = start_row->y;
16524 run.desired_y = it.current_y;
16525 run.height = it.last_visible_y - it.current_y;
16527 if (run.height > 0 && run.current_y != run.desired_y)
16529 update_begin (f);
16530 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
16531 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
16532 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
16533 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
16534 update_end (f);
16537 /* Shift current matrix down by nrows_scrolled lines. */
16538 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
16539 rotate_matrix (w->current_matrix,
16540 start_vpos,
16541 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, w->current_matrix),
16542 nrows_scrolled);
16544 /* Disable lines that must be updated. */
16545 for (i = 0; i < nrows_scrolled; ++i)
16546 (start_row + i)->enabled_p = 0;
16548 /* Re-compute Y positions. */
16549 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16550 max_y = it.last_visible_y;
16551 for (row = start_row + nrows_scrolled;
16552 row < bottom_row;
16553 ++row)
16555 row->y = it.current_y;
16556 row->visible_height = row->height;
16558 if (row->y < min_y)
16559 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
16560 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
16561 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
16562 if (row->fringe_bitmap_periodic_p)
16563 row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
16565 it.current_y += row->height;
16567 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
16568 last_reused_text_row = row;
16569 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= it.last_visible_y)
16570 break;
16573 /* Disable lines in the current matrix which are now
16574 below the window. */
16575 for (++row; row < bottom_row; ++row)
16576 row->enabled_p = row->mode_line_p = 0;
16579 /* Update window_end_pos etc.; last_reused_text_row is the last
16580 reused row from the current matrix containing text, if any.
16581 The value of last_text_row is the last displayed line
16582 containing text. */
16583 if (last_reused_text_row)
16585 w->window_end_bytepos
16586 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_reused_text_row);
16587 wset_window_end_pos
16588 (w, make_number (Z
16589 - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_reused_text_row)));
16590 wset_window_end_vpos
16591 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_reused_text_row,
16592 w->current_matrix)));
16594 else if (last_text_row)
16596 w->window_end_bytepos
16597 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
16598 wset_window_end_pos
16599 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row)));
16600 wset_window_end_vpos
16601 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row,
16602 w->desired_matrix)));
16604 else
16606 /* This window must be completely empty. */
16607 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - ZV_BYTE;
16608 wset_window_end_pos (w, make_number (Z - ZV));
16609 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (0));
16611 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
16613 /* Update hint: don't try scrolling again in update_window. */
16614 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
16616 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
16617 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_reusing_current_matrix 1");
16618 #endif
16619 return 1;
16621 else if (CHARPOS (new_start) > CHARPOS (start))
16623 struct glyph_row *pt_row, *row;
16624 struct glyph_row *first_reusable_row;
16625 struct glyph_row *first_row_to_display;
16626 int dy;
16627 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
16629 /* Find the row starting at new_start, if there is one. Don't
16630 reuse a partially visible line at the end. */
16631 first_reusable_row = start_row;
16632 while (first_reusable_row->enabled_p
16633 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_reusable_row) < yb
16634 && (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_reusable_row)
16635 < CHARPOS (new_start)))
16636 ++first_reusable_row;
16638 /* Give up if there is no row to reuse. */
16639 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_reusable_row) >= yb
16640 || !first_reusable_row->enabled_p
16641 || (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_reusable_row)
16642 != CHARPOS (new_start)))
16643 return 0;
16645 /* We can reuse fully visible rows beginning with
16646 first_reusable_row to the end of the window. Set
16647 first_row_to_display to the first row that cannot be reused.
16648 Set pt_row to the row containing point, if there is any. */
16649 pt_row = NULL;
16650 for (first_row_to_display = first_reusable_row;
16651 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_row_to_display) < yb;
16652 ++first_row_to_display)
16654 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_row_to_display)
16655 && (PT < MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (first_row_to_display)
16656 || (PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (first_row_to_display)
16657 && first_row_to_display->ends_at_zv_p
16658 && pt_row == NULL)))
16659 pt_row = first_row_to_display;
16662 /* Start displaying at the start of first_row_to_display. */
16663 eassert (first_row_to_display->y < yb);
16664 init_to_row_start (&it, w, first_row_to_display);
16666 nrows_scrolled = (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_reusable_row, w->current_matrix)
16667 - start_vpos);
16668 it.vpos = (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_row_to_display, w->current_matrix)
16669 - nrows_scrolled);
16670 it.current_y = (first_row_to_display->y - first_reusable_row->y
16671 + WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w));
16673 /* Display lines beginning with first_row_to_display in the
16674 desired matrix. Set last_text_row to the last row displayed
16675 that displays text. */
16676 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, it.vpos);
16677 if (pt_row == NULL)
16678 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
16679 last_text_row = NULL;
16680 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y && !fonts_changed_p)
16681 if (display_line (&it))
16682 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
16684 /* If point is in a reused row, adjust y and vpos of the cursor
16685 position. */
16686 if (pt_row)
16688 w->cursor.vpos -= nrows_scrolled;
16689 w->cursor.y -= first_reusable_row->y - start_row->y;
16692 /* Give up if point isn't in a row displayed or reused. (This
16693 also handles the case where w->cursor.vpos < nrows_scrolled
16694 after the calls to display_line, which can happen with scroll
16695 margins. See bug#1295.) */
16696 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
16698 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
16699 return 0;
16702 /* Scroll the display. */
16703 run.current_y = first_reusable_row->y;
16704 run.desired_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16705 run.height = it.last_visible_y - run.current_y;
16706 dy = run.current_y - run.desired_y;
16708 if (run.height)
16710 update_begin (f);
16711 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
16712 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
16713 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
16714 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
16715 update_end (f);
16718 /* Adjust Y positions of reused rows. */
16719 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w);
16720 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
16721 max_y = it.last_visible_y;
16722 for (row = first_reusable_row; row < first_row_to_display; ++row)
16724 row->y -= dy;
16725 row->visible_height = row->height;
16726 if (row->y < min_y)
16727 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
16728 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
16729 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
16730 if (row->fringe_bitmap_periodic_p)
16731 row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
16734 /* Scroll the current matrix. */
16735 eassert (nrows_scrolled > 0);
16736 rotate_matrix (w->current_matrix,
16737 start_vpos,
16738 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, w->current_matrix),
16739 -nrows_scrolled);
16741 /* Disable rows not reused. */
16742 for (row -= nrows_scrolled; row < bottom_row; ++row)
16743 row->enabled_p = 0;
16745 /* Point may have moved to a different line, so we cannot assume that
16746 the previous cursor position is valid; locate the correct row. */
16747 if (pt_row)
16749 for (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->cursor.vpos);
16750 row < bottom_row
16751 && PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
16752 && !row->ends_at_zv_p;
16753 row++)
16755 w->cursor.vpos++;
16756 w->cursor.y = row->y;
16758 if (row < bottom_row)
16760 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + w->cursor.hpos;
16761 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
16763 /* Can't use this optimization with bidi-reordered glyph
16764 rows, unless cursor is already at point. */
16765 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering)))
16767 if (!(w->cursor.hpos >= 0
16768 && w->cursor.hpos < row->used[TEXT_AREA]
16769 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
16770 && glyph->charpos == PT))
16771 return 0;
16773 else
16774 for (; glyph < end
16775 && (!BUFFERP (glyph->object)
16776 || glyph->charpos < PT);
16777 glyph++)
16779 w->cursor.hpos++;
16780 w->cursor.x += glyph->pixel_width;
16785 /* Adjust window end. A null value of last_text_row means that
16786 the window end is in reused rows which in turn means that
16787 only its vpos can have changed. */
16788 if (last_text_row)
16790 w->window_end_bytepos
16791 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
16792 wset_window_end_pos
16793 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row)));
16794 wset_window_end_vpos
16795 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row,
16796 w->desired_matrix)));
16798 else
16800 wset_window_end_vpos
16801 (w, make_number (XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) - nrows_scrolled));
16804 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
16805 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
16807 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
16808 debug_method_add (w, "try_window_reusing_current_matrix 2");
16809 #endif
16810 return 1;
16813 return 0;
16818 /************************************************************************
16819 Window redisplay reusing current matrix when buffer has changed
16820 ************************************************************************/
16822 static struct glyph_row *find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (struct window *);
16823 static struct glyph_row *find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (struct window *,
16824 ptrdiff_t *, ptrdiff_t *);
16825 static struct glyph_row *
16826 find_last_row_displaying_text (struct glyph_matrix *, struct it *,
16827 struct glyph_row *);
16830 /* Return the last row in MATRIX displaying text. If row START is
16831 non-null, start searching with that row. IT gives the dimensions
16832 of the display. Value is null if matrix is empty; otherwise it is
16833 a pointer to the row found. */
16835 static struct glyph_row *
16836 find_last_row_displaying_text (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, struct it *it,
16837 struct glyph_row *start)
16839 struct glyph_row *row, *row_found;
16841 /* Set row_found to the last row in IT->w's current matrix
16842 displaying text. The loop looks funny but think of partially
16843 visible lines. */
16844 row_found = NULL;
16845 row = start ? start : MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (matrix);
16846 while (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
16848 eassert (row->enabled_p);
16849 row_found = row;
16850 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= it->last_visible_y)
16851 break;
16852 ++row;
16855 return row_found;
16859 /* Return the last row in the current matrix of W that is not affected
16860 by changes at the start of current_buffer that occurred since W's
16861 current matrix was built. Value is null if no such row exists.
16863 BEG_UNCHANGED us the number of characters unchanged at the start of
16864 current_buffer. BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED is the buffer position of the
16865 first changed character in current_buffer. Characters at positions <
16866 BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED are at the same buffer positions as they were
16867 when the current matrix was built. */
16869 static struct glyph_row *
16870 find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (struct window *w)
16872 ptrdiff_t first_changed_pos = BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED;
16873 struct glyph_row *row;
16874 struct glyph_row *row_found = NULL;
16875 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
16877 /* Find the last row displaying unchanged text. */
16878 for (row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16879 MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
16880 && MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) < first_changed_pos;
16881 ++row)
16883 if (/* If row ends before first_changed_pos, it is unchanged,
16884 except in some case. */
16885 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) <= first_changed_pos
16886 /* When row ends in ZV and we write at ZV it is not
16887 unchanged. */
16888 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
16889 /* When first_changed_pos is the end of a continued line,
16890 row is not unchanged because it may be no longer
16891 continued. */
16892 && !(MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == first_changed_pos
16893 && (row->continued_p
16894 || row->exact_window_width_line_p))
16895 /* If ROW->end is beyond ZV, then ROW->end is outdated and
16896 needs to be recomputed, so don't consider this row as
16897 unchanged. This happens when the last line was
16898 bidi-reordered and was killed immediately before this
16899 redisplay cycle. In that case, ROW->end stores the
16900 buffer position of the first visual-order character of
16901 the killed text, which is now beyond ZV. */
16902 && CHARPOS (row->end.pos) <= ZV)
16903 row_found = row;
16905 /* Stop if last visible row. */
16906 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= yb)
16907 break;
16910 return row_found;
16914 /* Find the first glyph row in the current matrix of W that is not
16915 affected by changes at the end of current_buffer since the
16916 time W's current matrix was built.
16918 Return in *DELTA the number of chars by which buffer positions in
16919 unchanged text at the end of current_buffer must be adjusted.
16921 Return in *DELTA_BYTES the corresponding number of bytes.
16923 Value is null if no such row exists, i.e. all rows are affected by
16924 changes. */
16926 static struct glyph_row *
16927 find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (struct window *w,
16928 ptrdiff_t *delta, ptrdiff_t *delta_bytes)
16930 struct glyph_row *row;
16931 struct glyph_row *row_found = NULL;
16933 *delta = *delta_bytes = 0;
16935 /* Display must not have been paused, otherwise the current matrix
16936 is not up to date. */
16937 eassert (!NILP (w->window_end_valid));
16939 /* A value of window_end_pos >= END_UNCHANGED means that the window
16940 end is in the range of changed text. If so, there is no
16941 unchanged row at the end of W's current matrix. */
16942 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) >= END_UNCHANGED)
16943 return NULL;
16945 /* Set row to the last row in W's current matrix displaying text. */
16946 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
16948 /* If matrix is entirely empty, no unchanged row exists. */
16949 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
16951 /* The value of row is the last glyph row in the matrix having a
16952 meaningful buffer position in it. The end position of row
16953 corresponds to window_end_pos. This allows us to translate
16954 buffer positions in the current matrix to current buffer
16955 positions for characters not in changed text. */
16956 ptrdiff_t Z_old =
16957 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
16958 ptrdiff_t Z_BYTE_old =
16959 MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + w->window_end_bytepos;
16960 ptrdiff_t last_unchanged_pos, last_unchanged_pos_old;
16961 struct glyph_row *first_text_row
16962 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
16964 *delta = Z - Z_old;
16965 *delta_bytes = Z_BYTE - Z_BYTE_old;
16967 /* Set last_unchanged_pos to the buffer position of the last
16968 character in the buffer that has not been changed. Z is the
16969 index + 1 of the last character in current_buffer, i.e. by
16970 subtracting END_UNCHANGED we get the index of the last
16971 unchanged character, and we have to add BEG to get its buffer
16972 position. */
16973 last_unchanged_pos = Z - END_UNCHANGED + BEG;
16974 last_unchanged_pos_old = last_unchanged_pos - *delta;
16976 /* Search backward from ROW for a row displaying a line that
16977 starts at a minimum position >= last_unchanged_pos_old. */
16978 for (; row > first_text_row; --row)
16980 /* This used to abort, but it can happen.
16981 It is ok to just stop the search instead here. KFS. */
16982 if (!row->enabled_p || !MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row))
16983 break;
16985 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) >= last_unchanged_pos_old)
16986 row_found = row;
16990 eassert (!row_found || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row_found));
16992 return row_found;
16996 /* Make sure that glyph rows in the current matrix of window W
16997 reference the same glyph memory as corresponding rows in the
16998 frame's frame matrix. This function is called after scrolling W's
16999 current matrix on a terminal frame in try_window_id and
17000 try_window_reusing_current_matrix. */
17002 static void
17003 sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (struct window *w)
17005 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
17006 struct glyph_row *window_row, *window_row_end, *frame_row;
17008 /* Preconditions: W must be a leaf window and full-width. Its frame
17009 must have a frame matrix. */
17010 eassert (NILP (w->hchild) && NILP (w->vchild));
17011 eassert (WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w));
17012 eassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f));
17014 /* If W is a full-width window, glyph pointers in W's current matrix
17015 have, by definition, to be the same as glyph pointers in the
17016 corresponding frame matrix. Note that frame matrices have no
17017 marginal areas (see build_frame_matrix). */
17018 window_row = w->current_matrix->rows;
17019 window_row_end = window_row + w->current_matrix->nrows;
17020 frame_row = f->current_matrix->rows + WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w);
17021 while (window_row < window_row_end)
17023 struct glyph *start = window_row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA];
17024 struct glyph *end = window_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA];
17026 frame_row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] = start;
17027 frame_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] = start;
17028 frame_row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] = end;
17029 frame_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] = end;
17031 /* Disable frame rows whose corresponding window rows have
17032 been disabled in try_window_id. */
17033 if (!window_row->enabled_p)
17034 frame_row->enabled_p = 0;
17036 ++window_row, ++frame_row;
17041 /* Find the glyph row in window W containing CHARPOS. Consider all
17042 rows between START and END (not inclusive). END null means search
17043 all rows to the end of the display area of W. Value is the row
17044 containing CHARPOS or null. */
17046 struct glyph_row *
17047 row_containing_pos (struct window *w, ptrdiff_t charpos,
17048 struct glyph_row *start, struct glyph_row *end, int dy)
17050 struct glyph_row *row = start;
17051 struct glyph_row *best_row = NULL;
17052 ptrdiff_t mindif = BUF_ZV (XBUFFER (w->buffer)) + 1;
17053 int last_y;
17055 /* If we happen to start on a header-line, skip that. */
17056 if (row->mode_line_p)
17057 ++row;
17059 if ((end && row >= end) || !row->enabled_p)
17060 return NULL;
17062 last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w) - dy;
17064 while (1)
17066 /* Give up if we have gone too far. */
17067 if (end && row >= end)
17068 return NULL;
17069 /* This formerly returned if they were equal.
17070 I think that both quantities are of a "last plus one" type;
17071 if so, when they are equal, the row is within the screen. -- rms. */
17072 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y)
17073 return NULL;
17075 /* If it is in this row, return this row. */
17076 if (! (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) < charpos
17077 || (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) == charpos
17078 /* The end position of a row equals the start
17079 position of the next row. If CHARPOS is there, we
17080 would rather display it in the next line, except
17081 when this line ends in ZV. */
17082 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
17083 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)))
17084 && charpos >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
17086 struct glyph *g;
17088 if (NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
17089 || (!best_row && !row->continued_p))
17090 return row;
17091 /* In bidi-reordered rows, there could be several rows
17092 occluding point, all of them belonging to the same
17093 continued line. We need to find the row which fits
17094 CHARPOS the best. */
17095 for (g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
17096 g < row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
17097 g++)
17099 if (!STRINGP (g->object))
17101 if (g->charpos > 0 && eabs (g->charpos - charpos) < mindif)
17103 mindif = eabs (g->charpos - charpos);
17104 best_row = row;
17105 /* Exact match always wins. */
17106 if (mindif == 0)
17107 return best_row;
17112 else if (best_row && !row->continued_p)
17113 return best_row;
17114 ++row;
17119 /* Try to redisplay window W by reusing its existing display. W's
17120 current matrix must be up to date when this function is called,
17121 i.e. window_end_valid must not be nil.
17123 Value is
17125 1 if display has been updated
17126 0 if otherwise unsuccessful
17127 -1 if redisplay with same window start is known not to succeed
17129 The following steps are performed:
17131 1. Find the last row in the current matrix of W that is not
17132 affected by changes at the start of current_buffer. If no such row
17133 is found, give up.
17135 2. Find the first row in W's current matrix that is not affected by
17136 changes at the end of current_buffer. Maybe there is no such row.
17138 3. Display lines beginning with the row + 1 found in step 1 to the
17139 row found in step 2 or, if step 2 didn't find a row, to the end of
17140 the window.
17142 4. If cursor is not known to appear on the window, give up.
17144 5. If display stopped at the row found in step 2, scroll the
17145 display and current matrix as needed.
17147 6. Maybe display some lines at the end of W, if we must. This can
17148 happen under various circumstances, like a partially visible line
17149 becoming fully visible, or because newly displayed lines are displayed
17150 in smaller font sizes.
17152 7. Update W's window end information. */
17154 static int
17155 try_window_id (struct window *w)
17157 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
17158 struct glyph_matrix *current_matrix = w->current_matrix;
17159 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = w->desired_matrix;
17160 struct glyph_row *last_unchanged_at_beg_row;
17161 struct glyph_row *first_unchanged_at_end_row;
17162 struct glyph_row *row;
17163 struct glyph_row *bottom_row;
17164 int bottom_vpos;
17165 struct it it;
17166 ptrdiff_t delta = 0, delta_bytes = 0, stop_pos;
17167 int dvpos, dy;
17168 struct text_pos start_pos;
17169 struct run run;
17170 int first_unchanged_at_end_vpos = 0;
17171 struct glyph_row *last_text_row, *last_text_row_at_end;
17172 struct text_pos start;
17173 ptrdiff_t first_changed_charpos, last_changed_charpos;
17175 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
17176 if (inhibit_try_window_id)
17177 return 0;
17178 #endif
17180 /* This is handy for debugging. */
17181 #if 0
17182 #define GIVE_UP(X) \
17183 do { \
17184 fprintf (stderr, "try_window_id give up %d\n", (X)); \
17185 return 0; \
17186 } while (0)
17187 #else
17188 #define GIVE_UP(X) return 0
17189 #endif
17191 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (start, w->start);
17193 /* Don't use this for mini-windows because these can show
17194 messages and mini-buffers, and we don't handle that here. */
17195 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w))
17196 GIVE_UP (1);
17198 /* This flag is used to prevent redisplay optimizations. */
17199 if (windows_or_buffers_changed || cursor_type_changed)
17200 GIVE_UP (2);
17202 /* Verify that narrowing has not changed.
17203 Also verify that we were not told to prevent redisplay optimizations.
17204 It would be nice to further
17205 reduce the number of cases where this prevents try_window_id. */
17206 if (current_buffer->clip_changed
17207 || current_buffer->prevent_redisplay_optimizations_p)
17208 GIVE_UP (3);
17210 /* Window must either use window-based redisplay or be full width. */
17211 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
17212 && (!FRAME_LINE_INS_DEL_OK (f)
17213 || !WINDOW_FULL_WIDTH_P (w)))
17214 GIVE_UP (4);
17216 /* Give up if point is known NOT to appear in W. */
17217 if (PT < CHARPOS (start))
17218 GIVE_UP (5);
17220 /* Another way to prevent redisplay optimizations. */
17221 if (w->last_modified == 0)
17222 GIVE_UP (6);
17224 /* Verify that window is not hscrolled. */
17225 if (w->hscroll != 0)
17226 GIVE_UP (7);
17228 /* Verify that display wasn't paused. */
17229 if (NILP (w->window_end_valid))
17230 GIVE_UP (8);
17232 /* Can't use this if highlighting a region because a cursor movement
17233 will do more than just set the cursor. */
17234 if (!NILP (Vtransient_mark_mode)
17235 && !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, mark_active)))
17236 GIVE_UP (9);
17238 /* Likewise if highlighting trailing whitespace. */
17239 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
17240 GIVE_UP (11);
17242 /* Likewise if showing a region. */
17243 if (!NILP (w->region_showing))
17244 GIVE_UP (10);
17246 /* Can't use this if overlay arrow position and/or string have
17247 changed. */
17248 if (overlay_arrows_changed_p ())
17249 GIVE_UP (12);
17251 /* When word-wrap is on, adding a space to the first word of a
17252 wrapped line can change the wrap position, altering the line
17253 above it. It might be worthwhile to handle this more
17254 intelligently, but for now just redisplay from scratch. */
17255 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), word_wrap)))
17256 GIVE_UP (21);
17258 /* Under bidi reordering, adding or deleting a character in the
17259 beginning of a paragraph, before the first strong directional
17260 character, can change the base direction of the paragraph (unless
17261 the buffer specifies a fixed paragraph direction), which will
17262 require to redisplay the whole paragraph. It might be worthwhile
17263 to find the paragraph limits and widen the range of redisplayed
17264 lines to that, but for now just give up this optimization and
17265 redisplay from scratch. */
17266 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
17267 && NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (w->buffer), bidi_paragraph_direction)))
17268 GIVE_UP (22);
17270 /* Make sure beg_unchanged and end_unchanged are up to date. Do it
17271 only if buffer has really changed. The reason is that the gap is
17272 initially at Z for freshly visited files. The code below would
17273 set end_unchanged to 0 in that case. */
17274 if (MODIFF > SAVE_MODIFF
17275 /* This seems to happen sometimes after saving a buffer. */
17276 || BEG_UNCHANGED + END_UNCHANGED > Z_BYTE)
17278 if (GPT - BEG < BEG_UNCHANGED)
17279 BEG_UNCHANGED = GPT - BEG;
17280 if (Z - GPT < END_UNCHANGED)
17281 END_UNCHANGED = Z - GPT;
17284 /* The position of the first and last character that has been changed. */
17285 first_changed_charpos = BEG + BEG_UNCHANGED;
17286 last_changed_charpos = Z - END_UNCHANGED;
17288 /* If window starts after a line end, and the last change is in
17289 front of that newline, then changes don't affect the display.
17290 This case happens with stealth-fontification. Note that although
17291 the display is unchanged, glyph positions in the matrix have to
17292 be adjusted, of course. */
17293 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
17294 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)
17295 && ((last_changed_charpos < CHARPOS (start)
17296 && CHARPOS (start) == BEGV)
17297 || (last_changed_charpos < CHARPOS (start) - 1
17298 && FETCH_BYTE (BYTEPOS (start) - 1) == '\n')))
17300 ptrdiff_t Z_old, Z_delta, Z_BYTE_old, Z_delta_bytes;
17301 struct glyph_row *r0;
17303 /* Compute how many chars/bytes have been added to or removed
17304 from the buffer. */
17305 Z_old = MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
17306 Z_BYTE_old = MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) + w->window_end_bytepos;
17307 Z_delta = Z - Z_old;
17308 Z_delta_bytes = Z_BYTE - Z_BYTE_old;
17310 /* Give up if PT is not in the window. Note that it already has
17311 been checked at the start of try_window_id that PT is not in
17312 front of the window start. */
17313 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) + Z_delta)
17314 GIVE_UP (13);
17316 /* If window start is unchanged, we can reuse the whole matrix
17317 as is, after adjusting glyph positions. No need to compute
17318 the window end again, since its offset from Z hasn't changed. */
17319 r0 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
17320 if (CHARPOS (start) == MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r0) + Z_delta
17321 && BYTEPOS (start) == MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (r0) + Z_delta_bytes
17322 /* PT must not be in a partially visible line. */
17323 && !(PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) + Z_delta
17324 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > window_text_bottom_y (w)))
17326 /* Adjust positions in the glyph matrix. */
17327 if (Z_delta || Z_delta_bytes)
17329 struct glyph_row *r1
17330 = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix, w);
17331 increment_matrix_positions (w->current_matrix,
17332 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r0, current_matrix),
17333 MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r1, current_matrix),
17334 Z_delta, Z_delta_bytes);
17337 /* Set the cursor. */
17338 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, r0, NULL, 0);
17339 if (row)
17340 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
17341 else
17342 abort ();
17343 return 1;
17347 /* Handle the case that changes are all below what is displayed in
17348 the window, and that PT is in the window. This shortcut cannot
17349 be taken if ZV is visible in the window, and text has been added
17350 there that is visible in the window. */
17351 if (first_changed_charpos >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
17352 /* ZV is not visible in the window, or there are no
17353 changes at ZV, actually. */
17354 && (current_matrix->zv > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
17355 || first_changed_charpos == last_changed_charpos))
17357 struct glyph_row *r0;
17359 /* Give up if PT is not in the window. Note that it already has
17360 been checked at the start of try_window_id that PT is not in
17361 front of the window start. */
17362 if (PT >= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
17363 GIVE_UP (14);
17365 /* If window start is unchanged, we can reuse the whole matrix
17366 as is, without changing glyph positions since no text has
17367 been added/removed in front of the window end. */
17368 r0 = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
17369 if (TEXT_POS_EQUAL_P (start, r0->minpos)
17370 /* PT must not be in a partially visible line. */
17371 && !(PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
17372 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > window_text_bottom_y (w)))
17374 /* We have to compute the window end anew since text
17375 could have been added/removed after it. */
17376 wset_window_end_pos
17377 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)));
17378 w->window_end_bytepos
17379 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
17381 /* Set the cursor. */
17382 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT, r0, NULL, 0);
17383 if (row)
17384 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
17385 else
17386 abort ();
17387 return 2;
17391 /* Give up if window start is in the changed area.
17393 The condition used to read
17395 (BEG_UNCHANGED + END_UNCHANGED != Z - BEG && ...)
17397 but why that was tested escapes me at the moment. */
17398 if (CHARPOS (start) >= first_changed_charpos
17399 && CHARPOS (start) <= last_changed_charpos)
17400 GIVE_UP (15);
17402 /* Check that window start agrees with the start of the first glyph
17403 row in its current matrix. Check this after we know the window
17404 start is not in changed text, otherwise positions would not be
17405 comparable. */
17406 row = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix);
17407 if (!TEXT_POS_EQUAL_P (start, row->minpos))
17408 GIVE_UP (16);
17410 /* Give up if the window ends in strings. Overlay strings
17411 at the end are difficult to handle, so don't try. */
17412 row = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
17413 if (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
17414 GIVE_UP (20);
17416 /* Compute the position at which we have to start displaying new
17417 lines. Some of the lines at the top of the window might be
17418 reusable because they are not displaying changed text. Find the
17419 last row in W's current matrix not affected by changes at the
17420 start of current_buffer. Value is null if changes start in the
17421 first line of window. */
17422 last_unchanged_at_beg_row = find_last_unchanged_at_beg_row (w);
17423 if (last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
17425 /* Avoid starting to display in the middle of a character, a TAB
17426 for instance. This is easier than to set up the iterator
17427 exactly, and it's not a frequent case, so the additional
17428 effort wouldn't really pay off. */
17429 while ((MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
17430 || last_unchanged_at_beg_row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
17431 && last_unchanged_at_beg_row > w->current_matrix->rows)
17432 --last_unchanged_at_beg_row;
17434 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (last_unchanged_at_beg_row))
17435 GIVE_UP (17);
17437 if (init_to_row_end (&it, w, last_unchanged_at_beg_row) == 0)
17438 GIVE_UP (18);
17439 start_pos = it.current.pos;
17441 /* Start displaying new lines in the desired matrix at the same
17442 vpos we would use in the current matrix, i.e. below
17443 last_unchanged_at_beg_row. */
17444 it.vpos = 1 + MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_unchanged_at_beg_row,
17445 current_matrix);
17446 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, it.vpos);
17447 it.current_y = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_unchanged_at_beg_row);
17449 eassert (it.hpos == 0 && it.current_x == 0);
17451 else
17453 /* There are no reusable lines at the start of the window.
17454 Start displaying in the first text line. */
17455 start_display (&it, w, start);
17456 it.vpos = it.first_vpos;
17457 start_pos = it.current.pos;
17460 /* Find the first row that is not affected by changes at the end of
17461 the buffer. Value will be null if there is no unchanged row, in
17462 which case we must redisplay to the end of the window. delta
17463 will be set to the value by which buffer positions beginning with
17464 first_unchanged_at_end_row have to be adjusted due to text
17465 changes. */
17466 first_unchanged_at_end_row
17467 = find_first_unchanged_at_end_row (w, &delta, &delta_bytes);
17468 IF_DEBUG (debug_delta = delta);
17469 IF_DEBUG (debug_delta_bytes = delta_bytes);
17471 /* Set stop_pos to the buffer position up to which we will have to
17472 display new lines. If first_unchanged_at_end_row != NULL, this
17473 is the buffer position of the start of the line displayed in that
17474 row. For first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL, use 0 to indicate
17475 that we don't stop at a buffer position. */
17476 stop_pos = 0;
17477 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17479 eassert (last_unchanged_at_beg_row == NULL
17480 || first_unchanged_at_end_row >= last_unchanged_at_beg_row);
17482 /* If this is a continuation line, move forward to the next one
17483 that isn't. Changes in lines above affect this line.
17484 Caution: this may move first_unchanged_at_end_row to a row
17485 not displaying text. */
17486 while (MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17487 && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17488 && (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17489 < it.last_visible_y))
17490 ++first_unchanged_at_end_row;
17492 if (!MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17493 || (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17494 >= it.last_visible_y))
17495 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17496 else
17498 stop_pos = (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17499 + delta);
17500 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos
17501 = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row, current_matrix);
17502 eassert (stop_pos >= Z - END_UNCHANGED);
17505 else if (last_unchanged_at_beg_row == NULL)
17506 GIVE_UP (19);
17509 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
17511 /* Either there is no unchanged row at the end, or the one we have
17512 now displays text. This is a necessary condition for the window
17513 end pos calculation at the end of this function. */
17514 eassert (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17515 || MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row));
17517 debug_last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos
17518 = (last_unchanged_at_beg_row
17519 ? MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_unchanged_at_beg_row, current_matrix)
17520 : -1);
17521 debug_first_unchanged_at_end_vpos = first_unchanged_at_end_vpos;
17523 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
17526 /* Display new lines. Set last_text_row to the last new line
17527 displayed which has text on it, i.e. might end up as being the
17528 line where the window_end_vpos is. */
17529 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
17530 last_text_row = NULL;
17531 overlay_arrow_seen = 0;
17532 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y
17533 && !fonts_changed_p
17534 && (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17535 || IT_CHARPOS (it) < stop_pos))
17537 if (display_line (&it))
17538 last_text_row = it.glyph_row - 1;
17541 if (fonts_changed_p)
17542 return -1;
17545 /* Compute differences in buffer positions, y-positions etc. for
17546 lines reused at the bottom of the window. Compute what we can
17547 scroll. */
17548 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row
17549 /* No lines reused because we displayed everything up to the
17550 bottom of the window. */
17551 && it.current_y < it.last_visible_y)
17553 dvpos = (it.vpos
17554 - MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row,
17555 current_matrix));
17556 dy = it.current_y - first_unchanged_at_end_row->y;
17557 run.current_y = first_unchanged_at_end_row->y;
17558 run.desired_y = run.current_y + dy;
17559 run.height = it.last_visible_y - max (run.current_y, run.desired_y);
17561 else
17563 delta = delta_bytes = dvpos = dy
17564 = run.current_y = run.desired_y = run.height = 0;
17565 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17567 IF_DEBUG (debug_dvpos = dvpos; debug_dy = dy);
17570 /* Find the cursor if not already found. We have to decide whether
17571 PT will appear on this window (it sometimes doesn't, but this is
17572 not a very frequent case.) This decision has to be made before
17573 the current matrix is altered. A value of cursor.vpos < 0 means
17574 that PT is either in one of the lines beginning at
17575 first_unchanged_at_end_row or below the window. Don't care for
17576 lines that might be displayed later at the window end; as
17577 mentioned, this is not a frequent case. */
17578 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
17580 /* Cursor in unchanged rows at the top? */
17581 if (PT < CHARPOS (start_pos)
17582 && last_unchanged_at_beg_row)
17584 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT,
17585 MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix),
17586 last_unchanged_at_beg_row + 1, 0);
17587 if (row)
17588 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
17591 /* Start from first_unchanged_at_end_row looking for PT. */
17592 else if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17594 row = row_containing_pos (w, PT - delta,
17595 first_unchanged_at_end_row, NULL, 0);
17596 if (row)
17597 set_cursor_from_row (w, row, w->current_matrix, delta,
17598 delta_bytes, dy, dvpos);
17601 /* Give up if cursor was not found. */
17602 if (w->cursor.vpos < 0)
17604 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
17605 return -1;
17609 /* Don't let the cursor end in the scroll margins. */
17611 int this_scroll_margin, cursor_height;
17613 this_scroll_margin =
17614 max (0, min (scroll_margin, WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w) / 4));
17615 this_scroll_margin *= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it.f);
17616 cursor_height = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, w->cursor.vpos)->height;
17618 if ((w->cursor.y < this_scroll_margin
17619 && CHARPOS (start) > BEGV)
17620 /* Old redisplay didn't take scroll margin into account at the bottom,
17621 but then global-hl-line-mode doesn't scroll. KFS 2004-06-14 */
17622 || (w->cursor.y + (make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p
17623 ? cursor_height + this_scroll_margin
17624 : 1)) > it.last_visible_y)
17626 w->cursor.vpos = -1;
17627 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
17628 return -1;
17632 /* Scroll the display. Do it before changing the current matrix so
17633 that xterm.c doesn't get confused about where the cursor glyph is
17634 found. */
17635 if (dy && run.height)
17637 update_begin (f);
17639 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
17641 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_begin_hook (w);
17642 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_window_mouse_face (w);
17643 FRAME_RIF (f)->scroll_run_hook (w, &run);
17644 FRAME_RIF (f)->update_window_end_hook (w, 0, 0);
17646 else
17648 /* Terminal frame. In this case, dvpos gives the number of
17649 lines to scroll by; dvpos < 0 means scroll up. */
17650 int from_vpos
17651 = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (first_unchanged_at_end_row, w->current_matrix);
17652 int from = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w) + from_vpos;
17653 int end = (WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w)
17654 + (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0)
17655 + window_internal_height (w));
17657 #if defined (HAVE_GPM) || defined (MSDOS)
17658 x_clear_window_mouse_face (w);
17659 #endif
17660 /* Perform the operation on the screen. */
17661 if (dvpos > 0)
17663 /* Scroll last_unchanged_at_beg_row to the end of the
17664 window down dvpos lines. */
17665 set_terminal_window (f, end);
17667 /* On dumb terminals delete dvpos lines at the end
17668 before inserting dvpos empty lines. */
17669 if (!FRAME_SCROLL_REGION_OK (f))
17670 ins_del_lines (f, end - dvpos, -dvpos);
17672 /* Insert dvpos empty lines in front of
17673 last_unchanged_at_beg_row. */
17674 ins_del_lines (f, from, dvpos);
17676 else if (dvpos < 0)
17678 /* Scroll up last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos to the end of
17679 the window to last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos - |dvpos|. */
17680 set_terminal_window (f, end);
17682 /* Delete dvpos lines in front of
17683 last_unchanged_at_beg_vpos. ins_del_lines will set
17684 the cursor to the given vpos and emit |dvpos| delete
17685 line sequences. */
17686 ins_del_lines (f, from + dvpos, dvpos);
17688 /* On a dumb terminal insert dvpos empty lines at the
17689 end. */
17690 if (!FRAME_SCROLL_REGION_OK (f))
17691 ins_del_lines (f, end + dvpos, -dvpos);
17694 set_terminal_window (f, 0);
17697 update_end (f);
17700 /* Shift reused rows of the current matrix to the right position.
17701 BOTTOM_ROW is the last + 1 row in the current matrix reserved for
17702 text. */
17703 bottom_row = MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (current_matrix, w);
17704 bottom_vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (bottom_row, current_matrix);
17705 if (dvpos < 0)
17707 rotate_matrix (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17708 bottom_vpos, dvpos);
17709 enable_glyph_matrix_rows (current_matrix, bottom_vpos + dvpos,
17710 bottom_vpos, 0);
17712 else if (dvpos > 0)
17714 rotate_matrix (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos,
17715 bottom_vpos, dvpos);
17716 enable_glyph_matrix_rows (current_matrix, first_unchanged_at_end_vpos,
17717 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos, 0);
17720 /* For frame-based redisplay, make sure that current frame and window
17721 matrix are in sync with respect to glyph memory. */
17722 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
17723 sync_frame_with_window_matrix_rows (w);
17725 /* Adjust buffer positions in reused rows. */
17726 if (delta || delta_bytes)
17727 increment_matrix_positions (current_matrix,
17728 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17729 bottom_vpos, delta, delta_bytes);
17731 /* Adjust Y positions. */
17732 if (dy)
17733 shift_glyph_matrix (w, current_matrix,
17734 first_unchanged_at_end_vpos + dvpos,
17735 bottom_vpos, dy);
17737 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row)
17739 first_unchanged_at_end_row += dvpos;
17740 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row->y >= it.last_visible_y
17741 || !MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (first_unchanged_at_end_row))
17742 first_unchanged_at_end_row = NULL;
17745 /* If scrolling up, there may be some lines to display at the end of
17746 the window. */
17747 last_text_row_at_end = NULL;
17748 if (dy < 0)
17750 /* Scrolling up can leave for example a partially visible line
17751 at the end of the window to be redisplayed. */
17752 /* Set last_row to the glyph row in the current matrix where the
17753 window end line is found. It has been moved up or down in
17754 the matrix by dvpos. */
17755 int last_vpos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) + dvpos;
17756 struct glyph_row *last_row = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, last_vpos);
17758 /* If last_row is the window end line, it should display text. */
17759 eassert (last_row->displays_text_p);
17761 /* If window end line was partially visible before, begin
17762 displaying at that line. Otherwise begin displaying with the
17763 line following it. */
17764 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_row) - dy >= it.last_visible_y)
17766 init_to_row_start (&it, w, last_row);
17767 it.vpos = last_vpos;
17768 it.current_y = last_row->y;
17770 else
17772 init_to_row_end (&it, w, last_row);
17773 it.vpos = 1 + last_vpos;
17774 it.current_y = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (last_row);
17775 ++last_row;
17778 /* We may start in a continuation line. If so, we have to
17779 get the right continuation_lines_width and current_x. */
17780 it.continuation_lines_width = last_row->continuation_lines_width;
17781 it.hpos = it.current_x = 0;
17783 /* Display the rest of the lines at the window end. */
17784 it.glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, it.vpos);
17785 while (it.current_y < it.last_visible_y
17786 && !fonts_changed_p)
17788 /* Is it always sure that the display agrees with lines in
17789 the current matrix? I don't think so, so we mark rows
17790 displayed invalid in the current matrix by setting their
17791 enabled_p flag to zero. */
17792 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, it.vpos)->enabled_p = 0;
17793 if (display_line (&it))
17794 last_text_row_at_end = it.glyph_row - 1;
17798 /* Update window_end_pos and window_end_vpos. */
17799 if (first_unchanged_at_end_row
17800 && !last_text_row_at_end)
17802 /* Window end line if one of the preserved rows from the current
17803 matrix. Set row to the last row displaying text in current
17804 matrix starting at first_unchanged_at_end_row, after
17805 scrolling. */
17806 eassert (first_unchanged_at_end_row->displays_text_p);
17807 row = find_last_row_displaying_text (w->current_matrix, &it,
17808 first_unchanged_at_end_row);
17809 eassert (row && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row));
17811 wset_window_end_pos (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)));
17812 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
17813 wset_window_end_vpos
17814 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, w->current_matrix)));
17815 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17816 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "A"));
17818 else if (last_text_row_at_end)
17820 wset_window_end_pos
17821 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row_at_end)));
17822 w->window_end_bytepos
17823 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row_at_end);
17824 wset_window_end_vpos
17825 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row_at_end,
17826 desired_matrix)));
17827 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17828 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "B"));
17830 else if (last_text_row)
17832 /* We have displayed either to the end of the window or at the
17833 end of the window, i.e. the last row with text is to be found
17834 in the desired matrix. */
17835 wset_window_end_pos
17836 (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (last_text_row)));
17837 w->window_end_bytepos
17838 = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (last_text_row);
17839 wset_window_end_vpos
17840 (w, make_number (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_text_row, desired_matrix)));
17841 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17843 else if (first_unchanged_at_end_row == NULL
17844 && last_text_row == NULL
17845 && last_text_row_at_end == NULL)
17847 /* Displayed to end of window, but no line containing text was
17848 displayed. Lines were deleted at the end of the window. */
17849 int first_vpos = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w) ? 1 : 0;
17850 int vpos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos);
17851 struct glyph_row *current_row = current_matrix->rows + vpos;
17852 struct glyph_row *desired_row = desired_matrix->rows + vpos;
17854 for (row = NULL;
17855 row == NULL && vpos >= first_vpos;
17856 --vpos, --current_row, --desired_row)
17858 if (desired_row->enabled_p)
17860 if (desired_row->displays_text_p)
17861 row = desired_row;
17863 else if (current_row->displays_text_p)
17864 row = current_row;
17867 eassert (row != NULL);
17868 wset_window_end_vpos (w, make_number (vpos + 1));
17869 wset_window_end_pos (w, make_number (Z - MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)));
17870 w->window_end_bytepos = Z_BYTE - MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row);
17871 eassert (w->window_end_bytepos >= 0);
17872 IF_DEBUG (debug_method_add (w, "C"));
17874 else
17875 abort ();
17877 IF_DEBUG (debug_end_pos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
17878 debug_end_vpos = XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
17880 /* Record that display has not been completed. */
17881 wset_window_end_valid (w, Qnil);
17882 w->desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p = 1;
17883 return 3;
17885 #undef GIVE_UP
17890 /***********************************************************************
17891 More debugging support
17892 ***********************************************************************/
17894 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
17896 void dump_glyph_row (struct glyph_row *, int, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
17897 void dump_glyph_matrix (struct glyph_matrix *, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
17898 void dump_glyph (struct glyph_row *, struct glyph *, int) EXTERNALLY_VISIBLE;
17901 /* Dump the contents of glyph matrix MATRIX on stderr.
17903 GLYPHS 0 means don't show glyph contents.
17904 GLYPHS 1 means show glyphs in short form
17905 GLYPHS > 1 means show glyphs in long form. */
17907 void
17908 dump_glyph_matrix (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, int glyphs)
17910 int i;
17911 for (i = 0; i < matrix->nrows; ++i)
17912 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, i), i, glyphs);
17916 /* Dump contents of glyph GLYPH to stderr. ROW and AREA are
17917 the glyph row and area where the glyph comes from. */
17919 void
17920 dump_glyph (struct glyph_row *row, struct glyph *glyph, int area)
17922 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
17924 fprintf (stderr,
17925 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
17926 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
17927 'C',
17928 glyph->charpos,
17929 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
17930 ? 'B'
17931 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
17932 ? 'S'
17933 : '-')),
17934 glyph->pixel_width,
17935 glyph->u.ch,
17936 (glyph->u.ch < 0x80 && glyph->u.ch >= ' '
17937 ? glyph->u.ch
17938 : '.'),
17939 glyph->face_id,
17940 glyph->left_box_line_p,
17941 glyph->right_box_line_p);
17943 else if (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
17945 fprintf (stderr,
17946 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
17947 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
17948 'S',
17949 glyph->charpos,
17950 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
17951 ? 'B'
17952 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
17953 ? 'S'
17954 : '-')),
17955 glyph->pixel_width,
17957 '.',
17958 glyph->face_id,
17959 glyph->left_box_line_p,
17960 glyph->right_box_line_p);
17962 else if (glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
17964 fprintf (stderr,
17965 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x %c %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
17966 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
17967 'I',
17968 glyph->charpos,
17969 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
17970 ? 'B'
17971 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
17972 ? 'S'
17973 : '-')),
17974 glyph->pixel_width,
17975 glyph->u.img_id,
17976 '.',
17977 glyph->face_id,
17978 glyph->left_box_line_p,
17979 glyph->right_box_line_p);
17981 else if (glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH)
17983 fprintf (stderr,
17984 " %5td %4c %6"pI"d %c %3d 0x%05x",
17985 glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA],
17986 '+',
17987 glyph->charpos,
17988 (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
17989 ? 'B'
17990 : (STRINGP (glyph->object)
17991 ? 'S'
17992 : '-')),
17993 glyph->pixel_width,
17994 glyph->u.cmp.id);
17995 if (glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
17996 fprintf (stderr,
17997 "[%d-%d]",
17998 glyph->slice.cmp.from, glyph->slice.cmp.to);
17999 fprintf (stderr, " . %4d %1.1d%1.1d\n",
18000 glyph->face_id,
18001 glyph->left_box_line_p,
18002 glyph->right_box_line_p);
18007 /* Dump the contents of glyph row at VPOS in MATRIX to stderr.
18008 GLYPHS 0 means don't show glyph contents.
18009 GLYPHS 1 means show glyphs in short form
18010 GLYPHS > 1 means show glyphs in long form. */
18012 void
18013 dump_glyph_row (struct glyph_row *row, int vpos, int glyphs)
18015 if (glyphs != 1)
18017 fprintf (stderr, "Row Start End Used oE><\\CTZFesm X Y W H V A P\n");
18018 fprintf (stderr, "======================================================================\n");
18020 fprintf (stderr, "%3d %5"pI"d %5"pI"d %4d %1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d\
18021 %1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d%1.1d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d %4d\n",
18022 vpos,
18023 MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row),
18024 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row),
18025 row->used[TEXT_AREA],
18026 row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p,
18027 row->enabled_p,
18028 row->truncated_on_left_p,
18029 row->truncated_on_right_p,
18030 row->continued_p,
18031 MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row),
18032 row->displays_text_p,
18033 row->ends_at_zv_p,
18034 row->fill_line_p,
18035 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p,
18036 row->starts_in_middle_of_char_p,
18037 row->mouse_face_p,
18038 row->x,
18039 row->y,
18040 row->pixel_width,
18041 row->height,
18042 row->visible_height,
18043 row->ascent,
18044 row->phys_ascent);
18045 fprintf (stderr, "%9"pD"d %5"pD"d\t%5d\n", row->start.overlay_string_index,
18046 row->end.overlay_string_index,
18047 row->continuation_lines_width);
18048 fprintf (stderr, "%9"pI"d %5"pI"d\n",
18049 CHARPOS (row->start.string_pos),
18050 CHARPOS (row->end.string_pos));
18051 fprintf (stderr, "%9d %5d\n", row->start.dpvec_index,
18052 row->end.dpvec_index);
18055 if (glyphs > 1)
18057 int area;
18059 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
18061 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[area];
18062 struct glyph *glyph_end = glyph + row->used[area];
18064 /* Glyph for a line end in text. */
18065 if (area == TEXT_AREA && glyph == glyph_end && glyph->charpos > 0)
18066 ++glyph_end;
18068 if (glyph < glyph_end)
18069 fprintf (stderr, " Glyph Type Pos O W Code C Face LR\n");
18071 for (; glyph < glyph_end; ++glyph)
18072 dump_glyph (row, glyph, area);
18075 else if (glyphs == 1)
18077 int area;
18079 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
18081 char *s = alloca (row->used[area] + 1);
18082 int i;
18084 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area]; ++i)
18086 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[area] + i;
18087 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18088 && glyph->u.ch < 0x80
18089 && glyph->u.ch >= ' ')
18090 s[i] = glyph->u.ch;
18091 else
18092 s[i] = '.';
18095 s[i] = '\0';
18096 fprintf (stderr, "%3d: (%d) '%s'\n", vpos, row->enabled_p, s);
18102 DEFUN ("dump-glyph-matrix", Fdump_glyph_matrix,
18103 Sdump_glyph_matrix, 0, 1, "p",
18104 doc: /* Dump the current matrix of the selected window to stderr.
18105 Shows contents of glyph row structures. With non-nil
18106 parameter GLYPHS, dump glyphs as well. If GLYPHS is 1 show
18107 glyphs in short form, otherwise show glyphs in long form. */)
18108 (Lisp_Object glyphs)
18110 struct window *w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
18111 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
18113 fprintf (stderr, "PT = %"pI"d, BEGV = %"pI"d. ZV = %"pI"d\n",
18114 BUF_PT (buffer), BUF_BEGV (buffer), BUF_ZV (buffer));
18115 fprintf (stderr, "Cursor x = %d, y = %d, hpos = %d, vpos = %d\n",
18116 w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y, w->cursor.hpos, w->cursor.vpos);
18117 fprintf (stderr, "=============================================\n");
18118 dump_glyph_matrix (w->current_matrix,
18119 TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, glyphs) ? XINT (glyphs) : 0);
18120 return Qnil;
18124 DEFUN ("dump-frame-glyph-matrix", Fdump_frame_glyph_matrix,
18125 Sdump_frame_glyph_matrix, 0, 0, "", doc: /* */)
18126 (void)
18128 struct frame *f = XFRAME (selected_frame);
18129 dump_glyph_matrix (f->current_matrix, 1);
18130 return Qnil;
18134 DEFUN ("dump-glyph-row", Fdump_glyph_row, Sdump_glyph_row, 1, 2, "",
18135 doc: /* Dump glyph row ROW to stderr.
18136 GLYPH 0 means don't dump glyphs.
18137 GLYPH 1 means dump glyphs in short form.
18138 GLYPH > 1 or omitted means dump glyphs in long form. */)
18139 (Lisp_Object row, Lisp_Object glyphs)
18141 struct glyph_matrix *matrix;
18142 EMACS_INT vpos;
18144 CHECK_NUMBER (row);
18145 matrix = XWINDOW (selected_window)->current_matrix;
18146 vpos = XINT (row);
18147 if (vpos >= 0 && vpos < matrix->nrows)
18148 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (matrix, vpos),
18149 vpos,
18150 TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, glyphs) ? XINT (glyphs) : 2);
18151 return Qnil;
18155 DEFUN ("dump-tool-bar-row", Fdump_tool_bar_row, Sdump_tool_bar_row, 1, 2, "",
18156 doc: /* Dump glyph row ROW of the tool-bar of the current frame to stderr.
18157 GLYPH 0 means don't dump glyphs.
18158 GLYPH 1 means dump glyphs in short form.
18159 GLYPH > 1 or omitted means dump glyphs in long form. */)
18160 (Lisp_Object row, Lisp_Object glyphs)
18162 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME ();
18163 struct glyph_matrix *m = XWINDOW (sf->tool_bar_window)->current_matrix;
18164 EMACS_INT vpos;
18166 CHECK_NUMBER (row);
18167 vpos = XINT (row);
18168 if (vpos >= 0 && vpos < m->nrows)
18169 dump_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (m, vpos), vpos,
18170 TYPE_RANGED_INTEGERP (int, glyphs) ? XINT (glyphs) : 2);
18171 return Qnil;
18175 DEFUN ("trace-redisplay", Ftrace_redisplay, Strace_redisplay, 0, 1, "P",
18176 doc: /* Toggle tracing of redisplay.
18177 With ARG, turn tracing on if and only if ARG is positive. */)
18178 (Lisp_Object arg)
18180 if (NILP (arg))
18181 trace_redisplay_p = !trace_redisplay_p;
18182 else
18184 arg = Fprefix_numeric_value (arg);
18185 trace_redisplay_p = XINT (arg) > 0;
18188 return Qnil;
18192 DEFUN ("trace-to-stderr", Ftrace_to_stderr, Strace_to_stderr, 1, MANY, "",
18193 doc: /* Like `format', but print result to stderr.
18194 usage: (trace-to-stderr STRING &rest OBJECTS) */)
18195 (ptrdiff_t nargs, Lisp_Object *args)
18197 Lisp_Object s = Fformat (nargs, args);
18198 fprintf (stderr, "%s", SDATA (s));
18199 return Qnil;
18202 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
18206 /***********************************************************************
18207 Building Desired Matrix Rows
18208 ***********************************************************************/
18210 /* Return a temporary glyph row holding the glyphs of an overlay arrow.
18211 Used for non-window-redisplay windows, and for windows w/o left fringe. */
18213 static struct glyph_row *
18214 get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (struct window *w, Lisp_Object overlay_arrow_string)
18216 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
18217 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
18218 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
18219 const unsigned char *arrow_string = SDATA (overlay_arrow_string);
18220 int arrow_len = SCHARS (overlay_arrow_string);
18221 const unsigned char *arrow_end = arrow_string + arrow_len;
18222 const unsigned char *p;
18223 struct it it;
18224 int multibyte_p;
18225 int n_glyphs_before;
18227 set_buffer_temp (buffer);
18228 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, &scratch_glyph_row, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
18229 it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 0;
18230 SET_TEXT_POS (it.position, 0, 0);
18232 multibyte_p = !NILP (BVAR (buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
18233 p = arrow_string;
18234 while (p < arrow_end)
18236 Lisp_Object face, ilisp;
18238 /* Get the next character. */
18239 if (multibyte_p)
18240 it.c = it.char_to_display = string_char_and_length (p, &it.len);
18241 else
18243 it.c = it.char_to_display = *p, it.len = 1;
18244 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (it.c))
18245 it.char_to_display = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it.c);
18247 p += it.len;
18249 /* Get its face. */
18250 ilisp = make_number (p - arrow_string);
18251 face = Fget_text_property (ilisp, Qface, overlay_arrow_string);
18252 it.face_id = compute_char_face (f, it.char_to_display, face);
18254 /* Compute its width, get its glyphs. */
18255 n_glyphs_before = it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18256 SET_TEXT_POS (it.position, -1, -1);
18257 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&it);
18259 /* If this character doesn't fit any more in the line, we have
18260 to remove some glyphs. */
18261 if (it.current_x > it.last_visible_x)
18263 it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
18264 break;
18268 set_buffer_temp (old);
18269 return it.glyph_row;
18273 /* Insert truncation glyphs at the start of IT->glyph_row. Which
18274 glyphs to insert is determined by produce_special_glyphs. */
18276 static void
18277 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (struct it *it)
18279 struct it truncate_it;
18280 struct glyph *from, *end, *to, *toend;
18282 eassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
18283 || (!it->glyph_row->reversed_p
18284 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0)
18285 || (it->glyph_row->reversed_p
18286 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0));
18288 /* Get the truncation glyphs. */
18289 truncate_it = *it;
18290 truncate_it.current_x = 0;
18291 truncate_it.face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
18292 truncate_it.glyph_row = &scratch_glyph_row;
18293 truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 0;
18294 CHARPOS (truncate_it.position) = BYTEPOS (truncate_it.position) = -1;
18295 truncate_it.object = make_number (0);
18296 produce_special_glyphs (&truncate_it, IT_TRUNCATION);
18298 /* Overwrite glyphs from IT with truncation glyphs. */
18299 if (!it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
18301 short tused = truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18303 from = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18304 end = from + tused;
18305 to = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18306 toend = to + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18307 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18309 /* On GUI frames, when variable-size fonts are displayed,
18310 the truncation glyphs may need more pixels than the row's
18311 glyphs they overwrite. We overwrite more glyphs to free
18312 enough screen real estate, and enlarge the stretch glyph
18313 on the right (see display_line), if there is one, to
18314 preserve the screen position of the truncation glyphs on
18315 the right. */
18316 int w = 0;
18317 struct glyph *g = to;
18318 short used;
18320 /* The first glyph could be partially visible, in which case
18321 it->glyph_row->x will be negative. But we want the left
18322 truncation glyphs to be aligned at the left margin of the
18323 window, so we override the x coordinate at which the row
18324 will begin. */
18325 it->glyph_row->x = 0;
18326 while (g < toend && w < it->truncation_pixel_width)
18328 w += g->pixel_width;
18329 ++g;
18331 if (g - to - tused > 0)
18333 memmove (to + tused, g, (toend - g) * sizeof(*g));
18334 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] -= g - to - tused;
18336 used = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18337 if (it->glyph_row->truncated_on_right_p
18338 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0
18339 && it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][used - 2].type
18340 == STRETCH_GLYPH)
18342 int extra = w - it->truncation_pixel_width;
18344 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][used - 2].pixel_width += extra;
18348 while (from < end)
18349 *to++ = *from++;
18351 /* There may be padding glyphs left over. Overwrite them too. */
18352 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18354 while (to < toend && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*to))
18356 from = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18357 while (from < end)
18358 *to++ = *from++;
18362 if (to > toend)
18363 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = to - it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18365 else
18367 short tused = truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18369 /* In R2L rows, overwrite the last (rightmost) glyphs, and do
18370 that back to front. */
18371 end = truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18372 from = end + truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18373 toend = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18374 to = toend + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18375 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18377 int w = 0;
18378 struct glyph *g = to;
18380 while (g >= toend && w < it->truncation_pixel_width)
18382 w += g->pixel_width;
18383 --g;
18385 if (to - g - tused > 0)
18386 to = g + tused;
18387 if (it->glyph_row->truncated_on_right_p
18388 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w) == 0
18389 && it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][1].type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
18391 int extra = w - it->truncation_pixel_width;
18393 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][1].pixel_width += extra;
18397 while (from >= end && to >= toend)
18398 *to-- = *from--;
18399 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18401 while (to >= toend && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*to))
18403 from =
18404 truncate_it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
18405 + truncate_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18406 while (from >= end && to >= toend)
18407 *to-- = *from--;
18410 if (from >= end)
18412 /* Need to free some room before prepending additional
18413 glyphs. */
18414 int move_by = from - end + 1;
18415 struct glyph *g0 = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18416 struct glyph *g = g0 + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18418 for ( ; g >= g0; g--)
18419 g[move_by] = *g;
18420 while (from >= end)
18421 *to-- = *from--;
18422 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] += move_by;
18427 /* Compute the hash code for ROW. */
18428 unsigned
18429 row_hash (struct glyph_row *row)
18431 int area, k;
18432 unsigned hashval = 0;
18434 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area)
18435 for (k = 0; k < row->used[area]; ++k)
18436 hashval = ((((hashval << 4) + (hashval >> 24)) & 0x0fffffff)
18437 + row->glyphs[area][k].u.val
18438 + row->glyphs[area][k].face_id
18439 + row->glyphs[area][k].padding_p
18440 + (row->glyphs[area][k].type << 2));
18442 return hashval;
18445 /* Compute the pixel height and width of IT->glyph_row.
18447 Most of the time, ascent and height of a display line will be equal
18448 to the max_ascent and max_height values of the display iterator
18449 structure. This is not the case if
18451 1. We hit ZV without displaying anything. In this case, max_ascent
18452 and max_height will be zero.
18454 2. We have some glyphs that don't contribute to the line height.
18455 (The glyph row flag contributes_to_line_height_p is for future
18456 pixmap extensions).
18458 The first case is easily covered by using default values because in
18459 these cases, the line height does not really matter, except that it
18460 must not be zero. */
18462 static void
18463 compute_line_metrics (struct it *it)
18465 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
18467 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18469 int i, min_y, max_y;
18471 /* The line may consist of one space only, that was added to
18472 place the cursor on it. If so, the row's height hasn't been
18473 computed yet. */
18474 if (row->height == 0)
18476 if (it->max_ascent + it->max_descent == 0)
18477 it->max_descent = it->max_phys_descent = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f);
18478 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
18479 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
18480 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
18481 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
18482 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
18485 /* Compute the width of this line. */
18486 row->pixel_width = row->x;
18487 for (i = 0; i < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ++i)
18488 row->pixel_width += row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i].pixel_width;
18490 eassert (row->pixel_width >= 0);
18491 eassert (row->ascent >= 0 && row->height > 0);
18493 row->overlapping_p = (MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_SUCC_P (row)
18494 || MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_PRED_P (row));
18496 /* If first line's physical ascent is larger than its logical
18497 ascent, use the physical ascent, and make the row taller.
18498 This makes accented characters fully visible. */
18499 if (row == MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix)
18500 && row->phys_ascent > row->ascent)
18502 row->height += row->phys_ascent - row->ascent;
18503 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent;
18506 /* Compute how much of the line is visible. */
18507 row->visible_height = row->height;
18509 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (it->w);
18510 max_y = WINDOW_BOX_HEIGHT_NO_MODE_LINE (it->w);
18512 if (row->y < min_y)
18513 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y;
18514 if (row->y + row->height > max_y)
18515 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y;
18517 else
18519 row->pixel_width = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18520 if (row->continued_p)
18521 row->pixel_width -= it->continuation_pixel_width;
18522 else if (row->truncated_on_right_p)
18523 row->pixel_width -= it->truncation_pixel_width;
18524 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent = 0;
18525 row->height = row->phys_height = row->visible_height = 1;
18526 row->extra_line_spacing = 0;
18529 /* Compute a hash code for this row. */
18530 row->hash = row_hash (row);
18532 it->max_ascent = it->max_descent = 0;
18533 it->max_phys_ascent = it->max_phys_descent = 0;
18537 /* Append one space to the glyph row of iterator IT if doing a
18538 window-based redisplay. The space has the same face as
18539 IT->face_id. Value is non-zero if a space was added.
18541 This function is called to make sure that there is always one glyph
18542 at the end of a glyph row that the cursor can be set on under
18543 window-systems. (If there weren't such a glyph we would not know
18544 how wide and tall a box cursor should be displayed).
18546 At the same time this space let's a nicely handle clearing to the
18547 end of the line if the row ends in italic text. */
18549 static int
18550 append_space_for_newline (struct it *it, int default_face_p)
18552 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
18554 int n = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18556 if (it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n
18557 < it->glyph_row->glyphs[1 + TEXT_AREA])
18559 /* Save some values that must not be changed.
18560 Must save IT->c and IT->len because otherwise
18561 ITERATOR_AT_END_P wouldn't work anymore after
18562 append_space_for_newline has been called. */
18563 enum display_element_type saved_what = it->what;
18564 int saved_c = it->c, saved_len = it->len;
18565 int saved_char_to_display = it->char_to_display;
18566 int saved_x = it->current_x;
18567 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18568 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18569 Lisp_Object saved_object;
18570 struct face *face;
18572 saved_object = it->object;
18573 saved_pos = it->position;
18575 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
18576 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18577 it->object = make_number (0);
18578 it->c = it->char_to_display = ' ';
18579 it->len = 1;
18581 /* If the default face was remapped, be sure to use the
18582 remapped face for the appended newline. */
18583 if (default_face_p)
18584 it->face_id = lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
18585 else if (it->face_before_selective_p)
18586 it->face_id = it->saved_face_id;
18587 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
18588 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
18590 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18592 it->override_ascent = -1;
18593 it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p = 0;
18594 it->current_x = saved_x;
18595 it->object = saved_object;
18596 it->position = saved_pos;
18597 it->what = saved_what;
18598 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18599 it->len = saved_len;
18600 it->c = saved_c;
18601 it->char_to_display = saved_char_to_display;
18602 return 1;
18606 return 0;
18610 /* Extend the face of the last glyph in the text area of IT->glyph_row
18611 to the end of the display line. Called from display_line. If the
18612 glyph row is empty, add a space glyph to it so that we know the
18613 face to draw. Set the glyph row flag fill_line_p. If the glyph
18614 row is R2L, prepend a stretch glyph to cover the empty space to the
18615 left of the leftmost glyph. */
18617 static void
18618 extend_face_to_end_of_line (struct it *it)
18620 struct face *face, *default_face;
18621 struct frame *f = it->f;
18623 /* If line is already filled, do nothing. Non window-system frames
18624 get a grace of one more ``pixel'' because their characters are
18625 1-``pixel'' wide, so they hit the equality too early. This grace
18626 is needed only for R2L rows that are not continued, to produce
18627 one extra blank where we could display the cursor. */
18628 if (it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x
18629 + (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
18630 && it->glyph_row->reversed_p
18631 && !it->glyph_row->continued_p))
18632 return;
18634 /* The default face, possibly remapped. */
18635 default_face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, lookup_basic_face (f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID));
18637 /* Face extension extends the background and box of IT->face_id
18638 to the end of the line. If the background equals the background
18639 of the frame, we don't have to do anything. */
18640 if (it->face_before_selective_p)
18641 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, it->saved_face_id);
18642 else
18643 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, it->face_id);
18645 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
18646 && it->glyph_row->displays_text_p
18647 && face->box == FACE_NO_BOX
18648 && face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f)
18649 && !face->stipple
18650 && !it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
18651 return;
18653 /* Set the glyph row flag indicating that the face of the last glyph
18654 in the text area has to be drawn to the end of the text area. */
18655 it->glyph_row->fill_line_p = 1;
18657 /* If current character of IT is not ASCII, make sure we have the
18658 ASCII face. This will be automatically undone the next time
18659 get_next_display_element returns a multibyte character. Note
18660 that the character will always be single byte in unibyte
18661 text. */
18662 if (!ASCII_CHAR_P (it->c))
18664 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
18667 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
18669 /* If the row is empty, add a space with the current face of IT,
18670 so that we know which face to draw. */
18671 if (it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 0)
18673 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][0] = space_glyph;
18674 it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][0].face_id = face->id;
18675 it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = 1;
18677 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
18678 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p)
18680 /* Prepend a stretch glyph to the row, such that the
18681 rightmost glyph will be drawn flushed all the way to the
18682 right margin of the window. The stretch glyph that will
18683 occupy the empty space, if any, to the left of the
18684 glyphs. */
18685 struct font *font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (f);
18686 struct glyph *row_start = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18687 struct glyph *row_end = row_start + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18688 struct glyph *g;
18689 int row_width, stretch_ascent, stretch_width;
18690 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18691 int saved_face_id, saved_avoid_cursor;
18693 for (row_width = 0, g = row_start; g < row_end; g++)
18694 row_width += g->pixel_width;
18695 stretch_width = window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA) - row_width;
18696 if (stretch_width > 0)
18698 stretch_ascent =
18699 (((it->ascent + it->descent)
18700 * FONT_BASE (font)) / FONT_HEIGHT (font));
18701 saved_pos = it->position;
18702 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18703 saved_avoid_cursor = it->avoid_cursor_p;
18704 it->avoid_cursor_p = 1;
18705 saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18706 /* The last row's stretch glyph should get the default
18707 face, to avoid painting the rest of the window with
18708 the region face, if the region ends at ZV. */
18709 if (it->glyph_row->ends_at_zv_p)
18710 it->face_id = default_face->id;
18711 else
18712 it->face_id = face->id;
18713 append_stretch_glyph (it, make_number (0), stretch_width,
18714 it->ascent + it->descent, stretch_ascent);
18715 it->position = saved_pos;
18716 it->avoid_cursor_p = saved_avoid_cursor;
18717 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18720 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
18722 else
18724 /* Save some values that must not be changed. */
18725 int saved_x = it->current_x;
18726 struct text_pos saved_pos;
18727 Lisp_Object saved_object;
18728 enum display_element_type saved_what = it->what;
18729 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
18731 saved_object = it->object;
18732 saved_pos = it->position;
18734 it->what = IT_CHARACTER;
18735 memset (&it->position, 0, sizeof it->position);
18736 it->object = make_number (0);
18737 it->c = it->char_to_display = ' ';
18738 it->len = 1;
18739 /* The last row's blank glyphs should get the default face, to
18740 avoid painting the rest of the window with the region face,
18741 if the region ends at ZV. */
18742 if (it->glyph_row->ends_at_zv_p)
18743 it->face_id = default_face->id;
18744 else
18745 it->face_id = face->id;
18747 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18749 while (it->current_x <= it->last_visible_x)
18750 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
18752 /* Don't count these blanks really. It would let us insert a left
18753 truncation glyph below and make us set the cursor on them, maybe. */
18754 it->current_x = saved_x;
18755 it->object = saved_object;
18756 it->position = saved_pos;
18757 it->what = saved_what;
18758 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
18763 /* Value is non-zero if text starting at CHARPOS in current_buffer is
18764 trailing whitespace. */
18766 static int
18767 trailing_whitespace_p (ptrdiff_t charpos)
18769 ptrdiff_t bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (charpos);
18770 int c = 0;
18772 while (bytepos < ZV_BYTE
18773 && (c = FETCH_CHAR (bytepos),
18774 c == ' ' || c == '\t'))
18775 ++bytepos;
18777 if (bytepos >= ZV_BYTE || c == '\n' || c == '\r')
18779 if (bytepos != PT_BYTE)
18780 return 1;
18782 return 0;
18786 /* Highlight trailing whitespace, if any, in ROW. */
18788 static void
18789 highlight_trailing_whitespace (struct frame *f, struct glyph_row *row)
18791 int used = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
18793 if (used)
18795 struct glyph *start = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18796 struct glyph *glyph = start + used - 1;
18798 if (row->reversed_p)
18800 /* Right-to-left rows need to be processed in the opposite
18801 direction, so swap the edge pointers. */
18802 glyph = start;
18803 start = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + used - 1;
18806 /* Skip over glyphs inserted to display the cursor at the
18807 end of a line, for extending the face of the last glyph
18808 to the end of the line on terminals, and for truncation
18809 and continuation glyphs. */
18810 if (!row->reversed_p)
18812 while (glyph >= start
18813 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18814 && INTEGERP (glyph->object))
18815 --glyph;
18817 else
18819 while (glyph <= start
18820 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18821 && INTEGERP (glyph->object))
18822 ++glyph;
18825 /* If last glyph is a space or stretch, and it's trailing
18826 whitespace, set the face of all trailing whitespace glyphs in
18827 IT->glyph_row to `trailing-whitespace'. */
18828 if ((row->reversed_p ? glyph <= start : glyph >= start)
18829 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18830 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
18831 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18832 && glyph->u.ch == ' '))
18833 && trailing_whitespace_p (glyph->charpos))
18835 int face_id = lookup_named_face (f, Qtrailing_whitespace, 0);
18836 if (face_id < 0)
18837 return;
18839 if (!row->reversed_p)
18841 while (glyph >= start
18842 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18843 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
18844 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18845 && glyph->u.ch == ' ')))
18846 (glyph--)->face_id = face_id;
18848 else
18850 while (glyph <= start
18851 && BUFFERP (glyph->object)
18852 && (glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
18853 || (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
18854 && glyph->u.ch == ' ')))
18855 (glyph++)->face_id = face_id;
18862 /* Value is non-zero if glyph row ROW should be
18863 used to hold the cursor. */
18865 static int
18866 cursor_row_p (struct glyph_row *row)
18868 int result = 1;
18870 if (PT == CHARPOS (row->end.pos)
18871 || PT == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))
18873 /* Suppose the row ends on a string.
18874 Unless the row is continued, that means it ends on a newline
18875 in the string. If it's anything other than a display string
18876 (e.g., a before-string from an overlay), we don't want the
18877 cursor there. (This heuristic seems to give the optimal
18878 behavior for the various types of multi-line strings.)
18879 One exception: if the string has `cursor' property on one of
18880 its characters, we _do_ want the cursor there. */
18881 if (CHARPOS (row->end.string_pos) >= 0)
18883 if (row->continued_p)
18884 result = 1;
18885 else
18887 /* Check for `display' property. */
18888 struct glyph *beg = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
18889 struct glyph *end = beg + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
18890 struct glyph *glyph;
18892 result = 0;
18893 for (glyph = end; glyph >= beg; --glyph)
18894 if (STRINGP (glyph->object))
18896 Lisp_Object prop
18897 = Fget_char_property (make_number (PT),
18898 Qdisplay, Qnil);
18899 result =
18900 (!NILP (prop)
18901 && display_prop_string_p (prop, glyph->object));
18902 /* If there's a `cursor' property on one of the
18903 string's characters, this row is a cursor row,
18904 even though this is not a display string. */
18905 if (!result)
18907 Lisp_Object s = glyph->object;
18909 for ( ; glyph >= beg && EQ (glyph->object, s); --glyph)
18911 ptrdiff_t gpos = glyph->charpos;
18913 if (!NILP (Fget_char_property (make_number (gpos),
18914 Qcursor, s)))
18916 result = 1;
18917 break;
18921 break;
18925 else if (MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))
18927 /* If the row ends in middle of a real character,
18928 and the line is continued, we want the cursor here.
18929 That's because CHARPOS (ROW->end.pos) would equal
18930 PT if PT is before the character. */
18931 if (!row->ends_in_ellipsis_p)
18932 result = row->continued_p;
18933 else
18934 /* If the row ends in an ellipsis, then
18935 CHARPOS (ROW->end.pos) will equal point after the
18936 invisible text. We want that position to be displayed
18937 after the ellipsis. */
18938 result = 0;
18940 /* If the row ends at ZV, display the cursor at the end of that
18941 row instead of at the start of the row below. */
18942 else if (row->ends_at_zv_p)
18943 result = 1;
18944 else
18945 result = 0;
18948 return result;
18953 /* Push the property PROP so that it will be rendered at the current
18954 position in IT. Return 1 if PROP was successfully pushed, 0
18955 otherwise. Called from handle_line_prefix to handle the
18956 `line-prefix' and `wrap-prefix' properties. */
18958 static int
18959 push_prefix_prop (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop)
18961 struct text_pos pos =
18962 STRINGP (it->string) ? it->current.string_pos : it->current.pos;
18964 eassert (it->method == GET_FROM_BUFFER
18965 || it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
18966 || it->method == GET_FROM_STRING);
18968 /* We need to save the current buffer/string position, so it will be
18969 restored by pop_it, because iterate_out_of_display_property
18970 depends on that being set correctly, but some situations leave
18971 it->position not yet set when this function is called. */
18972 push_it (it, &pos);
18974 if (STRINGP (prop))
18976 if (SCHARS (prop) == 0)
18978 pop_it (it);
18979 return 0;
18982 it->string = prop;
18983 it->string_from_prefix_prop_p = 1;
18984 it->multibyte_p = STRING_MULTIBYTE (it->string);
18985 it->current.overlay_string_index = -1;
18986 IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it) = IT_STRING_BYTEPOS (*it) = 0;
18987 it->end_charpos = it->string_nchars = SCHARS (it->string);
18988 it->method = GET_FROM_STRING;
18989 it->stop_charpos = 0;
18990 it->prev_stop = 0;
18991 it->base_level_stop = 0;
18993 /* Force paragraph direction to be that of the parent
18994 buffer/string. */
18995 if (it->bidi_p && it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
18996 it->paragraph_embedding = it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir;
18997 else
18998 it->paragraph_embedding = L2R;
19000 /* Set up the bidi iterator for this display string. */
19001 if (it->bidi_p)
19003 it->bidi_it.string.lstring = it->string;
19004 it->bidi_it.string.s = NULL;
19005 it->bidi_it.string.schars = it->end_charpos;
19006 it->bidi_it.string.bufpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
19007 it->bidi_it.string.from_disp_str = it->string_from_display_prop_p;
19008 it->bidi_it.string.unibyte = !it->multibyte_p;
19009 bidi_init_it (0, 0, FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f), &it->bidi_it);
19012 else if (CONSP (prop) && EQ (XCAR (prop), Qspace))
19014 it->method = GET_FROM_STRETCH;
19015 it->object = prop;
19017 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
19018 else if (IMAGEP (prop))
19020 it->what = IT_IMAGE;
19021 it->image_id = lookup_image (it->f, prop);
19022 it->method = GET_FROM_IMAGE;
19024 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
19025 else
19027 pop_it (it); /* bogus display property, give up */
19028 return 0;
19031 return 1;
19034 /* Return the character-property PROP at the current position in IT. */
19036 static Lisp_Object
19037 get_it_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop)
19039 Lisp_Object position;
19041 if (STRINGP (it->object))
19042 position = make_number (IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it));
19043 else if (BUFFERP (it->object))
19044 position = make_number (IT_CHARPOS (*it));
19045 else
19046 return Qnil;
19048 return Fget_char_property (position, prop, it->object);
19051 /* See if there's a line- or wrap-prefix, and if so, push it on IT. */
19053 static void
19054 handle_line_prefix (struct it *it)
19056 Lisp_Object prefix;
19058 if (it->continuation_lines_width > 0)
19060 prefix = get_it_property (it, Qwrap_prefix);
19061 if (NILP (prefix))
19062 prefix = Vwrap_prefix;
19064 else
19066 prefix = get_it_property (it, Qline_prefix);
19067 if (NILP (prefix))
19068 prefix = Vline_prefix;
19070 if (! NILP (prefix) && push_prefix_prop (it, prefix))
19072 /* If the prefix is wider than the window, and we try to wrap
19073 it, it would acquire its own wrap prefix, and so on till the
19074 iterator stack overflows. So, don't wrap the prefix. */
19075 it->line_wrap = TRUNCATE;
19076 it->avoid_cursor_p = 1;
19082 /* Remove N glyphs at the start of a reversed IT->glyph_row. Called
19083 only for R2L lines from display_line and display_string, when they
19084 decide that too many glyphs were produced by PRODUCE_GLYPHS, and
19085 the line/string needs to be continued on the next glyph row. */
19086 static void
19087 unproduce_glyphs (struct it *it, int n)
19089 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
19091 eassert (it->glyph_row);
19092 eassert (it->glyph_row->reversed_p);
19093 eassert (it->area == TEXT_AREA);
19094 eassert (n <= it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]);
19096 if (n > it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
19097 n = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19098 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n;
19099 end = it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19100 for ( ; glyph < end; glyph++)
19101 glyph[-n] = *glyph;
19104 /* Find the positions in a bidi-reordered ROW to serve as ROW->minpos
19105 and ROW->maxpos. */
19106 static void
19107 find_row_edges (struct it *it, struct glyph_row *row,
19108 ptrdiff_t min_pos, ptrdiff_t min_bpos,
19109 ptrdiff_t max_pos, ptrdiff_t max_bpos)
19111 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in continuation
19112 lines' rows is implemented for bidi-reordered rows. */
19114 /* ROW->minpos is the value of min_pos, the minimal buffer position
19115 we have in ROW, or ROW->start.pos if that is smaller. */
19116 if (min_pos <= ZV && min_pos < row->start.pos.charpos)
19117 SET_TEXT_POS (row->minpos, min_pos, min_bpos);
19118 else
19119 /* We didn't find buffer positions smaller than ROW->start, or
19120 didn't find _any_ valid buffer positions in any of the glyphs,
19121 so we must trust the iterator's computed positions. */
19122 row->minpos = row->start.pos;
19123 if (max_pos <= 0)
19125 max_pos = CHARPOS (it->current.pos);
19126 max_bpos = BYTEPOS (it->current.pos);
19129 /* Here are the various use-cases for ending the row, and the
19130 corresponding values for ROW->maxpos:
19132 Line ends in a newline from buffer eol_pos + 1
19133 Line is continued from buffer max_pos + 1
19134 Line is truncated on right it->current.pos
19135 Line ends in a newline from string max_pos + 1(*)
19136 (*) + 1 only when line ends in a forward scan
19137 Line is continued from string max_pos
19138 Line is continued from display vector max_pos
19139 Line is entirely from a string min_pos == max_pos
19140 Line is entirely from a display vector min_pos == max_pos
19141 Line that ends at ZV ZV
19143 If you discover other use-cases, please add them here as
19144 appropriate. */
19145 if (row->ends_at_zv_p)
19146 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
19147 else if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
19149 int seen_this_string = 0;
19150 struct glyph_row *r1 = row - 1;
19152 /* Did we see the same display string on the previous row? */
19153 if (STRINGP (it->object)
19154 /* this is not the first row */
19155 && row > it->w->desired_matrix->rows
19156 /* previous row is not the header line */
19157 && !r1->mode_line_p
19158 /* previous row also ends in a newline from a string */
19159 && r1->ends_in_newline_from_string_p)
19161 struct glyph *start, *end;
19163 /* Search for the last glyph of the previous row that came
19164 from buffer or string. Depending on whether the row is
19165 L2R or R2L, we need to process it front to back or the
19166 other way round. */
19167 if (!r1->reversed_p)
19169 start = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19170 end = start + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
19171 /* Glyphs inserted by redisplay have an integer (zero)
19172 as their object. */
19173 while (end > start
19174 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object)
19175 && (end - 1)->charpos <= 0)
19176 --end;
19177 if (end > start)
19179 if (EQ ((end - 1)->object, it->object))
19180 seen_this_string = 1;
19182 else
19183 /* If all the glyphs of the previous row were inserted
19184 by redisplay, it means the previous row was
19185 produced from a single newline, which is only
19186 possible if that newline came from the same string
19187 as the one which produced this ROW. */
19188 seen_this_string = 1;
19190 else
19192 end = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
19193 start = end + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
19194 while (end < start
19195 && INTEGERP ((end + 1)->object)
19196 && (end + 1)->charpos <= 0)
19197 ++end;
19198 if (end < start)
19200 if (EQ ((end + 1)->object, it->object))
19201 seen_this_string = 1;
19203 else
19204 seen_this_string = 1;
19207 /* Take note of each display string that covers a newline only
19208 once, the first time we see it. This is for when a display
19209 string includes more than one newline in it. */
19210 if (row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p && !seen_this_string)
19212 /* If we were scanning the buffer forward when we displayed
19213 the string, we want to account for at least one buffer
19214 position that belongs to this row (position covered by
19215 the display string), so that cursor positioning will
19216 consider this row as a candidate when point is at the end
19217 of the visual line represented by this row. This is not
19218 required when scanning back, because max_pos will already
19219 have a much larger value. */
19220 if (CHARPOS (row->end.pos) > max_pos)
19221 INC_BOTH (max_pos, max_bpos);
19222 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19224 else if (CHARPOS (it->eol_pos) > 0)
19225 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos,
19226 CHARPOS (it->eol_pos) + 1, BYTEPOS (it->eol_pos) + 1);
19227 else if (row->continued_p)
19229 /* If max_pos is different from IT's current position, it
19230 means IT->method does not belong to the display element
19231 at max_pos. However, it also means that the display
19232 element at max_pos was displayed in its entirety on this
19233 line, which is equivalent to saying that the next line
19234 starts at the next buffer position. */
19235 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) == max_pos && it->method != GET_FROM_BUFFER)
19236 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19237 else
19239 INC_BOTH (max_pos, max_bpos);
19240 SET_TEXT_POS (row->maxpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19243 else if (row->truncated_on_right_p)
19244 /* display_line already called reseat_at_next_visible_line_start,
19245 which puts the iterator at the beginning of the next line, in
19246 the logical order. */
19247 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
19248 else if (max_pos == min_pos && it->method != GET_FROM_BUFFER)
19249 /* A line that is entirely from a string/image/stretch... */
19250 row->maxpos = row->minpos;
19251 else
19252 abort ();
19254 else
19255 row->maxpos = it->current.pos;
19258 /* Construct the glyph row IT->glyph_row in the desired matrix of
19259 IT->w from text at the current position of IT. See dispextern.h
19260 for an overview of struct it. Value is non-zero if
19261 IT->glyph_row displays text, as opposed to a line displaying ZV
19262 only. */
19264 static int
19265 display_line (struct it *it)
19267 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
19268 Lisp_Object overlay_arrow_string;
19269 struct it wrap_it;
19270 void *wrap_data = NULL;
19271 int may_wrap = 0, wrap_x IF_LINT (= 0);
19272 int wrap_row_used = -1;
19273 int wrap_row_ascent IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_height IF_LINT (= 0);
19274 int wrap_row_phys_ascent IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_phys_height IF_LINT (= 0);
19275 int wrap_row_extra_line_spacing IF_LINT (= 0);
19276 ptrdiff_t wrap_row_min_pos IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_min_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
19277 ptrdiff_t wrap_row_max_pos IF_LINT (= 0), wrap_row_max_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
19278 int cvpos;
19279 ptrdiff_t min_pos = ZV + 1, max_pos = 0;
19280 ptrdiff_t min_bpos IF_LINT (= 0), max_bpos IF_LINT (= 0);
19282 /* We always start displaying at hpos zero even if hscrolled. */
19283 eassert (it->hpos == 0 && it->current_x == 0);
19285 if (MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, it->w->desired_matrix)
19286 >= it->w->desired_matrix->nrows)
19288 it->w->nrows_scale_factor++;
19289 fonts_changed_p = 1;
19290 return 0;
19293 /* Is IT->w showing the region? */
19294 wset_region_showing (it->w, it->region_beg_charpos > 0 ? Qt : Qnil);
19296 /* Clear the result glyph row and enable it. */
19297 prepare_desired_row (row);
19299 row->y = it->current_y;
19300 row->start = it->start;
19301 row->continuation_lines_width = it->continuation_lines_width;
19302 row->displays_text_p = 1;
19303 row->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p;
19304 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 0;
19306 /* Arrange the overlays nicely for our purposes. Usually, we call
19307 display_line on only one line at a time, in which case this
19308 can't really hurt too much, or we call it on lines which appear
19309 one after another in the buffer, in which case all calls to
19310 recenter_overlay_lists but the first will be pretty cheap. */
19311 recenter_overlay_lists (current_buffer, IT_CHARPOS (*it));
19313 /* Move over display elements that are not visible because we are
19314 hscrolled. This may stop at an x-position < IT->first_visible_x
19315 if the first glyph is partially visible or if we hit a line end. */
19316 if (it->current_x < it->first_visible_x)
19318 enum move_it_result move_result;
19320 this_line_min_pos = row->start.pos;
19321 move_result = move_it_in_display_line_to (it, ZV, it->first_visible_x,
19322 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X);
19323 /* If we are under a large hscroll, move_it_in_display_line_to
19324 could hit the end of the line without reaching
19325 it->first_visible_x. Pretend that we did reach it. This is
19326 especially important on a TTY, where we will call
19327 extend_face_to_end_of_line, which needs to know how many
19328 blank glyphs to produce. */
19329 if (it->current_x < it->first_visible_x
19330 && (move_result == MOVE_NEWLINE_OR_CR
19331 || move_result == MOVE_POS_MATCH_OR_ZV))
19332 it->current_x = it->first_visible_x;
19334 /* Record the smallest positions seen while we moved over
19335 display elements that are not visible. This is needed by
19336 redisplay_internal for optimizing the case where the cursor
19337 stays inside the same line. The rest of this function only
19338 considers positions that are actually displayed, so
19339 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS will not otherwise record positions that
19340 are hscrolled to the left of the left edge of the window. */
19341 min_pos = CHARPOS (this_line_min_pos);
19342 min_bpos = BYTEPOS (this_line_min_pos);
19344 else
19346 /* We only do this when not calling `move_it_in_display_line_to'
19347 above, because move_it_in_display_line_to calls
19348 handle_line_prefix itself. */
19349 handle_line_prefix (it);
19352 /* Get the initial row height. This is either the height of the
19353 text hscrolled, if there is any, or zero. */
19354 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
19355 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
19356 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
19357 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
19358 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
19360 /* Utility macro to record max and min buffer positions seen until now. */
19361 #define RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS(IT) \
19362 do \
19364 int composition_p = !STRINGP ((IT)->string) \
19365 && ((IT)->what == IT_COMPOSITION); \
19366 ptrdiff_t current_pos = \
19367 composition_p ? (IT)->cmp_it.charpos \
19368 : IT_CHARPOS (*(IT)); \
19369 ptrdiff_t current_bpos = \
19370 composition_p ? CHAR_TO_BYTE (current_pos) \
19371 : IT_BYTEPOS (*(IT)); \
19372 if (current_pos < min_pos) \
19374 min_pos = current_pos; \
19375 min_bpos = current_bpos; \
19377 if (IT_CHARPOS (*it) > max_pos) \
19379 max_pos = IT_CHARPOS (*it); \
19380 max_bpos = IT_BYTEPOS (*it); \
19383 while (0)
19385 /* Loop generating characters. The loop is left with IT on the next
19386 character to display. */
19387 while (1)
19389 int n_glyphs_before, hpos_before, x_before;
19390 int x, nglyphs;
19391 int ascent = 0, descent = 0, phys_ascent = 0, phys_descent = 0;
19393 /* Retrieve the next thing to display. Value is zero if end of
19394 buffer reached. */
19395 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
19397 /* Maybe add a space at the end of this line that is used to
19398 display the cursor there under X. Set the charpos of the
19399 first glyph of blank lines not corresponding to any text
19400 to -1. */
19401 if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19402 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19403 else if ((append_space_for_newline (it, 1) && row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 1)
19404 || row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 0)
19406 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos = -1;
19407 row->displays_text_p = 0;
19409 if (!NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (it->w->buffer), indicate_empty_lines))
19410 && (!MINI_WINDOW_P (it->w)
19411 || (minibuf_level && EQ (it->window, minibuf_window))))
19412 row->indicate_empty_line_p = 1;
19415 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19416 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
19417 /* A row that displays right-to-left text must always have
19418 its last face extended all the way to the end of line,
19419 even if this row ends in ZV, because we still write to
19420 the screen left to right. We also need to extend the
19421 last face if the default face is remapped to some
19422 different face, otherwise the functions that clear
19423 portions of the screen will clear with the default face's
19424 background color. */
19425 if (row->reversed_p
19426 || lookup_basic_face (it->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID) != DEFAULT_FACE_ID)
19427 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19428 break;
19431 /* Now, get the metrics of what we want to display. This also
19432 generates glyphs in `row' (which is IT->glyph_row). */
19433 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19434 x = it->current_x;
19436 /* Remember the line height so far in case the next element doesn't
19437 fit on the line. */
19438 if (it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE)
19440 ascent = it->max_ascent;
19441 descent = it->max_descent;
19442 phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
19443 phys_descent = it->max_phys_descent;
19445 if (it->line_wrap == WORD_WRAP && it->area == TEXT_AREA)
19447 if (IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it))
19448 may_wrap = 1;
19449 else if (may_wrap)
19451 SAVE_IT (wrap_it, *it, wrap_data);
19452 wrap_x = x;
19453 wrap_row_used = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19454 wrap_row_ascent = row->ascent;
19455 wrap_row_height = row->height;
19456 wrap_row_phys_ascent = row->phys_ascent;
19457 wrap_row_phys_height = row->phys_height;
19458 wrap_row_extra_line_spacing = row->extra_line_spacing;
19459 wrap_row_min_pos = min_pos;
19460 wrap_row_min_bpos = min_bpos;
19461 wrap_row_max_pos = max_pos;
19462 wrap_row_max_bpos = max_bpos;
19463 may_wrap = 0;
19468 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
19470 /* If this display element was in marginal areas, continue with
19471 the next one. */
19472 if (it->area != TEXT_AREA)
19474 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
19475 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
19476 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
19477 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
19478 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
19479 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
19480 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
19481 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19482 continue;
19485 /* Does the display element fit on the line? If we truncate
19486 lines, we should draw past the right edge of the window. If
19487 we don't truncate, we want to stop so that we can display the
19488 continuation glyph before the right margin. If lines are
19489 continued, there are two possible strategies for characters
19490 resulting in more than 1 glyph (e.g. tabs): Display as many
19491 glyphs as possible in this line and leave the rest for the
19492 continuation line, or display the whole element in the next
19493 line. Original redisplay did the former, so we do it also. */
19494 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
19495 hpos_before = it->hpos;
19496 x_before = x;
19498 if (/* Not a newline. */
19499 nglyphs > 0
19500 /* Glyphs produced fit entirely in the line. */
19501 && it->current_x < it->last_visible_x)
19503 it->hpos += nglyphs;
19504 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
19505 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
19506 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
19507 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
19508 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
19509 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
19510 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
19511 if (it->current_x - it->pixel_width < it->first_visible_x)
19512 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
19513 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer positions seen so
19514 far in glyphs that will be displayed by this row. */
19515 if (it->bidi_p)
19516 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19518 else
19520 int i, new_x;
19521 struct glyph *glyph;
19523 for (i = 0; i < nglyphs; ++i, x = new_x)
19525 glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
19526 new_x = x + glyph->pixel_width;
19528 if (/* Lines are continued. */
19529 it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
19530 && (/* Glyph doesn't fit on the line. */
19531 new_x > it->last_visible_x
19532 /* Or it fits exactly on a window system frame. */
19533 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
19534 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19535 && (row->reversed_p
19536 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19537 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)))))
19539 /* End of a continued line. */
19541 if (it->hpos == 0
19542 || (new_x == it->last_visible_x
19543 && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19544 && (row->reversed_p
19545 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19546 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w))))
19548 /* Current glyph is the only one on the line or
19549 fits exactly on the line. We must continue
19550 the line because we can't draw the cursor
19551 after the glyph. */
19552 row->continued_p = 1;
19553 it->current_x = new_x;
19554 it->continuation_lines_width += new_x;
19555 ++it->hpos;
19556 if (i == nglyphs - 1)
19558 /* If line-wrap is on, check if a previous
19559 wrap point was found. */
19560 if (wrap_row_used > 0
19561 /* Even if there is a previous wrap
19562 point, continue the line here as
19563 usual, if (i) the previous character
19564 was a space or tab AND (ii) the
19565 current character is not. */
19566 && (!may_wrap
19567 || IT_DISPLAYING_WHITESPACE (it)))
19568 goto back_to_wrap;
19570 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer
19571 positions seen so far in glyphs that will be
19572 displayed by this row. */
19573 if (it->bidi_p)
19574 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19575 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19576 if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19578 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
19580 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19581 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19582 row->continued_p = 0;
19583 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
19585 else if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
19587 row->continued_p = 0;
19588 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19592 else if (it->bidi_p)
19593 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19595 else if (CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*glyph)
19596 && !FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19598 /* A padding glyph that doesn't fit on this line.
19599 This means the whole character doesn't fit
19600 on the line. */
19601 if (row->reversed_p)
19602 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19603 - n_glyphs_before);
19604 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
19606 /* Fill the rest of the row with continuation
19607 glyphs like in 20.x. */
19608 while (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19609 < row->glyphs[1 + TEXT_AREA])
19610 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
19612 row->continued_p = 1;
19613 it->current_x = x_before;
19614 it->continuation_lines_width += x_before;
19616 /* Restore the height to what it was before the
19617 element not fitting on the line. */
19618 it->max_ascent = ascent;
19619 it->max_descent = descent;
19620 it->max_phys_ascent = phys_ascent;
19621 it->max_phys_descent = phys_descent;
19623 else if (wrap_row_used > 0)
19625 back_to_wrap:
19626 if (row->reversed_p)
19627 unproduce_glyphs (it,
19628 row->used[TEXT_AREA] - wrap_row_used);
19629 RESTORE_IT (it, &wrap_it, wrap_data);
19630 it->continuation_lines_width += wrap_x;
19631 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = wrap_row_used;
19632 row->ascent = wrap_row_ascent;
19633 row->height = wrap_row_height;
19634 row->phys_ascent = wrap_row_phys_ascent;
19635 row->phys_height = wrap_row_phys_height;
19636 row->extra_line_spacing = wrap_row_extra_line_spacing;
19637 min_pos = wrap_row_min_pos;
19638 min_bpos = wrap_row_min_bpos;
19639 max_pos = wrap_row_max_pos;
19640 max_bpos = wrap_row_max_bpos;
19641 row->continued_p = 1;
19642 row->ends_at_zv_p = 0;
19643 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 0;
19644 it->continuation_lines_width += x;
19646 /* Make sure that a non-default face is extended
19647 up to the right margin of the window. */
19648 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19650 else if (it->c == '\t' && FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19652 /* A TAB that extends past the right edge of the
19653 window. This produces a single glyph on
19654 window system frames. We leave the glyph in
19655 this row and let it fill the row, but don't
19656 consume the TAB. */
19657 if ((row->reversed_p
19658 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19659 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19660 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
19661 it->continuation_lines_width += it->last_visible_x;
19662 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19663 row->continued_p = 1;
19664 glyph->pixel_width = it->last_visible_x - x;
19665 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19667 else
19669 /* Something other than a TAB that draws past
19670 the right edge of the window. Restore
19671 positions to values before the element. */
19672 if (row->reversed_p)
19673 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
19674 - (n_glyphs_before + i));
19675 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before + i;
19677 /* Display continuation glyphs. */
19678 it->current_x = x_before;
19679 it->continuation_lines_width += x;
19680 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19681 || (row->reversed_p
19682 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19683 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19684 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_CONTINUATION);
19685 row->continued_p = 1;
19687 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19689 if (nglyphs > 1 && i > 0)
19691 row->ends_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19692 it->starts_in_middle_of_char_p = 1;
19695 /* Restore the height to what it was before the
19696 element not fitting on the line. */
19697 it->max_ascent = ascent;
19698 it->max_descent = descent;
19699 it->max_phys_ascent = phys_ascent;
19700 it->max_phys_descent = phys_descent;
19703 break;
19705 else if (new_x > it->first_visible_x)
19707 /* Increment number of glyphs actually displayed. */
19708 ++it->hpos;
19710 /* Record the maximum and minimum buffer positions
19711 seen so far in glyphs that will be displayed by
19712 this row. */
19713 if (it->bidi_p)
19714 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19716 if (x < it->first_visible_x)
19717 /* Glyph is partially visible, i.e. row starts at
19718 negative X position. */
19719 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
19721 else
19723 /* Glyph is completely off the left margin of the
19724 window. This should not happen because of the
19725 move_it_in_display_line at the start of this
19726 function, unless the text display area of the
19727 window is empty. */
19728 eassert (it->first_visible_x <= it->last_visible_x);
19731 /* Even if this display element produced no glyphs at all,
19732 we want to record its position. */
19733 if (it->bidi_p && nglyphs == 0)
19734 RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS (it);
19736 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
19737 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
19738 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
19739 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
19740 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
19741 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
19742 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
19744 /* End of this display line if row is continued. */
19745 if (row->continued_p || row->ends_at_zv_p)
19746 break;
19749 at_end_of_line:
19750 /* Is this a line end? If yes, we're also done, after making
19751 sure that a non-default face is extended up to the right
19752 margin of the window. */
19753 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
19755 int used_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19757 row->ends_in_newline_from_string_p = STRINGP (it->object);
19759 /* Add a space at the end of the line that is used to
19760 display the cursor there. */
19761 if (!IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19762 append_space_for_newline (it, 0);
19764 /* Extend the face to the end of the line. */
19765 extend_face_to_end_of_line (it);
19767 /* Make sure we have the position. */
19768 if (used_before == 0)
19769 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
19771 /* Record the position of the newline, for use in
19772 find_row_edges. */
19773 it->eol_pos = it->current.pos;
19775 /* Consume the line end. This skips over invisible lines. */
19776 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19777 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19778 break;
19781 /* Proceed with next display element. Note that this skips
19782 over lines invisible because of selective display. */
19783 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
19785 /* If we truncate lines, we are done when the last displayed
19786 glyphs reach past the right margin of the window. */
19787 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
19788 && (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f) && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19789 ? (it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
19790 : (it->current_x > it->last_visible_x)))
19792 /* Maybe add truncation glyphs. */
19793 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19794 || (row->reversed_p
19795 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19796 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19798 int i, n;
19800 if (!row->reversed_p)
19802 for (i = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1; i > 0; --i)
19803 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i]))
19804 break;
19806 else
19808 for (i = 0; i < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; i++)
19809 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i]))
19810 break;
19811 /* Remove any padding glyphs at the front of ROW, to
19812 make room for the truncation glyphs we will be
19813 adding below. The loop below always inserts at
19814 least one truncation glyph, so also remove the
19815 last glyph added to ROW. */
19816 unproduce_glyphs (it, i + 1);
19817 /* Adjust i for the loop below. */
19818 i = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - (i + 1);
19821 it->current_x = x_before;
19822 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
19824 for (n = row->used[TEXT_AREA]; i < n; ++i)
19826 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = i;
19827 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
19830 else
19832 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = i;
19833 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
19836 else if (IT_OVERFLOW_NEWLINE_INTO_FRINGE (it))
19838 /* Don't truncate if we can overflow newline into fringe. */
19839 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
19841 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19842 row->ends_at_zv_p = 1;
19843 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19844 break;
19846 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
19848 row->exact_window_width_line_p = 1;
19849 goto at_end_of_line;
19851 it->current_x = x_before;
19854 row->truncated_on_right_p = 1;
19855 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
19856 reseat_at_next_visible_line_start (it, 0);
19857 row->ends_at_zv_p = FETCH_BYTE (IT_BYTEPOS (*it) - 1) != '\n';
19858 it->hpos = hpos_before;
19859 break;
19863 if (wrap_data)
19864 bidi_unshelve_cache (wrap_data, 1);
19866 /* If line is not empty and hscrolled, maybe insert truncation glyphs
19867 at the left window margin. */
19868 if (it->first_visible_x
19869 && IT_CHARPOS (*it) != CHARPOS (row->start.pos))
19871 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
19872 || (row->reversed_p
19873 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
19874 : WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
19875 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (it);
19876 row->truncated_on_left_p = 1;
19879 /* Remember the position at which this line ends.
19881 BIDI Note: any code that needs MATRIX_ROW_START/END_CHARPOS
19882 cannot be before the call to find_row_edges below, since that is
19883 where these positions are determined. */
19884 row->end = it->current;
19885 if (!it->bidi_p)
19887 row->minpos = row->start.pos;
19888 row->maxpos = row->end.pos;
19890 else
19892 /* ROW->minpos and ROW->maxpos must be the smallest and
19893 `1 + the largest' buffer positions in ROW. But if ROW was
19894 bidi-reordered, these two positions can be anywhere in the
19895 row, so we must determine them now. */
19896 find_row_edges (it, row, min_pos, min_bpos, max_pos, max_bpos);
19899 /* If the start of this line is the overlay arrow-position, then
19900 mark this glyph row as the one containing the overlay arrow.
19901 This is clearly a mess with variable size fonts. It would be
19902 better to let it be displayed like cursors under X. */
19903 if ((row->displays_text_p || !overlay_arrow_seen)
19904 && (overlay_arrow_string = overlay_arrow_at_row (it, row),
19905 !NILP (overlay_arrow_string)))
19907 /* Overlay arrow in window redisplay is a fringe bitmap. */
19908 if (STRINGP (overlay_arrow_string))
19910 struct glyph_row *arrow_row
19911 = get_overlay_arrow_glyph_row (it->w, overlay_arrow_string);
19912 struct glyph *glyph = arrow_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19913 struct glyph *arrow_end = glyph + arrow_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19914 struct glyph *p = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19915 struct glyph *p2, *end;
19917 /* Copy the arrow glyphs. */
19918 while (glyph < arrow_end)
19919 *p++ = *glyph++;
19921 /* Throw away padding glyphs. */
19922 p2 = p;
19923 end = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
19924 while (p2 < end && CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*p2))
19925 ++p2;
19926 if (p2 > p)
19928 while (p2 < end)
19929 *p++ = *p2++;
19930 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = p2 - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
19933 else
19935 eassert (INTEGERP (overlay_arrow_string));
19936 row->overlay_arrow_bitmap = XINT (overlay_arrow_string);
19938 overlay_arrow_seen = 1;
19941 /* Highlight trailing whitespace. */
19942 if (!NILP (Vshow_trailing_whitespace))
19943 highlight_trailing_whitespace (it->f, it->glyph_row);
19945 /* Compute pixel dimensions of this line. */
19946 compute_line_metrics (it);
19948 /* Implementation note: No changes in the glyphs of ROW or in their
19949 faces can be done past this point, because compute_line_metrics
19950 computes ROW's hash value and stores it within the glyph_row
19951 structure. */
19953 /* Record whether this row ends inside an ellipsis. */
19954 row->ends_in_ellipsis_p
19955 = (it->method == GET_FROM_DISPLAY_VECTOR
19956 && it->ellipsis_p);
19958 /* Save fringe bitmaps in this row. */
19959 row->left_user_fringe_bitmap = it->left_user_fringe_bitmap;
19960 row->left_user_fringe_face_id = it->left_user_fringe_face_id;
19961 row->right_user_fringe_bitmap = it->right_user_fringe_bitmap;
19962 row->right_user_fringe_face_id = it->right_user_fringe_face_id;
19964 it->left_user_fringe_bitmap = 0;
19965 it->left_user_fringe_face_id = 0;
19966 it->right_user_fringe_bitmap = 0;
19967 it->right_user_fringe_face_id = 0;
19969 /* Maybe set the cursor. */
19970 cvpos = it->w->cursor.vpos;
19971 if ((cvpos < 0
19972 /* In bidi-reordered rows, keep checking for proper cursor
19973 position even if one has been found already, because buffer
19974 positions in such rows change non-linearly with ROW->VPOS,
19975 when a line is continued. One exception: when we are at ZV,
19976 display cursor on the first suitable glyph row, since all
19977 the empty rows after that also have their position set to ZV. */
19978 /* FIXME: Revisit this when glyph ``spilling'' in continuation
19979 lines' rows is implemented for bidi-reordered rows. */
19980 || (it->bidi_p
19981 && !MATRIX_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix, cvpos)->ends_at_zv_p))
19982 && PT >= MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
19983 && PT <= MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
19984 && cursor_row_p (row))
19985 set_cursor_from_row (it->w, row, it->w->desired_matrix, 0, 0, 0, 0);
19987 /* Prepare for the next line. This line starts horizontally at (X
19988 HPOS) = (0 0). Vertical positions are incremented. As a
19989 convenience for the caller, IT->glyph_row is set to the next
19990 row to be used. */
19991 it->current_x = it->hpos = 0;
19992 it->current_y += row->height;
19993 SET_TEXT_POS (it->eol_pos, 0, 0);
19994 ++it->vpos;
19995 ++it->glyph_row;
19996 /* The next row should by default use the same value of the
19997 reversed_p flag as this one. set_iterator_to_next decides when
19998 it's a new paragraph, and PRODUCE_GLYPHS recomputes the value of
19999 the flag accordingly. */
20000 if (it->glyph_row < MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (it->w->desired_matrix, it->w))
20001 it->glyph_row->reversed_p = row->reversed_p;
20002 it->start = row->end;
20003 return row->displays_text_p;
20005 #undef RECORD_MAX_MIN_POS
20008 DEFUN ("current-bidi-paragraph-direction", Fcurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction,
20009 Scurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction, 0, 1, 0,
20010 doc: /* Return paragraph direction at point in BUFFER.
20011 Value is either `left-to-right' or `right-to-left'.
20012 If BUFFER is omitted or nil, it defaults to the current buffer.
20014 Paragraph direction determines how the text in the paragraph is displayed.
20015 In left-to-right paragraphs, text begins at the left margin of the window
20016 and the reading direction is generally left to right. In right-to-left
20017 paragraphs, text begins at the right margin and is read from right to left.
20019 See also `bidi-paragraph-direction'. */)
20020 (Lisp_Object buffer)
20022 struct buffer *buf = current_buffer;
20023 struct buffer *old = buf;
20025 if (! NILP (buffer))
20027 CHECK_BUFFER (buffer);
20028 buf = XBUFFER (buffer);
20031 if (NILP (BVAR (buf, bidi_display_reordering))
20032 || NILP (BVAR (buf, enable_multibyte_characters))
20033 /* When we are loading loadup.el, the character property tables
20034 needed for bidi iteration are not yet available. */
20035 || !NILP (Vpurify_flag))
20036 return Qleft_to_right;
20037 else if (!NILP (BVAR (buf, bidi_paragraph_direction)))
20038 return BVAR (buf, bidi_paragraph_direction);
20039 else
20041 /* Determine the direction from buffer text. We could try to
20042 use current_matrix if it is up to date, but this seems fast
20043 enough as it is. */
20044 struct bidi_it itb;
20045 ptrdiff_t pos = BUF_PT (buf);
20046 ptrdiff_t bytepos = BUF_PT_BYTE (buf);
20047 int c;
20048 void *itb_data = bidi_shelve_cache ();
20050 set_buffer_temp (buf);
20051 /* bidi_paragraph_init finds the base direction of the paragraph
20052 by searching forward from paragraph start. We need the base
20053 direction of the current or _previous_ paragraph, so we need
20054 to make sure we are within that paragraph. To that end, find
20055 the previous non-empty line. */
20056 if (pos >= ZV && pos > BEGV)
20058 pos--;
20059 bytepos = CHAR_TO_BYTE (pos);
20061 if (fast_looking_at (build_string ("[\f\t ]*\n"),
20062 pos, bytepos, ZV, ZV_BYTE, Qnil) > 0)
20064 while ((c = FETCH_BYTE (bytepos)) == '\n'
20065 || c == ' ' || c == '\t' || c == '\f')
20067 if (bytepos <= BEGV_BYTE)
20068 break;
20069 bytepos--;
20070 pos--;
20072 while (!CHAR_HEAD_P (FETCH_BYTE (bytepos)))
20073 bytepos--;
20075 bidi_init_it (pos, bytepos, FRAME_WINDOW_P (SELECTED_FRAME ()), &itb);
20076 itb.paragraph_dir = NEUTRAL_DIR;
20077 itb.string.s = NULL;
20078 itb.string.lstring = Qnil;
20079 itb.string.bufpos = 0;
20080 itb.string.unibyte = 0;
20081 bidi_paragraph_init (NEUTRAL_DIR, &itb, 1);
20082 bidi_unshelve_cache (itb_data, 0);
20083 set_buffer_temp (old);
20084 switch (itb.paragraph_dir)
20086 case L2R:
20087 return Qleft_to_right;
20088 break;
20089 case R2L:
20090 return Qright_to_left;
20091 break;
20092 default:
20093 abort ();
20100 /***********************************************************************
20101 Menu Bar
20102 ***********************************************************************/
20104 /* Redisplay the menu bar in the frame for window W.
20106 The menu bar of X frames that don't have X toolkit support is
20107 displayed in a special window W->frame->menu_bar_window.
20109 The menu bar of terminal frames is treated specially as far as
20110 glyph matrices are concerned. Menu bar lines are not part of
20111 windows, so the update is done directly on the frame matrix rows
20112 for the menu bar. */
20114 static void
20115 display_menu_bar (struct window *w)
20117 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
20118 struct it it;
20119 Lisp_Object items;
20120 int i;
20122 /* Don't do all this for graphical frames. */
20123 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
20124 if (FRAME_W32_P (f))
20125 return;
20126 #endif
20127 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
20128 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
20129 return;
20130 #endif
20132 #ifdef HAVE_NS
20133 if (FRAME_NS_P (f))
20134 return;
20135 #endif /* HAVE_NS */
20137 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
20138 eassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f));
20139 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, f->desired_matrix->rows, MENU_FACE_ID);
20140 it.first_visible_x = 0;
20141 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
20142 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
20143 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
20145 /* Menu bar lines are displayed in the desired matrix of the
20146 dummy window menu_bar_window. */
20147 struct window *menu_w;
20148 eassert (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window));
20149 menu_w = XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window);
20150 init_iterator (&it, menu_w, -1, -1, menu_w->desired_matrix->rows,
20151 MENU_FACE_ID);
20152 it.first_visible_x = 0;
20153 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
20155 else
20157 /* This is a TTY frame, i.e. character hpos/vpos are used as
20158 pixel x/y. */
20159 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, f->desired_matrix->rows,
20160 MENU_FACE_ID);
20161 it.first_visible_x = 0;
20162 it.last_visible_x = FRAME_COLS (f);
20164 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
20166 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. See the
20167 comments in redisplay_tool_bar and display_mode_line about
20168 this. */
20169 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
20171 if (! mode_line_inverse_video)
20172 /* Force the menu-bar to be displayed in the default face. */
20173 it.base_face_id = it.face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
20175 /* Clear all rows of the menu bar. */
20176 for (i = 0; i < FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f); ++i)
20178 struct glyph_row *row = it.glyph_row + i;
20179 clear_glyph_row (row);
20180 row->enabled_p = 1;
20181 row->full_width_p = 1;
20184 /* Display all items of the menu bar. */
20185 items = FRAME_MENU_BAR_ITEMS (it.f);
20186 for (i = 0; i < ASIZE (items); i += 4)
20188 Lisp_Object string;
20190 /* Stop at nil string. */
20191 string = AREF (items, i + 1);
20192 if (NILP (string))
20193 break;
20195 /* Remember where item was displayed. */
20196 ASET (items, i + 3, make_number (it.hpos));
20198 /* Display the item, pad with one space. */
20199 if (it.current_x < it.last_visible_x)
20200 display_string (NULL, string, Qnil, 0, 0, &it,
20201 SCHARS (string) + 1, 0, 0, -1);
20204 /* Fill out the line with spaces. */
20205 if (it.current_x < it.last_visible_x)
20206 display_string ("", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, &it, -1, 0, 0, -1);
20208 /* Compute the total height of the lines. */
20209 compute_line_metrics (&it);
20214 /***********************************************************************
20215 Mode Line
20216 ***********************************************************************/
20218 /* Redisplay mode lines in the window tree whose root is WINDOW. If
20219 FORCE is non-zero, redisplay mode lines unconditionally.
20220 Otherwise, redisplay only mode lines that are garbaged. Value is
20221 the number of windows whose mode lines were redisplayed. */
20223 static int
20224 redisplay_mode_lines (Lisp_Object window, int force)
20226 int nwindows = 0;
20228 while (!NILP (window))
20230 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
20232 if (WINDOWP (w->hchild))
20233 nwindows += redisplay_mode_lines (w->hchild, force);
20234 else if (WINDOWP (w->vchild))
20235 nwindows += redisplay_mode_lines (w->vchild, force);
20236 else if (force
20237 || FRAME_GARBAGED_P (XFRAME (w->frame))
20238 || !MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)->enabled_p)
20240 struct text_pos lpoint;
20241 struct buffer *old = current_buffer;
20243 /* Set the window's buffer for the mode line display. */
20244 SET_TEXT_POS (lpoint, PT, PT_BYTE);
20245 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (w->buffer));
20247 /* Point refers normally to the selected window. For any
20248 other window, set up appropriate value. */
20249 if (!EQ (window, selected_window))
20251 struct text_pos pt;
20253 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (pt, w->pointm);
20254 if (CHARPOS (pt) < BEGV)
20255 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (BEGV, BEGV_BYTE);
20256 else if (CHARPOS (pt) > (ZV - 1))
20257 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (ZV, ZV_BYTE);
20258 else
20259 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (pt), BYTEPOS (pt));
20262 /* Display mode lines. */
20263 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix);
20264 if (display_mode_lines (w))
20266 ++nwindows;
20267 w->must_be_updated_p = 1;
20270 /* Restore old settings. */
20271 set_buffer_internal_1 (old);
20272 TEMP_SET_PT_BOTH (CHARPOS (lpoint), BYTEPOS (lpoint));
20275 window = w->next;
20278 return nwindows;
20282 /* Display the mode and/or header line of window W. Value is the
20283 sum number of mode lines and header lines displayed. */
20285 static int
20286 display_mode_lines (struct window *w)
20288 Lisp_Object old_selected_window, old_selected_frame;
20289 int n = 0;
20291 old_selected_frame = selected_frame;
20292 selected_frame = w->frame;
20293 old_selected_window = selected_window;
20294 XSETWINDOW (selected_window, w);
20296 /* These will be set while the mode line specs are processed. */
20297 line_number_displayed = 0;
20298 wset_column_number_displayed (w, Qnil);
20300 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w))
20302 struct window *sel_w = XWINDOW (old_selected_window);
20304 /* Select mode line face based on the real selected window. */
20305 display_mode_line (w, CURRENT_MODE_LINE_FACE_ID_3 (sel_w, sel_w, w),
20306 BVAR (current_buffer, mode_line_format));
20307 ++n;
20310 if (WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w))
20312 display_mode_line (w, HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID,
20313 BVAR (current_buffer, header_line_format));
20314 ++n;
20317 selected_frame = old_selected_frame;
20318 selected_window = old_selected_window;
20319 return n;
20323 /* Display mode or header line of window W. FACE_ID specifies which
20324 line to display; it is either MODE_LINE_FACE_ID or
20325 HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID. FORMAT is the mode/header line format to
20326 display. Value is the pixel height of the mode/header line
20327 displayed. */
20329 static int
20330 display_mode_line (struct window *w, enum face_id face_id, Lisp_Object format)
20332 struct it it;
20333 struct face *face;
20334 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
20336 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, NULL, face_id);
20337 /* Don't extend on a previously drawn mode-line.
20338 This may happen if called from pos_visible_p. */
20339 it.glyph_row->enabled_p = 0;
20340 prepare_desired_row (it.glyph_row);
20342 it.glyph_row->mode_line_p = 1;
20344 if (! mode_line_inverse_video)
20345 /* Force the mode-line to be displayed in the default face. */
20346 it.base_face_id = it.face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
20348 /* FIXME: This should be controlled by a user option. But
20349 supporting such an option is not trivial, since the mode line is
20350 made up of many separate strings. */
20351 it.paragraph_embedding = L2R;
20353 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
20354 format_mode_line_unwind_data (NULL, NULL, Qnil, 0));
20356 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_DISPLAY;
20358 /* Temporarily make frame's keyboard the current kboard so that
20359 kboard-local variables in the mode_line_format will get the right
20360 values. */
20361 push_kboard (FRAME_KBOARD (it.f));
20362 record_unwind_save_match_data ();
20363 display_mode_element (&it, 0, 0, 0, format, Qnil, 0);
20364 pop_kboard ();
20366 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
20368 /* Fill up with spaces. */
20369 display_string (" ", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, &it, 10000, -1, -1, 0);
20371 compute_line_metrics (&it);
20372 it.glyph_row->full_width_p = 1;
20373 it.glyph_row->continued_p = 0;
20374 it.glyph_row->truncated_on_left_p = 0;
20375 it.glyph_row->truncated_on_right_p = 0;
20377 /* Make a 3D mode-line have a shadow at its right end. */
20378 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it.f, face_id);
20379 extend_face_to_end_of_line (&it);
20380 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
20382 struct glyph *last = (it.glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
20383 + it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1);
20384 last->right_box_line_p = 1;
20387 return it.glyph_row->height;
20390 /* Move element ELT in LIST to the front of LIST.
20391 Return the updated list. */
20393 static Lisp_Object
20394 move_elt_to_front (Lisp_Object elt, Lisp_Object list)
20396 register Lisp_Object tail, prev;
20397 register Lisp_Object tem;
20399 tail = list;
20400 prev = Qnil;
20401 while (CONSP (tail))
20403 tem = XCAR (tail);
20405 if (EQ (elt, tem))
20407 /* Splice out the link TAIL. */
20408 if (NILP (prev))
20409 list = XCDR (tail);
20410 else
20411 Fsetcdr (prev, XCDR (tail));
20413 /* Now make it the first. */
20414 Fsetcdr (tail, list);
20415 return tail;
20417 else
20418 prev = tail;
20419 tail = XCDR (tail);
20420 QUIT;
20423 /* Not found--return unchanged LIST. */
20424 return list;
20427 /* Contribute ELT to the mode line for window IT->w. How it
20428 translates into text depends on its data type.
20430 IT describes the display environment in which we display, as usual.
20432 DEPTH is the depth in recursion. It is used to prevent
20433 infinite recursion here.
20435 FIELD_WIDTH is the number of characters the display of ELT should
20436 occupy in the mode line, and PRECISION is the maximum number of
20437 characters to display from ELT's representation. See
20438 display_string for details.
20440 Returns the hpos of the end of the text generated by ELT.
20442 PROPS is a property list to add to any string we encounter.
20444 If RISKY is nonzero, remove (disregard) any properties in any string
20445 we encounter, and ignore :eval and :propertize.
20447 The global variable `mode_line_target' determines whether the
20448 output is passed to `store_mode_line_noprop',
20449 `store_mode_line_string', or `display_string'. */
20451 static int
20452 display_mode_element (struct it *it, int depth, int field_width, int precision,
20453 Lisp_Object elt, Lisp_Object props, int risky)
20455 int n = 0, field, prec;
20456 int literal = 0;
20458 tail_recurse:
20459 if (depth > 100)
20460 elt = build_string ("*too-deep*");
20462 depth++;
20464 switch (XTYPE (elt))
20466 case Lisp_String:
20468 /* A string: output it and check for %-constructs within it. */
20469 unsigned char c;
20470 ptrdiff_t offset = 0;
20472 if (SCHARS (elt) > 0
20473 && (!NILP (props) || risky))
20475 Lisp_Object oprops, aelt;
20476 oprops = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (0), elt);
20478 /* If the starting string's properties are not what
20479 we want, translate the string. Also, if the string
20480 is risky, do that anyway. */
20482 if (NILP (Fequal (props, oprops)) || risky)
20484 /* If the starting string has properties,
20485 merge the specified ones onto the existing ones. */
20486 if (! NILP (oprops) && !risky)
20488 Lisp_Object tem;
20490 oprops = Fcopy_sequence (oprops);
20491 tem = props;
20492 while (CONSP (tem))
20494 oprops = Fplist_put (oprops, XCAR (tem),
20495 XCAR (XCDR (tem)));
20496 tem = XCDR (XCDR (tem));
20498 props = oprops;
20501 aelt = Fassoc (elt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20502 if (! NILP (aelt) && !NILP (Fequal (props, XCDR (aelt))))
20504 /* AELT is what we want. Move it to the front
20505 without consing. */
20506 elt = XCAR (aelt);
20507 mode_line_proptrans_alist
20508 = move_elt_to_front (aelt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20510 else
20512 Lisp_Object tem;
20514 /* If AELT has the wrong props, it is useless.
20515 so get rid of it. */
20516 if (! NILP (aelt))
20517 mode_line_proptrans_alist
20518 = Fdelq (aelt, mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20520 elt = Fcopy_sequence (elt);
20521 Fset_text_properties (make_number (0), Flength (elt),
20522 props, elt);
20523 /* Add this item to mode_line_proptrans_alist. */
20524 mode_line_proptrans_alist
20525 = Fcons (Fcons (elt, props),
20526 mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20527 /* Truncate mode_line_proptrans_alist
20528 to at most 50 elements. */
20529 tem = Fnthcdr (make_number (50),
20530 mode_line_proptrans_alist);
20531 if (! NILP (tem))
20532 XSETCDR (tem, Qnil);
20537 offset = 0;
20539 if (literal)
20541 prec = precision - n;
20542 switch (mode_line_target)
20544 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20545 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20546 n += store_mode_line_noprop (SSDATA (elt), -1, prec);
20547 break;
20548 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20549 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL, elt, 1, 0, prec, Qnil);
20550 break;
20551 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20552 n += display_string (NULL, elt, Qnil, 0, 0, it,
20553 0, prec, 0, STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt));
20554 break;
20557 break;
20560 /* Handle the non-literal case. */
20562 while ((precision <= 0 || n < precision)
20563 && SREF (elt, offset) != 0
20564 && (mode_line_target != MODE_LINE_DISPLAY
20565 || it->current_x < it->last_visible_x))
20567 ptrdiff_t last_offset = offset;
20569 /* Advance to end of string or next format specifier. */
20570 while ((c = SREF (elt, offset++)) != '\0' && c != '%')
20573 if (offset - 1 != last_offset)
20575 ptrdiff_t nchars, nbytes;
20577 /* Output to end of string or up to '%'. Field width
20578 is length of string. Don't output more than
20579 PRECISION allows us. */
20580 offset--;
20582 prec = c_string_width (SDATA (elt) + last_offset,
20583 offset - last_offset, precision - n,
20584 &nchars, &nbytes);
20586 switch (mode_line_target)
20588 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20589 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20590 n += store_mode_line_noprop (SSDATA (elt) + last_offset, 0, prec);
20591 break;
20592 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20594 ptrdiff_t bytepos = last_offset;
20595 ptrdiff_t charpos = string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos);
20596 ptrdiff_t endpos = (precision <= 0
20597 ? string_byte_to_char (elt, offset)
20598 : charpos + nchars);
20600 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL,
20601 Fsubstring (elt, make_number (charpos),
20602 make_number (endpos)),
20603 0, 0, 0, Qnil);
20605 break;
20606 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20608 ptrdiff_t bytepos = last_offset;
20609 ptrdiff_t charpos = string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos);
20611 if (precision <= 0)
20612 nchars = string_byte_to_char (elt, offset) - charpos;
20613 n += display_string (NULL, elt, Qnil, 0, charpos,
20614 it, 0, nchars, 0,
20615 STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt));
20617 break;
20620 else /* c == '%' */
20622 ptrdiff_t percent_position = offset;
20624 /* Get the specified minimum width. Zero means
20625 don't pad. */
20626 field = 0;
20627 while ((c = SREF (elt, offset++)) >= '0' && c <= '9')
20628 field = field * 10 + c - '0';
20630 /* Don't pad beyond the total padding allowed. */
20631 if (field_width - n > 0 && field > field_width - n)
20632 field = field_width - n;
20634 /* Note that either PRECISION <= 0 or N < PRECISION. */
20635 prec = precision - n;
20637 if (c == 'M')
20638 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field, prec,
20639 Vglobal_mode_string, props,
20640 risky);
20641 else if (c != 0)
20643 int multibyte;
20644 ptrdiff_t bytepos, charpos;
20645 const char *spec;
20646 Lisp_Object string;
20648 bytepos = percent_position;
20649 charpos = (STRING_MULTIBYTE (elt)
20650 ? string_byte_to_char (elt, bytepos)
20651 : bytepos);
20652 spec = decode_mode_spec (it->w, c, field, &string);
20653 multibyte = STRINGP (string) && STRING_MULTIBYTE (string);
20655 switch (mode_line_target)
20657 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20658 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20659 n += store_mode_line_noprop (spec, field, prec);
20660 break;
20661 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20663 Lisp_Object tem = build_string (spec);
20664 props = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (charpos), elt);
20665 /* Should only keep face property in props */
20666 n += store_mode_line_string (NULL, tem, 0, field, prec, props);
20668 break;
20669 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20671 int nglyphs_before, nwritten;
20673 nglyphs_before = it->glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA];
20674 nwritten = display_string (spec, string, elt,
20675 charpos, 0, it,
20676 field, prec, 0,
20677 multibyte);
20679 /* Assign to the glyphs written above the
20680 string where the `%x' came from, position
20681 of the `%'. */
20682 if (nwritten > 0)
20684 struct glyph *glyph
20685 = (it->glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
20686 + nglyphs_before);
20687 int i;
20689 for (i = 0; i < nwritten; ++i)
20691 glyph[i].object = elt;
20692 glyph[i].charpos = charpos;
20695 n += nwritten;
20698 break;
20701 else /* c == 0 */
20702 break;
20706 break;
20708 case Lisp_Symbol:
20709 /* A symbol: process the value of the symbol recursively
20710 as if it appeared here directly. Avoid error if symbol void.
20711 Special case: if value of symbol is a string, output the string
20712 literally. */
20714 register Lisp_Object tem;
20716 /* If the variable is not marked as risky to set
20717 then its contents are risky to use. */
20718 if (NILP (Fget (elt, Qrisky_local_variable)))
20719 risky = 1;
20721 tem = Fboundp (elt);
20722 if (!NILP (tem))
20724 tem = Fsymbol_value (elt);
20725 /* If value is a string, output that string literally:
20726 don't check for % within it. */
20727 if (STRINGP (tem))
20728 literal = 1;
20730 if (!EQ (tem, elt))
20732 /* Give up right away for nil or t. */
20733 elt = tem;
20734 goto tail_recurse;
20738 break;
20740 case Lisp_Cons:
20742 register Lisp_Object car, tem;
20744 /* A cons cell: five distinct cases.
20745 If first element is :eval or :propertize, do something special.
20746 If first element is a string or a cons, process all the elements
20747 and effectively concatenate them.
20748 If first element is a negative number, truncate displaying cdr to
20749 at most that many characters. If positive, pad (with spaces)
20750 to at least that many characters.
20751 If first element is a symbol, process the cadr or caddr recursively
20752 according to whether the symbol's value is non-nil or nil. */
20753 car = XCAR (elt);
20754 if (EQ (car, QCeval))
20756 /* An element of the form (:eval FORM) means evaluate FORM
20757 and use the result as mode line elements. */
20759 if (risky)
20760 break;
20762 if (CONSP (XCDR (elt)))
20764 Lisp_Object spec;
20765 spec = safe_eval (XCAR (XCDR (elt)));
20766 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field_width - n,
20767 precision - n, spec, props,
20768 risky);
20771 else if (EQ (car, QCpropertize))
20773 /* An element of the form (:propertize ELT PROPS...)
20774 means display ELT but applying properties PROPS. */
20776 if (risky)
20777 break;
20779 if (CONSP (XCDR (elt)))
20780 n += display_mode_element (it, depth, field_width - n,
20781 precision - n, XCAR (XCDR (elt)),
20782 XCDR (XCDR (elt)), risky);
20784 else if (SYMBOLP (car))
20786 tem = Fboundp (car);
20787 elt = XCDR (elt);
20788 if (!CONSP (elt))
20789 goto invalid;
20790 /* elt is now the cdr, and we know it is a cons cell.
20791 Use its car if CAR has a non-nil value. */
20792 if (!NILP (tem))
20794 tem = Fsymbol_value (car);
20795 if (!NILP (tem))
20797 elt = XCAR (elt);
20798 goto tail_recurse;
20801 /* Symbol's value is nil (or symbol is unbound)
20802 Get the cddr of the original list
20803 and if possible find the caddr and use that. */
20804 elt = XCDR (elt);
20805 if (NILP (elt))
20806 break;
20807 else if (!CONSP (elt))
20808 goto invalid;
20809 elt = XCAR (elt);
20810 goto tail_recurse;
20812 else if (INTEGERP (car))
20814 register int lim = XINT (car);
20815 elt = XCDR (elt);
20816 if (lim < 0)
20818 /* Negative int means reduce maximum width. */
20819 if (precision <= 0)
20820 precision = -lim;
20821 else
20822 precision = min (precision, -lim);
20824 else if (lim > 0)
20826 /* Padding specified. Don't let it be more than
20827 current maximum. */
20828 if (precision > 0)
20829 lim = min (precision, lim);
20831 /* If that's more padding than already wanted, queue it.
20832 But don't reduce padding already specified even if
20833 that is beyond the current truncation point. */
20834 field_width = max (lim, field_width);
20836 goto tail_recurse;
20838 else if (STRINGP (car) || CONSP (car))
20840 Lisp_Object halftail = elt;
20841 int len = 0;
20843 while (CONSP (elt)
20844 && (precision <= 0 || n < precision))
20846 n += display_mode_element (it, depth,
20847 /* Do padding only after the last
20848 element in the list. */
20849 (! CONSP (XCDR (elt))
20850 ? field_width - n
20851 : 0),
20852 precision - n, XCAR (elt),
20853 props, risky);
20854 elt = XCDR (elt);
20855 len++;
20856 if ((len & 1) == 0)
20857 halftail = XCDR (halftail);
20858 /* Check for cycle. */
20859 if (EQ (halftail, elt))
20860 break;
20864 break;
20866 default:
20867 invalid:
20868 elt = build_string ("*invalid*");
20869 goto tail_recurse;
20872 /* Pad to FIELD_WIDTH. */
20873 if (field_width > 0 && n < field_width)
20875 switch (mode_line_target)
20877 case MODE_LINE_NOPROP:
20878 case MODE_LINE_TITLE:
20879 n += store_mode_line_noprop ("", field_width - n, 0);
20880 break;
20881 case MODE_LINE_STRING:
20882 n += store_mode_line_string ("", Qnil, 0, field_width - n, 0, Qnil);
20883 break;
20884 case MODE_LINE_DISPLAY:
20885 n += display_string ("", Qnil, Qnil, 0, 0, it, field_width - n,
20886 0, 0, 0);
20887 break;
20891 return n;
20894 /* Store a mode-line string element in mode_line_string_list.
20896 If STRING is non-null, display that C string. Otherwise, the Lisp
20897 string LISP_STRING is displayed.
20899 FIELD_WIDTH is the minimum number of output glyphs to produce.
20900 If STRING has fewer characters than FIELD_WIDTH, pad to the right
20901 with spaces. FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't pad.
20903 PRECISION is the maximum number of characters to output from
20904 STRING. PRECISION <= 0 means don't truncate the string.
20906 If COPY_STRING is non-zero, make a copy of LISP_STRING before adding
20907 properties to the string.
20909 PROPS are the properties to add to the string.
20910 The mode_line_string_face face property is always added to the string.
20913 static int
20914 store_mode_line_string (const char *string, Lisp_Object lisp_string, int copy_string,
20915 int field_width, int precision, Lisp_Object props)
20917 ptrdiff_t len;
20918 int n = 0;
20920 if (string != NULL)
20922 len = strlen (string);
20923 if (precision > 0 && len > precision)
20924 len = precision;
20925 lisp_string = make_string (string, len);
20926 if (NILP (props))
20927 props = mode_line_string_face_prop;
20928 else if (!NILP (mode_line_string_face))
20930 Lisp_Object face = Fplist_get (props, Qface);
20931 props = Fcopy_sequence (props);
20932 if (NILP (face))
20933 face = mode_line_string_face;
20934 else
20935 face = Fcons (face, Fcons (mode_line_string_face, Qnil));
20936 props = Fplist_put (props, Qface, face);
20938 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (len),
20939 props, lisp_string);
20941 else
20943 len = XFASTINT (Flength (lisp_string));
20944 if (precision > 0 && len > precision)
20946 len = precision;
20947 lisp_string = Fsubstring (lisp_string, make_number (0), make_number (len));
20948 precision = -1;
20950 if (!NILP (mode_line_string_face))
20952 Lisp_Object face;
20953 if (NILP (props))
20954 props = Ftext_properties_at (make_number (0), lisp_string);
20955 face = Fplist_get (props, Qface);
20956 if (NILP (face))
20957 face = mode_line_string_face;
20958 else
20959 face = Fcons (face, Fcons (mode_line_string_face, Qnil));
20960 props = Fcons (Qface, Fcons (face, Qnil));
20961 if (copy_string)
20962 lisp_string = Fcopy_sequence (lisp_string);
20964 if (!NILP (props))
20965 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (len),
20966 props, lisp_string);
20969 if (len > 0)
20971 mode_line_string_list = Fcons (lisp_string, mode_line_string_list);
20972 n += len;
20975 if (field_width > len)
20977 field_width -= len;
20978 lisp_string = Fmake_string (make_number (field_width), make_number (' '));
20979 if (!NILP (props))
20980 Fadd_text_properties (make_number (0), make_number (field_width),
20981 props, lisp_string);
20982 mode_line_string_list = Fcons (lisp_string, mode_line_string_list);
20983 n += field_width;
20986 return n;
20990 DEFUN ("format-mode-line", Fformat_mode_line, Sformat_mode_line,
20991 1, 4, 0,
20992 doc: /* Format a string out of a mode line format specification.
20993 First arg FORMAT specifies the mode line format (see `mode-line-format'
20994 for details) to use.
20996 By default, the format is evaluated for the currently selected window.
20998 Optional second arg FACE specifies the face property to put on all
20999 characters for which no face is specified. The value nil means the
21000 default face. The value t means whatever face the window's mode line
21001 currently uses (either `mode-line' or `mode-line-inactive',
21002 depending on whether the window is the selected window or not).
21003 An integer value means the value string has no text
21004 properties.
21006 Optional third and fourth args WINDOW and BUFFER specify the window
21007 and buffer to use as the context for the formatting (defaults
21008 are the selected window and the WINDOW's buffer). */)
21009 (Lisp_Object format, Lisp_Object face,
21010 Lisp_Object window, Lisp_Object buffer)
21012 struct it it;
21013 int len;
21014 struct window *w;
21015 struct buffer *old_buffer = NULL;
21016 int face_id;
21017 int no_props = INTEGERP (face);
21018 ptrdiff_t count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
21019 Lisp_Object str;
21020 int string_start = 0;
21022 if (NILP (window))
21023 window = selected_window;
21024 CHECK_WINDOW (window);
21025 w = XWINDOW (window);
21027 if (NILP (buffer))
21028 buffer = w->buffer;
21029 CHECK_BUFFER (buffer);
21031 /* Make formatting the modeline a non-op when noninteractive, otherwise
21032 there will be problems later caused by a partially initialized frame. */
21033 if (NILP (format) || noninteractive)
21034 return empty_unibyte_string;
21036 if (no_props)
21037 face = Qnil;
21039 face_id = (NILP (face) || EQ (face, Qdefault)) ? DEFAULT_FACE_ID
21040 : EQ (face, Qt) ? (EQ (window, selected_window)
21041 ? MODE_LINE_FACE_ID : MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID)
21042 : EQ (face, Qmode_line) ? MODE_LINE_FACE_ID
21043 : EQ (face, Qmode_line_inactive) ? MODE_LINE_INACTIVE_FACE_ID
21044 : EQ (face, Qheader_line) ? HEADER_LINE_FACE_ID
21045 : EQ (face, Qtool_bar) ? TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
21046 : DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
21048 if (XBUFFER (buffer) != current_buffer)
21049 old_buffer = current_buffer;
21051 /* Save things including mode_line_proptrans_alist,
21052 and set that to nil so that we don't alter the outer value. */
21053 record_unwind_protect (unwind_format_mode_line,
21054 format_mode_line_unwind_data
21055 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (window))),
21056 old_buffer, selected_window, 1));
21057 mode_line_proptrans_alist = Qnil;
21059 Fselect_window (window, Qt);
21060 if (old_buffer)
21061 set_buffer_internal_1 (XBUFFER (buffer));
21063 init_iterator (&it, w, -1, -1, NULL, face_id);
21065 if (no_props)
21067 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_NOPROP;
21068 mode_line_string_face_prop = Qnil;
21069 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
21070 string_start = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (0);
21072 else
21074 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_STRING;
21075 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
21076 mode_line_string_face = face;
21077 mode_line_string_face_prop
21078 = (NILP (face) ? Qnil : Fcons (Qface, Fcons (face, Qnil)));
21081 push_kboard (FRAME_KBOARD (it.f));
21082 display_mode_element (&it, 0, 0, 0, format, Qnil, 0);
21083 pop_kboard ();
21085 if (no_props)
21087 len = MODE_LINE_NOPROP_LEN (string_start);
21088 str = make_string (mode_line_noprop_buf + string_start, len);
21090 else
21092 mode_line_string_list = Fnreverse (mode_line_string_list);
21093 str = Fmapconcat (intern ("identity"), mode_line_string_list,
21094 empty_unibyte_string);
21097 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
21098 return str;
21101 /* Write a null-terminated, right justified decimal representation of
21102 the positive integer D to BUF using a minimal field width WIDTH. */
21104 static void
21105 pint2str (register char *buf, register int width, register ptrdiff_t d)
21107 register char *p = buf;
21109 if (d <= 0)
21110 *p++ = '0';
21111 else
21113 while (d > 0)
21115 *p++ = d % 10 + '0';
21116 d /= 10;
21120 for (width -= (int) (p - buf); width > 0; --width)
21121 *p++ = ' ';
21122 *p-- = '\0';
21123 while (p > buf)
21125 d = *buf;
21126 *buf++ = *p;
21127 *p-- = d;
21131 /* Write a null-terminated, right justified decimal and "human
21132 readable" representation of the nonnegative integer D to BUF using
21133 a minimal field width WIDTH. D should be smaller than 999.5e24. */
21135 static const char power_letter[] =
21137 0, /* no letter */
21138 'k', /* kilo */
21139 'M', /* mega */
21140 'G', /* giga */
21141 'T', /* tera */
21142 'P', /* peta */
21143 'E', /* exa */
21144 'Z', /* zetta */
21145 'Y' /* yotta */
21148 static void
21149 pint2hrstr (char *buf, int width, ptrdiff_t d)
21151 /* We aim to represent the nonnegative integer D as
21152 QUOTIENT.TENTHS * 10 ^ (3 * EXPONENT). */
21153 ptrdiff_t quotient = d;
21154 int remainder = 0;
21155 /* -1 means: do not use TENTHS. */
21156 int tenths = -1;
21157 int exponent = 0;
21159 /* Length of QUOTIENT.TENTHS as a string. */
21160 int length;
21162 char * psuffix;
21163 char * p;
21165 if (1000 <= quotient)
21167 /* Scale to the appropriate EXPONENT. */
21170 remainder = quotient % 1000;
21171 quotient /= 1000;
21172 exponent++;
21174 while (1000 <= quotient);
21176 /* Round to nearest and decide whether to use TENTHS or not. */
21177 if (quotient <= 9)
21179 tenths = remainder / 100;
21180 if (50 <= remainder % 100)
21182 if (tenths < 9)
21183 tenths++;
21184 else
21186 quotient++;
21187 if (quotient == 10)
21188 tenths = -1;
21189 else
21190 tenths = 0;
21194 else
21195 if (500 <= remainder)
21197 if (quotient < 999)
21198 quotient++;
21199 else
21201 quotient = 1;
21202 exponent++;
21203 tenths = 0;
21208 /* Calculate the LENGTH of QUOTIENT.TENTHS as a string. */
21209 if (tenths == -1 && quotient <= 99)
21210 if (quotient <= 9)
21211 length = 1;
21212 else
21213 length = 2;
21214 else
21215 length = 3;
21216 p = psuffix = buf + max (width, length);
21218 /* Print EXPONENT. */
21219 *psuffix++ = power_letter[exponent];
21220 *psuffix = '\0';
21222 /* Print TENTHS. */
21223 if (tenths >= 0)
21225 *--p = '0' + tenths;
21226 *--p = '.';
21229 /* Print QUOTIENT. */
21232 int digit = quotient % 10;
21233 *--p = '0' + digit;
21235 while ((quotient /= 10) != 0);
21237 /* Print leading spaces. */
21238 while (buf < p)
21239 *--p = ' ';
21242 /* Set a mnemonic character for coding_system (Lisp symbol) in BUF.
21243 If EOL_FLAG is 1, set also a mnemonic character for end-of-line
21244 type of CODING_SYSTEM. Return updated pointer into BUF. */
21246 static unsigned char invalid_eol_type[] = "(*invalid*)";
21248 static char *
21249 decode_mode_spec_coding (Lisp_Object coding_system, register char *buf, int eol_flag)
21251 Lisp_Object val;
21252 int multibyte = !NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, enable_multibyte_characters));
21253 const unsigned char *eol_str;
21254 int eol_str_len;
21255 /* The EOL conversion we are using. */
21256 Lisp_Object eoltype;
21258 val = CODING_SYSTEM_SPEC (coding_system);
21259 eoltype = Qnil;
21261 if (!VECTORP (val)) /* Not yet decided. */
21263 *buf++ = multibyte ? '-' : ' ';
21264 if (eol_flag)
21265 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
21266 /* Don't mention EOL conversion if it isn't decided. */
21268 else
21270 Lisp_Object attrs;
21271 Lisp_Object eolvalue;
21273 attrs = AREF (val, 0);
21274 eolvalue = AREF (val, 2);
21276 *buf++ = multibyte
21277 ? XFASTINT (CODING_ATTR_MNEMONIC (attrs))
21278 : ' ';
21280 if (eol_flag)
21282 /* The EOL conversion that is normal on this system. */
21284 if (NILP (eolvalue)) /* Not yet decided. */
21285 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
21286 else if (VECTORP (eolvalue)) /* Not yet decided. */
21287 eoltype = eol_mnemonic_undecided;
21288 else /* eolvalue is Qunix, Qdos, or Qmac. */
21289 eoltype = (EQ (eolvalue, Qunix)
21290 ? eol_mnemonic_unix
21291 : (EQ (eolvalue, Qdos) == 1
21292 ? eol_mnemonic_dos : eol_mnemonic_mac));
21296 if (eol_flag)
21298 /* Mention the EOL conversion if it is not the usual one. */
21299 if (STRINGP (eoltype))
21301 eol_str = SDATA (eoltype);
21302 eol_str_len = SBYTES (eoltype);
21304 else if (CHARACTERP (eoltype))
21306 unsigned char *tmp = alloca (MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH);
21307 int c = XFASTINT (eoltype);
21308 eol_str_len = CHAR_STRING (c, tmp);
21309 eol_str = tmp;
21311 else
21313 eol_str = invalid_eol_type;
21314 eol_str_len = sizeof (invalid_eol_type) - 1;
21316 memcpy (buf, eol_str, eol_str_len);
21317 buf += eol_str_len;
21320 return buf;
21323 /* Return a string for the output of a mode line %-spec for window W,
21324 generated by character C. FIELD_WIDTH > 0 means pad the string
21325 returned with spaces to that value. Return a Lisp string in
21326 *STRING if the resulting string is taken from that Lisp string.
21328 Note we operate on the current buffer for most purposes,
21329 the exception being w->base_line_pos. */
21331 static char lots_of_dashes[] = "--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------";
21333 static const char *
21334 decode_mode_spec (struct window *w, register int c, int field_width,
21335 Lisp_Object *string)
21337 Lisp_Object obj;
21338 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
21339 char *decode_mode_spec_buf = f->decode_mode_spec_buffer;
21340 struct buffer *b = current_buffer;
21342 obj = Qnil;
21343 *string = Qnil;
21345 switch (c)
21347 case '*':
21348 if (!NILP (BVAR (b, read_only)))
21349 return "%";
21350 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
21351 return "*";
21352 return "-";
21354 case '+':
21355 /* This differs from %* only for a modified read-only buffer. */
21356 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
21357 return "*";
21358 if (!NILP (BVAR (b, read_only)))
21359 return "%";
21360 return "-";
21362 case '&':
21363 /* This differs from %* in ignoring read-only-ness. */
21364 if (BUF_MODIFF (b) > BUF_SAVE_MODIFF (b))
21365 return "*";
21366 return "-";
21368 case '%':
21369 return "%";
21371 case '[':
21373 int i;
21374 char *p;
21376 if (command_loop_level > 5)
21377 return "[[[... ";
21378 p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21379 for (i = 0; i < command_loop_level; i++)
21380 *p++ = '[';
21381 *p = 0;
21382 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21385 case ']':
21387 int i;
21388 char *p;
21390 if (command_loop_level > 5)
21391 return " ...]]]";
21392 p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21393 for (i = 0; i < command_loop_level; i++)
21394 *p++ = ']';
21395 *p = 0;
21396 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21399 case '-':
21401 register int i;
21403 /* Let lots_of_dashes be a string of infinite length. */
21404 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_NOPROP ||
21405 mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_STRING)
21406 return "--";
21407 if (field_width <= 0
21408 || field_width > sizeof (lots_of_dashes))
21410 for (i = 0; i < FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f) - 1; ++i)
21411 decode_mode_spec_buf[i] = '-';
21412 decode_mode_spec_buf[i] = '\0';
21413 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21415 else
21416 return lots_of_dashes;
21419 case 'b':
21420 obj = BVAR (b, name);
21421 break;
21423 case 'c':
21424 /* %c and %l are ignored in `frame-title-format'.
21425 (In redisplay_internal, the frame title is drawn _before_ the
21426 windows are updated, so the stuff which depends on actual
21427 window contents (such as %l) may fail to render properly, or
21428 even crash emacs.) */
21429 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_TITLE)
21430 return "";
21431 else
21433 ptrdiff_t col = current_column ();
21434 wset_column_number_displayed (w, make_number (col));
21435 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, field_width, col);
21436 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21439 case 'e':
21440 #ifndef SYSTEM_MALLOC
21442 if (NILP (Vmemory_full))
21443 return "";
21444 else
21445 return "!MEM FULL! ";
21447 #else
21448 return "";
21449 #endif
21451 case 'F':
21452 /* %F displays the frame name. */
21453 if (!NILP (f->title))
21454 return SSDATA (f->title);
21455 if (f->explicit_name || ! FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
21456 return SSDATA (f->name);
21457 return "Emacs";
21459 case 'f':
21460 obj = BVAR (b, filename);
21461 break;
21463 case 'i':
21465 ptrdiff_t size = ZV - BEGV;
21466 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, field_width, size);
21467 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21470 case 'I':
21472 ptrdiff_t size = ZV - BEGV;
21473 pint2hrstr (decode_mode_spec_buf, field_width, size);
21474 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21477 case 'l':
21479 ptrdiff_t startpos, startpos_byte, line, linepos, linepos_byte;
21480 ptrdiff_t topline, nlines, height;
21481 ptrdiff_t junk;
21483 /* %c and %l are ignored in `frame-title-format'. */
21484 if (mode_line_target == MODE_LINE_TITLE)
21485 return "";
21487 startpos = XMARKER (w->start)->charpos;
21488 startpos_byte = marker_byte_position (w->start);
21489 height = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w);
21491 /* If we decided that this buffer isn't suitable for line numbers,
21492 don't forget that too fast. */
21493 if (EQ (w->base_line_pos, w->buffer))
21494 goto no_value;
21495 /* But do forget it, if the window shows a different buffer now. */
21496 else if (BUFFERP (w->base_line_pos))
21497 wset_base_line_pos (w, Qnil);
21499 /* If the buffer is very big, don't waste time. */
21500 if (INTEGERP (Vline_number_display_limit)
21501 && BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b) > XINT (Vline_number_display_limit))
21503 wset_base_line_pos (w, Qnil);
21504 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
21505 goto no_value;
21508 if (INTEGERP (w->base_line_number)
21509 && INTEGERP (w->base_line_pos)
21510 && XFASTINT (w->base_line_pos) <= startpos)
21512 line = XFASTINT (w->base_line_number);
21513 linepos = XFASTINT (w->base_line_pos);
21514 linepos_byte = buf_charpos_to_bytepos (b, linepos);
21516 else
21518 line = 1;
21519 linepos = BUF_BEGV (b);
21520 linepos_byte = BUF_BEGV_BYTE (b);
21523 /* Count lines from base line to window start position. */
21524 nlines = display_count_lines (linepos_byte,
21525 startpos_byte,
21526 startpos, &junk);
21528 topline = nlines + line;
21530 /* Determine a new base line, if the old one is too close
21531 or too far away, or if we did not have one.
21532 "Too close" means it's plausible a scroll-down would
21533 go back past it. */
21534 if (startpos == BUF_BEGV (b))
21536 wset_base_line_number (w, make_number (topline));
21537 wset_base_line_pos (w, make_number (BUF_BEGV (b)));
21539 else if (nlines < height + 25 || nlines > height * 3 + 50
21540 || linepos == BUF_BEGV (b))
21542 ptrdiff_t limit = BUF_BEGV (b);
21543 ptrdiff_t limit_byte = BUF_BEGV_BYTE (b);
21544 ptrdiff_t position;
21545 ptrdiff_t distance =
21546 (height * 2 + 30) * line_number_display_limit_width;
21548 if (startpos - distance > limit)
21550 limit = startpos - distance;
21551 limit_byte = CHAR_TO_BYTE (limit);
21554 nlines = display_count_lines (startpos_byte,
21555 limit_byte,
21556 - (height * 2 + 30),
21557 &position);
21558 /* If we couldn't find the lines we wanted within
21559 line_number_display_limit_width chars per line,
21560 give up on line numbers for this window. */
21561 if (position == limit_byte && limit == startpos - distance)
21563 wset_base_line_pos (w, w->buffer);
21564 wset_base_line_number (w, Qnil);
21565 goto no_value;
21568 wset_base_line_number (w, make_number (topline - nlines));
21569 wset_base_line_pos (w, make_number (BYTE_TO_CHAR (position)));
21572 /* Now count lines from the start pos to point. */
21573 nlines = display_count_lines (startpos_byte,
21574 PT_BYTE, PT, &junk);
21576 /* Record that we did display the line number. */
21577 line_number_displayed = 1;
21579 /* Make the string to show. */
21580 pint2str (decode_mode_spec_buf, field_width, topline + nlines);
21581 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21582 no_value:
21584 char* p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21585 int pad = field_width - 2;
21586 while (pad-- > 0)
21587 *p++ = ' ';
21588 *p++ = '?';
21589 *p++ = '?';
21590 *p = '\0';
21591 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21594 break;
21596 case 'm':
21597 obj = BVAR (b, mode_name);
21598 break;
21600 case 'n':
21601 if (BUF_BEGV (b) > BUF_BEG (b) || BUF_ZV (b) < BUF_Z (b))
21602 return " Narrow";
21603 break;
21605 case 'p':
21607 ptrdiff_t pos = marker_position (w->start);
21608 ptrdiff_t total = BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b);
21610 if (XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos) <= BUF_Z (b) - BUF_ZV (b))
21612 if (pos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21613 return "All";
21614 else
21615 return "Bottom";
21617 else if (pos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21618 return "Top";
21619 else
21621 if (total > 1000000)
21622 /* Do it differently for a large value, to avoid overflow. */
21623 total = ((pos - BUF_BEGV (b)) + (total / 100) - 1) / (total / 100);
21624 else
21625 total = ((pos - BUF_BEGV (b)) * 100 + total - 1) / total;
21626 /* We can't normally display a 3-digit number,
21627 so get us a 2-digit number that is close. */
21628 if (total == 100)
21629 total = 99;
21630 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "%2"pD"d%%", total);
21631 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21635 /* Display percentage of size above the bottom of the screen. */
21636 case 'P':
21638 ptrdiff_t toppos = marker_position (w->start);
21639 ptrdiff_t botpos = BUF_Z (b) - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos);
21640 ptrdiff_t total = BUF_ZV (b) - BUF_BEGV (b);
21642 if (botpos >= BUF_ZV (b))
21644 if (toppos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21645 return "All";
21646 else
21647 return "Bottom";
21649 else
21651 if (total > 1000000)
21652 /* Do it differently for a large value, to avoid overflow. */
21653 total = ((botpos - BUF_BEGV (b)) + (total / 100) - 1) / (total / 100);
21654 else
21655 total = ((botpos - BUF_BEGV (b)) * 100 + total - 1) / total;
21656 /* We can't normally display a 3-digit number,
21657 so get us a 2-digit number that is close. */
21658 if (total == 100)
21659 total = 99;
21660 if (toppos <= BUF_BEGV (b))
21661 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "Top%2"pD"d%%", total);
21662 else
21663 sprintf (decode_mode_spec_buf, "%2"pD"d%%", total);
21664 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21668 case 's':
21669 /* status of process */
21670 obj = Fget_buffer_process (Fcurrent_buffer ());
21671 if (NILP (obj))
21672 return "no process";
21673 #ifndef MSDOS
21674 obj = Fsymbol_name (Fprocess_status (obj));
21675 #endif
21676 break;
21678 case '@':
21680 ptrdiff_t count = inhibit_garbage_collection ();
21681 Lisp_Object val = call1 (intern ("file-remote-p"),
21682 BVAR (current_buffer, directory));
21683 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
21685 if (NILP (val))
21686 return "-";
21687 else
21688 return "@";
21691 case 't': /* indicate TEXT or BINARY */
21692 return "T";
21694 case 'z':
21695 /* coding-system (not including end-of-line format) */
21696 case 'Z':
21697 /* coding-system (including end-of-line type) */
21699 int eol_flag = (c == 'Z');
21700 char *p = decode_mode_spec_buf;
21702 if (! FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
21704 /* No need to mention EOL here--the terminal never needs
21705 to do EOL conversion. */
21706 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (CODING_ID_NAME
21707 (FRAME_KEYBOARD_CODING (f)->id),
21708 p, 0);
21709 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (CODING_ID_NAME
21710 (FRAME_TERMINAL_CODING (f)->id),
21711 p, 0);
21713 p = decode_mode_spec_coding (BVAR (b, buffer_file_coding_system),
21714 p, eol_flag);
21716 #if 0 /* This proves to be annoying; I think we can do without. -- rms. */
21717 #ifdef subprocesses
21718 obj = Fget_buffer_process (Fcurrent_buffer ());
21719 if (PROCESSP (obj))
21721 p = decode_mode_spec_coding
21722 (XPROCESS (obj)->decode_coding_system, p, eol_flag);
21723 p = decode_mode_spec_coding
21724 (XPROCESS (obj)->encode_coding_system, p, eol_flag);
21726 #endif /* subprocesses */
21727 #endif /* 0 */
21728 *p = 0;
21729 return decode_mode_spec_buf;
21733 if (STRINGP (obj))
21735 *string = obj;
21736 return SSDATA (obj);
21738 else
21739 return "";
21743 /* Count up to COUNT lines starting from START_BYTE.
21744 But don't go beyond LIMIT_BYTE.
21745 Return the number of lines thus found (always nonnegative).
21747 Set *BYTE_POS_PTR to 1 if we found COUNT lines, 0 if we hit LIMIT. */
21749 static ptrdiff_t
21750 display_count_lines (ptrdiff_t start_byte,
21751 ptrdiff_t limit_byte, ptrdiff_t count,
21752 ptrdiff_t *byte_pos_ptr)
21754 register unsigned char *cursor;
21755 unsigned char *base;
21757 register ptrdiff_t ceiling;
21758 register unsigned char *ceiling_addr;
21759 ptrdiff_t orig_count = count;
21761 /* If we are not in selective display mode,
21762 check only for newlines. */
21763 int selective_display = (!NILP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display))
21764 && !INTEGERP (BVAR (current_buffer, selective_display)));
21766 if (count > 0)
21768 while (start_byte < limit_byte)
21770 ceiling = BUFFER_CEILING_OF (start_byte);
21771 ceiling = min (limit_byte - 1, ceiling);
21772 ceiling_addr = BYTE_POS_ADDR (ceiling) + 1;
21773 base = (cursor = BYTE_POS_ADDR (start_byte));
21774 while (1)
21776 if (selective_display)
21777 while (*cursor != '\n' && *cursor != 015 && ++cursor != ceiling_addr)
21779 else
21780 while (*cursor != '\n' && ++cursor != ceiling_addr)
21783 if (cursor != ceiling_addr)
21785 if (--count == 0)
21787 start_byte += cursor - base + 1;
21788 *byte_pos_ptr = start_byte;
21789 return orig_count;
21791 else
21792 if (++cursor == ceiling_addr)
21793 break;
21795 else
21796 break;
21798 start_byte += cursor - base;
21801 else
21803 while (start_byte > limit_byte)
21805 ceiling = BUFFER_FLOOR_OF (start_byte - 1);
21806 ceiling = max (limit_byte, ceiling);
21807 ceiling_addr = BYTE_POS_ADDR (ceiling) - 1;
21808 base = (cursor = BYTE_POS_ADDR (start_byte - 1) + 1);
21809 while (1)
21811 if (selective_display)
21812 while (--cursor != ceiling_addr
21813 && *cursor != '\n' && *cursor != 015)
21815 else
21816 while (--cursor != ceiling_addr && *cursor != '\n')
21819 if (cursor != ceiling_addr)
21821 if (++count == 0)
21823 start_byte += cursor - base + 1;
21824 *byte_pos_ptr = start_byte;
21825 /* When scanning backwards, we should
21826 not count the newline posterior to which we stop. */
21827 return - orig_count - 1;
21830 else
21831 break;
21833 /* Here we add 1 to compensate for the last decrement
21834 of CURSOR, which took it past the valid range. */
21835 start_byte += cursor - base + 1;
21839 *byte_pos_ptr = limit_byte;
21841 if (count < 0)
21842 return - orig_count + count;
21843 return orig_count - count;
21849 /***********************************************************************
21850 Displaying strings
21851 ***********************************************************************/
21853 /* Display a NUL-terminated string, starting with index START.
21855 If STRING is non-null, display that C string. Otherwise, the Lisp
21856 string LISP_STRING is displayed. There's a case that STRING is
21857 non-null and LISP_STRING is not nil. It means STRING is a string
21858 data of LISP_STRING. In that case, we display LISP_STRING while
21859 ignoring its text properties.
21861 If FACE_STRING is not nil, FACE_STRING_POS is a position in
21862 FACE_STRING. Display STRING or LISP_STRING with the face at
21863 FACE_STRING_POS in FACE_STRING:
21865 Display the string in the environment given by IT, but use the
21866 standard display table, temporarily.
21868 FIELD_WIDTH is the minimum number of output glyphs to produce.
21869 If STRING has fewer characters than FIELD_WIDTH, pad to the right
21870 with spaces. If STRING has more characters, more than FIELD_WIDTH
21871 glyphs will be produced. FIELD_WIDTH <= 0 means don't pad.
21873 PRECISION is the maximum number of characters to output from
21874 STRING. PRECISION < 0 means don't truncate the string.
21876 This is roughly equivalent to printf format specifiers:
21878 FIELD_WIDTH PRECISION PRINTF
21879 ----------------------------------------
21880 -1 -1 %s
21881 -1 10 %.10s
21882 10 -1 %10s
21883 20 10 %20.10s
21885 MULTIBYTE zero means do not display multibyte chars, > 0 means do
21886 display them, and < 0 means obey the current buffer's value of
21887 enable_multibyte_characters.
21889 Value is the number of columns displayed. */
21891 static int
21892 display_string (const char *string, Lisp_Object lisp_string, Lisp_Object face_string,
21893 ptrdiff_t face_string_pos, ptrdiff_t start, struct it *it,
21894 int field_width, int precision, int max_x, int multibyte)
21896 int hpos_at_start = it->hpos;
21897 int saved_face_id = it->face_id;
21898 struct glyph_row *row = it->glyph_row;
21899 ptrdiff_t it_charpos;
21901 /* Initialize the iterator IT for iteration over STRING beginning
21902 with index START. */
21903 reseat_to_string (it, NILP (lisp_string) ? string : NULL, lisp_string, start,
21904 precision, field_width, multibyte);
21905 if (string && STRINGP (lisp_string))
21906 /* LISP_STRING is the one returned by decode_mode_spec. We should
21907 ignore its text properties. */
21908 it->stop_charpos = it->end_charpos;
21910 /* If displaying STRING, set up the face of the iterator from
21911 FACE_STRING, if that's given. */
21912 if (STRINGP (face_string))
21914 ptrdiff_t endptr;
21915 struct face *face;
21917 it->face_id
21918 = face_at_string_position (it->w, face_string, face_string_pos,
21919 0, it->region_beg_charpos,
21920 it->region_end_charpos,
21921 &endptr, it->base_face_id, 0);
21922 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
21923 it->face_box_p = face->box != FACE_NO_BOX;
21926 /* Set max_x to the maximum allowed X position. Don't let it go
21927 beyond the right edge of the window. */
21928 if (max_x <= 0)
21929 max_x = it->last_visible_x;
21930 else
21931 max_x = min (max_x, it->last_visible_x);
21933 /* Skip over display elements that are not visible. because IT->w is
21934 hscrolled. */
21935 if (it->current_x < it->first_visible_x)
21936 move_it_in_display_line_to (it, 100000, it->first_visible_x,
21937 MOVE_TO_POS | MOVE_TO_X);
21939 row->ascent = it->max_ascent;
21940 row->height = it->max_ascent + it->max_descent;
21941 row->phys_ascent = it->max_phys_ascent;
21942 row->phys_height = it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent;
21943 row->extra_line_spacing = it->max_extra_line_spacing;
21945 if (STRINGP (it->string))
21946 it_charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
21947 else
21948 it_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
21950 /* This condition is for the case that we are called with current_x
21951 past last_visible_x. */
21952 while (it->current_x < max_x)
21954 int x_before, x, n_glyphs_before, i, nglyphs;
21956 /* Get the next display element. */
21957 if (!get_next_display_element (it))
21958 break;
21960 /* Produce glyphs. */
21961 x_before = it->current_x;
21962 n_glyphs_before = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
21963 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (it);
21965 nglyphs = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - n_glyphs_before;
21966 i = 0;
21967 x = x_before;
21968 while (i < nglyphs)
21970 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + n_glyphs_before + i;
21972 if (it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
21973 && x + glyph->pixel_width > max_x)
21975 /* End of continued line or max_x reached. */
21976 if (CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (*glyph))
21978 /* A wide character is unbreakable. */
21979 if (row->reversed_p)
21980 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
21981 - n_glyphs_before);
21982 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before;
21983 it->current_x = x_before;
21985 else
21987 if (row->reversed_p)
21988 unproduce_glyphs (it, row->used[TEXT_AREA]
21989 - (n_glyphs_before + i));
21990 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = n_glyphs_before + i;
21991 it->current_x = x;
21993 break;
21995 else if (x + glyph->pixel_width >= it->first_visible_x)
21997 /* Glyph is at least partially visible. */
21998 ++it->hpos;
21999 if (x < it->first_visible_x)
22000 row->x = x - it->first_visible_x;
22002 else
22004 /* Glyph is off the left margin of the display area.
22005 Should not happen. */
22006 abort ();
22009 row->ascent = max (row->ascent, it->max_ascent);
22010 row->height = max (row->height, it->max_ascent + it->max_descent);
22011 row->phys_ascent = max (row->phys_ascent, it->max_phys_ascent);
22012 row->phys_height = max (row->phys_height,
22013 it->max_phys_ascent + it->max_phys_descent);
22014 row->extra_line_spacing = max (row->extra_line_spacing,
22015 it->max_extra_line_spacing);
22016 x += glyph->pixel_width;
22017 ++i;
22020 /* Stop if max_x reached. */
22021 if (i < nglyphs)
22022 break;
22024 /* Stop at line ends. */
22025 if (ITERATOR_AT_END_OF_LINE_P (it))
22027 it->continuation_lines_width = 0;
22028 break;
22031 set_iterator_to_next (it, 1);
22032 if (STRINGP (it->string))
22033 it_charpos = IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it);
22034 else
22035 it_charpos = IT_CHARPOS (*it);
22037 /* Stop if truncating at the right edge. */
22038 if (it->line_wrap == TRUNCATE
22039 && it->current_x >= it->last_visible_x)
22041 /* Add truncation mark, but don't do it if the line is
22042 truncated at a padding space. */
22043 if (it_charpos < it->string_nchars)
22045 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
22047 int ii, n;
22049 if (it->current_x > it->last_visible_x)
22051 if (!row->reversed_p)
22053 for (ii = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1; ii > 0; --ii)
22054 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][ii]))
22055 break;
22057 else
22059 for (ii = 0; ii < row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ii++)
22060 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][ii]))
22061 break;
22062 unproduce_glyphs (it, ii + 1);
22063 ii = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - (ii + 1);
22065 for (n = row->used[TEXT_AREA]; ii < n; ++ii)
22067 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = ii;
22068 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
22071 produce_special_glyphs (it, IT_TRUNCATION);
22073 row->truncated_on_right_p = 1;
22075 break;
22079 /* Maybe insert a truncation at the left. */
22080 if (it->first_visible_x
22081 && it_charpos > 0)
22083 if (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
22084 || (row->reversed_p
22085 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
22086 : WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)) == 0)
22087 insert_left_trunc_glyphs (it);
22088 row->truncated_on_left_p = 1;
22091 it->face_id = saved_face_id;
22093 /* Value is number of columns displayed. */
22094 return it->hpos - hpos_at_start;
22099 /* This is like a combination of memq and assq. Return 1/2 if PROPVAL
22100 appears as an element of LIST or as the car of an element of LIST.
22101 If PROPVAL is a list, compare each element against LIST in that
22102 way, and return 1/2 if any element of PROPVAL is found in LIST.
22103 Otherwise return 0. This function cannot quit.
22104 The return value is 2 if the text is invisible but with an ellipsis
22105 and 1 if it's invisible and without an ellipsis. */
22108 invisible_p (register Lisp_Object propval, Lisp_Object list)
22110 register Lisp_Object tail, proptail;
22112 for (tail = list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
22114 register Lisp_Object tem;
22115 tem = XCAR (tail);
22116 if (EQ (propval, tem))
22117 return 1;
22118 if (CONSP (tem) && EQ (propval, XCAR (tem)))
22119 return NILP (XCDR (tem)) ? 1 : 2;
22122 if (CONSP (propval))
22124 for (proptail = propval; CONSP (proptail); proptail = XCDR (proptail))
22126 Lisp_Object propelt;
22127 propelt = XCAR (proptail);
22128 for (tail = list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
22130 register Lisp_Object tem;
22131 tem = XCAR (tail);
22132 if (EQ (propelt, tem))
22133 return 1;
22134 if (CONSP (tem) && EQ (propelt, XCAR (tem)))
22135 return NILP (XCDR (tem)) ? 1 : 2;
22140 return 0;
22143 DEFUN ("invisible-p", Finvisible_p, Sinvisible_p, 1, 1, 0,
22144 doc: /* Non-nil if the property makes the text invisible.
22145 POS-OR-PROP can be a marker or number, in which case it is taken to be
22146 a position in the current buffer and the value of the `invisible' property
22147 is checked; or it can be some other value, which is then presumed to be the
22148 value of the `invisible' property of the text of interest.
22149 The non-nil value returned can be t for truly invisible text or something
22150 else if the text is replaced by an ellipsis. */)
22151 (Lisp_Object pos_or_prop)
22153 Lisp_Object prop
22154 = (NATNUMP (pos_or_prop) || MARKERP (pos_or_prop)
22155 ? Fget_char_property (pos_or_prop, Qinvisible, Qnil)
22156 : pos_or_prop);
22157 int invis = TEXT_PROP_MEANS_INVISIBLE (prop);
22158 return (invis == 0 ? Qnil
22159 : invis == 1 ? Qt
22160 : make_number (invis));
22163 /* Calculate a width or height in pixels from a specification using
22164 the following elements:
22166 SPEC ::=
22167 NUM - a (fractional) multiple of the default font width/height
22168 (NUM) - specifies exactly NUM pixels
22169 UNIT - a fixed number of pixels, see below.
22170 ELEMENT - size of a display element in pixels, see below.
22171 (NUM . SPEC) - equals NUM * SPEC
22172 (+ SPEC SPEC ...) - add pixel values
22173 (- SPEC SPEC ...) - subtract pixel values
22174 (- SPEC) - negate pixel value
22176 NUM ::=
22177 INT or FLOAT - a number constant
22178 SYMBOL - use symbol's (buffer local) variable binding.
22180 UNIT ::=
22181 in - pixels per inch *)
22182 mm - pixels per 1/1000 meter *)
22183 cm - pixels per 1/100 meter *)
22184 width - width of current font in pixels.
22185 height - height of current font in pixels.
22187 *) using the ratio(s) defined in display-pixels-per-inch.
22189 ELEMENT ::=
22191 left-fringe - left fringe width in pixels
22192 right-fringe - right fringe width in pixels
22194 left-margin - left margin width in pixels
22195 right-margin - right margin width in pixels
22197 scroll-bar - scroll-bar area width in pixels
22199 Examples:
22201 Pixels corresponding to 5 inches:
22202 (5 . in)
22204 Total width of non-text areas on left side of window (if scroll-bar is on left):
22205 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin scroll-bar))
22207 Align to first text column (in header line):
22208 '(space :align-to 0)
22210 Align to middle of text area minus half the width of variable `my-image'
22211 containing a loaded image:
22212 '(space :align-to (0.5 . (- text my-image)))
22214 Width of left margin minus width of 1 character in the default font:
22215 '(space :width (- left-margin 1))
22217 Width of left margin minus width of 2 characters in the current font:
22218 '(space :width (- left-margin (2 . width)))
22220 Center 1 character over left-margin (in header line):
22221 '(space :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin) -0.5))
22223 Different ways to express width of left fringe plus left margin minus one pixel:
22224 '(space :width (- (+ left-fringe left-margin) (1)))
22225 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin (- (1))))
22226 '(space :width (+ left-fringe left-margin (-1)))
22230 #define NUMVAL(X) \
22231 ((INTEGERP (X) || FLOATP (X)) \
22232 ? XFLOATINT (X) \
22233 : - 1)
22235 static int
22236 calc_pixel_width_or_height (double *res, struct it *it, Lisp_Object prop,
22237 struct font *font, int width_p, int *align_to)
22239 double pixels;
22241 #define OK_PIXELS(val) ((*res = (double)(val)), 1)
22242 #define OK_ALIGN_TO(val) ((*align_to = (int)(val)), 1)
22244 if (NILP (prop))
22245 return OK_PIXELS (0);
22247 eassert (FRAME_LIVE_P (it->f));
22249 if (SYMBOLP (prop))
22251 if (SCHARS (SYMBOL_NAME (prop)) == 2)
22253 char *unit = SSDATA (SYMBOL_NAME (prop));
22255 if (unit[0] == 'i' && unit[1] == 'n')
22256 pixels = 1.0;
22257 else if (unit[0] == 'm' && unit[1] == 'm')
22258 pixels = 25.4;
22259 else if (unit[0] == 'c' && unit[1] == 'm')
22260 pixels = 2.54;
22261 else
22262 pixels = 0;
22263 if (pixels > 0)
22265 double ppi;
22266 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22267 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
22268 && (ppi = (width_p
22269 ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (it->f)->resx
22270 : FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (it->f)->resy),
22271 ppi > 0))
22272 return OK_PIXELS (ppi / pixels);
22273 #endif
22275 if ((ppi = NUMVAL (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch), ppi > 0)
22276 || (CONSP (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch)
22277 && (ppi = (width_p
22278 ? NUMVAL (XCAR (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch))
22279 : NUMVAL (XCDR (Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch))),
22280 ppi > 0)))
22281 return OK_PIXELS (ppi / pixels);
22283 return 0;
22287 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22288 if (EQ (prop, Qheight))
22289 return OK_PIXELS (font ? FONT_HEIGHT (font) : FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
22290 if (EQ (prop, Qwidth))
22291 return OK_PIXELS (font ? FONT_WIDTH (font) : FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f));
22292 #else
22293 if (EQ (prop, Qheight) || EQ (prop, Qwidth))
22294 return OK_PIXELS (1);
22295 #endif
22297 if (EQ (prop, Qtext))
22298 return OK_PIXELS (width_p
22299 ? window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA)
22300 : WINDOW_BOX_HEIGHT_NO_MODE_LINE (it->w));
22302 if (align_to && *align_to < 0)
22304 *res = 0;
22305 if (EQ (prop, Qleft))
22306 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
22307 if (EQ (prop, Qright))
22308 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_right_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
22309 if (EQ (prop, Qcenter))
22310 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA)
22311 + window_box_width (it->w, TEXT_AREA) / 2);
22312 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_fringe))
22313 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
22314 ? WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (it->w)
22315 : window_box_right_offset (it->w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
22316 if (EQ (prop, Qright_fringe))
22317 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
22318 ? window_box_right_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
22319 : window_box_right_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
22320 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_margin))
22321 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA));
22322 if (EQ (prop, Qright_margin))
22323 return OK_ALIGN_TO (window_box_left_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA));
22324 if (EQ (prop, Qscroll_bar))
22325 return OK_ALIGN_TO (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (it->w)
22327 : (window_box_right_offset (it->w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA)
22328 + (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (it->w)
22329 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w)
22330 : 0)));
22332 else
22334 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_fringe))
22335 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w));
22336 if (EQ (prop, Qright_fringe))
22337 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (it->w));
22338 if (EQ (prop, Qleft_margin))
22339 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_WIDTH (it->w));
22340 if (EQ (prop, Qright_margin))
22341 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_WIDTH (it->w));
22342 if (EQ (prop, Qscroll_bar))
22343 return OK_PIXELS (WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (it->w));
22346 prop = buffer_local_value_1 (prop, it->w->buffer);
22347 if (EQ (prop, Qunbound))
22348 prop = Qnil;
22351 if (INTEGERP (prop) || FLOATP (prop))
22353 int base_unit = (width_p
22354 ? FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f)
22355 : FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (it->f));
22356 return OK_PIXELS (XFLOATINT (prop) * base_unit);
22359 if (CONSP (prop))
22361 Lisp_Object car = XCAR (prop);
22362 Lisp_Object cdr = XCDR (prop);
22364 if (SYMBOLP (car))
22366 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22367 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
22368 && valid_image_p (prop))
22370 ptrdiff_t id = lookup_image (it->f, prop);
22371 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (it->f, id);
22373 return OK_PIXELS (width_p ? img->width : img->height);
22375 #endif
22376 if (EQ (car, Qplus) || EQ (car, Qminus))
22378 int first = 1;
22379 double px;
22381 pixels = 0;
22382 while (CONSP (cdr))
22384 if (!calc_pixel_width_or_height (&px, it, XCAR (cdr),
22385 font, width_p, align_to))
22386 return 0;
22387 if (first)
22388 pixels = (EQ (car, Qplus) ? px : -px), first = 0;
22389 else
22390 pixels += px;
22391 cdr = XCDR (cdr);
22393 if (EQ (car, Qminus))
22394 pixels = -pixels;
22395 return OK_PIXELS (pixels);
22398 car = buffer_local_value_1 (car, it->w->buffer);
22399 if (EQ (car, Qunbound))
22400 car = Qnil;
22403 if (INTEGERP (car) || FLOATP (car))
22405 double fact;
22406 pixels = XFLOATINT (car);
22407 if (NILP (cdr))
22408 return OK_PIXELS (pixels);
22409 if (calc_pixel_width_or_height (&fact, it, cdr,
22410 font, width_p, align_to))
22411 return OK_PIXELS (pixels * fact);
22412 return 0;
22415 return 0;
22418 return 0;
22422 /***********************************************************************
22423 Glyph Display
22424 ***********************************************************************/
22426 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
22428 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
22430 void
22431 dump_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
22433 fprintf (stderr, "glyph string\n");
22434 fprintf (stderr, " x, y, w, h = %d, %d, %d, %d\n",
22435 s->x, s->y, s->width, s->height);
22436 fprintf (stderr, " ybase = %d\n", s->ybase);
22437 fprintf (stderr, " hl = %d\n", s->hl);
22438 fprintf (stderr, " left overhang = %d, right = %d\n",
22439 s->left_overhang, s->right_overhang);
22440 fprintf (stderr, " nchars = %d\n", s->nchars);
22441 fprintf (stderr, " extends to end of line = %d\n",
22442 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p);
22443 fprintf (stderr, " font height = %d\n", FONT_HEIGHT (s->font));
22444 fprintf (stderr, " bg width = %d\n", s->background_width);
22447 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
22449 /* Initialize glyph string S. CHAR2B is a suitably allocated vector
22450 of XChar2b structures for S; it can't be allocated in
22451 init_glyph_string because it must be allocated via `alloca'. W
22452 is the window on which S is drawn. ROW and AREA are the glyph row
22453 and area within the row from which S is constructed. START is the
22454 index of the first glyph structure covered by S. HL is a
22455 face-override for drawing S. */
22457 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
22458 #define OPTIONAL_HDC(hdc) HDC hdc,
22459 #define DECLARE_HDC(hdc) HDC hdc;
22460 #define ALLOCATE_HDC(hdc, f) hdc = get_frame_dc ((f))
22461 #define RELEASE_HDC(hdc, f) release_frame_dc ((f), (hdc))
22462 #endif
22464 #ifndef OPTIONAL_HDC
22465 #define OPTIONAL_HDC(hdc)
22466 #define DECLARE_HDC(hdc)
22467 #define ALLOCATE_HDC(hdc, f)
22468 #define RELEASE_HDC(hdc, f)
22469 #endif
22471 static void
22472 init_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s,
22473 OPTIONAL_HDC (hdc)
22474 XChar2b *char2b, struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
22475 enum glyph_row_area area, int start, enum draw_glyphs_face hl)
22477 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
22478 s->w = w;
22479 s->f = XFRAME (w->frame);
22480 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
22481 s->hdc = hdc;
22482 #endif
22483 s->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (s->f);
22484 s->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (s->f);
22485 s->char2b = char2b;
22486 s->hl = hl;
22487 s->row = row;
22488 s->area = area;
22489 s->first_glyph = row->glyphs[area] + start;
22490 s->height = row->height;
22491 s->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
22492 s->ybase = s->y + row->ascent;
22496 /* Append the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the list
22497 with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the result. */
22499 static inline void
22500 append_glyph_string_lists (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
22501 struct glyph_string *h, struct glyph_string *t)
22503 if (h)
22505 if (*head)
22506 (*tail)->next = h;
22507 else
22508 *head = h;
22509 h->prev = *tail;
22510 *tail = t;
22515 /* Prepend the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the
22516 list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the
22517 result. */
22519 static inline void
22520 prepend_glyph_string_lists (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
22521 struct glyph_string *h, struct glyph_string *t)
22523 if (h)
22525 if (*head)
22526 (*head)->prev = t;
22527 else
22528 *tail = t;
22529 t->next = *head;
22530 *head = h;
22535 /* Append glyph string S to the list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL.
22536 Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the resulting list. */
22538 static inline void
22539 append_glyph_string (struct glyph_string **head, struct glyph_string **tail,
22540 struct glyph_string *s)
22542 s->next = s->prev = NULL;
22543 append_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, s, s);
22547 /* Get face and two-byte form of character C in face FACE_ID on frame F.
22548 The encoding of C is returned in *CHAR2B. DISPLAY_P non-zero means
22549 make sure that X resources for the face returned are allocated.
22550 Value is a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display if
22551 DISPLAY_P is non-zero. */
22553 static inline struct face *
22554 get_char_face_and_encoding (struct frame *f, int c, int face_id,
22555 XChar2b *char2b, int display_p)
22557 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
22559 if (face->font)
22561 unsigned code = face->font->driver->encode_char (face->font, c);
22563 if (code != FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22564 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
22565 else
22566 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, 0, 0);
22569 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
22570 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
22571 if (display_p)
22572 #endif
22574 eassert (face != NULL);
22575 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
22578 return face;
22582 /* Get face and two-byte form of character glyph GLYPH on frame F.
22583 The encoding of GLYPH->u.ch is returned in *CHAR2B. Value is
22584 a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display. */
22586 static inline struct face *
22587 get_glyph_face_and_encoding (struct frame *f, struct glyph *glyph,
22588 XChar2b *char2b, int *two_byte_p)
22590 struct face *face;
22592 eassert (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH);
22593 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->face_id);
22595 if (two_byte_p)
22596 *two_byte_p = 0;
22598 if (face->font)
22600 unsigned code;
22602 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (glyph->u.ch))
22603 code = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (glyph->u.ch);
22604 else
22605 code = face->font->driver->encode_char (face->font, glyph->u.ch);
22607 if (code != FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22608 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
22609 else
22610 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, 0, 0);
22613 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
22614 eassert (face != NULL);
22615 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
22616 return face;
22620 /* Get glyph code of character C in FONT in the two-byte form CHAR2B.
22621 Return 1 if FONT has a glyph for C, otherwise return 0. */
22623 static inline int
22624 get_char_glyph_code (int c, struct font *font, XChar2b *char2b)
22626 unsigned code;
22628 if (CHAR_BYTE8_P (c))
22629 code = CHAR_TO_BYTE8 (c);
22630 else
22631 code = font->driver->encode_char (font, c);
22633 if (code == FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22634 return 0;
22635 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b, (code >> 8), (code & 0xFF));
22636 return 1;
22640 /* Fill glyph string S with composition components specified by S->cmp.
22642 BASE_FACE is the base face of the composition.
22643 S->cmp_from is the index of the first component for S.
22645 OVERLAPS non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and use
22646 its physical height for clipping. See also draw_glyphs.
22648 Value is the index of a component not in S. */
22650 static int
22651 fill_composite_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, struct face *base_face,
22652 int overlaps)
22654 int i;
22655 /* For all glyphs of this composition, starting at the offset
22656 S->cmp_from, until we reach the end of the definition or encounter a
22657 glyph that requires the different face, add it to S. */
22658 struct face *face;
22660 eassert (s);
22662 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22663 s->face = NULL;
22664 s->font = NULL;
22665 for (i = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp->glyph_len; i++)
22667 int c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, i);
22669 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding space
22670 on the left or right. */
22671 if (c != '\t')
22673 int face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, base_face->ascii_face, c,
22674 -1, Qnil);
22676 face = get_char_face_and_encoding (s->f, c, face_id,
22677 s->char2b + i, 1);
22678 if (face)
22680 if (! s->face)
22682 s->face = face;
22683 s->font = s->face->font;
22685 else if (s->face != face)
22686 break;
22689 ++s->nchars;
22691 s->cmp_to = i;
22693 if (s->face == NULL)
22695 s->face = base_face->ascii_face;
22696 s->font = s->face->font;
22699 /* All glyph strings for the same composition has the same width,
22700 i.e. the width set for the first component of the composition. */
22701 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
22703 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's
22704 default font, but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
22705 the glyph string so that we can draw rectangles for the
22706 characters of the glyph string. */
22707 if (s->font == NULL)
22709 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
22710 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
22713 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22714 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
22716 /* This glyph string must always be drawn with 16-bit functions. */
22717 s->two_byte_p = 1;
22719 return s->cmp_to;
22722 static int
22723 fill_gstring_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
22724 int start, int end, int overlaps)
22726 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22727 Lisp_Object lgstring;
22728 int i;
22730 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22731 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22732 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22733 s->cmp_id = glyph->u.cmp.id;
22734 s->cmp_from = glyph->slice.cmp.from;
22735 s->cmp_to = glyph->slice.cmp.to + 1;
22736 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
22737 lgstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
22738 s->font = XFONT_OBJECT (LGSTRING_FONT (lgstring));
22739 glyph++;
22740 while (glyph < last
22741 && glyph->u.cmp.automatic
22742 && glyph->u.cmp.id == s->cmp_id
22743 && s->cmp_to == glyph->slice.cmp.from)
22744 s->cmp_to = (glyph++)->slice.cmp.to + 1;
22746 for (i = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
22748 Lisp_Object lglyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (lgstring, i);
22749 unsigned code = LGLYPH_CODE (lglyph);
22751 STORE_XCHAR2B ((s->char2b + i), code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
22753 s->width = composition_gstring_width (lgstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, NULL);
22754 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22758 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence glyphs for glyphless characters.
22759 See the comment of fill_glyph_string for arguments.
22760 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
22763 static int
22764 fill_glyphless_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
22765 int start, int end, int overlaps)
22767 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22768 int voffset;
22770 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == GLYPHLESS_GLYPH);
22771 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22772 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22773 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22774 voffset = glyph->voffset;
22775 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
22776 s->font = s->face->font ? s->face->font : FRAME_FONT (s->f);
22777 s->nchars = 1;
22778 s->width = glyph->pixel_width;
22779 glyph++;
22780 while (glyph < last
22781 && glyph->type == GLYPHLESS_GLYPH
22782 && glyph->voffset == voffset
22783 && glyph->face_id == face_id)
22785 s->nchars++;
22786 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
22787 glyph++;
22789 s->ybase += voffset;
22790 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22794 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of character glyphs.
22796 FACE_ID is the face id of the string. START is the index of the
22797 first glyph to consider, END is the index of the last + 1.
22798 OVERLAPS non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and use
22799 its physical height for clipping. See also draw_glyphs.
22801 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
22803 static int
22804 fill_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int face_id,
22805 int start, int end, int overlaps)
22807 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22808 int voffset;
22809 int glyph_not_available_p;
22811 eassert (s->f == XFRAME (s->w->frame));
22812 eassert (s->nchars == 0);
22813 eassert (start >= 0 && end > start);
22815 s->for_overlaps = overlaps;
22816 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22817 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22818 voffset = glyph->voffset;
22819 s->padding_p = glyph->padding_p;
22820 glyph_not_available_p = glyph->glyph_not_available_p;
22822 while (glyph < last
22823 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
22824 && glyph->voffset == voffset
22825 /* Same face id implies same font, nowadays. */
22826 && glyph->face_id == face_id
22827 && glyph->glyph_not_available_p == glyph_not_available_p)
22829 int two_byte_p;
22831 s->face = get_glyph_face_and_encoding (s->f, glyph,
22832 s->char2b + s->nchars,
22833 &two_byte_p);
22834 s->two_byte_p = two_byte_p;
22835 ++s->nchars;
22836 eassert (s->nchars <= end - start);
22837 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
22838 if (glyph++->padding_p != s->padding_p)
22839 break;
22842 s->font = s->face->font;
22844 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's font,
22845 but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
22846 S->font_not_found_p so that we can draw rectangles for the
22847 characters of the glyph string. */
22848 if (s->font == NULL || glyph_not_available_p)
22850 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
22851 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
22854 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22855 s->ybase += voffset;
22857 eassert (s->face && s->face->gc);
22858 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22862 /* Fill glyph string S from image glyph S->first_glyph. */
22864 static void
22865 fill_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
22867 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH);
22868 s->img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->u.img_id);
22869 eassert (s->img);
22870 s->slice = s->first_glyph->slice.img;
22871 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->face_id);
22872 s->font = s->face->font;
22873 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
22875 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22876 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
22880 /* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of stretch glyphs.
22882 START is the index of the first glyph to consider,
22883 END is the index of the last + 1.
22885 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
22887 static int
22888 fill_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s, int start, int end)
22890 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
22891 int voffset, face_id;
22893 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
22895 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
22896 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
22897 face_id = glyph->face_id;
22898 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
22899 s->font = s->face->font;
22900 s->width = glyph->pixel_width;
22901 s->nchars = 1;
22902 voffset = glyph->voffset;
22904 for (++glyph;
22905 (glyph < last
22906 && glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
22907 && glyph->voffset == voffset
22908 && glyph->face_id == face_id);
22909 ++glyph)
22910 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
22912 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
22913 s->ybase += voffset;
22915 /* The case that face->gc == 0 is handled when drawing the glyph
22916 string by calling PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY. */
22917 eassert (s->face);
22918 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22921 static struct font_metrics *
22922 get_per_char_metric (struct font *font, XChar2b *char2b)
22924 static struct font_metrics metrics;
22925 unsigned code = (XCHAR2B_BYTE1 (char2b) << 8) | XCHAR2B_BYTE2 (char2b);
22927 if (! font || code == FONT_INVALID_CODE)
22928 return NULL;
22929 font->driver->text_extents (font, &code, 1, &metrics);
22930 return &metrics;
22933 /* EXPORT for RIF:
22934 Set *LEFT and *RIGHT to the left and right overhang of GLYPH on
22935 frame F. Overhangs of glyphs other than type CHAR_GLYPH are
22936 assumed to be zero. */
22938 void
22939 x_get_glyph_overhangs (struct glyph *glyph, struct frame *f, int *left, int *right)
22941 *left = *right = 0;
22943 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
22945 struct face *face;
22946 XChar2b char2b;
22947 struct font_metrics *pcm;
22949 face = get_glyph_face_and_encoding (f, glyph, &char2b, NULL);
22950 if (face->font && (pcm = get_per_char_metric (face->font, &char2b)))
22952 if (pcm->rbearing > pcm->width)
22953 *right = pcm->rbearing - pcm->width;
22954 if (pcm->lbearing < 0)
22955 *left = -pcm->lbearing;
22958 else if (glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH)
22960 if (! glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
22962 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[glyph->u.cmp.id];
22964 if (cmp->rbearing > cmp->pixel_width)
22965 *right = cmp->rbearing - cmp->pixel_width;
22966 if (cmp->lbearing < 0)
22967 *left = - cmp->lbearing;
22969 else
22971 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (glyph->u.cmp.id);
22972 struct font_metrics metrics;
22974 composition_gstring_width (gstring, glyph->slice.cmp.from,
22975 glyph->slice.cmp.to + 1, &metrics);
22976 if (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width)
22977 *right = metrics.rbearing - metrics.width;
22978 if (metrics.lbearing < 0)
22979 *left = - metrics.lbearing;
22985 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
22986 is overwritten by S because of S's left overhang. Value is -1
22987 if no glyphs are overwritten. */
22989 static int
22990 left_overwritten (struct glyph_string *s)
22992 int k;
22994 if (s->left_overhang)
22996 int x = 0, i;
22997 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
22998 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
23000 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0 && x > -s->left_overhang; --i)
23001 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23003 k = i + 1;
23005 else
23006 k = -1;
23008 return k;
23012 /* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
23013 is overwriting S because of its right overhang. Value is -1 if no
23014 glyph in front of S overwrites S. */
23016 static int
23017 left_overwriting (struct glyph_string *s)
23019 int i, k, x;
23020 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23021 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
23023 k = -1;
23024 x = 0;
23025 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0; --i)
23027 int left, right;
23028 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
23029 if (x + right > 0)
23030 k = i;
23031 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23034 return k;
23038 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that is
23039 overwritten by S because of S's right overhang. Value is -1 if
23040 no such glyph is found. */
23042 static int
23043 right_overwritten (struct glyph_string *s)
23045 int k = -1;
23047 if (s->right_overhang)
23049 int x = 0, i;
23050 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23051 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs) + (s->cmp ? 1 : s->nchars);
23052 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
23054 for (i = first; i < end && s->right_overhang > x; ++i)
23055 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23057 k = i;
23060 return k;
23064 /* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that
23065 overwrites S because of its left overhang. Value is negative
23066 if no such glyph is found. */
23068 static int
23069 right_overwriting (struct glyph_string *s)
23071 int i, k, x;
23072 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
23073 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
23074 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs) + (s->cmp ? 1 : s->nchars);
23076 k = -1;
23077 x = 0;
23078 for (i = first; i < end; ++i)
23080 int left, right;
23081 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
23082 if (x - left < 0)
23083 k = i;
23084 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
23087 return k;
23091 /* Set background width of glyph string S. START is the index of the
23092 first glyph following S. LAST_X is the right-most x-position + 1
23093 in the drawing area. */
23095 static inline void
23096 set_glyph_string_background_width (struct glyph_string *s, int start, int last_x)
23098 /* If the face of this glyph string has to be drawn to the end of
23099 the drawing area, set S->extends_to_end_of_line_p. */
23101 if (start == s->row->used[s->area]
23102 && s->area == TEXT_AREA
23103 && ((s->row->fill_line_p
23104 && (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
23105 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
23106 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN))
23107 || s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE))
23108 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p = 1;
23110 /* If S extends its face to the end of the line, set its
23111 background_width to the distance to the right edge of the drawing
23112 area. */
23113 if (s->extends_to_end_of_line_p)
23114 s->background_width = last_x - s->x + 1;
23115 else
23116 s->background_width = s->width;
23120 /* Compute overhangs and x-positions for glyph string S and its
23121 predecessors, or successors. X is the starting x-position for S.
23122 BACKWARD_P non-zero means process predecessors. */
23124 static void
23125 compute_overhangs_and_x (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int backward_p)
23127 if (backward_p)
23129 while (s)
23131 if (FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
23132 FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
23133 x -= s->width;
23134 s->x = x;
23135 s = s->prev;
23138 else
23140 while (s)
23142 if (FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
23143 FRAME_RIF (s->f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
23144 s->x = x;
23145 x += s->width;
23146 s = s->next;
23153 /* The following macros are only called from draw_glyphs below.
23154 They reference the following parameters of that function directly:
23155 `w', `row', `area', and `overlap_p'
23156 as well as the following local variables:
23157 `s', `f', and `hdc' (in W32) */
23159 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI
23160 /* On W32, silently add local `hdc' variable to argument list of
23161 init_glyph_string. */
23162 #define INIT_GLYPH_STRING(s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl) \
23163 init_glyph_string (s, hdc, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl)
23164 #else
23165 #define INIT_GLYPH_STRING(s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl) \
23166 init_glyph_string (s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl)
23167 #endif
23169 /* Add a glyph string for a stretch glyph to the list of strings
23170 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the stretch glyph in
23171 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
23172 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
23173 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
23174 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
23175 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
23177 /* SunOS 4 bundled cc, barfed on continuations in the arg lists here
23178 and below -- keep them on one line. */
23179 #define BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23180 do \
23182 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23183 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23184 START = fill_stretch_glyph_string (s, START, END); \
23185 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23186 s->x = (X); \
23188 while (0)
23191 /* Add a glyph string for an image glyph to the list of strings
23192 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the image glyph in
23193 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
23194 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
23195 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
23196 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
23197 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
23199 #define BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23200 do \
23202 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23203 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23204 fill_image_glyph_string (s); \
23205 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23206 ++START; \
23207 s->x = (X); \
23209 while (0)
23212 /* Add a glyph string for a sequence of character glyphs to the list
23213 of strings between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first
23214 glyph in row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new
23215 glyph string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row
23216 area. X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph
23217 string constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it
23218 is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the
23219 right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
23221 #define BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23222 do \
23224 int face_id; \
23225 XChar2b *char2b; \
23227 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23229 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23230 char2b = alloca ((END - START) * sizeof *char2b); \
23231 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23232 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23233 s->x = (X); \
23234 START = fill_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, overlaps); \
23236 while (0)
23239 /* Add a glyph string for a composite sequence to the list of strings
23240 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first glyph in
23241 row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new glyph
23242 string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row area.
23243 X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph string
23244 constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it is
23245 DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the right-most
23246 x-position of the drawing area. */
23248 #define BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23249 do { \
23250 int face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23251 struct face *base_face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id); \
23252 ptrdiff_t cmp_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].u.cmp.id; \
23253 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[cmp_id]; \
23254 XChar2b *char2b; \
23255 struct glyph_string *first_s = NULL; \
23256 int n; \
23258 char2b = alloca (cmp->glyph_len * sizeof *char2b); \
23260 /* Make glyph_strings for each glyph sequence that is drawable by \
23261 the same face, and append them to HEAD/TAIL. */ \
23262 for (n = 0; n < cmp->glyph_len;) \
23264 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23265 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23266 append_glyph_string (&(HEAD), &(TAIL), s); \
23267 s->cmp = cmp; \
23268 s->cmp_from = n; \
23269 s->x = (X); \
23270 if (n == 0) \
23271 first_s = s; \
23272 n = fill_composite_glyph_string (s, base_face, overlaps); \
23275 ++START; \
23276 s = first_s; \
23277 } while (0)
23280 /* Add a glyph string for a glyph-string sequence to the list of strings
23281 between HEAD and TAIL. */
23283 #define BUILD_GSTRING_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23284 do { \
23285 int face_id; \
23286 XChar2b *char2b; \
23287 Lisp_Object gstring; \
23289 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23290 gstring = (composition_gstring_from_id \
23291 ((row)->glyphs[area][START].u.cmp.id)); \
23292 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23293 char2b = alloca (LGSTRING_GLYPH_LEN (gstring) * sizeof *char2b); \
23294 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, char2b, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23295 append_glyph_string (&(HEAD), &(TAIL), s); \
23296 s->x = (X); \
23297 START = fill_gstring_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, overlaps); \
23298 } while (0)
23301 /* Add a glyph string for a sequence of glyphless character's glyphs
23302 to the list of strings between HEAD and TAIL. The meanings of
23303 arguments are the same as those of BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS. */
23305 #define BUILD_GLYPHLESS_GLYPH_STRING(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23306 do \
23308 int face_id; \
23310 face_id = (row)->glyphs[area][START].face_id; \
23312 s = alloca (sizeof *s); \
23313 INIT_GLYPH_STRING (s, NULL, w, row, area, START, HL); \
23314 append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
23315 s->x = (X); \
23316 START = fill_glyphless_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, \
23317 overlaps); \
23319 while (0)
23322 /* Build a list of glyph strings between HEAD and TAIL for the glyphs
23323 of AREA of glyph row ROW on window W between indices START and END.
23324 HL overrides the face for drawing glyph strings, e.g. it is
23325 DRAW_CURSOR to draw a cursor. X and LAST_X are start and end
23326 x-positions of the drawing area.
23328 This is an ugly monster macro construct because we must use alloca
23329 to allocate glyph strings (because draw_glyphs can be called
23330 asynchronously). */
23332 #define BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS(START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
23333 do \
23335 HEAD = TAIL = NULL; \
23336 while (START < END) \
23338 struct glyph *first_glyph = (row)->glyphs[area] + START; \
23339 switch (first_glyph->type) \
23341 case CHAR_GLYPH: \
23342 BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23343 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23344 break; \
23346 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH: \
23347 if (first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic) \
23348 BUILD_GSTRING_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23349 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23350 else \
23351 BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23352 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23353 break; \
23355 case STRETCH_GLYPH: \
23356 BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23357 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23358 break; \
23360 case IMAGE_GLYPH: \
23361 BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23362 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23363 break; \
23365 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH: \
23366 BUILD_GLYPHLESS_GLYPH_STRING (START, END, HEAD, TAIL, \
23367 HL, X, LAST_X); \
23368 break; \
23370 default: \
23371 abort (); \
23374 if (s) \
23376 set_glyph_string_background_width (s, START, LAST_X); \
23377 (X) += s->width; \
23380 } while (0)
23383 /* Draw glyphs between START and END in AREA of ROW on window W,
23384 starting at x-position X. X is relative to AREA in W. HL is a
23385 face-override with the following meaning:
23387 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT draw normally
23388 DRAW_CURSOR draw in cursor face
23389 DRAW_MOUSE_FACE draw in mouse face.
23390 DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO draw in mode line face
23391 DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN draw an image with a sunken relief around it
23392 DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED draw an image with a raised relief around it
23394 If OVERLAPS is non-zero, draw only the foreground of characters and
23395 clip to the physical height of ROW. Non-zero value also defines
23396 the overlapping part to be drawn:
23398 OVERLAPS_PRED overlap with preceding rows
23399 OVERLAPS_SUCC overlap with succeeding rows
23400 OVERLAPS_BOTH overlap with both preceding/succeeding rows
23401 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR overlap with erased cursor area
23403 Value is the x-position reached, relative to AREA of W. */
23405 static int
23406 draw_glyphs (struct window *w, int x, struct glyph_row *row,
23407 enum glyph_row_area area, ptrdiff_t start, ptrdiff_t end,
23408 enum draw_glyphs_face hl, int overlaps)
23410 struct glyph_string *head, *tail;
23411 struct glyph_string *s;
23412 struct glyph_string *clip_head = NULL, *clip_tail = NULL;
23413 int i, j, x_reached, last_x, area_left = 0;
23414 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
23415 DECLARE_HDC (hdc);
23417 ALLOCATE_HDC (hdc, f);
23419 /* Let's rather be paranoid than getting a SEGV. */
23420 end = min (end, row->used[area]);
23421 start = max (0, start);
23422 start = min (end, start);
23424 /* Translate X to frame coordinates. Set last_x to the right
23425 end of the drawing area. */
23426 if (row->full_width_p)
23428 /* X is relative to the left edge of W, without scroll bars
23429 or fringes. */
23430 area_left = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
23431 last_x = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w) + WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
23433 else
23435 area_left = window_box_left (w, area);
23436 last_x = area_left + window_box_width (w, area);
23438 x += area_left;
23440 /* Build a doubly-linked list of glyph_string structures between
23441 head and tail from what we have to draw. Note that the macro
23442 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS will modify its start parameter. That's
23443 the reason we use a separate variable `i'. */
23444 i = start;
23445 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (i, end, head, tail, hl, x, last_x);
23446 if (tail)
23447 x_reached = tail->x + tail->background_width;
23448 else
23449 x_reached = x;
23451 /* If there are any glyphs with lbearing < 0 or rbearing > width in
23452 the row, redraw some glyphs in front or following the glyph
23453 strings built above. */
23454 if (head && !overlaps && row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p)
23456 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
23457 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
23458 int mouse_beg_col IF_LINT (= 0), mouse_end_col IF_LINT (= 0);
23459 int check_mouse_face = 0;
23460 int dummy_x = 0;
23462 /* If mouse highlighting is on, we may need to draw adjacent
23463 glyphs using mouse-face highlighting. */
23464 if (area == TEXT_AREA && row->mouse_face_p)
23466 struct glyph_row *mouse_beg_row, *mouse_end_row;
23468 mouse_beg_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row);
23469 mouse_end_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row);
23471 if (row >= mouse_beg_row && row <= mouse_end_row)
23473 check_mouse_face = 1;
23474 mouse_beg_col = (row == mouse_beg_row)
23475 ? hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col : 0;
23476 mouse_end_col = (row == mouse_end_row)
23477 ? hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col
23478 : row->used[TEXT_AREA];
23482 /* Compute overhangs for all glyph strings. */
23483 if (FRAME_RIF (f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs)
23484 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
23485 FRAME_RIF (f)->compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
23487 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
23488 string that are overwritten because of the first glyph
23489 string's left overhang. The background of all strings
23490 prepended must be drawn because the first glyph string
23491 draws over it. */
23492 i = left_overwritten (head);
23493 if (i >= 0)
23495 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
23497 /* If this row contains mouse highlighting, attempt to draw
23498 the overlapped glyphs with the correct highlight. This
23499 code fails if the overlap encompasses more than one glyph
23500 and mouse-highlight spans only some of these glyphs.
23501 However, making it work perfectly involves a lot more
23502 code, and I don't know if the pathological case occurs in
23503 practice, so we'll stick to this for now. --- cyd */
23504 if (check_mouse_face
23505 && mouse_beg_col < start && mouse_end_col > i)
23506 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
23507 else
23508 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
23510 j = i;
23511 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (j, start, h, t,
23512 overlap_hl, dummy_x, last_x);
23513 start = i;
23514 compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
23515 prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
23516 clip_head = head;
23519 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
23520 string that overwrite that glyph string because of their
23521 right overhang. For these strings, only the foreground must
23522 be drawn, because it draws over the glyph string at `head'.
23523 The background must not be drawn because this would overwrite
23524 right overhangs of preceding glyphs for which no glyph
23525 strings exist. */
23526 i = left_overwriting (head);
23527 if (i >= 0)
23529 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
23531 if (check_mouse_face
23532 && mouse_beg_col < start && mouse_end_col > i)
23533 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
23534 else
23535 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
23537 clip_head = head;
23538 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (i, start, h, t,
23539 overlap_hl, dummy_x, last_x);
23540 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
23541 s->background_filled_p = 1;
23542 compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
23543 prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
23546 /* Append glyphs strings for glyphs following the last glyph
23547 string tail that are overwritten by tail. The background of
23548 these strings has to be drawn because tail's foreground draws
23549 over it. */
23550 i = right_overwritten (tail);
23551 if (i >= 0)
23553 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
23555 if (check_mouse_face
23556 && mouse_beg_col < i && mouse_end_col > end)
23557 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
23558 else
23559 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
23561 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (end, i, h, t,
23562 overlap_hl, x, last_x);
23563 /* Because BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS updates the first argument,
23564 we don't have `end = i;' here. */
23565 compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
23566 append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
23567 clip_tail = tail;
23570 /* Append glyph strings for glyphs following the last glyph
23571 string tail that overwrite tail. The foreground of such
23572 glyphs has to be drawn because it writes into the background
23573 of tail. The background must not be drawn because it could
23574 paint over the foreground of following glyphs. */
23575 i = right_overwriting (tail);
23576 if (i >= 0)
23578 enum draw_glyphs_face overlap_hl;
23579 if (check_mouse_face
23580 && mouse_beg_col < i && mouse_end_col > end)
23581 overlap_hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
23582 else
23583 overlap_hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
23585 clip_tail = tail;
23586 i++; /* We must include the Ith glyph. */
23587 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (end, i, h, t,
23588 overlap_hl, x, last_x);
23589 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
23590 s->background_filled_p = 1;
23591 compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
23592 append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
23594 if (clip_head || clip_tail)
23595 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
23597 s->clip_head = clip_head;
23598 s->clip_tail = clip_tail;
23602 /* Draw all strings. */
23603 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
23604 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_glyph_string (s);
23606 #ifndef HAVE_NS
23607 /* When focus a sole frame and move horizontally, this sets on_p to 0
23608 causing a failure to erase prev cursor position. */
23609 if (area == TEXT_AREA
23610 && !row->full_width_p
23611 /* When drawing overlapping rows, only the glyph strings'
23612 foreground is drawn, which doesn't erase a cursor
23613 completely. */
23614 && !overlaps)
23616 int x0 = clip_head ? clip_head->x : (head ? head->x : x);
23617 int x1 = (clip_tail ? clip_tail->x + clip_tail->background_width
23618 : (tail ? tail->x + tail->background_width : x));
23619 x0 -= area_left;
23620 x1 -= area_left;
23622 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, TEXT_AREA, x0, x1,
23623 row->y, MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row));
23625 #endif
23627 /* Value is the x-position up to which drawn, relative to AREA of W.
23628 This doesn't include parts drawn because of overhangs. */
23629 if (row->full_width_p)
23630 x_reached = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, x_reached);
23631 else
23632 x_reached -= area_left;
23634 RELEASE_HDC (hdc, f);
23636 return x_reached;
23639 /* Expand row matrix if too narrow. Don't expand if area
23640 is not present. */
23642 #define IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH(it, area) \
23644 if (!fonts_changed_p \
23645 && (it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] \
23646 < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])) \
23648 it->w->ncols_scale_factor++; \
23649 fonts_changed_p = 1; \
23653 /* Store one glyph for IT->char_to_display in IT->glyph_row.
23654 Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is non-null. */
23656 static inline void
23657 append_glyph (struct it *it)
23659 struct glyph *glyph;
23660 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23662 eassert (it->glyph_row);
23663 eassert (it->char_to_display != '\n' && it->char_to_display != '\t');
23665 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23666 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23668 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
23669 rather than append it. */
23670 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
23672 struct glyph *g;
23674 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
23675 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
23676 g[1] = *g;
23677 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
23679 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
23680 glyph->object = it->object;
23681 if (it->pixel_width > 0)
23683 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
23684 glyph->padding_p = 0;
23686 else
23688 /* Assure at least 1-pixel width. Otherwise, cursor can't
23689 be displayed correctly. */
23690 glyph->pixel_width = 1;
23691 glyph->padding_p = 1;
23693 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
23694 glyph->descent = it->descent;
23695 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
23696 glyph->type = CHAR_GLYPH;
23697 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
23698 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
23699 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
23700 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
23701 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
23702 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
23703 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = it->glyph_not_available_p;
23704 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
23705 glyph->u.ch = it->char_to_display;
23706 glyph->slice.img = null_glyph_slice;
23707 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
23708 if (it->bidi_p)
23710 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
23711 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
23712 abort ();
23713 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
23715 else
23717 glyph->resolved_level = 0;
23718 glyph->bidi_type = UNKNOWN_BT;
23720 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
23722 else
23723 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
23726 /* Store one glyph for the composition IT->cmp_it.id in
23727 IT->glyph_row. Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is
23728 non-null. */
23730 static inline void
23731 append_composite_glyph (struct it *it)
23733 struct glyph *glyph;
23734 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23736 eassert (it->glyph_row);
23738 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23739 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23741 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
23742 rather than append it. */
23743 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && it->area == TEXT_AREA)
23745 struct glyph *g;
23747 /* Make room for the new glyph. */
23748 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[it->area]; g--)
23749 g[1] = *g;
23750 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[it->area];
23752 glyph->charpos = it->cmp_it.charpos;
23753 glyph->object = it->object;
23754 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
23755 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
23756 glyph->descent = it->descent;
23757 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
23758 glyph->type = COMPOSITE_GLYPH;
23759 if (it->cmp_it.ch < 0)
23761 glyph->u.cmp.automatic = 0;
23762 glyph->u.cmp.id = it->cmp_it.id;
23763 glyph->slice.cmp.from = glyph->slice.cmp.to = 0;
23765 else
23767 glyph->u.cmp.automatic = 1;
23768 glyph->u.cmp.id = it->cmp_it.id;
23769 glyph->slice.cmp.from = it->cmp_it.from;
23770 glyph->slice.cmp.to = it->cmp_it.to - 1;
23772 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
23773 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
23774 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
23775 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
23776 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
23777 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
23778 glyph->padding_p = 0;
23779 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
23780 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
23781 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
23782 if (it->bidi_p)
23784 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
23785 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
23786 abort ();
23787 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
23789 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
23791 else
23792 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
23796 /* Change IT->ascent and IT->height according to the setting of
23797 IT->voffset. */
23799 static inline void
23800 take_vertical_position_into_account (struct it *it)
23802 if (it->voffset)
23804 if (it->voffset < 0)
23805 /* Increase the ascent so that we can display the text higher
23806 in the line. */
23807 it->ascent -= it->voffset;
23808 else
23809 /* Increase the descent so that we can display the text lower
23810 in the line. */
23811 it->descent += it->voffset;
23816 /* Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the image IT is loaded with.
23817 See the description of struct display_iterator in dispextern.h for
23818 an overview of struct display_iterator. */
23820 static void
23821 produce_image_glyph (struct it *it)
23823 struct image *img;
23824 struct face *face;
23825 int glyph_ascent, crop;
23826 struct glyph_slice slice;
23828 eassert (it->what == IT_IMAGE);
23830 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
23831 eassert (face);
23832 /* Make sure X resources of the face is loaded. */
23833 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
23835 if (it->image_id < 0)
23837 /* Fringe bitmap. */
23838 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = 0;
23839 it->descent = it->phys_descent = 0;
23840 it->pixel_width = 0;
23841 it->nglyphs = 0;
23842 return;
23845 img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->image_id);
23846 eassert (img);
23847 /* Make sure X resources of the image is loaded. */
23848 prepare_image_for_display (it->f, img);
23850 slice.x = slice.y = 0;
23851 slice.width = img->width;
23852 slice.height = img->height;
23854 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.x))
23855 slice.x = XINT (it->slice.x);
23856 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.x))
23857 slice.x = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.x) * img->width;
23859 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.y))
23860 slice.y = XINT (it->slice.y);
23861 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.y))
23862 slice.y = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.y) * img->height;
23864 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.width))
23865 slice.width = XINT (it->slice.width);
23866 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.width))
23867 slice.width = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.width) * img->width;
23869 if (INTEGERP (it->slice.height))
23870 slice.height = XINT (it->slice.height);
23871 else if (FLOATP (it->slice.height))
23872 slice.height = XFLOAT_DATA (it->slice.height) * img->height;
23874 if (slice.x >= img->width)
23875 slice.x = img->width;
23876 if (slice.y >= img->height)
23877 slice.y = img->height;
23878 if (slice.x + slice.width >= img->width)
23879 slice.width = img->width - slice.x;
23880 if (slice.y + slice.height > img->height)
23881 slice.height = img->height - slice.y;
23883 if (slice.width == 0 || slice.height == 0)
23884 return;
23886 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = glyph_ascent = image_ascent (img, face, &slice);
23888 it->descent = slice.height - glyph_ascent;
23889 if (slice.y == 0)
23890 it->descent += img->vmargin;
23891 if (slice.y + slice.height == img->height)
23892 it->descent += img->vmargin;
23893 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
23895 it->pixel_width = slice.width;
23896 if (slice.x == 0)
23897 it->pixel_width += img->hmargin;
23898 if (slice.x + slice.width == img->width)
23899 it->pixel_width += img->hmargin;
23901 /* It's quite possible for images to have an ascent greater than
23902 their height, so don't get confused in that case. */
23903 if (it->descent < 0)
23904 it->descent = 0;
23906 it->nglyphs = 1;
23908 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
23910 if (face->box_line_width > 0)
23912 if (slice.y == 0)
23913 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
23914 if (slice.y + slice.height == img->height)
23915 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
23918 if (it->start_of_box_run_p && slice.x == 0)
23919 it->pixel_width += eabs (face->box_line_width);
23920 if (it->end_of_box_run_p && slice.x + slice.width == img->width)
23921 it->pixel_width += eabs (face->box_line_width);
23924 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
23926 /* Automatically crop wide image glyphs at right edge so we can
23927 draw the cursor on same display row. */
23928 if ((crop = it->pixel_width - (it->last_visible_x - it->current_x), crop > 0)
23929 && (it->hpos == 0 || it->pixel_width > it->last_visible_x / 4))
23931 it->pixel_width -= crop;
23932 slice.width -= crop;
23935 if (it->glyph_row)
23937 struct glyph *glyph;
23938 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23940 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23941 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23943 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
23944 glyph->object = it->object;
23945 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
23946 glyph->ascent = glyph_ascent;
23947 glyph->descent = it->descent;
23948 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
23949 glyph->type = IMAGE_GLYPH;
23950 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
23951 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
23952 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
23953 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
23954 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
23955 glyph->padding_p = 0;
23956 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
23957 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
23958 glyph->u.img_id = img->id;
23959 glyph->slice.img = slice;
23960 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
23961 if (it->bidi_p)
23963 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
23964 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
23965 abort ();
23966 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
23968 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
23970 else
23971 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
23976 /* Append a stretch glyph to IT->glyph_row. OBJECT is the source
23977 of the glyph, WIDTH and HEIGHT are the width and height of the
23978 stretch. ASCENT is the ascent of the glyph (0 <= ASCENT <= HEIGHT). */
23980 static void
23981 append_stretch_glyph (struct it *it, Lisp_Object object,
23982 int width, int height, int ascent)
23984 struct glyph *glyph;
23985 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
23987 eassert (ascent >= 0 && ascent <= height);
23989 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
23990 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
23992 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
23993 rather than append it. */
23994 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
23996 struct glyph *g;
23998 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
23999 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
24000 g[1] = *g;
24001 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
24003 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
24004 glyph->object = object;
24005 glyph->pixel_width = width;
24006 glyph->ascent = ascent;
24007 glyph->descent = height - ascent;
24008 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
24009 glyph->type = STRETCH_GLYPH;
24010 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
24011 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
24012 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
24013 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24014 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
24015 glyph->padding_p = 0;
24016 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24017 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
24018 glyph->u.stretch.ascent = ascent;
24019 glyph->u.stretch.height = height;
24020 glyph->slice.img = null_glyph_slice;
24021 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
24022 if (it->bidi_p)
24024 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
24025 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
24026 abort ();
24027 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
24029 else
24031 glyph->resolved_level = 0;
24032 glyph->bidi_type = UNKNOWN_BT;
24034 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
24036 else
24037 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
24040 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
24042 /* Produce a stretch glyph for iterator IT. IT->object is the value
24043 of the glyph property displayed. The value must be a list
24044 `(space KEYWORD VALUE ...)' with the following KEYWORD/VALUE pairs
24045 being recognized:
24047 1. `:width WIDTH' specifies that the space should be WIDTH *
24048 canonical char width wide. WIDTH may be an integer or floating
24049 point number.
24051 2. `:relative-width FACTOR' specifies that the width of the stretch
24052 should be computed from the width of the first character having the
24053 `glyph' property, and should be FACTOR times that width.
24055 3. `:align-to HPOS' specifies that the space should be wide enough
24056 to reach HPOS, a value in canonical character units.
24058 Exactly one of the above pairs must be present.
24060 4. `:height HEIGHT' specifies that the height of the stretch produced
24061 should be HEIGHT, measured in canonical character units.
24063 5. `:relative-height FACTOR' specifies that the height of the
24064 stretch should be FACTOR times the height of the characters having
24065 the glyph property.
24067 Either none or exactly one of 4 or 5 must be present.
24069 6. `:ascent ASCENT' specifies that ASCENT percent of the height
24070 of the stretch should be used for the ascent of the stretch.
24071 ASCENT must be in the range 0 <= ASCENT <= 100. */
24073 void
24074 produce_stretch_glyph (struct it *it)
24076 /* (space :width WIDTH :height HEIGHT ...) */
24077 Lisp_Object prop, plist;
24078 int width = 0, height = 0, align_to = -1;
24079 int zero_width_ok_p = 0;
24080 int ascent = 0;
24081 double tem;
24082 struct face *face = NULL;
24083 struct font *font = NULL;
24085 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24086 int zero_height_ok_p = 0;
24088 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24090 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
24091 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24092 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
24094 #endif
24096 /* List should start with `space'. */
24097 eassert (CONSP (it->object) && EQ (XCAR (it->object), Qspace));
24098 plist = XCDR (it->object);
24100 /* Compute the width of the stretch. */
24101 if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCwidth), !NILP (prop))
24102 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 1, 0))
24104 /* Absolute width `:width WIDTH' specified and valid. */
24105 zero_width_ok_p = 1;
24106 width = (int)tem;
24108 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24109 else if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f)
24110 && (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_width), NUMVAL (prop) > 0))
24112 /* Relative width `:relative-width FACTOR' specified and valid.
24113 Compute the width of the characters having the `glyph'
24114 property. */
24115 struct it it2;
24116 unsigned char *p = BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
24118 it2 = *it;
24119 if (it->multibyte_p)
24120 it2.c = it2.char_to_display = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (p, it2.len);
24121 else
24123 it2.c = it2.char_to_display = *p, it2.len = 1;
24124 if (! ASCII_CHAR_P (it2.c))
24125 it2.char_to_display = BYTE8_TO_CHAR (it2.c);
24128 it2.glyph_row = NULL;
24129 it2.what = IT_CHARACTER;
24130 x_produce_glyphs (&it2);
24131 width = NUMVAL (prop) * it2.pixel_width;
24133 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
24134 else if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCalign_to), !NILP (prop))
24135 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 1, &align_to))
24137 if (it->glyph_row == NULL || !it->glyph_row->mode_line_p)
24138 align_to = (align_to < 0
24140 : align_to - window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA));
24141 else if (align_to < 0)
24142 align_to = window_box_left_offset (it->w, TEXT_AREA);
24143 width = max (0, (int)tem + align_to - it->current_x);
24144 zero_width_ok_p = 1;
24146 else
24147 /* Nothing specified -> width defaults to canonical char width. */
24148 width = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (it->f);
24150 if (width <= 0 && (width < 0 || !zero_width_ok_p))
24151 width = 1;
24153 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24154 /* Compute height. */
24155 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24157 if ((prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCheight), !NILP (prop))
24158 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 0, 0))
24160 height = (int)tem;
24161 zero_height_ok_p = 1;
24163 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_height),
24164 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
24165 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font) * NUMVAL (prop);
24166 else
24167 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
24169 if (height <= 0 && (height < 0 || !zero_height_ok_p))
24170 height = 1;
24172 /* Compute percentage of height used for ascent. If
24173 `:ascent ASCENT' is present and valid, use that. Otherwise,
24174 derive the ascent from the font in use. */
24175 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCascent),
24176 NUMVAL (prop) > 0 && NUMVAL (prop) <= 100)
24177 ascent = height * NUMVAL (prop) / 100.0;
24178 else if (!NILP (prop)
24179 && calc_pixel_width_or_height (&tem, it, prop, font, 0, 0))
24180 ascent = min (max (0, (int)tem), height);
24181 else
24182 ascent = (height * FONT_BASE (font)) / FONT_HEIGHT (font);
24184 else
24185 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
24186 height = 1;
24188 if (width > 0 && it->line_wrap != TRUNCATE
24189 && it->current_x + width > it->last_visible_x)
24191 width = it->last_visible_x - it->current_x;
24192 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24193 /* Subtract one more pixel from the stretch width, but only on
24194 GUI frames, since on a TTY each glyph is one "pixel" wide. */
24195 width -= FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f);
24196 #endif
24199 if (width > 0 && height > 0 && it->glyph_row)
24201 Lisp_Object o_object = it->object;
24202 Lisp_Object object = it->stack[it->sp - 1].string;
24203 int n = width;
24205 if (!STRINGP (object))
24206 object = it->w->buffer;
24207 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24208 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24209 append_stretch_glyph (it, object, width, height, ascent);
24210 else
24211 #endif
24213 it->object = object;
24214 it->char_to_display = ' ';
24215 it->pixel_width = it->len = 1;
24216 while (n--)
24217 tty_append_glyph (it);
24218 it->object = o_object;
24222 it->pixel_width = width;
24223 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24224 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (it->f))
24226 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = ascent;
24227 it->descent = it->phys_descent = height - it->ascent;
24228 it->nglyphs = width > 0 && height > 0 ? 1 : 0;
24229 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
24231 else
24232 #endif
24233 it->nglyphs = width;
24236 /* Get information about special display element WHAT in an
24237 environment described by IT. WHAT is one of IT_TRUNCATION or
24238 IT_CONTINUATION. Maybe produce glyphs for WHAT if IT has a
24239 non-null glyph_row member. This function ensures that fields like
24240 face_id, c, len of IT are left untouched. */
24242 static void
24243 produce_special_glyphs (struct it *it, enum display_element_type what)
24245 struct it temp_it;
24246 Lisp_Object gc;
24247 GLYPH glyph;
24249 temp_it = *it;
24250 temp_it.object = make_number (0);
24251 memset (&temp_it.current, 0, sizeof temp_it.current);
24253 if (what == IT_CONTINUATION)
24255 /* Continuation glyph. For R2L lines, we mirror it by hand. */
24256 if (it->bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L)
24257 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR (glyph, '/');
24258 else
24259 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR (glyph, '\\');
24260 if (it->dp
24261 && (gc = DISP_CONTINUE_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
24263 /* FIXME: Should we mirror GC for R2L lines? */
24264 SET_GLYPH_FROM_GLYPH_CODE (glyph, gc);
24265 spec_glyph_lookup_face (XWINDOW (it->window), &glyph);
24268 else if (what == IT_TRUNCATION)
24270 /* Truncation glyph. */
24271 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR (glyph, '$');
24272 if (it->dp
24273 && (gc = DISP_TRUNC_GLYPH (it->dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)))
24275 /* FIXME: Should we mirror GC for R2L lines? */
24276 SET_GLYPH_FROM_GLYPH_CODE (glyph, gc);
24277 spec_glyph_lookup_face (XWINDOW (it->window), &glyph);
24280 else
24281 abort ();
24283 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24284 /* On a GUI frame, when the right fringe (left fringe for R2L rows)
24285 is turned off, we precede the truncation/continuation glyphs by a
24286 stretch glyph whose width is computed such that these special
24287 glyphs are aligned at the window margin, even when very different
24288 fonts are used in different glyph rows. */
24289 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (temp_it.f)
24290 /* init_iterator calls this with it->glyph_row == NULL, and it
24291 wants only the pixel width of the truncation/continuation
24292 glyphs. */
24293 && temp_it.glyph_row
24294 /* insert_left_trunc_glyphs calls us at the beginning of the
24295 row, and it has its own calculation of the stretch glyph
24296 width. */
24297 && temp_it.glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA] > 0
24298 && (temp_it.glyph_row->reversed_p
24299 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (temp_it.w)
24300 : WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (temp_it.w)) == 0)
24302 int stretch_width = temp_it.last_visible_x - temp_it.current_x;
24304 if (stretch_width > 0)
24306 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (temp_it.f, temp_it.face_id);
24307 struct font *font =
24308 face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (temp_it.f);
24309 int stretch_ascent =
24310 (((temp_it.ascent + temp_it.descent)
24311 * FONT_BASE (font)) / FONT_HEIGHT (font));
24313 append_stretch_glyph (&temp_it, make_number (0), stretch_width,
24314 temp_it.ascent + temp_it.descent,
24315 stretch_ascent);
24318 #endif
24320 temp_it.dp = NULL;
24321 temp_it.what = IT_CHARACTER;
24322 temp_it.len = 1;
24323 temp_it.c = temp_it.char_to_display = GLYPH_CHAR (glyph);
24324 temp_it.face_id = GLYPH_FACE (glyph);
24325 temp_it.len = CHAR_BYTES (temp_it.c);
24327 PRODUCE_GLYPHS (&temp_it);
24328 it->pixel_width = temp_it.pixel_width;
24329 it->nglyphs = temp_it.pixel_width;
24332 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
24334 /* Calculate line-height and line-spacing properties.
24335 An integer value specifies explicit pixel value.
24336 A float value specifies relative value to current face height.
24337 A cons (float . face-name) specifies relative value to
24338 height of specified face font.
24340 Returns height in pixels, or nil. */
24343 static Lisp_Object
24344 calc_line_height_property (struct it *it, Lisp_Object val, struct font *font,
24345 int boff, int override)
24347 Lisp_Object face_name = Qnil;
24348 int ascent, descent, height;
24350 if (NILP (val) || INTEGERP (val) || (override && EQ (val, Qt)))
24351 return val;
24353 if (CONSP (val))
24355 face_name = XCAR (val);
24356 val = XCDR (val);
24357 if (!NUMBERP (val))
24358 val = make_number (1);
24359 if (NILP (face_name))
24361 height = it->ascent + it->descent;
24362 goto scale;
24366 if (NILP (face_name))
24368 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24369 boff = FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (it->f);
24371 else if (EQ (face_name, Qt))
24373 override = 0;
24375 else
24377 int face_id;
24378 struct face *face;
24380 face_id = lookup_named_face (it->f, face_name, 0);
24381 if (face_id < 0)
24382 return make_number (-1);
24384 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
24385 font = face->font;
24386 if (font == NULL)
24387 return make_number (-1);
24388 boff = font->baseline_offset;
24389 if (font->vertical_centering)
24390 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
24393 ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24394 descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24396 if (override)
24398 it->override_ascent = ascent;
24399 it->override_descent = descent;
24400 it->override_boff = boff;
24403 height = ascent + descent;
24405 scale:
24406 if (FLOATP (val))
24407 height = (int)(XFLOAT_DATA (val) * height);
24408 else if (INTEGERP (val))
24409 height *= XINT (val);
24411 return make_number (height);
24415 /* Append a glyph for a glyphless character to IT->glyph_row. FACE_ID
24416 is a face ID to be used for the glyph. FOR_NO_FONT is nonzero if
24417 and only if this is for a character for which no font was found.
24419 If the display method (it->glyphless_method) is
24420 GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM or GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE, LEN is a
24421 length of the acronym or the hexadecimal string, UPPER_XOFF and
24422 UPPER_YOFF are pixel offsets for the upper part of the string,
24423 LOWER_XOFF and LOWER_YOFF are for the lower part.
24425 For the other display methods, LEN through LOWER_YOFF are zero. */
24427 static void
24428 append_glyphless_glyph (struct it *it, int face_id, int for_no_font, int len,
24429 short upper_xoff, short upper_yoff,
24430 short lower_xoff, short lower_yoff)
24432 struct glyph *glyph;
24433 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
24435 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
24436 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
24438 /* If the glyph row is reversed, we need to prepend the glyph
24439 rather than append it. */
24440 if (it->glyph_row->reversed_p && area == TEXT_AREA)
24442 struct glyph *g;
24444 /* Make room for the additional glyph. */
24445 for (g = glyph - 1; g >= it->glyph_row->glyphs[area]; g--)
24446 g[1] = *g;
24447 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area];
24449 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
24450 glyph->object = it->object;
24451 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
24452 glyph->ascent = it->ascent;
24453 glyph->descent = it->descent;
24454 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
24455 glyph->type = GLYPHLESS_GLYPH;
24456 glyph->u.glyphless.method = it->glyphless_method;
24457 glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font = for_no_font;
24458 glyph->u.glyphless.len = len;
24459 glyph->u.glyphless.ch = it->c;
24460 glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff = upper_xoff;
24461 glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff = upper_yoff;
24462 glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff = lower_xoff;
24463 glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff = lower_yoff;
24464 glyph->avoid_cursor_p = it->avoid_cursor_p;
24465 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
24466 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
24467 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
24468 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
24469 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
24470 glyph->padding_p = 0;
24471 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24472 glyph->face_id = face_id;
24473 glyph->font_type = FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
24474 if (it->bidi_p)
24476 glyph->resolved_level = it->bidi_it.resolved_level;
24477 if ((it->bidi_it.type & 7) != it->bidi_it.type)
24478 abort ();
24479 glyph->bidi_type = it->bidi_it.type;
24481 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
24483 else
24484 IT_EXPAND_MATRIX_WIDTH (it, area);
24488 /* Produce a glyph for a glyphless character for iterator IT.
24489 IT->glyphless_method specifies which method to use for displaying
24490 the character. See the description of enum
24491 glyphless_display_method in dispextern.h for the detail.
24493 FOR_NO_FONT is nonzero if and only if this is for a character for
24494 which no font was found. ACRONYM, if non-nil, is an acronym string
24495 for the character. */
24497 static void
24498 produce_glyphless_glyph (struct it *it, int for_no_font, Lisp_Object acronym)
24500 int face_id;
24501 struct face *face;
24502 struct font *font;
24503 int base_width, base_height, width, height;
24504 short upper_xoff, upper_yoff, lower_xoff, lower_yoff;
24505 int len;
24507 /* Get the metrics of the base font. We always refer to the current
24508 ASCII face. */
24509 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id)->ascii_face;
24510 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24511 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + font->baseline_offset;
24512 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - font->baseline_offset;
24513 base_height = it->ascent + it->descent;
24514 base_width = font->average_width;
24516 /* Get a face ID for the glyph by utilizing a cache (the same way as
24517 done for `escape-glyph' in get_next_display_element). */
24518 if (it->f == last_glyphless_glyph_frame
24519 && it->face_id == last_glyphless_glyph_face_id)
24521 face_id = last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id;
24523 else
24525 /* Merge the `glyphless-char' face into the current face. */
24526 face_id = merge_faces (it->f, Qglyphless_char, 0, it->face_id);
24527 last_glyphless_glyph_frame = it->f;
24528 last_glyphless_glyph_face_id = it->face_id;
24529 last_glyphless_glyph_merged_face_id = face_id;
24532 if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
24534 it->pixel_width = THIN_SPACE_WIDTH;
24535 len = 0;
24536 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = lower_xoff = lower_yoff = 0;
24538 else if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_EMPTY_BOX)
24540 width = CHAR_WIDTH (it->c);
24541 if (width == 0)
24542 width = 1;
24543 else if (width > 4)
24544 width = 4;
24545 it->pixel_width = base_width * width;
24546 len = 0;
24547 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = lower_xoff = lower_yoff = 0;
24549 else
24551 char buf[7];
24552 const char *str;
24553 unsigned int code[6];
24554 int upper_len;
24555 int ascent, descent;
24556 struct font_metrics metrics_upper, metrics_lower;
24558 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
24559 font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
24560 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
24562 if (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
24564 if (! STRINGP (acronym) && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display))
24565 acronym = CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display, it->c);
24566 if (CONSP (acronym))
24567 acronym = XCAR (acronym);
24568 str = STRINGP (acronym) ? SSDATA (acronym) : "";
24570 else
24572 eassert (it->glyphless_method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE);
24573 sprintf (buf, "%0*X", it->c < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6, it->c);
24574 str = buf;
24576 for (len = 0; str[len] && ASCII_BYTE_P (str[len]) && len < 6; len++)
24577 code[len] = font->driver->encode_char (font, str[len]);
24578 upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
24579 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, upper_len,
24580 &metrics_upper);
24581 font->driver->text_extents (font, code + upper_len, len - upper_len,
24582 &metrics_lower);
24586 /* +4 is for vertical bars of a box plus 1-pixel spaces at both side. */
24587 width = max (metrics_upper.width, metrics_lower.width) + 4;
24588 upper_xoff = upper_yoff = 2; /* the typical case */
24589 if (base_width >= width)
24591 /* Align the upper to the left, the lower to the right. */
24592 it->pixel_width = base_width;
24593 lower_xoff = base_width - 2 - metrics_lower.width;
24595 else
24597 /* Center the shorter one. */
24598 it->pixel_width = width;
24599 if (metrics_upper.width >= metrics_lower.width)
24600 lower_xoff = (width - metrics_lower.width) / 2;
24601 else
24603 /* FIXME: This code doesn't look right. It formerly was
24604 missing the "lower_xoff = 0;", which couldn't have
24605 been right since it left lower_xoff uninitialized. */
24606 lower_xoff = 0;
24607 upper_xoff = (width - metrics_upper.width) / 2;
24611 /* +5 is for horizontal bars of a box plus 1-pixel spaces at
24612 top, bottom, and between upper and lower strings. */
24613 height = (metrics_upper.ascent + metrics_upper.descent
24614 + metrics_lower.ascent + metrics_lower.descent) + 5;
24615 /* Center vertically.
24616 H:base_height, D:base_descent
24617 h:height, ld:lower_descent, la:lower_ascent, ud:upper_descent
24619 ascent = - (D - H/2 - h/2 + 1); "+ 1" for rounding up
24620 descent = D - H/2 + h/2;
24621 lower_yoff = descent - 2 - ld;
24622 upper_yoff = lower_yoff - la - 1 - ud; */
24623 ascent = - (it->descent - (base_height + height + 1) / 2);
24624 descent = it->descent - (base_height - height) / 2;
24625 lower_yoff = descent - 2 - metrics_lower.descent;
24626 upper_yoff = (lower_yoff - metrics_lower.ascent - 1
24627 - metrics_upper.descent);
24628 /* Don't make the height shorter than the base height. */
24629 if (height > base_height)
24631 it->ascent = ascent;
24632 it->descent = descent;
24636 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
24637 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
24638 if (it->glyph_row)
24639 append_glyphless_glyph (it, face_id, for_no_font, len,
24640 upper_xoff, upper_yoff,
24641 lower_xoff, lower_yoff);
24642 it->nglyphs = 1;
24643 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
24647 /* RIF:
24648 Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the display element IT is
24649 loaded with. See the description of struct it in dispextern.h
24650 for an overview of struct it. */
24652 void
24653 x_produce_glyphs (struct it *it)
24655 int extra_line_spacing = it->extra_line_spacing;
24657 it->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
24659 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
24661 XChar2b char2b;
24662 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
24663 struct font *font = face->font;
24664 struct font_metrics *pcm = NULL;
24665 int boff; /* baseline offset */
24667 if (font == NULL)
24669 /* When no suitable font is found, display this character by
24670 the method specified in the first extra slot of
24671 Vglyphless_char_display. */
24672 Lisp_Object acronym = lookup_glyphless_char_display (-1, it);
24674 eassert (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS);
24675 produce_glyphless_glyph (it, 1, STRINGP (acronym) ? acronym : Qnil);
24676 goto done;
24679 boff = font->baseline_offset;
24680 if (font->vertical_centering)
24681 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
24683 if (it->char_to_display != '\n' && it->char_to_display != '\t')
24685 int stretched_p;
24687 it->nglyphs = 1;
24689 if (it->override_ascent >= 0)
24691 it->ascent = it->override_ascent;
24692 it->descent = it->override_descent;
24693 boff = it->override_boff;
24695 else
24697 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24698 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24701 if (get_char_glyph_code (it->char_to_display, font, &char2b))
24703 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
24704 if (pcm->width == 0
24705 && pcm->rbearing == 0 && pcm->lbearing == 0)
24706 pcm = NULL;
24709 if (pcm)
24711 it->phys_ascent = pcm->ascent + boff;
24712 it->phys_descent = pcm->descent - boff;
24713 it->pixel_width = pcm->width;
24715 else
24717 it->glyph_not_available_p = 1;
24718 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
24719 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
24720 it->pixel_width = font->space_width;
24723 if (it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p)
24725 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
24727 it->ascent += it->descent - it->max_descent;
24728 it->descent = it->max_descent;
24730 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
24732 it->descent = min (it->max_descent, it->descent + it->ascent - it->max_ascent);
24733 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
24735 it->phys_ascent = min (it->phys_ascent, it->ascent);
24736 it->phys_descent = min (it->phys_descent, it->descent);
24737 extra_line_spacing = 0;
24740 /* If this is a space inside a region of text with
24741 `space-width' property, change its width. */
24742 stretched_p = it->char_to_display == ' ' && !NILP (it->space_width);
24743 if (stretched_p)
24744 it->pixel_width *= XFLOATINT (it->space_width);
24746 /* If face has a box, add the box thickness to the character
24747 height. If character has a box line to the left and/or
24748 right, add the box line width to the character's width. */
24749 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
24751 int thick = face->box_line_width;
24753 if (thick > 0)
24755 it->ascent += thick;
24756 it->descent += thick;
24758 else
24759 thick = -thick;
24761 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
24762 it->pixel_width += thick;
24763 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
24764 it->pixel_width += thick;
24767 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
24768 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
24769 if (face->overline_p)
24770 it->ascent += overline_margin;
24772 if (it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p)
24774 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
24775 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
24776 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
24777 it->descent = it->max_descent;
24780 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
24782 /* If we have to actually produce glyphs, do it. */
24783 if (it->glyph_row)
24785 if (stretched_p)
24787 /* Translate a space with a `space-width' property
24788 into a stretch glyph. */
24789 int ascent = (((it->ascent + it->descent) * FONT_BASE (font))
24790 / FONT_HEIGHT (font));
24791 append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
24792 it->ascent + it->descent, ascent);
24794 else
24795 append_glyph (it);
24797 /* If characters with lbearing or rbearing are displayed
24798 in this line, record that fact in a flag of the
24799 glyph row. This is used to optimize X output code. */
24800 if (pcm && (pcm->lbearing < 0 || pcm->rbearing > pcm->width))
24801 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
24803 if (! stretched_p && it->pixel_width == 0)
24804 /* We assure that all visible glyphs have at least 1-pixel
24805 width. */
24806 it->pixel_width = 1;
24808 else if (it->char_to_display == '\n')
24810 /* A newline has no width, but we need the height of the
24811 line. But if previous part of the line sets a height,
24812 don't increase that height */
24814 Lisp_Object height;
24815 Lisp_Object total_height = Qnil;
24817 it->override_ascent = -1;
24818 it->pixel_width = 0;
24819 it->nglyphs = 0;
24821 height = get_it_property (it, Qline_height);
24822 /* Split (line-height total-height) list */
24823 if (CONSP (height)
24824 && CONSP (XCDR (height))
24825 && NILP (XCDR (XCDR (height))))
24827 total_height = XCAR (XCDR (height));
24828 height = XCAR (height);
24830 height = calc_line_height_property (it, height, font, boff, 1);
24832 if (it->override_ascent >= 0)
24834 it->ascent = it->override_ascent;
24835 it->descent = it->override_descent;
24836 boff = it->override_boff;
24838 else
24840 it->ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24841 it->descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24844 if (EQ (height, Qt))
24846 if (it->descent > it->max_descent)
24848 it->ascent += it->descent - it->max_descent;
24849 it->descent = it->max_descent;
24851 if (it->ascent > it->max_ascent)
24853 it->descent = min (it->max_descent, it->descent + it->ascent - it->max_ascent);
24854 it->ascent = it->max_ascent;
24856 it->phys_ascent = min (it->phys_ascent, it->ascent);
24857 it->phys_descent = min (it->phys_descent, it->descent);
24858 it->constrain_row_ascent_descent_p = 1;
24859 extra_line_spacing = 0;
24861 else
24863 Lisp_Object spacing;
24865 it->phys_ascent = it->ascent;
24866 it->phys_descent = it->descent;
24868 if ((it->max_ascent > 0 || it->max_descent > 0)
24869 && face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
24870 && face->box_line_width > 0)
24872 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
24873 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
24875 if (!NILP (height)
24876 && XINT (height) > it->ascent + it->descent)
24877 it->ascent = XINT (height) - it->descent;
24879 if (!NILP (total_height))
24880 spacing = calc_line_height_property (it, total_height, font, boff, 0);
24881 else
24883 spacing = get_it_property (it, Qline_spacing);
24884 spacing = calc_line_height_property (it, spacing, font, boff, 0);
24886 if (INTEGERP (spacing))
24888 extra_line_spacing = XINT (spacing);
24889 if (!NILP (total_height))
24890 extra_line_spacing -= (it->phys_ascent + it->phys_descent);
24894 else /* i.e. (it->char_to_display == '\t') */
24896 if (font->space_width > 0)
24898 int tab_width = it->tab_width * font->space_width;
24899 int x = it->current_x + it->continuation_lines_width;
24900 int next_tab_x = ((1 + x + tab_width - 1) / tab_width) * tab_width;
24902 /* If the distance from the current position to the next tab
24903 stop is less than a space character width, use the
24904 tab stop after that. */
24905 if (next_tab_x - x < font->space_width)
24906 next_tab_x += tab_width;
24908 it->pixel_width = next_tab_x - x;
24909 it->nglyphs = 1;
24910 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24911 it->descent = it->phys_descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24913 if (it->glyph_row)
24915 append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
24916 it->ascent + it->descent, it->ascent);
24919 else
24921 it->pixel_width = 0;
24922 it->nglyphs = 1;
24926 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION && it->cmp_it.ch < 0)
24928 /* A static composition.
24930 Note: A composition is represented as one glyph in the
24931 glyph matrix. There are no padding glyphs.
24933 Important note: pixel_width, ascent, and descent are the
24934 values of what is drawn by draw_glyphs (i.e. the values of
24935 the overall glyphs composed). */
24936 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
24937 int boff; /* baseline offset */
24938 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[it->cmp_it.id];
24939 int glyph_len = cmp->glyph_len;
24940 struct font *font = face->font;
24942 it->nglyphs = 1;
24944 /* If we have not yet calculated pixel size data of glyphs of
24945 the composition for the current face font, calculate them
24946 now. Theoretically, we have to check all fonts for the
24947 glyphs, but that requires much time and memory space. So,
24948 here we check only the font of the first glyph. This may
24949 lead to incorrect display, but it's very rare, and C-l
24950 (recenter-top-bottom) can correct the display anyway. */
24951 if (! cmp->font || cmp->font != font)
24953 /* Ascent and descent of the font of the first character
24954 of this composition (adjusted by baseline offset).
24955 Ascent and descent of overall glyphs should not be less
24956 than these, respectively. */
24957 int font_ascent, font_descent, font_height;
24958 /* Bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
24959 int leftmost, rightmost, lowest, highest;
24960 int lbearing, rbearing;
24961 int i, width, ascent, descent;
24962 int left_padded = 0, right_padded = 0;
24963 int c IF_LINT (= 0); /* cmp->glyph_len can't be zero; see Bug#8512 */
24964 XChar2b char2b;
24965 struct font_metrics *pcm;
24966 int font_not_found_p;
24967 ptrdiff_t pos;
24969 for (glyph_len = cmp->glyph_len; glyph_len > 0; glyph_len--)
24970 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, glyph_len - 1)) != '\t')
24971 break;
24972 if (glyph_len < cmp->glyph_len)
24973 right_padded = 1;
24974 for (i = 0; i < glyph_len; i++)
24976 if ((c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i)) != '\t')
24977 break;
24978 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = 0;
24980 if (i > 0)
24981 left_padded = 1;
24983 pos = (STRINGP (it->string) ? IT_STRING_CHARPOS (*it)
24984 : IT_CHARPOS (*it));
24985 /* If no suitable font is found, use the default font. */
24986 font_not_found_p = font == NULL;
24987 if (font_not_found_p)
24989 face = face->ascii_face;
24990 font = face->font;
24992 boff = font->baseline_offset;
24993 if (font->vertical_centering)
24994 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
24995 font_ascent = FONT_BASE (font) + boff;
24996 font_descent = FONT_DESCENT (font) - boff;
24997 font_height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
24999 cmp->font = font;
25001 pcm = NULL;
25002 if (! font_not_found_p)
25004 get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, c, it->face_id,
25005 &char2b, 0);
25006 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
25009 /* Initialize the bounding box. */
25010 if (pcm)
25012 width = cmp->glyph_len > 0 ? pcm->width : 0;
25013 ascent = pcm->ascent;
25014 descent = pcm->descent;
25015 lbearing = pcm->lbearing;
25016 rbearing = pcm->rbearing;
25018 else
25020 width = cmp->glyph_len > 0 ? font->space_width : 0;
25021 ascent = FONT_BASE (font);
25022 descent = FONT_DESCENT (font);
25023 lbearing = 0;
25024 rbearing = width;
25027 rightmost = width;
25028 leftmost = 0;
25029 lowest = - descent + boff;
25030 highest = ascent + boff;
25032 if (! font_not_found_p
25033 && font->default_ascent
25034 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vuse_default_ascent)
25035 && !NILP (Faref (Vuse_default_ascent,
25036 make_number (it->char_to_display))))
25037 highest = font->default_ascent + boff;
25039 /* Draw the first glyph at the normal position. It may be
25040 shifted to right later if some other glyphs are drawn
25041 at the left. */
25042 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = 0;
25043 cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = boff;
25044 cmp->lbearing = lbearing;
25045 cmp->rbearing = rbearing;
25047 /* Set cmp->offsets for the remaining glyphs. */
25048 for (i++; i < glyph_len; i++)
25050 int left, right, btm, top;
25051 int ch = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i);
25052 int face_id;
25053 struct face *this_face;
25055 if (ch == '\t')
25056 ch = ' ';
25057 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, ch, pos, it->string);
25058 this_face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
25059 font = this_face->font;
25061 if (font == NULL)
25062 pcm = NULL;
25063 else
25065 get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, ch, face_id,
25066 &char2b, 0);
25067 pcm = get_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
25069 if (! pcm)
25070 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = 0;
25071 else
25073 width = pcm->width;
25074 ascent = pcm->ascent;
25075 descent = pcm->descent;
25076 lbearing = pcm->lbearing;
25077 rbearing = pcm->rbearing;
25078 if (cmp->method != COMPOSITION_WITH_RULE_ALTCHARS)
25080 /* Relative composition with or without
25081 alternate chars. */
25082 left = (leftmost + rightmost - width) / 2;
25083 btm = - descent + boff;
25084 if (font->relative_compose
25085 && (! CHAR_TABLE_P (Vignore_relative_composition)
25086 || NILP (Faref (Vignore_relative_composition,
25087 make_number (ch)))))
25090 if (- descent >= font->relative_compose)
25091 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
25092 btm = highest + 1;
25093 else if (ascent <= 0)
25094 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
25095 btm = lowest - 1 - ascent - descent;
25098 else
25100 /* A composition rule is specified by an integer
25101 value that encodes global and new reference
25102 points (GREF and NREF). GREF and NREF are
25103 specified by numbers as below:
25105 0---1---2 -- ascent
25109 9--10--11 -- center
25111 ---3---4---5--- baseline
25113 6---7---8 -- descent
25115 int rule = COMPOSITION_RULE (cmp, i);
25116 int gref, nref, grefx, grefy, nrefx, nrefy, xoff, yoff;
25118 COMPOSITION_DECODE_RULE (rule, gref, nref, xoff, yoff);
25119 grefx = gref % 3, nrefx = nref % 3;
25120 grefy = gref / 3, nrefy = nref / 3;
25121 if (xoff)
25122 xoff = font_height * (xoff - 128) / 256;
25123 if (yoff)
25124 yoff = font_height * (yoff - 128) / 256;
25126 left = (leftmost
25127 + grefx * (rightmost - leftmost) / 2
25128 - nrefx * width / 2
25129 + xoff);
25131 btm = ((grefy == 0 ? highest
25132 : grefy == 1 ? 0
25133 : grefy == 2 ? lowest
25134 : (highest + lowest) / 2)
25135 - (nrefy == 0 ? ascent + descent
25136 : nrefy == 1 ? descent - boff
25137 : nrefy == 2 ? 0
25138 : (ascent + descent) / 2)
25139 + yoff);
25142 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = left;
25143 cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = btm + descent;
25145 /* Update the bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
25146 if (width > 0)
25148 right = left + width;
25149 if (left < leftmost)
25150 leftmost = left;
25151 if (right > rightmost)
25152 rightmost = right;
25154 top = btm + descent + ascent;
25155 if (top > highest)
25156 highest = top;
25157 if (btm < lowest)
25158 lowest = btm;
25160 if (cmp->lbearing > left + lbearing)
25161 cmp->lbearing = left + lbearing;
25162 if (cmp->rbearing < left + rbearing)
25163 cmp->rbearing = left + rbearing;
25167 /* If there are glyphs whose x-offsets are negative,
25168 shift all glyphs to the right and make all x-offsets
25169 non-negative. */
25170 if (leftmost < 0)
25172 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
25173 cmp->offsets[i * 2] -= leftmost;
25174 rightmost -= leftmost;
25175 cmp->lbearing -= leftmost;
25176 cmp->rbearing -= leftmost;
25179 if (left_padded && cmp->lbearing < 0)
25181 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
25182 cmp->offsets[i * 2] -= cmp->lbearing;
25183 rightmost -= cmp->lbearing;
25184 cmp->rbearing -= cmp->lbearing;
25185 cmp->lbearing = 0;
25187 if (right_padded && rightmost < cmp->rbearing)
25189 rightmost = cmp->rbearing;
25192 cmp->pixel_width = rightmost;
25193 cmp->ascent = highest;
25194 cmp->descent = - lowest;
25195 if (cmp->ascent < font_ascent)
25196 cmp->ascent = font_ascent;
25197 if (cmp->descent < font_descent)
25198 cmp->descent = font_descent;
25201 if (it->glyph_row
25202 && (cmp->lbearing < 0
25203 || cmp->rbearing > cmp->pixel_width))
25204 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
25206 it->pixel_width = cmp->pixel_width;
25207 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = cmp->ascent;
25208 it->descent = it->phys_descent = cmp->descent;
25209 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
25211 int thick = face->box_line_width;
25213 if (thick > 0)
25215 it->ascent += thick;
25216 it->descent += thick;
25218 else
25219 thick = - thick;
25221 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
25222 it->pixel_width += thick;
25223 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
25224 it->pixel_width += thick;
25227 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
25228 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
25229 if (face->overline_p)
25230 it->ascent += overline_margin;
25232 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
25233 if (it->ascent < 0)
25234 it->ascent = 0;
25235 if (it->descent < 0)
25236 it->descent = 0;
25238 if (it->glyph_row && cmp->glyph_len > 0)
25239 append_composite_glyph (it);
25241 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
25243 /* A dynamic (automatic) composition. */
25244 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
25245 Lisp_Object gstring;
25246 struct font_metrics metrics;
25248 it->nglyphs = 1;
25250 gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (it->cmp_it.id);
25251 it->pixel_width
25252 = composition_gstring_width (gstring, it->cmp_it.from, it->cmp_it.to,
25253 &metrics);
25254 if (it->glyph_row
25255 && (metrics.lbearing < 0 || metrics.rbearing > metrics.width))
25256 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
25257 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = metrics.ascent;
25258 it->descent = it->phys_descent = metrics.descent;
25259 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
25261 int thick = face->box_line_width;
25263 if (thick > 0)
25265 it->ascent += thick;
25266 it->descent += thick;
25268 else
25269 thick = - thick;
25271 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
25272 it->pixel_width += thick;
25273 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
25274 it->pixel_width += thick;
25276 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
25277 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
25278 if (face->overline_p)
25279 it->ascent += overline_margin;
25280 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
25281 if (it->ascent < 0)
25282 it->ascent = 0;
25283 if (it->descent < 0)
25284 it->descent = 0;
25286 if (it->glyph_row)
25287 append_composite_glyph (it);
25289 else if (it->what == IT_GLYPHLESS)
25290 produce_glyphless_glyph (it, 0, Qnil);
25291 else if (it->what == IT_IMAGE)
25292 produce_image_glyph (it);
25293 else if (it->what == IT_STRETCH)
25294 produce_stretch_glyph (it);
25296 done:
25297 /* Accumulate dimensions. Note: can't assume that it->descent > 0
25298 because this isn't true for images with `:ascent 100'. */
25299 eassert (it->ascent >= 0 && it->descent >= 0);
25300 if (it->area == TEXT_AREA)
25301 it->current_x += it->pixel_width;
25303 if (extra_line_spacing > 0)
25305 it->descent += extra_line_spacing;
25306 if (extra_line_spacing > it->max_extra_line_spacing)
25307 it->max_extra_line_spacing = extra_line_spacing;
25310 it->max_ascent = max (it->max_ascent, it->ascent);
25311 it->max_descent = max (it->max_descent, it->descent);
25312 it->max_phys_ascent = max (it->max_phys_ascent, it->phys_ascent);
25313 it->max_phys_descent = max (it->max_phys_descent, it->phys_descent);
25316 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25317 Output LEN glyphs starting at START at the nominal cursor position.
25318 Advance the nominal cursor over the text. The global variable
25319 updated_window contains the window being updated, updated_row is
25320 the glyph row being updated, and updated_area is the area of that
25321 row being updated. */
25323 void
25324 x_write_glyphs (struct glyph *start, int len)
25326 int x, hpos, chpos = updated_window->phys_cursor.hpos;
25328 eassert (updated_window && updated_row);
25329 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be out
25330 of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding window
25331 margin in that case. */
25332 if (!updated_row->reversed_p && chpos < 0)
25333 chpos = 0;
25334 if (updated_row->reversed_p && chpos >= updated_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
25335 chpos = updated_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
25337 BLOCK_INPUT;
25339 /* Write glyphs. */
25341 hpos = start - updated_row->glyphs[updated_area];
25342 x = draw_glyphs (updated_window, output_cursor.x,
25343 updated_row, updated_area,
25344 hpos, hpos + len,
25345 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
25347 /* Invalidate old phys cursor if the glyph at its hpos is redrawn. */
25348 if (updated_area == TEXT_AREA
25349 && updated_window->phys_cursor_on_p
25350 && updated_window->phys_cursor.vpos == output_cursor.vpos
25351 && chpos >= hpos
25352 && chpos < hpos + len)
25353 updated_window->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
25355 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
25357 /* Advance the output cursor. */
25358 output_cursor.hpos += len;
25359 output_cursor.x = x;
25363 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25364 Insert LEN glyphs from START at the nominal cursor position. */
25366 void
25367 x_insert_glyphs (struct glyph *start, int len)
25369 struct frame *f;
25370 struct window *w;
25371 int line_height, shift_by_width, shifted_region_width;
25372 struct glyph_row *row;
25373 struct glyph *glyph;
25374 int frame_x, frame_y;
25375 ptrdiff_t hpos;
25377 eassert (updated_window && updated_row);
25378 BLOCK_INPUT;
25379 w = updated_window;
25380 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
25382 /* Get the height of the line we are in. */
25383 row = updated_row;
25384 line_height = row->height;
25386 /* Get the width of the glyphs to insert. */
25387 shift_by_width = 0;
25388 for (glyph = start; glyph < start + len; ++glyph)
25389 shift_by_width += glyph->pixel_width;
25391 /* Get the width of the region to shift right. */
25392 shifted_region_width = (window_box_width (w, updated_area)
25393 - output_cursor.x
25394 - shift_by_width);
25396 /* Shift right. */
25397 frame_x = window_box_left (w, updated_area) + output_cursor.x;
25398 frame_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, output_cursor.y);
25400 FRAME_RIF (f)->shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, frame_x, frame_y, shifted_region_width,
25401 line_height, shift_by_width);
25403 /* Write the glyphs. */
25404 hpos = start - row->glyphs[updated_area];
25405 draw_glyphs (w, output_cursor.x, row, updated_area,
25406 hpos, hpos + len,
25407 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
25409 /* Advance the output cursor. */
25410 output_cursor.hpos += len;
25411 output_cursor.x += shift_by_width;
25412 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
25416 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25417 Erase the current text line from the nominal cursor position
25418 (inclusive) to pixel column TO_X (exclusive). The idea is that
25419 everything from TO_X onward is already erased.
25421 TO_X is a pixel position relative to updated_area of
25422 updated_window. TO_X == -1 means clear to the end of this area. */
25424 void
25425 x_clear_end_of_line (int to_x)
25427 struct frame *f;
25428 struct window *w = updated_window;
25429 int max_x, min_y, max_y;
25430 int from_x, from_y, to_y;
25432 eassert (updated_window && updated_row);
25433 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
25435 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
25436 max_x = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
25437 else
25438 max_x = window_box_width (w, updated_area);
25439 max_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
25441 /* TO_X == 0 means don't do anything. TO_X < 0 means clear to end
25442 of window. For TO_X > 0, truncate to end of drawing area. */
25443 if (to_x == 0)
25444 return;
25445 else if (to_x < 0)
25446 to_x = max_x;
25447 else
25448 to_x = min (to_x, max_x);
25450 to_y = min (max_y, output_cursor.y + updated_row->height);
25452 /* Notice if the cursor will be cleared by this operation. */
25453 if (!updated_row->full_width_p)
25454 notice_overwritten_cursor (w, updated_area,
25455 output_cursor.x, -1,
25456 updated_row->y,
25457 MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (updated_row));
25459 from_x = output_cursor.x;
25461 /* Translate to frame coordinates. */
25462 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
25464 from_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, from_x);
25465 to_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, to_x);
25467 else
25469 int area_left = window_box_left (w, updated_area);
25470 from_x += area_left;
25471 to_x += area_left;
25474 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
25475 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (min_y, output_cursor.y));
25476 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, to_y);
25478 /* Prevent inadvertently clearing to end of the X window. */
25479 if (to_x > from_x && to_y > from_y)
25481 BLOCK_INPUT;
25482 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_frame_area (f, from_x, from_y,
25483 to_x - from_x, to_y - from_y);
25484 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
25488 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
25492 /***********************************************************************
25493 Cursor types
25494 ***********************************************************************/
25496 /* Value is the internal representation of the specified cursor type
25497 ARG. If type is BAR_CURSOR, return in *WIDTH the specified width
25498 of the bar cursor. */
25500 static enum text_cursor_kinds
25501 get_specified_cursor_type (Lisp_Object arg, int *width)
25503 enum text_cursor_kinds type;
25505 if (NILP (arg))
25506 return NO_CURSOR;
25508 if (EQ (arg, Qbox))
25509 return FILLED_BOX_CURSOR;
25511 if (EQ (arg, Qhollow))
25512 return HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25514 if (EQ (arg, Qbar))
25516 *width = 2;
25517 return BAR_CURSOR;
25520 if (CONSP (arg)
25521 && EQ (XCAR (arg), Qbar)
25522 && RANGED_INTEGERP (0, XCDR (arg), INT_MAX))
25524 *width = XINT (XCDR (arg));
25525 return BAR_CURSOR;
25528 if (EQ (arg, Qhbar))
25530 *width = 2;
25531 return HBAR_CURSOR;
25534 if (CONSP (arg)
25535 && EQ (XCAR (arg), Qhbar)
25536 && RANGED_INTEGERP (0, XCDR (arg), INT_MAX))
25538 *width = XINT (XCDR (arg));
25539 return HBAR_CURSOR;
25542 /* Treat anything unknown as "hollow box cursor".
25543 It was bad to signal an error; people have trouble fixing
25544 .Xdefaults with Emacs, when it has something bad in it. */
25545 type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25547 return type;
25550 /* Set the default cursor types for specified frame. */
25551 void
25552 set_frame_cursor_types (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object arg)
25554 int width = 1;
25555 Lisp_Object tem;
25557 FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f) = get_specified_cursor_type (arg, &width);
25558 FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f) = width;
25560 /* By default, set up the blink-off state depending on the on-state. */
25562 tem = Fassoc (arg, Vblink_cursor_alist);
25563 if (!NILP (tem))
25565 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f)
25566 = get_specified_cursor_type (XCDR (tem), &width);
25567 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR_WIDTH (f) = width;
25569 else
25570 FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f) = DEFAULT_CURSOR;
25574 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
25576 /* Return the cursor we want to be displayed in window W. Return
25577 width of bar/hbar cursor through WIDTH arg. Return with
25578 ACTIVE_CURSOR arg set to 1 if cursor in window W is `active'
25579 (i.e. if the `system caret' should track this cursor).
25581 In a mini-buffer window, we want the cursor only to appear if we
25582 are reading input from this window. For the selected window, we
25583 want the cursor type given by the frame parameter or buffer local
25584 setting of cursor-type. If explicitly marked off, draw no cursor.
25585 In all other cases, we want a hollow box cursor. */
25587 static enum text_cursor_kinds
25588 get_window_cursor_type (struct window *w, struct glyph *glyph, int *width,
25589 int *active_cursor)
25591 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
25592 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
25593 int cursor_type = DEFAULT_CURSOR;
25594 Lisp_Object alt_cursor;
25595 int non_selected = 0;
25597 *active_cursor = 1;
25599 /* Echo area */
25600 if (cursor_in_echo_area
25601 && FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f)
25602 && EQ (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), echo_area_window))
25604 if (w == XWINDOW (echo_area_window))
25606 if (EQ (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Qt) || NILP (BVAR (b, cursor_type)))
25608 *width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
25609 return FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
25611 else
25612 return get_specified_cursor_type (BVAR (b, cursor_type), width);
25615 *active_cursor = 0;
25616 non_selected = 1;
25619 /* Detect a nonselected window or nonselected frame. */
25620 else if (w != XWINDOW (f->selected_window)
25621 || f != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame)
25623 *active_cursor = 0;
25625 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w) && minibuf_level == 0)
25626 return NO_CURSOR;
25628 non_selected = 1;
25631 /* Never display a cursor in a window in which cursor-type is nil. */
25632 if (NILP (BVAR (b, cursor_type)))
25633 return NO_CURSOR;
25635 /* Get the normal cursor type for this window. */
25636 if (EQ (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Qt))
25638 cursor_type = FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
25639 *width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
25641 else
25642 cursor_type = get_specified_cursor_type (BVAR (b, cursor_type), width);
25644 /* Use cursor-in-non-selected-windows instead
25645 for non-selected window or frame. */
25646 if (non_selected)
25648 alt_cursor = BVAR (b, cursor_in_non_selected_windows);
25649 if (!EQ (Qt, alt_cursor))
25650 return get_specified_cursor_type (alt_cursor, width);
25651 /* t means modify the normal cursor type. */
25652 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
25653 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25654 else if (cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR && *width > 1)
25655 --*width;
25656 return cursor_type;
25659 /* Use normal cursor if not blinked off. */
25660 if (!w->cursor_off_p)
25662 if (glyph != NULL && glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
25664 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
25666 /* Using a block cursor on large images can be very annoying.
25667 So use a hollow cursor for "large" images.
25668 If image is not transparent (no mask), also use hollow cursor. */
25669 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->u.img_id);
25670 if (img != NULL && IMAGEP (img->spec))
25672 /* Arbitrarily, interpret "Large" as >32x32 and >NxN
25673 where N = size of default frame font size.
25674 This should cover most of the "tiny" icons people may use. */
25675 if (!img->mask
25676 || img->width > max (32, WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w))
25677 || img->height > max (32, WINDOW_FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (w)))
25678 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25681 else if (cursor_type != NO_CURSOR)
25683 /* Display current only supports BOX and HOLLOW cursors for images.
25684 So for now, unconditionally use a HOLLOW cursor when cursor is
25685 not a solid box cursor. */
25686 cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25689 return cursor_type;
25692 /* Cursor is blinked off, so determine how to "toggle" it. */
25694 /* First look for an entry matching the buffer's cursor-type in blink-cursor-alist. */
25695 if ((alt_cursor = Fassoc (BVAR (b, cursor_type), Vblink_cursor_alist), !NILP (alt_cursor)))
25696 return get_specified_cursor_type (XCDR (alt_cursor), width);
25698 /* Then see if frame has specified a specific blink off cursor type. */
25699 if (FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f) != DEFAULT_CURSOR)
25701 *width = FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
25702 return FRAME_BLINK_OFF_CURSOR (f);
25705 #if 0
25706 /* Some people liked having a permanently visible blinking cursor,
25707 while others had very strong opinions against it. So it was
25708 decided to remove it. KFS 2003-09-03 */
25710 /* Finally perform built-in cursor blinking:
25711 filled box <-> hollow box
25712 wide [h]bar <-> narrow [h]bar
25713 narrow [h]bar <-> no cursor
25714 other type <-> no cursor */
25716 if (cursor_type == FILLED_BOX_CURSOR)
25717 return HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
25719 if ((cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR || cursor_type == HBAR_CURSOR) && *width > 1)
25721 *width = 1;
25722 return cursor_type;
25724 #endif
25726 return NO_CURSOR;
25730 /* Notice when the text cursor of window W has been completely
25731 overwritten by a drawing operation that outputs glyphs in AREA
25732 starting at X0 and ending at X1 in the line starting at Y0 and
25733 ending at Y1. X coordinates are area-relative. X1 < 0 means all
25734 the rest of the line after X0 has been written. Y coordinates
25735 are window-relative. */
25737 static void
25738 notice_overwritten_cursor (struct window *w, enum glyph_row_area area,
25739 int x0, int x1, int y0, int y1)
25741 int cx0, cx1, cy0, cy1;
25742 struct glyph_row *row;
25744 if (!w->phys_cursor_on_p)
25745 return;
25746 if (area != TEXT_AREA)
25747 return;
25749 if (w->phys_cursor.vpos < 0
25750 || w->phys_cursor.vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
25751 || (row = w->current_matrix->rows + w->phys_cursor.vpos,
25752 !(row->enabled_p && row->displays_text_p)))
25753 return;
25755 if (row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
25757 row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 0;
25758 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, row->reversed_p);
25759 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
25760 return;
25763 cx0 = w->phys_cursor.x;
25764 cx1 = cx0 + w->phys_cursor_width;
25765 if (x0 > cx0 || (x1 >= 0 && x1 < cx1))
25766 return;
25768 /* The cursor image will be completely removed from the
25769 screen if the output area intersects the cursor area in
25770 y-direction. When we draw in [y0 y1[, and some part of
25771 the cursor is at y < y0, that part must have been drawn
25772 before. When scrolling, the cursor is erased before
25773 actually scrolling, so we don't come here. When not
25774 scrolling, the rows above the old cursor row must have
25775 changed, and in this case these rows must have written
25776 over the cursor image.
25778 Likewise if part of the cursor is below y1, with the
25779 exception of the cursor being in the first blank row at
25780 the buffer and window end because update_text_area
25781 doesn't draw that row. (Except when it does, but
25782 that's handled in update_text_area.) */
25784 cy0 = w->phys_cursor.y;
25785 cy1 = cy0 + w->phys_cursor_height;
25786 if ((y0 < cy0 || y0 >= cy1) && (y1 <= cy0 || y1 >= cy1))
25787 return;
25789 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
25792 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
25795 /************************************************************************
25796 Mouse Face
25797 ************************************************************************/
25799 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
25801 /* EXPORT for RIF:
25802 Fix the display of area AREA of overlapping row ROW in window W
25803 with respect to the overlapping part OVERLAPS. */
25805 void
25806 x_fix_overlapping_area (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
25807 enum glyph_row_area area, int overlaps)
25809 int i, x;
25811 BLOCK_INPUT;
25813 x = 0;
25814 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area];)
25816 if (row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p)
25818 int start = i, start_x = x;
25822 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
25823 ++i;
25825 while (i < row->used[area]
25826 && row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p);
25828 draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, area,
25829 start, i,
25830 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, overlaps);
25832 else
25834 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
25835 ++i;
25839 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
25843 /* EXPORT:
25844 Draw the cursor glyph of window W in glyph row ROW. See the
25845 comment of draw_glyphs for the meaning of HL. */
25847 void
25848 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
25849 enum draw_glyphs_face hl)
25851 /* If cursor hpos is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can
25852 happen in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area
25853 glyphs and mini-buffer. */
25854 if ((row->reversed_p
25855 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= 0)
25856 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos < row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
25858 int on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
25859 int x1;
25860 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
25862 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be
25863 out of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding
25864 window margin in that case. */
25865 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
25866 hpos = 0;
25867 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
25868 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
25870 x1 = draw_glyphs (w, w->phys_cursor.x, row, TEXT_AREA, hpos, hpos + 1,
25871 hl, 0);
25872 w->phys_cursor_on_p = on_p;
25874 if (hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
25875 w->phys_cursor_width = x1 - w->phys_cursor.x;
25876 /* When we erase the cursor, and ROW is overlapped by other
25877 rows, make sure that these overlapping parts of other rows
25878 are redrawn. */
25879 else if (hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT && row->overlapped_p)
25881 w->phys_cursor_width = x1 - w->phys_cursor.x;
25883 if (row > w->current_matrix->rows
25884 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_SUCC_P (row - 1))
25885 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row - 1, TEXT_AREA,
25886 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR);
25888 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < window_text_bottom_y (w)
25889 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_PRED_P (row + 1))
25890 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row + 1, TEXT_AREA,
25891 OVERLAPS_ERASED_CURSOR);
25897 /* EXPORT:
25898 Erase the image of a cursor of window W from the screen. */
25900 void
25901 erase_phys_cursor (struct window *w)
25903 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
25904 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
25905 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
25906 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
25907 int mouse_face_here_p = 0;
25908 struct glyph_matrix *active_glyphs = w->current_matrix;
25909 struct glyph_row *cursor_row;
25910 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
25911 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
25913 /* No cursor displayed or row invalidated => nothing to do on the
25914 screen. */
25915 if (w->phys_cursor_type == NO_CURSOR)
25916 goto mark_cursor_off;
25918 /* VPOS >= active_glyphs->nrows means that window has been resized.
25919 Don't bother to erase the cursor. */
25920 if (vpos >= active_glyphs->nrows)
25921 goto mark_cursor_off;
25923 /* If row containing cursor is marked invalid, there is nothing we
25924 can do. */
25925 cursor_row = MATRIX_ROW (active_glyphs, vpos);
25926 if (!cursor_row->enabled_p)
25927 goto mark_cursor_off;
25929 /* If line spacing is > 0, old cursor may only be partially visible in
25930 window after split-window. So adjust visible height. */
25931 cursor_row->visible_height = min (cursor_row->visible_height,
25932 window_text_bottom_y (w) - cursor_row->y);
25934 /* If row is completely invisible, don't attempt to delete a cursor which
25935 isn't there. This can happen if cursor is at top of a window, and
25936 we switch to a buffer with a header line in that window. */
25937 if (cursor_row->visible_height <= 0)
25938 goto mark_cursor_off;
25940 /* If cursor is in the fringe, erase by drawing actual bitmap there. */
25941 if (cursor_row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
25943 cursor_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 0;
25944 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, cursor_row, cursor_row->reversed_p);
25945 goto mark_cursor_off;
25948 /* This can happen when the new row is shorter than the old one.
25949 In this case, either draw_glyphs or clear_end_of_line
25950 should have cleared the cursor. Note that we wouldn't be
25951 able to erase the cursor in this case because we don't have a
25952 cursor glyph at hand. */
25953 if ((cursor_row->reversed_p
25954 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
25955 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
25956 goto mark_cursor_off;
25958 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be out
25959 of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding window
25960 margin in that case. */
25961 if (!cursor_row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
25962 hpos = 0;
25963 if (cursor_row->reversed_p && hpos >= cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
25964 hpos = cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
25966 /* If the cursor is in the mouse face area, redisplay that when
25967 we clear the cursor. */
25968 if (! NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
25969 && coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, hpos, vpos)
25970 /* Don't redraw the cursor's spot in mouse face if it is at the
25971 end of a line (on a newline). The cursor appears there, but
25972 mouse highlighting does not. */
25973 && cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA] > hpos && hpos >= 0)
25974 mouse_face_here_p = 1;
25976 /* Maybe clear the display under the cursor. */
25977 if (w->phys_cursor_type == HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR)
25979 int x, y, left_x;
25980 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
25981 int width;
25983 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
25984 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
25985 goto mark_cursor_off;
25987 width = cursor_glyph->pixel_width;
25988 left_x = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA);
25989 x = w->phys_cursor.x;
25990 if (x < left_x)
25991 width -= left_x - x;
25992 width = min (width, window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA) - x);
25993 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height, cursor_row->y));
25994 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, max (x, left_x));
25996 if (width > 0)
25997 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, cursor_row->visible_height);
26000 /* Erase the cursor by redrawing the character underneath it. */
26001 if (mouse_face_here_p)
26002 hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
26003 else
26004 hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
26005 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, cursor_row, hl);
26007 mark_cursor_off:
26008 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
26009 w->phys_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
26013 /* EXPORT:
26014 Display or clear cursor of window W. If ON is zero, clear the
26015 cursor. If it is non-zero, display the cursor. If ON is nonzero,
26016 where to put the cursor is specified by HPOS, VPOS, X and Y. */
26018 void
26019 display_and_set_cursor (struct window *w, int on,
26020 int hpos, int vpos, int x, int y)
26022 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
26023 int new_cursor_type;
26024 int new_cursor_width;
26025 int active_cursor;
26026 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
26027 struct glyph *glyph;
26029 /* This is pointless on invisible frames, and dangerous on garbaged
26030 windows and frames; in the latter case, the frame or window may
26031 be in the midst of changing its size, and x and y may be off the
26032 window. */
26033 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
26034 || FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f)
26035 || vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
26036 || hpos >= w->current_matrix->matrix_w)
26037 return;
26039 /* If cursor is off and we want it off, return quickly. */
26040 if (!on && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
26041 return;
26043 glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
26044 /* If cursor row is not enabled, we don't really know where to
26045 display the cursor. */
26046 if (!glyph_row->enabled_p)
26048 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
26049 return;
26052 glyph = NULL;
26053 if (!glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
26054 || (0 <= hpos && hpos < glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA]))
26055 glyph = glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + hpos;
26057 eassert (interrupt_input_blocked);
26059 /* Set new_cursor_type to the cursor we want to be displayed. */
26060 new_cursor_type = get_window_cursor_type (w, glyph,
26061 &new_cursor_width, &active_cursor);
26063 /* If cursor is currently being shown and we don't want it to be or
26064 it is in the wrong place, or the cursor type is not what we want,
26065 erase it. */
26066 if (w->phys_cursor_on_p
26067 && (!on
26068 || w->phys_cursor.x != x
26069 || w->phys_cursor.y != y
26070 || new_cursor_type != w->phys_cursor_type
26071 || ((new_cursor_type == BAR_CURSOR || new_cursor_type == HBAR_CURSOR)
26072 && new_cursor_width != w->phys_cursor_width)))
26073 erase_phys_cursor (w);
26075 /* Don't check phys_cursor_on_p here because that flag is only set
26076 to zero in some cases where we know that the cursor has been
26077 completely erased, to avoid the extra work of erasing the cursor
26078 twice. In other words, phys_cursor_on_p can be 1 and the cursor
26079 still not be visible, or it has only been partly erased. */
26080 if (on)
26082 w->phys_cursor_ascent = glyph_row->ascent;
26083 w->phys_cursor_height = glyph_row->height;
26085 /* Set phys_cursor_.* before x_draw_.* is called because some
26086 of them may need the information. */
26087 w->phys_cursor.x = x;
26088 w->phys_cursor.y = glyph_row->y;
26089 w->phys_cursor.hpos = hpos;
26090 w->phys_cursor.vpos = vpos;
26093 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y,
26094 new_cursor_type, new_cursor_width,
26095 on, active_cursor);
26099 /* Switch the display of W's cursor on or off, according to the value
26100 of ON. */
26102 static void
26103 update_window_cursor (struct window *w, int on)
26105 /* Don't update cursor in windows whose frame is in the process
26106 of being deleted. */
26107 if (w->current_matrix)
26109 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
26110 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
26111 struct glyph_row *row;
26113 if (vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
26114 || hpos >= w->current_matrix->matrix_w)
26115 return;
26117 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
26119 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be
26120 out of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding
26121 window margin in that case. */
26122 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26123 hpos = 0;
26124 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26125 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26127 BLOCK_INPUT;
26128 display_and_set_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos,
26129 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
26130 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
26135 /* Call update_window_cursor with parameter ON_P on all leaf windows
26136 in the window tree rooted at W. */
26138 static void
26139 update_cursor_in_window_tree (struct window *w, int on_p)
26141 while (w)
26143 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
26144 update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), on_p);
26145 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
26146 update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), on_p);
26147 else
26148 update_window_cursor (w, on_p);
26150 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next);
26155 /* EXPORT:
26156 Display the cursor on window W, or clear it, according to ON_P.
26157 Don't change the cursor's position. */
26159 void
26160 x_update_cursor (struct frame *f, int on_p)
26162 update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), on_p);
26166 /* EXPORT:
26167 Clear the cursor of window W to background color, and mark the
26168 cursor as not shown. This is used when the text where the cursor
26169 is about to be rewritten. */
26171 void
26172 x_clear_cursor (struct window *w)
26174 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (w->frame)) && w->phys_cursor_on_p)
26175 update_window_cursor (w, 0);
26178 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26180 /* Implementation of draw_row_with_mouse_face for GUI sessions, GPM,
26181 and MSDOS. */
26182 static void
26183 draw_row_with_mouse_face (struct window *w, int start_x, struct glyph_row *row,
26184 int start_hpos, int end_hpos,
26185 enum draw_glyphs_face draw)
26187 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26188 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (w->frame)))
26190 draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, TEXT_AREA, start_hpos, end_hpos, draw, 0);
26191 return;
26193 #endif
26194 #if defined (HAVE_GPM) || defined (MSDOS) || defined (WINDOWSNT)
26195 tty_draw_row_with_mouse_face (w, row, start_hpos, end_hpos, draw);
26196 #endif
26199 /* Display the active region described by mouse_face_* according to DRAW. */
26201 static void
26202 show_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo, enum draw_glyphs_face draw)
26204 struct window *w = XWINDOW (hlinfo->mouse_face_window);
26205 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
26207 if (/* If window is in the process of being destroyed, don't bother
26208 to do anything. */
26209 w->current_matrix != NULL
26210 /* Don't update mouse highlight if hidden */
26211 && (draw != DRAW_MOUSE_FACE || !hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
26212 /* Recognize when we are called to operate on rows that don't exist
26213 anymore. This can happen when a window is split. */
26214 && hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row < w->current_matrix->nrows)
26216 int phys_cursor_on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
26217 struct glyph_row *row, *first, *last;
26219 first = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row);
26220 last = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row);
26222 for (row = first; row <= last && row->enabled_p; ++row)
26224 int start_hpos, end_hpos, start_x;
26226 /* For all but the first row, the highlight starts at column 0. */
26227 if (row == first)
26229 /* R2L rows have BEG and END in reversed order, but the
26230 screen drawing geometry is always left to right. So
26231 we need to mirror the beginning and end of the
26232 highlighted area in R2L rows. */
26233 if (!row->reversed_p)
26235 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
26236 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x;
26238 else if (row == last)
26240 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
26241 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x;
26243 else
26245 start_hpos = 0;
26246 start_x = 0;
26249 else if (row->reversed_p && row == last)
26251 start_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
26252 start_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x;
26254 else
26256 start_hpos = 0;
26257 start_x = 0;
26260 if (row == last)
26262 if (!row->reversed_p)
26263 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
26264 else if (row == first)
26265 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
26266 else
26268 end_hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
26269 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
26270 row->fill_line_p = 1; /* Clear to end of line */
26273 else if (row->reversed_p && row == first)
26274 end_hpos = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
26275 else
26277 end_hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
26278 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
26279 row->fill_line_p = 1; /* Clear to end of line */
26282 if (end_hpos > start_hpos)
26284 draw_row_with_mouse_face (w, start_x, row,
26285 start_hpos, end_hpos, draw);
26287 row->mouse_face_p
26288 = draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE || draw == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
26292 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26293 /* When we've written over the cursor, arrange for it to
26294 be displayed again. */
26295 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)
26296 && phys_cursor_on_p && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
26298 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
26300 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be
26301 out of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding
26302 window margin in that case. */
26303 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26304 hpos = 0;
26305 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26306 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26308 BLOCK_INPUT;
26309 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, hpos, w->phys_cursor.vpos,
26310 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
26311 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
26313 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26316 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
26317 /* Change the mouse cursor. */
26318 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
26320 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
26321 && !EQ (hlinfo->mouse_face_window, f->tool_bar_window))
26322 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor);
26323 else if (draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
26324 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hand_cursor);
26325 else
26326 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor);
26328 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
26331 /* EXPORT:
26332 Clear out the mouse-highlighted active region.
26333 Redraw it un-highlighted first. Value is non-zero if mouse
26334 face was actually drawn unhighlighted. */
26337 clear_mouse_face (Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo)
26339 int cleared = 0;
26341 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && !NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window))
26343 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT);
26344 cleared = 1;
26347 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
26348 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
26349 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
26350 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
26351 return cleared;
26354 /* Return non-zero if the coordinates HPOS and VPOS on windows W are
26355 within the mouse face on that window. */
26356 static int
26357 coords_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *w, int hpos, int vpos)
26359 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
26361 /* Quickly resolve the easy cases. */
26362 if (!(WINDOWP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
26363 && XWINDOW (hlinfo->mouse_face_window) == w))
26364 return 0;
26365 if (vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
26366 || vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
26367 return 0;
26368 if (vpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
26369 && vpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
26370 return 1;
26372 if (!MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->reversed_p)
26374 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
26376 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col <= hpos && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col)
26377 return 1;
26379 else if ((vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
26380 && hpos >= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
26381 || (vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
26382 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col))
26383 return 1;
26385 else
26387 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
26389 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col < hpos && hpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
26390 return 1;
26392 else if ((vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
26393 && hpos <= hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
26394 || (vpos == hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
26395 && hpos > hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col))
26396 return 1;
26398 return 0;
26402 /* EXPORT:
26403 Non-zero if physical cursor of window W is within mouse face. */
26406 cursor_in_mouse_face_p (struct window *w)
26408 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
26409 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
26410 struct glyph_row *row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
26412 /* When the window is hscrolled, cursor hpos can legitimately be out
26413 of bounds, but we draw the cursor at the corresponding window
26414 margin in that case. */
26415 if (!row->reversed_p && hpos < 0)
26416 hpos = 0;
26417 if (row->reversed_p && hpos >= row->used[TEXT_AREA])
26418 hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26420 return coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, hpos, vpos);
26425 /* Find the glyph rows START_ROW and END_ROW of window W that display
26426 characters between buffer positions START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS
26427 (excluding END_CHARPOS). DISP_STRING is a display string that
26428 covers these buffer positions. This is similar to
26429 row_containing_pos, but is more accurate when bidi reordering makes
26430 buffer positions change non-linearly with glyph rows. */
26431 static void
26432 rows_from_pos_range (struct window *w,
26433 ptrdiff_t start_charpos, ptrdiff_t end_charpos,
26434 Lisp_Object disp_string,
26435 struct glyph_row **start, struct glyph_row **end)
26437 struct glyph_row *first = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
26438 int last_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
26439 struct glyph_row *row;
26441 *start = NULL;
26442 *end = NULL;
26444 while (!first->enabled_p
26445 && first < MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w))
26446 first++;
26448 /* Find the START row. */
26449 for (row = first;
26450 row->enabled_p && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y;
26451 row++)
26453 /* A row can potentially be the START row if the range of the
26454 characters it displays intersects the range
26455 [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS). */
26456 if (! ((start_charpos < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row)
26457 && end_charpos < MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))
26458 /* See the commentary in row_containing_pos, for the
26459 explanation of the complicated way to check whether
26460 some position is beyond the end of the characters
26461 displayed by a row. */
26462 || ((start_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
26463 || (start_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
26464 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
26465 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row)))
26466 && (end_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
26467 || (end_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row)
26468 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
26469 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (row))))))
26471 /* Found a candidate row. Now make sure at least one of the
26472 glyphs it displays has a charpos from the range
26473 [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS).
26475 This is not obvious because bidi reordering could make
26476 buffer positions of a row be 1,2,3,102,101,100, and if we
26477 want to highlight characters in [50..60), we don't want
26478 this row, even though [50..60) does intersect [1..103),
26479 the range of character positions given by the row's start
26480 and end positions. */
26481 struct glyph *g = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26482 struct glyph *e = g + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
26484 while (g < e)
26486 if (((BUFFERP (g->object) || INTEGERP (g->object))
26487 && start_charpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos < end_charpos)
26488 /* A glyph that comes from DISP_STRING is by
26489 definition to be highlighted. */
26490 || EQ (g->object, disp_string))
26491 *start = row;
26492 g++;
26494 if (*start)
26495 break;
26499 /* Find the END row. */
26500 if (!*start
26501 /* If the last row is partially visible, start looking for END
26502 from that row, instead of starting from FIRST. */
26503 && !(row->enabled_p
26504 && row->y < last_y && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) > last_y))
26505 row = first;
26506 for ( ; row->enabled_p && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= last_y; row++)
26508 struct glyph_row *next = row + 1;
26509 ptrdiff_t next_start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (next);
26511 if (!next->enabled_p
26512 || next >= MATRIX_BOTTOM_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix, w)
26513 /* The first row >= START whose range of displayed characters
26514 does NOT intersect the range [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS]
26515 is the row END + 1. */
26516 || (start_charpos < next_start
26517 && end_charpos < next_start)
26518 || ((start_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
26519 || (start_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
26520 && !next->ends_at_zv_p
26521 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (next)))
26522 && (end_charpos > MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
26523 || (end_charpos == MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (next)
26524 && !next->ends_at_zv_p
26525 && !MATRIX_ROW_ENDS_IN_MIDDLE_OF_CHAR_P (next)))))
26527 *end = row;
26528 break;
26530 else
26532 /* If the next row's edges intersect [START_CHARPOS..END_CHARPOS],
26533 but none of the characters it displays are in the range, it is
26534 also END + 1. */
26535 struct glyph *g = next->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26536 struct glyph *s = g;
26537 struct glyph *e = g + next->used[TEXT_AREA];
26539 while (g < e)
26541 if (((BUFFERP (g->object) || INTEGERP (g->object))
26542 && ((start_charpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos < end_charpos)
26543 /* If the buffer position of the first glyph in
26544 the row is equal to END_CHARPOS, it means
26545 the last character to be highlighted is the
26546 newline of ROW, and we must consider NEXT as
26547 END, not END+1. */
26548 || (((!next->reversed_p && g == s)
26549 || (next->reversed_p && g == e - 1))
26550 && (g->charpos == end_charpos
26551 /* Special case for when NEXT is an
26552 empty line at ZV. */
26553 || (g->charpos == -1
26554 && !row->ends_at_zv_p
26555 && next_start == end_charpos)))))
26556 /* A glyph that comes from DISP_STRING is by
26557 definition to be highlighted. */
26558 || EQ (g->object, disp_string))
26559 break;
26560 g++;
26562 if (g == e)
26564 *end = row;
26565 break;
26567 /* The first row that ends at ZV must be the last to be
26568 highlighted. */
26569 else if (next->ends_at_zv_p)
26571 *end = next;
26572 break;
26578 /* This function sets the mouse_face_* elements of HLINFO, assuming
26579 the mouse cursor is on a glyph with buffer charpos MOUSE_CHARPOS in
26580 window WINDOW. START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS are buffer positions
26581 for the overlay or run of text properties specifying the mouse
26582 face. BEFORE_STRING and AFTER_STRING, if non-nil, are a
26583 before-string and after-string that must also be highlighted.
26584 DISP_STRING, if non-nil, is a display string that may cover some
26585 or all of the highlighted text. */
26587 static void
26588 mouse_face_from_buffer_pos (Lisp_Object window,
26589 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo,
26590 ptrdiff_t mouse_charpos,
26591 ptrdiff_t start_charpos,
26592 ptrdiff_t end_charpos,
26593 Lisp_Object before_string,
26594 Lisp_Object after_string,
26595 Lisp_Object disp_string)
26597 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
26598 struct glyph_row *first = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
26599 struct glyph_row *r1, *r2;
26600 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
26601 ptrdiff_t ignore, pos;
26602 int x;
26604 eassert (NILP (disp_string) || STRINGP (disp_string));
26605 eassert (NILP (before_string) || STRINGP (before_string));
26606 eassert (NILP (after_string) || STRINGP (after_string));
26608 /* Find the rows corresponding to START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
26609 rows_from_pos_range (w, start_charpos, end_charpos, disp_string, &r1, &r2);
26610 if (r1 == NULL)
26611 r1 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
26612 /* If the before-string or display-string contains newlines,
26613 rows_from_pos_range skips to its last row. Move back. */
26614 if (!NILP (before_string) || !NILP (disp_string))
26616 struct glyph_row *prev;
26617 while ((prev = r1 - 1, prev >= first)
26618 && MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (prev) == start_charpos
26619 && prev->used[TEXT_AREA] > 0)
26621 struct glyph *beg = prev->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26622 glyph = beg + prev->used[TEXT_AREA];
26623 while (--glyph >= beg && INTEGERP (glyph->object));
26624 if (glyph < beg
26625 || !(EQ (glyph->object, before_string)
26626 || EQ (glyph->object, disp_string)))
26627 break;
26628 r1 = prev;
26631 if (r2 == NULL)
26633 r2 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
26634 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 1;
26636 else if (!NILP (after_string))
26638 /* If the after-string has newlines, advance to its last row. */
26639 struct glyph_row *next;
26640 struct glyph_row *last
26641 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos));
26643 for (next = r2 + 1;
26644 next <= last
26645 && next->used[TEXT_AREA] > 0
26646 && EQ (next->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->object, after_string);
26647 ++next)
26648 r2 = next;
26650 /* The rest of the display engine assumes that mouse_face_beg_row is
26651 either above mouse_face_end_row or identical to it. But with
26652 bidi-reordered continued lines, the row for START_CHARPOS could
26653 be below the row for END_CHARPOS. If so, swap the rows and store
26654 them in correct order. */
26655 if (r1->y > r2->y)
26657 struct glyph_row *tem = r2;
26659 r2 = r1;
26660 r1 = tem;
26663 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = r1->y;
26664 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r1, w->current_matrix);
26665 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = r2->y;
26666 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (r2, w->current_matrix);
26668 /* For a bidi-reordered row, the positions of BEFORE_STRING,
26669 AFTER_STRING, DISP_STRING, START_CHARPOS, and END_CHARPOS
26670 could be anywhere in the row and in any order. The strategy
26671 below is to find the leftmost and the rightmost glyph that
26672 belongs to either of these 3 strings, or whose position is
26673 between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS, and highlight all the
26674 glyphs between those two. This may cover more than just the text
26675 between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS if the range of characters
26676 strides the bidi level boundary, e.g. if the beginning is in R2L
26677 text while the end is in L2R text or vice versa. */
26678 if (!r1->reversed_p)
26680 /* This row is in a left to right paragraph. Scan it left to
26681 right. */
26682 glyph = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26683 end = glyph + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
26684 x = r1->x;
26686 /* Skip truncation glyphs at the start of the glyph row. */
26687 if (r1->displays_text_p)
26688 for (; glyph < end
26689 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26690 && glyph->charpos < 0;
26691 ++glyph)
26692 x += glyph->pixel_width;
26694 /* Scan the glyph row, looking for BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING,
26695 or DISP_STRING, and the first glyph from buffer whose
26696 position is between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
26697 for (; glyph < end
26698 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26699 && !EQ (glyph->object, disp_string)
26700 && !(BUFFERP (glyph->object)
26701 && (glyph->charpos >= start_charpos
26702 && glyph->charpos < end_charpos));
26703 ++glyph)
26705 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26706 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26707 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26708 if (EQ (glyph->object, before_string))
26710 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string,
26711 start_charpos);
26712 /* If pos == 0, it means before_string came from an
26713 overlay, not from a buffer position. */
26714 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26715 break;
26717 else if (EQ (glyph->object, after_string))
26719 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26720 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26721 break;
26723 x += glyph->pixel_width;
26725 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
26726 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = glyph - r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26728 else
26730 /* This row is in a right to left paragraph. Scan it right to
26731 left. */
26732 struct glyph *g;
26734 end = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26735 glyph = end + r1->used[TEXT_AREA];
26737 /* Skip truncation glyphs at the start of the glyph row. */
26738 if (r1->displays_text_p)
26739 for (; glyph > end
26740 && INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26741 && glyph->charpos < 0;
26742 --glyph)
26745 /* Scan the glyph row, looking for BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING,
26746 or DISP_STRING, and the first glyph from buffer whose
26747 position is between START_CHARPOS and END_CHARPOS. */
26748 for (; glyph > end
26749 && !INTEGERP (glyph->object)
26750 && !EQ (glyph->object, disp_string)
26751 && !(BUFFERP (glyph->object)
26752 && (glyph->charpos >= start_charpos
26753 && glyph->charpos < end_charpos));
26754 --glyph)
26756 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26757 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26758 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26759 if (EQ (glyph->object, before_string))
26761 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
26762 /* If pos == 0, it means before_string came from an
26763 overlay, not from a buffer position. */
26764 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26765 break;
26767 else if (EQ (glyph->object, after_string))
26769 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26770 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26771 break;
26775 glyph++; /* first glyph to the right of the highlighted area */
26776 for (g = r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], x = r1->x; g < glyph; g++)
26777 x += g->pixel_width;
26778 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
26779 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = glyph - r1->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26782 /* If the highlight ends in a different row, compute GLYPH and END
26783 for the end row. Otherwise, reuse the values computed above for
26784 the row where the highlight begins. */
26785 if (r2 != r1)
26787 if (!r2->reversed_p)
26789 glyph = r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26790 end = glyph + r2->used[TEXT_AREA];
26791 x = r2->x;
26793 else
26795 end = r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
26796 glyph = end + r2->used[TEXT_AREA];
26800 if (!r2->reversed_p)
26802 /* Skip truncation and continuation glyphs near the end of the
26803 row, and also blanks and stretch glyphs inserted by
26804 extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
26805 while (end > glyph
26806 && INTEGERP ((end - 1)->object))
26807 --end;
26808 /* Scan the rest of the glyph row from the end, looking for the
26809 first glyph that comes from BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING, or
26810 DISP_STRING, or whose position is between START_CHARPOS
26811 and END_CHARPOS */
26812 for (--end;
26813 end > glyph
26814 && !INTEGERP (end->object)
26815 && !EQ (end->object, disp_string)
26816 && !(BUFFERP (end->object)
26817 && (end->charpos >= start_charpos
26818 && end->charpos < end_charpos));
26819 --end)
26821 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26822 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26823 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26824 if (EQ (end->object, before_string))
26826 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
26827 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26828 break;
26830 else if (EQ (end->object, after_string))
26832 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26833 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26834 break;
26837 /* Find the X coordinate of the last glyph to be highlighted. */
26838 for (; glyph <= end; ++glyph)
26839 x += glyph->pixel_width;
26841 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x;
26842 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = glyph - r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26844 else
26846 /* Skip truncation and continuation glyphs near the end of the
26847 row, and also blanks and stretch glyphs inserted by
26848 extend_face_to_end_of_line. */
26849 x = r2->x;
26850 end++;
26851 while (end < glyph
26852 && INTEGERP (end->object))
26854 x += end->pixel_width;
26855 ++end;
26857 /* Scan the rest of the glyph row from the end, looking for the
26858 first glyph that comes from BEFORE_STRING, AFTER_STRING, or
26859 DISP_STRING, or whose position is between START_CHARPOS
26860 and END_CHARPOS */
26861 for ( ;
26862 end < glyph
26863 && !INTEGERP (end->object)
26864 && !EQ (end->object, disp_string)
26865 && !(BUFFERP (end->object)
26866 && (end->charpos >= start_charpos
26867 && end->charpos < end_charpos));
26868 ++end)
26870 /* BEFORE_STRING or AFTER_STRING are only relevant if they
26871 are present at buffer positions between START_CHARPOS and
26872 END_CHARPOS, or if they come from an overlay. */
26873 if (EQ (end->object, before_string))
26875 pos = string_buffer_position (before_string, start_charpos);
26876 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26877 break;
26879 else if (EQ (end->object, after_string))
26881 pos = string_buffer_position (after_string, end_charpos);
26882 if (!pos || (pos >= start_charpos && pos < end_charpos))
26883 break;
26885 x += end->pixel_width;
26887 /* If we exited the above loop because we arrived at the last
26888 glyph of the row, and its buffer position is still not in
26889 range, it means the last character in range is the preceding
26890 newline. Bump the end column and x values to get past the
26891 last glyph. */
26892 if (end == glyph
26893 && BUFFERP (end->object)
26894 && (end->charpos < start_charpos
26895 || end->charpos >= end_charpos))
26897 x += end->pixel_width;
26898 ++end;
26900 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x;
26901 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = end - r2->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26904 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
26905 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id
26906 = face_at_buffer_position (w, mouse_charpos, 0, 0, &ignore,
26907 mouse_charpos + 1,
26908 !hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden, -1);
26909 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
26912 /* The following function is not used anymore (replaced with
26913 mouse_face_from_string_pos), but I leave it here for the time
26914 being, in case someone would. */
26916 #if 0 /* not used */
26918 /* Find the position of the glyph for position POS in OBJECT in
26919 window W's current matrix, and return in *X, *Y the pixel
26920 coordinates, and return in *HPOS, *VPOS the column/row of the glyph.
26922 RIGHT_P non-zero means return the position of the right edge of the
26923 glyph, RIGHT_P zero means return the left edge position.
26925 If no glyph for POS exists in the matrix, return the position of
26926 the glyph with the next smaller position that is in the matrix, if
26927 RIGHT_P is zero. If RIGHT_P is non-zero, and no glyph for POS
26928 exists in the matrix, return the position of the glyph with the
26929 next larger position in OBJECT.
26931 Value is non-zero if a glyph was found. */
26933 static int
26934 fast_find_string_pos (struct window *w, ptrdiff_t pos, Lisp_Object object,
26935 int *hpos, int *vpos, int *x, int *y, int right_p)
26937 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
26938 struct glyph_row *r;
26939 struct glyph *best_glyph = NULL;
26940 struct glyph_row *best_row = NULL;
26941 int best_x = 0;
26943 for (r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
26944 r->enabled_p && r->y < yb;
26945 ++r)
26947 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26948 struct glyph *e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
26949 int gx;
26951 for (gx = r->x; g < e; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
26952 if (EQ (g->object, object))
26954 if (g->charpos == pos)
26956 best_glyph = g;
26957 best_x = gx;
26958 best_row = r;
26959 goto found;
26961 else if (best_glyph == NULL
26962 || ((eabs (g->charpos - pos)
26963 < eabs (best_glyph->charpos - pos))
26964 && (right_p
26965 ? g->charpos < pos
26966 : g->charpos > pos)))
26968 best_glyph = g;
26969 best_x = gx;
26970 best_row = r;
26975 found:
26977 if (best_glyph)
26979 *x = best_x;
26980 *hpos = best_glyph - best_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
26982 if (right_p)
26984 *x += best_glyph->pixel_width;
26985 ++*hpos;
26988 *y = best_row->y;
26989 *vpos = best_row - w->current_matrix->rows;
26992 return best_glyph != NULL;
26994 #endif /* not used */
26996 /* Find the positions of the first and the last glyphs in window W's
26997 current matrix that occlude positions [STARTPOS..ENDPOS] in OBJECT
26998 (assumed to be a string), and return in HLINFO's mouse_face_*
26999 members the pixel and column/row coordinates of those glyphs. */
27001 static void
27002 mouse_face_from_string_pos (struct window *w, Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo,
27003 Lisp_Object object,
27004 ptrdiff_t startpos, ptrdiff_t endpos)
27006 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
27007 struct glyph_row *r;
27008 struct glyph *g, *e;
27009 int gx;
27010 int found = 0;
27012 /* Find the glyph row with at least one position in the range
27013 [STARTPOS..ENDPOS], and the first glyph in that row whose
27014 position belongs to that range. */
27015 for (r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
27016 r->enabled_p && r->y < yb;
27017 ++r)
27019 if (!r->reversed_p)
27021 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27022 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27023 for (gx = r->x; g < e; gx += g->pixel_width, ++g)
27024 if (EQ (g->object, object)
27025 && startpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos <= endpos)
27027 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = r - w->current_matrix->rows;
27028 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = r->y;
27029 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = g - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27030 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = gx;
27031 found = 1;
27032 break;
27035 else
27037 struct glyph *g1;
27039 e = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27040 g = e + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27041 for ( ; g > e; --g)
27042 if (EQ ((g-1)->object, object)
27043 && startpos <= (g-1)->charpos && (g-1)->charpos <= endpos)
27045 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = r - w->current_matrix->rows;
27046 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = r->y;
27047 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = g - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27048 for (gx = r->x, g1 = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; g1 < g; ++g1)
27049 gx += g1->pixel_width;
27050 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = gx;
27051 found = 1;
27052 break;
27055 if (found)
27056 break;
27059 if (!found)
27060 return;
27062 /* Starting with the next row, look for the first row which does NOT
27063 include any glyphs whose positions are in the range. */
27064 for (++r; r->enabled_p && r->y < yb; ++r)
27066 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27067 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27068 found = 0;
27069 for ( ; g < e; ++g)
27070 if (EQ (g->object, object)
27071 && startpos <= g->charpos && g->charpos <= endpos)
27073 found = 1;
27074 break;
27076 if (!found)
27077 break;
27080 /* The highlighted region ends on the previous row. */
27081 r--;
27083 /* Set the end row and its vertical pixel coordinate. */
27084 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = r - w->current_matrix->rows;
27085 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = r->y;
27087 /* Compute and set the end column and the end column's horizontal
27088 pixel coordinate. */
27089 if (!r->reversed_p)
27091 g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27092 e = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27093 for ( ; e > g; --e)
27094 if (EQ ((e-1)->object, object)
27095 && startpos <= (e-1)->charpos && (e-1)->charpos <= endpos)
27096 break;
27097 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = e - g;
27099 for (gx = r->x; g < e; ++g)
27100 gx += g->pixel_width;
27101 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = gx;
27103 else
27105 e = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27106 g = e + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
27107 for (gx = r->x ; e < g; ++e)
27109 if (EQ (e->object, object)
27110 && startpos <= e->charpos && e->charpos <= endpos)
27111 break;
27112 gx += e->pixel_width;
27114 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = e - r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27115 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = gx;
27119 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27121 /* See if position X, Y is within a hot-spot of an image. */
27123 static int
27124 on_hot_spot_p (Lisp_Object hot_spot, int x, int y)
27126 if (!CONSP (hot_spot))
27127 return 0;
27129 if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qrect))
27131 /* CDR is (Top-Left . Bottom-Right) = ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1)) */
27132 Lisp_Object rect = XCDR (hot_spot);
27133 Lisp_Object tem;
27134 if (!CONSP (rect))
27135 return 0;
27136 if (!CONSP (XCAR (rect)))
27137 return 0;
27138 if (!CONSP (XCDR (rect)))
27139 return 0;
27140 if (!(tem = XCAR (XCAR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && x >= XINT (tem)))
27141 return 0;
27142 if (!(tem = XCDR (XCAR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && y >= XINT (tem)))
27143 return 0;
27144 if (!(tem = XCAR (XCDR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && x <= XINT (tem)))
27145 return 0;
27146 if (!(tem = XCDR (XCDR (rect)), INTEGERP (tem) && y <= XINT (tem)))
27147 return 0;
27148 return 1;
27150 else if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qcircle))
27152 /* CDR is (Center . Radius) = ((x0 . y0) . r) */
27153 Lisp_Object circ = XCDR (hot_spot);
27154 Lisp_Object lr, lx0, ly0;
27155 if (CONSP (circ)
27156 && CONSP (XCAR (circ))
27157 && (lr = XCDR (circ), INTEGERP (lr) || FLOATP (lr))
27158 && (lx0 = XCAR (XCAR (circ)), INTEGERP (lx0))
27159 && (ly0 = XCDR (XCAR (circ)), INTEGERP (ly0)))
27161 double r = XFLOATINT (lr);
27162 double dx = XINT (lx0) - x;
27163 double dy = XINT (ly0) - y;
27164 return (dx * dx + dy * dy <= r * r);
27167 else if (EQ (XCAR (hot_spot), Qpoly))
27169 /* CDR is [x0 y0 x1 y1 x2 y2 ...x(n-1) y(n-1)] */
27170 if (VECTORP (XCDR (hot_spot)))
27172 struct Lisp_Vector *v = XVECTOR (XCDR (hot_spot));
27173 Lisp_Object *poly = v->contents;
27174 ptrdiff_t n = v->header.size;
27175 ptrdiff_t i;
27176 int inside = 0;
27177 Lisp_Object lx, ly;
27178 int x0, y0;
27180 /* Need an even number of coordinates, and at least 3 edges. */
27181 if (n < 6 || n & 1)
27182 return 0;
27184 /* Count edge segments intersecting line from (X,Y) to (X,infinity).
27185 If count is odd, we are inside polygon. Pixels on edges
27186 may or may not be included depending on actual geometry of the
27187 polygon. */
27188 if ((lx = poly[n-2], !INTEGERP (lx))
27189 || (ly = poly[n-1], !INTEGERP (lx)))
27190 return 0;
27191 x0 = XINT (lx), y0 = XINT (ly);
27192 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 2)
27194 int x1 = x0, y1 = y0;
27195 if ((lx = poly[i], !INTEGERP (lx))
27196 || (ly = poly[i+1], !INTEGERP (ly)))
27197 return 0;
27198 x0 = XINT (lx), y0 = XINT (ly);
27200 /* Does this segment cross the X line? */
27201 if (x0 >= x)
27203 if (x1 >= x)
27204 continue;
27206 else if (x1 < x)
27207 continue;
27208 if (y > y0 && y > y1)
27209 continue;
27210 if (y < y0 + ((y1 - y0) * (x - x0)) / (x1 - x0))
27211 inside = !inside;
27213 return inside;
27216 return 0;
27219 Lisp_Object
27220 find_hot_spot (Lisp_Object map, int x, int y)
27222 while (CONSP (map))
27224 if (CONSP (XCAR (map))
27225 && on_hot_spot_p (XCAR (XCAR (map)), x, y))
27226 return XCAR (map);
27227 map = XCDR (map);
27230 return Qnil;
27233 DEFUN ("lookup-image-map", Flookup_image_map, Slookup_image_map,
27234 3, 3, 0,
27235 doc: /* Lookup in image map MAP coordinates X and Y.
27236 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
27237 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
27238 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1))) specifying the
27239 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
27240 A circle is a cons (circle . ((x0 . y0) . r)) specifying the center
27241 and the radius of the circle; r may be a float or integer.
27242 A polygon is a cons (poly . [x0 y0 x1 y1 ...]) where each pair in the
27243 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
27244 Returns the alist element for the first matching AREA in MAP. */)
27245 (Lisp_Object map, Lisp_Object x, Lisp_Object y)
27247 if (NILP (map))
27248 return Qnil;
27250 CHECK_NUMBER (x);
27251 CHECK_NUMBER (y);
27253 return find_hot_spot (map,
27254 clip_to_bounds (INT_MIN, XINT (x), INT_MAX),
27255 clip_to_bounds (INT_MIN, XINT (y), INT_MAX));
27259 /* Display frame CURSOR, optionally using shape defined by POINTER. */
27260 static void
27261 define_frame_cursor1 (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor, Lisp_Object pointer)
27263 /* Do not change cursor shape while dragging mouse. */
27264 if (!NILP (do_mouse_tracking))
27265 return;
27267 if (!NILP (pointer))
27269 if (EQ (pointer, Qarrow))
27270 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27271 else if (EQ (pointer, Qhand))
27272 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hand_cursor;
27273 else if (EQ (pointer, Qtext))
27274 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor;
27275 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("hdrag")))
27276 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->horizontal_drag_cursor;
27277 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
27278 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("vdrag")))
27279 cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
27280 #endif
27281 else if (EQ (pointer, intern ("hourglass")))
27282 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->hourglass_cursor;
27283 else if (EQ (pointer, Qmodeline))
27284 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->modeline_cursor;
27285 else
27286 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27289 if (cursor != No_Cursor)
27290 FRAME_RIF (f)->define_frame_cursor (f, cursor);
27293 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
27295 /* Take proper action when mouse has moved to the mode or header line
27296 or marginal area AREA of window W, x-position X and y-position Y.
27297 X is relative to the start of the text display area of W, so the
27298 width of bitmap areas and scroll bars must be subtracted to get a
27299 position relative to the start of the mode line. */
27301 static void
27302 note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight (Lisp_Object window, int x, int y,
27303 enum window_part area)
27305 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
27306 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
27307 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
27308 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27309 Display_Info *dpyinfo;
27310 #endif
27311 Cursor cursor = No_Cursor;
27312 Lisp_Object pointer = Qnil;
27313 int dx, dy, width, height;
27314 ptrdiff_t charpos;
27315 Lisp_Object string, object = Qnil;
27316 Lisp_Object pos IF_LINT (= Qnil), help;
27318 Lisp_Object mouse_face;
27319 int original_x_pixel = x;
27320 struct glyph * glyph = NULL, * row_start_glyph = NULL;
27321 struct glyph_row *row IF_LINT (= 0);
27323 if (area == ON_MODE_LINE || area == ON_HEADER_LINE)
27325 int x0;
27326 struct glyph *end;
27328 /* Kludge alert: mode_line_string takes X/Y in pixels, but
27329 returns them in row/column units! */
27330 string = mode_line_string (w, area, &x, &y, &charpos,
27331 &object, &dx, &dy, &width, &height);
27333 row = (area == ON_MODE_LINE
27334 ? MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix)
27335 : MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix));
27337 /* Find the glyph under the mouse pointer. */
27338 if (row->mode_line_p && row->enabled_p)
27340 glyph = row_start_glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
27341 end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
27343 for (x0 = original_x_pixel;
27344 glyph < end && x0 >= glyph->pixel_width;
27345 ++glyph)
27346 x0 -= glyph->pixel_width;
27348 if (glyph >= end)
27349 glyph = NULL;
27352 else
27354 x -= WINDOW_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
27355 /* Kludge alert: marginal_area_string takes X/Y in pixels, but
27356 returns them in row/column units! */
27357 string = marginal_area_string (w, area, &x, &y, &charpos,
27358 &object, &dx, &dy, &width, &height);
27361 help = Qnil;
27363 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27364 if (IMAGEP (object))
27366 Lisp_Object image_map, hotspot;
27367 if ((image_map = Fplist_get (XCDR (object), QCmap),
27368 !NILP (image_map))
27369 && (hotspot = find_hot_spot (image_map, dx, dy),
27370 CONSP (hotspot))
27371 && (hotspot = XCDR (hotspot), CONSP (hotspot)))
27373 Lisp_Object plist;
27375 /* Could check XCAR (hotspot) to see if we enter/leave this hot-spot.
27376 If so, we could look for mouse-enter, mouse-leave
27377 properties in PLIST (and do something...). */
27378 hotspot = XCDR (hotspot);
27379 if (CONSP (hotspot)
27380 && (plist = XCAR (hotspot), CONSP (plist)))
27382 pointer = Fplist_get (plist, Qpointer);
27383 if (NILP (pointer))
27384 pointer = Qhand;
27385 help = Fplist_get (plist, Qhelp_echo);
27386 if (!NILP (help))
27388 help_echo_string = help;
27389 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
27390 help_echo_object = w->buffer;
27391 help_echo_pos = charpos;
27395 if (NILP (pointer))
27396 pointer = Fplist_get (XCDR (object), QCpointer);
27398 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
27400 if (STRINGP (string))
27401 pos = make_number (charpos);
27403 /* Set the help text and mouse pointer. If the mouse is on a part
27404 of the mode line without any text (e.g. past the right edge of
27405 the mode line text), use the default help text and pointer. */
27406 if (STRINGP (string) || area == ON_MODE_LINE)
27408 /* Arrange to display the help by setting the global variables
27409 help_echo_string, help_echo_object, and help_echo_pos. */
27410 if (NILP (help))
27412 if (STRINGP (string))
27413 help = Fget_text_property (pos, Qhelp_echo, string);
27415 if (!NILP (help))
27417 help_echo_string = help;
27418 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
27419 help_echo_object = string;
27420 help_echo_pos = charpos;
27422 else if (area == ON_MODE_LINE)
27424 Lisp_Object default_help
27425 = buffer_local_value_1 (Qmode_line_default_help_echo,
27426 w->buffer);
27428 if (STRINGP (default_help))
27430 help_echo_string = default_help;
27431 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
27432 help_echo_object = Qnil;
27433 help_echo_pos = -1;
27438 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27439 /* Change the mouse pointer according to what is under it. */
27440 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
27442 dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
27443 if (STRINGP (string))
27445 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27447 if (NILP (pointer))
27448 pointer = Fget_text_property (pos, Qpointer, string);
27450 /* Change the mouse pointer according to what is under X/Y. */
27451 if (NILP (pointer)
27452 && ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE)))
27454 Lisp_Object map;
27455 map = Fget_text_property (pos, Qlocal_map, string);
27456 if (!KEYMAPP (map))
27457 map = Fget_text_property (pos, Qkeymap, string);
27458 if (!KEYMAPP (map))
27459 cursor = dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
27462 else
27463 /* Default mode-line pointer. */
27464 cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
27466 #endif
27469 /* Change the mouse face according to what is under X/Y. */
27470 if (STRINGP (string))
27472 mouse_face = Fget_text_property (pos, Qmouse_face, string);
27473 if (!NILP (mouse_face)
27474 && ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE))
27475 && glyph)
27477 Lisp_Object b, e;
27479 struct glyph * tmp_glyph;
27481 int gpos;
27482 int gseq_length;
27483 int total_pixel_width;
27484 ptrdiff_t begpos, endpos, ignore;
27486 int vpos, hpos;
27488 b = Fprevious_single_property_change (make_number (charpos + 1),
27489 Qmouse_face, string, Qnil);
27490 if (NILP (b))
27491 begpos = 0;
27492 else
27493 begpos = XINT (b);
27495 e = Fnext_single_property_change (pos, Qmouse_face, string, Qnil);
27496 if (NILP (e))
27497 endpos = SCHARS (string);
27498 else
27499 endpos = XINT (e);
27501 /* Calculate the glyph position GPOS of GLYPH in the
27502 displayed string, relative to the beginning of the
27503 highlighted part of the string.
27505 Note: GPOS is different from CHARPOS. CHARPOS is the
27506 position of GLYPH in the internal string object. A mode
27507 line string format has structures which are converted to
27508 a flattened string by the Emacs Lisp interpreter. The
27509 internal string is an element of those structures. The
27510 displayed string is the flattened string. */
27511 tmp_glyph = row_start_glyph;
27512 while (tmp_glyph < glyph
27513 && (!(EQ (tmp_glyph->object, glyph->object)
27514 && begpos <= tmp_glyph->charpos
27515 && tmp_glyph->charpos < endpos)))
27516 tmp_glyph++;
27517 gpos = glyph - tmp_glyph;
27519 /* Calculate the length GSEQ_LENGTH of the glyph sequence of
27520 the highlighted part of the displayed string to which
27521 GLYPH belongs. Note: GSEQ_LENGTH is different from
27522 SCHARS (STRING), because the latter returns the length of
27523 the internal string. */
27524 for (tmp_glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1;
27525 tmp_glyph > glyph
27526 && (!(EQ (tmp_glyph->object, glyph->object)
27527 && begpos <= tmp_glyph->charpos
27528 && tmp_glyph->charpos < endpos));
27529 tmp_glyph--)
27531 gseq_length = gpos + (tmp_glyph - glyph) + 1;
27533 /* Calculate the total pixel width of all the glyphs between
27534 the beginning of the highlighted area and GLYPH. */
27535 total_pixel_width = 0;
27536 for (tmp_glyph = glyph - gpos; tmp_glyph != glyph; tmp_glyph++)
27537 total_pixel_width += tmp_glyph->pixel_width;
27539 /* Pre calculation of re-rendering position. Note: X is in
27540 column units here, after the call to mode_line_string or
27541 marginal_area_string. */
27542 hpos = x - gpos;
27543 vpos = (area == ON_MODE_LINE
27544 ? (w->current_matrix)->nrows - 1
27545 : 0);
27547 /* If GLYPH's position is included in the region that is
27548 already drawn in mouse face, we have nothing to do. */
27549 if ( EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
27550 && (!row->reversed_p
27551 ? (hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col <= hpos
27552 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col)
27553 /* In R2L rows we swap BEG and END, see below. */
27554 : (hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col <= hpos
27555 && hpos < hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col))
27556 && hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row == vpos )
27557 return;
27559 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
27560 cursor = No_Cursor;
27562 if (!row->reversed_p)
27564 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos;
27565 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = original_x_pixel
27566 - (total_pixel_width + dx);
27567 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos + gseq_length;
27568 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = 0;
27570 else
27572 /* In R2L rows, show_mouse_face expects BEG and END
27573 coordinates to be swapped. */
27574 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos;
27575 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_x = original_x_pixel
27576 - (total_pixel_width + dx);
27577 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos + gseq_length;
27578 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = 0;
27581 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = vpos;
27582 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row;
27583 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = 0;
27584 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_y = 0;
27585 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
27586 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
27588 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = face_at_string_position (w, string,
27589 charpos,
27590 0, 0, 0,
27591 &ignore,
27592 glyph->face_id,
27594 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
27596 if (NILP (pointer))
27597 pointer = Qhand;
27599 else if ((area == ON_MODE_LINE) || (area == ON_HEADER_LINE))
27600 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
27602 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27603 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
27604 define_frame_cursor1 (f, cursor, pointer);
27605 #endif
27609 /* EXPORT:
27610 Take proper action when the mouse has moved to position X, Y on
27611 frame F as regards highlighting characters that have mouse-face
27612 properties. Also de-highlighting chars where the mouse was before.
27613 X and Y can be negative or out of range. */
27615 void
27616 note_mouse_highlight (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
27618 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
27619 enum window_part part = ON_NOTHING;
27620 Lisp_Object window;
27621 struct window *w;
27622 Cursor cursor = No_Cursor;
27623 Lisp_Object pointer = Qnil; /* Takes precedence over cursor! */
27624 struct buffer *b;
27626 /* When a menu is active, don't highlight because this looks odd. */
27627 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK) || defined (HAVE_NS) || defined (MSDOS)
27628 if (popup_activated ())
27629 return;
27630 #endif
27632 if (NILP (Vmouse_highlight)
27633 || !f->glyphs_initialized_p
27634 || f->pointer_invisible)
27635 return;
27637 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = x;
27638 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = y;
27639 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = f;
27641 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_defer)
27642 return;
27644 if (gc_in_progress)
27646 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 1;
27647 return;
27650 /* Which window is that in? */
27651 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, &part, 1);
27653 /* If displaying active text in another window, clear that. */
27654 if (! EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
27655 /* Also clear if we move out of text area in same window. */
27656 || (!NILP (hlinfo->mouse_face_window)
27657 && !NILP (window)
27658 && part != ON_TEXT
27659 && part != ON_MODE_LINE
27660 && part != ON_HEADER_LINE))
27661 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
27663 /* Not on a window -> return. */
27664 if (!WINDOWP (window))
27665 return;
27667 /* Reset help_echo_string. It will get recomputed below. */
27668 help_echo_string = Qnil;
27670 /* Convert to window-relative pixel coordinates. */
27671 w = XWINDOW (window);
27672 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
27674 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27675 /* Handle tool-bar window differently since it doesn't display a
27676 buffer. */
27677 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
27679 note_tool_bar_highlight (f, x, y);
27680 return;
27682 #endif
27684 /* Mouse is on the mode, header line or margin? */
27685 if (part == ON_MODE_LINE || part == ON_HEADER_LINE
27686 || part == ON_LEFT_MARGIN || part == ON_RIGHT_MARGIN)
27688 note_mode_line_or_margin_highlight (window, x, y, part);
27689 return;
27692 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27693 if (part == ON_VERTICAL_BORDER)
27695 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->horizontal_drag_cursor;
27696 help_echo_string = build_string ("drag-mouse-1: resize");
27698 else if (part == ON_LEFT_FRINGE || part == ON_RIGHT_FRINGE
27699 || part == ON_SCROLL_BAR)
27700 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27701 else
27702 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->text_cursor;
27703 #endif
27705 /* Are we in a window whose display is up to date?
27706 And verify the buffer's text has not changed. */
27707 b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
27708 if (part == ON_TEXT
27709 && EQ (w->window_end_valid, w->buffer)
27710 && w->last_modified == BUF_MODIFF (b)
27711 && w->last_overlay_modified == BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF (b))
27713 int hpos, vpos, dx, dy, area = LAST_AREA;
27714 ptrdiff_t pos;
27715 struct glyph *glyph;
27716 Lisp_Object object;
27717 Lisp_Object mouse_face = Qnil, position;
27718 Lisp_Object *overlay_vec = NULL;
27719 ptrdiff_t i, noverlays;
27720 struct buffer *obuf;
27721 ptrdiff_t obegv, ozv;
27722 int same_region;
27724 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
27725 glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, &hpos, &vpos, &dx, &dy, &area);
27727 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27728 /* Look for :pointer property on image. */
27729 if (glyph != NULL && glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
27731 struct image *img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->u.img_id);
27732 if (img != NULL && IMAGEP (img->spec))
27734 Lisp_Object image_map, hotspot;
27735 if ((image_map = Fplist_get (XCDR (img->spec), QCmap),
27736 !NILP (image_map))
27737 && (hotspot = find_hot_spot (image_map,
27738 glyph->slice.img.x + dx,
27739 glyph->slice.img.y + dy),
27740 CONSP (hotspot))
27741 && (hotspot = XCDR (hotspot), CONSP (hotspot)))
27743 Lisp_Object plist;
27745 /* Could check XCAR (hotspot) to see if we enter/leave
27746 this hot-spot.
27747 If so, we could look for mouse-enter, mouse-leave
27748 properties in PLIST (and do something...). */
27749 hotspot = XCDR (hotspot);
27750 if (CONSP (hotspot)
27751 && (plist = XCAR (hotspot), CONSP (plist)))
27753 pointer = Fplist_get (plist, Qpointer);
27754 if (NILP (pointer))
27755 pointer = Qhand;
27756 help_echo_string = Fplist_get (plist, Qhelp_echo);
27757 if (!NILP (help_echo_string))
27759 help_echo_window = window;
27760 help_echo_object = glyph->object;
27761 help_echo_pos = glyph->charpos;
27765 if (NILP (pointer))
27766 pointer = Fplist_get (XCDR (img->spec), QCpointer);
27769 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
27771 /* Clear mouse face if X/Y not over text. */
27772 if (glyph == NULL
27773 || area != TEXT_AREA
27774 || !MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->displays_text_p
27775 /* Glyph's OBJECT is an integer for glyphs inserted by the
27776 display engine for its internal purposes, like truncation
27777 and continuation glyphs and blanks beyond the end of
27778 line's text on text terminals. If we are over such a
27779 glyph, we are not over any text. */
27780 || INTEGERP (glyph->object)
27781 /* R2L rows have a stretch glyph at their front, which
27782 stands for no text, whereas L2R rows have no glyphs at
27783 all beyond the end of text. Treat such stretch glyphs
27784 like we do with NULL glyphs in L2R rows. */
27785 || (MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->reversed_p
27786 && glyph == MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]
27787 && glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
27788 && glyph->avoid_cursor_p))
27790 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
27791 cursor = No_Cursor;
27792 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
27793 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && NILP (pointer))
27795 if (area != TEXT_AREA)
27796 cursor = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->nontext_cursor;
27797 else
27798 pointer = Vvoid_text_area_pointer;
27800 #endif
27801 goto set_cursor;
27804 pos = glyph->charpos;
27805 object = glyph->object;
27806 if (!STRINGP (object) && !BUFFERP (object))
27807 goto set_cursor;
27809 /* If we get an out-of-range value, return now; avoid an error. */
27810 if (BUFFERP (object) && pos > BUF_Z (b))
27811 goto set_cursor;
27813 /* Make the window's buffer temporarily current for
27814 overlays_at and compute_char_face. */
27815 obuf = current_buffer;
27816 current_buffer = b;
27817 obegv = BEGV;
27818 ozv = ZV;
27819 BEGV = BEG;
27820 ZV = Z;
27822 /* Is this char mouse-active or does it have help-echo? */
27823 position = make_number (pos);
27825 if (BUFFERP (object))
27827 /* Put all the overlays we want in a vector in overlay_vec. */
27828 GET_OVERLAYS_AT (pos, overlay_vec, noverlays, NULL, 0);
27829 /* Sort overlays into increasing priority order. */
27830 noverlays = sort_overlays (overlay_vec, noverlays, w);
27832 else
27833 noverlays = 0;
27835 same_region = coords_in_mouse_face_p (w, hpos, vpos);
27837 if (same_region)
27838 cursor = No_Cursor;
27840 /* Check mouse-face highlighting. */
27841 if (! same_region
27842 /* If there exists an overlay with mouse-face overlapping
27843 the one we are currently highlighting, we have to
27844 check if we enter the overlapping overlay, and then
27845 highlight only that. */
27846 || (OVERLAYP (hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay)
27847 && mouse_face_overlay_overlaps (hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay)))
27849 /* Find the highest priority overlay with a mouse-face. */
27850 Lisp_Object overlay = Qnil;
27851 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (overlay); --i)
27853 mouse_face = Foverlay_get (overlay_vec[i], Qmouse_face);
27854 if (!NILP (mouse_face))
27855 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
27858 /* If we're highlighting the same overlay as before, there's
27859 no need to do that again. */
27860 if (!NILP (overlay) && EQ (overlay, hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay))
27861 goto check_help_echo;
27862 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = overlay;
27864 /* Clear the display of the old active region, if any. */
27865 if (clear_mouse_face (hlinfo))
27866 cursor = No_Cursor;
27868 /* If no overlay applies, get a text property. */
27869 if (NILP (overlay))
27870 mouse_face = Fget_text_property (position, Qmouse_face, object);
27872 /* Next, compute the bounds of the mouse highlighting and
27873 display it. */
27874 if (!NILP (mouse_face) && STRINGP (object))
27876 /* The mouse-highlighting comes from a display string
27877 with a mouse-face. */
27878 Lisp_Object s, e;
27879 ptrdiff_t ignore;
27881 s = Fprevious_single_property_change
27882 (make_number (pos + 1), Qmouse_face, object, Qnil);
27883 e = Fnext_single_property_change
27884 (position, Qmouse_face, object, Qnil);
27885 if (NILP (s))
27886 s = make_number (0);
27887 if (NILP (e))
27888 e = make_number (SCHARS (object) - 1);
27889 mouse_face_from_string_pos (w, hlinfo, object,
27890 XINT (s), XINT (e));
27891 hlinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
27892 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
27893 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id
27894 = face_at_string_position (w, object, pos, 0, 0, 0, &ignore,
27895 glyph->face_id, 1);
27896 show_mouse_face (hlinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
27897 cursor = No_Cursor;
27899 else
27901 /* The mouse-highlighting, if any, comes from an overlay
27902 or text property in the buffer. */
27903 Lisp_Object buffer IF_LINT (= Qnil);
27904 Lisp_Object disp_string IF_LINT (= Qnil);
27906 if (STRINGP (object))
27908 /* If we are on a display string with no mouse-face,
27909 check if the text under it has one. */
27910 struct glyph_row *r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
27911 ptrdiff_t start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
27912 pos = string_buffer_position (object, start);
27913 if (pos > 0)
27915 mouse_face = get_char_property_and_overlay
27916 (make_number (pos), Qmouse_face, w->buffer, &overlay);
27917 buffer = w->buffer;
27918 disp_string = object;
27921 else
27923 buffer = object;
27924 disp_string = Qnil;
27927 if (!NILP (mouse_face))
27929 Lisp_Object before, after;
27930 Lisp_Object before_string, after_string;
27931 /* To correctly find the limits of mouse highlight
27932 in a bidi-reordered buffer, we must not use the
27933 optimization of limiting the search in
27934 previous-single-property-change and
27935 next-single-property-change, because
27936 rows_from_pos_range needs the real start and end
27937 positions to DTRT in this case. That's because
27938 the first row visible in a window does not
27939 necessarily display the character whose position
27940 is the smallest. */
27941 Lisp_Object lim1 =
27942 NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
27943 ? Fmarker_position (w->start)
27944 : Qnil;
27945 Lisp_Object lim2 =
27946 NILP (BVAR (XBUFFER (buffer), bidi_display_reordering))
27947 ? make_number (BUF_Z (XBUFFER (buffer))
27948 - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos))
27949 : Qnil;
27951 if (NILP (overlay))
27953 /* Handle the text property case. */
27954 before = Fprevious_single_property_change
27955 (make_number (pos + 1), Qmouse_face, buffer, lim1);
27956 after = Fnext_single_property_change
27957 (make_number (pos), Qmouse_face, buffer, lim2);
27958 before_string = after_string = Qnil;
27960 else
27962 /* Handle the overlay case. */
27963 before = Foverlay_start (overlay);
27964 after = Foverlay_end (overlay);
27965 before_string = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qbefore_string);
27966 after_string = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qafter_string);
27968 if (!STRINGP (before_string)) before_string = Qnil;
27969 if (!STRINGP (after_string)) after_string = Qnil;
27972 mouse_face_from_buffer_pos (window, hlinfo, pos,
27973 NILP (before)
27975 : XFASTINT (before),
27976 NILP (after)
27977 ? BUF_Z (XBUFFER (buffer))
27978 : XFASTINT (after),
27979 before_string, after_string,
27980 disp_string);
27981 cursor = No_Cursor;
27986 check_help_echo:
27988 /* Look for a `help-echo' property. */
27989 if (NILP (help_echo_string)) {
27990 Lisp_Object help, overlay;
27992 /* Check overlays first. */
27993 help = overlay = Qnil;
27994 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (help); --i)
27996 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
27997 help = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qhelp_echo);
28000 if (!NILP (help))
28002 help_echo_string = help;
28003 help_echo_window = window;
28004 help_echo_object = overlay;
28005 help_echo_pos = pos;
28007 else
28009 Lisp_Object obj = glyph->object;
28010 ptrdiff_t charpos = glyph->charpos;
28012 /* Try text properties. */
28013 if (STRINGP (obj)
28014 && charpos >= 0
28015 && charpos < SCHARS (obj))
28017 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
28018 Qhelp_echo, obj);
28019 if (NILP (help))
28021 /* If the string itself doesn't specify a help-echo,
28022 see if the buffer text ``under'' it does. */
28023 struct glyph_row *r
28024 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
28025 ptrdiff_t start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
28026 ptrdiff_t p = string_buffer_position (obj, start);
28027 if (p > 0)
28029 help = Fget_char_property (make_number (p),
28030 Qhelp_echo, w->buffer);
28031 if (!NILP (help))
28033 charpos = p;
28034 obj = w->buffer;
28039 else if (BUFFERP (obj)
28040 && charpos >= BEGV
28041 && charpos < ZV)
28042 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos), Qhelp_echo,
28043 obj);
28045 if (!NILP (help))
28047 help_echo_string = help;
28048 help_echo_window = window;
28049 help_echo_object = obj;
28050 help_echo_pos = charpos;
28055 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28056 /* Look for a `pointer' property. */
28057 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && NILP (pointer))
28059 /* Check overlays first. */
28060 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (pointer); --i)
28061 pointer = Foverlay_get (overlay_vec[i], Qpointer);
28063 if (NILP (pointer))
28065 Lisp_Object obj = glyph->object;
28066 ptrdiff_t charpos = glyph->charpos;
28068 /* Try text properties. */
28069 if (STRINGP (obj)
28070 && charpos >= 0
28071 && charpos < SCHARS (obj))
28073 pointer = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
28074 Qpointer, obj);
28075 if (NILP (pointer))
28077 /* If the string itself doesn't specify a pointer,
28078 see if the buffer text ``under'' it does. */
28079 struct glyph_row *r
28080 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
28081 ptrdiff_t start = MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (r);
28082 ptrdiff_t p = string_buffer_position (obj, start);
28083 if (p > 0)
28084 pointer = Fget_char_property (make_number (p),
28085 Qpointer, w->buffer);
28088 else if (BUFFERP (obj)
28089 && charpos >= BEGV
28090 && charpos < ZV)
28091 pointer = Fget_text_property (make_number (charpos),
28092 Qpointer, obj);
28095 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
28097 BEGV = obegv;
28098 ZV = ozv;
28099 current_buffer = obuf;
28102 set_cursor:
28104 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28105 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f))
28106 define_frame_cursor1 (f, cursor, pointer);
28107 #else
28108 /* This is here to prevent a compiler error, about "label at end of
28109 compound statement". */
28110 return;
28111 #endif
28115 /* EXPORT for RIF:
28116 Clear any mouse-face on window W. This function is part of the
28117 redisplay interface, and is called from try_window_id and similar
28118 functions to ensure the mouse-highlight is off. */
28120 void
28121 x_clear_window_mouse_face (struct window *w)
28123 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
28124 Lisp_Object window;
28126 BLOCK_INPUT;
28127 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
28128 if (EQ (window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window))
28129 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
28130 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
28134 /* EXPORT:
28135 Just discard the mouse face information for frame F, if any.
28136 This is used when the size of F is changed. */
28138 void
28139 cancel_mouse_face (struct frame *f)
28141 Lisp_Object window;
28142 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
28144 window = hlinfo->mouse_face_window;
28145 if (! NILP (window) && XFRAME (XWINDOW (window)->frame) == f)
28147 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
28148 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
28149 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
28155 /***********************************************************************
28156 Exposure Events
28157 ***********************************************************************/
28159 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28161 /* Redraw the part of glyph row area AREA of glyph row ROW on window W
28162 which intersects rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. */
28164 static void
28165 expose_area (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, XRectangle *r,
28166 enum glyph_row_area area)
28168 struct glyph *first = row->glyphs[area];
28169 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[area] + row->used[area];
28170 struct glyph *last;
28171 int first_x, start_x, x;
28173 if (area == TEXT_AREA && row->fill_line_p)
28174 /* If row extends face to end of line write the whole line. */
28175 draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, area,
28176 0, row->used[area],
28177 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
28178 else
28180 /* Set START_X to the window-relative start position for drawing glyphs of
28181 AREA. The first glyph of the text area can be partially visible.
28182 The first glyphs of other areas cannot. */
28183 start_x = window_box_left_offset (w, area);
28184 x = start_x;
28185 if (area == TEXT_AREA)
28186 x += row->x;
28188 /* Find the first glyph that must be redrawn. */
28189 while (first < end
28190 && x + first->pixel_width < r->x)
28192 x += first->pixel_width;
28193 ++first;
28196 /* Find the last one. */
28197 last = first;
28198 first_x = x;
28199 while (last < end
28200 && x < r->x + r->width)
28202 x += last->pixel_width;
28203 ++last;
28206 /* Repaint. */
28207 if (last > first)
28208 draw_glyphs (w, first_x - start_x, row, area,
28209 first - row->glyphs[area], last - row->glyphs[area],
28210 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
28215 /* Redraw the parts of the glyph row ROW on window W intersecting
28216 rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. Value is
28217 non-zero if mouse-face was overwritten. */
28219 static int
28220 expose_line (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, XRectangle *r)
28222 eassert (row->enabled_p);
28224 if (row->mode_line_p || w->pseudo_window_p)
28225 draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, TEXT_AREA,
28226 0, row->used[TEXT_AREA],
28227 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, 0);
28228 else
28230 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA])
28231 expose_area (w, row, r, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
28232 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
28233 expose_area (w, row, r, TEXT_AREA);
28234 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA])
28235 expose_area (w, row, r, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA);
28236 draw_row_fringe_bitmaps (w, row);
28239 return row->mouse_face_p;
28243 /* Redraw those parts of glyphs rows during expose event handling that
28244 overlap other rows. Redrawing of an exposed line writes over parts
28245 of lines overlapping that exposed line; this function fixes that.
28247 W is the window being exposed. FIRST_OVERLAPPING_ROW is the first
28248 row in W's current matrix that is exposed and overlaps other rows.
28249 LAST_OVERLAPPING_ROW is the last such row. */
28251 static void
28252 expose_overlaps (struct window *w,
28253 struct glyph_row *first_overlapping_row,
28254 struct glyph_row *last_overlapping_row,
28255 XRectangle *r)
28257 struct glyph_row *row;
28259 for (row = first_overlapping_row; row <= last_overlapping_row; ++row)
28260 if (row->overlapping_p)
28262 eassert (row->enabled_p && !row->mode_line_p);
28264 row->clip = r;
28265 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA])
28266 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
28268 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
28269 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, TEXT_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
28271 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA])
28272 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA, OVERLAPS_BOTH);
28273 row->clip = NULL;
28278 /* Return non-zero if W's cursor intersects rectangle R. */
28280 static int
28281 phys_cursor_in_rect_p (struct window *w, XRectangle *r)
28283 XRectangle cr, result;
28284 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
28285 struct glyph_row *row;
28287 if (w->phys_cursor.vpos >= 0
28288 && w->phys_cursor.vpos < w->current_matrix->nrows
28289 && (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos),
28290 row->enabled_p)
28291 && row->cursor_in_fringe_p)
28293 /* Cursor is in the fringe. */
28294 cr.x = window_box_right_offset (w,
28295 (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
28296 ? RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA
28297 : TEXT_AREA));
28298 cr.y = row->y;
28299 cr.width = WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w);
28300 cr.height = row->height;
28301 return x_intersect_rectangles (&cr, r, &result);
28304 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
28305 if (cursor_glyph)
28307 /* r is relative to W's box, but w->phys_cursor.x is relative
28308 to left edge of W's TEXT area. Adjust it. */
28309 cr.x = window_box_left_offset (w, TEXT_AREA) + w->phys_cursor.x;
28310 cr.y = w->phys_cursor.y;
28311 cr.width = cursor_glyph->pixel_width;
28312 cr.height = w->phys_cursor_height;
28313 /* ++KFS: W32 version used W32-specific IntersectRect here, but
28314 I assume the effect is the same -- and this is portable. */
28315 return x_intersect_rectangles (&cr, r, &result);
28317 /* If we don't understand the format, pretend we're not in the hot-spot. */
28318 return 0;
28322 /* EXPORT:
28323 Draw a vertical window border to the right of window W if W doesn't
28324 have vertical scroll bars. */
28326 void
28327 x_draw_vertical_border (struct window *w)
28329 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
28331 /* We could do better, if we knew what type of scroll-bar the adjacent
28332 windows (on either side) have... But we don't :-(
28333 However, I think this works ok. ++KFS 2003-04-25 */
28335 /* Redraw borders between horizontally adjacent windows. Don't
28336 do it for frames with vertical scroll bars because either the
28337 right scroll bar of a window, or the left scroll bar of its
28338 neighbor will suffice as a border. */
28339 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (w->frame)))
28340 return;
28342 if (!WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
28343 && !WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
28345 int x0, x1, y0, y1;
28347 window_box_edges (w, -1, &x0, &y0, &x1, &y1);
28348 y1 -= 1;
28350 if (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w) == 0)
28351 x1 -= 1;
28353 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_vertical_window_border (w, x1, y0, y1);
28355 else if (!WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
28356 && !WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
28358 int x0, x1, y0, y1;
28360 window_box_edges (w, -1, &x0, &y0, &x1, &y1);
28361 y1 -= 1;
28363 if (WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w) == 0)
28364 x0 -= 1;
28366 FRAME_RIF (f)->draw_vertical_window_border (w, x0, y0, y1);
28371 /* Redraw the part of window W intersection rectangle FR. Pixel
28372 coordinates in FR are frame-relative. Call this function with
28373 input blocked. Value is non-zero if the exposure overwrites
28374 mouse-face. */
28376 static int
28377 expose_window (struct window *w, XRectangle *fr)
28379 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
28380 XRectangle wr, r;
28381 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
28383 /* If window is not yet fully initialized, do nothing. This can
28384 happen when toolkit scroll bars are used and a window is split.
28385 Reconfiguring the scroll bar will generate an expose for a newly
28386 created window. */
28387 if (w->current_matrix == NULL)
28388 return 0;
28390 /* When we're currently updating the window, display and current
28391 matrix usually don't agree. Arrange for a thorough display
28392 later. */
28393 if (w == updated_window)
28395 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
28396 return 0;
28399 /* Frame-relative pixel rectangle of W. */
28400 wr.x = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
28401 wr.y = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
28402 wr.width = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w);
28403 wr.height = WINDOW_TOTAL_HEIGHT (w);
28405 if (x_intersect_rectangles (fr, &wr, &r))
28407 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
28408 struct glyph_row *row;
28409 int cursor_cleared_p, phys_cursor_on_p;
28410 struct glyph_row *first_overlapping_row, *last_overlapping_row;
28412 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_window (%d, %d, %d, %d)\n",
28413 r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
28415 /* Convert to window coordinates. */
28416 r.x -= WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w);
28417 r.y -= WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_Y (w);
28419 /* Turn off the cursor. */
28420 if (!w->pseudo_window_p
28421 && phys_cursor_in_rect_p (w, &r))
28423 x_clear_cursor (w);
28424 cursor_cleared_p = 1;
28426 else
28427 cursor_cleared_p = 0;
28429 /* If the row containing the cursor extends face to end of line,
28430 then expose_area might overwrite the cursor outside the
28431 rectangle and thus notice_overwritten_cursor might clear
28432 w->phys_cursor_on_p. We remember the original value and
28433 check later if it is changed. */
28434 phys_cursor_on_p = w->phys_cursor_on_p;
28436 /* Update lines intersecting rectangle R. */
28437 first_overlapping_row = last_overlapping_row = NULL;
28438 for (row = w->current_matrix->rows;
28439 row->enabled_p;
28440 ++row)
28442 int y0 = row->y;
28443 int y1 = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row);
28445 if ((y0 >= r.y && y0 < r.y + r.height)
28446 || (y1 > r.y && y1 < r.y + r.height)
28447 || (r.y >= y0 && r.y < y1)
28448 || (r.y + r.height > y0 && r.y + r.height < y1))
28450 /* A header line may be overlapping, but there is no need
28451 to fix overlapping areas for them. KFS 2005-02-12 */
28452 if (row->overlapping_p && !row->mode_line_p)
28454 if (first_overlapping_row == NULL)
28455 first_overlapping_row = row;
28456 last_overlapping_row = row;
28459 row->clip = fr;
28460 if (expose_line (w, row, &r))
28461 mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1;
28462 row->clip = NULL;
28464 else if (row->overlapping_p)
28466 /* We must redraw a row overlapping the exposed area. */
28467 if (y0 < r.y
28468 ? y0 + row->phys_height > r.y
28469 : y0 + row->ascent - row->phys_ascent < r.y +r.height)
28471 if (first_overlapping_row == NULL)
28472 first_overlapping_row = row;
28473 last_overlapping_row = row;
28477 if (y1 >= yb)
28478 break;
28481 /* Display the mode line if there is one. */
28482 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
28483 && (row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix),
28484 row->enabled_p)
28485 && row->y < r.y + r.height)
28487 if (expose_line (w, row, &r))
28488 mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1;
28491 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
28493 /* Fix the display of overlapping rows. */
28494 if (first_overlapping_row)
28495 expose_overlaps (w, first_overlapping_row, last_overlapping_row,
28496 fr);
28498 /* Draw border between windows. */
28499 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
28501 /* Turn the cursor on again. */
28502 if (cursor_cleared_p
28503 || (phys_cursor_on_p && !w->phys_cursor_on_p))
28504 update_window_cursor (w, 1);
28508 return mouse_face_overwritten_p;
28513 /* Redraw (parts) of all windows in the window tree rooted at W that
28514 intersect R. R contains frame pixel coordinates. Value is
28515 non-zero if the exposure overwrites mouse-face. */
28517 static int
28518 expose_window_tree (struct window *w, XRectangle *r)
28520 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
28521 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
28523 while (w && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
28525 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
28526 mouse_face_overwritten_p
28527 |= expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), r);
28528 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
28529 mouse_face_overwritten_p
28530 |= expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), r);
28531 else
28532 mouse_face_overwritten_p |= expose_window (w, r);
28534 w = NILP (w->next) ? NULL : XWINDOW (w->next);
28537 return mouse_face_overwritten_p;
28541 /* EXPORT:
28542 Redisplay an exposed area of frame F. X and Y are the upper-left
28543 corner of the exposed rectangle. W and H are width and height of
28544 the exposed area. All are pixel values. W or H zero means redraw
28545 the entire frame. */
28547 void
28548 expose_frame (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int w, int h)
28550 XRectangle r;
28551 int mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0;
28553 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_frame "));
28555 /* No need to redraw if frame will be redrawn soon. */
28556 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
28558 TRACE ((stderr, " garbaged\n"));
28559 return;
28562 /* If basic faces haven't been realized yet, there is no point in
28563 trying to redraw anything. This can happen when we get an expose
28564 event while Emacs is starting, e.g. by moving another window. */
28565 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f) == NULL
28566 || FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f)->used < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
28568 TRACE ((stderr, " no faces\n"));
28569 return;
28572 if (w == 0 || h == 0)
28574 r.x = r.y = 0;
28575 r.width = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) * FRAME_COLS (f);
28576 r.height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) * FRAME_LINES (f);
28578 else
28580 r.x = x;
28581 r.y = y;
28582 r.width = w;
28583 r.height = h;
28586 TRACE ((stderr, "(%d, %d, %d, %d)\n", r.x, r.y, r.width, r.height));
28587 mouse_face_overwritten_p = expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), &r);
28589 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window))
28590 mouse_face_overwritten_p
28591 |= expose_window (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window), &r);
28593 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
28594 #ifndef MSDOS
28595 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
28596 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window))
28597 mouse_face_overwritten_p
28598 |= expose_window (XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window), &r);
28599 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
28600 #endif
28601 #endif
28603 /* Some window managers support a focus-follows-mouse style with
28604 delayed raising of frames. Imagine a partially obscured frame,
28605 and moving the mouse into partially obscured mouse-face on that
28606 frame. The visible part of the mouse-face will be highlighted,
28607 then the WM raises the obscured frame. With at least one WM, KDE
28608 2.1, Emacs is not getting any event for the raising of the frame
28609 (even tried with SubstructureRedirectMask), only Expose events.
28610 These expose events will draw text normally, i.e. not
28611 highlighted. Which means we must redo the highlight here.
28612 Subsume it under ``we love X''. --gerd 2001-08-15 */
28613 /* Included in Windows version because Windows most likely does not
28614 do the right thing if any third party tool offers
28615 focus-follows-mouse with delayed raise. --jason 2001-10-12 */
28616 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
28618 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
28619 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
28621 int mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x;
28622 int mouse_y = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y;
28623 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
28624 note_mouse_highlight (f, mouse_x, mouse_y);
28630 /* EXPORT:
28631 Determine the intersection of two rectangles R1 and R2. Return
28632 the intersection in *RESULT. Value is non-zero if RESULT is not
28633 empty. */
28636 x_intersect_rectangles (XRectangle *r1, XRectangle *r2, XRectangle *result)
28638 XRectangle *left, *right;
28639 XRectangle *upper, *lower;
28640 int intersection_p = 0;
28642 /* Rearrange so that R1 is the left-most rectangle. */
28643 if (r1->x < r2->x)
28644 left = r1, right = r2;
28645 else
28646 left = r2, right = r1;
28648 /* X0 of the intersection is right.x0, if this is inside R1,
28649 otherwise there is no intersection. */
28650 if (right->x <= left->x + left->width)
28652 result->x = right->x;
28654 /* The right end of the intersection is the minimum of
28655 the right ends of left and right. */
28656 result->width = (min (left->x + left->width, right->x + right->width)
28657 - result->x);
28659 /* Same game for Y. */
28660 if (r1->y < r2->y)
28661 upper = r1, lower = r2;
28662 else
28663 upper = r2, lower = r1;
28665 /* The upper end of the intersection is lower.y0, if this is inside
28666 of upper. Otherwise, there is no intersection. */
28667 if (lower->y <= upper->y + upper->height)
28669 result->y = lower->y;
28671 /* The lower end of the intersection is the minimum of the lower
28672 ends of upper and lower. */
28673 result->height = (min (lower->y + lower->height,
28674 upper->y + upper->height)
28675 - result->y);
28676 intersection_p = 1;
28680 return intersection_p;
28683 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */
28686 /***********************************************************************
28687 Initialization
28688 ***********************************************************************/
28690 void
28691 syms_of_xdisp (void)
28693 Vwith_echo_area_save_vector = Qnil;
28694 staticpro (&Vwith_echo_area_save_vector);
28696 Vmessage_stack = Qnil;
28697 staticpro (&Vmessage_stack);
28699 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_redisplay, "inhibit-redisplay");
28701 message_dolog_marker1 = Fmake_marker ();
28702 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker1);
28703 message_dolog_marker2 = Fmake_marker ();
28704 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker2);
28705 message_dolog_marker3 = Fmake_marker ();
28706 staticpro (&message_dolog_marker3);
28708 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
28709 defsubr (&Sdump_frame_glyph_matrix);
28710 defsubr (&Sdump_glyph_matrix);
28711 defsubr (&Sdump_glyph_row);
28712 defsubr (&Sdump_tool_bar_row);
28713 defsubr (&Strace_redisplay);
28714 defsubr (&Strace_to_stderr);
28715 #endif
28716 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28717 defsubr (&Stool_bar_lines_needed);
28718 defsubr (&Slookup_image_map);
28719 #endif
28720 defsubr (&Sformat_mode_line);
28721 defsubr (&Sinvisible_p);
28722 defsubr (&Scurrent_bidi_paragraph_direction);
28724 DEFSYM (Qmenu_bar_update_hook, "menu-bar-update-hook");
28725 DEFSYM (Qoverriding_terminal_local_map, "overriding-terminal-local-map");
28726 DEFSYM (Qoverriding_local_map, "overriding-local-map");
28727 DEFSYM (Qwindow_scroll_functions, "window-scroll-functions");
28728 DEFSYM (Qwindow_text_change_functions, "window-text-change-functions");
28729 DEFSYM (Qredisplay_end_trigger_functions, "redisplay-end-trigger-functions");
28730 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_point_motion_hooks, "inhibit-point-motion-hooks");
28731 DEFSYM (Qeval, "eval");
28732 DEFSYM (QCdata, ":data");
28733 DEFSYM (Qdisplay, "display");
28734 DEFSYM (Qspace_width, "space-width");
28735 DEFSYM (Qraise, "raise");
28736 DEFSYM (Qslice, "slice");
28737 DEFSYM (Qspace, "space");
28738 DEFSYM (Qmargin, "margin");
28739 DEFSYM (Qpointer, "pointer");
28740 DEFSYM (Qleft_margin, "left-margin");
28741 DEFSYM (Qright_margin, "right-margin");
28742 DEFSYM (Qcenter, "center");
28743 DEFSYM (Qline_height, "line-height");
28744 DEFSYM (QCalign_to, ":align-to");
28745 DEFSYM (QCrelative_width, ":relative-width");
28746 DEFSYM (QCrelative_height, ":relative-height");
28747 DEFSYM (QCeval, ":eval");
28748 DEFSYM (QCpropertize, ":propertize");
28749 DEFSYM (QCfile, ":file");
28750 DEFSYM (Qfontified, "fontified");
28751 DEFSYM (Qfontification_functions, "fontification-functions");
28752 DEFSYM (Qtrailing_whitespace, "trailing-whitespace");
28753 DEFSYM (Qescape_glyph, "escape-glyph");
28754 DEFSYM (Qnobreak_space, "nobreak-space");
28755 DEFSYM (Qimage, "image");
28756 DEFSYM (Qtext, "text");
28757 DEFSYM (Qboth, "both");
28758 DEFSYM (Qboth_horiz, "both-horiz");
28759 DEFSYM (Qtext_image_horiz, "text-image-horiz");
28760 DEFSYM (QCmap, ":map");
28761 DEFSYM (QCpointer, ":pointer");
28762 DEFSYM (Qrect, "rect");
28763 DEFSYM (Qcircle, "circle");
28764 DEFSYM (Qpoly, "poly");
28765 DEFSYM (Qmessage_truncate_lines, "message-truncate-lines");
28766 DEFSYM (Qgrow_only, "grow-only");
28767 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_menubar_update, "inhibit-menubar-update");
28768 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_eval_during_redisplay, "inhibit-eval-during-redisplay");
28769 DEFSYM (Qposition, "position");
28770 DEFSYM (Qbuffer_position, "buffer-position");
28771 DEFSYM (Qobject, "object");
28772 DEFSYM (Qbar, "bar");
28773 DEFSYM (Qhbar, "hbar");
28774 DEFSYM (Qbox, "box");
28775 DEFSYM (Qhollow, "hollow");
28776 DEFSYM (Qhand, "hand");
28777 DEFSYM (Qarrow, "arrow");
28778 DEFSYM (Qinhibit_free_realized_faces, "inhibit-free-realized-faces");
28780 list_of_error = Fcons (Fcons (intern_c_string ("error"),
28781 Fcons (intern_c_string ("void-variable"), Qnil)),
28782 Qnil);
28783 staticpro (&list_of_error);
28785 DEFSYM (Qlast_arrow_position, "last-arrow-position");
28786 DEFSYM (Qlast_arrow_string, "last-arrow-string");
28787 DEFSYM (Qoverlay_arrow_string, "overlay-arrow-string");
28788 DEFSYM (Qoverlay_arrow_bitmap, "overlay-arrow-bitmap");
28790 echo_buffer[0] = echo_buffer[1] = Qnil;
28791 staticpro (&echo_buffer[0]);
28792 staticpro (&echo_buffer[1]);
28794 echo_area_buffer[0] = echo_area_buffer[1] = Qnil;
28795 staticpro (&echo_area_buffer[0]);
28796 staticpro (&echo_area_buffer[1]);
28798 Vmessages_buffer_name = build_pure_c_string ("*Messages*");
28799 staticpro (&Vmessages_buffer_name);
28801 mode_line_proptrans_alist = Qnil;
28802 staticpro (&mode_line_proptrans_alist);
28803 mode_line_string_list = Qnil;
28804 staticpro (&mode_line_string_list);
28805 mode_line_string_face = Qnil;
28806 staticpro (&mode_line_string_face);
28807 mode_line_string_face_prop = Qnil;
28808 staticpro (&mode_line_string_face_prop);
28809 Vmode_line_unwind_vector = Qnil;
28810 staticpro (&Vmode_line_unwind_vector);
28812 DEFSYM (Qmode_line_default_help_echo, "mode-line-default-help-echo");
28814 help_echo_string = Qnil;
28815 staticpro (&help_echo_string);
28816 help_echo_object = Qnil;
28817 staticpro (&help_echo_object);
28818 help_echo_window = Qnil;
28819 staticpro (&help_echo_window);
28820 previous_help_echo_string = Qnil;
28821 staticpro (&previous_help_echo_string);
28822 help_echo_pos = -1;
28824 DEFSYM (Qright_to_left, "right-to-left");
28825 DEFSYM (Qleft_to_right, "left-to-right");
28827 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
28828 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-stretch-cursor", x_stretch_cursor_p,
28829 doc: /* Non-nil means draw block cursor as wide as the glyph under it.
28830 For example, if a block cursor is over a tab, it will be drawn as
28831 wide as that tab on the display. */);
28832 x_stretch_cursor_p = 0;
28833 #endif
28835 DEFVAR_LISP ("show-trailing-whitespace", Vshow_trailing_whitespace,
28836 doc: /* Non-nil means highlight trailing whitespace.
28837 The face used for trailing whitespace is `trailing-whitespace'. */);
28838 Vshow_trailing_whitespace = Qnil;
28840 DEFVAR_LISP ("nobreak-char-display", Vnobreak_char_display,
28841 doc: /* Control highlighting of non-ASCII space and hyphen chars.
28842 If the value is t, Emacs highlights non-ASCII chars which have the
28843 same appearance as an ASCII space or hyphen, using the `nobreak-space'
28844 or `escape-glyph' face respectively.
28846 U+00A0 (no-break space), U+00AD (soft hyphen), U+2010 (hyphen), and
28847 U+2011 (non-breaking hyphen) are affected.
28849 Any other non-nil value means to display these characters as a escape
28850 glyph followed by an ordinary space or hyphen.
28852 A value of nil means no special handling of these characters. */);
28853 Vnobreak_char_display = Qt;
28855 DEFVAR_LISP ("void-text-area-pointer", Vvoid_text_area_pointer,
28856 doc: /* The pointer shape to show in void text areas.
28857 A value of nil means to show the text pointer. Other options are `arrow',
28858 `text', `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'. */);
28859 Vvoid_text_area_pointer = Qarrow;
28861 DEFVAR_LISP ("inhibit-redisplay", Vinhibit_redisplay,
28862 doc: /* Non-nil means don't actually do any redisplay.
28863 This is used for internal purposes. */);
28864 Vinhibit_redisplay = Qnil;
28866 DEFVAR_LISP ("global-mode-string", Vglobal_mode_string,
28867 doc: /* String (or mode line construct) included (normally) in `mode-line-format'. */);
28868 Vglobal_mode_string = Qnil;
28870 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-position", Voverlay_arrow_position,
28871 doc: /* Marker for where to display an arrow on top of the buffer text.
28872 This must be the beginning of a line in order to work.
28873 See also `overlay-arrow-string'. */);
28874 Voverlay_arrow_position = Qnil;
28876 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-string", Voverlay_arrow_string,
28877 doc: /* String to display as an arrow in non-window frames.
28878 See also `overlay-arrow-position'. */);
28879 Voverlay_arrow_string = build_pure_c_string ("=>");
28881 DEFVAR_LISP ("overlay-arrow-variable-list", Voverlay_arrow_variable_list,
28882 doc: /* List of variables (symbols) which hold markers for overlay arrows.
28883 The symbols on this list are examined during redisplay to determine
28884 where to display overlay arrows. */);
28885 Voverlay_arrow_variable_list
28886 = Fcons (intern_c_string ("overlay-arrow-position"), Qnil);
28888 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-step", emacs_scroll_step,
28889 doc: /* The number of lines to try scrolling a window by when point moves out.
28890 If that fails to bring point back on frame, point is centered instead.
28891 If this is zero, point is always centered after it moves off frame.
28892 If you want scrolling to always be a line at a time, you should set
28893 `scroll-conservatively' to a large value rather than set this to 1. */);
28895 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-conservatively", scroll_conservatively,
28896 doc: /* Scroll up to this many lines, to bring point back on screen.
28897 If point moves off-screen, redisplay will scroll by up to
28898 `scroll-conservatively' lines in order to bring point just barely
28899 onto the screen again. If that cannot be done, then redisplay
28900 recenters point as usual.
28902 If the value is greater than 100, redisplay will never recenter point,
28903 but will always scroll just enough text to bring point into view, even
28904 if you move far away.
28906 A value of zero means always recenter point if it moves off screen. */);
28907 scroll_conservatively = 0;
28909 DEFVAR_INT ("scroll-margin", scroll_margin,
28910 doc: /* Number of lines of margin at the top and bottom of a window.
28911 Recenter the window whenever point gets within this many lines
28912 of the top or bottom of the window. */);
28913 scroll_margin = 0;
28915 DEFVAR_LISP ("display-pixels-per-inch", Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch,
28916 doc: /* Pixels per inch value for non-window system displays.
28917 Value is a number or a cons (WIDTH-DPI . HEIGHT-DPI). */);
28918 Vdisplay_pixels_per_inch = make_float (72.0);
28920 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
28921 DEFVAR_INT ("debug-end-pos", debug_end_pos, doc: /* Don't ask. */);
28922 #endif
28924 DEFVAR_LISP ("truncate-partial-width-windows",
28925 Vtruncate_partial_width_windows,
28926 doc: /* Non-nil means truncate lines in windows narrower than the frame.
28927 For an integer value, truncate lines in each window narrower than the
28928 full frame width, provided the window width is less than that integer;
28929 otherwise, respect the value of `truncate-lines'.
28931 For any other non-nil value, truncate lines in all windows that do
28932 not span the full frame width.
28934 A value of nil means to respect the value of `truncate-lines'.
28936 If `word-wrap' is enabled, you might want to reduce this. */);
28937 Vtruncate_partial_width_windows = make_number (50);
28939 DEFVAR_BOOL ("mode-line-inverse-video", mode_line_inverse_video,
28940 doc: /* When nil, display the mode-line/header-line/menu-bar in the default face.
28941 Any other value means to use the appropriate face, `mode-line',
28942 `header-line', or `menu' respectively. */);
28943 mode_line_inverse_video = 1;
28945 DEFVAR_LISP ("line-number-display-limit", Vline_number_display_limit,
28946 doc: /* Maximum buffer size for which line number should be displayed.
28947 If the buffer is bigger than this, the line number does not appear
28948 in the mode line. A value of nil means no limit. */);
28949 Vline_number_display_limit = Qnil;
28951 DEFVAR_INT ("line-number-display-limit-width",
28952 line_number_display_limit_width,
28953 doc: /* Maximum line width (in characters) for line number display.
28954 If the average length of the lines near point is bigger than this, then the
28955 line number may be omitted from the mode line. */);
28956 line_number_display_limit_width = 200;
28958 DEFVAR_BOOL ("highlight-nonselected-windows", highlight_nonselected_windows,
28959 doc: /* Non-nil means highlight region even in nonselected windows. */);
28960 highlight_nonselected_windows = 0;
28962 DEFVAR_BOOL ("multiple-frames", multiple_frames,
28963 doc: /* Non-nil if more than one frame is visible on this display.
28964 Minibuffer-only frames don't count, but iconified frames do.
28965 This variable is not guaranteed to be accurate except while processing
28966 `frame-title-format' and `icon-title-format'. */);
28968 DEFVAR_LISP ("frame-title-format", Vframe_title_format,
28969 doc: /* Template for displaying the title bar of visible frames.
28970 \(Assuming the window manager supports this feature.)
28972 This variable has the same structure as `mode-line-format', except that
28973 the %c and %l constructs are ignored. It is used only on frames for
28974 which no explicit name has been set \(see `modify-frame-parameters'). */);
28976 DEFVAR_LISP ("icon-title-format", Vicon_title_format,
28977 doc: /* Template for displaying the title bar of an iconified frame.
28978 \(Assuming the window manager supports this feature.)
28979 This variable has the same structure as `mode-line-format' (which see),
28980 and is used only on frames for which no explicit name has been set
28981 \(see `modify-frame-parameters'). */);
28982 Vicon_title_format
28983 = Vframe_title_format
28984 = listn (CONSTYPE_PURE, 3,
28985 intern_c_string ("multiple-frames"),
28986 build_pure_c_string ("%b"),
28987 listn (CONSTYPE_PURE, 4,
28988 empty_unibyte_string,
28989 intern_c_string ("invocation-name"),
28990 build_pure_c_string ("@"),
28991 intern_c_string ("system-name")));
28993 DEFVAR_LISP ("message-log-max", Vmessage_log_max,
28994 doc: /* Maximum number of lines to keep in the message log buffer.
28995 If nil, disable message logging. If t, log messages but don't truncate
28996 the buffer when it becomes large. */);
28997 Vmessage_log_max = make_number (100);
28999 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-size-change-functions", Vwindow_size_change_functions,
29000 doc: /* Functions called before redisplay, if window sizes have changed.
29001 The value should be a list of functions that take one argument.
29002 Just before redisplay, for each frame, if any of its windows have changed
29003 size since the last redisplay, or have been split or deleted,
29004 all the functions in the list are called, with the frame as argument. */);
29005 Vwindow_size_change_functions = Qnil;
29007 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-scroll-functions", Vwindow_scroll_functions,
29008 doc: /* List of functions to call before redisplaying a window with scrolling.
29009 Each function is called with two arguments, the window and its new
29010 display-start position. Note that these functions are also called by
29011 `set-window-buffer'. Also note that the value of `window-end' is not
29012 valid when these functions are called.
29014 Warning: Do not use this feature to alter the way the window
29015 is scrolled. It is not designed for that, and such use probably won't
29016 work. */);
29017 Vwindow_scroll_functions = Qnil;
29019 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-text-change-functions",
29020 Vwindow_text_change_functions,
29021 doc: /* Functions to call in redisplay when text in the window might change. */);
29022 Vwindow_text_change_functions = Qnil;
29024 DEFVAR_LISP ("redisplay-end-trigger-functions", Vredisplay_end_trigger_functions,
29025 doc: /* Functions called when redisplay of a window reaches the end trigger.
29026 Each function is called with two arguments, the window and the end trigger value.
29027 See `set-window-redisplay-end-trigger'. */);
29028 Vredisplay_end_trigger_functions = Qnil;
29030 DEFVAR_LISP ("mouse-autoselect-window", Vmouse_autoselect_window,
29031 doc: /* Non-nil means autoselect window with mouse pointer.
29032 If nil, do not autoselect windows.
29033 A positive number means delay autoselection by that many seconds: a
29034 window is autoselected only after the mouse has remained in that
29035 window for the duration of the delay.
29036 A negative number has a similar effect, but causes windows to be
29037 autoselected only after the mouse has stopped moving. \(Because of
29038 the way Emacs compares mouse events, you will occasionally wait twice
29039 that time before the window gets selected.\)
29040 Any other value means to autoselect window instantaneously when the
29041 mouse pointer enters it.
29043 Autoselection selects the minibuffer only if it is active, and never
29044 unselects the minibuffer if it is active.
29046 When customizing this variable make sure that the actual value of
29047 `focus-follows-mouse' matches the behavior of your window manager. */);
29048 Vmouse_autoselect_window = Qnil;
29050 DEFVAR_LISP ("auto-resize-tool-bars", Vauto_resize_tool_bars,
29051 doc: /* Non-nil means automatically resize tool-bars.
29052 This dynamically changes the tool-bar's height to the minimum height
29053 that is needed to make all tool-bar items visible.
29054 If value is `grow-only', the tool-bar's height is only increased
29055 automatically; to decrease the tool-bar height, use \\[recenter]. */);
29056 Vauto_resize_tool_bars = Qt;
29058 DEFVAR_BOOL ("auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons", auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p,
29059 doc: /* Non-nil means raise tool-bar buttons when the mouse moves over them. */);
29060 auto_raise_tool_bar_buttons_p = 1;
29062 DEFVAR_BOOL ("make-cursor-line-fully-visible", make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p,
29063 doc: /* Non-nil means to scroll (recenter) cursor line if it is not fully visible. */);
29064 make_cursor_line_fully_visible_p = 1;
29066 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-border", Vtool_bar_border,
29067 doc: /* Border below tool-bar in pixels.
29068 If an integer, use it as the height of the border.
29069 If it is one of `internal-border-width' or `border-width', use the
29070 value of the corresponding frame parameter.
29071 Otherwise, no border is added below the tool-bar. */);
29072 Vtool_bar_border = Qinternal_border_width;
29074 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-button-margin", Vtool_bar_button_margin,
29075 doc: /* Margin around tool-bar buttons in pixels.
29076 If an integer, use that for both horizontal and vertical margins.
29077 Otherwise, value should be a pair of integers `(HORZ . VERT)' with
29078 HORZ specifying the horizontal margin, and VERT specifying the
29079 vertical margin. */);
29080 Vtool_bar_button_margin = make_number (DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_MARGIN);
29082 DEFVAR_INT ("tool-bar-button-relief", tool_bar_button_relief,
29083 doc: /* Relief thickness of tool-bar buttons. */);
29084 tool_bar_button_relief = DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
29086 DEFVAR_LISP ("tool-bar-style", Vtool_bar_style,
29087 doc: /* Tool bar style to use.
29088 It can be one of
29089 image - show images only
29090 text - show text only
29091 both - show both, text below image
29092 both-horiz - show text to the right of the image
29093 text-image-horiz - show text to the left of the image
29094 any other - use system default or image if no system default.
29096 This variable only affects the GTK+ toolkit version of Emacs. */);
29097 Vtool_bar_style = Qnil;
29099 DEFVAR_INT ("tool-bar-max-label-size", tool_bar_max_label_size,
29100 doc: /* Maximum number of characters a label can have to be shown.
29101 The tool bar style must also show labels for this to have any effect, see
29102 `tool-bar-style'. */);
29103 tool_bar_max_label_size = DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_LABEL_SIZE;
29105 DEFVAR_LISP ("fontification-functions", Vfontification_functions,
29106 doc: /* List of functions to call to fontify regions of text.
29107 Each function is called with one argument POS. Functions must
29108 fontify a region starting at POS in the current buffer, and give
29109 fontified regions the property `fontified'. */);
29110 Vfontification_functions = Qnil;
29111 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qfontification_functions);
29113 DEFVAR_BOOL ("unibyte-display-via-language-environment",
29114 unibyte_display_via_language_environment,
29115 doc: /* Non-nil means display unibyte text according to language environment.
29116 Specifically, this means that raw bytes in the range 160-255 decimal
29117 are displayed by converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters
29118 according to the current language environment. As a result, they are
29119 displayed according to the current fontset.
29121 Note that this variable affects only how these bytes are displayed,
29122 but does not change the fact they are interpreted as raw bytes. */);
29123 unibyte_display_via_language_environment = 0;
29125 DEFVAR_LISP ("max-mini-window-height", Vmax_mini_window_height,
29126 doc: /* Maximum height for resizing mini-windows (the minibuffer and the echo area).
29127 If a float, it specifies a fraction of the mini-window frame's height.
29128 If an integer, it specifies a number of lines. */);
29129 Vmax_mini_window_height = make_float (0.25);
29131 DEFVAR_LISP ("resize-mini-windows", Vresize_mini_windows,
29132 doc: /* How to resize mini-windows (the minibuffer and the echo area).
29133 A value of nil means don't automatically resize mini-windows.
29134 A value of t means resize them to fit the text displayed in them.
29135 A value of `grow-only', the default, means let mini-windows grow only;
29136 they return to their normal size when the minibuffer is closed, or the
29137 echo area becomes empty. */);
29138 Vresize_mini_windows = Qgrow_only;
29140 DEFVAR_LISP ("blink-cursor-alist", Vblink_cursor_alist,
29141 doc: /* Alist specifying how to blink the cursor off.
29142 Each element has the form (ON-STATE . OFF-STATE). Whenever the
29143 `cursor-type' frame-parameter or variable equals ON-STATE,
29144 comparing using `equal', Emacs uses OFF-STATE to specify
29145 how to blink it off. ON-STATE and OFF-STATE are values for
29146 the `cursor-type' frame parameter.
29148 If a frame's ON-STATE has no entry in this list,
29149 the frame's other specifications determine how to blink the cursor off. */);
29150 Vblink_cursor_alist = Qnil;
29152 DEFVAR_BOOL ("auto-hscroll-mode", automatic_hscrolling_p,
29153 doc: /* Allow or disallow automatic horizontal scrolling of windows.
29154 If non-nil, windows are automatically scrolled horizontally to make
29155 point visible. */);
29156 automatic_hscrolling_p = 1;
29157 DEFSYM (Qauto_hscroll_mode, "auto-hscroll-mode");
29159 DEFVAR_INT ("hscroll-margin", hscroll_margin,
29160 doc: /* How many columns away from the window edge point is allowed to get
29161 before automatic hscrolling will horizontally scroll the window. */);
29162 hscroll_margin = 5;
29164 DEFVAR_LISP ("hscroll-step", Vhscroll_step,
29165 doc: /* How many columns to scroll the window when point gets too close to the edge.
29166 When point is less than `hscroll-margin' columns from the window
29167 edge, automatic hscrolling will scroll the window by the amount of columns
29168 determined by this variable. If its value is a positive integer, scroll that
29169 many columns. If it's a positive floating-point number, it specifies the
29170 fraction of the window's width to scroll. If it's nil or zero, point will be
29171 centered horizontally after the scroll. Any other value, including negative
29172 numbers, are treated as if the value were zero.
29174 Automatic hscrolling always moves point outside the scroll margin, so if
29175 point was more than scroll step columns inside the margin, the window will
29176 scroll more than the value given by the scroll step.
29178 Note that the lower bound for automatic hscrolling specified by `scroll-left'
29179 and `scroll-right' overrides this variable's effect. */);
29180 Vhscroll_step = make_number (0);
29182 DEFVAR_BOOL ("message-truncate-lines", message_truncate_lines,
29183 doc: /* If non-nil, messages are truncated instead of resizing the echo area.
29184 Bind this around calls to `message' to let it take effect. */);
29185 message_truncate_lines = 0;
29187 DEFVAR_LISP ("menu-bar-update-hook", Vmenu_bar_update_hook,
29188 doc: /* Normal hook run to update the menu bar definitions.
29189 Redisplay runs this hook before it redisplays the menu bar.
29190 This is used to update submenus such as Buffers,
29191 whose contents depend on various data. */);
29192 Vmenu_bar_update_hook = Qnil;
29194 DEFVAR_LISP ("menu-updating-frame", Vmenu_updating_frame,
29195 doc: /* Frame for which we are updating a menu.
29196 The enable predicate for a menu binding should check this variable. */);
29197 Vmenu_updating_frame = Qnil;
29199 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-menubar-update", inhibit_menubar_update,
29200 doc: /* Non-nil means don't update menu bars. Internal use only. */);
29201 inhibit_menubar_update = 0;
29203 DEFVAR_LISP ("wrap-prefix", Vwrap_prefix,
29204 doc: /* Prefix prepended to all continuation lines at display time.
29205 The value may be a string, an image, or a stretch-glyph; it is
29206 interpreted in the same way as the value of a `display' text property.
29208 This variable is overridden by any `wrap-prefix' text or overlay
29209 property.
29211 To add a prefix to non-continuation lines, use `line-prefix'. */);
29212 Vwrap_prefix = Qnil;
29213 DEFSYM (Qwrap_prefix, "wrap-prefix");
29214 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qwrap_prefix);
29216 DEFVAR_LISP ("line-prefix", Vline_prefix,
29217 doc: /* Prefix prepended to all non-continuation lines at display time.
29218 The value may be a string, an image, or a stretch-glyph; it is
29219 interpreted in the same way as the value of a `display' text property.
29221 This variable is overridden by any `line-prefix' text or overlay
29222 property.
29224 To add a prefix to continuation lines, use `wrap-prefix'. */);
29225 Vline_prefix = Qnil;
29226 DEFSYM (Qline_prefix, "line-prefix");
29227 Fmake_variable_buffer_local (Qline_prefix);
29229 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-eval-during-redisplay", inhibit_eval_during_redisplay,
29230 doc: /* Non-nil means don't eval Lisp during redisplay. */);
29231 inhibit_eval_during_redisplay = 0;
29233 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-free-realized-faces", inhibit_free_realized_faces,
29234 doc: /* Non-nil means don't free realized faces. Internal use only. */);
29235 inhibit_free_realized_faces = 0;
29237 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
29238 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-window-id", inhibit_try_window_id,
29239 doc: /* Inhibit try_window_id display optimization. */);
29240 inhibit_try_window_id = 0;
29242 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-window-reusing", inhibit_try_window_reusing,
29243 doc: /* Inhibit try_window_reusing display optimization. */);
29244 inhibit_try_window_reusing = 0;
29246 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inhibit-try-cursor-movement", inhibit_try_cursor_movement,
29247 doc: /* Inhibit try_cursor_movement display optimization. */);
29248 inhibit_try_cursor_movement = 0;
29249 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
29251 DEFVAR_INT ("overline-margin", overline_margin,
29252 doc: /* Space between overline and text, in pixels.
29253 The default value is 2: the height of the overline (1 pixel) plus 1 pixel
29254 margin to the character height. */);
29255 overline_margin = 2;
29257 DEFVAR_INT ("underline-minimum-offset",
29258 underline_minimum_offset,
29259 doc: /* Minimum distance between baseline and underline.
29260 This can improve legibility of underlined text at small font sizes,
29261 particularly when using variable `x-use-underline-position-properties'
29262 with fonts that specify an UNDERLINE_POSITION relatively close to the
29263 baseline. The default value is 1. */);
29264 underline_minimum_offset = 1;
29266 DEFVAR_BOOL ("display-hourglass", display_hourglass_p,
29267 doc: /* Non-nil means show an hourglass pointer, when Emacs is busy.
29268 This feature only works when on a window system that can change
29269 cursor shapes. */);
29270 display_hourglass_p = 1;
29272 DEFVAR_LISP ("hourglass-delay", Vhourglass_delay,
29273 doc: /* Seconds to wait before displaying an hourglass pointer when Emacs is busy. */);
29274 Vhourglass_delay = make_number (DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY);
29276 hourglass_atimer = NULL;
29277 hourglass_shown_p = 0;
29279 DEFSYM (Qglyphless_char, "glyphless-char");
29280 DEFSYM (Qhex_code, "hex-code");
29281 DEFSYM (Qempty_box, "empty-box");
29282 DEFSYM (Qthin_space, "thin-space");
29283 DEFSYM (Qzero_width, "zero-width");
29285 DEFSYM (Qglyphless_char_display, "glyphless-char-display");
29286 /* Intern this now in case it isn't already done.
29287 Setting this variable twice is harmless.
29288 But don't staticpro it here--that is done in alloc.c. */
29289 Qchar_table_extra_slots = intern_c_string ("char-table-extra-slots");
29290 Fput (Qglyphless_char_display, Qchar_table_extra_slots, make_number (1));
29292 DEFVAR_LISP ("glyphless-char-display", Vglyphless_char_display,
29293 doc: /* Char-table defining glyphless characters.
29294 Each element, if non-nil, should be one of the following:
29295 an ASCII acronym string: display this string in a box
29296 `hex-code': display the hexadecimal code of a character in a box
29297 `empty-box': display as an empty box
29298 `thin-space': display as 1-pixel width space
29299 `zero-width': don't display
29300 An element may also be a cons cell (GRAPHICAL . TEXT), which specifies the
29301 display method for graphical terminals and text terminals respectively.
29302 GRAPHICAL and TEXT should each have one of the values listed above.
29304 The char-table has one extra slot to control the display of a character for
29305 which no font is found. This slot only takes effect on graphical terminals.
29306 Its value should be an ASCII acronym string, `hex-code', `empty-box', or
29307 `thin-space'. The default is `empty-box'. */);
29308 Vglyphless_char_display = Fmake_char_table (Qglyphless_char_display, Qnil);
29309 Fset_char_table_extra_slot (Vglyphless_char_display, make_number (0),
29310 Qempty_box);
29314 /* Initialize this module when Emacs starts. */
29316 void
29317 init_xdisp (void)
29319 current_header_line_height = current_mode_line_height = -1;
29321 CHARPOS (this_line_start_pos) = 0;
29323 if (!noninteractive)
29325 struct window *m = XWINDOW (minibuf_window);
29326 Lisp_Object frame = m->frame;
29327 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
29328 Lisp_Object root = FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f);
29329 struct window *r = XWINDOW (root);
29330 int i;
29332 echo_area_window = minibuf_window;
29334 wset_top_line (r, make_number (FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f)));
29335 wset_total_lines
29336 (r, make_number (FRAME_LINES (f) - 1 - FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f)));
29337 wset_total_cols (r, make_number (FRAME_COLS (f)));
29338 wset_top_line (m, make_number (FRAME_LINES (f) - 1));
29339 wset_total_lines (m, make_number (1));
29340 wset_total_cols (m, make_number (FRAME_COLS (f)));
29342 scratch_glyph_row.glyphs[TEXT_AREA] = scratch_glyphs;
29343 scratch_glyph_row.glyphs[TEXT_AREA + 1]
29344 = scratch_glyphs + MAX_SCRATCH_GLYPHS;
29346 /* The default ellipsis glyphs `...'. */
29347 for (i = 0; i < 3; ++i)
29348 default_invis_vector[i] = make_number ('.');
29352 /* Allocate the buffer for frame titles.
29353 Also used for `format-mode-line'. */
29354 int size = 100;
29355 mode_line_noprop_buf = xmalloc (size);
29356 mode_line_noprop_buf_end = mode_line_noprop_buf + size;
29357 mode_line_noprop_ptr = mode_line_noprop_buf;
29358 mode_line_target = MODE_LINE_DISPLAY;
29361 help_echo_showing_p = 0;
29364 /* Since w32 does not support atimers, it defines its own implementation of
29365 the following three functions in w32fns.c. */
29366 #ifndef WINDOWSNT
29368 /* Platform-independent portion of hourglass implementation. */
29370 /* Cancel a currently active hourglass timer, and start a new one. */
29371 void
29372 start_hourglass (void)
29374 #if defined (HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM)
29375 EMACS_TIME delay;
29377 cancel_hourglass ();
29379 if (INTEGERP (Vhourglass_delay)
29380 && XINT (Vhourglass_delay) > 0)
29381 delay = make_emacs_time (min (XINT (Vhourglass_delay),
29382 TYPE_MAXIMUM (time_t)),
29384 else if (FLOATP (Vhourglass_delay)
29385 && XFLOAT_DATA (Vhourglass_delay) > 0)
29386 delay = EMACS_TIME_FROM_DOUBLE (XFLOAT_DATA (Vhourglass_delay));
29387 else
29388 delay = make_emacs_time (DEFAULT_HOURGLASS_DELAY, 0);
29390 hourglass_atimer = start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, delay,
29391 show_hourglass, NULL);
29392 #endif
29396 /* Cancel the hourglass cursor timer if active, hide a busy cursor if
29397 shown. */
29398 void
29399 cancel_hourglass (void)
29401 #if defined (HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM)
29402 if (hourglass_atimer)
29404 cancel_atimer (hourglass_atimer);
29405 hourglass_atimer = NULL;
29408 if (hourglass_shown_p)
29409 hide_hourglass ();
29410 #endif
29412 #endif /* ! WINDOWSNT */